Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) Manuel Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) Manuel CISCO sur FNAC.COM

 

 

Télécharger le pdf 

http://www.cisco.com/en/US/docs/voice_ip_comm/cuipph/7962g_7942g/6_1/french_fra/user/guide/62fra61.pdf

Voir également d'autres Guide CISCO :

Cisco-Security-Appliance-Command-Line-ASA-5500-version-7-2

Cisco-Introduction-to-the-Security-Appliance

Cisco-ASR-9000-Series-Aggregation-Configuration-Guide-Release-4-2-x

Cisco-IOS-XR-Carrier-Grade-NAT-Configuration-Guide-for-the-Cisco-CRS-Router-Release-4-2-x

Cisco-ASR-9000-Series-Aggregation-Services-Router-Interface-and-Hardware-Component-Configuration-Guide-Release-4-2-x

Cisco-ASR-9000-Series-Aggregation-Services-Router-IP-Addresses-and-Services-Configuration-Guide-Release-4-2-x

Cisco-ASR-9000-Series-Aggregation-Services-Router-L2VPN-et-services-Ethernet-Configuration-Guide-version-4-2-x

Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Modular Quality of Service Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x

Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x

Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x

Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x

Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x

Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x

Siège social aux États-Unis Cisco Systems, Inc. 170 West Tasman Drive San Jose, CA 95134-1706 États-Unis http://www.cisco.com Tél. : +1 408 526-4000 +1 800 553-NETS (6387) Fax : +1 408 527-0883 Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP)Cisco, Cisco Systems, the Cisco logo, and the Cisco Systems logo are registered trademarks or trademarks of Cisco Systems, Inc. and/or its affiliates in the United States and certain other countries. All other trademarks mentioned in this document or Website are the property of their respective owners. The use of the word partner does not imply a partnership relationship between Cisco and any other company. (0705R) © 2007 Cisco Systems, Inc. All rights reserved. OL-15178-01 LIVRET DE RÉFÉRENCE Téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) Définition des touches dynamiques Icônes de l’écran du téléphone Icônes des boutons Tâches téléphoniques courantes Définition des touches dynamiques AGrpIntr Prendre un appel en sonnerie dans un groupe associé Annuler Annuler une opération ou quitter un écran sans appliquer les modifications effectuées autres Afficher d’autres touches dynamiques Bis Rappeler le dernier numéro composé Composer Composer un numéro de téléphone Conf. Créer une conférence téléphonique Détails (SCCP uniquement) Ouvrir l’enregistrement Détails d’un appel à plusieurs interlocuteurs dans lesjournaux d’appels en absence et d’appels reçus EditNum Modifier un numéro dans un journal d’appels Effacer Supprimer des enregistrements ou des paramètres Enreg. Sauvegarder les paramètres choisis Fermer Fermer la fenêtre active FinApp. Mettre fin à l’appel en cours (intercom ou non) GrpIntr Répondre à un appel en sonnerie dans un autre groupe InsConf Participer à un appel sur une ligne partagée et établir une conférence téléphonique Insert Vous ajouter à un appel sur une ligne partagée Intrcpt Prendre un appel de votre groupe Joindre (SCCP uniquement) Joindre plusieurs appels existants pour créer une conférence Liens Afficher des rubriques d’aide connexes ListConf Afficher la liste des participants à la conférence ModeVid. (SCCP uniquement) Choisir un mode d’affichage vidéo MàJ Actualiser le contenu Tâches téléphoniques courantes Afficher l’Aide en ligne sur le téléphone Appuyez sur . Passer un appel Décrochez avant ou après avoir composé un numéro. Rappeler le dernier numéro composé Appuyez sur Bis ou sur la touche de navigation (téléphone raccroché) pour afficher le journal des appels composés. Passer en mode Combiné au cours d’un appel Décrochez le combiné. Passer en mode haut-parleur ou casque en cours d’appel Appuyez sur ou sur , puis raccrochez le combiné. Activer le mode Coupure micro du téléphone Appuyez sur . Utiliser les journaux d’appels Appuyez sur pour choisir un journal d’appels. Pour numéroter, mettez une entrée de la liste en surbrillance et décrochez le téléphone. Modifier un numéro Appuyez sur EditNum, sur << ou sur >>. Mettre en attente/ reprendre un appel Appuyez sur Attente ou sur Reprend. Transférer un appel vers un nouveau numéro Appuyez sur Trnsfer, saisissez le numéro, puis appuyez de nouveau sur Trnsfer. Passer un appel intercom Appuyez sur le bouton intercom et, le cas échéant, saisissez un numéro. Quand vous entendez la tonalité, commencez à parler. Démarrer une conférence téléphonique standard (ad hoc) Appuyez sur autres > Conf., composez le numéro du participant, puis appuyez de nouveau sur Conf.MulConf Héberger une conférence téléphonique Mul-conf NPD Activer/Désactiver la fonction Ne pas déranger (NPD) NumAbr Composer un numéro en utilisant un code de numérotation abrégée NvAppel Passer un nouvel appel Parquer Stocker un appel à l’aide de la fonction de parcage d’appels Précédent Revenir à la rubrique d’aide précédente Principal Afficher le menu principal de l’Aide QRT Soumettre à l’administrateur système les problèmes relatifs aux appels Quitter Revenir à l’écran précédent Rappel Recevoir une notification lorsqu’un poste occupé se libère Recherch. Effectuer une recherche dans une liste de répertoires Réinit. Réinitialiser les valeurs par défaut des paramètres RenvTt Configurer/annuler le renvoi d’appels Répond. Prendre un appel Reprend Reprendre un appel en attente Rvoi Im Transférer ou rediriger un appel vers un système de messagerie vocale Sélect. Sélectionner une option de menu ou un appel SupDerA Abandonner le dernier interlocuteur à avoir rejoint une conférence téléphonique Suppr. Supprimer un participant de la conférence Supprimer Supprimer les caractères se trouvant à droite du curseur lors de l’utilisation de la touche EditNum TrnsDir (SCCP uniquement) Transférer deux appels l’un vers l’autre Trnsfer Transférer un appel << Supprimer les caractères saisis >> Passer d’un caractère saisi à un autre Icônes de l’écran du téléphone État de la ligne/de l’appel Renvoi d’appels activé Appel en attente Appel connecté Appel entrant Combiné décroché Combiné raccroché Ligne partagée en cours d’utilisation Message en attente Appel authentifié Appel chiffré Ligne occupée dans une numérotation abrégée, un journal d’appels ou une entrée de répertoire (fonction FLO) Ligne inactive dans une numérotation abrégée, un journal d’appels ou une entrée de répertoire (fonction FLO) Numérotation abrégée, journal d’appels ou entrée de répertoire (état de la ligne inconnu) Ligne en mode Ne pas déranger (fonction FLO) Ligne intercom inactive Ligne intercom unidirectionnelle Ligne intercom bidirectionnelle Mode audio ou vidéo Combiné en cours d’utilisation Casque en cours d’utilisation Icônes des boutons Haut-parleur en cours d’utilisation Vidéo activée (SCCP uniquement) Accès aux fonctions Fonction associée à un bouton Mobilité associée à un bouton Attente associée à un bouton Conférence associée à un bouton Transfert associé à un bouton URL de service téléphonique associée à un bouton L’entrée d’URL dans un journal d’appels peut maintenant être modifiée (SIP uniquement) Option sélectionnée Fonction activée Messages Services Aide Répertoires Paramètres Volume Haut-parleur Coupure micro CasqueManuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) iii Table des matieres Mise en route 1 Utilisation de ce guide 1 Recherche d’informations supplémentaires 2 Informations relatives à la sécurité et aux performances 2 Présentation de la sécurité des produits Cisco 3 Fonctions d’accessibilité 3 Raccordement du téléphone 4 Présentation du téléphone 7 Présentation des boutons et du matériel 7 Présentation des lignes et des appels 11 Présentation des icônes de lignes et d’appels 11 Présentation desfonctions de l’écran du téléphone 12 Nettoyage de l’écran du téléphone 13 Présentation des menus et des boutons de fonctions 14 Accès au système d’aide du téléphone 14 Explications relatives à la disponibilité des fonctions 15 Différence entre le protocole SIP et le protocole SCCP 16 Gestion de base des appels 17 Établissement d’un appel : options de base 17 Établissement d’un appel : options supplémentaires 18 Prise d’appel 20 Fin d’un appel 22 Utilisation des fonctions Attente et Reprise 22 Coupure du micro 23 Passage d’un appel à l’autre 24iv OL-15178-01 Transfert d’un appel en cours vers un autre téléphone 24 Affichage de plusieurs appels 25 Transfert d’appels 25 Transfert d’un appel vers un système demessagerie vocale 27 Renvoi des appels vers un autre numéro 27 Utilisation de la fonction Ne pas déranger 29 Établissement de conférences téléphoniques 30 Utilisation des fonctions de conférence 30 Utilisation de Conférence 30 Utilisation de la fonction Joindre 31 Utilisation de InsConf 32 Utilisation de la fonction Mul-conf 32 Affichage ou suppression de participants à une conférence 33 Passer ou recevoir des appels intercom 34 Gestion avancée des appels 35 Numérotation abrégée 35 Interception d’un appel redirigé sur votre téléphone 36 Stockage et récupération d’appels parqués 38 Déconnexion de groupes de recherche 39 Utilisation d’une ligne partagée 40 Présentation des lignes partagées 40 Utilisation de l’insertion pour vous ajouter à un appel sur une ligne partagée 40 Présentation des fonctions d’insertion 41 Utilisation des fonctions d’insertion 41 Procédure permettant d’empêcher d’autres personnes d’afficher un appel sur une ligne partagée ou de s’y joindre 42 Utilisation de FLO pour déterminer l’état d’une ligne 43 Émission et réception d’appels sécurisés 43 Suivi des appels suspects 44 Donner la priorité aux appels critiques 45 Utilisation de la fonction demobilité de poste de Cisco 46 Gestion des appels professionnels à l’aide d’un seul numéro de téléphone 47Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) v Utilisation du combiné, du casque et du haut-parleur 49 Acquisition d’un casque 50 Utilisation dumode Réponse automatique 50 Modification des paramètres du téléphone 51 Personnalisation dessonneries et desindicateurs demessage 51 Personnalisation de l’écran du téléphone 52 Utilisation des journaux d’appels et des répertoires 53 Utilisation des journaux d’appels 53 Composition depuis le répertoire 55 Utilisation du répertoire d’entreprise sur le téléphone 56 Utilisation du répertoire personnel sur le téléphone 57 Accès aux messages vocaux 60 Utilisation des pages Web Options utilisateur 61 Accès à vos pages Web Options utilisateur 61 Configuration des fonctions et des services sur le Web 62 Utilisation du répertoire personnel sur le Web 62 Utilisation de votre carnet d’adresses personnel sur le Web 62 Configuration de codes de carnet d’adresses personnel sur le Web 63 Utilisation de l’outil de synchronisation du carnet d’adresses 64 Configuration de numéros abrégés sur le Web 64 Configuration de services téléphoniques sur le Web 65 Contrôle des paramètres utilisateur sur le Web 66 Contrôle des paramètres de ligne sur le Web 67 Configuration des téléphones et des listes d’accès pour la connexion mobile 69 Utilisation de Cisco WebDialer 71vi OL-15178-01 Présentation des options de configuration supplémentaires 73 Dépannage du téléphone 76 Informations générales de dépannage 76 Affichage des données d’administration de votre téléphone 77 Utilisation de l’outil de génération de rapports qualité 77 Conditions générales de la garantie matérielle limitée à un an de Cisco 79 Index 81Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 1 Mise en route Utilisation de ce guide Ce guide propose une présentation générale des fonctions disponibles sur votre téléphone. Parcourez-le dans son intégralité pour prendre connaissance de toutes les possibilités de votre téléphone. Vous pouvez également vous reporter au tableau ci-après, qui permet d’atteindre d’un seul clic les sections les plus utilisées. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Apprendre à utiliser le téléphone par vous-même Lorsque vous avez besoin d’aide, appuyez sur sur le téléphone. Prendre connaissance des consignes de sécurité Reportez-vous à Informations relatives à la sécurité et aux performances page 2. Raccorder le téléphone Reportez-vous à Raccordement du téléphone page 4. Utiliser le téléphone une fois qu’il est installé Commencez par vous reporter à Présentation du téléphone page 7. Connaître la signification des boutons et des voyants Reportez-vous à Présentation des boutons et du matériel page 7. En savoir plus sur l’écran Reportez-vous à Présentation des fonctions de l’écran du téléphone page 12. Passer des appels Reportez-vous à Établissement d’un appel : options de base page 17. Mettre des appels en attente Reportez-vous à Utilisation des fonctions Attente et Reprise page 22. Désactiver le micro durant les appels Reportez-vous à Coupure du micro page 23. Transférer des appels Reportez-vous à Transfert d’appels page 25. Établir des conférences téléphoniques Reportez-vous à Établissement de conférences téléphoniques page 30. Configurer la numérotation abrégée Reportez-vous à Numérotation abrégée page 35. Partager un numéro de téléphone Reportez-vous à Utilisation d’une ligne partagée page 40.2 OL-15178-01 Recherche d’informations supplémentaires Pour obtenir la documentation la plus récente sur les téléphones IP Cisco Unified, reportez-vous au site Web à l’adresse suivante : http://www.cisco.com/en/US/products/hw/phones/ps379/tsd_products_support_series_home.html Vous pouvez accéder au site Web de Cisco à l’adresse suivante : http://www.cisco.com/ Le site Web de Cisco de chaque pays est accessible à l’adresse suivante : http://www.cisco.com/public/countries_languages.shtml Informations relatives à la sécurité et aux performances Cette section décrit l’effet des pannes d’électricité et des autres périphériques sur votre téléphone IP Cisco Unified. Panne d’électricité Pour accéder au service d’urgence, votre téléphone doit être alimenté. Si l’alimentation est interrompue, le service d’appel d’urgence et de réparation est indisponible pendant toute la durée de la coupure. Il se peut que vous deviez ensuite réinitialiser ou reconfigurer votre téléphone pour pouvoir utiliser le service d’appel d’urgence et de réparation. Utilisation de périphériques externes Les informations suivantes s’appliquent lorsque vous utilisez des périphériques externes avec le téléphone IP Cisco Unified. Cisco recommande d’utiliser des périphériques externes (casques, etc.) de bonne qualité et protégés des interférences produites par les signaux de fréquences radio et audio. Utiliser la fonction haut-parleur du téléphone Reportez-vous à Utilisation du combiné, du casque et du haut-parleur page 49. Modifier le volume ou la tonalité de la sonnerie Reportez-vous à Modification des paramètres du téléphone page 51. Connaître les appels en absence Reportez-vous à Utilisation des journaux d’appels et des répertoires page 53. Écouter vos messages vocaux Reportez-vous à Accès aux messages vocaux page 60. Connaître la définition des touches dynamiques et des icônes Reportez-vous au Livret de référence au début du présent manuel. Pour... Procédez comme suit :Mise en route Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 3 Selon la qualité de ces périphériques et leur proximité par rapport à d’autres périphériques, tels que des téléphones portables ou des radios bidirectionnelles, des parasites sonores peuvent toujours se produire. Dans ce cas, Cisco vous recommande d’effectuer une ou plusieurs des opérations suivantes : • Éloignez le périphérique externe de la source émettrice des signaux de fréquences radio ou audio. • Maintenez les câbles du périphérique externe éloignés de la source émettrice des signaux de fréquences radio ou audio. • Utilisez des câbles blindés pour le périphérique externe ou des câbles dotés d’un blindage supérieur et d’un meilleur connecteur. • Raccourcissez le câble du périphérique externe. • Utilisez des structures en ferrite ou d’autres dispositifs de ce type pour les câbles du périphérique externe. La société Cisco ne peut garantir les performances du système car elle ne dispose d’aucun moyen de contrôle sur la qualité des périphériques externes, des câbles et des connecteurs utilisés. Le système fonctionne de manière adéquate lorsque les périphériques appropriés sont connectés à l’aide de câbles et de connecteurs de bonne qualité. Avertissement Dans les pays de l’Union européenne, utilisez uniquement des casques externes conformes à la Directive [89/336/CE] sur la compatibilité électromagnétique (CEM). Présentation de la sécurité des produits Cisco Ce produit contient des fonctions cryptographiques et est soumis aux lois des États-Unis et des autres pays qui en régissent l’importation, l’exportation, le transfert et l’utilisation. La fourniture de produits cryptographiques Cisco n’autorise pas un tiers à importer, exporter, distribuer ou utiliser le chiffrement. Les importateurs, exportateurs, distributeurs et utilisateurs sont responsables du respect des lois américaines et des autres pays. Si vous utilisez ce produit, vous vous engagez à respecter les lois et réglementations applicables. Si vous n’êtes pas en mesure de respecter les lois américaines et des autres pays, renvoyez-nous ce produit immédiatement. Vous trouverez un récapitulatif des lois américaines qui régissent les produits cryptographiques Cisco à l’adresse : http://www.cisco.com/wwl/export/crypto/tool/stqrg.html. Si vous avez besoin d’aide supplémentaire, contactez-nous par e-mail à l’adresse export@cisco.com. Fonctions d’accessibilité La liste des fonctions d’accessibilité est disponible sur demande.4 OL-15178-01 Raccordement du téléphone Votre administrateur système sera probablement chargé de raccorder votre nouveau téléphone IP Cisco Unified au réseau de téléphonie IP de votre entreprise. Si ce n’est pas le cas, reportez-vous à l’illustration et au tableau ci-dessous pour raccorder le téléphone. 1 Port de l’adaptateur CC (48 V) 5 Port d’accès (10/100 PC) 2 Alimentation CA vers CC 6 Prise du combiné 3 Cordon secteur 7 Prise du casque 4 Port réseau (10/100 SW) 8 Bouton du socle AUX DC48V 10/100 SW 10/100 PC + 113656 2 8 3 4 5 6 7 1Raccordement du téléphone Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 5 Réglage du socle Pour modifier l’angle de la base de votre téléphone, maintenez le bouton du socle enfoncé pendant que vous réglez le socle. Réglage du support du combiné Cisco recommande de régler le support du combiné, notamment lors du montage mural du téléphone. Cette opération évite que le récepteur tombe facilement de son support. Reportez-vous au tableau ci-dessous pour obtenir les instructions correspondantes. Enregistrement à l’aide de l’outil TAPS Une fois votre téléphone raccordé au réseau, votre administrateur système peut vous demander d’enregistrer automatiquement votre téléphone à l’aide de l’outil TAPS (Tool for Auto-Registered Phones Support, Outil d’assistance des téléphones enregistrés automatiquement). L’outil TAPS peut être utilisé aussi bien pour un nouveau téléphone que pour remplacer un téléphone existant. Pour enregistrer un téléphone à l’aide de l’outil TAPS, décrochez le combiné, saisissez le numéro de poste TAPS fourni par votre administrateur système et suivez les instructions vocales. Il se peut que vous ayez à saisir la totalité de votre numéro de poste, y compris l’indicatif régional. Lorsque votre téléphone affiche un message de confirmation, raccrochez. Le processus de redémarrage du téléphone est lancé. 1 Posez le combiné sur le côté et tirez vers le haut la plaquette en plastique carrée du support du combiné. 2 Faites pivoter la plaquette de 180 degrés. 3 Pour remettre la plaquette en place sur le support du combiné, faites-la coulisser. Une extension ressort en haut de la plaquette qui a pivoté. Replacez le combiné sur son support. 1 2 3 1205216 OL-15178-01 Informations sur le casque Pour utiliser un casque, branchez-le sur la prise correspondante située à l’arrière du téléphone. Bien que Cisco Systems réalise des essais internes sur des casques de fournisseurs tiers utilisés avec les téléphones IP Cisco Unified, Cisco ne certifie, ni ne promeut de produits de fournisseurs de casques ou de combinés. En raison des contraintes environnementales et matérielles liées aux différents sites de déploiement des téléphones IP Cisco Unified, il n’existe pas de solution optimale unique pour tous les environnements. Cisco recommande à ses clients de tester les casques qui fonctionnent le mieux dans leur environnement avant de les déployer à grande échelle sur leur réseau. Dans certains cas, les pièces mécaniques ou les composants électroniques de différents casques peuvent provoquer un écho sur le poste des interlocuteurs des utilisateurs de téléphones IP Cisco Unified. Cisco Systems recommande d’utiliser des périphériques externes de bonne qualité, tels que des casques blindés contre les interférences produites par les signaux de fréquences radio (FR) ou audio (FA). En fonction de la qualité de ces périphériques et de leur proximité par rapport à d’autres appareils, tels que les téléphones portables et les radios bidirectionnelles, des parasites sonores peuvent toujours se produire. Pour déterminer si un casque donné convient au téléphone IP Cisco Unified, vérifiez avant tout qu’il ne provoque pas de ronflement sonore. Ce ronflement peut être entendu soit par votre interlocuteur uniquement, soit par votre interlocuteur et par vous-même (utilisateur du téléphone IP Cisco Unified). Certains ronflements ou bourdonnements potentiels peuvent être dus à de nombreuses causes extérieures, par exemple l’éclairage électrique, la proximité de moteurs électriques ou de grands écrans de PC. Dans certains cas, il est possible de réduire ou d’éliminer le ronflement entendu par un utilisateur à l’aide d’un groupe amplificateur de puissance local ou d’un injecteur de puissance. Qualité audio à l’appréciation de l’utilisateur Au-delà des performances physiques, mécaniques et techniques, la qualité sonore d’un casque doit vous sembler bonne à vous-même (l’utilisateur) et à votre interlocuteur. Le son est un facteur subjectif. Par conséquent, Cisco ne peut pas garantir les performances d’un casque ou d’un combiné. Toutefois, certains des casques et combinés disponibles sur les sites indiqués ci-dessous semblent fonctionner correctement sur les téléphones IP Cisco Unified. Néanmoins, il appartient en dernier ressort au client de tester cet équipement dans son propre environnement pour déterminer si ses performances sont acceptables. Pour plus d’informations sur les casques, visitez les sites suivants : http://www.vxicorp.com/cisco http://www.plantronics.com http://www.jabra.comPrésentation du téléphone Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 7 Présentation du téléphone Le Téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G est un téléphone intégré qui permet une communication vocale via le réseau de données utilisé par votre ordinateur. Ainsi, vous pouvez passer et recevoir des appels téléphoniques, mettre des appels en attente, utiliser la numérotation abrégée, transférer des appels, établir des conférences téléphoniques, etc. Outre ses capacités de gestion de base des appels, votre téléphone prend en charge certaines fonctions d’optimisation de productivité. Selon la configuration de votre téléphone, celui-ci peut prendre en charge : • l’accès aux données du réseau, aux applications XML et aux services Web ; • la personnalisation en ligne des fonctions et services du téléphone à partir de vos pages Web Options utilisateur ; • un système d’aide en ligne complet qui affiche des informations sur l’écran du téléphone. Présentation des boutons et du matériel Pour identifier les boutons et les composants matériels du téléphone, reportez-vous à l’illustration et au tableau ci-dessous. Téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G 1 16 3 4 5 7 9 6 8 15 14 13 12 11 10 184911 1 28 OL-15178-01 Téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7942G 184910 4 5 6 7 9 15 14 13 12 11 10 16 1 3 8 1 2Présentation du téléphone Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 9 Élément Description Pour en savoir plus, reportez-vous à... 1 Touches programmables Selon la configuration du téléphone, les touches programmables permettent l’accès aux : • Lignes téléphoniques et lignes intercom (boutons de ligne) • Numéros abrégés (touches de numérotation abrégée, y compris la fonction de ligne occupée FLO) • Services en ligne (par exemple, bouton du carnet d’adresses personnel) • Fonctions d’appel (par exemple, un bouton de confidentialité, de mise en attente ou de transfert) Les boutons s’allument pour indiquer les états suivants : Vert fixe : appel actif ou appel intercom bidirectionnel Vert clignotant : appel en attente Orange fixe : fonction de confidentialité en cours d’utilisation, appel intercom unidirectionnel, activation de NPD ou connexion établie avec un groupe de recherche Orange clignotant : appel entrant ou à reprendre Rouge fixe : ligne distante utilisée (ligne partagée ou état FLO) • Présentation des fonctions de l’écran du téléphone page 12 • Gestion de base des appels page 17 • Numérotation abrégée page 35 • Utilisation d’une ligne partagée page 40 • Utilisation de FLO pour déterminer l’état d’une ligne page 43 • Utilisation de FLO pour déterminer l’état d’une ligne page 43 • Passer ou recevoir des appels intercom page 34 2 Écran du téléphone Affiche les fonctions téléphoniques. Présentation des fonctions de l’écran du téléphone page 12 3 Bouton du socle Permet de régler l’angle du socle du téléphone. Réglage du socle page 5 4 Bouton Messages Compose automatiquement le numéro de votre service de messagerie vocale (variable selon les services). Accès aux messages vocaux page 6010 OL-15178-01 5 Bouton Répertoires Active ou désactive le menu Répertoires et permet d’accéder aux journaux d’appels et aux répertoires. Utilisation des journaux d’appels page 53 6 Bouton Aide Active le menu Aide. Accès au système d’aide du téléphone page 14 7 Bouton Paramètres Active ou désactive le menu Paramètres et permet de contrôler le contraste de l’écran et les sonneries. Modification des paramètres du téléphone page 51 8 Bouton Services Active ou désactive le menu Services. Utilisation des pages Web Options utilisateur page 61 9 Bouton Volume Contrôle le volume du combiné, du casque et du haut-parleur (décroché), ainsi que le volume de la sonnerie (raccroché). Utilisation du combiné, du casque et du haut-parleur page 49 10 Bouton Haut-parleur Active ou désactive le mode haut-parleur. Lorsque le mode haut-parleur est activé, le bouton est allumé. Utilisation du combiné, du casque et du haut-parleur page 49 11 Bouton de coupure du micro Active ou désactive le micro. Lorsque le micro est coupé, le bouton est allumé. Coupure du micro page 23 12 Bouton Casque Active ou désactive le mode casque. Lorsque le mode casque est activé, le bouton est allumé. Utilisation du combiné, du casque et du haut-parleur page 49 13 Bouton Navigation Permet de faire défiler les menus et de mettre les options de menu en surbrillance. Lorsque le téléphone est raccroché, ce bouton permet d’afficher les numéros de téléphone du journal d’appels passés. Utilisation des journaux d’appels page 53 14 Clavier Permet de composer des numéros de téléphone, de saisir des lettres et de sélectionner des options de menu. Gestion de base des appels page 17 15 Touches dynamiques Chacune de ces touches active une option (affichée sur l’écran du téléphone). Présentation des fonctions de l’écran du téléphone page 12 16 Bande lumineuse du combiné Signale un appel entrant ou un nouveau message vocal. Accès aux messages vocaux page 60 Élément Description Pour en savoir plus, reportez-vous à...Présentation du téléphone Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 11 Présentation des lignes et des appels Pour éviter toute confusion entre une ligne et un appel, reportez-vous aux définitions suivantes : Lignes : chacune est associée à un numéro de répertoire ou à un numéro intercom que vos contacts peuvent utiliser pour vous appeler. Les téléphones IP Cisco Unified 7962G et 7942G prennent en charge respectivement une à six lignes et une à deux lignes, selon la configuration. Pour connaître le nombre de lignes dont vous disposez, regardez à droite de l’écran du téléphone. Vous disposez d’autant de lignes que de numéros d’annuaire et d’icônes de lignes téléphoniques . Appels : chaque ligne peut prendre en charge plusieurs appels. Par défaut, le téléphone prend en charge quatre appels connectés par ligne mais l’administrateur système peut adapter ce nombre à vos besoins. Il ne peut y avoir qu’un seul appel actif ; tous les autres appels sont automatiquement mis en attente. Présentation des icônes de lignes et d’appels Votre téléphone affiche des icônes pour vous aider à connaître l’état d’appel ou de ligne. Icône État de la ligne ou de l’appel Description Combiné raccroché Aucune activité d’appel sur cette ligne. Combiné décroché Vous êtes en train de composer un numéro ou un appel sortant est en sonnerie. Appel connecté La communication avec votre interlocuteur est actuellement établie. Appel en sonnerie Un appel entrant est en sonnerie sur l’une de vos lignes. Appel en attente Vous avez mis l’appel en attente. Reportez-vous à Utilisation des fonctions Attente et Reprise page 22. Utilisé à distance Un autre téléphone qui partage votre ligne a un appel connecté. Pour plus d’informations, reportez-vous à Utilisation d’une ligne partagée page 40. Appel à reprendre Vous avez un appel en attente à reprendre sur votre téléphone. Reportez-vous à Utilisation des fonctions Attente et Reprise page 22. Appel authentifié Reportez-vous à Émission et réception d’appels sécurisés page 43. Appel chiffré Reportez-vous à Émission et réception d’appels sécurisés page 43. Ligne inactive (FLO) Reportez-vous à Utilisation de FLO pour déterminer l’état d’une ligne page 43.12 OL-15178-01 Présentation des fonctions de l’écran du téléphone Lorsque des appels sont actifs et que plusieurs menus de fonctions sont ouverts, l’écran principal du téléphone se présente de la façon suivante : Ligne occupée (FLO) Reportez-vous à Utilisation de FLO pour déterminer l’état d’une ligne page 43. Ligne en mode Ne pas déranger (FLO) Reportez-vous à Utilisation de FLO pour déterminer l’état d’une ligne page 43. Ligne intercom inactive La ligne intercom n’est pas utilisée. Reportez-vous à Passer ou recevoir des appels intercom page 34. Appel intercom unidirectionnel La ligne intercom envoie ou reçoit des données audio unidirectionnelles. Reportez-vous à Passer ou recevoir des appels intercom page 34. Appel intercom bidirectionnel Le destinataire a appuyé sur le bouton de ligne intercom pour utiliser la fonction audio bidirectionnelle avec l’appelant. Reportez-vous à Passer ou recevoir des appels intercom page 34. Icône État de la ligne ou de l’appel Description 7 1 6 5 4 2 3 137522 77961Présentation du téléphone Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 13 Nettoyage de l’écran du téléphone Utilisez uniquement un chiffon doux et sec pour essuyer l’écran du téléphone. N’utilisez pas de produits liquides ou en poudre sur le téléphone, car ils risquent d’endommager les composants de l’appareil et donc d’entraîner des dysfonctionnements. 1 Ligne téléphonique principale Affiche le numéro de téléphone (numéro de répertoire) de votre ligne téléphonique principale. Lorsque plusieurs onglets de fonctions sont ouverts, le numéro de téléphone, l’heure et la date s’affichent en alternance à cet endroit. 2 Indicateurs des touches programmables Les touches programmables peuvent servir de boutons de lignes téléphoniques, de boutons de numérotation abrégée, de boutons de services téléphoniques ou de Touches dynamiquess téléphoniques. Les icônes et les étiquettes indiquent le mode de configuration de ces boutons. Pour obtenir des informations sur une icône, reportez-vous à « Icônes de l’écran du téléphone » dans le Livret de référence au début du présent manuel. 3 Étiquettes des touches dynamiques Chacune décrit la fonction d’une touche dynamique. Pour activer une touche dynamique, appuyez sur le bouton correspondant. 4 Ligne d’état Affiche les icônes du mode audio, les informations d’état et les invites. 5 Zone d’activité des appels Affiche les appels en cours par ligne, notamment l’ID de l’appelant, la durée et l’état de l’appel pour la ligne mise en surbrillance (en mode d’affichage standard). Reportez-vous à « Présentation des icônes de lignes et d’appels » à la page 11 et à Affichage de plusieurs appels page 25. 6 Onglet de téléphone Indique l’activité des appels. Si nécessaire, appuyez sur cet onglet pour revenir à la zone d’activité des appels. 7 Onglets de fonctionnalités Indiquent qu’un menu de fonctions est ouvert. Reportez-vous à Présentation des menus et des boutons de fonctions page 14.14 OL-15178-01 Présentation des menus et des boutons de fonctions Appuyez sur une touche dynamique pour ouvrir ou fermer un menu de fonctions. Accès au système d’aide du téléphone Votre téléphone comprend un système complet d’aide en ligne. Les rubriques d’aide apparaissent à l’écran du téléphone. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Ouvrir ou fermer un menu de fonctions Appuyez sur une touche dynamique : Messages Services Répertoires Paramètres Aide relative à Faire défiler une liste ou un menu Appuyez sur le bouton Navigation. Remonter d’un niveau au sein d’un menu de fonctions Appuyez sur Quitter. Si vous appuyez sur Quitter alors que vous êtes dans le niveau supérieur d’un menu, ce dernier se ferme. Passer d’un menu de fonctions actif à un autre Appuyez sur un onglet de fonction. Chaque menu de fonctions a un onglet. Celui-ci est visible lorsque le menu de fonctions est ouvert. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Afficher le menu principal Appuyez sur le bouton du téléphone et attendez quelques secondes que le menu s’affiche. Les rubriques du menu principal abordent les thèmes suivants. • À propos de votre téléphone IP Cisco Unified : détails • Procédures relatives aux tâches téléphoniques courantes • Fonctions d’appel : description et procédures d’utilisation des fonctions d’appel • Aide : conseils sur l’utilisation et l’accèsPrésentation du téléphone Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 15 Explications relatives à la disponibilité des fonctions Selon la configuration de votre système téléphonique, certaines fonctionnalités décrites dans ce guide sont susceptibles de ne pas être disponibles dans votre cas ou de fonctionner différemment. Pour en savoir plus sur le fonctionnement ou la disponibilité des fonctions, contactez un membre de l’équipe d’assistance ou votre administrateur système. Une touche dynamique ou un bouton de ligne peut permettre d’accéder à de nombreuses fonctions. Vous pouvez configurer certaines fonctions, mais votre administrateur contrôle la plupart d’entre elles. L’accès aux fonctions au moyen des touches dynamiques et des boutons de ligne est résumé ci-dessous. Obtenir des informations sur un bouton ou une touche dynamique Appuyez sur , puis rapidement sur le bouton ou la touche dynamique. Obtenir des informations sur une option de menu Appuyez sur , ou pour afficher un menu de fonctions. Mettez une option du menu en surbrillance, puis appuyez deux fois rapidement sur . Apprendre à se servir de l’aide Appuyez deux fois rapidement sur . Sélectionnez la rubrique de votre choix. Fonctionnalité Touche dynamique Étiquette et icône du bouton de ligne Rappel Rappel Rappel Renvoi d’appels RenvTt Renv. tous les appels Parcage d’appel Parquer Parquer Interception d’appels Intrcpt Intrcpt Conférence Conf. Conférence Liste de conférence ListConf Liste de conférence Ne pas déranger NPD Ne pas déranger ou Ne pas déranger Mettre fin à un appel FinApp. Mettre fin à un appel Interception d’appels de groupe GrpIntr Interception d’appels de groupe Attente Attente Attente Pour... Procédez comme suit :16 OL-15178-01 Différence entre le protocole SIP et le protocole SCCP Votre téléphone peut être configuré pour fonctionner avec l’un de ces deux protocoles de signalisation : SIP (Session Initiation Protocol) ou SCCP (Skinny Call Control Protocol). C’est votre administrateur système qui détermine cette configuration. Les fonctions disponibles sur le téléphone dépendent du protocole choisi. Le présent manuel indique les fonctions spécifiques à chaque protocole. Pour déterminer le protocole configuré sur votre téléphone, contactez votre administrateur système ou sélectionnez l’option > Caractéristiques > Protocole de contrôle d’appel sur votre téléphone. Groupe de recherche Groupmt Groupe de recherche ou Groupe de recherche Identification d’appels malveillants IDAM ID appelant malveillant Conférences Mul-conf MulConf MulConf Mobilité Mobilité Mobilité Nouvel appel NvAppel Nouvel appel Autre groupe de prise d’appel AGrpIntr Autre groupe de prise d’appel Outil de génération de rapports qualité QRT Outil de génération de rapports qualité Bis Bis Bis Suppression du dernier participant à une conférence SupDerA Supprimer le dernier participant Transfert Trnsfer Transfert Commande du mode vidéo ModeVid. Vidéo Fonctionnalité Touche dynamique Étiquette et icône du bouton de ligneGestion de base des appels Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 17 Gestion de base des appels Les tâches de gestion de base des appels s’appuient sur un ensemble de fonctions et de services. La disponibilité des fonctionnalités peut varier. Pour plus d’informations, tournez-vous vers votre administrateur système. Établissement d’un appel: options de base Voici quelques méthodes simples pour passer un appel depuis votre téléphone IP Cisco Unified. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Pour en savoir plus, reportez-vous à... Passer un appel à l’aide du combiné Décrochez le combiné et saisissez un numéro. Présentation du téléphone page 7 Passer un appel en utilisant le haut-parleur Appuyez sur , puis saisissez un numéro. Utilisation du combiné, du casque et du haut-parleur page 49 Passer un appel en utilisant le casque Appuyez sur , puis saisissez un numéro. Si le bouton est allumé, vous pouvez également appuyer sur NvAppel et composer un numéro. Utilisation du combiné, du casque et du haut-parleur page 49 Rappeler un numéro Appuyez sur Bis pour composer le dernier numéro ou sur la touche de navigation pour afficher les appels passés (dans ce dernier cas, le téléphone doit être inactif). Utilisation des journaux d’appels page 53 Passer un appel lorsqu’un autre appel est actif (en utilisant la même ligne) 1. Appuyez sur Attente. 2. Appuyez ensuite sur NvAppel. 3. Saisissez un numéro. Utilisation des fonctions Attente et Reprise page 22 Composer un numéro à partir d’un journal d’appels 1. Sélectionnez > Appels en absence, Appels reçus ou Appels composés. 2. Sélectionnez ou recherchez une entrée de la liste, puis décrochez le téléphone. Utilisation des journaux d’appels page 5318 OL-15178-01 Conseils • Vous pouvez composer un numéro avec le combiné raccroché et sans tonalité (prénumérotation). Pour la prénumérotation, entrez un numéro, puis décrochez en soulevant le combiné ou en appuyant sur Compos., ou . • Lors de la prénumérotation, le téléphone tente d’anticiper le numéro en cours de composition. Pour ce faire, il utilise le journal d’appels passés pour afficher les numéros correspondants (s’ils sont disponibles). Cette opération s’appelle la numérotation automatique. Pour la lancer à l’écran, appuyez sur un numéro affiché ou une autre occurrence de la liste, puis décrochez le combiné. • Si vous commettez une erreur pendant la numérotation, appuyez sur << pour effacer des chiffres. Établissement d’un appel: options supplémentaires Vous pouvez passer des appels à l’aide des fonctions et services spéciaux éventuellement disponibles sur votre téléphone. Pour plus d’informations sur ces options supplémentaires, contactez votre administrateur système. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Pour en savoir plus, reportez-vous à... Passer un appel lorsqu’un autre est actif (sur une ligne différente) 1. Appuyez sur pour une nouvelle ligne. Le premier appel est automatiquement mis en attente. 2. Saisissez un numéro. Utilisation des fonctions Attente et Reprise page 22 Composer un numéro abrégé Procédez comme suit : • Appuyez sur (bouton de numérotation abrégée). • Utilisez la fonctionnalité NumAbr. • Utilisez la fonction de numérotation abrégée. Numérotation abrégée page 35 Composer un numéro à partir d’un répertoire d’entreprise disponible sur le téléphone 1. Sélectionnez > Répertoire d’entreprise (le nom exact de la fonction peut varier). 2. Saisissez un nom, puis appuyez sur Recher. 3. Mettez l’entrée de la liste en surbrillance et décrochez. Utilisation des journaux d’appels page 53Gestion de base des appels Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 19 Utiliser un répertoire d’entreprise sur un ordinateur pour composer un numéro à l’aide de la fonctionnalité Cisco WebDialer 1. Ouvrez un navigateur Web et accédez au répertoire compatible WebDialer de votre entreprise. 2. Cliquez sur le numéro à composer. Utilisation de Cisco WebDialer page 71 Utiliser la fonction de rappel Cisco pour recevoir une notification lorsqu’un poste occupé ou en sonnerie se libère 1. Appuyez sur Rappel lorsque vous entendez la tonalité occupé ou la sonnerie. 2. Raccrochez. Le téléphone vous avertit lorsque la ligne se libère. 3. Passez de nouveau l’appel. Votre administrateur système Vérifier si une ligne associée à un numéro abrégé, un journal d’appels ou une liste de répertoires est occupée avant de l’appeler Recherchez les indicateurs d’affichage de ligne occupée. Utilisation de FLO pour déterminer l’état d’une ligne page 43 Passer un appel prioritaire (qui a la préséance) (uniquement sur les téléphones SCCP) Entrez le numéro d’accès MLPP, puis le numéro de téléphone. Donner la priorité aux appels critiques page 45 Composer un numéro depuis une entrée de carnet d’adresses personnel 1. Sélectionnez > Répertoire personnel pour vous connecter. 2. Sélectionnez Carnet d’adresses personnel et recherchez le numéro dans la liste. Utilisation du répertoire personnel sur le téléphone page 57 Passer un appel à l’aide d’un code de facturation ou de suivi (uniquement sur les téléphones SCCP) 1. Composez le numéro. 2. Lorsque vous entendez la tonalité, saisissez un code d’affaire client ou un code d’autorisation forcée. Votre administrateur système Pour... Procédez comme suit : Pour en savoir plus, reportez-vous à...20 OL-15178-01 Prise d’appel Vous pouvez prendre un appel en décrochant le combiné ou en utilisant d’autres options éventuellement disponibles sur le téléphone. Passer un appel en utilisant votre profil de mobilité de poste Cisco Connectez-vous au service de mobilité de poste de Cisco sur un téléphone. Utilisation de la fonction de mobilité de poste de Cisco page 46 Utiliser la fonction d’accès vocal mobile pour passer un appel depuis un téléphone portable 1. Composez le numéro d’accès vocal mobile qui vous a été attribué. 2. Saisissez le numéro de votre téléphone portable, si vous y êtes invité, et votre PIN. 3. Appuyez sur 1 pour effectuer un appel vers un téléphone IP d’entreprise. 4. Composez le numéro d’un téléphone de bureau autre que le vôtre. Remarque Avant d’effectuer un appel à l’aide de la fonction, procurez-vous le numéro d’accès vocal mobile et le PIN de l’utilisateur final auprès de votre administrateur système. Utilisation de la fonction de mobilité de poste de Cisco page 46 Pour... Procédez comme suit : Pour en savoir plus, reportez-vous à... Répondre en mode casque Si le bouton est éteint, appuyez dessus. Si la touche est déjà allumée, appuyez sur Répond. ou sur (clignotement). Utilisation du combiné, du casque et du haut-parleur page 49 Répondre en mode haut-parleur Appuyez sur , Répond. ou sur (voyant clignotant). Utilisation du combiné, du casque et du haut-parleur page 49 Prendre un nouvel appel à partir d’un appel déjà connecté Appuyez sur Répond. ou, si l’appel est en sonnerie sur une autre ligne, appuyez sur (clignotement). Utilisation des fonctions Attente et Reprise page 22 Pour... Procédez comme suit : Pour en savoir plus, reportez-vous à...Gestion de base des appels Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 21 Répondre à l’aide de la fonction d’appel en attente Appuyez sur Répond. Utilisation des fonctions Attente et Reprise page 22 Transférer un appel vers un système de messagerie vocale Appuyez sur Rvoi Im. Transfert d’un appel vers un système de messagerie vocale page 27 Connecter automatiquement des appels Utilisez la fonctionnalité de réponse automatique. Utilisation du mode Réponse automatique page 50 Récupérer un appel parqué sur un autre téléphone Utilisez Parcage d’appel ou Parcage d’appels dirigé. Stockage et récupération d’appels parqués page 38 Utiliser le téléphone pour prendre un appel en sonnerie ailleurs Utilisez la fonction d’interception d’appels. Interception d’un appel redirigé sur votre téléphone page 36 Prendre un appel prioritaire (uniquement sur les téléphones SCCP) Mettez fin à l’appel en cours en raccrochant, puis appuyez sur Répond. Donner la priorité aux appels critiques page 45 Prendre un appel sur votre téléphone portable ou à une autre destination distante Activez la connexion mobile et répondez sur votre téléphone. Lorsque vous activez la connexion mobile : • Votre bureau et vos destinations distantes reçoivent les appels simultanément. • Lorsque vous prenez l’appel sur votre téléphone de bureau, la sonnerie s’interrompt, la déconnexion se produit et un message d’appel en absence s’affiche aux destinations distantes. • Lorsque vous prenez l’appel à une destination distante, la sonnerie s’interrompt, la déconnexion se produit et un message d’appel en absence s’affiche aux autres destinations distantes. Utilisation de la fonction de mobilité de poste de Cisco page 46 Pour... Procédez comme suit : Pour en savoir plus, reportez-vous à...22 OL-15178-01 Conseil Si les interlocuteurs d’un appel entendent un bip, l’appel est peut-être surveillé ou enregistré. Pour plus d’informations, contactez votre administrateur système. Fin d’un appel Pour mettre fin à un appel, raccrochez. Le tableau ci-dessous présente des informations à ce sujet. Utilisation des fonctions Attente et Reprise Vous pouvez mettre des appels en attente et les reprendre. Lorsque vous mettez un appel en attente, l’icône Attente apparaît en regard de l’ID de l’appelant et le bouton de la ligne correspondante clignote en vert . Si la fonction Récupérer l’appel en attente est activée sur votre téléphone, l’appel que vous avez mis en attente sonne de nouveau au bout d’un certain temps. Un appel en attente reste en attente jusqu’à ce que vous le repreniez ou que cette fonction expire. Votre téléphone peut vous indiquer la présence d’un appel à reprendre de diverses manières : • En vous avertissant à intervalles réguliers par une sonnerie (ou par un clignotement ou un bip, selon la configuration de votre ligne téléphonique) • En affichant brièvement Récupérer l’appel en attente dans la barre d’état, en bas de l’écran du téléphone • En affichant l’icône animée Récupérer l’appel en attente en regard de l’ID de l’appelant correspondant à l’appel • En affichant un bouton de ligne orange (voyant clignotant, selon l’état de la ligne). Pour... Procédez comme suit : Raccrocher lorsque vous utilisez le combiné Raccrochez le combiné. Autre possibilité : appuyez sur FinApp. Raccrocher lorsque vous utilisez le casque Appuyez sur . Pour que le mode casque reste activé, appuyez sur FinApp. Raccrocher en cas d’utilisation du haut-parleur Appuyez sur ou sur FinApp. Mettre fin à un appel sans pour autant mettre fin à un autre appel sur la même ligne Appuyez sur FinApp. Si nécessaire, récupérez d’abord l’appel mis en attente.Gestion de base des appels Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 23 Conseils • Habituellement, l’activation de la fonction de mise en attente génère de la musique ou un bip. • Si vous êtes informé au même moment de l’arrivée d’un appel entrant et d’un appel à reprendre, l’écran de votre téléphone affiche en priorité l’appel entrant (par défaut). Votre administrateur système peut modifier ce paramètre de priorité. • Si vous utilisez une ligne partagée, la fonction Récupérer l’appel en attente permet d’appliquer la sonnerie uniquement au téléphone ayant mis l’appel en attente et non aux autres téléphones de ce réseau. • Votre administrateur système détermine le délai entre les alertes de la fonction Récupérer l’appel en attente. Coupure du micro Lorsque la coupure micro est activée, vous pouvez entendre vos interlocuteurs, mais ces derniers ne peuvent pas vous entendre. Il est possible d’utiliser cette fonction avec le combiné, le haut-parleur ou le casque. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Mettre un appel en attente 1. Assurez-vous que l’appel à mettre en attente est mis en surbrillance. 2. Appuyez sur Attente. Reprendre sur la ligne active un appel mis en attente 1. Vérifiez que l’appel concerné est en surbrillance. 2. Appuyez sur Reprend. Reprendre sur une autre ligne un appel mis en attente 1. Appuyez sur le bouton de ligne correspondant : ou (voyant clignotant). Cela peut entraîner la reprise automatique d’un appel en attente : • Si la ligne comporte un appel à récupérer, celui-ci est repris. • Si la ligne comporte plusieurs appels à récupérer, le plus ancien est repris. • Si la ligne comporte uniquement un appel en attente qui n’est pas à récupérer, celui-ci est repris. 2. Le cas échéant, recherchez l’appel concerné dans la liste, puis appuyez sur Reprise. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Activer le microphone Appuyez sur . Désactiver le microphone Appuyez sur .24 OL-15178-01 Passage d’un appel à l’autre Vous pouvez passer d’un appel à un autre, sur une ou plusieurs lignes. Si l’appel sur lequel vous voulez basculer n’est pas automatiquement mis en surbrillance, utilisez le bouton de navigation pour l’atteindre. Transfert d’un appel en cours vers un autre téléphone Vous pouvez transférer l’appel en cours de votre téléphone de bureau vers votre portable ou une autre destination distante. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Passer d’un appel connecté à l’autre sur une même ligne 1. Assurez-vous que l’appel vers lequel vous souhaitez basculer est mis en surbrillance. 2. Appuyez sur Reprend. Les appels en cours sont mis en attente et l’appel sélectionné est de nouveau actif. Passer d’un appel connecté à l’autre sur différentes lignes Appuyez sur le bouton de la ligne sur laquelle passer. Si la ligne ne comporte qu’un seul appel en attente, la reprise de ce dernier est automatique. Si elle en comporte plusieurs, mettez l’appel concerné en surbrillance, puis appuyez sur Reprise. Répondre à un appel en sonnerie à partir d’un appel déjà connecté Appuyez sur Répond. ou, si l’appel est en sonnerie sur une autre ligne, appuyez sur (voyant clignotant). Les appels en cours sont mis en attente et l’appel sélectionné est de nouveau actif. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Transférer l’appel en cours de votre téléphone de bureau vers un portable 1. Appuyez sur la touche dynamique Mobilité, puis sélectionnez Transférer l’appel vers le téléphone portable. 2. Répondez à l’appel en cours sur votre portable. Le bouton de la ligne du téléphone de bureau devient rouge et les icônes du combiné ainsi que le numéro de l’appelant apparaissent sur l’écran du téléphone. Vous ne pouvez pas utiliser la même ligne téléphonique pour d’autres appels mais, si votre téléphone de bureau prend en charge plusieurs lignes, vous pouvez utiliser une autre ligne pour émettre ou recevoir des appels. Transférer l’appel en cours d’un portable vers votre téléphone de bureau 1. Raccrochez pour déconnecter le portable sans interrompre l’appel. 2. Dans un délai de quatre secondes, appuyez sur la touche Reprise de votre téléphone de bureau et commencez à parler. Gestion de base des appels Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 25 Affichage de plusieurs appels Une meilleure compréhension de l’affichage d’appels multiples sur le téléphone peut vous aider à organiser vos efforts de gestion des appels. En mode d’affichage standard, le téléphone affiche les appels de la façon suivante pour la ligne mise en surbrillance : • Les appels ayant le niveau de priorité le plus élevé et dont la durée est la plus longue figurent en haut de la liste. • Les appels du même type sont regroupés. Par exemple, les appels auxquels vous vous êtes déjà connecté sont regroupés au début de la liste, alors que les appels en attente sont regroupés à la fin. Les méthodes suivantes permettent d’afficher plusieurs appels sur plusieurs lignes : Transfert d’appels Le transfert permet de rediriger un appel connecté. La cible est le numéro vers lequel l’appel doit être transféré. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Afficher les appels d’une autre ligne 1. Appuyez sur . 2. Appuyez immédiatement sur le bouton de ligne . Passer en mode de présentation des appels Appuyez sur correspondant à la ligne mise en surbrillance. Le téléphone bascule sur le mode de présentation des appels et affiche un appel par ligne. L’appel affiché est l’appel actif ou l’appel en attente le plus ancien. Pour revenir au mode d’affichage standard, appuyez sur , puis, immédiatement après, sur le bouton de ligne. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Transférer un appel sans prévenir le destinataire du transfert 1. Au cours de l’ appel, appuyez sur Trnsfer. 2. Saisissez le numéro cible. 3. Appuyez de nouveau sur Trnsfer pour effectuer le transfert ou sur FinApp. pour l’annuler. Remarque Si la fonction de transfert en mode combiné raccroché est activée sur votre téléphone, terminez le transfert en raccrochant.26 OL-15178-01 Conseils • Si la fonction de transfert en mode combiné raccroché est activée sur votre téléphone, terminez l’appel en raccrochant. • Dans le cas contraire, l’appel est mis en attente si vous raccrochez sans avoir appuyé de nouveau sur Trnsfer. • Vous ne pouvez pas utiliser la touche Trnsfer pour rediriger un appel en attente. Appuyez sur Reprend. pour le reprendre avant de le transférer. Informer le destinataire du transfert avant de lui transférer un appel (transfert par consultation) 1. Au cours de l’appel, appuyez sur Trnsfer. 2. Saisissez le numéro cible. 3. Patientez quelques instants pour laisser le temps au destinataire du transfert de répondre. 4. Appuyez de nouveau sur Trnsfer pour effectuer le transfert ou sur FinApp. pour l’annuler. Remarque Si la fonction de transfert en mode combiné raccroché est activée sur votre téléphone, terminez le transfert en raccrochant. Mettre en communication un appelant avec un autre (transfert direct) sans rester en ligne (uniquement sur les téléphones SCCP) 1. Faites défiler les appels en cours sur la ligne et mettez en surbrillance l’appel concerné. 2. Appuyez sur Sélect. 3. Renouvelez cette procédure pour le second appel. 4. Lorsque l’un des appels sélectionnés est mis en surbrillance, appuyez sur TrnsDir (Il se peut que vous deviez au préalable appuyer sur autres). Les deux appels se connectent l’un à l’autre et vous ne participez plus à l’appel. Remarque Pour rester en ligne avec ces appelants, utilisez l’option Joindre. Rediriger un appel vers un système de messagerie vocale Appuyez sur Rvoi Im. Pour plus d’informations, reportez-vous à Transfert d’un appel vers un système de messagerie vocale page 27. Pour... Procédez comme suit :Gestion de base des appels Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 27 Transfert d’un appel vers un système demessagerie vocale La touche Rvoi Im vous permet de transférer un appel actif, en sonnerie ou en attente vers votre système de messagerie vocale. Selon le type d’appel et la configuration de votre téléphone, cette touche permet également de transférer l’appel vers le système de messagerie vocale d’un autre interlocuteur. • Si le téléphone d’une autre personne sonne, Rvoi Im permet de rediriger l’appel soit vers votre propre système de messagerie vocale, soit vers celui du destinataire initial. Votre administrateur système doit au préalable avoir activé cette option pour vous. • Si l’appel vous est directement destiné (sans être transféré ou redirigé vers votre poste) ou si votre téléphone ne prend pas en charge l’option décrite ci-dessus, appuyez sur la touche Rvoi Im pour rediriger l’appel vers votre système de messagerie vocale. Conseil Si le menu disparaît avant que vous ayez pu faire votre choix, appuyez de nouveau sur Rvoi Im pour qu’il se réaffiche. Vous pouvez également demander à votre administrateur système qu’il définisse une valeur de temporisation plus longue. Renvoi des appels vers un autre numéro Les fonctions de renvoi des appels permettent de rediriger tous les appels entrants de votre téléphone vers un autre numéro. Votre administrateur système peut vous autoriser à choisir entre deux types de fonctions de transfert d’appel : • Renvoi d’appels sans condition (Renvoi de tous les appels) : s’applique à tous les appels que vous recevez. • Renvoi d’appel conditionnel (Renvoi si sans réponse, Renvoi si occupé, Pas de couverture) : s’applique à certains appels que vous recevez, sous certaines conditions. Vous pouvez accéder à l’option Renvoi de tous les appels depuis votre téléphone. Les autres fonctions de renvoi ne sont accessibles que depuis vos pages Web Options utilisateur. Votre administrateur système détermine les fonctions de renvoi d’appels auxquelles vous avez accès. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Transférer un appel actif, en sonnerie ou en attente vers un système de messagerie vocale Appuyez sur Rvoi Im. Cela entraîne l’une des actions suivantes : • L’appel est transféré vers votre système de messagerie vocale. • L’écran de votre téléphone affiche un menu vous permettant de choisir entre votre système de messagerie vocale et celui du destinataire initial. Sélectionnez une option pour rediriger l’appel.28 OL-15178-01 Conseils • Saisissez le numéro cible du renvoi d’appel exactement comme si vous le composiez sur le téléphone. Par exemple, saisissez le code d’accès ou l’indicatif régional (le cas échéant). • Vous pouvez renvoyer vos appels vers un téléphone analogique traditionnel ou vers un autre téléphone IP, même si votre administrateur système peut limiter la fonction de renvoi des appels aux numéros utilisés au sein de votre société. • Le renvoi d’appels dépend de la ligne téléphonique. Si un appel arrive sur une ligne dont la fonction de renvoi n’est pas activée, sa sonnerie est normale. • Votre administrateur système peut activer une fonction d’annulation de transfert permettant à la personne qui reçoit vos appels transférés de vous joindre. Lorsque cette fonction est activée, un appel passé depuis le téléphone cible vers votre poste n’est pas transféré et votre poste sonne. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Configurer le renvoi d’appels sur votre ligne principale Appuyez sur RenvTt/Renv. tous les appels, puis saisissez un numéro de téléphone cible. Annuler le renvoi de tous les appels sur votre ligne principale Appuyez sur RenvTt/Renv. tous les appels. Vérifier que le renvoi de tous les appels est activé sur votre ligne principale Recherchez : • L’icône de renvoi d’appel au-dessus du numéro de téléphone principal : . • Le numéro cible de renvoi d’appel dans la ligne d’état. Configurer ou annuler le renvoi d’appels à distance ou dans le cas d’une ligne autre que la ligne principale 1. Connectez-vous à vos pages Web Options utilisateur. (Reportez-vous à Accès à vos pages Web Options utilisateur page 61.) 2. Accédez à vos paramètres de renvoi d’appels. (Reportez-vous à Contrôle des paramètres de ligne sur le Web page 67.) Remarque Si la fonction de renvoi des appels s’applique à toute ligne secondaire, aucune confirmation de votre téléphone n’indique que l’opération est en cours. Au lieu de cela, vous devez confirmer vos paramètres dans les pages Web Options utilisateur. Gestion de base des appels Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 29 Utilisation de la fonction Ne pas déranger La fonction Ne pas déranger (NPD) permet d’empêcher les appels entrants de déclencher la sonnerie de votre téléphone. L’activation de cette fonction requiert l’intervention de votre administrateur système. Lorsque les fonctions NPD et Renvoi des appels sont activées sur votre téléphone, les appels sont renvoyés et l’appelant n’entend pas de tonalité occupé. Vos lignes intercom sonnent même si la fonction NPD est activée. Conseils • Lorsque la fonction NPD est active, le blocage est appliqué à toutes les lignes de votre téléphone. • Lorsque les fonctions NPD et Renvoi de tous les appels sont activées sur votre téléphone, c’est le Renvoi de tous les appels qui a la priorité sur les appels entrants. Cela signifie que les appels sont renvoyés et que l’appelant n’entend pas de tonalité occupé. • Les fonctions d’intercom, de préséance et de préemption à plusieurs niveaux (MLPP), de récupération des appel parqués et de récupération des appels en attente ont toutes précédence sur la fonction NPD. • L’activation de cette dernière requiert l’intervention de votre administrateur système. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Activer NPD Appuyez sur NPD ou Ne pas déranger . « Ne pas déranger » s’affiche sur l’écran du téléphone, le voyant NPD s’allume et la sonnerie est désactivée. Désactiver NPD Appuyez sur NPD ou Ne pas déranger . Personnaliser les paramètres NPD Si votre administrateur système a configuré la fonction NPD de manière à afficher ses paramètres dans la page Options utilisateur, procédez comme suit : 1. Connectez-vous à vos pages Web Options utilisateur. Reportez-vous à Accès à vos pages Web Options utilisateur page 61. 2. Dans le menu déroulant, sélectionnez Options utilisateur > Périphérique. 3. Vous pouvez définir les options suivantes : • Ne pas déranger : active ou désactive la fonction NPD. • Alerte appel entrant avec fonction NPD : permet d’activer uniquement le bip ou le clignotement, ou de désactiver les alertes visuelles et sonores. 30 OL-15178-01 Établissement de conférences téléphoniques Votre téléphone IP Cisco Unified vous permet de parler à plusieurs personnes en même temps dans une conférence téléphonique. Utilisation des fonctions de conférence Vous pouvez créer une conférence de différentes manières, en fonction de vos besoins et des fonctions disponibles sur votre téléphone. • Conférence : permet de créer une conférence standard (ad hoc) en appelant chaque participant. Utilisez la touche dynamique Conf. ou le bouton Conférence. La fonction de conférence est disponible sur la plupart des téléphones. • Joindre : permet de créer une conférence standard (ad hoc) en combinant des appels existants. Utilisez le bouton ou la touche dynamique Joindre. La touche Joindre est disponible uniquement sur les téléphones SCCP. • InsConf : permet de créer une conférence standard (ad hoc) en vous ajoutant à un appel sur une ligne partagée. Appuyez sur un bouton de ligne ou sur la touche dynamique ou le bouton InsConf. La fonction InsConf est disponible uniquement sur les téléphones qui utilisent des lignes partagées. • Mul-conf : permet de créer ou de rejoindre une conférence en appelant un numéro de conférence. Utilisez le bouton ou la touche dynamique MulConf. Utilisation de Conférence Conférence permet d’appeler chaque participant. La fonction de conférence est disponible sur la plupart des téléphones. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Créer une conférence 1. Au cours d’un appel, appuyez sur Conf. ou Conférence. (il se peut que vous deviez au préalable appuyer sur la touche dynamique autres pour accéder à Conf.). 2. Saisissez le numéro de téléphone du participant. 3. Attendez que l’appel soit établi. 4. Appuyez de nouveau sur Conf. ou Conférence pour que le participant se joigne à votre appel. 5. Répétez cette procédure pour ajouter d’autres participants. Ajouter de nouveaux participants à une conférence déjà créée Répétez les étapes ci-dessus. Votre administrateur système détermine si vous pouvez ajouter ou supprimer des participants si vous n’êtes pas l’organisateur de la conférence.Gestion de base des appels Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 31 Utilisation de la fonction Joindre (uniquement sur les téléphones SCCP) La fonction Joindre permet de combiner plusieurs appels existants afin de créer une conférence à laquelle vous participez. Afficher la liste des participants ou supprimer des participants Reportez-vous à Affichage ou suppression de participants à une conférence page 33. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Créer une conférence en joignant des appels existants passés sur une même ligne téléphonique 1. Depuis un appel actif, surlignez un autre appel à inclure dans la conférence, puis appuyez sur Sélect. Les appels sélectionnés affichent l’icône . 2. Répétez cette étape pour chacun des appels à ajouter. 3. Appuyez sur Joindre. (Il se peut que vous deviez au préalable appuyer sur la touche dynamique autres). Créer une conférence en joignant des appels existants passés sur plusieurs lignes téléphoniques 1. Depuis un appel actif, appuyez sur Joindre. (Il se peut que vous deviez au préalable appuyer sur la touche dynamique autres). 2. Appuyez sur le bouton de ligne vert clignotant pour les appels que vous voulez inclure à la conférence. L’un des événements suivants se produit : • Les appels sont joints. • Une fenêtre s’ouvre sur l’écran du téléphone ; celle-ci vous permet de sélectionner les appels à joindre. Mettez les appels en surbrillance. Appuyez ensuite sur Sélectionner, puis sur Joindre pour terminer l’opération. Remarque Si votre téléphone ne prend pas en charge la fonction Joindre dans le cas d’appels sur plusieurs lignes, transférez les appels vers une ligne unique. Vous pourrez alors utiliser la fonction Joindre. Joindre deux conférences existantes Utilisez les touches dynamiques Joindre ou TrnsDir. Vérifiez auprès de votre administrateur système que vous disposez de cette fonction. Afficher la liste des participants ou supprimer des participants Reportez-vous à Affichage ou suppression de participants à une conférence page 33. Pour... Procédez comme suit :32 OL-15178-01 Utilisation de InsConf Vous pouvez créer une conférence à l’aide de InsConf et vous ajouter à un appel sur une ligne partagée. Utilisation de la fonction Mul-conf La conférence téléphonique Mul-conf permet de démarrer une conférence ou de s’y connecter en composant son numéro. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Créer une conférence téléphonique en se connectant par insertion à un appel sur une ligne partagée Appuyez sur le bouton de ligne correspondant à la ligne partagée. Dans certains cas, vous devez mettre l’appel en surbrillance et appuyer sur InsConf pour terminer l’opération. Pour plus d’informations, reportez-vous à Utilisation de l’insertion pour vous ajouter à un appel sur une ligne partagée page 40. Afficher la liste des participants ou supprimer des participants Reportez-vous à Affichage ou suppression de participants à une conférence page 33. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Démarrer une conférence Mul-conf 1. Demandez à votre administrateur système un numéro de téléphone Mul-conf. 2. Communiquez ce numéro à tous les participants. 3. Lorsque vous êtes prêt à lancer la conférence, décrochez pour obtenir une tonalité, puis appuyez sur MulConf. 4. Composez le numéro de la conférence Mul-conf. Les participants peuvent à présent rejoindre la conférence en composant le numéro correspondant. Remarque Les participants entendent une tonalité occupé s’ils composent le numéro de la conférence avant que l’organisateur ne soit lui-même connecté. Dans ce cas, ils doivent rappeler. Rejoindre une conférence Mul-conf Composez le numéro de la conférence Mul-conf (que vous a communiqué l’organisateur de la conférence). Remarque Vous entendez une tonalité occupé si vous composez le numéro de la conférence avant que l’organisateur ne soit connecté. Dans ce cas, rappelez ultérieurement. Mettre fin à une conférence Mul-conf Tous les participants doivent raccrocher. La conférence ne s’arrête pas automatiquement lorsque l’organisateur se déconnecte.Gestion de base des appels Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 33 Conseil Si vous composez le numéro d’une conférence Mul-conf depuis un téléphone non sécurisé, celui-ci affiche Périphérique non autorisé. Pour plus d’informations, reportez-vous à Émission et réception d’appels sécurisés page 43. Affichage ou suppression de participants à une conférence Lors d’une conférence standard (ad hoc), vous pouvez afficher la liste des participants et supprimer des participants. Afficher la liste des participants à une conférence Appuyez sur ListConf ou sur Liste de conférence. Les participants sont affichés dans l’ordre dans lequel ils ont rejoint la conférence, les derniers à la rejoindre apparaissant en tête de liste. Mettre à jour la liste des participants à une conférence Lorsque la liste des participants à la conférence est affichée, appuyez sur MàJ. Savoir qui a organisé la conférence Lorsque la liste des participants à la conférence est affichée, recherchez le participant répertorié au bas de la liste, avec un astérisque (*) en regard de son nom. Exclure un participant de la conférence Lorsque vous affichez la liste, surlignez le nom du participant, puis appuyez sur Suppr. Abandonner le dernier interlocuteur à avoir rejoint la conférence Lorsque la liste des participants à la conférence est affichée, appuyez sur SupDerA ou Supprimer le dernier participant. Vérifier si une conférence téléphonique est sécurisée Recherchez l’icône ou après « Conférence », sur l’écran du téléphone. Vérifier qu’un participant appelle depuis un téléphone sécurisé Recherchez l’icône ou à côté du nom du participant sur l’écran du téléphone. Ajouter d’autres participants Reportez-vous à Utilisation de Conférence page 30.34 OL-15178-01 Passer ou recevoir des appels intercom Vous pouvez passer un appel intercom à destination d’un téléphone qui répond alors automatiquement à l’appel en mode haut-parleur et coupure micro. L’appel intercom unidirectionnel permet d’envoyer un message court au destinataire. S’il utilise le combiné ou le casque, il y entend le message. Si le destinataire a déjà un appel en cours, celui-ci continue simultanément. Le destinataire de l’appel reçoit une tonalité d’alerte intercom et dispose des possibilités suivantes : • Écouter l’appelant, son microphone étant coupé (il peut écouter l’appelant, mais celui-ci ne peut pas l’entendre). • Mettre fin à l’appel intercom en appuyant sur la touche dynamique FinApp. après avoir sélectionné l’appel intercom. Cette option permet de ne pas écouter le message. • Parler à l’appelant à l’aide du bouton intercom actif en mode combiné, via le casque ou le haut-parleur. L’appel intercom devient une connexion bidirectionnelle permettant de communiquer avec l’appelant. Lorsque vous utilisez la fonction intercom, n’oubliez pas les points suivants : • Les lignes intercom ne sont reliées qu’entre elles. • Une seule ligne est utilisable à la fois. • Vous ne pouvez ni recevoir ni émettre d’appel intercom si votre appel actif est surveillé ou enregistré. • Vous ne pouvez pas mettre un appel intercom en attente. Remarque Si vous vous connectez à votre téléphone de bureau tous les jours à l’aide de votre profil de mobilité de poste, vérifiez que votre administrateur système a configuré votre profil de mobilité de poste en y incluant la fonction intercom. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Passer un appel intercom vers une cible intercom préconfigurée Appuyez sur (ligne cible intercom) et commencez à parler lorsque vous entendez la tonalité d’alerte intercom. Passer un appel intercom vers un numéro intercom Appuyez sur (ligne intercom). Entrez le numéro intercom ou appuyez sur le numéro abrégé cible. Lorsque vous entendez la tonalité d’alerte intercom, commencez à parler. Recevoir un appel intercom Lorsque vous entendez la tonalité d’alerte intercom, vous pouvez traiter l’appel de l’une des manières suivantes: • Écouter le message par voie audio unidirectionnelle. • Parler à l’appelant en appuyant sur (ligne intercom active). • Appuyer sur FinApp. après avoir sélectionné l’appel intercom.Gestion avancée des appels Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 35 Gestion avancée des appels Les tâches de gestion avancée des appels comprennent des fonctions spéciales que votre administrateur système peut configurer sur votre téléphone, en fonction de vos besoins en matière de gestion des appels et de votre environnement de travail. Numérotation abrégée La numérotation abrégée permet de saisir un code, d’appuyer sur un bouton ou de sélectionner un élément de l’écran du téléphone pour passer un appel. Selon sa configuration, votre téléphone peut prendre en charge plusieurs fonctions de numérotation abrégée : • Boutons de numérotation abrégée • Composition d’un code • Codes de carnet d’adresses personnel Remarque • Pour configurer des touches de numérotation abrégée et la numérotation abrégée, vous devez accéder aux pages Web Options utilisateur. Reportez-vous à Accès à vos pages Web Options utilisateur page 61. • Pour configurer des numéros abrégés, vous devez accéder à la fonction de répertoire personnel. Reportez-vous à Utilisation du répertoire personnel sur le téléphone page 57. • Votre administrateur système peut également configurer des fonctions de numérotation abrégée à votre attention. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Utiliser des boutons de numérotation abrégée 1. Configurez les touches de numérotation abrégée. Reportez-vous à Configuration de numéros abrégés sur le Web page 64. 2. Pour passer un appel, appuyez sur (bouton de numérotation abrégée). Remarque Si votre téléphone prend en charge la fonction de numérotation abrégée d’affichage de ligne occupée (FLO), vous pouvez savoir si le numéro abrégé est occupé avant de le composer. Reportez-vous à Utilisation de FLO pour déterminer l’état d’une ligne page 43.36 OL-15178-01 Interception d’un appel redirigé sur votre téléphone Grâce à cette fonction, vous pouvez répondre à un appel en sonnerie sur le téléphone d’un collègue en le redirigeant vers votre appareil. Cette fonction peut être utile si vous êtes plusieurs à gérer les appels. Utiliser un code à composer 1. Configurez des codes de numérotation abrégée. Reportez-vous à Configuration de numéros abrégés sur le Web page 64. 2. Pour passer un appel, saisissez le code de numérotation abrégée correspondant, puis appuyez sur NumAbr. Utiliser un code de carnet d’adresses personnel 1. Créez une entrée du carnet d’adresses personnel et affectez-lui un code de numérotation abrégée. Reportez-vous à Utilisation de votre carnet d’adresses personnel sur le Web page 62. 2. Pour passer un appel, accédez au service de numérotation abrégée de votre téléphone. Reportez-vous à Utilisation du répertoire personnel sur le téléphone page 57. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Répondre à un appel qui est en sonnerie sur un autre poste faisant partie de votre groupe de prise d’appel 1. Procédez comme suit : • Si le bouton ou la touche dynamique Intrcpt est disponible, appuyez dessus. • Dans le cas contraire, décrochez le combiné pour afficher Intrcpt, puis appuyez dessus. Si votre téléphone prend en charge l’interception automatique des appels, vous êtes connecté à l’appel. 2. Si le téléphone sonne, appuyez sur Répond. pour vous connecter à l’appel. Pour... Procédez comme suit :Gestion avancée des appels Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 37 Conseils • Selon la configuration du téléphone, vous pouvez recevoir un signal sonore et/ou visuel à propos d’un appel vers votre groupe de prise d’appel. • En appuyant sur Intrcpt/GrpIntr ou Interception d’appels de groupe, vous prenez l’appel en sonnerie le plus long. • En appuyant sur AGrpIntr ou sur Autre groupe de prise d’appel, vous prenez l’appel du groupe de niveau de priorité supérieur. • Si vous avez plusieurs lignes et si vous voulez prendre l’appel sur une ligne secondaire, appuyez sur le bouton de la ligne souhaitée, puis sur une touche dynamique d’interception d’appel. Prendre un appel en sonnerie sur un poste qui ne fait pas partie de votre groupe 1. Procédez comme suit : • Si la touche dynamique GrpIntr ou le bouton Interception d’appels de groupe est disponible, appuyez dessus. • Dans le cas contraire, décrochez le combiné pour afficher GrpIntr, puis appuyez dessus. 2. Saisissez le code du groupe de prise d’appel. Si votre téléphone prend en charge l’interception automatique des appels, vous êtes connecté à l’appel. 3. Si le téléphone sonne, appuyez sur Répond. pour vous connecter à l’appel. Prendre un appel en sonnerie sur un autre poste de votre groupe ou sur celui d’un groupe associé 1. Procédez comme suit : • Si la touche dynamique AGrpIntr ou le bouton Autre groupe de prise d’appel est disponible, appuyez dessus. • Dans le cas contraire, décrochez le combiné pour afficher AGrpIntr, puis appuyez dessus. Si votre téléphone prend en charge l’interception automatique des appels, vous êtes connecté à l’appel. 2. Si le téléphone sonne, appuyez sur Répond. pour vous connecter à l’appel. Pour... Procédez comme suit :38 OL-15178-01 Stockage et récupération d’appels parqués Si vous souhaitez stocker un appel, vous pouvez le parquer pour qu’il soit récupérable (par vous ou par un tiers) sur un autre téléphone du système Cisco Unified Communications Manager (par exemple, le téléphone du bureau d’un collègue ou celui d’une salle de conférence). Vous pouvez parquer un appel en utilisant les méthodes suivantes : • Parcage d’appels : appuyez sur la touche dynamique Parquer pour stocker l’appel. Le téléphone affiche le numéro de parcage où le système a stocké l’appel. Vous devez enregistrer ce numéro et utiliser le même pour récupérer l’appel. • Parcage d’appels dirigés : utilisez la touche dynamique Trnsfer pour diriger l’appel vers un numéro de parcage disponible (abrégé ou non). Pour récupérer ensuite l’appel, composez le préfixe de récupération du parcage, puis le numéro (abrégé ou non). Le bouton de parcage d’appel dirigé permet de composer le numéro abrégé correspondant et d’en déterminer la disponibilité. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Stocker un appel actif à l’aide de la fonction de parcage d’appels 1. Au cours d’un appel, appuyez sur Parquer (Il se peut que vous deviez au préalable appuyer sur la touche dynamique autres pour accéder à Parquer.) 2. Notez le numéro de parcage affiché à l’écran du téléphone. 3. Raccrochez. Récupérer un appel parqué Saisissez le numéro de parcage sur un téléphone IP Cisco Unified du réseau pour vous connecter à l’appel. Diriger et stocker un appel actif vers un numéro de parcage d’appels dirigés 1. Au cours d’un appel, appuyez sur Trnsfer. 2. Pour composer le numéro abrégé, appuyez sur le bouton de parcage d’appel dirigé associé à l’icône de disponibilité . Lorsque le bouton de parcage d’appel dirigé accompagné de l’icône de non-disponibilité clignote, le numéro correspondant n’est pas accessible. 3. Appuyez de nouveau sur Trnsfer pour valider le stockage de l’appel. Récupérer un appel parqué depuis un numéro de parcage d’appels dirigés Depuis un téléphone IP Cisco Unified de votre réseau, entrez le préfixe de récupération et le numéro de parcage d’appel dirigé. Autre possibilité : après avoir entré le préfixe, appuyez sur (voyant clignotant) avec pour prendre l’appel.Gestion avancée des appels Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 39 Conseils • Vous disposez d’un délai limité pour récupérer l’appel parqué avant qu’il ne recommence à sonner sur le poste auquel il était destiné à l’origine. Contactez votre administrateur système pour en savoir plus. • L’administrateur système peut affecter des fonctions de parcage d’appel dirigé aux boutons de ligne disponibles sur le téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G disposant du module d’extension Cisco Unified IP Phone 7914 (le modèle 7942G ne prend pas en charge ce modèle d’extension). • Vous pouvez composer des numéros de parcage d’appel dirigé si vous n’avez pas de boutons correspondants. Toutefois, vous ne pourrez pas afficher l’état du numéro de parcage d’appels dirigé. Déconnexion de groupes de recherche Si votre entreprise reçoit un grand nombre d’appels entrants, vous pouvez être membre d’un groupe de recherche. Un groupe de recherche inclut une série de numéros de répertoire partageant la charge des appels entrants. Lorsque le premier numéro de répertoire du groupe de recherche est occupé, le système recherche le numéro de répertoire suivant disponible dans le groupe et dirige les appels vers ce téléphone. Lorsque vous vous éloignez du téléphone, vous pouvez vous déconnecter des groupes de recherche pour que le téléphone ne sonne pas. Conseil Vous déconnecter des groupes de recherche n’empêche pas les appels d’autres groupes de sonner sur votre téléphone. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Vous déconnecter des groupes de recherche pour bloquer temporairement les appels des groupes de recherche Appuyez sur Groupmt ou sur Groupe de recherche. L’écran du téléphone affiche « Déconnecté du grpe rech ». Vous connecter pour recevoir des appels des groupes de recherche Appuyez sur Groupmt ou sur Groupe de recherche. Lorsque vous êtes connecté, le bouton Groupe de recherche s’allume.40 OL-15178-01 Utilisation d’une ligne partagée Votre administrateur système peut vous demander d’utiliser une ligne partagée si vous : • disposez de plusieurs téléphones et souhaitez avoir le même numéro pour tous ; • partagez des tâches de gestion d’appels avec des collègues ; • gérez des appels pour le compte d’un manager. Présentation des lignes partagées Icône Utilisé à distance L’icône Utilisé à distance apparaît lorsqu’un autre téléphone de votre ligne partagée a un appel connecté. Vous pouvez passer et recevoir des appels normalement sur la ligne partagée, même si l’icône Utilisé à distance s’affiche. Partage des informations relatives aux appels et insertion Les téléphones qui partagent une ligne affichent des informations concernant les appels passés et reçus sur la ligne partagée. Ces informations peuvent inclure l’ID de l’appelant et la durée de l’appel. (pour connaître les cas d’exception, reportez-vous à Confidentialité). Lorsque les informations relatives aux appels sont visibles, vous et les collègues qui partagent la ligne pouvez vous joindre à des appels à l’aide de la fonction Insert ou InsConf. Reportez-vous à Utilisation de l’insertion pour vous ajouter à un appel sur une ligne partagée page 40. Confidentialité Si vous ne souhaitez pas que les collègues qui partagent votre ligne puissent afficher les informations concernant vos appels, activez la fonction de confidentialité. Ainsi, ils ne peuvent pas se connecter à vos appels. Reportez-vous à Procédure permettant d’empêcher d’autres personnes d’afficher un appel sur une ligne partagée ou de s’y joindre page 42. Remarque Le nombre maximum d’appels pris en charge sur une ligne partagée varie selon les téléphones. Utilisation de l’insertion pour vous ajouter à un appel sur une ligne partagée Vous pouvez utiliser les fonctions d’insertion (InsConf ou Inser.) pour vous ajouter à des appels sur votre ligne partagée. (Les appels ne doivent pas être confidentiels. Reportez-vous à Présentation des lignes partagées page 40.)Gestion avancée des appels Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 41 Présentation des fonctions d’insertion InsConf et Inser. Selon la configuration de votre téléphone, vous pouvez vous connecter à un appel sur une ligne partagée à l’aide de la fonction InsConf ou Inser. • InsConf transforme l’appel en conférence téléphonique standard et permet ainsi d’ajouter de nouveaux participants. (Reportez-vous à Établissement de conférences téléphoniques page 30 pour plus d’informations sur les conférences standard.) • Inser. permet de vous ajouter à l’appel mais ne le transforme pas en conférence téléphonique et ne permet pas d’y ajouter de nouveaux participants. Insertion directe ou différée L’administrateur système détermine si la fonction d’insertion de votre téléphone (InsConf ou Inser) doit être directe ou différée. • La fonction d’insertion directe permet de vous ajouter à un appel en appuyant sur un simple bouton de ligne (téléphones SCCP uniquement). • La fonction d’insertion différée permet d’afficher les informations concernant un appel avant de vous y ajouter. Utilisation des fonctions d’insertion Le tableau ci-dessous décrit la façon d’utiliser les fonctions d’insertion (Insert ou InsConf) pour vous ajouter à un appel sur une ligne partagée. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Savoir si la ligne partagée est en cours d’utilisation Recherchez l’icône Utilisé à distance en regard d’un bouton de ligne rouge . Vous ajouter à un appel sur une ligne partagée Appuyez sur le bouton de ligne rouge correspondant à la ligne partagée ( ). Un des événements suivants se produit : • Vous êtes ajouté à l’appel. • Une fenêtre s’ouvre sur l’écran du téléphone, dans laquelle vous pouvez sélectionner l’appel à joindre. Appuyez sur Insert ou InsConf pour faire votre sélection. (Il se peut que vous deviez appuyer sur la touche dynamique Autres pour accéder à l’option Insert ou InsConf). Afficher la liste des participants à la conférence (si vous avez utilisé InsConf) Reportez-vous à Affichage ou suppression de participants à une conférence page 33.42 OL-15178-01 Conseils • Lorsque vous vous insérez à un appel, les autres participants entendent un bip annonçant votre présence. Avec InsConf, les autres participants entendent une courte interruption audio, et l’écran du téléphone change pour afficher les détails de la conférence. • Si la fonction Confidentialité est activée sur un téléphone qui utilise la ligne partagée, les informations concernant l’appel et les touches dynamiques d’insertion n’apparaissent pas sur les autres téléphones qui partagent la ligne. • Lorsque vous vous connectez à un appel à l’aide de la touche Insert, vous en serez déconnecté s’il est mis en attente, transféré ou transformé en conférence téléphonique. Procédure permettant d’empêcher d’autres personnes d’afficher un appel sur une ligne partagée ou de s’y joindre Si vous partagez une ligne téléphonique, vous pouvez utiliser la fonctionnalité de confidentialité pour empêcher les personnes qui partagent votre ligne d’afficher vos appels ou de s’y insérer. Conseils • Si vous partagez la ligne avec un téléphone dont la fonction de confidentialité est activée, vous pouvez passer et recevoir des appels normalement sur la ligne partagée. • La fonction de confidentialité s’applique à toutes les lignes partagées de votre téléphone. Par conséquent, si vous avez plusieurs lignes partagées sur votre téléphone et que la fonction de confidentialité est activée, vos collègues ne pourront pas afficher les appels sur vos lignes partagées, ni s’y connecter. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Empêcher d’autres personnes d’afficher vos appels sur une ligne partagée ou de s’y insérer 1. Appuyez sur Confidentiel . 2. Pour vérifier que la fonction de confidentialité est activée, vérifiez la présence d’une icône de confidentialité activée située en regard d’un bouton de ligne orange . Autoriser les autres personnes à afficher vos appels sur une ligne partagée ou à s’y insérer 1. Appuyez sur Confidentiel . 2. Pour vérifier que la fonction de confidentialité est désactivée, vérifiez l’absence de l’icône correspondante en regard d’un bouton de ligne éteint .Gestion avancée des appels Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 43 Utilisation de FLO pour déterminer l’état d’une ligne Selon la configuration, vous pouvez utiliser FLO pour déterminer l’état d’une autre ligne téléphonique associée à un bouton de numérotation abrégée, un journal d’appels ou une liste de répertoires sur votre téléphone. Vous pouvez passer un appel sur cette ligne, quel que soit l’état de la fonction FLO. Cette fonction n’interdit pas la composition. Émission et réception d’appels sécurisés Selon la configuration choisie par votre administrateur système, votre téléphone peut prendre en charge la fonction d’établissement et de réception d’appels sécurisés. Il peut prendre en charge les types d’appels suivants : • Appel authentifié : l’identité de tous les téléphones participant à l’appel a été vérifiée. • Appel chiffré : le téléphone reçoit et transmet des données audio chiffrées (votre conversation) sur le réseau IP Cisco. Les appels chiffrés sont également authentifiés. • Appel non sécurisé : au moins un des téléphones participant à l’appel ou la connexion ne prend pas en charge ces fonctions de sécurité, ou il n’est pas possible de vérifier l’identité des propriétaires des téléphones. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Afficher l’état d’une ligne de numérotation abrégée Recherchez l’un des indicateurs suivants en regard du numéro de la ligne : + La ligne est en cours d’utilisation. + La ligne est inactive. L’indicateur FLO n’est pas disponible pour cette ligne. + La ligne est en mode Ne pas déranger. Consulter l’état d’une ligne figurant dans un journal d’appels ou un répertoire Recherchez l’un des indicateurs suivants en regard du numéro de la ligne : La ligne est en cours d’utilisation. La ligne est inactive. L’indicateur FLO n’est pas disponible pour cette ligne. La ligne est en mode Ne pas déranger.44 OL-15178-01 Remarque Des interactions, des restrictions et des limites affectent l’exécution des fonctions de sécurité de votre téléphone. Pour en savoir plus, contactez votre administrateur système. Suivi des appels suspects (uniquement sur les téléphones SCCP) Si vous faites l’objet d’appels suspects ou malveillants, votre administrateur système peut ajouter la fonction d’identification des appels malveillants (IDAM) à votre téléphone. Cette fonction permet d’identifier un appel actif comme suspect, ce qui lance une série de messages automatiques de suivi et de notification. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Contrôler le niveau de sécurité d’un appel ou d’une conférence Regardez si l’une des icônes de sécurité suivantes apparaît en haut à droite de la zone d’activité des appels, en regard de l’indicateur de durée d’appel : Appel ou conférence authentifié(e) Appel ou conférence chiffré(e) Appel ou conférence non sécurisé(e) Déterminer s’il est possible de passer des appels sécurisés au sein de votre société Contactez votre administrateur système. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Informer votre administrateur système d’un appel suspect ou malveillant Appuyez sur IDAM ou sur l’option Identification d’appel malveillant. Vous entendez une tonalité et le message « MAL réussie » s’affiche sur votre téléphone.Gestion avancée des appels Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 45 Donner la priorité aux appels critiques (uniquement sur les téléphones SCCP) Dans certains environnements spécialisés, tels que les bureaux de l’Armée ou de l’État, il se peut que vous ayez besoin de passer et de recevoir des appels urgents ou critiques. Si vous avez besoin de ce traitement spécialisé des appels, votre administrateur système peut ajouter une fonction de préséance et préemption à plusieurs niveaux (MLPP) sur votre téléphone. Gardez ces définitions à l’esprit : • La préséance indique la priorité associée à un appel. • La préemption est le processus qui permet de mettre fin à un appel en cours dont la priorité est inférieure et, parallèlement, d’accepter un appel de priorité supérieure qui est envoyé vers votre téléphone. Si vous... Procédez comme suit : Souhaitez pouvoir choisir le niveau de priorité (préséance) d’un appel sortant Contactez votre administrateur système pour obtenir la liste des numéros de préséance correspondant aux appels. Souhaitez passer un appel prioritaire (qui a la préséance) Saisissez le numéro d’accès MLPP (que vous a fourni votre administrateur système), puis le numéro de téléphone. Entendez une sonnerie différente (plus rapide que d’habitude) ou une tonalité d’attente spéciale Vous recevez un appel prioritaire (qui a la préséance). Une icône MLPP s’affiche sur l’écran de votre téléphone pour indiquer le niveau de priorité de l’appel. Souhaitez afficher le niveau de priorité d’un appel Recherchez l’icône MLPP sur l’écran de votre téléphone : Appel prioritaire Appel d’importance moyenne (immédiat) Appel très important (rapide) Appel de la plus haute importance (suppression rapide) ou appel prioritaire Les appels les plus importants s’affichent en haut de la liste des appels. Si aucune icône MLPP n’apparaît, l’appel est un appel normal (routine). Souhaitez accepter un appel plus important Répondez normalement à l’appel. Le cas échéant, mettez d’abord fin à l’appel en cours. Entendez une tonalité continue qui interrompt votre appel Cela signifie que vous ou votre interlocuteur recevez un appel qui est prioritaire sur l’appel en cours. Raccrochez immédiatement pour permettre à l’appel plus important de sonner sur votre téléphone.46 OL-15178-01 Conseils • Lorsque vous passez ou recevez un appel compatible MLPP, vous entendez une sonnerie et une tonalité d’attente spéciales, différentes des sonnerie et tonalité standard. • Si vous saisissez un numéro d’accès MLPP incorrect, un message vocal vous en avertit. • Un appel MLPP reste prioritaire lorsque vous : – le mettez en attente ; – le transférez ; – l’ajoutez à une conférence à trois ; – y répondez par interception. • MLPP est prioritaire sur NPD (Ne pas déranger). Utilisation de la fonction demobilité de poste deCisco La fonction de mobilité de poste de Cisco (EM) permet de configurer temporairement un téléphone IP Cisco Unified comme étant le vôtre. Lorsque vous vous connectez à EM, le téléphone adopte votre profil utilisateur, vos lignes téléphoniques, fonctions, services établis et paramètres Web. Seul l’administrateur système peut configurer la mobilité de poste. Conseils • Vous êtes automatiquement déconnecté de la mobilité de poste au bout d’un certain temps. C’est l’administrateur système qui détermine ce délai. • Les modifications que vous apportez à votre profil de mobilité de poste dans les pages Web Options utilisateur sont prises en compte immédiatement si vous êtes connecté à la fonction de mobilité de poste. Sinon, elles ne seront prises en compte qu’à votre prochaine connexion. • Les modifications que vous apportez à votre téléphone dans les pages Web Options utilisateur sont prises en compte immédiatement si vous vous déconnectez. Sinon, elles ne seront prises en compte qu’à votre prochaine déconnexion. • Les paramètres locaux réglables sur le téléphone ne sont pas enregistrés dans votre profil de mobilité de poste. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Vous connecter au service EM 1. Sélectionnez > Service de mobilité de poste (le nom de la fonction peut varier). 2. Saisissez votre ID utilisateur et votre PIN (fournis par votre administrateur système). 3. Si vous y êtes invité, sélectionnez un profil de périphérique. Vous déconnecter du service EM 1. Sélectionnez > Service de mobilité de poste (le nom de la fonction peut varier). 2. Lorsque vous êtes invité à vous déconnecter, appuyez sur Oui.Gestion avancée des appels Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 47 Gestion des appels professionnels à l’aide d’un seul numéro de téléphone Lorsque les fonctions de connexion et d’accès vocal mobiles sont installées, vous pouvez utiliser votre téléphone portable pour gérer les appels associés au numéro de votre téléphone de bureau. Un téléphone intelligent est un mobile doté des fonctions d’un PC (navigateur Web, e-mail, carnet d’adresses, agenda, etc.). Pour... Procédez comme suit : Configurer la connexion mobile Utilisez les pages Web Options utilisateur pour configurer les destinations distantes et créer des listes d’accès destinées à autoriser ou à bloquer les appels depuis des numéros spécifiques. Reportez-vous à Configuration des téléphones et des listes d’accès pour la connexion mobile page 69. Répondre à un appel sur votre téléphone portable Reportez-vous à Prise d’appel page 20. Faire basculer un appel en cours entre votre téléphone de bureau et un téléphone portable Reportez-vous à Transfert d’un appel en cours vers un autre téléphone page 24. Mettre en attente un appel pris sur un téléphone intelligent 1. Sur le téléphone intelligent, appuyez sur la touche dynamique d’attente d’appel professionnel (le nom de la touche peut varier). Votre interlocuteur est mis en attente. 2. Sur le téléphone intelligent, appuyez sur la touche dynamique Reprise (le nom de la touche peut varier). Reportez-vous à Transfert d’un appel en cours vers un autre téléphone page 24. Transférer vers un autre numéro un appel pris sur un téléphone intelligent 1. Sur le téléphone intelligent, appuyez sur la touche dynamique de transfert d’appel professionnel (le nom de la touche peut varier). 2. Composez le code d’accès de votre entreprise destiné à transférer les appels et ainsi à effectuer un nouvel appel. Votre interlocuteur est mis en attente. 3. Appuyez sur la touche dynamique de transfert d’appel professionnel pour effectuer le transfert. Établir une conférence téléphonique depuis un appel pris sur un téléphone intelligent 1. Sur le téléphone intelligent, appuyez sur la touche dynamique de conférence professionnelle (le nom de la touche peut varier). 2. Composez le code d’accès d’entreprise destiné à établir des conférences et ainsi à effectuer un nouvel appel. Votre interlocuteur est mis en attente. 3. Appuyez sur la touche dynamique de conférence professionnelle pour terminer la configuration et y faire participer les deux appelants.48 OL-15178-01 Conseils • En cas d’accès vocal mobile, vous devez saisir le numéro depuis lequel vous appelez, en plus du PIN, si l’une des conditions suivantes s’applique : – Le numéro depuis lequel vous appelez n’est pas l’une de vos destinations distantes. – Le numéro est bloqué par votre opérateur ou vous (affiché comme étant inconnu). – Le numéro ne se présente pas exactement de la même manière dans la base de données Cisco Unified Communications Manager. Par exemple : votre numéro est le 510-666-9999 (ou 408-999-6666) mais la base de données contient 666-9999 (ou 1-408-999-6666). • Si vous faites une erreur dans la saisie des informations demandées telles que le numéro de téléphone portable ou le PIN trois fois de suite, vous ne disposez plus de la fonction d’accès vocal mobile et vous restez bloqué pendant une certaine durée. Pour toute assistance, contactez votre administrateur système. Obtenir la fonction d’accès vocal mobile 1. Composez le numéro d’accès vocal mobile qui vous a été attribué depuis n’importe quel téléphone. 2. Saisissez le numéro depuis lequel vous appelez, si vous y êtes invité, et votre PIN. Activer la connexion mobile depuis votre téléphone portable 1. Composez le numéro d’accès vocal mobile qui vous a été attribué. 2. Saisissez le numéro de votre téléphone portable, si vous y êtes invité, et votre PIN. 3. Appuyez sur 2 pour activer la connexion mobile. 4. Vous pouvez activer la connexion mobile pour tous les téléphones configurés ou pour un seul. – Tous les téléphones : saisissez 2. – Un seul téléphone : saisissez 1, le numéro de destination distante à ajouter, puis #. Émettre un appel depuis votre téléphone portable Reportez-vous à Établissement d’un appel : options supplémentaires page 18. Désactiver la connexion mobile depuis votre téléphone portable 1. Composez le numéro d’accès vocal mobile qui vous a été attribué. 2. Saisissez le numéro de votre téléphone portable, si vous y êtes invité, et votre PIN. 3. Appuyez sur 3 pour désactiver la connexion mobile. 4. Vous pouvez désactiver la connexion mobile pour tous les téléphones configurés ou pour un seul. – Tous les téléphones : saisissez 2. – Un seul téléphone : saisissez 1, le numéro de destination distante à supprimer, puis #. Pour... Procédez comme suit :Utilisation du combiné, du casque et du haut-parleur Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 49 Utilisation du combiné, du casque et du haut-parleur Vous pouvez utiliser votre téléphone avec un combiné, un casque ou un haut-parleur. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Utiliser le combiné Soulevez-le pour décrocher. Remettez-le en place pour raccrocher. Utiliser un casque Appuyez sur pour activer/désactiver le mode casque. Vous pouvez utiliser un casque avec toutes les commandes de votre téléphone, notamment et . Si vous utilisez le mode réponse automatique, reportez-vous à Utilisation du mode Réponse automatique page 50. Si vous utilisez un casque large bande, vous devriez bénéficier d’une meilleure sensibilité audio en activant le paramètre large bande de votre téléphone (ce paramètre est désactivé par défaut). Pour accéder à ce paramètre, appuyez sur et sélectionnez Préférences utilisateur > Préférences audio > Casque large bande. Si le paramètre Casque large bande apparaît en grisé, vous ne pouvez pas le modifier. Assurez-vous auprès de l’administrateur que votre système téléphonique est bien configuré pour le mode large bande. Si ce n’est pas le cas, vous risquez de ne pas pouvoir détecter de sensibilité audio supplémentaire, même en utilisant un casque large bande. Pour connaître les caractéristiques de votre casque, reportez-vous à la documentation qui l’accompagne ou demandez de l’aide à votre administrateur système. Utiliser le haut-parleur Appuyez sur pour activer ou désactiver le mode haut-parleur. Pour composer un numéro ou prendre un appel, la plupart des actions déclenchent automatiquement le mode haut-parleur, à condition que le combiné soit raccroché et que le bouton soit éteint. Passer en mode casque ou haut-parleur au cours d’un appel (à partir du mode combiné) Appuyez sur ou sur , puis raccrochez le combiné. Passer en mode combiné au cours d’un appel (depuis le mode haut-parleur ou casque) Soulevez le combiné (n’appuyez sur aucun bouton).50 OL-15178-01 Acquisition d’un casque Votre téléphone prend en charge des prises casque à 4 ou 6 fils. Pour plus d’informations sur l’achat d’un casque, reportez-vous à Informations sur le casque page 6. Utilisation dumode Réponse automatique Lorsque la fonction Réponse automatique est activée, votre téléphone répond automatiquement aux appels entrants après quelques sonneries. Votre administrateur système doit configurer la fonction de réponse automatique de sorte qu’elle fonctionne avec votre haut-parleur ou avec votre casque. Utilisez la fonction de réponse automatique si vous recevez un grand nombre d’appels entrants. Conseil En mode NPD, la fonction Réponse automatique est désactivée. Régler le volume d’un appel Appuyez sur au cours de l’appel ou après obtention de la tonalité. Cette opération règle le volume du combiné, du haut-parleur ou du casque, selon le mode utilisé. Appuyez sur Enreg. pour que le volume soit le même lors de vos prochains appels. Si vous... Procédez comme suit : Utilisez la fonction de réponse automatique avec un casque Même si aucun appel n’est en cours, gardez le mode casque activé. En d’autres termes, le bouton doit rester allumé. Pour que le mode casque reste activé, procédez comme suit : • Appuyez sur FinApp. pour raccrocher. • Appuyez sur NvAppel ou sur Compos. pour passer d’autres appels. À condition que votre téléphone soit configuré pour utiliser la fonction Réponse automatique en mode casque, la réponse aux appels est automatique uniquement si le bouton est allumé. Dans le cas contraire, les appels sonnent normalement et vous devez y répondre manuellement. Utilisez la fonction de réponse automatique avec le haut-parleur Laissez le combiné raccroché et gardez le mode casque inactif. En d’autres termes, le bouton reste éteint. Dans le cas contraire, les appels sonnent normalement et vous devez y répondre manuellement. Pour... Procédez comme suit :Modification des paramètres du téléphone Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 51 Modification des paramètres du téléphone Vous pouvez personnaliser votre téléphone IP Cisco Unified en réglant la sonnerie, l’image d’arrière-plan et d’autres paramètres. Personnalisation des sonneries et des indicateurs demessage Vous pouvez personnaliser la manière dont votre téléphone signale les appels entrants et les nouveaux messages vocaux. Vous pouvez également régler le volume de la sonnerie de votre téléphone. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Changer la sonnerie suivant la ligne 1. Sélectionnez > Préférences utilisateur > Sonneries. 2. Choisissez une ligne téléphonique ou la sonnerie par défaut. 3. Sélectionnez une sonnerie pour en entendre un extrait. 4. Appuyez sur Sélect. et sur Enreg. pour utiliser cette sonnerie ou sur Annuler. Modifier la séquence de la sonnerie pour chaque ligne (clignotement seulement, une sonnerie, bip seulement, etc.) 1. Connectez-vous à vos pages Web Options utilisateur. (Reportez-vous à Accès à vos pages Web Options utilisateur page 61.) 2. Accédez à vos paramètres de mode de sonnerie. (Reportez-vous à Contrôle des paramètres de ligne sur le Web page 67.) Remarque Votre administrateur système devra peut-être activer ce paramètre pour que vous puissiez y accéder. Régler le volume de la sonnerie du téléphone Appuyez sur en mode combiné raccroché lorsque les boutons du casque et du haut-parleur sont désactivés. Le nouveau volume de la sonnerie est enregistré automatiquement. Modifier la façon dont le témoin lumineux de votre combiné signale les messages vocaux 1. Connectez-vous à vos pages Web Options utilisateur. (Reportez-vous à Accès à vos pages Web Options utilisateur page 61.) 2. Accédez à vos paramètres d’indicateur de message. (Reportez-vous à Contrôle des paramètres de ligne sur le Web page 67.) Remarque Généralement, la politique par défaut du système est d’indiquer les nouveaux messages vocaux en affichant un témoin fixe sur la bande lumineuse du combiné.52 OL-15178-01 Personnalisation de l’écran du téléphone Vous pouvez régler les caractéristiques de l’écran du téléphone. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Modifier le niveau de contraste de l’écran du téléphone 1. Sélectionnez > Préférences utilisateur > Contraste. 2. Pour procéder aux réglages, appuyez sur Plus, Moins ou . 3. Appuyez sur Enreg. ou sur Annuler. Remarque Si vous enregistrez par erreur un niveau de contraste très faible ou très élevé et que vous ne voyez plus l’affichage de l’écran du téléphone : Appuyez sur , puis sur 1, 4 sur le clavier. Appuyez ensuite sur pour modifier le contraste jusqu’à ce que l’affichage de l’écran du téléphone soit lisible, puis appuyez sur Enreg. Modifier l’image d’arrière-plan 1. Sélectionnez > Préférences utilisateur > Images d’arrière-plan. 2. Faites défiler les images disponibles, puis appuyez sur Sélect. pour en choisir une. 3. Appuyez sur Aperçu pour afficher une vue plus grande de l’image d’arrière-plan. 4. Appuyez sur Quitter pour retourner au menu de sélection. 5. Appuyez sur Enreg. pour accepter l’image ou sur Annuler. Remarque La sélection d’images ne s’affiche pas si cette option n’a pas été activée sur votre système. Modifier la langue de l’écran 1. Connectez-vous à vos pages Web Options utilisateur. (Reportez-vous à Accès à vos pages Web Options utilisateur page 61.) 2. Accédez à vos paramètres utilisateur. (Reportez-vous à Contrôle des paramètres utilisateur sur le Web page 66.) Changer le libellé de ligne 1. Connectez-vous à vos pages Web Options utilisateur. (Reportez-vous à Accès à vos pages Web Options utilisateur page 61.) 2. Accédez à vos paramètres de libellé de ligne. (Reportez-vous à Contrôle des paramètres de ligne sur le Web page 67.) Régler le contraste du module d’extension pour téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7914 (téléphones SCCP avec module d’extension uniquement) 1. Sélectionnez > Préférences utilisateur > Contraste. 2. Pour procéder aux réglages, appuyez sur Haut, Bas ou . 3. Appuyez sur Enreg. ou sur Annuler. Remarque Le téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7942G ne prend pas en charge le module d’extension pour téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7914.Utilisation des journaux d’appels et des répertoires Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 53 Utilisation des journaux d’appels et des répertoires Cette section explique comment utiliser les journaux d’appels et les répertoires. Pour accéder aux deux fonctions, utilisez le bouton Répertoires . Utilisation des journaux d’appels Votre téléphone tient à jour des journaux d’appels en absence, passés et reçus. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Afficher vos journaux d’appels Appuyez sur , puis sélectionnez Appels en absence, Appels composés, ou Appels reçus. Chacun contient jusqu’à 100 enregistrements. Afficher les détails concernant un enregistrement particulier 1. Appuyez sur , puis sélectionnez Appels en absence, Appels composés, ou Appels reçus. 2. Mettez en surbrillance l’enregistrement d’appel. 3. Appuyez sur Détails. Cette opération permet d’afficher des informations, telles que le numéro de l’appelé, le numéro de l’appelant, l’heure du jour et la durée de l’appel (uniquement pour les appels passés et reçus). Effacer l’ensemble des enregistrements d’appels de tous les journaux d’appels Appuyez sur , puis sur Effacer. Effacer tous les enregistrements d’appels d’un journal d’appels en particulier 1. Appuyez sur , puis sélectionnez Appels en absence, Appels composés, ou Appels reçus. 2. Mettez en surbrillance l’enregistrement d’appel. 3. Appuyez sur Effacer. (Il se peut que vous deviez au préalable appuyer sur la touche dynamique autres pour accéder à Effacer.) Effacer un seul enregistrement d’appel 1. Appuyez sur , puis sélectionnez Appels en absence, Appels composés, ou Appels reçus. 2. Mettez en surbrillance l’enregistrement d’appel. 3. Appuyez sur Supprimer. 54 OL-15178-01 Composer un numéro à partir d’un journal d’appels (aucun autre appel n’est en cours) 1. Appuyez sur , puis sélectionnez Appels en absence, Appels composés, ou Appels reçus. 2. Mettez en surbrillance l’enregistrement d’appel. Remarque Si la touche dynamique Détails s’affiche, l’appel représente l’entrée principale d’une communication à plusieurs interlocuteurs. Reportez-vous ci-dessous à Conseil. 3. Si vous devez modifier le numéro affiché, appuyez sur EditNum, puis sur << ou >>. Pour supprimer le numéro, appuyez sur EditNum puis sur Suppr. (Il se peut que vous deviez au préalable appuyer sur la touche dynamique autres pour accéder à Suppr.) 4. Décrochez pour passer l’appel. Composer un numéro à partir d’un journal d’appels (avec un autre appel en cours) 1. Appuyez sur , puis sélectionnez Appels en absence, Appels composés, ou Appels reçus. 2. Mettez en surbrillance l’enregistrement d’appel. Remarque Si la touche dynamique Détails s’affiche, l’appel représente l’entrée principale d’une communication à plusieurs interlocuteurs. Reportez-vous ci-dessous à Conseil. 3. Si vous devez modifier le numéro affiché, appuyez sur EditNum, puis sur << ou >>. Pour supprimer le numéro, appuyez sur EditNum puis sur Suppr. (Il se peut que vous deviez au préalable appuyer sur la touche dynamique autres pour accéder à Suppr.) 4. Appuyez sur Compos. 5. Choisissez une option de menu pour traiter l’appel initial. • Attente : met le premier appel en attente et compose le second. • Trnsfer : transfère le premier interlocuteur vers le second et coupe votre communication. (Appuyez de nouveau sur ce bouton après avoir composé le numéro pour que l’opération soit effectuée.) • Conférence : établit une conférence téléphonique entre tous les interlocuteurs, vous y compris. (Appuyez de nouveau dessus ou sur Conférence après avoir composé le numéro pour que l’opération soit effectuée.) • FinApp. : met fin au premier appel et compose le second. Vérifier si la ligne du journal d’appels est occupée avant de l’appeler Recherchez les indicateurs d’affichage de ligne occupée. Reportez-vous à Utilisation de FLO pour déterminer l’état d’une ligne page 43. Pour... Procédez comme suit :Utilisation des journaux d’appels et des répertoires Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 55 Conseil (uniquement sur les téléphones SCCP) Pour afficher l’enregistrement d’appel complet d’un appel à plusieurs interlocuteurs (par exemple, d’un appel qui a été redirigé ou transféré sur votre poste), mettez en surbrillance l’enregistrement d’appel et appuyez sur Détails. L’enregistrement Détails affiche deux entrées pour chaque appel à plusieurs interlocuteurs en absence ou reçu. Celles-ci apparaissent dans l’ordre chronologique inverse : • La première entrée enregistrée contient le nom ou le numéro du dernier appel à plusieurs interlocuteurs terminé, reçu sur votre téléphone. • La seconde entrée enregistrée contient le nom ou le numéro du premier appel à plusieurs interlocuteurs terminé, reçu sur votre téléphone. Composition depuis le répertoire Selon la configuration de votre téléphone, celui-ci dispose peut-être de fonctions de répertoire d’entreprise et personnel : • Le répertoire d’entreprise contient des contacts professionnels accessibles depuis votre téléphone. Il est configuré et géré par votre administrateur système. • Le répertoire personnel est configurable et accessible depuis votre téléphone et vos pages Web Options utilisateur (le cas échéant). Le répertoire personnel comprend le carnet d’adresses personnel et les numéros abrégés : – Les contacts du carnet d’adresses personnel. – Les numéros abrégés sont des codes affectés aux entrées du carnet d’adresses personnel et permettent de composer les numéros rapidement. Passer un appel à partir d’une entrée d’URL d’un journal d’appels (uniquement sur les téléphones SIP) 1. Appuyez sur , puis sélectionnez Appels en absence, Appels composés, ou Appels reçus. 2. Mettez en surbrillance l’entrée d’URL à composer. 3. Si vous devez modifier l’entrée, appuyez sur EditNum. 4. L’icône apparaît pour indiquer que vous pouvez commencer à modifier les caractères dans l’entrée d’URL. 5. Appuyez sur Compos. Afficher l’historique des appels intercom Sélectionnez > Historique Intercom. L’historique contient le détail des 25 derniers appels intercom. Vous ne pouvez pas composer de numéro intercom depuis cet écran. Pour... Procédez comme suit :56 OL-15178-01 Utilisation du répertoire d’entreprise sur le téléphone Le répertoire d’entreprise vous permet d’appeler vos collègues. Conseil Utilisez le pavé numérique pour saisir des caractères sur l’écran du téléphone. Utilisez le bouton de navigation de votre téléphone pour passer d’un champ de saisie à un autre. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Composer un numéro à partir d’un répertoire d’entreprise (aucun autre appel n’est en cours) 1. Sélectionnez > Répertoire d’entreprise (le nom exact de la fonction peut varier). 2. Saisissez un nom complet ou partiel à l’aide du clavier, puis appuyez sur Recher. 3. Pour composer un numéro, sélectionnez ou recherchez une entrée dans la liste, puis décrochez le combiné. Composer un numéro à partir d’un répertoire d’entreprise (en étant connecté à un autre appel) 1. Sélectionnez > Répertoire d’entreprise (le nom exact de la fonction peut varier). 2. Saisissez un nom complet ou partiel à l’aide du clavier, puis appuyez sur Recher. 3. Faites défiler la liste jusqu’au numéro souhaité, puis appuyez sur Compos. 4. Choisissez une option de menu pour traiter l’appel initial. • Attente : met le premier appel en attente et compose le second. • Trnsfer : transfère le premier interlocuteur vers le second et coupe votre communication. (Appuyez de nouveau sur ce bouton après avoir composé le numéro pour que l’opération soit effectuée.) • Conférence : établit une conférence téléphonique entre tous les interlocuteurs, vous y compris. (Appuyez de nouveau dessus ou sur Conférence après avoir composé le numéro pour que l’opération soit effectuée.) • FinApp. : met fin au premier appel et compose le second. Vérifier si la ligne de téléphone du répertoire est occupée Recherchez les indicateurs d’affichage de ligne occupée (BLF). Reportez-vous à Utilisation de FLO pour déterminer l’état d’une ligne page 43.Utilisation des journaux d’appels et des répertoires Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 57 Utilisation du répertoire personnel surle téléphone Le répertoire personnel contient les contacts du carnet d’adresses personnel et leurs numéros abrégés. Cette section explique comment configurer et utiliser le répertoire personnel sur votre téléphone. Vous pouvez également vous reporter à Utilisation du répertoire personnel sur le Web page 62. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Accéder au répertoire personnel (pour le carnet d’adresses personnel et les codes de numérotation abrégée) 1. Sélectionnez > Répertoire personnel (le nom exact de la fonction peut varier). 2. Saisissez votre ID utilisateur et votre PIN Cisco Unified Communications Manager, puis appuyez sur Soumet. Effectuer une recherche d’entrée dans le carnet d’adresses personnel 1. Accédez au répertoire personnel, puis sélectionnez Carnet d’adresses personnel. 2. Saisissez des critères de recherche, puis appuyez sur Soumet. 3. Préc. et Suivant permettent de passer d’une liste à une autre. 4. Mettez en surbrillance la liste du carnet d’adresses personnel de votre choix, puis appuyez sur Sélect. Composer un numéro à partir d’une entrée du carnet d’adresses personnel 1. Recherchez l’entrée. 2. Mettez l’entrée en surbrillance, puis appuyez sur Sélect. 3. Appuyez sur Compos. (Il se peut que vous deviez au préalable appuyer sur la touche dynamique autres pour accéder à Compos.) 4. Saisissez le numéro de téléphone du participant. 5. Mettez en surbrillance le numéro à composer, puis appuyez sur OK. 6. Appuyez de nouveau sur OK pour composer le numéro. Supprimer une entrée du carnet d’adresses personnel 1. Recherchez l’entrée. 2. Mettez l’entrée en surbrillance, puis appuyez sur Sélect. 3. Appuyez sur Suppr. 4. Appuyez sur OK pour confirmer la suppression. Modifier une entrée du carnet d’adresses personnel 1. Recherchez l’entrée. 2. Mettez en surbrillance l’entrée à modifier, puis appuyez sur Modif. pour modifier un nom ou une adresse e-mail. 3. Si nécessaire, sélectionnez Téléphones pour modifier un numéro de téléphone. 4. Appuyez sur MàJ.58 OL-15178-01 Ajouter une entrée au carnet d’adresses personnel 1. Accédez au répertoire personnel, puis sélectionnez Carnet d’adresses personnel. 2. Accédez à la page de recherche en sélectionnant Soumettre. (Il n’est pas nécessaire de commencer par saisir les informations de recherche.) 3. Appuyez sur Nouveau. 4. Utilisez le clavier de votre téléphone pour saisir un nom et une adresse e-mail. 5. Sélectionnez Téléphones et utilisez le clavier pour saisir des numéros de téléphone. N’oubliez pas d’inclure les codes d’accès nécessaires, tels que le 9 ou le 1. 6. Sélectionnez Soumettre pour ajouter l’entrée à la base de données. Affecter un numéro abrégé à une entrée du carnet d’adresses personnel 1. Recherchez l’entrée dans le carnet d’adresses personnel. 2. Mettez l’entrée en surbrillance, puis appuyez sur Sélect. 3. Appuyez sur Numéro abrégé. 4. Mettez en surbrillance le numéro à composer, puis appuyez sur Sélect. 5. Mettez en surbrillance le code de numérotation abrégée à affecter au numéro, puis appuyez sur Sélect. Ajouter un code de numérotation abrégée (sans utiliser une entrée du carnet d’adresses personnel) 1. Sélectionnez > Répertoire personnel > Numéros abrégés personnels. 2. Appuyez sur Numéro abrégé. 3. Mettez en surbrillance un code de numérotation abrégée qui n’est pas affecté, puis appuyez sur Sélect. 4. Appuyez sur Affecter. 5. Saisissez un numéro de téléphone 6. Appuyez sur MàJ. Rechercher des codes de numérotation abrégée 1. Sélectionnez > Répertoire personnel > Numéros abrégés personnels. 2. Préc. et Suivant permettent de passer d’une liste à une autre. 3. Mettez en surbrillance l’entrée de votre choix, puis appuyez sur Sélect. Passer un appel à l’aide d’un code de numérotation abrégée 1. Recherchez le code de numérotation abrégée. 2. Mettez en surbrillance l’entrée de votre choix, puis appuyez sur Sélect. 3. Appuyez sur Compos. 4. Appuyez sur OK pour terminer l’opération. Pour... Procédez comme suit :Utilisation des journaux d’appels et des répertoires Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 59 Conseils • L’administrateur système peut vous fournir l’ID utilisateur et le code PIN nécessaires pour vous connecter au répertoire personnel. • Le répertoire personnel vous déconnecte automatiquement au bout d’un certain temps. Ce délai peut varier. Pour plus d’informations, contactez votre administrateur système. • Utilisez le pavé numérique pour saisir des caractères sur l’écran du téléphone. Utilisez le bouton de navigation de votre téléphone pour passer d’un champ de saisie à un autre. Supprimer un code de numérotation abrégée 1. Recherchez le code de numérotation abrégée. 2. Mettez en surbrillance l’entrée de votre choix, puis appuyez sur Sélect. 3. Appuyez sur Suppr. Vous déconnecter du répertoire personnel 1. Sélectionnez > Répertoire personnel (le nom exact de la fonction peut varier). 2. Sélectionnez Déconn. Pour... Procédez comme suit :60 OL-15178-01 Accès aux messages vocaux Pour accéder aux messages vocaux, utilisez le bouton . Remarque Votre société détermine le service de messagerie vocale utilisé par votre système téléphonique. Pour obtenir des informations précises et détaillées, reportez-vous à la documentation livrée avec votre système de messagerie vocale. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Configurer et personnaliser votre service de messagerie vocale Appuyez sur et suivez les instructions vocales. Si un menu apparaît à l’écran, sélectionnez l’option appropriée. Savoir si vous avez de nouveaux messages vocaux Vérifiez la présence des élements suivants : • Un témoin lumineux rouge fixe sur votre combiné. (Cet indicateur peut varier. Reportez-vous à Personnalisation des sonneries et des indicateurs de message page 51.) • Une icône de message en attente clignotante et un message affiché sur l’écran du téléphone. Remarque Le témoin lumineux rouge et l’icône de message en attente s’affichent si vous avez un message vocal sur votre ligne principale et non sur d’autres lignes. Vérifiez si : • Une tonalité accélérée se fait entendre dans le combiné, le casque ou le haut-parleur lorsque vous émettez un appel. Remarque La tonalité accélérée est propre à la ligne. Vous ne l’entendez que si vous utilisez la ligne associée au message en attente. Écouter vos messages vocaux ou accéder au menu des messages vocaux Appuyez sur . Selon votre service de messagerie vocale, cette opération permet de composer automatiquement le numéro du service de messagerie ou d’afficher un menu. Transférer un appel vers un système de messagerie vocale Appuyez sur Rvoi Im. Pour plus d’informations, reportez-vous à Transfert d’un appel vers un système de messagerie vocale page 27.Utilisation des pages Web Options utilisateur Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 61 Utilisation des pages Web Options utilisateur Votre téléphone IP Cisco Unified est un périphérique réseau qui peut partager des informations avec les autres périphériques du même type de votre entreprise, notamment votre ordinateur. Vous pouvez utiliser votre ordinateur pour vous connecter à vos pages Web Options utilisateur Cisco Unified CM. Celles-ci permettent de contrôler les fonctions, les paramètres et les services de votre téléphone IP Cisco Unified. Par exemple, vous pouvez configurer des touches de numérotation abrégée depuis les pages Web Options utilisateur. Accès à vos pages Web Options utilisateur Cette section explique comment vous connecter et sélectionner un périphérique de téléphonie. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Vous connecter à vos pages Web Options utilisateur 1. Demandez à votre administrateur système de vous fournir une URL, un ID utilisateur et un mot de passe par défaut pour vos Options utilisateur. 2. Ouvrez un navigateur Web sur votre ordinateur, saisissez l’URL, puis connectez-vous. 3. Si le programme vous invite à accepter les paramètres de sécurité, cliquez sur Oui ou sur Installer le certificat. La page Web Options utilisateur principale de Cisco Unified Communications Manager s’affiche. Dans cette page, sélectionnez Options utilisateur pour accéder aux paramètres utilisateur, aux fonctions de répertoire, à un carnet d’adresses personnel et aux numéros abrégés. Pour accéder aux options spécifiques au téléphone, sélectionnez un appareil (voir ci-dessous). Sélectionner un périphérique après vous être connecté 1. Après vous être connecté aux pages Web Options utilisateur, sélectionnez Options utilisateur > Périphérique. La page Configuration du périphérique s’affiche. 2. Si plusieurs périphériques vous sont affectés, sélectionnez le périphérique approprié (modèle de téléphone, profil de mobilité de poste ou profil de destination distante) dans le menu déroulant Nom. Remarque Les boutons de barre d’outils situés en haut de la page Configuration du périphérique sont propres au type de périphérique sélectionné.62 OL-15178-01 Configuration des fonctions et des services sur le Web Les rubriques de cette section expliquent comment configurer les fonctions et les services de vos pages Web Options utilisateur après vous être connecté. Reportez-vous à Accès à vos pages Web Options utilisateur page 61. Utilisation du répertoire personnel sur le Web L’ensemble des fonctions de répertoire personnel auquel vous avez accès depuis votre ordinateur comprend : • Un carnet d’adresses personnel • Codes de carnet d’adresses personnel • Cisco Unified Communications Manager, outil de synchronisation du carnet d’adresses Remarque Vous pouvez également accéder au carnet d’adresses personnel et aux numéros abrégés depuis votre téléphone. Reportez-vous à Utilisation du répertoire personnel sur le téléphone page 57. Utilisation de votre carnet d’adresses personnel sur le Web Cette section explique comment utiliser le carnet d’adresses personnel depuis les pages Web Options utilisateur. Sélectionner une option de configuration après vous être connecté 1. Après vous être connecté à vos pages Web Options utilisateur, sélectionnez Options utilisateur pour accéder aux paramètres utilisateur, au répertoire, au carnet d’adresses personnel, aux numéros abrégés de contacts personnels et aux paramètres de mobilité. 2. Pour revenir à la page Configuration du périphérique depuis une autre page, sélectionnez Options utilisateur > Périphérique. Pour... Connectez-vous et procédez comme suit : Ajouter une entrée au carnet d’adresses personnel 1. Sélectionnez Options utilisateur > Carnet d’adresses personnel. 2. Cliquez sur Ajouter nouveau. 3. Saisissez les informations correspondant à l’entrée. 4. Cliquez sur Enregistrer. Effectuer une recherche d’entrée dans le carnet d’adresses personnel 1. Sélectionnez Options utilisateur > Carnet d’adresses personnel. 2. Indiquez les informations recherchées et cliquez sur Trouver. Pour... Procédez comme suit :Utilisation des pages Web Options utilisateur Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 63 Configuration de codes de carnet d’adresses personnel surle Web Cette section explique comment affecter des numéros abrégés depuis vos pages Web Options utilisateur. Modifier une entrée du carnet d’adresses personnel 1. Recherchez l’entrée dans le carnet d’adresses personnel. 2. Cliquez sur un nom ou un pseudonyme. 3. Modifiez l’entrée et cliquez sur Enreg. Supprimer une entrée du carnet d’adresses personnel 1. Recherchez l’entrée dans le carnet d’adresses personnel. 2. Sélectionnez une ou plusieurs entrées. 3. Cliquez sur Supprimer la sélection. Pour... Connectez-vous et procédez comme suit : Affecter un numéro abrégé à une entrée du carnet d’adresses personnel 1. Créez une entrée dans le carnet d’adresses personnel. Reportez-vous à Utilisation de votre carnet d’adresses personnel sur le Web page 62. 2. Sélectionnez Options utilisateur > Numéros abrégés. 3. Cliquez sur Ajouter nouveau. 4. Utilisez la zone des options de recherche pour trouver l’entrée souhaitée dans le carnet d’adresses personnel. 5. Cliquez sur un numéro de téléphone dans la zone des résultats de recherche. 6. Modifiez le code de numérotation abrégée si vous le souhaitez. 7. Cliquez sur Enregistrer. Affecter un code de numérotation abrégée à un numéro de téléphone (sans utiliser d’entrée du carnet d’adresses personnel) 1. Sélectionnez Options utilisateur > Numéros abrégés. 2. Cliquez sur Ajouter nouveau. 3. Modifiez le code de numérotation abrégée si vous le souhaitez. 4. Saisissez un numéro de téléphone 5. Cliquez sur Enregistrer. Rechercher une entrée de numérotation abrégée 1. Sélectionnez Options utilisateur > Numéros abrégés. 2. Indiquez les informations recherchées et cliquez sur Trouver. Modifier le numéro de téléphone correspondant à un numéro abrégé 1. Sélectionnez Options utilisateur > Numéros abrégés. 2. Recherchez le numéro abrégé à modifier. 3. Cliquez sur un composant de l’entrée. 4. Modifiez le numéro de téléphone. 1. Cliquez sur Enregistrer. Pour... Connectez-vous et procédez comme suit :64 OL-15178-01 Conseils • Vous pouvez créer jusqu’à 500 entrées de numéros abrégés et de carnet d’adresses personnel. • Vous pouvez créer une nouvelle entrée de numérotation abrégée sans utiliser d’entrée du carnet d’adresses personnel. Ces entrées de numérotation abrégée sont étiquetées brut dans les pages web Options utilisateur et n’affichent pas d’étiquette de texte configurable. Utilisation de l’outil de synchronisation du carnet d’adresses L’outil de synchronisation du carnet d’adresses (TABSynch) permet de synchroniser votre carnet d’adresses Microsoft Windows existant (le cas échéant) avec votre carnet d’adresses personnel. Les entrées de votre carnet d’adresses Microsoft Windows sont ensuite accessibles depuis votre téléphone IP Cisco Unified et vos pages Web Options utilisateur. Votre administrateur système peut vous donner accès à l’outil TABSynch et vous fournir des instructions détaillées. Configuration de numéros abrégés sur le Web Selon sa configuration, votre téléphone peut prendre en charge plusieurs fonctions de numérotation abrégée : • Boutons de numérotation abrégée • Composition d’un code • Codes de carnet d’adresses personnel Remarque Pour obtenir de l’aide sur l’utilisation des fonctions de numérotation abrégée, reportez-vous à Numérotation abrégée page 35. Supprimer une entrée de numérotation abrégée 1. Recherchez le numéro abrégé. 2. Sélectionnez une ou plusieurs entrées. 3. Cliquez sur Supprimer la sélection. Pour... Connectez-vous et procédez comme suit : Configurer les touches de numérotation abrégée 1. Sélectionnez Options utilisateur > Périphérique. 2. Sélectionnez un téléphone dans le menu déroulant Nom. 3. Cliquez sur Numérotations abrégées. 4. Saisissez le numéro et l’intitulé correspondant à une touche de numérotation abrégée (touche programmable) de votre téléphone. 5. Cliquez sur Enregistrer. Remarque Votre téléphone utilise le champ Étiquette ASCII. Pour... Connectez-vous et procédez comme suit :Utilisation des pages Web Options utilisateur Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 65 Configuration de services téléphoniques sur le Web Les services téléphoniques peuvent inclure des fonctions spéciales, des données du réseau et des informations Web (par exemple les cours de la bourse ou les programmes de cinéma). Vous devez d’abord vous abonner à un service téléphonique avant de pouvoir y accéder sur votre téléphone. Configurer des codes à composer 1. Sélectionnez Options utilisateur > Périphérique. 2. Sélectionnez un téléphone dans le menu déroulant Nom. 3. Cliquez sur Numérotations abrégées. 4. Saisissez le numéro et le libellé correspondant à un code de numérotation abrégée. 5. Cliquez sur Enregistrer. Configurer des codes de carnet d’adresses personnel Reportez-vous à Configuration de codes de carnet d’adresses personnel sur le Web page 63. Vous pouvez également configurer ce type de code sur votre téléphone. Reportez-vous à Utilisation du répertoire personnel sur le téléphone page 57. Pour... Connectez-vous et procédez comme suit : Vous abonner à un service 1. Sélectionnez Options utilisateur > Périphérique. 2. Sélectionnez un téléphone dans le menu déroulant Nom. 3. Cliquez sur Services téléphoniques. 4. Cliquez sur Ajouter nouveau. 5. Choisissez un service dans la liste déroulante et cliquez sur Suivant. 6. Changez l’intitulé du service et/ou saisissez des informations supplémentaires sur le service, le cas échéant (facultatif). 7. Cliquez sur Enregistrer. Rechercher des services 1. Sélectionnez un périphérique. 2. Cliquez sur Services téléphoniques. 3. Cliquez sur Trouver. Modifier un service ou y mettre fin 1. Recherchez les services. 2. Sélectionnez une ou plusieurs entrées. 3. Cliquez sur Supprimer la sélection. Modifier le nom d’un service 1. Recherchez les services. 2. Cliquez sur le nom du service. 3. Modifiez les informations et cliquez sur Enreg. Pour... Connectez-vous et procédez comme suit :66 OL-15178-01 Contrôle des paramètres utilisateur sur le Web Les paramètres utilisateur incluent votre mot de passe, votre PIN et votre langue (paramètres régionaux). Associer un service à une touche programmable disponible 1. Sélectionnez Options utilisateur > Périphérique. 2. Sélectionnez un téléphone dans le menu déroulant Nom. 3. Cliquez sur URL de service. Remarque Si cette option n’apparaît pas, demandez à votre administrateur système de configurer une touche d’URL de service pour votre téléphone. 4. Sélectionnez un service dans la liste déroulante Touche de service. 5. Si vous souhaitez renommer le service, modifiez les champs d’étiquettes. Remarque Votre téléphone utilise le champ Étiquette ASCII s’il ne prend pas en charge les jeux de caractères à deux octets. 6. Cliquez sur Enregistrer. 7. Cliquez sur Réinitialiser pour réinitialiser votre téléphone (nécessaire pour afficher le nouveau libellé de la touche sur votre téléphone). Accéder à un service depuis le téléphone Sélectionnez ( ) > Services. Pour... Connectez-vous et procédez comme suit : Modifier votre mot de passe 1. Sélectionnez Options utilisateur > Paramètres utilisateur. 2. Dans la zone Mot de passe du navigateur, saisissez les informations. 3. Cliquez sur Enregistrer. Modifier votre PIN 1. Sélectionnez Options utilisateur > Paramètres utilisateur. 2. Dans la zone PIN du téléphone, saisissez les informations. 3. Cliquez sur Enregistrer. Modifier la langue (paramètres régionaux) des pages Web Options utilisateur 1. Sélectionnez Options utilisateur > Paramètres utilisateur. 2. Dans la zone Langue utilisateur, choisissez une option dans la liste déroulante Langue. 3. Cliquez sur Enregistrer. Pour... Connectez-vous et procédez comme suit :Utilisation des pages Web Options utilisateur Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 67 Conseil Votre code PIN et votre mot de passe permettent d’accéder à plusieurs fonctions et services. Par exemple, utilisez votre code PIN pour vous connecter au service de mobilité de poste de Cisco ou au répertoire personnel de votre téléphone. Utilisez votre mot de passe pour vous connecter à vos pages Web Options utilisateur et à Cisco WebDialer sur votre ordinateur. Pour en savoir plus, contactez votre administrateur système. Contrôle des paramètres de ligne sur le Web Les paramètres de ligne ont une incidence sur une ligne donnée (numéro d’annuaire) de votre téléphone. Les paramètres de ligne peuvent inclure le renvoi d’appels, les indicateurs de message vocal, le modèle de sonneries et les libellés de ligne. Vous pouvez configurer d’autres paramètres de ligne directement sur votre téléphone : • Configuration du renvoi d’appels sur votre ligne téléphonique principale (reportez-vous à Renvoi des appels vers un autre numéro page 27). • Modification des sonneries, de l’affichage et d’autres paramètres propres au modèle de téléphone (reportez-vous à Modification des paramètres du téléphone page 51). Modifier la langue (paramètres régionaux) de l’écran de votre téléphone 1. Sélectionnez Options utilisateur > Paramètres utilisateur. 2. Sélectionnez une option dans la liste déroulante Langue utilisateur. 3. Cliquez sur Enregistrer. Pour... Connectez-vous et procédez comme suit : Configurer le transfert d’appel par ligne 1. Sélectionnez Options utilisateur > Périphérique. 2. Sélectionnez un téléphone dans le menu déroulant Nom. 3. Cliquez sur Paramètres de ligne. 4. Si plusieurs numéros de répertoire (lignes) sont affectés à votre téléphone, sélectionnez une ligne dans le menu déroulant Ligne. 5. Dans la zone Renvoi des appels entrants, choisissez les paramètres de renvoi d’appels correspondant aux différentes situations. 6. Cliquez sur Enregistrer. Pour... Connectez-vous et procédez comme suit :68 OL-15178-01 Modifier le paramètre d’indicateur de message vocal selon la ligne (signal visuel) 1. Sélectionnez Options utilisateur > Périphérique. 2. Sélectionnez un téléphone dans le menu déroulant Nom. 3. Cliquez sur Paramètres de ligne. 4. Si plusieurs numéros de répertoire (lignes) sont affectés à votre téléphone, sélectionnez une ligne dans le menu déroulant Ligne. 5. Dans la zone Indicateur de messages en attente, choisissez un ou plusieurs paramètres. Remarque Généralement, le paramètre par défaut de messages en attente demande à votre téléphone d’afficher un témoin lumineux rouge fixe sur la bande lumineuse du combiné pour indiquer la présence d’un nouveau message vocal. 6. Cliquez sur Enregistrer. Modifier le paramètre d’indicateur de message vocal selon la ligne (signal sonore) 1. Sélectionnez Options utilisateur > Périphérique. 2. Sélectionnez un téléphone dans le menu déroulant Nom. 3. Cliquez sur Paramètres de ligne. 4. Si plusieurs numéros de répertoire (lignes) sont affectés à votre téléphone, sélectionnez une ligne dans le menu déroulant Ligne. 5. Dans la zone Indicateur de messages vocaux en attente, choisissez un ou plusieurs paramètres. Remarque Généralement, le paramètre par défaut de messages en attente demande à votre téléphone d’afficher un témoin lumineux rouge fixe sur la bande lumineuse du combiné pour indiquer la présence d’un nouveau message vocal. 6. Cliquez sur Enregistrer. Modifier ou créer le libellé de ligne devant apparaître à l’écran de votre téléphone 1. Sélectionnez Options utilisateur > Périphérique. 2. Sélectionnez un téléphone dans le menu déroulant Nom. 3. Cliquez sur Paramètres de ligne. 4. Si plusieurs numéros de répertoire (lignes) sont affectés à votre téléphone, sélectionnez une ligne dans le menu déroulant Ligne. 5. Dans la zone Libellé de ligne, saisissez un libellé. 6. Cliquez sur Enregistrer. Remarque Votre téléphone utilise le champ Étiquette ASCII s’il ne prend pas en charge les jeux de caractères à deux octets. Pour... Connectez-vous et procédez comme suit :Utilisation des pages Web Options utilisateur Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 69 Configuration des téléphones et des listes d’accès pour la connexion mobile Lorsque vous utilisez la fonction de connexion mobile de Cisco, vous devez indiquer les téléphones (portables et autres) à utiliser pour émettre et recevoir des appels en utilisant les mêmes numéros de répertoire que ceux de votre téléphone de bureau. Ces téléphones sont appelés destinations distantes. Vous pouvez également définir des listes d’accès pour interdire ou autoriser l’envoi des appels en provenance de certains numéros et à destination de votre téléphone portable. Pour... Connectez-vous et procédez comme suit : Créer une liste d’accès 1. Sélectionnez le paramètre de mobilité Listes d’accès dans les options utilisateur. 2. Cliquez sur Ajouter nouveau. 3. Saisissez les informations suivantes : – Nom : identifie la liste d’accès. – Description : décrit la liste d’accès. 4. Choisissez l’une des options suivantes : – Liste d’accès bloqué : crée une liste de numéros à bloquer. – Liste d’accès autorisé : crée une liste de numéros à autoriser. 5. Cliquez sur Enregistrer. Ajouter des membres à une liste d’accès 1. Créez une liste d’accès. 2. Cliquez sur Ajouter un membre pour ajouter des membres ou des filtres à la liste. 3. Sélectionnez une option dans la liste déroulante Masque de filtre. Vous pouvez filtrer soit un numéro de répertoire, soit les appels dont l’ID de l’appelant est restreint (Non disponible) ou anonyme (Confidentiel). 4. Si vous sélectionnez un numéro de répertoire dans la liste déroulante Masque de filtre, saisissez un numéro de téléphone ou un filtre dans le champ Masque NR. Vous pouvez utiliser les caractères génériques suivants pour définir un filtre : – X (majuscule ou minuscule) : correspond à un chiffre. Par exemple, 408555123X correspond aux numéros 4085551230, 4085551231, 4085551232, 4085551233, 4085551234, 4085551235, 4085551236, 4085551237, 4085551238 ou 4085551239. – ! : correspond à un nombre indéfini de chiffres. Par exemple, 408! correspond à tout numéro commençant par 408. – # : remplace un chiffre pour créer une correspondance exacte. 5. Pour ajouter ce membre à la liste d’accès, cliquez sur Enreg. 6. Pour enregistrer la liste d’accès, cliquez sur Enreg.70 OL-15178-01 Ajouter une nouvelle destination distante 1. Sélectionnez le paramètre de mobilité Destinations distantes dans les options utilisateur. 2. Sélectionnez le périphérique dans la liste déroulante Nom. 3. Cliquez sur Destinations distantes. 4. Cliquez sur Ajouter nouveau. 5. Saisissez les informations suivantes : – Nom : donnez un nom au téléphone portable (ou autre). – Numéro de destination : saisissez le numéro de votre téléphone portable. – Minuteur de réponse précoce : saisissez le délai d’attente avant interception d’un appel sur la destination distante (en millisecondes). – Minuteur de réponse tardive : saisissez le délai maximal de l’interception d’un appel sur la destination distante (en millisecondes). – Indicateur de délai avant sonnerie : saisissez le délai d’attente avant déclenchement d’une sonnerie d’appel sur la destination distante (en millisecondes). – Profil de destination distante : sélectionnez un profil de destination distante contenant les paramètres applicables à toutes vos destinations distantes. – Liste d’accès autorisé : sélectionnez un numéro de téléphone ou une règle d’inclusion pour lesquels votre téléphone portable peut sonner lorsqu’un appel parvient à votre téléphone de bureau. Vous pouvez sélectionner une liste d’accès autorisé ou bloqué (sans choisir les deux). – Liste d’accès bloqué : sélectionnez un numéro de téléphone ou une règle d’exclusion pour lesquels votre téléphone portable ne sonne pas lorsqu’un appel parvient à votre téléphone de bureau. Vous pouvez sélectionner une liste d’accès autorisé ou bloqué (sans choisir les deux). – Téléphone portable : sélectionnez cette option pour autoriser votre téléphone portable à accepter un appel passé depuis votre téléphone de bureau. – Activer la connexion mobile : sélectionnez cette option pour autoriser votre téléphone portable à sonner en même temps que votre téléphone de bureau. – Smart Client installé : sélectionnez cette option pour indiquer que la destination distante en cours de configuration est un téléphone intelligent. 6. Cliquez sur Enregistrer. Pour... Connectez-vous et procédez comme suit :Utilisation des pages Web Options utilisateur Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 71 Utilisation de CiscoWebDialer Cisco WebDialer permet de passer des appels sur votre téléphone IP Cisco Unified à des contacts du répertoire en cliquant sur les éléments d’un navigateur Web. L’administrateur système doit vous configurer cette fonction. Pour... Procédez comme suit : Utiliser WebDialer avec votre répertoire Options utilisateur 1. Connectez-vous à vos pages Web Options utilisateur. Reportez-vous à Accès à vos pages Web Options utilisateur page 61. 2. Sélectionnez Options utilisateur > Répertoire et recherchez un collègue. 3. Cliquez sur le numéro à composer. 4. Si vous utilisez WebDialer pour la première fois, configurez vos préférences et cliquez sur Soumet. (Reportez-vous à la dernière ligne de ce tableau pour plus de détails). 5. Si la page Passer un appel s’affiche, cliquez sur Compos. (Reportez-vous à la dernière ligne de ce tableau si vous souhaitez que cette page ne s’affiche plus à l’avenir.) L’appel est maintenant passé sur votre téléphone. 6. Pour mettre fin à un appel, cliquez sur Raccrocher ou raccrochez le combiné de votre téléphone. Utiliser WebDialer avec un autre répertoire d’entreprise en ligne (au lieu de votre répertoire Options utilisateur) 1. Connectez-vous à un répertoire d’entreprise compatible WebDialer et recherchez des collègues. 2. Cliquez sur le numéro à composer. 3. Lorsque vous y êtes invité, saisissez votre ID utilisateur et votre mot de passe. 4. Si vous utilisez WebDialer pour la première fois, configurez vos préférences et cliquez sur Soumet. (Reportez-vous à la dernière ligne de ce tableau pour plus de détails). 5. Si la page Passer un appel s’affiche, cliquez sur Compos. (Reportez-vous à la dernière ligne de ce tableau si vous souhaitez que cette page ne s’affiche plus à l’avenir.) L’appel est maintenant passé sur votre téléphone. 6. Pour mettre fin à un appel, cliquez sur Raccrocher ou raccrochez le combiné de votre téléphone.72 OL-15178-01 Vous déconnecter de WebDialer Cliquez sur l’icône de déconnexion dans la page Passer un appel ou Raccrocher. Configurer, afficher ou modifier des préférences de WebDialer Accédez à la page Préférences. La page Préférences s’affiche la première fois que vous utilisez WebDialer (après avoir cliqué sur le numéro que vous voulez composer). Pour revenir aux préférences ultérieurement, cliquez sur l’icône Préférences des pages Passer un appel ou Raccrocher. La page Préférences contient les options suivantes : • Langue souhaitée : détermine la langue utilisée pour les paramètres et les invites de WebDialer. • Utiliser un périphérique permanent : identifie le téléphone IP Cisco Unified et le numéro d’annuaire (ligne) que vous utiliserez pour passer des appels WebDialer. Si votre téléphone dispose d’une seule ligne, ce téléphone et cette ligne sont sélectionnés automatiquement. Sinon, choisissez un téléphone et/ou une ligne. Les téléphones sont indiqués par leur nom système. (Pour afficher le nom système de votre téléphone, sélectionnez > Config. réseau > Nom système.) • Utiliser la mobilité de poste : si cette option est sélectionnée, elle invite WebDialer à utiliser le téléphone IP Cisco Unified associé à votre profil de mobilité de poste (s’il existe). • Ne pas afficher la boîte de dialogue de confirmation d’appel : si cette option est sélectionnée, elle invite WebDialer à supprimer la page Passer un appel. Cette page s’affiche par défaut lorsque vous cliquez sur un numéro de téléphone dans un répertoire en ligne compatible WebDialer. Pour... Procédez comme suit :Présentation des options de configuration supplémentaires Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 73 Présentation des options de configuration supplémentaires Votre administrateur système peut configurer votre téléphone de manière à ce que vous puissiez utiliser, le cas échéant, des modèles spécifiques de boutons et de touches dynamiques, associés à des fonctions et à des services particuliers. Le tableau ci-après présente certaines options de configuration que vous pouvez demander à l’administrateur de votre système téléphonique en fonction de vos besoins en appels ou de votre environnement de travail. Remarque Les guides des téléphones et autres documents auxquels il est fait référence dans ce tableau sont disponibles à l’adresse suivante : http://www.cisco.com/en/US/products/hw/phones/ps379/tsd_products_support_series_h ome.html Si vous... Procédez comme suit : Pour plus d’informations... Devez gérer davantage d’appels sur votre ligne téléphonique Demandez à votre administrateur système de configurer votre ligne de manière à ce qu’elle prenne en charge un plus grand nombre d’appels. Contactez votre administrateur système ou l’équipe d’assistance téléphonique. Avez besoin de plusieurs lignes téléphoniques Demandez à votre administrateur système de vous configurer un ou plusieurs numéros de répertoire supplémentaires. Contactez votre administrateur système ou l’équipe d’assistance téléphonique. Avez besoin de plus de boutons de numérotation abrégée Vérifiez d’abord que vous utilisez déjà la totalité des boutons de numérotation abrégée disponibles. Si vous avez besoin de touches de numérotation abrégée supplémentaires, utilisez la fonction de numérotation abrégée ou abonnez-vous au service de numérotation abrégée. Vous pouvez également ajouter un module d’extension 7914 à votre téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G. Reportez-vous aux références suivantes : • Numérotation abrégée page 35 • Cisco Unified IP Phone Expansion Module 7914 Phone Guide (uniquement sur les téléphones SCCP 7962G) Le téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7942G ne prend pas en charge le module d’extension pour téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7914.74 OL-15178-01 Travaillez en collaboration avec un assistant administratif (ou en tant qu’assistant administratif) Pensez à utiliser : • Cisco Unified Communications Manager Assistant • Une ligne partagée. Reportez-vous aux références suivantes : • Utilisation d’une ligne partagée page 40 • Guide de l’utilisateur de Cisco Unified Communications Manager Assistant Souhaitez utiliser un même numéro de poste pour plusieurs téléphones Demandez une ligne partagée. Cela permet d’utiliser un numéro de poste unique pour les téléphones de votre bureau et de votre laboratoire, par exemple. Reportez-vous à Utilisation d’une ligne partagée page 40. Partagez vos téléphones ou votre bureau avec des collègues Pensez à utiliser : • La fonction de parcage d’appels pour enregistrer et récupérer des appels sans utiliser la fonction de transfert. • La fonction d’interception d’appels pour répondre à des appels en sonnerie sur un autre téléphone. • Une ligne partagée pour afficher les appels de vos collègues ou vous y connecter • La fonction de mobilité de poste de Cisco pour affecter vos numéro de téléphone et profil utilisateur à un téléphone IP Cisco Unified partagé. Demandez des informations sur ces fonctions à votre administrateur système et reportez-vous aux sections suivantes : • Gestion avancée des appels page 35 • Utilisation d’une ligne partagée page 40 • Utilisation de la fonction de mobilité de poste de Cisco page 46 Répondez à de nombreux appels ou traitez des appels pour une autre personne Demandez à votre administrateur système de configurer la fonction de réponse automatique sur le téléphone. Reportez-vous à Utilisation du mode Réponse automatique page 50. Si vous... Procédez comme suit : Pour plus d’informations...Présentation des options de configuration supplémentaires Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 75 Devez passer des appels vidéo (sur les téléphones SCCP uniquement) Pensez à utiliser Cisco Unified Video Advantage pour passer des appels vidéo en utilisant votre téléphone IP Cisco Unified, votre PC et une caméra vidéo externe. Si vous avez besoin d’aide, contactez votre administrateur système et reportez-vous aux documents Cisco Unified Video Advantage Quick Start Guide et Cisco Unified Video Advantage User Guide. Devez déterminer l’état d’une ligne téléphonique associée à une touche de numérotation abrégée, un journal d’appels ou une entrée de répertoire sur votre téléphone Demandez à votre administrateur de configurer la fonction de ligne occupée (FLO) sur votre téléphone. Reportez-vous à Utilisation de FLO pour déterminer l’état d’une ligne page 43. Souhaitez affecter temporairement vos numéro de téléphone et paramètres à un téléphone IP Cisco Unified partagé Demandez des détails sur le service de mobilité de poste de Cisco à votre administrateur système. Reportez-vous à Utilisation de la fonction de mobilité de poste de Cisco page 46. Si vous... Procédez comme suit : Pour plus d’informations...76 OL-15178-01 Dépannage du téléphone Cette section fournit des informations de dépannage sur le téléphone IP Cisco Unified. Informations générales de dépannage La présente section vous donne des indications destinées à vous aider à résoudre les problèmes majeurs de votre téléphone. Pour en savoir plus, contactez votre administrateur système. Signe Explication Vous n’entendez pas de tonalité ou vous n’arrivez pas à passer d’appel Cela est peut-être dû à l’une (ou plusieurs) des raisons suivantes : • Vous devez vous connecter au service de mobilité de poste. • Vous devez entrer un code d’affaire client (CMC) ou un code d’autorisation forcée (FAC) après avoir composé un numéro (uniquement sur les téléphones SCCP) • Votre téléphone est soumis à des restrictions horaires qui vous empêchent d’utiliser certaines fonctions à certaines heures de la journée. Le bouton de paramètres ne répond pas Votre administrateur système peut avoir désactivé sur votre téléphone. La touche dynamique que vous souhaitez utiliser ne s’affiche pas Cela est peut-être dû à l’une (ou plusieurs) des raisons suivantes : • Vous devez appuyer sur autres pour afficher des touches dynamiques supplémentaires. • Vous devez changer l’état de la ligne (par exemple en décrochant ou passant un appel). • Votre téléphone n’est pas configuré pour prendre en charge la fonction associée à cette touche dynamique. L’option Insert ne fonctionne pas et le téléphone émet une tonalité occupé rapide Vous ne pouvez pas vous connecter à un appel chiffré si le téléphone que vous utilisez n’est pas configuré pour le chiffrement. Si votre tentative de connexion échoue pour cette raison, le téléphone émet une tonalité occupé rapide. Vous êtes déconnecté d’un appel que vous avez rejoint par insertion Lorsque vous vous connectez à un appel à l’aide de la touche Insert, vous pouvez en être déconnecté s’il est mis en attente, transféré ou transformé en conférence téléphonique. Le rappel Cisco échoue Votre interlocuteur a peut-être activé la fonction de renvoi d’appels.Dépannage du téléphone Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 77 Affichage des données d’administration de votre téléphone Votre administrateur système peut vous demander d’accéder à des données d’administration sur votre téléphone en vue du dépannage. Utilisation de l’outil de génération de rapports qualité L’administrateur système peut configurer temporairement le téléphone avec l’outil de génération de rapports qualité (QRT) pour résoudre les problèmes de performances. Appuyez sur QRT ou Outil de génération de rapports qualité pour lui soumettre des informations. Selon la configuration de votre téléphone, l’outil QRT permet de : • Signaler immédiatement un problème audio sur un appel en cours. • Sélectionner un problème général dans une liste et choisir des codes motifs. Si vous devez... Procédez comme suit : Accéder aux données de configuration du réseau Sélectionnez > Configuration réseau, puis l’élément de configuration réseau que vous souhaitez afficher. Accéder aux données d’état Sélectionnez > État, puis l’élément d’état que vous souhaitez afficher. Accéder aux caractéristiques du téléphone Sélectionnez > Caractéristiques. Accéder aux informations relatives aux appels et à la qualité vocale du téléphone Sélectionnez > État > Statistiques d’appel.78 OL-15178-01Conditions générales de la garantie matérielle limitée à un an de Cisco Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 79 Conditions générales de la garantie matérielle limitée à un an de Cisco Des conditions spéciales s’appliquent à votre garantie matérielle et plusieurs services sont à votre disposition au cours de la période couverte par cette garantie. Vous trouverez votre déclaration de garantie formelle, avec les garanties et les accords de licence qui s’appliquent aux logiciels Cisco, sur Cisco.com. Procédez comme suit pour accéder au pack d’informations Cisco, à la garantie et aux accords de licence, et les télécharger sur Cisco.com : 1. Lancez votre navigateur, puis saisissez l’URL suivante : http://www.cisco.com/univercd/cc/td/doc/es_inpck/cetrans.htm La page des garanties et des accords de licence s’affiche. 2. Pour lire le pack d’informations Cisco, procédez comme suit : a. Cliquez sur la liste déroulante du champ Information Packet Number et vérifiez que la référence 78-5235-03A0 est mise en surbrillance. b. Sélectionnez la langue souhaitée pour la lecture du document. c. Cliquez sur Go. La page de garantie limitée et de licence pour les logiciels Cisco inclus dans le pack d’informations s’affiche. d. Lisez ce document en ligne ou cliquez sur l’icône PDF pour le télécharger et l’imprimer au format PDF (Portable Document Format) d’Adobe. Remarque Vous devez avoir installé Adobe Acrobat Reader pour afficher et imprimer les fichiers PDF. Vous pouvez télécharger le logiciel Reader sur le site Web d’Adobe : http://www.adobe.com. 3. Pour lire la version traduite et localisée des informations de garantie relatives à votre produit, procédez comme suit : a. Saisissez la référence suivante dans le champ Warranty Document Number : 78-10747-01C0 b. Sélectionnez la langue souhaitée pour l’affichage du document. c. Cliquez sur Go. La page de garantie de Cisco s’affiche. d. Lisez ce document en ligne ou cliquez sur l’icône PDF pour le télécharger et l’imprimer au format PDF (Portable Document Format) d’Adobe. Vous pouvez également contacter le site Web de service et d’assistance de Cisco pour obtenir de l’aide : http://www.cisco.com/public/Support_root.shtml80 OL-15178-01 Durée de la garantie matérielle Un (1) an Politique de remplacement, de réparation ou de remboursement du matériel Cisco ou son centre de réparation feront leur possible (dans des limites commerciales raisonnables) pour expédier une pièce de rechange sous dix (10) jours ouvrables après réception de la demande d’autorisation de renvoi de matériel. Les délais de livraison réels peuvent varier selon la situation géographique du client. Cisco se réserve le droit de rembourser au prix d’achat comme recours exclusif sous garantie. Obtention d’un numéro d’autorisation de renvoi de matériel Contactez l’entreprise auprès de laquelle vous avez acheté le produit. Si vous avez acheté le produit directement auprès de Cisco, contactez votre représentant commercial et de service après-vente Cisco. Fournissez les renseignements ci-dessous et conservez-les pour référence : Produit acheté auprès de Numéro de téléphone de l’entreprise Référence du produit Numéro de série du produit Numéro du contrat de maintenanceManuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 81 Index A Abonnement à des services téléphoniques 65 AGrpIntr 37 Aide en ligne, utilisation 14 Aide, utilisation 14 Appel en attente 21 Appels affichage 12, 24 attente et reprise 22 attribution de priorités 45 avec plusieurs interlocuteurs 30 blocage 29 coupure micro 23 différences avec une ligne 11 émission 17 fin 22 fonctions de conférence 30 gestion de plusieurs 24 icônes 11 insertion 40 nombre maximal par ligne 11 parcage 38 plusieurs appels, affichage 25 plusieurs appels, passage de l’un à l’autre 24 prendre 20 rapports sur les problèmes de 77 redirection d’appels en sonnerie 36 renvoi 27, 67 sécurisés 43 stockage et récupération 38 transfert 25 utilisation de NPD 29 Appels à plusieurs interlocuteurs affichage des détails 54, 55 identification dans les journaux d’appels 54 Appels authentifiés 43 Appels chiffrés 43 Appels composés, enregistrements 53 Appels en absence, enregistrements 53 Appels reçus, enregistrements 53 Appels sécurisés 43 Appels suspects, suivi 44 Appels, gestion de base 17 Attente et passage d’un appel à l’autre 24 et transfert 25 utilisation 22 Attribution de priorités aux appels 45 Audible, indicateur d’attente de message 60 Audio, qualité 6 Autre groupe de prise d’appel, utilisation 3782 OL-15178-01 B Bidirectionnel 12 Bouton 34 Bouton Aide, description 10 Bouton Coupure micro, description 10 Bouton Messages, description 9 Bouton Navigation, description 10 Bouton Paramètres, description 10 Bouton Services, description 10 Bouton Volume, description 10 Boutons de ligne, identification 9 C Carnet d’adresses personnel 55 composition d’un numéro 19 utilisation depuis la page Web 62 voir Personnel, carnet d’adresses 57 Carnet personnel, voir Carnet d’adresses personnel Casque bouton, identification 10 mode 49 obtention 50 prendre des appels 20 qualité audio 6 raccrochage 22 Chuchotement 12 Cisco Unified Communications Manager, outil de synchronisation du carnet d’adresses 64 Cisco Unified Video Advantage 75 Cisco WebDialer 71 Clavier description 10 CMC 19 Code d’affaire client 19 Code d’autorisation forcée 19 Codes de carnet d’adresses personnel configuration depuis la page Web 63 Combiné bande lumineuse 10 fixation sur son support 5 utilisation 49 Composition d’un code 64 Composition d’une URL, à partir d’un journal d’appels 55 Composition le combiné raccroché 18 Composition, options 17 Conférences Mul-conf 32 Conférences téléphoniques Mul-conf 32 types 30 Confidentialité et lignes partagées 40 utilisation 42 Configuration options 73 coupure micro, utilisation 23 D Déconnexion de groupes de recherche 39 Dépannage 76 voir aussi QRT 76Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 83 E Écran du téléphone fonctions 12 modification de la langue 52 nettoyage 13 réglage du contraste 52 Émission d’appels, options 17 État de la ligne, affichage 12 État, recherche des données 76 F FAC 19 Fin d’un appel, options 22 FLO 43 Fonction ligne occupée voir FLO 43 Fonctions, disponibilité 15, 73 G Gestion avancée des appels 35 Groupes de recherche, déconnexion 39 GrpIntr 37 H Haut-parleur bouton, identification 10 mode 49 prendre des appels 20 raccrochage 22 I Icône Utilisé à distance pour les lignes partagées 40 Icônes de l’état des appels 11 des lignes 11 ID de l’appelant 13 Identification des appels malveillants (IDAM), utilisation 44 Inactivité 12 Indicateur de messages vocaux 60 modification des paramètres 67 Insertion et confidentialité 42 et lignes partagées 40 utilisation 40 Installation du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 4 Interception d’appels de groupe, utilisation 37 Interception d’appels, utilisation 36 Intercom, appels 34 Intercom, ligne 12, 34 Intrcpt 36 J Journaux d’appels affichage et composition d’un numéro 53 composition à partir d’une entrée d’URL dans 55 effacement 5384 OL-15178-01 L Lignes affichage 12 description 11 et états d’appel 11 et renvoi d’appels 67 et utilisation de la fonction FLO 43 icônes 11 libellé 67 modes de sonnerie 67 paramètre d’indicateur de message vocal 67 Lignes partagées avec insertion 40 avec la fonction de confidentialité 42 description 40 et icône Utilisé à distance 40 Lignes téléphoniques affichage 12 boutons 9 description 11 M Menus de fonctions, utilisation 15 Menus, utilisation 15 Messages écoute 60 indicateur 51, 60 MLPP, utilisation 45 Mobilité de poste connexion 46 déconnexion 46 Modes de sonnerie, modification 67 Module d’extension pour téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7914 52, 73 Mot de passe, modif. 66 N Ne pas déranger 29 NPD 29 Numérotation abrégée 35 Boutons, identification 9 configuration 64 étiquettes 12, 64 utilisation 18 Numérotation automatique 18 O Onglets, téléphone et fonction 13 Outil d’assistance des téléphones enregistrés automatiquement (TAPS, Tool for Auto-Registered Phones Support) 5 Outil de génération de rapports qualité 77 Outil de synchronisation du carnet d’adresses 64 P Pages Web Options utilisat. abonnement à des services téléphoniques 65 accès 61 configuration des fonctions et des services 62 Paramètres de langue (paramètres régionaux) 66Manuel du téléphone IP Cisco Unified 7962G/7942G pour Cisco Unified Communications Manager 6.1 (SCCP et SIP) 85 Paramètres, personnalisation 51 Parcage d’appel dirigé 38 Parcage d’appels 38 Parcage, préfixe de récupération 38 Passage d’un appel à l’autre 24 Performances du casque, généralités 6 Périphérique, page de configuration 61 Personnalisation Messages 60 PIN, modif. 66 Plusieurs appels, gestion 24 Poste, numéros 12 Prendre des appels, options 20 Prise en charge du champ Étiquette ASCII 64 Problèmes audio 77 Q QRT 77 QRT, utilisation 77 R Raccrochage, options 22 Rappel 17 Récupérer l’appel en attente, indicateurs 22 Renvoi d’appels 27 configuration depuis la page Web 67 Renvoi d’appels vers une messagerie vocale 27, 60 Renvoi d’appels, options 27 Répertoire composition d’un numéro depuis une page Web 19 d’entreprise 55 personnel 55 sur votre téléphone 53 utilisation depuis la page Web 71 utilisation sur votre téléphone 18 Répertoire d’entreprise composition d’un numéro depuis une page Web 19 utilisation depuis la page Web 71 utilisation sur votre téléphone 18 Répertoire personnel utilisation depuis la page Web 62 Réponse automatique 50 Reprise, utilisation 22 Réseau, recherche des données de configuration 76 S Sécurité établissement et réception d’appels sécurisés 43 niveaux 44 vérification des appels non sécurisés 43 Sécurité, consignes 2 Service de messagerie vocale 60 Service de numérotation abrégée numérotation 1986 OL-15178-01 Services téléphoniques configuration voir Pages Web Options utilisateur Services Web configuration 61 voir Pages Web Options utilisateur Services, abonnement 65 Socle bouton, identification 9 réglage 5 Son voir Audio, qualité 6 Sonnerie indicateur 10 personnalisation 51 T TABSynch 64 TAPS, utilisation 5 Téléphone IP Cisco Unified aide en ligne 14 configuration des fonctions 15, 73 description 7 enregistrement 5 fixation du support du combiné 5 illustration 7 raccordement 4 réglage de la hauteur 5 services Web 61 Téléphonie, fonctions indicateur d’attente de message audible 60 Texte saisi sur le téléphone 15 Touche dynamique Détails, affichage des appels à plusieurs interlocuteurs avec la 54, 55 Touche programmable description 9 étiqu. 12 Touches dynamiques Aide 10 description 10 étiqu. 12 Messages 9 paramètres 10 Services 10 Transfert direct 26 Transfert, options 25 V vers 60 W WebDialer 19, 71 Z Zone d’activité des appels 12Siège social aux États-Unis Cisco Systems, Inc. 170 West Tasman Drive San Jose, CA 95134-1706 États-Unis www.cisco.com Tél. : +1 408 526-4000 +1 800 553-NETS (6387) Fax : + 1 408 527-0883 Siège social en Asie-Pacifique Cisco Systems, Inc. 168 Robinson Road #28-01 Capital Tower Singapour 068912 www.cisco.com Tél. : +65 6317 7777 Fax : +65 6317 7799 Siège social en Europe Cisco Systems International BV Haarlerbergpark Haarlerbergweg 13-19 1101 CH Amsterdam Pays-Bas www-europe.cisco.com Tél. : +31 800 020 0791 Fax :+31 20 357 1100 Cisco possède plus de 200 bureaux dans le monde. Les adresses ainsi que les numéros de téléphone et de fax se trouvent sur le site Web Cisco, à l’adresse www.cisco.com/go/offices. CCVP, the Cisco logo, and the Cisco Square Bridge logo are trademarks of Cisco Systems, Inc.; Changing the Way We Work, Live, Play, and Learn is a service mark of Cisco Systems, Inc.; and Access Registrar, Aironet, BPX, Catalyst, CCDA, CCDP, CCIE, CCIP, CCNA, CCNP, CCSP, Cisco, the Cisco Certified Internetwork Expert logo, Cisco IOS, Cisco Press, Cisco Systems, Cisco Systems Capital, the Cisco Systems logo, Cisco Unity, Enterprise/Solver, EtherChannel, EtherFast, EtherSwitch, Fast Step, Follow Me Browsing, FormShare, GigaDrive, HomeLink, Internet Quotient, IOS, iPhone, IP/TV, iQ Expertise, the iQ logo, iQ Net Readiness Scorecard, iQuick Study, LightStream, Linksys, MeetingPlace, MGX, Networking Academy, Network Registrar, PIX, ProConnect, ScriptShare, SMARTnet, StackWise, The Fastest Way to Increase Your Internet Quotient, and TransPath are registered trademarks of Cisco Systems, Inc. and/or its affiliates in the United States and certain other countries. All other trademarks mentioned in this document or Website are the property of their respective owners. The use of the word partner does not imply a partnership relationship between Cisco and any other company. (0709R) © 2007 Cisco Systems, Inc. All rights reserved. OL-15178-01 The Java logo is a trademark or registered trademark of Sun Microsystems, Inc. in the U.S. or other countries. CHAPITRE 4-1 Cisco 837 Router and Cisco SOHO 97 Router Cabling and Setup Quick Start Guide 78-14782-07 Français 4 Configuration et câblage des routeurs Cisco 837 et SOHO 97 • Garantie limitée Cisco d'un an sur le matériel • Vérification des éléments livrés avec le routeur • Connexion du routeur • Configuration du routeur • Félicitations ! Vous avez terminé la configuration. • Obtention de documentation • Vos commentaires sur la documentation • Assistance technique • Obtention de publications et d'informations complémentaires4-2 Cisco 837 Router and Cisco SOHO 97 Router Cabling and Setup Quick Start Guide 78-14782-07 Chapitre 4 Configuration et câblage des routeurs Cisco 837 et SOHO 97 Garantie limitée Cisco d'un an sur le matériel Garantie limitée Cisco d'un an sur le matériel Des conditions spécifiques s'appliquent à la garantie de votre matériel et aux prestations de services dont vous pouvez bénéficier pendant la période de validité de cette garantie. Votre déclaration formelle de garantie, qui inclut la garantie et les accords de licence applicables aux logiciels Cisco, est disponible sur le site Cisco.com. Démarrez votre navigateur et accédez à l'URL suivante : http://www.cisco.com/en/US/products/prod_warranties_listing.html Vous pouvez également vous rendre sur le site Web de l'assistance technique et des services Cisco pour obtenir une aide : http://www.cisco.com/public/Support_root.shtml. Vérification des éléments livrés avec le routeur Respectez les étapes de la procédure suivante pour vérifier que tous les éléments nécessaires ont été livrés avec le routeur. Étape 1 Les éléments livrés avec votre routeur sont les suivants. Si l'un des éléments manque ou est endommagé, contactez votre service clientèle. Remarque Le câble ADSL standard est un câble direct bleu lavande. Si le câble qui a été commandé est un câble ADSL croisé, il est bleu lavande avec une bande bleue. Étape 2 Localisez la référence du produit. L'étiquette mentionnant la référence du routeur Cisco 837 se trouve sur la partie arrière gauche du châssis. Figure 4-1 Emplacement de la référence du produit 1 Câble Ethernet jaune 5 Documentation produit 2 Câble ADSL bleu lavande 6 Câble de console bleu clair (RJ-45 à DB-9) 3 Adaptateur secteur de bureau 7 Câble modem pour les gammes de routeurs SOHO/800 (commandé séparément) 4 Cordon d'alimentation noir INTERNET (E1) 4 3 2 1 Cisco 831 +18 VCC CONSOLE ETHERNET 10-BASE-T ORDINATEURS (E0) ETHERNET 10-BASE-T MARCHE ARRÊT Réf. : AAANNNNXXXX 121480 SN: AAANNNNXXXX4-3 Cisco 837 Router and Cisco SOHO 97 Router Cabling and Setup Quick Start Guide 78-14782-07 Chapitre 4 Configuration et câblage des routeurs Cisco 837 et SOHO 97 Connexion du routeur Connexion du routeur La Figure 4-2 montre l'installation type d'un routeur Cisco 837 ou SOHO 97. Figure 4-2 Installation type d'un routeur Cisco 837 ou SOHO 97 Procédez comme suit pour connecter le routeur à l'adaptateur secteur, à votre réseau local et au réseau de votre fournisseur de services : Étape 1 Si vous connectez plus de quatre PC au routeur, connectez ce dernier à un commutateur ou à un concentrateur à l’aide d'un câble Ethernet jaune, comme le montre la Figure 4-2. Étape 2 Pour connecter un PC directement au routeur, procédez comme indiqué dans la Figure 4-2. Mettez le PC hors tension afin qu'il obtienne une adresse IP du routeur lorsqu'il sera remis sous tension. Vous pouvez connecter d'autres PC aux ports Ethernet numérotés restants. Étape 3 Le port console est un port de service auquel vous pouvez connecter un terminal ou un PC pour configurer le logiciel à l'aide de l'interface CLI (command-line interface) ou résoudre les problèmes rencontrés avec le routeur. Si vous voulez accéder à la console du routeur, connectez un PC ou un terminal au port console sur le routeur. Pour plus d'informations, consultez le document Cisco 837 and SOHO 97 Hardware Installation Guide (Routeurs Cisco 837 et SOHO 97 - Guide d'installation matérielle). Remarque En connectant le port console à un modem asynchrone à l’aide du câble modem pour les gammes de routeurs SOHO/800 (disponible en option), vous pouvez doter le routeur de fonctionnalités de sauvegarde et de gestion à distance. Reportez-vous au document Cisco 831 Router and SOHO 91 Router Hardware Installation Guide (Routeurs Cisco 831 et SOHO 91 - Guide d'installation matérielle) pour plus d'informations. Cisco 837 CONSOLE ADSLoISDN +18 VDC ETHERNET 10BASET COMPUTERS (E0)a 4 3 2 1 1X 2X 1X 2X 1 121524 1 2 3 4 54-4 Cisco 837 Router and Cisco SOHO 97 Router Cabling and Setup Quick Start Guide 78-14782-07 Chapitre 4 Configuration et câblage des routeurs Cisco 837 et SOHO 97 Configuration du routeur Étape 4 Connectez le port ADSL du routeur à la prise murale du téléphone à l'aide du câble ADSL bleu lavande. Si la ligne ADSL sert aussi à la communication vocale, vous pouvez empêcher toute interruption de la transmission de données en connectant le routeur à un filtre ADSL ou en installant des microfiltres entre les téléphones ou les télécopieurs et la prise murale. Étape 5 Raccordez le cordon d'alimentation au routeur comme indiqué dans la Figure 4-2 et mettez le routeur sous tension. Assurez-vous d'utiliser l'adaptateur secteur livré avec le routeur. Le routeur n'accepte pas d'autres adaptateurs secteur Cisco. Configuration du routeur Le routeur est livré avec un outil de configuration basé sur le Web que vous exécutez à partir d'un navigateur Web. Instructions de configuration SDM Si le manuel Cisco Router and Security Device Manager (SDM) Quick Start Guide (Guide de démarrage rapide du gestionnaire de routeur SDM) fait partie de votre kit d'accessoires, alors Cisco Router and Security Device Manager (SDM) est chargé sur le routeur. Reportez-vous à ce document pour configurer votre routeur Cisco 837. Le lien suivant permet d'accéder à plus d'informations sur SDM, notamment aux notes de version et à d'autres documentations SDM. http://www.cisco.com/en/US/products/sw/secursw/ps5318/ Remarque SDM n'est pas livré avec les routeurs SOHO 97. Instructions de configuration du logiciel CRWS Si vous n'avez pas reçu le manuel Cisco Router and Security Device Manager (SDM) Quick Start Guide (Guide de démarrage rapide du gestionnaire de routeur SDM), cela signifie que Cisco Router Web Setup (CRWS) est chargé sur votre routeur. Les instructions de ce guide vous expliquent comment configurer le routeur à l'aide du logiciel CRWS. Ce logiciel s'exécute avec les versions 3.0 à 4.7 de Netscape et les versions 4 et supérieures d'Internet Explorer. Le logiciel CRWS (Cisco Router Web Setup) est installé sur le routeur. Il sert à configurer la connexion du routeur à Internet. Le logiciel CRWS s'exécute avec les versions 3.0 à 4.7 de Netscape et les versions 4 et supérieures d'Internet Explorer. Pour démarrer le logiciel CRWS et configurer le routeur, respectez la procédure suivante : Étape 1 Démarrez ou redémarrez un PC connecté à l'un des ports Ethernet (1, 2, 3 ou 4) du routeur. Étape 2 Lancez un navigateur Web. Assurez-vous que le navigateur est configuré pour travailler en mode connexion. • Dans Internet Explorer, cliquez sur le menu Fichier et assurez-vous que l'option Travailler hors connexion est désactivée. • Dans Netscape, l'option Travailler hors ligne du menu Fichier est désactivée par défaut. 4-5 Cisco 837 Router and Cisco SOHO 97 Router Cabling and Setup Quick Start Guide 78-14782-07 Chapitre 4 Configuration et câblage des routeurs Cisco 837 et SOHO 97 Configuration du routeur Étape 3 Tapez l'URL (Universal Resource Locator) indiquée dans la Figure 4-3. Figure 4-3 Tapez l'URL http://10.10.10.1 Le tableau de bord du logiciel CRWS (Figure 4-4) doit apparaître après 1 à 2 minutes. Figure 4-4 Tableau de bord du logiciel CRWS Conseil Si le tableau de bord de CRWS ne s'affiche pas lorsque vous entrez l'URL http://10.10.10.1, testez la connexion entre le PC et le routeur en procédant comme suit : • Assurez-vous que le témoin OK du routeur est allumé et vérifiez la connexion des câbles entre le routeur et le PC. • Si la page d'accueil CRWS ne s'affiche toujours pas, vérifiez que l'option « Travailler hors connexion » du navigateur est désactivée. • Si la page Web refuse toujours de s'afficher, assurez-vous que le PC est configuré pour la réception automatique d'une adresse IP. Sélectionnez Démarrer/Exécuter, tapez winipcfg dans la fenêtre Exécuter et examinez l'adresse se trouvant dans le champ de l'adresse IP. Cette adresse doit être au 4-6 Cisco 837 Router and Cisco SOHO 97 Router Cabling and Setup Quick Start Guide 78-14782-07 Chapitre 4 Configuration et câblage des routeurs Cisco 837 et SOHO 97 Configuration du routeur format 10.10.10.X, où X est un nombre supérieur ou égal à 2 (par exemple, 10.10.10.2 ou 10.10.10.3). Si le format de l’adresse IP n'est pas conforme, suivez les instructions du Conseil à la page 4-6 pour configurer le PC afin d'obtenir une adresse IP automatiquement. Relancez ensuite le logiciel CRWS. Étape 4 Si vous souhaitez une configuration standard, cliquez sur le lien Router Setup (Configuration du routeur) de la page d'accueil, puis cliquez sur Quick Setup (Configuration rapide). Entrez ensuite le nom d'utilisateur et le mot de passe attribués par votre fournisseur d'accès Internet et suivez la procédure indiquée sur la page affichée. Étape 5 Si vous devez configurer des fonctions particulières, comme le protocole NAT (Network Address Translation), cliquez sur les liens correspondants de la page d'accueil et complétez les écrans de configuration. Étape 6 Cliquez sur le lienMot de passe du routeur de la page d'accueil et définissez un mot de passe pour le routeur. Étape 7 Sélectionnez Démarrer/Exécuter et tapez winipcfg dans le champ Ouvrir de la fenêtre Exécuter. Lorsque la fenêtre Configuration IP s'affiche, cliquez sur Libérer, puis sur Renouveler pour respectivement libérer et renouveler l'adresse IP du PC. Vous pouvez également ouvrir une fenêtre DOS et saisir ipconfig /release pour libérer l'adresse IP du PC. Entrez ensuite ipconfig /renew pour la renouveler. Étape 8 Ouvrez un navigateur Web sur le PC et connectez-vous à un site Web. Conseil Si vous n'avez pas pu démarrer CRWS, cela indique peut-être que votre PC n'est pas configuré pour obtenir une adresse IP automatiquement. Vous pouvez utiliser les informations suivantes si votre PC s'exécute sous Microsoft Windows NT ou Microsoft Windows 95, 98 ou 2000. Pour les autres versions de Microsoft Windows, consultez la documentation livrée avec le PC. 1. Mettez le PC en route et ouvrez le Panneau de configuration. 2. Double-cliquez sur l'icône Réseau pour afficher la fenêtre correspondante. 3. Vérifiez que le protocole TCP/IP a été ajouté et associé à l'adaptateur Ethernet. L'icône TCP/IP représente un câble en Y dans la fenêtre Configuration de Microsoft Windows 95, 98, 2000, ME et XP et dans la fenêtre Protocole de Microsoft Windows NT. Si cette icône n'est pas visible, cliquez sur Ajouter, puis ajoutez Microsoft TCP/IP. 4. Pour vérifier si le PC est configuré pour obtenir une adresse IP automatiquement, cliquez sur l'icône TCP/IP représentant un câble, puis sélectionnez l'onglet Adresse IP dans la fenêtre Propriétés TCP/IP. Si ce n'est déjà fait, cochez la case Obtenir automatiquement une adresse IP. Les champs Adresse IP et Masque de sous-réseau doivent être grisés. 5. Pour accepter toutes les modifications et quitter cette fenêtre, cliquez sur OK. Cliquez ensuite sur OK dans la fenêtre Réseau. 6. Si vous y êtes invité, cliquez sur Oui pour redémarrer le PC. 7. Revenez à l'Étape 3 de la section Configuration du routeur page 4-4. Pour plus d'informations sur la configuration du protocole TCP/IP, consultez le manuel Guide de dépannage de la configuration Web d'un routeur Cisco disponible sur le CD de documentation produit des gammes Cisco 800 et SOHO .4-7 Cisco 837 Router and Cisco SOHO 97 Router Cabling and Setup Quick Start Guide 78-14782-07 Chapitre 4 Configuration et câblage des routeurs Cisco 837 et SOHO 97 Félicitations ! Vous avez terminé la configuration. Félicitations ! Vous avez terminé la configuration. Si vous parvenez à vous connecter à un site Web, cela indique que le câblage et la configuration de votre routeur ont réussi. Vous pouvez désormais utiliser le routeur pour accéder à Internet. Pour configurer d'autres fonctionnalités, cliquez sur les liens CRWS appropriés et entrez les valeurs de configuration du routeur. Les autres sections de ce guide de démarrage rapide présentent des informations sur la documentation connexe des gammes Cisco 800 et SOHO. Informations complémentaires sur le routeur Pour plus d'informations, consultez les documents suivants : • Cisco 837 Router and SOHO 97 Router Hardware Installation Guide (Routeurs Cisco 837 et SOHO 97 - Guide d'installation matérielle) : fournit des informations détaillées concernant le câblage et le matériel pour les routeurs Cisco 837 et SOHO 97. • Cisco 800 Series Router Software Configuration Guide (Routeurs Cisco 800 – Guide de configuration logicielle) : fournit des informations détaillées sur la configuration des routeurs Cisco 800. • Cisco 828 Router and SOHO 78 Router Hardware Installation Guide (Routeurs Cisco 828 et SOHO 78 - Guide d'installation matérielle) : fournit des informations détaillées concernant le câblage et le matériel pour les routeurs Cisco 828 et SOHO 78. • Cisco 828 Router and SOHO 78 Router Software Configuration Guide (Routeurs Cisco 828 et SOHO 78 - Guide de configuration logicielle) : fournit des instructions de configuration détaillées pour les routeurs Cisco 828 et SOHO 78. • Cisco Router Web Setup Troubleshooting Guide (Guide de dépannage de la configuration Web d'un routeur Cisco) : fournit des informations de base sur la configuration du routeur. • Upgrading Memory in Cisco 800 Series Routers (Routeurs Cisco 800 – Mise à niveau de la mémoire) : fournit des informations sur la mise à niveau de la mémoire des routeurs Cisco 800. La documentation Cisco la plus récente est disponible sur Internet à partir des sites suivants : • http://www.cisco.com • http://www-china.cisco.com • http://www-europe.cisco.com Obtention de documentation La documentation Cisco est disponible sur le site Cisco.com. Cisco propose aussi divers moyens pour obtenir une assistance technique et d'autres ressources techniques. Les sections qui suivent expliquent comment obtenir des informations techniques de Cisco Systems. Cisco.com Vous pouvez accéder à la documentation Cisco la plus récente à l'adresse suivante : http://www.cisco.com/en/US/docs/general/whatsnew/whatsnew.html4-8 Cisco 837 Router and Cisco SOHO 97 Router Cabling and Setup Quick Start Guide 78-14782-07 Chapitre 4 Configuration et câblage des routeurs Cisco 837 et SOHO 97 Vos commentaires sur la documentation Vous pouvez accéder au site Web de Cisco à l'adresse suivante : http://www.cisco.com Vous pouvez accéder aux sites Web internationaux de Cisco à l'adresse suivante : http://www.cisco.com/public/countries_languages.shtml Commande de documentation Vous trouverez les instructions de commande de documentation à l'adresse suivante : http://www.cisco.com/univercd/cc/td/doc/es_inpck/pdi.htm Vous pouvez commander de la documentation Cisco comme suit : • Les utilisateurs inscrits sur Cisco.com (clients directs de Cisco) peuvent commander de la documentation à l'adresse suivante : http://www.cisco.com/en/US/partner/ordering/index.shtml • Les utilisateurs non inscrits sur Cisco.com peuvent se procurer de la documentation par l'intermédiaire d'un représentant de compte local en appelant le siège social de Cisco Systems (Californie, États-Unis) au numéro 408 526-7208 ou, en Amérique du Nord, en composant le 800 553-NETS (6387). Vos commentaires sur la documentation Vous pouvez envoyer vos commentaires sur la documentation technique à l'adresse bug-doc@cisco.com. Pour envoyer vos commentaires par courrier ordinaire, utilisez le coupon-réponse situé à l'arrière de la couverture de votre document ou, à défaut, écrivez à l'adresse suivante : Cisco Systems Attn: Customer Document Ordering 170 West Tasman Drive San Jose, CA 95134-9883 États-Unis Vos commentaires sont les bienvenus. Assistance technique Pour tous les clients, partenaires, revendeurs et distributeurs en possession de contrats de service Cisco valides, le centre d'assistance technique Cisco propose une assistance hors pair disponible 24 heures sur 24. Le site Web d'assistance technique Cisco sur Cisco.com propose des ressources en ligne très complètes. En outre, le centre d'assistance technique (TAC) Cisco fournit une assistance téléphonique. Si vous n'avez pas de contrat de service Cisco valide, contactez votre revendeur.4-9 Cisco 837 Router and Cisco SOHO 97 Router Cabling and Setup Quick Start Guide 78-14782-07 Chapitre 4 Configuration et câblage des routeurs Cisco 837 et SOHO 97 Assistance technique Site Web d'assistance technique Cisco Ce site propose des documents et outils en ligne pour dépanner et résoudre les problèmes techniques liés aux technologies et produits Cisco. Il est disponible 24 heures sur 24, 365 jours par an à l'adresse suivante : http://www.cisco.com/techsupport Pour accéder aux outils du site, vous devez être inscrit à Cisco.com et posséder un ID utilisateur ainsi qu'un mot de passe. Si vous êtes en possession d'un contrat de service valide mais que vous n'avez ni ID utilisateur ni de mot de passe, connectez-vous à l'adresse suivante pour vous inscrire : http://tools.cisco.com/RPF/register/register.do Soumission d'une demande de service Utiliser l'outil de demande de service en ligne sur le TAC est le moyen le plus rapide d'ouvrir des demandes de service S3 et S4. (Ces demandes correspondent à une dégradation minimale du fonctionnement de votre réseau ou à une demande d'information produit.) Lorsque vous avez décrit la situation, l'outil de demande de service du TAC vous propose automatiquement les solutions recommandées. Si cela ne résout pas le problème, votre demande de service est affectée à un ingénieur du TAC Cisco. Vous trouverez l'outil de demande de service du TAC à l'adresse suivante : http://www.cisco.com/techsupport/servicerequest Pour les demandes de service S1 ou S2 ou si vous n'avez pas d'accès à Internet, contactez le TAC Cisco par téléphone. (Vous soumettez ce type de demandes quand votre réseau opérationnel est très dégradé ou paralysé.) Ces demandes sont affectées immédiatement aux ingénieurs du TAC Cisco pour préserver le bon fonctionnement de vos activités. Pour ouvrir une demande de service par téléphone, composez l'un des numéros suivants : Asie-Pacifique : +61 2 8446 7411 (Australie : 1 800 805 227) Zone EMEA : +32 2 704 55 55 États-Unis : 1 800 553 2447 Pour consulter la liste complète des contacts du TAC Cisco, rendez-vous à l'adresse : http://www.cisco.com/techsupport/contacts Définition de la gravité des demandes de service Cisco a défini des niveaux de gravité de sorte que toutes les demandes de service observent un format standard. Gravité 1 (S1) : votre réseau est « paralysé » ou la situation a un impact très négatif sur vos activités commerciales. Vous et Cisco engagerez 24 heures sur 24 toutes les ressources nécessaires pour résoudre le problème. Gravité 2 (S2) : le fonctionnement d'un réseau existant est très dégradé ou des aspects importants de vos activités commerciales sont affectés par les performances inadéquates des produits Cisco. Vous et Cisco engagerez des ressources à temps plein pendant les heures de bureau normales pour résoudre le problème. Gravité 3 (S3) : les performances de votre réseau sont affectées mais la plupart de vos activités commerciales restent fonctionnelles. Vous et Cisco engagerez des ressources pendant les heures de bureau normales pour rétablir des niveaux de service satisfaisants.4-10 Cisco 837 Router and Cisco SOHO 97 Router Cabling and Setup Quick Start Guide 78-14782-07 Chapitre 4 Configuration et câblage des routeurs Cisco 837 et SOHO 97 Obtention de publications et d'informations complémentaires Gravité 4 (S4) : vous avez besoin d'informations ou d'assistance concernant des fonctionnalités, l'installation ou la configuration de produits Cisco. L'impact sur vos activités commerciales est faible, voire nul. Obtention de publications et d'informations complémentaires Des informations sur les produits, les technologies et les solutions réseau Cisco sont disponibles en ligne et sous forme imprimée. • La boutique Cisco Marketplace offre un grand choix d'ouvrages Cisco, de guides de référence et de produits. Pour la découvrir, rendez-vous à l'adresse suivante : http://www.cisco.com/go/marketplace/ • Le Catalogue des produits Cisco détaille les produits réseau proposés par Cisco Systems, ainsi que les services clients gérant les commandes et les demandes d'assistance. Accédez au Catalogue des produits Cisco en tapant l'URL suivante : http://cisco.com/univercd/cc/td/doc/pcat/ • Cisco Press publie une large gamme d'ouvrages traitant de l'administration réseau, des formations et des certifications. Les utilisateurs débutants comme les plus expérimentés y trouveront des informations utiles. Pour connaître les dernières publications de Cisco Press et consulter d'autres informations, visitez le site de Cisco Press à l'adresse suivante : http://www.ciscopress.com • Le magazine Packet destiné aux utilisateurs techniques de Cisco Systems détaille comment maximiser les investissements Internet et réseau. Chaque trimestre, il présente les dernières tendances en matière de réseaux, les innovations technologiques ainsi que les produits et solutions Cisco. Il donne des conseils pour le déploiement et le dépannage des réseaux et propose des exemples de configuration, des études de cas relatives à la clientèle, des informations sur les certifications et les formations et des liens vers des ressources plus détaillées accessibles en ligne. Vous pouvez accéder au magazine Packet à l'adresse suivante : http://www.cisco.com/packet • Le journal trimestriel Internet Protocol Journal publié par Cisco Systems s'adresse aux ingénieurs concernés par la conception, le développement et l'exploitation de réseaux Internet et intranet publics et privés. Vous pouvez y accéder à l'adresse suivante : http://www.cisco.com/ipj • Cisco propose des formations de niveau international sur les réseaux. Les programmes en cours sont présentés à l'adresse suivante : http://www.cisco.com/en/US/learning/index.html CHAPITRE 4-1 Cisco 836 Router and Cisco SOHO 96 Router Cabling and Setup Quick Start Guide 78-14767-06 Français 4 Guide de démarrage rapide - Configuration et câblage des routeurs Cisco 836 et SOHO 96 • Garantie limitée Cisco d’un an sur le matériel • Vérification des éléments livrés avec le routeur • Connexion du routeur • Configuration du routeur • Félicitations ! Vous avez terminé la configuration. • Obtention de documentation • Vos commentaires sur la documentation • Assistance technique • Obtention de publications et d’informations complémentaires4-2 Cisco 836 Router and Cisco SOHO 96 Router Cabling and Setup Quick Start Guide 78-14767-06 Chapitre 4 Guide de démarrage rapide - Configuration et câblage des routeurs Cisco 836 et SOHO 96 Garantie limitée Cisco d’un an sur le matériel Garantie limitée Cisco d’un an sur le matériel Des conditions spécifiques s’appliquent à la garantie de votre matériel et aux prestations de services dont vous pouvez bénéficier pendant la période de validité de cette garantie. Votre déclaration formelle de garantie, qui inclut la garantie et les accords de licence applicables aux logiciels Cisco, est disponible sur le site Cisco.com. Démarrez votre navigateur et accédez à l’URL suivante : http://www.cisco.com/en/US/products/prod_warranties_listing.html Vous pouvez également vous rendre sur le site Web de l’assistance technique et des services Cisco pour obtenir une aide : http://www.cisco.com/public/Support_root.shtml. Durée de la garantie sur le matériel Un (1) an Procédure de remplacement, réparation ou remboursement du matériel Cisco ou son centre de service sera en mesure d’expédier une pièce de rechange dans un délai de dix (10) jours suivant la réception de la demande d’autorisation de retour de matériel (ARM). Le délai effectif de livraison pourra varier en fonction de la destination. Cisco se réserve le droit de rembourser le prix d’achat comme seule garantie. Pour recevoir un numéro d’autorisation de retour de matériel (ARM) Contactez la société auprès de laquelle vous avez acheté le produit. Si vous avez acheté le produit directement auprès de Cisco, contactez votre responsable des ventes Cisco. Complétez les informations ci-dessous et conservez-les comme référence. Vérification des éléments livrés avec le routeur Respectez les étapes de la procédure suivante pour vérifier que tous les éléments nécessaires ont été livrés avec le routeur. Étape 1 La Figure 4-1 présente les éléments livrés avec le routeur. Si l’un des éléments manque ou est endommagé, contactez votre service clientèle. Produit acheté auprès de Numéro de téléphone du vendeur Modèle du produit Référence du produit Numéro du contrat de maintenance4-3 Cisco 836 Router and Cisco SOHO 96 Router Cabling and Setup Quick Start Guide 78-14767-06 Chapitre 4 Guide de démarrage rapide - Configuration et câblage des routeurs Cisco 836 et SOHO 96 Vérification des éléments livrés avec le routeur Figure 4-1 Éléments livrés avec le routeur Étape 2 Vérifiez quel câble ADSL a été livré avec le routeur. Le routeur est livré avec un des câbles ADSL suivants, spécifié lors de la commande du routeur : un câble ADSL standard direct RJ-11 à RJ-11, croisé RJ-11 à RJ-11 ou direct RJ-11 à RJ-45. Étape 3 Localisez la référence du produit. L’étiquette mentionnant la référence du routeur Cisco 836 se trouve sur la partie arrière gauche du châssis. Figure 4-2 Emplacement de la référence du produit 1 Câble Ethernet jaune 5 Cordon d’alimentation noir 2 Câble ADSL bleu lavande 6 Documentation produit 3 Câble S/T RNIS orange (commandé séparément) 7 Câble de console bleu clair (RJ-45 à DB-9) 4 Adaptateur secteur de bureau 5 6 121478 2 Autre documentation Guide de démarrage rapide INTERNET (E1) 4 3 2 1 Cisco 831 +18 VCC CONSOLE ETHERNET 10-BASE-T ORDINATEURS (E0) ETHERNET 10-BASE-T MARCHE ARRÊT Réf. : AAANNNNXXXX 121480 SN: AAANNNNXXXX4-4 Cisco 836 Router and Cisco SOHO 96 Router Cabling and Setup Quick Start Guide 78-14767-06 Chapitre 4 Guide de démarrage rapide - Configuration et câblage des routeurs Cisco 836 et SOHO 96 Connexion du routeur Connexion du routeur La Figure 4-3 montre l’installation type d’un routeur Cisco 836 ou SOHO 96. Figure 4-3 Installation type d’un routeur Cisco 836 ou SOHO 96 Cisco 836 CONSOLE ISDN S/T ADSLoISDN +18 VDC ETHERNET 10BASET COMPUTERS (E0)a 4 3 2 1 1X 2X 1X 2X 1 121520 1 2 4 5 34-5 Cisco 836 Router and Cisco SOHO 96 Router Cabling and Setup Quick Start Guide 78-14767-06 Chapitre 4 Guide de démarrage rapide - Configuration et câblage des routeurs Cisco 836 et SOHO 96 Configuration du routeur Procédez comme suit pour connecter le routeur à l’adaptateur secteur, à votre réseau local et au réseau de votre fournisseur de services : Étape 1 Si vous connectez plus de quatre PC au routeur, connectez ce dernier à un commutateur ou à un concentrateur à l’aide d’un câble Ethernet jaune, comme le montre la Figure 4-3. Étape 2 Pour connecter un PC directement au routeur, procédez comme indiqué dans la Figure 4-3. Mettez le PC hors tension afin qu’il obtienne une adresse IP du routeur lorsqu’il sera remis sous tension. Vous pouvez connecter d’autres PC aux ports Ethernet numérotés restants. Étape 3 Le port console est un port de service auquel vous pouvez connecter un terminal ou un PC pour configurer le logiciel à l’aide de l’interface CLI (command-line interface) ou résoudre les problèmes rencontrés avec le routeur. Si vous voulez accéder à la console du routeur, connectez un PC ou un terminal au port console. Pour plus d’informations, consultez le document Cisco 836 and SOHO 96 Hardware Installation Guide (Routeurs Cisco 836 et SOHO 96 - Guide d’installation matérielle). Étape 4 Facultatif. Pour la sauvegarde et la gestion à distance, vous pouvez connecter le port S/T RNIS à une terminaison réseau (NT1) ou à un filtre ADSL à l’aide du câble S/T RNIS orange (disponible en option). Pour plus d’informations, consultez le document Cisco 836 and SOHO 96 Hardware Installation Guide (Routeurs Cisco 836 et SOHO 96 - Guide d’installation matérielle). Étape 5 Branchez le câble ADSL sur le port ADSLoRNIS du routeur et sur le filtre ADSL ou la prise murale. Si vous utilisez un filtre ADSL, connectez-le à la prise murale à l’aide d’un câble à paire torsadée non blindée de catégorie 5. Étape 6 Raccordez le cordon d’alimentation au routeur comme indiqué dans la Figure 4-3 et mettez le routeur sous tension. Assurez-vous d’utiliser l’adaptateur secteur livré avec le routeur. Attention L’appareil est prévu pour fonctionner avec des systèmes d’alimentation TN. Attention Ce produit dépend des installations du bâtiment pour la protection contre les courts-circuits (surtension). Assurez-vous qu’un fusible ou un disjoncteur (maximum 240VCA, 16 A, 120 V CA, 15 A aux États-Unis) est utilisé sur les conducteurs de phase (tous les conducteurs sous tension). Attention Cet appareil doit être mis à la terre. Assurez-vous que le système hôte est raccordé à la terre en cours d’utilisation. Configuration du routeur Le routeur est livré avec un outil de configuration basé sur le Web que vous exécutez à partir d’un navigateur Web. Instructions de configuration SDM Si le manuel Cisco Router and Security Device Manager (SDM) Quick Start Guide (Guide de démarrage rapide du gestionnaire de routeur SDM) fait partie de votre kit d’accessoires, alors Cisco Router and Security Device Manager (SDM) est chargé sur le routeur. Reportez-vous à ce document pour configurer votre routeur Cisco 836.4-6 Cisco 836 Router and Cisco SOHO 96 Router Cabling and Setup Quick Start Guide 78-14767-06 Chapitre 4 Guide de démarrage rapide - Configuration et câblage des routeurs Cisco 836 et SOHO 96 Configuration du routeur Le lien suivant permet d’accéder à plus d’informations sur SDM, notamment aux notes de version et à d’autres documentations SDM. http://www.cisco.com/en/US/products/sw/secursw/ps5318/ Remarque SDM n’est pas livré avec les routeurs SOHO 96. Instructions de configuration du logiciel CRWS Si vous n’avez pas reçu le Cisco Router and Security Device Manager (SDM) Quick Start Guide (Guide de démarrage rapide du gestionnaire de routeur SDM), alors Cisco Router Web Setup (CRWS) est chargé sur votre routeur. Les instructions de ce guide vous expliquent comment configurer le routeur à l’aide du logiciel CRWS. Ce logiciel s’exécute avec les versions 3.0 à 4.7 de Netscape et les versions 4 et supérieures d’Internet Explorer. Pour démarrer le logiciel CRWS et configurer le routeur, respectez la procédure suivante : Étape 1 Démarrez ou redémarrez un PC connecté à l’un des ports Ethernet (1, 2, 3 ou 4) du routeur. Il n’est pas nécessaire que le PC soit connecté directement au routeur. Il peut être connecté par l’intermédiaire d’un commutateur ou d’un concentrateur. Étape 2 Lancez un navigateur Web. Assurez-vous que le navigateur est configuré pour travailler en mode connexion. • Dans Internet Explorer, cliquez sur le menu Fichier et assurez-vous que l’option Travailler hors connexion est désactivée. • Dans Netscape, l’option Travailler hors ligne du menu Fichier est désactivée par défaut. Étape 3 Tapez l’URL (Universal Resource Locator) indiquée dans la Figure 4-4. Figure 4-4 Tapez l’URL http://10.10.10.1 Le tableau de bord du logiciel CRWS (Figure 4-5) doit apparaître après 1 à 2 minutes.4-7 Cisco 836 Router and Cisco SOHO 96 Router Cabling and Setup Quick Start Guide 78-14767-06 Chapitre 4 Guide de démarrage rapide - Configuration et câblage des routeurs Cisco 836 et SOHO 96 Configuration du routeur Figure 4-5 Tableau de bord du logiciel CRWS Conseil Si le tableau de bord de CRWS ne s’affiche pas lorsque vous entrez l’URL http://10.10.10.1, testez la connexion entre le PC et le routeur en procédant comme suit : • Assurez-vous que le témoin OK du routeur est allumé et vérifiez la connexion des câbles entre le routeur et le PC. • Si la page d’accueil CRWS ne s’affiche toujours pas, vérifiez que l’option « Travailler hors connexion » du navigateur est désactivée. • Si la page Web refuse toujours de s’afficher, assurez-vous que le PC est configuré pour la réception automatique d’une adresse IP. Sélectionnez Démarrer/Exécuter, tapez winipcfg dans la fenêtre Exécuter et examinez l’adresse se trouvant dans le champ de l’adresse IP. Cette adresse doit être au format 10.10.10.X, où X est un nombre supérieur ou égal à 2 (par exemple, 10.10.10.2 ou 10.10.10.3). Si le format de l’adresse IP n’est pas conforme, suivez les instructions du Conseil à la page 4-8 pour configurer le PC afin d’obtenir une adresse IP automatiquement. Relancez ensuite le logiciel CRWS. Étape 4 Si vous souhaitez une configuration standard, cliquez sur le lien Router Setup (Configuration du routeur) de la page d’accueil, puis cliquez sur Quick Setup (Configuration rapide). Entrez ensuite le nom d’utilisateur et le mot de passe attribués par votre fournisseur d’accès Internet et suivez la procédure indiquée sur la page affichée. Étape 5 Si vous devez configurer des fonctions particulières, comme le protocole NAT (Network Address Translation), cliquez sur les liens correspondants de la page d’accueil et complétez les écrans de configuration.4-8 Cisco 836 Router and Cisco SOHO 96 Router Cabling and Setup Quick Start Guide 78-14767-06 Chapitre 4 Guide de démarrage rapide - Configuration et câblage des routeurs Cisco 836 et SOHO 96 Félicitations ! Vous avez terminé la configuration. Étape 6 Cliquez sur le lien Router Password (Routeur - Mot de passe) de la page d’accueil et définissez un mot de passe pour le routeur. Étape 7 Sélectionnez Démarrer/Exécuter et tapez winipcfg dans le champ Ouvrir de la fenêtre Exécuter. Lorsque la fenêtre Configuration IP s’affiche, cliquez sur Libérer, puis sur Renouveler pour respectivement libérer et renouveler l’adresse IP du PC. Vous pouvez également ouvrir une fenêtre Exécuter et saisir ipconfig /release pour libérer l’adresse IP du PC. Entrez ensuite ipconfig /renew pour la renouveler. Étape 8 Ouvrez un navigateur Web sur le PC et connectez-vous à un site Web. Conseil Si vous n’avez pas pu démarrer CRWS, cela indique peut-être que votre PC n’est pas configuré pour obtenir une adresse IP automatiquement. Vous pouvez utiliser les informations suivantes si votre PC s’exécute sous Microsoft Windows NT ou Microsoft Windows 95, 98 ou 2000. Pour les autres versions de Microsoft Windows, consultez la documentation livrée avec le PC. 1. Mettez le PC en route et ouvrez le Panneau de configuration. 2. Double-cliquez sur l’icône Réseau pour afficher la fenêtre correspondante. 3. Vérifiez que le protocole TCP/IP a été ajouté et associé à l’adaptateur Ethernet. L’icône TCP/IP représente un câble en Y dans la fenêtre Configuration de Microsoft Windows 95, 98, 2000, ME et XP et dans la fenêtre Protocole de Microsoft Windows NT. Si cette icône n’est pas visible, cliquez sur Ajouter, puis ajoutez Microsoft TCP/IP. 4. Pour vérifier si le PC est configuré pour obtenir une adresse IP automatiquement, cliquez sur l’icône TCP/IP représentant un câble, puis sélectionnez l’onglet Adresse IP dans la fenêtre Propriétés TCP/IP. Si ce n’est déjà fait, cochez la case Obtenir automatiquement une adresse IP. Les champs Adresse IP et Masque de sous-réseau doivent être grisés. 5. Pour accepter toutes les modifications et quitter cette fenêtre, cliquez sur OK. Cliquez ensuite sur OK dans la fenêtre Réseau. 6. Si vous y êtes invité, cliquez sur Oui pour redémarrer le PC. 7. Revenez à l’Étape 3 de la section Configuration du routeur page 4-5. Pour plus d’informations sur la configuration du protocole TCP/IP, consultez le manuel Guide de dépannage de la configuration Web d'un routeur Cisco disponible sur le Cisco.com. Félicitations ! Vous avez terminé la configuration. Si vous parvenez à vous connecter à un site Web, cela indique que le câblage et la configuration de votre routeur ont réussi. Vous pouvez désormais l’utiliser pour accéder à Internet. Pour configurer d’autres fonctionnalités, cliquez sur les liens CRWS appropriés et entrez les valeurs de configuration du routeur.4-9 Cisco 836 Router and Cisco SOHO 96 Router Cabling and Setup Quick Start Guide 78-14767-06 Chapitre 4 Guide de démarrage rapide - Configuration et câblage des routeurs Cisco 836 et SOHO 96 Obtention de documentation Informations complémentaires sur le routeur Pour plus d’informations, consultez les documents suivants : • Cisco 836 Router and SOHO 96 Router Hardware Installation Guide (Routeurs Cisco 836 et SOHO 96 - Guide d’installation matérielle) : fournit des informations détaillées concernant le câblage et le matériel pour les routeurs Cisco 836 et SOHO 96. • Cisco 800 Series Router Software Configuration Guide (Routeurs Cisco 800 – Guide de configuration logicielle) : fournit des informations détaillées sur la configuration des routeurs Cisco 800. • Regulatory Compliance and Safety Information for Cisco 800 Series and SOHO Series Routers (Routeurs des gammes Cisco 800 et SOHO – Informations relatives au respect des réglementations et à la sécurité) : fournit des informations sur les normes de sécurité et les réglementations internationales pour tous les routeurs des gammes Cisco 800 et SOHO. • Upgrading Memory in Cisco 800 Series Routers (Routeurs Cisco 800 – Mise à niveau de la mémoire) : fournit des informations sur la mise à niveau de la mémoire des routeurs Cisco 800. La documentation Cisco la plus récente est disponible sur Internet à partir des sites suivants : • http://www.cisco.com • http://www-china.cisco.com • http://www-europe.cisco.com Obtention de documentation La documentation Cisco est disponible sur le site Cisco.com. Cisco propose aussi divers moyens pour obtenir une assistance technique et d’autres ressources techniques. Les sections qui suivent expliquent comment obtenir des informations techniques de Cisco Systems. Cisco.com Vous pouvez accéder à la documentation Cisco la plus récente à l’adresse suivante : http://www.cisco.com/en/US/support/index.html Vous pouvez accéder au site Web de Cisco à l’adresse suivante : http://www.cisco.com Vous pouvez accéder aux sites Web internationaux de Cisco à l’adresse suivante : http://www.cisco.com/public/countries_languages.shtml Commande de documentation Vous trouverez les instructions de commande de documentation à l’adresse suivante : http://www.cisco.com/en/US/docs/general/whatsnew/whatsnew.html4-10 Cisco 836 Router and Cisco SOHO 96 Router Cabling and Setup Quick Start Guide 78-14767-06 Chapitre 4 Guide de démarrage rapide - Configuration et câblage des routeurs Cisco 836 et SOHO 96 Vos commentaires sur la documentation Vous pouvez commander de la documentation Cisco comme suit : • Les utilisateurs inscrits sur Cisco.com (clients directs de Cisco) peuvent commander de la documentation à l’adresse suivante : http://www.cisco.com/en/US/partner/ordering/index.shtml • Les utilisateurs non inscrits sur Cisco.com peuvent se procurer de la documentation par l’intermédiaire d’un représentant de compte local en appelant le siège social de Cisco Systems (Californie, États-Unis) au numéro 408 526-7208 ou, en Amérique du Nord, en composant le 800 553-NETS (6387). Vos commentaires sur la documentation Vous pouvez envoyer vos commentaires sur la documentation technique à l’adresse bug-doc@cisco.com. Pour envoyer vos commentaires par courrier ordinaire, utilisez le coupon-réponse situé à l’arrière de la couverture de votre document ou, à défaut, écrivez à l’adresse suivante : Cisco Systems Attn: Customer Document Ordering 170 West Tasman Drive San Jose, CA 95134-9883 États-Unis Vos commentaires sont les bienvenus. Assistance technique Pour tous les clients, partenaires, revendeurs et distributeurs en possession de contrats de service Cisco valides, le centre d’assistance technique Cisco propose une assistance hors pair disponible 24 heures sur 24. Le site Web d’assistance technique Cisco sur Cisco.com propose des ressources en ligne très complètes. En outre, le centre d’assistance technique (TAC) Cisco fournit une assistance téléphonique. Si vous n’avez pas de contrat de service Cisco valide, contactez votre revendeur. Site Web d’assistance technique Cisco Ce site propose des documents et outils en ligne pour dépanner et résoudre les problèmes techniques liés aux technologies et produits Cisco. Il est disponible 24 heures sur 24, 365 jours par an à l’adresse suivante : http://www.cisco.com/techsupport Pour accéder aux outils du site, vous devez être inscrit à Cisco.com et posséder une ID utilisateur ainsi qu’un mot de passe. Si vous êtes en possession d’un contrat de service valide mais que vous n’avez ni ID utilisateur ni de mot de passe, connectez-vous à l’adresse suivante pour vous inscrire : http://tools.cisco.com/RPF/register/register.do4-11 Cisco 836 Router and Cisco SOHO 96 Router Cabling and Setup Quick Start Guide 78-14767-06 Chapitre 4 Guide de démarrage rapide - Configuration et câblage des routeurs Cisco 836 et SOHO 96 Assistance technique Soumission d’une demande de service Utiliser l’outil de demande de service en ligne sur le TAC est le moyen le plus rapide d’ouvrir des demandes de service S3 et S4. (Ces demandes correspondent à une dégradation minimale du fonctionnement de votre réseau ou à une demande d’information produit.) Lorsque vous avez décrit la situation, l’outil de demande de service du TAC vous propose automatiquement les solutions recommandées. Si cela ne résout pas le problème, votre demande de service est affectée à un ingénieur du TAC Cisco. Vous trouverez l’outil de demande de service du TAC à l’adresse suivante : http://www.cisco.com/techsupport/servicerequest Pour les demandes de service S1 ou S2 ou si vous n’avez pas d’accès à Internet, contactez le TAC Cisco par téléphone. (Vous soumettez ce type de demandes quand votre réseau opérationnel est très dégradé ou paralysé.) Ces demandes sont affectées immédiatement aux ingénieurs du TAC Cisco pour préserver le bon fonctionnement de vos activités. Pour ouvrir une demande de service par téléphone, composez l’un des numéros suivants : Asie-Pacifique : +61 2 8446 7411 (Australie : 1 800 805 227) Zone EMEA : +32 2 704 55 55 États-Unis : 1 800 553 2447 Pour consulter la liste complète des contacts du TAC Cisco, rendez-vous à l’adresse : http://www.cisco.com/techsupport/contacts Définition de la gravité des demandes de service Cisco a défini des niveaux de gravité de sorte que toutes les demandes de service observent un format standard. Gravité 1 (S1) : votre réseau est « paralysé » ou la situation a un impact très négatif sur vos activités commerciales. Vous et Cisco engagerez 24 heures sur 24 toutes les ressources nécessaires pour résoudre le problème. Gravité 2 (S2) : le fonctionnement d’un réseau existant est très dégradé ou des aspects importants de vos activités commerciales sont affectés par les performances inadéquates des produits Cisco. Vous et Cisco engagerez des ressources à temps plein pendant les heures de bureau normales pour résoudre le problème. Gravité 3 (S3) : les performances de votre réseau sont affectées mais la plupart de vos activités commerciales restent fonctionnelles. Vous et Cisco engagerez des ressources pendant les heures de bureau normales pour rétablir des niveaux de service satisfaisants. Gravité 4 (S4) : vous avez besoin d’informations ou d’assistance concernant des fonctionnalités, l’installation ou la configuration de produits Cisco. L’impact sur vos activités commerciales est faible, voire nul.4-12 Cisco 836 Router and Cisco SOHO 96 Router Cabling and Setup Quick Start Guide 78-14767-06 Chapitre 4 Guide de démarrage rapide - Configuration et câblage des routeurs Cisco 836 et SOHO 96 Obtention de publications et d’informations complémentaires Obtention de publications et d’informations complémentaires Des informations sur les produits, les technologies et les solutions réseau Cisco sont disponibles en ligne et sous forme imprimée. • La boutique Cisco Marketplace offre un grand choix d’ouvrages Cisco, de guides de référence et de produits. Pour la découvrir, rendez-vous à l’adresse suivante : http://www.cisco.com/go/marketplace/ • Le Catalogue des produits Cisco détaille les produits réseau proposés par Cisco Systems, ainsi que les services clients gérant les commandes et les demandes d’assistance. Accédez au Catalogue des produits Cisco en tapant l’URL suivante : http://cisco.com/univercd/cc/td/doc/pcat/ • Cisco Press publie une large gamme d’ouvrages traitant de l’administration réseau, des formations et des certifications. Les utilisateurs débutants comme les plus expérimentés y trouveront des informations utiles. Pour connaître les dernières publications de Cisco Press et consulter d’autres informations, visitez le site de Cisco Press à l’adresse suivante : http://www.ciscopress.com • Le magazine Packet destiné aux utilisateurs techniques de Cisco Systems détaille comment maximiser les investissements Internet et réseau. Chaque trimestre, il présente les dernières tendances en matière de réseaux, les innovations technologiques ainsi que les produits et solutions Cisco. Il donne des conseils pour le déploiement et le dépannage des réseaux et propose des exemples de configuration, des études de cas relatives à la clientèle, des informations sur les certifications et les formations et des liens vers des ressources plus détaillées accessibles en ligne. Vous pouvez accéder au magazine Packet à l’adresse suivante : http://www.cisco.com/packet • Le journal trimestriel Internet Protocol Journal publié par Cisco Systems s’adresse aux ingénieurs concernés par la conception, le développement et l’exploitation de réseaux Internet et intranet publics et privés. Vous pouvez y accéder à l’adresse suivante : http://www.cisco.com/ipj • Cisco propose des formations de niveau international sur les réseaux. Les programmes en cours sont présentés à l’adresse suivante : http://www.cisco.com/en/US/learning/index.html Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x Americas Headquarters Cisco Systems, Inc. 170 West Tasman Drive San Jose, CA 95134-1706 USA http://www.cisco.com Tel: 408 526-4000 800 553-NETS (6387) Fax: 408 527-0883 Text Part Number: OL-26081-03THE SPECIFICATIONS AND INFORMATION REGARDING THE PRODUCTS IN THIS MANUAL ARE SUBJECT TO CHANGE WITHOUT NOTICE. ALL STATEMENTS, INFORMATION, AND RECOMMENDATIONS IN THIS MANUAL ARE BELIEVED TO BE ACCURATE BUT ARE PRESENTED WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED. USERS MUST TAKE FULL RESPONSIBILITY FOR THEIR APPLICATION OF ANY PRODUCTS. THE SOFTWARE LICENSE AND LIMITED WARRANTY FOR THE ACCOMPANYING PRODUCT ARE SET FORTH IN THE INFORMATION PACKET THAT SHIPPED WITH THE PRODUCT AND ARE INCORPORATED HEREIN BY THIS REFERENCE. IF YOU ARE UNABLE TO LOCATE THE SOFTWARE LICENSE OR LIMITED WARRANTY, CONTACT YOUR CISCO REPRESENTATIVE FOR A COPY. The Cisco implementation of TCP header compression is an adaptation of a program developed by the University of California, Berkeley (UCB) as part of UCB's public domain version of the UNIX operating system. All rights reserved. Copyright © 1981, Regents of the University of California. NOTWITHSTANDING ANY OTHER WARRANTY HEREIN, ALL DOCUMENT FILES AND SOFTWARE OF THESE SUPPLIERS ARE PROVIDED “AS IS" WITH ALL FAULTS. CISCO AND THE ABOVE-NAMED SUPPLIERS DISCLAIM ALL WARRANTIES, EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, THOSE OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT OR ARISING FROM A COURSE OF DEALING, USAGE, OR TRADE PRACTICE. IN NO EVENT SHALL CISCO OR ITS SUPPLIERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY INDIRECT, SPECIAL, CONSEQUENTIAL, OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES, INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, LOST PROFITS OR LOSS OR DAMAGE TO DATA ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THIS MANUAL, EVEN IF CISCO OR ITS SUPPLIERS HAVE BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. Cisco and the Cisco logo are trademarks or registered trademarks of Cisco and/or its affiliates in the U.S. and other countries. To view a list of Cisco trademarks, go to this URL: http:// www.cisco.com/go/trademarks. Third-party trademarks mentioned are the property of their respective owners. The use of the word partner does not imply a partnership relationship between Cisco and any other company. (1110R) Any Internet Protocol (IP) addresses used in this document are not intended to be actual addresses. Any examples, command display output, and figures included in the document are shown for illustrative purposes only. Any use of actual IP addresses in illustrative content is unintentional and coincidental. © 2012 Cisco Systems, Inc. All rights reserved.C O N T E N T S P r e f a c e Preface xiii Changes to This Document xiii Obtaining Documentation and Submitting a Service Request xiv C H A P T E R 1 Configuring Profiles on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router 1 Restrictions of Scale Profiles 1 Information About Profiles 2 Information About Scale Profiles 2 Information About Feature Profiles 2 Relationship Between Scale and Feature Profiles 2 How to Configure Profiles 3 Configuring the Scale Profile 3 Configuring the Feature Profile 5 Additional References 7 C H A P T E R 2 Secure Domain Routers on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router 9 Prerequisites for Working with Secure Domain Routers 9 Information About Configuring Secure Domain Routers 10 What Is a Secure Domain Router? 10 Owner SDR and Administration Configuration Mode 10 SDR Access Privileges 10 Root-System Users 11 root-lr Users 11 Other SDR Users 12 Designated Shelf Controller (DSC) 12 Default Configuration of the Router 12 Cisco IOS XR Software Package Management 12 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 iiiAdditional References 13 C H A P T E R 3 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router 15 Overview of Cisco IOS XR Software Packages 16 Package Installation Envelopes 16 Summary of Cisco IOS XR Software Packages 16 Packages in the Cisco IOS XR Unicast Routing Core Bundle 17 Software Maintenance Upgrades 17 Filename Component Description 17 PIE Filenames and Version Numbers 19 Copying the PIE File to a Local Storage Device or Network Server 20 Information About Package Management 20 Summary of Package Management 20 Adding Packages 21 Activating Packages 21 Activating Multiple Packages or SMUs 22 Activating All Packages Added in a Specific Operation 22 Adding and Activating a Package with a Single Command 22 Upgrading and Downgrading Packages 22 Committing the Active Software Set 22 Rolling Back to a Previous Installation Operation 22 Upgrading Packages 23 Downgrading Packages 23 Impact of Package Version Changes 24 Impact of Package Activation and Deactivation 24 Delaying the Return of the CLI Prompt 25 Displaying Installation Log Information 25 Examples 25 Package Management Procedures 27 Activation and Deactivation Prerequisites 27 Obtaining and Placing Cisco IOS XR Software 28 Transferring Installation Files from a Network File Server to a Local Storage Device 29 Preparing for Software Installation Operations 31 Examples 34 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x iv OL-26081-03 ContentsAdding and Activating Packages 41 Examples 47 Committing the Active Package Set 49 Examples 50 Upgrading to Cisco IOS XR Software Release 4.0 51 Deactivating and Removing Cisco IOS XR Software Packages 57 Examples 61 Rolling Back to a Previous Software Set 62 Displaying Rollback Points 62 Displaying the Active Packages Associated with a Rollback Point 63 Rolling Back to a Specific Rollback Point 63 Rolling Back to the Last Committed Package Set 64 Additional References 64 C H A P T E R 4 Configuring Disk Mirroring on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router 67 Disk Mirroring Prerequisites 67 Information About Disk Mirroring 68 How to Enable Disk Mirroring 69 Enabling Disk Mirroring 69 Replacing the Secondary Mirroring Device 71 Replacing the Primary Mirroring Device 72 Configuration Examples for Enabling Disk Mirroring 76 Additional References 77 C H A P T E R 5 Software Entitlement on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router 79 Prerequisites for Configuring Software Entitlement 80 Restrictions for Cisco IOS XR Software Entitlement 80 Information About Cisco IOS XR Software Entitlement 80 What Is Software Entitlement? 80 Types of Licenses 81 Router License Pools 81 Chassis-Locked Licenses 81 Slot-Based Licenses 81 Features that Require Licenses After a Software Image Upgrade 82 How to Configure Cisco IOS XR Software Entitlement 83 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 v ContentsAdding a License for a New Feature 83 Backing Up Licenses 85 Examples 86 Restoring Licenses 87 Examples 88 Troubleshooting License Issues after a Software Upgrade 88 Additional References 88 C H A P T E R 6 Managing the Router Hardware 91 Prerequisites for Managing Router Hardware 92 Displaying Hardware Status 92 Displaying SDR Hardware Version Information 92 Displaying System Hardware Version Information 95 Displaying Software and Hardware Information 98 Displaying SDR Node IDs and Status 99 Displaying Router Node IDs and Status 100 Displaying Router Environment Information 101 Displaying RP Redundancy Status 104 Displaying Field-Programmable Device Compatibility 105 RSP Redundancy and Switchover 107 Establishing RSP Redundancy 107 Determining the Active RP in a Redundant Pair 108 Role of the Standby RSP 109 Summary of Redundancy Commands 109 Automatic Switchover 110 RSP Redundancy During RSP Reload 110 Manual Switchover 110 Communicating with a Standby RP 111 Reloading, Shutting Down, or Power Cycling a Node 111 Reloading the Active RSP 113 Flash Disk Recovery 115 Using Controller Commands to Manage Hardware Components 115 Formatting Hard Drives, Flash Drives, and Other Storage Devices 115 Removing and Replacing Cards 116 Removing Line Cards 117 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x vi OL-26081-03 ContentsReplacing a Line Card with the Same Media Type and Port Count 118 Replacing a Line Card with the Same Media Type and a Different Port Count 118 Replacing a Line Card or PLIM with a Different Media Type 118 Upgrading the CPU Controller Bits 119 Examples 119 Additional References 119 C H A P T E R 7 Upgrading FPD on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router 123 Prerequisites for FPD Image Upgrades 124 Overview of FPD Image Upgrade Support 124 Automatic FPD Upgrade 124 How to Upgrade FPD Images 125 Configuration Examples for FPD Image Upgrade 128 show hw-module fpd Command Output: Example 128 show fpd package Command Output: Example 130 upgrade hw-module fpd Command Output: Example 139 show platform Command Output: Example 140 Troubleshooting Problems with FPD Image Upgrades 140 Power Failure or Removal of a SPA During an FPD Image Upgrade 140 Performing a SPA FPD Recovery Upgrade 141 Performing a SIP FPD Recovery Upgrade 141 Additional References 141 C H A P T E R 8 Configuring Manageability on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router 145 Information About XML Manageability 146 How to Configure Manageability 146 Configuring the XML Agent 146 Configuration Examples for Manageability 147 Enabling VRF on an XML Agent: Examples 147 Additional References 148 C H A P T E R 9 Configuring Call Home on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router 151 About Call Home 151 Destination Profiles 152 Call Home Alert Groups 152 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 vii ContentsCall Home Message Levels 153 Obtaining Smart Call Home 154 Configuring Call Home 155 Configuring Contact Information 155 Configuring and Activating Destination Profiles 158 Associating an Alert Group with a Destination Profile 160 Configuring Email 163 Enabling Call Home 165 C H A P T E R 1 0 Implementing NTP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router 169 Prerequisites for Implementing NTP on Cisco IOS XR Software 170 Information About Implementing NTP 170 How to Implement NTP on Cisco IOS XR Software 171 Configuring Poll-Based Associations 171 Configuring Broadcast-Based NTP Associates 173 Configuring NTP Access Groups 176 Configuring NTP Authentication 177 Disabling NTP Services on a Specific Interface 179 Configuring the Source IP Address for NTP Packets 181 Configuring the System as an Authoritative NTP Server 182 Updating the Hardware Clock 184 Verifying the Status of the External Reference Clock 185 Examples 186 Configuration Examples for Implementing NTP 186 Additional References 189 C H A P T E R 1 1 Implementing Object Tracking on Cisco IOS XR Software 191 Prerequisites for Implementing Object Tracking 191 Information About Object Tracking 192 How to Implement Object Tracking 192 Tracking Whether an Interface Is Up or Down 192 Tracking the Line Protocol State of an Interface 193 Tracking IP Route Reachability 196 Building a Track Based on a List of Objects 198 Building a Track Based on a List of Objects - Threshold Percentage 201 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x viii OL-26081-03 ContentsBuilding a Track Based on a List of Objects - Threshold Weight 202 Configuration Examples for Configuring Object Tracking 204 Additional References 206 C H A P T E R 1 2 Implementing Physical and Virtual Terminals on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router 209 Prerequisites for Implementing Physical and Virtual Terminals 210 Information About Implementing Physical and Virtual Terminals 210 Line Templates 210 Line Template Configuration Mode 210 Line Template Guidelines 211 Terminal Identification 212 vty Pools 212 How to Implement Physical and Virtual Terminals on Cisco IOS XR Software 212 Modifying Templates 212 Creating and Modifying vty Pools 214 Monitoring Terminals and Terminal Sessions 216 Configuration Examples for Implementing Physical and Virtual Terminals 217 Additional References 219 C H A P T E R 1 3 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router 223 Prerequisites for Implementing SNMP 224 Restrictions for SNMP Use on Cisco IOS XR Software 224 Information About Implementing SNMP 224 SNMP Functional Overview 224 SNMP Manager 224 SNMP Agent 224 MIB 225 SNMP Notifications 225 SNMP Versions 226 Comparison of SNMPv1, v2c, and v3 227 Security Models and Levels for SNMPv1, v2, v3 228 SNMPv3 Benefits 229 SNMPv3 Costs 230 User-Based Security Model 230 View-Based Access Control Model 230 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 ix ContentsMIB Views 231 Access Policy 231 IP Precedence and DSCP Support for SNMP 231 How to Implement SNMP on Cisco IOS XR Software 231 Configuring SNMPv3 231 Configuring SNMP Trap Notifications 234 Setting the Contact, Location, and Serial Number of the SNMP Agent 237 Defining the Maximum SNMP Agent Packet Size 238 Changing Notification Operation Values 240 Setting IP Precedence and DSCP Values 241 Configuring MIB Data to be Persistent 243 Configuring LinkUp and LinkDown Traps for a Subset of Interfaces 244 Configuration Examples for Implementing SNMP 247 Configuring SNMPv3: Examples 247 Configuring Trap Notifications: Example 250 Setting an IP Precedence Value for SNMP Traffic: Example 251 Setting an IP DSCP Value for SNMP Traffic: Example 251 Additional References 251 C H A P T E R 1 4 Configuring Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router 255 Prerequisites for Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer 255 Information About Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer 256 SNMP Objects and Instances 256 Bulk Statistics Object Lists 256 Bulk Statistics Schemas 256 Bulk Statistics Transfer Options 256 Benefits of Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer 257 How to Configure Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer 257 Configuring a Bulk Statistics Object List 257 Configuring a Bulk Statistics Schema 258 Configuring Bulk Statistics Transfer Options 261 Monitoring Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer 264 Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer: Example 265 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x x OL-26081-03 ContentsC H A P T E R 1 5 Implementing CDP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router 267 Prerequisites for Implementing CDP 267 Information About Implementing CDP 268 How to Implement CDP on Cisco IOS XR Software 269 Enabling CDP 269 Modifying CDP Default Settings 270 Monitoring CDP 272 Examples 273 Configuration Examples for Implementing CDP 275 Additional References 275 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 xi Contents Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x xii OL-26081-03 ContentsPreface This book presents configuration information and examples for System Management of the Cisco IOS XR software. The preface for Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide consists of the following sections: • Changes to This Document, page xiii • Obtaining Documentation and Submitting a Service Request, page xiv Changes to This Document This table lists the technical changes made to this document since it was first printed. Table 1: Changes to This Document Revision Date Change Summary Configuring Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer module was added. OL-26081-03 August 2012 The Object Tracking module was added. Information regarding image filenames was added to the topic: Filename Component Description, on page 17. OL-26081-02 May 2012 OL-26081-01 December 2011 Initial release of this document. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 xiiiObtaining Documentation and Submitting a Service Request For information on obtaining documentation,submitting a service request, and gathering additional information, see the monthly What's New in Cisco Product Documentation, which also lists all new and revised Cisco technical documentation, at: http://www.cisco.com/en/US/docs/general/whatsnew/whatsnew.html Subscribe to the What's New in Cisco Product Documentation as a Really Simple Syndication (RSS) feed and set content to be delivered directly to your desktop using a reader application. The RSS feeds are a free service and Cisco currently supports RSS version 2.0. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x xiv OL-26081-03 Preface Obtaining Documentation and Submitting a Service RequestC H A P T E R 1 Configuring Profiles on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Your router caters to different market segments on the service provider edge space. Your router is capable of supporting a wide range of market segments and features, but to make the software more efficient, you must configure the appropriate profiles to achieve the results you require. • Different customers have different network architectures, and this puts different scale demands on the router. By configuring the scale profile, you can configure your router to accommodate your needs. • The software supports a wide range of features. To optimize performance, each feature profile enables a subset of the total available features for a release. You must configure the appropriate profile to enable the features that you require. Table 2: Feature History for Configuring Profiles Release Modification Release 3.9.1 The scale profile was introduced The scale profile configuration was moved to admin mode. The feature profile was introduced. Release 4.0.1 This model contains the following topics: • Restrictions of Scale Profiles, page 1 • Information About Profiles, page 2 • How to Configure Profiles, page 3 • Additional References, page 7 Restrictions of Scale Profiles Video monitoring is not supported with the L3XL scale profile. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 1Information About Profiles Information About Scale Profiles A scale profile is a user-configurable setting that tunes the router to perform more efficiently depending on how the router is being used. You should configure a scale profile before deploying the router to production use. Your router can be used for different market segments on the service provider edge space. Because different customers have different network architectures, which can place different scale demands on the router, it is important to configure the scale profile so that your router works as efficiently as possible within the architecture that you are using. Possible scenarios that are taken into account by the scale profile are: • Use of the router as a Layer 2 transport device, thus requiring the support of high Layer 2 scale numbers. • Use of the router primarily as a Layer 3 box that provides Layer 3 virtual private network (VPN)services, thus requiring the support of a high number of Layer 3 routes. Information About Feature Profiles To allow sufficient computation capabilities within the router, the available features within the Cisco IOS XR software image are bundled. A feature profile determines which bundle of features is available for you to use. Although you can always configure a feature, if the feature is not supported by the active feature profile, you cannot use it. There are two feature profiles available on your router: • The default profile that supports all Cisco IOS XR software features except for IEEE 802.1ah provider backbone bridge (PBB). • The L2 profile that supports all Cisco IOS XR software features including IEEE 802.1ah PBB, but does not support IPv6, reverse-path forwarding (RPF) or netflow. If the feature profile that you have configured on your router does notsupport a feature that you have configured, warning messages are displayed on the console, and the feature does not work. A configured feature profile takes affect only after you reload all the line cards on the router. Relationship Between Scale and Feature Profiles Although you are not limited in your selection of scale and feature profiles in relation to each other, we recommend using one of the following pairs: • Default scale profile with default feature profile. • Default scale profile with Layer 2 feature profile. • Layer 3 scale profile with default feature profile. Other pairs are not recommended. Note that the Layer 3 XL scale profile does not support video monitoring. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 2 OL-26081-03 Configuring Profiles on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Information About ProfilesHow to Configure Profiles Configuring the Scale Profile Before you deploy your router, you should configure the scale profile to make the system most efficient for your specific network architecture. Before You Begin In general, the route switch processor (RSP) with 4 GB of memory is capable of loading 1.3 million IPv4 routes. However, consider using an 8 GB RSP if the router needs to hold a large number of routes. SUMMARY STEPS 1. admin 2. configure 3. hw-module profile scale{default | l3 | l3xl} 4. Use one of these commands: • end • commit 5. reload location {all | node-id} 6. show running-config 7. show hw-module profile DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose admin Enters administration EXEC mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# admin Step 1 configure Enters administration configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# configure Step 2 Step 3 hw-module profile scale{default | l3 | l3xl} Specifies the scale profile for the router. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin-config)# hw-module profile • default —efficient for deployments that require large Layer 2 MAC tables(up to 512,000 entries) and a relatively small number of Layer 3 routes (less than 512,000). scale l3xl Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 3 Configuring Profiles on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router How to Configure ProfilesCommand or Action Purpose • l3 —efficient for deployments that require more Layer 3 routes (up to 1 million) and smaller Layer 2 MAC tables (less than 128,000 entries). Sun Nov 14 10:04:27.109 PST In order to activate this new memory resource profile, you must manually reboot the system. • l3xl —efficient for deployments that require a very large number of Layer 3 routes (up to 1.3 million) and minimal Layer 2 functionality. Note that the support for up to 1.3 million routes is split into IPv4 scaled support and IPv4/IPV6 scaled support. You can configure up to 1.3 million IPv4 routes, or up to 1 million IPv4 routes with 128,000 IPv6 routes. Step 4 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin-config)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns or the router to EXEC mode. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin-config)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Reloads the entire router or all line cards in the chassis. If you are changing the scale profile to, or from, the l3xl value, you must perform a reload of reload location {all | node-id} Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# reload location 0/0/cpu0 Step 5 the entire system before the change is enabled. Use the reload location all command. For all other changesto the scale profile, you must reload all line cards in the router. Use the reload location node-id command for each line card separately. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# reload location all show running-config Displays the configured scale profile. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show running-config hw-module profile scale Step 6 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 4 OL-26081-03 Configuring Profiles on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring the Scale ProfileCommand or Action Purpose Displays the active scale profile. If the scale profile is different than the configured profile, the line cards have not been reloaded as required for the scale profile configuration to take place. show hw-module profile Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show hw-module profile scale Step 7 Configuring the Feature Profile Before deploying your router you should determine that the feature profile is consistent with the features that you need to use. If it is not, use this task to configure a different profile. SUMMARY STEPS 1. admin 2. configure 3. hw-module profile feature{default | l2} 4. Use one of these commands: • end • commit 5. reload location {all | node-id} 6. show running-config 7. show hw-module profile feature DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose admin Enters administration EXEC mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# admin Step 1 configure Enters administration configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# configure Step 2 Step 3 hw-module profile feature{default | l2} Specifies the feature profile for the router. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 5 Configuring Profiles on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring the Feature ProfileCommand or Action Purpose Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin-config)# hw-module profile • default—supports all features except provider backbone bridge (PBB). • l2—supports PBB, but does not support IPv6, reverse-path feature l2 forwarding (RPF) and netflow. Wed Dec 8 08:29:54.053 PST L2 feature profile does NOT support the following features: IPv6, RPF, Netflow. In order to activate this new memory resource profile, you must manually reboot the line cards. Step 4 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin-config)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin-config)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Reloads a line card. Before the feature profile configuration becomes effective, you must reload all line cards in the router. Use the reload location node-id command for each line card separately. reload location {all | node-id} Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# reload location 0/0/cpu0 Step 5 show running-config Displays the configured feature profile. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show running-config hw-module profile feature Step 6 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 6 OL-26081-03 Configuring Profiles on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring the Feature ProfileCommand or Action Purpose Displays the active feature profile. If the active profile is different from the configured profile, the line cards have not been reloaded as required for the feature profile configuration to take place. show hw-module profile feature Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show hw-module profile feature all Step 7 What to Do Next If you see warning messages to the console indicating that the active feature profile does not match the configured profile, you must reload the affected line card so that the configured profile matches the active profile. LC/0/1/CPU0:Nov 5 02:50:42.732 : prm_server[236]: Configured 'hw-module profile feature l2' does not match active 'hw-module profile feature default'. You must reload this line card in order to activate the configured profile on this card or you must change the configured profile. If you see warning messages to the console indicating that some features do not match the feature profile, you should either change the feature profile configuration, or remove the non-supported features. LC/0/1/CPU0:Nov 5 02:50:42.732 : prm_server[236]: Active 'hw-module profile feature l2' does not support IPv6, RPF, or Netflow features. Please remove all unsupported feature configurations. Additional References Related Documents Related Topic Document Title Hardware Redundancy and Node Administration on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Command Reference Profile commands Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Commands Master List Cisco IOS XR master command index Configuring AAA Services on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Security Configuration Guide Information about user groups and task IDs Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 7 Configuring Profiles on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional ReferencesStandards and RFCs Standard/RFC Title No new or modified standards are supported by this — feature, and support for existing standards has not been modified by this feature. MIBs MIB MIBs Link To locate and download MIBs using Cisco IOS XR software, use the Cisco MIB Locator found at the following URL and choose a platform under the Cisco Access Products menu: http://cisco.com/public/ sw-center/netmgmt/cmtk/mibs.shtml — Technical Assistance Description Link The Cisco Support website provides extensive online http://www.cisco.com/support resources, including documentation and tools for troubleshooting and resolving technical issues with Cisco products and technologies. To receive security and technical information about your products, you can subscribe to various services, such as the Product Alert Tool (accessed from Field Notices), the Cisco Technical Services Newsletter, and Really Simple Syndication (RSS) Feeds. Access to most tools on the Cisco Support website requires a Cisco.com user ID and password. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 8 OL-26081-03 Configuring Profiles on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional ReferencesC H A P T E R 2 Secure Domain Routers on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Secure domain routers (SDRs) are a means of dividing a single physical system into multiple logically separated routers. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routers are single-shelf routers that only support one SDR—the owner SDR. Table 3: Feature History for Secure Domain Routers on Cisco IOS XR Software Release Modification Release 3.7.2 This feature was introduced. This module contains the following topics: • Prerequisites for Working with Secure Domain Routers, page 9 • Information About Configuring Secure Domain Routers, page 10 • Additional References, page 13 Prerequisites for Working with Secure Domain Routers Initial Setup • The router must be running the Cisco IOS XR software . • The root-system username and password must be assigned as part of the initial configuration. • For more information on booting a router and performing initial configuration, see Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Getting Started Guide. Required Cards for Each SDR • Route switch processor (RSP) pair must be installed for the SDR. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 9Task ID Requirements • You must be in a user group associated with a task group that includesthe proper task IDs. The command reference guides include the task IDs required for each command. If you suspect user group assignment is preventing you from using a command, contact your AAA administrator for assistance. Maximum SDR Configurations • Only one owner SDR is supported. Non-owner SDRs are not supported Information About Configuring Secure Domain Routers What Is a Secure Domain Router? Cisco routers running Cisco IOS XR software can be partitioned into multiple, independent routers known assecure domain routers(SDRs). SDRs are a means of dividing a single physicalsystem into multiple logically separated routers. SDRs perform routing functions the same as a physical router, but they share resources with the rest of the system. For example, the software, configurations, protocols, and routing tables assigned to an SDR belong to that SDR only, but other functions, such as chassis-control and switch fabric, are shared with the rest of the system. Note Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routers are single-shelf routers that only support one SDR—the owner SDR. Owner SDR and Administration Configuration Mode The owner SDR is created at system startup and cannot be removed. This owner SDR performs system-wide functions, including the creation of additional non-owner SDRs. You cannot create the owner SDR because it always exists, nor can you completely remove the owner SDR because it is necessary to manage the router. By default, all nodes in the system belong to the owner SDR. The owner SDR also provides access to the administration EXEC and administration configuration modes. Only users with root-system privileges can access the administration modes by logging in to the primary route switch processor (RSP) for the owner SDR (called the designated shelf controller, or DSC). Administration modes are used to view and manage system-wide resources and logs. Related Topics SDR Access Privileges, on page 10 SDR Access Privileges Each SDR in a router has a separate AAA configuration that defines usernames, passwords, and associated privileges. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 10 OL-26081-03 Secure Domain Routers on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Information About Configuring Secure Domain Routers• Only users with root-system privileges can access the administration EXEC and administration configuration modes. • Users with other access privileges can access features according to their assigned privileges for a specific SDR. For more information about AAA policies, see the Configuring AAA Services on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Security Configuration Guide. Related Topics Root-System Users, on page 11 root-lr Users, on page 11 Other SDR Users, on page 12 Root-System Users Users with root-system privileges have access to system-wide features and resources. The root-system user is created during the initial boot and configuration of the router. The root-system user has the following privileges: • Access to administration EXEC and administration configuration commands. • Ability to create other users with similar or lower privileges. • Complete authority over the chassis. • Ability to install and activate software packages for the router. • Ability to view the following admin plane events (owner SDR logging system only): ? Software installation operations and events. ? System card boot operations, such as card booting notifications and errors, heartbeat-missed notifications, and card reloads. ? Card alphanumeric display changes. ? Environment monitoring events and alarms. ? Fabric control events. ? Upgrade progress information. root-lr Users Users with root-lr privileges can log in to an SDR only and perform configuration tasks that are specific to that SDR. The root-lr group has the following privileges: • Ability to configure interfaces and protocols. • Ability to create other users with similar or lower privileges on the SDR. • Ability to view the resources assigned to their particular SDR. The following restrictions apply to root-lr users: Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 11 Secure Domain Routers on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router SDR Access Privileges• Users with root-lr privileges cannot enter administration EXEC or configuration modes. • Users with root-lr privileges cannot add or remove nodes from an SDR. • Users with root-lr privileges cannot create root-system users. • The highest privilege a non-owner SDR user can have is root-lr. Other SDR Users Additional usernames and passwords can be created by the root-system or root-lr users to provide more restricted access to the configuration and management capabilities of the owner SDR. Designated Shelf Controller (DSC) In a router running Cisco IOS XR software, one RSP is assigned the role of DSC. The DSC provides system-wide administration and control capability, including access to the administration EXEC and administration configuration modes. For more information on DSCs, refer to Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Getting Started Guide. Default Configuration of the Router When a router is brought up, the nodes assigned to the router are activated with the default software package profile. In Cisco IOS XR software, the default software profile is defined by the last install operation. To view the default software profile, use the show install active summary command in administration EXEC mode. Any new nodes that are configured to the router boot with the default software profile listed in the output of this command. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show install active summary Tue Jul 21 06:10:48.321 DST Active Packages: disk0:comp-asr9k-mini-3.9.0.14I disk0:asr9k-adv-video-3.9.0.14I disk0:asr9k-fpd-3.9.0.14I disk0:asr9k-k9sec-3.9.0.14I disk0:asr9k-mgbl-3.9.0.14I disk0:asr9k-mcast-3.9.0.14I disk0:asr9k-mpls-3.9.0.14I For detailed instructions to add and activate software packages, see the Upgrading and Managing Cisco IOS XR Software module of the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide. See also the Software Package Management Commands on Cisco IOS XR Software module of the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Command Reference. Note Cisco IOS XR Software Package Management Software packages are added to the DSC of the system from administration EXEC mode. Once added, a package can be activated for the system. For detailed instructions regarding software package management, Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 12 OL-26081-03 Secure Domain Routers on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Designated Shelf Controller (DSC)see the Upgrading and Managing Cisco IOS XR Software module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide. See also the Software Package Management Commands on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Command Reference. • To access install commands, you must be a member of the root-system user group with access to the administration EXEC mode. • Most show install commands can be used in the EXEC mode of an SDR to view the details of the active packages for that SDR. Related Topics Default Configuration of the Router, on page 12 Additional References The following sections provide references related to SDR configuration. Related Documents Related Topic Document Title Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Getting Started Guide Initial system bootup and configuration information for a router using the Cisco IOS XR software Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Commands Master List Cisco IOS XR master command reference Configuring AAA Services on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Security Configuration Guide Information about user groups and task IDs Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Interface and Hardware Component Command Reference Cisco IOS XR interface configuration commands Configuring AAA Services on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Security Configuration Guide Information about AAA policies, including instructions to create and modify users and username access privileges Standards Standards Title No new or modified standards are supported by this — feature, and support for existing standards has not been modified by this feature. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 13 Secure Domain Routers on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional ReferencesMIBs MIBs MIBs Link To locate and download MIBs using Cisco IOS XR software, use the Cisco MIB Locator found at the following URL and choose a platform under the Cisco Access Products menu: http://cisco.com/public/ sw-center/netmgmt/cmtk/mibs.shtml — RFCs RFCs Title No new or modified RFCs are supported by this — feature, and support for existing RFCs has not been modified by this feature. Technical Assistance Description Link The Cisco Technical Support website contains http://www.cisco.com/techsupport thousands of pages of searchable technical content, including links to products, technologies, solutions, technical tips, and tools. Registered Cisco.com users can log in from this page to access even more content. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 14 OL-26081-03 Secure Domain Routers on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional ReferencesC H A P T E R 3 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router The Cisco IOS XR software is divided into software packages so that you can select which features run on your router. This module describes the concepts and tasks necessary to add feature packages, upgrade the active set of packages, roll back to a previously active set of packages, and perform other related package management tasks. For complete descriptions of the commands listed in this module, see Related Documents, on page 65. To locate documentation for other commands that might appear in the course of performing a configuration task, search online in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Commands Master List. Table 4: Feature History for Upgrading and Managing Cisco IOS XR Software Release Modification Release 3.7.2 The feature was introduced. A procedure to upgrade software from Cisco IOS XR Release 3.x was introduced. See Upgrading to Cisco IOS XR Software Release 4.0, on page 51. Support for installation commands was removed from EXEC mode. The ability to install software on a specific SDR was removed. Release 4.0.0 This module contains the following topics: • Overview of Cisco IOS XR Software Packages, page 16 • Information About Package Management, page 20 • Package Management Procedures, page 27 • Rolling Back to a Previous Software Set, page 62 • Additional References, page 64 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 15Overview of Cisco IOS XR Software Packages Cisco IOS XR software is divided into software packages so that you can select which features run on your router. Each package contains the components to perform a specific set of router functions, such as routing, security, or modular services card (MSC) support. Bundles are groups of packages that can be downloaded as a set. For example, Cisco IOS XR Unicast Routing Core Bundle (known as mini) providesthe main packages for use on every router. Adding a package to the router does not affect the operation of the router—it only copies the package files to a local storage device on the router, known as the boot device (such as the compact flash drive). To make the package functional on the router, you must activate it for one or more cards. To upgrade a package, you activate a newer version of the package. When the automatic compatibility checks have been passed, the new version is activated, and the old version is deactivated. Activating a software maintenance upgrade (SMU) does not cause any earlier SMUs or the package to which the SMU applies to be automatically deactivated. Note To downgrade a package, you activate an older version of the package. When the automatic compatibility checks have been passed, the older version is activated, and the newer version is deactivated. Note For more information on the features and components included in each package, refer to the release notes. Package Installation Envelopes Package Installation Envelopes (PIEs) are nonbootable files that contain a single package or a set of packages (called a composite package or bundle). Because the files are nonbootable, they are used to add software package files to a running router. PIE files have a pie extension. When a PIE file contains software for a specific bug fix, it is called a software maintenance upgrade (SMU). Files with the vm extension are bootable installation files used only to replace all current Cisco IOS XR software. These files are installed from ROM Monitor mode, which causes significant router downtime. Cisco Systems recommends installing or upgrading software packages only using PIE files as described in this document. For more information on vm files, see Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router ROM Monitor Guide. Note Summary of Cisco IOS XR Software Packages Every router includes a basic set of required packages contained in the Cisco IOS XR Unicast Routing Core Bundle. Additional optional packages can be added and activated on the router to provide specific features. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 16 OL-26081-03 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Overview of Cisco IOS XR Software PackagesPackages in the Cisco IOS XR Unicast Routing Core Bundle The packages contained in the Cisco IOS XR Unicast Routing Core Bundle are as follows: • Operating system (OS) and minimum boot image (MBI)—Kernel, file system, memory management, and other slow changing core components. • Base—Interface manager, system database, checkpoint services, configuration management, other slow-changing components. • Infra—Resource management: rack, fabric, secure domain router (SDR). • Routing—RIB, BGP, ISIS, OSPF, EIGRP, RIP, RPL. • Forwarding—FIB, ARP, QoS, ACL, and other components. • LC— Line card drivers. The filename for this bundle is: asr9k-mini.pie-version. Refer to the release notes for additional information on the specific features provided by each package. Software Maintenance Upgrades An SMU is a PIE file that contains fixes for a specific defect. A composite SMU is a PIE file that contains SMUs for more than one package. SMUs are added and activated using the same procedures as other PIE files. SMUs are created to respond to immediate issues and do not include new features. Typically, SMUs do not have a large impact on router operations. SMU versions are synchronized to the package major, minor, and maintenance versions they upgrade. SMUs are not an alternative to maintenance releases. They provide quick resolution of immediate issues. All bugsfixed by SMUs are integrated into the maintenance releases. For information on available SMUs, contact Cisco Technical Support, as described in Obtaining Technical Assistance in the monthly What’s New in Cisco Product Documentation. Activating a software maintenance upgrade (SMU) does not cause any earlier SMUs, or the package to which the SMU applies, to be automatically deactivated. Note Filename Component Description The filename componentsfor all packages are described in Table 5: Composite- and Single-Package Filename Components, on page 17. Table 5: Composite- and Single-Package Filename Components Component Description Identifiesthe platform for which the software package is designed. • The platform designation is “asr9k.” platform Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 17 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Summary of Cisco IOS XR Software PackagesComponent Description Identifies a specific composite package. • The only composite PIE file at this time is named “mini” and includes all packages described in the Cisco IOS XR Unicast Routing Core Bundle. composite_name Identifies the type of package the file supports (package_type applies only to single-package PIEs). Package types include: • mcast—Multicast package • mgbl—Manageability package • mpls—MPLS package • k9sec—Security package • diags—Diagnostics package • fpd—Field-programmable device package • doc—Documentation package package_type Identifies the major release of this package. • A major release occurs when there is a major architectural change to the product (for example, a major new capability is introduced). • All packages operating on the router must be at the same major release level. • A major release is the least frequent release and may require a router reboot. major Identifies the minor release of this package. • A minor release contains one or more of the following: ? New features ? Bug fixes • The minor release version does not have to be identical for all software packages operating on the router, but the operating packages must be certified by Cisco as compatible with each other. • A minor release may require a router reboot. minor Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 18 OL-26081-03 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Summary of Cisco IOS XR Software PackagesComponent Description Identifies the maintenance release of this package. • A maintenance release contains a collection of bug fixes for a package. • The maintenance release version does not have to be identical for all software packages operating on the router, but the major and minor versions of the maintenance release must match those of the package being updated. • A maintenance release does not usually require a router reboot. maintenance SMUs only. Identifies a DDTS 1 number that describes the problem this SMU addresses. DDTS is the method used to track known bugs and the resolutions or workarounds for those issues. ddts In Cisco IOS XR Software Release 4.0, the software packages were reorganized into functionally well-defined and independently-releasable packages. These reorganized packages are identified by the -p in the filename. These packages are not compatible with packages released prior to Release 4.0. When upgrading to Release 4.0 or above, special upgrade instructions must be followed. p Identifies images that are compatible with both the Cisco CRS-1 and Cisco CRS-3 routers. Starting with Cisco IOS XR Release 4.2, -px releases replace the -p releases. px 1 distributed defect tracking system Related Topics Summary of Cisco IOS XR Software Bundles PIE Filenames and Version Numbers PIE filenames have two formats: one for composite-package PIEs (bundles) and one for single-package PIEs. A composite-package file is a PIE file that contains multiple packages. Note Hyphens in the filename are part of the filename. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 19 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router PIE Filenames and Version NumbersTable 6: PIE Filenames, on page 20 shows the filenames for available PIE types. Table 6: PIE Filenames Software Delivery Type Filename Example platform-composite_name.pie- asr9k-mini.pie-3.7.2 major.minor.maintenance Composite (Bundle) PIE Single package PIE platform-package_type.-p.pie-major.minor.maintenance asr9k-mpls.pie-3.7.2 Composite SMU platform-p.composite_name.ddts.pie Copying the PIE File to a Local Storage Device or Network Server To add an optional package or upgrade or downgrade a package, you must copy the appropriate PIE file to a local storage device or to a network file server to which the router has access. If you need to store PIE files on the router, we recommended storing PIE files on the harddisk. Flash disk0: serves as the boot device for packages that have been added or activated on the system. Flash disk1: is used as a backup for disk0:. Before copying PIE files to a local storage device, use the dir command to check to see if the required PIE files are already on the device. Tip Information About Package Management Summary of Package Management The general procedure for adding optional packages, upgrading a package or package set, or downgrading packages on the router is as follows: 1 Copy the package file or files to a local storage device or file server. 2 Add the package or packages on the router using the command install add . 3 Activate the package or packages on the router using the install activate command. 4 Commit the current set of packages using the install commit command. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 20 OL-26081-03 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Information About Package ManagementFigure 1: Process to Add, Activate, and Commit Cisco IOS XR Software Packages, on page 21 illustrates key steps in the package management process. Figure 1: Process to Add, Activate, and Commit Cisco IOS XR Software Packages Adding Packages Use the install add command to unpack the package software files from a PIE file and copy them to the boot device (usually disk0:) of your router. From administration EXEC mode, the package software files are added to the boot device of the DSC of the router, as well as all active and standby Route Processors (RPs) and fabric shelf controllers (SCs) installed on the router. The disk that holds the unpacked software files is also known as the boot device. By default, flash disk0: is used as the boot device. To use an alternate storage device, such as flash disk1:, see the Router Recovery with ROM Monitor module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router ROM Monitor Guide. Remember that all RSPs in a system must use the same boot device. If the boot device on the primary RSP is flash disk0:, then the standby RSP must also have a flash disk0:. Note Activating Packages Software packages remain inactive until activated with the install activate command. After a package has been added to the router , use the install activate command to activate the package or SMUs for all valid cards. Information within the package is used to verify compatibility with the target cards and with the other active software. Actual activation is performed only after the package compatibility and application programming interface (API) compatibility checks have been passed. Activating a Package on the Router To activate a package on your router, use the install activate command in administration EXEC mode. The install activate command also activatesthe package on all administration plane nodes and resources, including service processors (SPs), fabric SCs, fan controllers, alarm modules, and power modules. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 21 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Summary of Package ManagementActivating Multiple Packages or SMUs To install multiple packages or software maintenance upgrades (SMUs) with a single command, use the install activate command and either specify up to 16 packages by repeating device: package arguments or use wildcard syntax to specify multiple packages. Some SMUs may require a reload. If the operation requires a node reload, the user is prompted before the installation operation occurs. Activating All Packages Added in a Specific Operation To install all packages that were added in a specific install add operation, use the install activate command with the id add-id keyword and argument, specifying the operation ID of the install add operation. You can specify up to 16 operations in a single command. Adding and Activating a Package with a Single Command To add and activate a package with a single command, use the install add command with the activate keyword from administration EXEC mode. Upgrading and Downgrading Packages To upgrade a package, activate the newer version of the package; the older version is automatically deactivated. To downgrade a package, activate the older version of the package; the newer version is automatically deactivated. Actual activation is performed only after the compatibility checks have been passed. Activating a software maintenance upgrade (SMU) does not cause any earlier SMUs, or the package to which the SMU applies, to be automatically deactivated. Note Committing the Active Software Set When a package is activated on the router , it becomes part of the current running configuration. To make the package activation persistent across reloads, enter the install commit command in administration EXEC mode. On startup, the DSC of the SDR loads the committed software set. If the system is restarted before the active software set is saved with the install commit command, the previously committed software set is used. Note Rolling Back to a Previous Installation Operation Although the term commit sounds final, the Cisco IOS XR software provides the flexibility to roll back the selected package set to previously saved package sets. Each time a package is activated or deactivated, a rollback point is created that defines the package set that is active after the package activation or deactivation. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 22 OL-26081-03 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Summary of Package ManagementThe software also creates a rollback point for the last committed package set. If you find that you prefer a previous package set over the currently active package set, you can use the install rollback command to make a previously active package set active again. Related Topics Rolling Back to a Previous Software Set, on page 62 Upgrading Packages To upgrade a package that is currently active on your router, add and activate a newer version of the same package (see Figure 2: Example of a Maintenance Release Package Upgrade, on page 23). The older version of the software package is deactivated automatically. These actions are permitted only after the package compatibility checks and API version compatibility checks have been passed. Deactivated packages are not removed from the router. To remove inactive package files, use the install remove command. Upgrading or downgrading a software package can cause a process to restart or a new process to start. Use the test option to preview the impact of the package activation. Caution Figure 2: Example of a Maintenance Release Package Upgrade Related Topics Deactivating and Removing Cisco IOS XR Software Packages, on page 57 Downgrading Packages To downgrade a software package, activate an older version on one or more cards for which that package is already active. The newer version of the same software package is deactivated automatically. These actions are performed only after the package compatibility checks and API version compatibility checks have been passed. Deactivated packages are not removed from the router. To remove inactive package files, use the install remove command. See the Related Topics section for links to more information. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 23 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Upgrading PackagesRelated Topics Deactivating and Removing Cisco IOS XR Software Packages, on page 57 Impact of Package Version Changes Each package version change has a different impact on the operation of the router, depending on the type of package and whether the upgrade is for a major, minor, or maintenance release. The following resources can provide more information on the impact of a package version change: • See Related Topics for more information on the typical impact for major, minor, and maintenance releases. • Forspecific information about the impact of an upgrade, consult the release notesfor the package release, and test the impact of the package activation by adding the test option to the install activate command. • The Cisco IOS XR Software Selector tool also contains information on package version compatibility. Related Topics PIE Filenames and Version Numbers, on page 19 Obtaining and Placing Cisco IOS XR Software, on page 28 Impact of Package Activation and Deactivation Activation or deactivation of a package can have an immediate impact on the system. The system can be affected in the following ways: • When a new package is activated, any new CLI commands for the package are added to the router. The router need not be restarted or reloaded. • When a package is deactivated, the commands associated with the features being deactivated are removed from the router. The commands are no longer available to the user. • During a software package deactivation, upgrade, or downgrade, any incompatible configurations are removed from the running configuration of the router, and saved to a file. Messages for incompatible configurations are displayed. Incompatible configurations are those configurationsthat are notsupported by the new version of the software package. You must address any issues that result from the revised configuration and reapply the configuration, if necessary. Note • New processes may be started. • Running processes may be stopped or restarted. • All processes in the cards may be restarted. Restarting processes in the cards is equivalent to a soft reset. • The cards may reload. • No impact: no processes in the card may be affected. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 24 OL-26081-03 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Impact of Package Version ChangesWhen activating and deactivating packages, use the test option to test the effects of a command without impacting the running system. After the activation or deactivation process completes, enter the show install log command to display the process results. Tip Delaying the Return of the CLI Prompt By default, the CLI prompt is returned to the screen before the installation operation is complete, which allows you to enter other commandsthat are not installation commands. If additional installation requests are attempted before the first operation is complete, they are not run. To delay the return of the CLI prompt until an installation operation is complete, enter the install command with the synchronous keyword. For example: install add disk1:pie-file synchronous install activate disk0:package synchronous To determine if an install command is currently running, enter the show install request command. Displaying Installation Log Information The install log provides information on the history of the installation operations. Each time an installation operation is run, a number is assigned to that operation. • Use the show install log command to display information about both successful and failed installation operations. • The show install log command with no arguments displays a summary of all installation operations. Specify the request-id argument to display information specific to an operation. Use the detail or verbose keywords to display details for specific operation. • Use the detail or verbose keywords to display detailed information, including file changes, nodes that could be reloaded, impact to processes, and impact to Dynamic Link Libraries (DLLs). By default, the install log stores up to 50 entries. Use the clear install log-history command to reset the number of entries to any value from 0 to 255. Tip Examples Displaying install log Entries: Example The following example displays information for the install requests. Use the verbose keyword to display detailed information, including files changes, impact to processes, and impact to DLLs. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show install log verbose Install operation 1 started by user 'labuser' at 17:48:51 UTC Sat Jun 03 2009. install add /disk1:asr9k-diags-p.pie-PD34-06.06.07 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 25 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Delaying the Return of the CLI Prompt/disk1:asr9k-k9sec-p.pie-PD34-06.06.07 /disk1:asr9k-mcast-p.pie-PD34-06.06.07 /disk1:asr9k-mgbl-p.pie-PD34-06.06.07 /disk1:asr9k-mpls-p.pie-PD34-06.06.07 Install operation 1 completed successfully at 17:51:32 UTC Sat Jun 03 2009. Install logs: Install operation 1 'install add /disk1:asr9k-diags-p.pie-PD34-06.06.07 /disk1:asr9k-k9sec-p.pie-PD34-06.06.07 /disk1:asr9k-mcast-p.pie-PD34-06.06.07 /disk1:asr9k-mgbl-p.pie-PD34-06.06.07 /disk1:asr9k-mpls-p.pie-PD34-06.06.07' started by user 'labuser' at 17:48:51 UTC Sat Jun 03 2009. Info: The following packages are now available to be activated: Info: Info: disk0:asr9k-diags-3.7.2.1I Info: disk0:asr9k-k9sec-3.7.2.1I Info: disk0:asr9k-mcast-3.7.2.1I Info: disk0:asr9k-mgbl-3.7.2.1I Info: disk0:asr9k-mpls-3.7.2.1I Info: Install operation 1 completed successfully at 17:51:32 UTC Sat Jun 03 2009. Install operation 2 started by user 'labuser' at 18:06:32 UTC Sat Jun 03 2009. install activate disk0:asr9k-diags-3.7.2.1I disk0:asr94k-k9sec-3.7.2.1I disk0:asr9k-mcast-3.7.2.1I disk0:asr9k-mgbl-3.7.2.1I disk0:asr9k-mpls-3.7.2.1I Install operation 2 completed successfully at 18:07:48 UTC Sat Jun 03 2009. Summary: Install method: parallel Summary of changes on nodes 0/1/SP, 0/6/SP, 0/SM0/SP, 0/SM1/SP, 0/SM2/SP,0/SM3/SP: Activated: asr9k-diags-3.7.2.1I No processes affected Summary of changes on nodes 0/1/CPU0, 0/6/CPU0: Activated: asr9k-diags-3.7.2.1I asr9k-mcast-3.7.2.1I asr9k-mpls-3.7.2.1I 1 asr9k-mpls processes affected (0 updated, 1 added, 0 removed, 0 impacted) 2 asr9k-mcast processes affected (0 updated, 2 added, 0 removed, 0 impacted) Summary of changes on nodes 0/RP0/CPU0, 0/RP1/CPU0: Activated: asr9k-diags-3.7.2.1I asr9k-k9sec-3.7.2.1I asr9k-mcast-3.7.2.1I asr9k-mgbl-3.7.2.1I asr9k-mpls-3.7.2.1I 6 asr9k-mgbl processes affected (0 updated, 6 added, 0 removed, 0 impacted) 8 asr9k-mpls processes affected (0 updated, 8 added, 0 removed, 0 impacted) 7 asr9k-k9sec processes affected (0 updated, 7 added, 0 removed, 0 impacted) 14 asr9k-mcast processes affected (0 updated, 14 added, 0 removed, 0 impacted) Install logs: Install operation 2 'install activate disk0:asr9k-diags-3.7.2.1I disk0:asr9k-k9sec-3.7.2.1I disk0:asr9k-mcast-3.7.2.1I disk0:asr9k-mgbl-3.7.2.1I disk0:asr9k-mpls-3.7.2.1I' started by user 'labuser' at 18:06:32 UTC Sat Jun 03 2009. Info: The changes made to software configurations will not be Info: persistent across system reloads. Use the command 'admin install Info: commit' to make changes persistent. Info: Please verify that the system is consistent following the Info: software change using the following commands: Info: show system verify --More-- The following example displays information for a specific install request. Use the detail keyword to display additional information, including impact to processes and nodes impacted. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show install log 2 detail Install operation 2 started by user 'labuser' at 18:06:32 UTC Sat Jun 03 2009. install activate disk0:asr9k-diags-3.7.2.1I disk0:asr9k-k9sec-3.7.2.1I disk0:asr9k-mcast-3.7.2.1I disk0:asr9k-mgbl-3.7.2.1I disk0:asr9k-mpls-3.7.2.1I Install operation 2 completed successfully at 18:07:48 UTC Sat Jun 03 2006. Summary: Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 26 OL-26081-03 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Displaying Installation Log InformationInstall method: parallel Summary of changes on nodes 0/1/SP, 0/6/SP, 0/SM0/SP, 0/SM1/SP, 0/SM2/SP, 0/SM3/SP: Activated: asr9k-diags-3.7.2.1I No processes affected Summary of changes on nodes 0/1/CPU0, 0/6/CPU0: Activated: asr9k-diags-3.7.2.1I asr9k-mcast-3.7.2.1I asr9k-mpls-3.7.2.1I 1 asr9k-mpls processes affected (0 updated, 1 added, 0 removed, 0 impacted) 2 asr9k-mcast processes affected (0 updated, 2 added, 0 removed, 0 impacted) Summary of changes on nodes 0/RP0/CPU0, 0/RP1/CPU0: Activated: asr9k-diags-3.7.2.1I asr9k-k9sec-3.7.2.1I asr9k-mcast-3.7.2.1I asr9k-mgbl-3.7.2.1I asr9k-mpls-3.7.2.1I 6 asr9k-mgbl processes affected (0 updated, 6 added, 0 removed, 0 impacted) 8 asr9k-mpls processes affected (0 updated, 8 added, 0 removed, 0 impacted) 7 asr9k-k9sec processes affected (0 updated, 7 added, 0 removed, 0 impacted) 14 asr9k-mcast processes affected (0 updated, 14 added, 0 removed, 0 impacted) Install logs: Install operation 2 'install activate disk0:asr9k-diags-3.7.2.1I disk0:asr9k-k9sec-3.7.2.1I disk0:asr9k-mcast-3.7.2.1I disk0:asr9k-mgbl-3.7.2.1I disk0:asr9k-mpls-3.7.2.1I' started by user 'labuser' at 18:06:32 UTC Sat Jun 03 2006. Info: The changes made to software configurations will not be Info: persistent across system reloads. Use the command 'admin install Info: commit' to make changes persistent. Info: Please verify that the system is consistent following the Info: software change using the following commands: Info: show system verify Info: install verify packages Install operation 2 completed successfully at 18:07:48 UTC Sat Jun 03 2006. Package Management Procedures Note Review the concepts about package management before performing the tasks described in this module. Related Topics Information About Package Management, on page 20 Activation and Deactivation Prerequisites The following prerequisites must be met for a package to be activated or deactivated: • You must be in a user group associated with a task group that includesthe proper task IDs. The command reference guides include the task IDs required for each command. If you suspect user group assignment is preventing you from using a command, contact your AAA administrator for assistance. • Verify that all cards are installed and operating properly. For example, do not activate or deactivate packages while cards are booting, while cards are being upgraded or replaced, or when you anticipate an automatic switchover activity. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 27 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Package Management Procedures• If a ROM Monitor upgrade is required for the software package, the upgrade must be completed before the package is activated. For ROM Monitor upgrade information and procedures, see Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router ROM Monitor Guide. • Check the sanity of the configuration file system and recover from any internal inconsistencies by using the cfs check command. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# cfs check Tue Sep 20 07:22:03.374 DST Creating any missing directories in Configuration File system...OK Initializing Configuration Version Manager...OK Syncing commit database with running configuration...OK • Clear any inconsistency alarms and remove any failed configurations using the clear configuration inconsistency command. An inconsistency alarm is set when there is a failure to restore the configuration; this can occur during router startup, or when a line card or route switch processor (RSP) card is inserted or removed. If an inconsistency alarm is set, a message similar to the following example is displayed: RP/0/0/CPU0:May 26 11:58:40.662 : cfgmgr-rp[130]: %MGBL-CONFIGCLI-3 BATCH_CONFIG_FAIL : 28 config(s) failed during startup. To view failed config(s) use the command - "show configuration failed startup" When the inconsistency alarm is set, all configuration commit operations fail until the alarm is cleared. • Although more than one version of a software package can be added to a storage device, only one version of a package can be active for any card. • Some packages require the activation or deactivation of other packages. • The package being activated must be compatible with the current active software set. Activation is performed only after the package compatibility checks and API version compatibility checks have been passed. If a conflict is found, an on-screen error message is displayed. While a software package is being activated, other requests are not allowed to run on any of the impacted nodes. Package activation is completed when a message similar to the following appears: Install operation 2 completed successfully at 20:30:29 UTC Mon Nov 14 2005. Each CLI install request is assigned a request ID, which can be used later to review the events. Obtaining and Placing Cisco IOS XR Software This section contains information to locate the available software packages and to transfer them either to a local storage device or to a network server. When this is done, the package or packages can be added and activated on the router . There are two primary ways to obtain packages in Cisco IOS XR software: • Request the software from Cisco on a flash disk that you can insert into the removable flash disk slot (usually flash disk1:). Flash disk1: is optional. When it is installed, flash disk1: can be used to store PIE files, which can then be used to add new software to the boot device (usually flash disk0:). • Download the Cisco IOS XR software packages to a local storage device of the DSC, such as flash disk1:, or to a remote server, such as a tftp or rcp server. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 28 OL-26081-03 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Obtaining and Placing Cisco IOS XR SoftwareThe boot device is the local disk on the DSC where Cisco IOS XR software is added and activated. PIE files should not be stored on this boot device. The default boot device is disk0:. All PIE files should be stored on flash disk1:. Transferring Installation Files from a Network File Server to a Local Storage Device If the Cisco IOS XR software PIE files are located on a remote TFTP, FTP, SFTP, or rcp server, you can copy the files to a local storage device such as disk1:. When the PIE files are located on a local storage device, the software packages can be added and activated on the router from that storage device. Table 7: Download Protocols Supported by Cisco IOS XR Software, on page 29 describes the supported server protocols, and the CLI syntax used copy files from each server type to the local storage device. Cisco IOS XR software PIE files can also be added to the router boot device directly from the remote server. Tip Note Consult your system administrator for the location and availability of your network server. Table 7: Download Protocols Supported by Cisco IOS XR Software Name Description TFTP allowsfilesto be transferred from one computer to another over a network, usually without the use of client authentication (for example, username and password). It is a simplified version of FTP. Some Cisco IOS XR software images may be larger than 32 MB, and the TFTP services provided by some vendors may not support a file this large. If you do not have access to a TFTP server that supports files larger than 32 MB, download the software image using FTP or rcp. Note Trivial File Transfer Protocol FTP is part of the TCP/IP protocol stack and requires a username and password. File Transfer Protocol The rcp protocol uses TCP to ensure the reliable delivery of data, and rcp downloads require a usernames. Remote Copy Protocol SFTP is part of the SSHv2 feature in the Security package and provides for secure file transfers. For more information, see the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Security Configuration Guide. SSH File Transfer Protocol Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 29 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Obtaining and Placing Cisco IOS XR SoftwareThe router commands listed in Table 8: Commands for Copying Package Files to the Router, on page 30 show how to copy package files to the router using three types of file transfer protocols. Table 8: Commands for Copying Package Files to the Router Server Type Command and Examples The following command syntax is used: copy tftp:// hostname_or_ipaddress/ directory-path / pie-name disk1: Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# copy tftp://10.1.1.1/images/compasr9k-mini.pie disk1: TFTP The following command syntax is used: copy ftp:// username : password @ hostname_or_ipaddress / directory-path / pie-name disk1: Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# copy ftp://john:secret@10.1.1.1/images/ comp-asr9k-mini.pie disk1: FTP The following command syntax is used: copy rcp:// username @ hostname_or_ipaddress / directory-path / pie-name disk1: Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# copy rcp://john@10.1.1.1/images/ comp-asr9k-mini.pie disk1: rcp Table 9: Command Variablesfor Copying and Adding Packagesfrom a Network Server, on page 30 describes the command variables for copying packages from a network server. Table 9: Command Variables for Copying and Adding Packages from a Network Server Variable Description Host name or IP address of the server that stores the source file. hostname_or_ipaddress Name of the PIE file (package). See the Overview of Cisco IOS XR Software Packages, on page 16 for descriptions of the available packages. pie-name Required for FTP and rcp only and must be a valid username on the FTP or rcp server. username Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 30 OL-26081-03 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Obtaining and Placing Cisco IOS XR SoftwareVariable Description Required for FTP only. If a password is not provided, the networking device accepts anonymous FTP. password The specified directory should be a directory under the home directory of the user. In the rcp and FTP examplesin Table 8: Commandsfor Copying Package Files to the Router, on page 30, the file being downloaded is in a subdirectory called “images” in the home directory of the user “john.” For FTP and rcp services, directory-path is the directory relative to the username home directory. If you want to specify an absolute path for the directory, you must add a "/" following the server address. Note directory-path When the installation files have been transferred to a network file server or the router, you are ready to activate or upgrade the software. Files with the vm extension are bootable installation files used only to replace all current Cisco IOS XR software. These files are installed from ROM monitor mode and cause significant router downtime. We recommend installing or upgrading software packages using PIE files only, as described in this chapter. See Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router ROM Monitor Guide for information on installing from vm files. Note Related Topics Adding and Activating Packages, on page 41 Overview of Cisco IOS XR Software Packages, on page 16 Preparing for Software Installation Operations This section includes instructions to prepare for software installation operations. Activation is performed only after the automatic package compatibility and API version compatibility checks have been passed. If a conflict is found, an on-screen error message is displayed. Note Before You Begin Before adding or activating Cisco IOS XR software: • Update the ROM Monitor software, if necessary. • Determine if a software change is required. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 31 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Preparing for Software Installation Operations• Verify that the new package is supported on your system. Some software packages require that other packages or package versions be activated, and some packages only support specific cards. • Review the release notes for important information related to that release and to help determine the package compatibility with your router configuration. • Verify that the system is stable and prepared for the software changes. SUMMARY STEPS 1. admin 2. show diag 3. Update the ROMMON software if necessary. 4. show install active 5. show install pie-info device:package [ brief | detail | verbose ] 6. verify packages 7. exit 8. (Optional) show system verify start 9. (Optional) show system verify [ detail | report ] 10. show clock DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose admin Enters administration EXEC mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# admin Step 1 Displays the ROMMON software version for all cards in the system. Verify that the correct ROMMON software version is installed before upgrading a Cisco IOS XR software package. show diag Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show diag Step 2 See Related Topics for information regarding the required ROM Monitor (ROMMON) software version. Note Updates the ROMMON software. For instructions, see Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router ROM Monitor Guide. Update the ROMMON software if necessary. Step 3 Displays the active software on the router for the owner SDR. Use this command to determine what software should be added, upgraded or downgraded on the show install active Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show install active Step 4 router, and to compare to the active software report after installation operations are complete. You can also display the active packages for a specific node, and view results in detailed or summary mode. See the Software Package Management Commands on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Command Reference for more information. Note Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 32 OL-26081-03 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Preparing for Software Installation OperationsCommand or Action Purpose Displays information imbedded in the package. The following keywords provide three levels of information: show install pie-info device:package [ brief | detail | verbose ] Step 5 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# • brief (default)—Displays the expiration date of the file, the size, and the installed package name. The expiration date is used for certifying the package. • detail—Displays the package components, the compatible cards, the expiration date, file size, and the installed package name. show install pie-info disk1:/asr9k-mcast-p.pie-3.8.30 • verbose—Displays information from the detail display and sub-component information. Always review the release notes for the software package for important information related to that release and to help determine the package compatibility with your router configuration. Note Verifies that there are no corrupted software files. The consistency of a previously installed software set is verified against the package file from which it originated. verify packages Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install verify packages Step 6 This command can be used as a debugging tool to verify the validity of the files that constitute the packages, to determine if there are any corrupted files. This command also checks for corruptions of installation state files and MBI image files. This command is particularly useful when issued after the activation of a package or upgrading the Cisco IOS XR software to a major release. The install verify packages command can take up to two minutes per package to process. Note exit Exits administration EXEC mode and returns to EXEC mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# exit Step 7 (Optional) Starts the system status check. show system verify start Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show system verify start Step 8 (Optional) Displayssystem statusinformation. A variety of information is displayed including the memory and CPU usage, process status, protocol status, and other status information. Use this information to verify that the system is stable. show system verify [ detail | report ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show system verify Step 9 • detail—Displays additional information at the card and processor level, including actual numbers. • report—Displays the same information as the default show system verify command Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 33 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Preparing for Software Installation OperationsCommand or Action Purpose Although most of the output should display the status “OK,” some processes may show other output, such as “Warning.” This does not specifically indicate a problem. Contact your Cisco technical support representative for more information on the output of this command. Note Verifiesthat the system clock is correct. Software operations use certificates based on router clock times. show clock Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show clock Step 10 Related Topics Activation and Deactivation Prerequisites, on page 27 Examples Verifying That the ROM Monitor Version Is Correct: Example In the following example, the ROM Monitor software version is displayed in the “ROMMON:” field for each card. For instructions to upgrade the ROM Monitor software, see Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router ROM Monitor Guide. Note RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# admin RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show diag Mon Jun 22 12:55:10.554 PST NODE module 0/RSP0/CPU0 : MAIN: board type 0x100302 S/N: FOC1230803H Top Assy. Number: 68-3160-04 PID: A2K-RSP-4G-HDD= UDI_VID: VP4 HwRev: V4.8 New Deviation Number: 0 CLEI: IPUCARJBAA Board State : IOS XR RUN PLD: Motherboard: N/A, Processor: 0x8004 (rev: 2.2), Power: N/A MONLIB: QNXFFS Monlib Version 3.2 ROMMON: Version 1.0(20081208:173612) [ASR9K ROMMON] Board FPGA/CPLD/ASIC Hardware Revision: Compact Flash : V1.0 XbarSwitch0 : V1.3 XbarSwitch1 : V1.3 XbarArbiter : V1.0 XbarInterface : V0.0 IntCtrl : V1.14 ClkCtrl : V1.13 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 34 OL-26081-03 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Preparing for Software Installation OperationsPuntFPGA : V1.5 HD : V3.0 USB0 : V77.20 USB1 : V77.20 CPUCtrl : V1.17 UTI : V1.6 LIU : V1.0 MLANSwitch : V0.0 EOBCSwitch : V2.0 CBC (active partition) : v1.2 CBC (inactive partition) : v1.1 NODE fantray 0/FT0/SP : MAIN: board type 0x900211 S/N: Top Assy. Number: 32-0000-00 PID: UDI_VID: HwRev: V32.0 New Deviation Number: 0 CLEI: PLD: Motherboard: N/A, Processor: N/A, Power: N/A ROMMON: Board FPGA/CPLD/ASIC Hardware Revision: CBC (active partition) : v4.0 CBC (inactive partition) : v0.13 NODE fantray 0/FT1/SP : MAIN: board type 0x900211 S/N: Top Assy. Number: 32-0000-00 PID: UDI_VID: HwRev: V32.0 New Deviation Number: 0 CLEI: PLD: Motherboard: N/A, Processor: N/A, Power: N/A ROMMON: Board FPGA/CPLD/ASIC Hardware Revision: CBC (active partition) : v4.0 CBC (inactive partition) : v0.13 NODE module 0/1/CPU0 : MAIN: board type 0x20207 S/N: FOC123081J6 Top Assy. Number: 68-3182-03 PID: A9K-40GE-B UDI_VID: V1D HwRev: V0.0 New Deviation Number: 0 CLEI: Board State : IOS XR RUN PLD: Motherboard: N/A, Processor: 0x8004 (rev: 2.2), Power: N/A ROMMON: Version 1.0(20081208:174521) [ASR9K ROMMON] Board FPGA/CPLD/ASIC Hardware Revision: NP0 : V3.194 NP1 : V3.194 NP2 : V3.194 NP3 : V3.194 XbarInterface : V18.4 Bridge0 : V0.38 Bridge1 : V0.38 CPUCtrl : V0.15 USB : V77.20 PortCtrl : V0.8 PHYCtrl : V0.6 40 Port Gigabit Ethernet Daughter board : V0.0 CBC (active partition) : v2.2 CBC (inactive partition) : v2.1 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 35 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Preparing for Software Installation OperationsNODE module 0/4/CPU0 : MAIN: board type 0x2020a S/N: FOC123081JA Top Assy. Number: 68-3183-02 PID: A9K-8T/4-B UDI_VID: V1D HwRev: V0.0 New Deviation Number: 0 CLEI: IPU3AE0CAA Board State : IOS XR RUN PLD: Motherboard: N/A, Processor: 0x8004 (rev: 2.2), Power: N/A ROMMON: Version 1.0(20081208:174521) [ASR9K ROMMON] Board FPGA/CPLD/ASIC Hardware Revision: NP0 : V3.194 NP1 : V3.194 NP2 : V3.194 NP3 : V3.194 XbarInterface : V18.4 Bridge0 : V0.38 Bridge1 : V0.38 CPUCtrl : V0.15 USB : V77.20 PortCtrl : V0.10 PHYCtrl : V0.7 PHY0 : V0.16 PHY1 : V0.16 PHY2 : V0.16 PHY3 : V0.16 PHY4 : V0.16 PHY5 : V0.16 PHY6 : V0.16 PHY7 : V0.16 8 Port Ten Gigabit Ethernet Daughter board : V0.0 CBC (active partition) : v2.2 CBC (inactive partition) : v2.1 NODE module 0/6/CPU0 : MAIN: board type 0x20208 S/N: FHH12250033 Top Assy. Number: 68-3184-02 PID: A9K-4T-B UDI_VID: V1D HwRev: V0.0 New Deviation Number: 0 CLEI: Board State : IOS XR RUN PLD: Motherboard: N/A, Processor: 0x8004 (rev: 2.2), Power: N/A ROMMON: Version 1.0(20081208:174521) [ASR9K ROMMON] Board FPGA/CPLD/ASIC Hardware Revision: NP0 : V3.194 NP1 : V3.194 NP2 : V3.194 NP3 : V3.194 XbarInterface : V18.4 Bridge0 : V0.38 Bridge1 : V0.38 CPUCtrl : V0.15 USB : V77.20 PHY0 : V0.16 PHY1 : V0.16 PHY2 : V0.16 PHY3 : V0.16 PortCtrl : V0.10 PHYCtrl : V0.7 4 Port Ten Gigabit Ethernet Daughter board : V0.0 CBC (active partition) : v2.2 CBC (inactive partition) : v2.1 NODE power-module 0/PM0/SP : MAIN: board type 0xf00188 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 36 OL-26081-03 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Preparing for Software Installation OperationsS/N: Top Assy. Number: 341-00032-01 PID: A9K-3KW-AC UDI_VID: V00 HwRev: V0.0 New Deviation Number: 0 CLEI: ACACACACAC PLD: Motherboard: N/A, Processor: N/A, Power: N/A ROMMON: Board FPGA/CPLD/ASIC Hardware Revision: NODE power-module 0/PM1/SP : MAIN: board type 0xf00188 S/N: Top Assy. Number: 341-00032-01 PID: A9K-3KW-AC UDI_VID: V00 HwRev: V0.0 New Deviation Number: 0 CLEI: ACACACACAC PLD: Motherboard: N/A, Processor: N/A, Power: N/A ROMMON: Board FPGA/CPLD/ASIC Hardware Revision: NODE power-module 0/PM2/SP : MAIN: board type 0xf00188 S/N: Top Assy. Number: 341-00032-01 PID: A9K-3KW-AC UDI_VID: V00 HwRev: V0.0 New Deviation Number: 0 CLEI: ACACACACAC PLD: Motherboard: N/A, Processor: N/A, Power: N/A ROMMON: Board FPGA/CPLD/ASIC Hardware Revision: Rack 0 - ASR-9010 Chassis, Includes Accessories RACK NUM: 0 S/N: PID: ASR-9010 Backplane VID: 0.1 Desc: ASR-9010 Chassis, Includes Accessories CLEI: NOCLEI Top Assy. Number: 68-1234-56 Displaying the Active Software for the Entire System: Example The following example displays the active packages for the entire system. Use this information to determine if a software change is required: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show install active summary Mon Jun 22 13:01:46.438 PST Default Profile: SDRs: Owner Active Packages: disk0:comp-asr9k-mini-3.9.0.12I disk0:asr9k-fpd-3.9.0.12I disk0:asr9k-k9sec-3.9.0.12I disk0:asr9k-mcast-3.9.0.12I disk0:asr9k-mgbl-3.9.0.12I disk0:asr9k-mpls-3.9.0.12I Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 37 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Preparing for Software Installation OperationsDisplaying Information About the Contents of a PIE File: Example In the following example, information is displayed about the manageability PIE. This command displays the expiry date of the package, the cards supported by the package, and other details. Use this information to verify the compatibility of the package with your system and other software packages. A software activation is performed only after the automatic package compatibility and API version compatibility checks have been passed. If a conflict is found, an on-screen error message is displayed. Note RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show install pie-info disk1:/ asr9k-mgbl-p.pie-3.8.0 detail Contents of pie file '/disk1:/asr9k-mgbl-p.pie-3.8.0': Expiry date : Jan 19, 2007 02:55:56 UTC Uncompressed size : 17892613 asr9k-mgbl-3.8.0 asr9k-mgbl V3.8.0[00] Manageability Package Vendor : Cisco Systems Desc : Manageability Package Build : Built on Wed May 10 08:04:58 UTC 2006 Source : By edde-bld1 in /vws/aga/production/3.8.0/asr9k/workspace for c28 Card(s): RP, DRP, DRPSC Restart information: Default: parallel impacted processes restart Components in package asr9k-mgbl-3.8.0, package asr9k-mgbl: manageability-cwi V[r33x/2] Craft Web Interface related binaries ae asr9k-feature-ipsla V[r33x/1] IPSLA time stamping feature doc-asr9k-mgbl V[r33x/2] Contains the man page documentation for asr9ks --More-- Verifying That There Are No Corrupted Software Files: Example The following sample output verifies the consistency of the currently active software against the file from which it originated: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install verify packages Mon Jun 22 13:19:08.590 PST Install operation 3 '(admin) install verify packages' started by user 'debbie' via CLI at 13:19:08 DST Mon Jun 22 2009. The install operation will continue asynchronously. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)#Info: This operation can take up to 2 minutes per package being verified. Info: Please be patient. Info: 0/6/CPU0 [LC] [SDR: Owner] Info: meta-data: [SUCCESS] Verification Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-scfclient-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Info: Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-os-mbi-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Info: Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-mpls-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-mcast-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Info: Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-lc-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-fwdg-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-fpd-3.9.0.12I: [ERROR] Detected anomalies. Info: /install/asr9k-diags-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Info: Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-base-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-admin-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Info: Successful. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 38 OL-26081-03 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Preparing for Software Installation OperationsInfo: 0/1/CPU0 [LC] [SDR: Owner] Info: meta-data: [SUCCESS] Verification Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-scfclient-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Info: Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-os-mbi-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Info: Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-mpls-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-mcast-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Info: Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-lc-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-fwdg-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-fpd-3.9.0.12I: [ERROR] Detected anomalies. Info: /install/asr9k-diags-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Info: Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-base-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-admin-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Info: Successful. Info: 0/4/CPU0 [LC] [SDR: Owner] Info: meta-data: [SUCCESS] Verification Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-scfclient-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Info: Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-os-mbi-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Info: Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-mpls-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-mcast-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Info: Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-lc-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-fwdg-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-fpd-3.9.0.12I: [ERROR] Detected anomalies. Info: /install/asr9k-diags-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Info: Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-base-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-admin-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Info: Successful. Info: 0/RSP0/CPU0 [RP] [SDR: Owner] Info: meta-data: [SUCCESS] Verification Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-fpd-3.9.0.12I: [ERROR] Detected anomalies. Info: /install/asr9k-mpls-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-mgbl-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-mcast-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Info: Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-k9sec-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Info: Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-os-mbi-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Info: Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-base-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-admin-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Info: Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-fwdg-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-lc-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-rout-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-diags-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Info: Successful. Info: /install/asr9k-scfclient-3.9.0.12I: [SUCCESS] Verification Info: Successful. Info: Verification Summary: Info: 0/6/CPU0: ERROR. Anomalies found. Info: 0/1/CPU0: ERROR. Anomalies found. Info: 0/4/CPU0: ERROR. Anomalies found. Info: 0/RSP0/CPU0: ERROR. Anomalies found. Info: Anomalies found on the primary RP. Info: No standby RP is present. Info: Please contact your technical services representative to repair Info: the system. Install operation 3 completed successfully at 13:21:29 DST Mon Jun 22 2009. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 39 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Preparing for Software Installation OperationsVerifying the Current System Status: Example The following example shows how to prepare for system verification: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show system verify start Storing initial router status ... done. The following example shows output from running the show system verify command. Although most of the output should display the status “OK,” some processes may show other output, such as “Warning.” This does not specifically indicate a problem. Contact your Cisco technical support representative for more information on the output of this command. Note RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show system verify Getting current router status ... System Verification Report ========================== - Verifying Memory Usage - Verified Memory Usage : [OK] - Verifying CPU Usage - Verified CPU Usage : [OK] - Verifying Blocked Processes - Verified Blocked Processes : [OK] - Verifying Aborted Processes - Verified Aborted Processes : [OK] - Verifying Crashed Processes - Verified Crashed Processes : [OK] - Verifying LC Status - Verified LC Status : [OK] - Verifying QNET Status Unable to get current LC status info - Verified QNET Status : [FAIL] - Verifying GSP Fabric Status - Verified GSP Fabric Status : [OK] - Verifying GSP Ethernet Status gsp WARNING messages for router Current set of gsp ping nodes does not match initial set of nodes - Verified GSP Ethernet Status : [WARNING] - Verifying POS interface Status - Verified POS interface Status : [OK] - Verifying TenGigE interface Status - Verified TenGigE interface Status : [OK] - Verifying TCP statistics - Verified TCP statistics : [OK] - Verifying UDP statistics tcp_udp_raw WARNING messages for router UDP Packets sent has not increased during this period. - Verified UDP statistics : [WARNING] - Verifying RAW statistics - Verified RAW statistics : [OK] - Verifying RIB Status - Verified RIB Status : [OK] - Verifying CEF Status - Verified CEF Status : [OK] - Verifying CEF Consistency Status - Verified CEF Consistency Status : [OK] - Verifying BGP Status Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 40 OL-26081-03 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Preparing for Software Installation Operations- Verified BGP Status : [OK] - Verifying ISIS Status - Verified ISIS Status : [OK] - Verifying OSPF Status - Verified OSPF Status : [OK] - Verifying Syslog Messages - Verified Syslog Messages : [OK] System may not be stable. Please look into WARNING messages. Verifying That the System Clock Is Correct: Example The following example displays the current system clock setting: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show clock 02:14:51.474 PST Wed Jan 28 2009 Adding and Activating Packages The procedure in this section describes how to upgrade or add Cisco IOS XR software PIE files that are stored on a local storage device, such as flash disk1:, or on a remote TFTP, FTP, SFTP, or rcp server. The PIE software file can include any of the following: • The Cisco IOS XR Unicast Routing Core Bundle (six packages in one composite PIE file) • Any of the optional packages (one package per PIE file) • Software maintenance upgrades (SMUs) When you need to add and activate two or more of the preceding package types, you should add and activate them in the order listed above. When adding and activating two or more packages, optional packages can be activated together. Also, if the operation is a reload, multiple packages can be activated together. For example, five reload SMUs can be activated together or the Cisco IOS XR Unicast Routing Core Bundle plus the SMUs and optional packages can be activated together. Note For a description of the software management process, see the Related Topics section. These instructions are also used to downgrade software packages. By default, installation operations are performed asynchronously: the CLI prompt is returned before the operation is complete, allowing the operator to continue work while the installation is completed in the background. Use the synchronous keyword at the end of install commands to delay the return of the CLI prompt until an installation operation is complete. See the Related Topicssection for more information. Note Before You Begin Before upgrading or adding packages from flash disk1:, verify that the following prerequisites have been met: Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 41 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Adding and Activating Packages• Verify that the ROMMON version is correct. For instructions on upgrading ROM Monitor, see Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router ROM Monitor Guide. • All packages to be upgraded or added are present on a local storage device (flash disk1:) or a network file server. • Prerequisites for the activation of packages are met as described in the Prerequisites section. • Complete the procedures described in the Preparing for Software Installation Operations, on page 31 section. To use the automatic FPD upgrade feature, the fpd auto-upgrade command must be enabled in administration configuration mode. Note SUMMARY STEPS 1. Connect to the console port and log in. 2. (Optional) dir device : 3. admin 4. Use one of the following commands: • install add [source source-path | tar] device file [activate] • install add [source source-path | tar] tftp:// hostname_or_ipaddress / directory-path / file [activate] • install add [source source-path | tar] ftp:// username : password @ hostname_or_ipaddress / directory-path / file [activate] • install add [ source source-path | tar] rcp:// username @ hostname_or_ipaddress / directory-path / file [activate] 5. (Optional) show install inactive summary 6. install activate {id add-id | device package} [test] [location node-id] [pause sw-change] [prompt-level {all | none}] [auto-abort-timer time 7. Repeat Step 4, on page 43 through Step 6, on page 44 until all packages are activated. 8. (Optional) show install active summary 9. (Optional) install verify packages 10. (Optional) exit 11. (Optional) show system verify start 12. admin 13. (Optional) install commit 14. Upgrade the field-programmable device (FPD) software, if necessary. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 42 OL-26081-03 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Adding and Activating PackagesDETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 Connect to the console port and log in. Establishes a CLI management session with the SDR. Connect to the console port for the active DSC. For more information on console connections, see Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Getting Started Guide. (Optional) Displays the package files that are available for package upgrades and additions. dir device : Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# dir disk1: Step 2 Only PIE files can be added and activated using this procedure. Note Step 3 admin Enters administration EXEC mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# admin Some show install commands can be entered in EXEC mode on an SDR. Note Unpacks a PIE file from localstorage device or network server and adds the package files to the boot device of the router. The boot device is located on the DSC. Step 4 Use one of the following commands: • install add [source source-path | tar] device file [activate] • If the tar keyword is used, all PIE files contained in the tar file are unpacked. • install add [source source-path | tar] tftp:// hostname_or_ipaddress/ directory-path / file [activate] • If the source keyword is used, the source-path specifies the directory path that is used for multiple filenames in the same directory. • install add [source source-path | tar] ftp:// username : password @ hostname_or_ipaddress / directory-path / file [activate] The following arguments are used when adding a package from a PIE file located on a network server: • install add [ source source-path | tar] rcp:// username @ hostname_or_ipaddress / directory-path / file [activate] • device:—Name of the localstorage device where the PIE file is stored, such as disk1:. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install add • file—Name of the PIE file you want to add. If the tar keyword is used, the file argument is the name of a tar file containing one or more PIE files or directories containing PIE files. disk1:asr9k-mgbl.pie-3.8.30.1i or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install add source • hostname_or_ipaddress—Host name or IP address of the network file server. tftp://10.1.1.1/images/ asr9k-k9sec-p.pie asr9k-mpls-p.pie asr9k-mcast-p.pie • directory-path—Network file server path that leads to or the PIE file to be added. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install add • username—Username that has access privileges to the directory in which the PIE file is stored. ftp://john:secret@10.1.1.1/images/asr9k-k9sec-p.pie Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 43 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Adding and Activating PackagesCommand or Action Purpose • password—Password associated with the username that has access privileges to the directory in which the PIE file is stored. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install add tar • activate—Automatically activates the software package after it is successfully added. rcp://john@10.1.1.1/images/asr9k-iosxr-3.6.0.tar Multiple versions of a software package can be added to the storage device without impacting the running configuration, but only one version of a package can be activated for a card. Note The automatic FPD upgrade occurs only when the FPD pie is added and activated together with the install PIE. Tip (Optional) Displays the inactive packages on the router. Verify that the package added in the previous step appears in the display. show install inactive summary Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show install inactive summary Step 5 Activates a package that was added to the router. Skip thisstep if the package was activated earlier with the install add command. install activate {id add-id | device package} [test] [location node-id] [pause sw-change] [prompt-level {all | none}] [auto-abort-timer time Step 6 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install activate disk0:asr9k-mgbl-3.8.30 • id add-id—Specifies the package using the operation ID of the install add operation in which you added the package. The operation ID is provided in the output of the install add command. You can also use show install log to display installation operation IDs. • device:package—Specifiesthe package by name. Replace the device:package argument with the name of the boot device and inactive package, which can be displayed as described in the previous step. Press ? after a partial package name to display all possible matches available for activation. If there is only one match, press [TAB] to fill in the rest of the package name. Note • location node-id—Activates a package for a specific card (node). To display a list of node IDs for the entire system, enter the show platform command in administration EXEC mode. A package cannot be activated on a single node unless some version of the package being activated is already active on all nodes. By default, packages are activated for all cards supported by that package. Note • pause sw-change—Pausesthe operation after preparatory checks and before the configuration is locked for the actual activation. This action enables you to hold the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 44 OL-26081-03 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Adding and Activating PackagesCommand or Action Purpose operation while you perform configuration changes, and proceed with the activation whenever you choose. This operation is useful, for example, if your workflow involves configuring a router out of the network during software installation and you want to minimize the time that the router is out of the network. Follow the onscreen instructions to control the pausing and completion of the operation. • prompt-level—Use a prompt-level of all to view all stages of the installation process and to specify whether to continue or not. • auto-abort-timer—Specifies an abort timer value, in minutes, which when expired loads the last committed loadpath. The default is 60 minutes.The timer is disabled by default.After the installation, if the activated software is working correctly, use the install commit command to cancel the timer and commit the new loadpath. The package being activated must be compatible with the currently active software to operate. When an activation is attempted, the system runs an automatic compatibility check to ensure that the package is compatible with the other active software on the router. The activation is permitted only after all compatibility checks have been passed. Note When activating packages, use the test option to test the effects of a command without impacting the running system. After the activation process finishes, enter the show install log command to display the process results. Tip The automatic FPD upgrade occurs only when the FPD pie is added and activated together with the install PIE. Tip Repeat Step 4, on page 43 through Step 6, on page 44 until Activates additional packages as required. all packages are activated. Step 7 (Optional) Displays all active packages. Use this display to determine if the correct packages are active: show install active summary Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show install active Step 8 (Optional) Verifies the consistency of a installed software set with the package file from which it originated. This command can be install verify packages Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install verify packages Step 9 used as a debugging tool to verify the validity of the files that constitute the packages, to determine if there are any corrupted files. This command also checksfor corruptions of installation state files and MBI image files. This command is particularly Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 45 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Adding and Activating PackagesCommand or Action Purpose useful when issued after the activation of a package or upgrading the Cisco IOS XR software to a major release. The install verify packages command can take up to two minutes per package to process. Note (Optional) Exits administration EXEC mode and returns to EXEC mode. exit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# exit Step 10 (Optional) Starts the system status check. show system verify start Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show system verify start Step 11 admin Enters administration EXEC mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# admin Step 12 (Optional) Commits the current set of packages on the router so that these packages are used if the router is restarted. install commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# dir disk1: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install commit Step 13 For more information, see the Related Topics section. Whenever a Cisco IOS XR software image is released that supports SPAs and SIPs, a companion SPA or SIP FPD image Upgrade the field-programmable device (FPD) software, if necessary. Step 14 is bundled with the Cisco IOS XR software release. Generally , the FPD image is not automatically upgraded. You must manually upgrade the FPD image running on the SPA or SIP when you upgrade the Cisco IOS XR software image. FPD versions must be compatible with the Cisco IOS XR software that is running on the router. If you have enabled the fpd auto-upgrade command and add and activate the FPD PIE together with the software installation PIE, the FPD image is automatically upgraded before the router is rebooted. Note For information on FPDs, including instructions to upgrade FPD images, see the Upgrading FPD Cisco IOS XR Software section. Related Topics Obtaining and Placing Cisco IOS XR Software, on page 28 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 46 OL-26081-03 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Adding and Activating PackagesActivation and Deactivation Prerequisites, on page 27 Preparing for Software Installation Operations, on page 31 Information About Package Management, on page 20 Downgrading Packages, on page 23 PIE Filenames and Version Numbers, on page 19 Committing the Active Package Set, on page 49 Examples Adding a Package: Example The following example shows how to add the contents of a PIE file on disk1: to the boot device. Because the software package is added to the boot device by default, it is not necessary to specify the destination device in the CLI. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install add disk1:asr9k-mpls-p.pie-3.7.2 synchronous Install operation 4 'install add /disk1:asr9k-mpls.pie synchronous' started by user 'cisco' at 18:10:18 UTC Sat Apr 08 2009. Info: The following package is now available to be activated: Info: Info: disk0:asr9k-mpls-3.7.2 Info: Install operation 4 completed successfully at 18:14:11 UTC Sat Apr 08 2009. The following example shows how to add the contents of a PIE file on a TFTP server to the boot device: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install add tftp://209.165.201.1/ asr9k-mpls.pie synchronous Install operation 4 '(admin) install add /tftp://209.165.201.1/asr9k-mpls.pie synchronous' started by user 'cisco' at 18:16:18 UTC Thu Jan 03 2009. Info: The following package is now available to be activated: Info: Info: disk0:asr9k-mpls-3.7.2 Info: Install operation 4 completed successfully at 18:19:10 UTC Thu Jan 03 2009. Activating a Package: Example The following example shows the activation of the MPLS package. The package is activated on the boot device disk0:. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install activate disk0: asr9k-mpls-3.7.2 synchronous Install operation 15 'install activate disk0:asr9k-mpls-3.7.2 synchronous' started by user 'lab' at 19:15:33 UTC Sat Apr 08 2009. Info: The changes made to software configurations will not be persistent Info: across system reloads. Use the command 'admin install commit' to make Info: changes persistent. Info: Please verify that the system is consistent following the software Info: change using the following commands: Info: show system verify Info: install verify packages Install operation 5 completed successfully at 19:16:18 UTC Sat Apr 08 2009. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 47 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Adding and Activating PackagesActivating a Package by Specifying an Operation ID: Example The following example shows the activation of the MPLS package using the operation ID of the install add operation that added the package: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install activate id 4 Install operation 5 '(admin) install activate id 4' started by user 'lab' via CLI at 18:20:17 UTC Thu Jan 03 2009. Info: This operation will activate the following package: Info: disk0:asr9k-mpls-3.7.2 Info: Install Method: Parallel Process Restart The install operation will continue asynchronously. Info: The changes made to software configurations will not be persistent Info: across system reloads. Use the command '(admin) install commit' to Info: make changes persistent. Info: Please verify that the system is consistent following the software Info: change using the following commands: Info: show system verify Info: install verify packages Install operation 5 completed successfully at 18:21:30 UTC Thu Jan 03 2009. Adding and Activating a Package from an FTP File Server with One Command: Example To add and activate a package with a single command, enter the install add command with the activate keyword. In the following example, the Manageability PIE located on disk1: is verified, unpacked, and added to the boot device disk0. Because this operation is performed in administration EXEC mode, the package is activated for all SDRs in the system. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install add disk1: asr9k-mgbl-p.pie-3.7.2 activate Install operation 4 'install add /disk1:asr9k-mgbl-p.pie-3.7.2 activate' started by user 'cisco' at 07:58:56 UTC Wed Mar 01 2009. The install operation will continue asynchronously. :router(admin)#Part 1 of 2 (add software): Started Info: The following package is now available to be activated: Info: Info: disk0:asr9k-mgbl-3.7.2 Info: Part 1 of 2 (add software): Completed successfully Part 2 of 2 (activate software): Started Info: The changes made to software configurations will not be persistent across system reloads. Use the command 'admin install Info: commit' to make changes persistent. Info: Please verify that the system is consistent following the software change using the following commands: Info: show system verify Info: install verify packages Part 2 of 2 (activate software): Completed successfully Part 1 of 2 (add software): Completed successfully Part 2 of 2 (activate software): Completed successfully Install operation 4 completed successfully at 08:00:24 UTC Wed Mar 01 2009. Displaying the Active Packages: Example The following example displays a summary of the active packages on a router. Because this operation is performed in administration EXEC mode, the active packages for all SDRs are displayed. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show install active summary Mon Jun 22 23:41:19.509 PST Default Profile: SDRs: Owner Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 48 OL-26081-03 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Adding and Activating PackagesActive Packages: disk0:comp-asr9k-mini-3.9.0.12I disk0:asr9k-fpd-3.9.0.12I disk0:asr9k-k9sec-3.9.0.12I disk0:asr9k-mcast-3.9.0.12I disk0:asr9k-mgbl-3.9.0.12I disk0:asr9k-mpls-3.9.0.12I Committing the Active Package Set When a package is activated, it becomes part of the current running configuration. To make the package activation persistent across system-wide reloads, enter the install commit command. On startup, DSC of the owner SDR loads this committed software set. If the system is reloaded before the current active software is committed with the install commit command, the previously committed software set is used. If the system is reloaded before the current active software is committed with the install commit command, the previously committed software set is used. Before committing a package set, verify that the SDR is operating correctly and is forwarding packets as expected. Tip SUMMARY STEPS 1. admin 2. install commit 3. show install committed [detail | summary | verbose] [location node-id] DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose admin Enters administration EXEC mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# admin Step 1 Commits the current set of packages on the router so that these packages are used if the router is restarted. install commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install commit Step 2 show install committed [detail | summary | verbose] Displays which packages are committed. [location node-id] Step 3 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show install committed Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 49 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Committing the Active Package SetExamples Committing the Active Package Set: Example In the following example, the active software packages are committed on the router: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install commit Install operation 16 'install commit' started by user 'lab' at 19:18:58 UTC Sat Apr 08 2009. Install operation 16 completed successfully at 19:19:01 UTC Sat Apr 08 2009. Displaying the Committed Package Versions: Example In the following example, the committed packages are shown for the owner SDR: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show install committed Tue Jun 23 05:11:29.968 PST Secure Domain Router: Owner Node 0/RSP0/CPU0 [RP] [SDR: Owner] Boot Device: disk0: Boot Image: /disk0/asr9k-os-mbi-3.9.0.12I/mbiasr9k-rp.vm Committed Packages: disk0:comp-asr9k-mini-3.9.0.12I disk0:asr9k-fpd-3.9.0.12I disk0:asr9k-k9sec-3.9.0.12I disk0:asr9k-mcast-3.9.0.12I disk0:asr9k-mgbl-3.9.0.12I disk0:asr9k-mpls-3.9.0.12I Node 0/1/CPU0 [LC] [SDR: Owner] Boot Device: mem: Boot Image: /disk0/asr9k-os-mbi-3.9.0.12I/lc/mbiasr9k-lc.vm Committed Packages: disk0:comp-asr9k-mini-3.9.0.12I disk0:asr9k-fpd-3.9.0.12I disk0:asr9k-mcast-3.9.0.12I disk0:asr9k-mpls-3.9.0.12I Node 0/4/CPU0 [LC] [SDR: Owner] Boot Device: mem: Boot Image: /disk0/asr9k-os-mbi-3.9.0.12I/lc/mbiasr9k-lc.vm Committed Packages: disk0:comp-asr9k-mini-3.9.0.12I disk0:asr9k-fpd-3.9.0.12I disk0:asr9k-mcast-3.9.0.12I disk0:asr9k-mpls-3.9.0.12I Node 0/6/CPU0 [LC] [SDR: Owner] Boot Device: mem: Boot Image: /disk0/asr9k-os-mbi-3.9.0.12I/lc/mbiasr9k-lc.vm Committed Packages: disk0:comp-asr9k-mini-3.9.0.12I disk0:asr9k-fpd-3.9.0.12I disk0:asr9k-mcast-3.9.0.12I disk0:asr9k-mpls-3.9.0.12I As with the show install active command, the show install committed command may display a composite package that represents all packages in the Cisco IOS XR Unicast Routing Core Bundle. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 50 OL-26081-03 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Committing the Active Package SetUpgrading to Cisco IOS XR Software Release 4.0 In Cisco IOS XR Software Release 4.0, the software packages were reorganized into functionally well-defined and independently-releasable packages. For this reason, when you upgrade from a software release prior to Release 4.0, you must perform the following procedure in order to synchronize all of the software packages according to the reorganized structure. General information regarding the the addition and activation of software packages is not covered in this procedure. The main difference between the standard upgrade procedure and the procedure required to upgrade from Release 3.x to 4.x is that the later requires the addition of one additional software package, known as the upgrade package (asr9k-upgrade-p.pie). Before You Begin Before performing this procedure, see the adding and activating software package procedures described in this module. SUMMARY STEPS 1. admin 2. install add tftp:// hostname_or_ipaddress / directory-path / mandatory-bundle-pie 3. install add tftp:// hostname_or_ipaddress / directory-path / asr9k-upgrade-p.pie 4. install activate device:mandatory-bundle-pie device:upgrade-package 5. install deactivate device:upgrade-package 6. (Optional) install commit 7. install remove device:upgrade-package DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose admin Enters administration EXEC mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# admin Step 1 Unpacks the mandatory bundle PIE file from a network server and adds the package file to the boot device of the router. install add tftp:// hostname_or_ipaddress / directory-path / mandatory-bundle-pie Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install add tftp://10.1.1.1/auto/tftpboot/usr/400/asr9k-mini-p.pie Step 2 Refer to the standard procedure to add and activate packages to see other options of PIE file locations and a description of the various arguments for the install add command. Note Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 51 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Upgrading to Cisco IOS XR Software Release 4.0Command or Action Purpose Unpacks the upgrade PIE file from a network server and adds the package file to the boot device of the router. install add tftp:// hostname_or_ipaddress / directory-path / asr9k-upgrade-p.pie Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install add tftp://10.1.1.1/auto/tftpboot/usr/400/asr9k-upgrade-p.pie Step 3 Activates the package that was added to the router together with the upgrade package. install activate device:mandatory-bundle-pie device:upgrade-package Step 4 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install activate disk0:asr9k-mini-p-4.0.0 disk0:asr9k-upgrade-p-4.0.0 The bundle of mandatory packages and the upgrade bundle are activated together to perform the successful upgrade from release 3.x to 4.x. Note Deactivates the upgrade package on the router. For specific information regarding the deactivation and install deactivate device:upgrade-package Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install deactivate disk0:asr9k-upgrade-p-4.0.0 Step 5 removal of software packages, refer to the general procedure. (Optional) Commits the current set of packages so that these packages are used if the router is restarted. Packages install commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install commit Step 6 can be removed only if the deactivation operation is committed. install remove device:upgrade-package Removes the inactive upgrade package. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install remove disk0:asr9k-upgrade-p-4.0.0 Step 7 The following example illustrates the upgrade operation: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install add /tftp://223.255.254.254/auto/tftpboot/users/user/ asr9k-mini-p.pie Fri Jul 9 03:53:11.052 UTCRP/0/RP1/CPU0:Jul 9 03:53:12.053 : instdir[235]: %INSTALL-INSTMGR-6-INSTALL_OPERATION_STARTED : Install operation 4 '(admin) install add /tftp://223.255.254.254/auto/tftpboot/users/user/asr9k-mini-p.pie' started by user 'lab' Install operation 4 '(admin) install add /tftp://223.255.254.254/auto/tftpboot/users/user/asr9k-mini-p.pie' started by user 'lab' via CLI at 03:53:12 UTC Fri Jul 09 2010. The install operation will continue asynchronously. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# Info: The following package is now available to be activated: Info: disk0:asr9k-mini-p-4.0.0 Info: The package can be activated across the entire router. Info: RP/0/RP1/CPU0:Jul 9 04:32:26.152 : instdir[235]: %INSTALL-INSTMGR-6-INSTALL_OPERATION_COMPLETED_SUCCESSFULLY : Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 52 OL-26081-03 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Upgrading to Cisco IOS XR Software Release 4.0Info: Install operation 4 completed successfully Info: Install operation 4 completed successfully at 04:32:26 UTC Fri Jul 09 2010. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install add /tftp://223.255.254.254/auto/tftpboot/users/user/ asr9k-mpls-p.pie Fri Jul 9 05:07:52.237 UTCRP/0/RP1/CPU0:Jul 9 05:07:53.710 : instdir[235]: %INSTALL-INSTMGR-6-INSTALL_OPERATION_STARTED : Info: Install operation 5 '(admin) install add /tftp://223.255.254.254/auto/tftpboot/users/user/asr9k-mpls-p.pie' Info: started by user 'lab' Info: Install operation 5 '(admin) install add /tftp://223.255.254.254/auto/tftpboot/users/user/asr9k-mpls-p.pie' Info: started by user 'lab' via CLI at 05:07:53 UTC Fri Jul 09 2010. Info: The install operation will continue asynchronously. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# Info: RP/0/RP1/CPU0:Jul 9 05:09:08.854 : instdir[235]: %INSTALL-INSTMGR-6-INSTALL_OPERATION_COMPLETED_SUCCESSFULLY : Install operation 5 completed successfully Info: The following package is now available to be activated: Info: disk0:asr9k-mpls-p-4.0.0 Info: The package can be activated across the entire router. Info: Install operation 5 completed successfully at 05:09:08 UTC Fri Jul 09 2010. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# install add /tftp://223.255.254.254/auto/tftpboot/users/user/ asr9k-upgrade-p.pie Fri Jul 9 05:10:31.133 UTCRP/0/RP1/CPU0:Jul 9 05:10:32.156 : instdir[235]: %INSTALL-INSTMGR-6-INSTALL_OPERATION_STARTED : Info: Install operation 6 '(admin) install add /tftp://223.255.254.254/auto/tftpboot/users/user/asr9k-upgrade-p.pie' Info: started by user 'lab' Info: Install operation 6 '(admin) install add /tftp://223.255.254.254/auto/tftpboot/users/user/asr9k-upgrade-p.pie' Info: started by user 'lab' via CLI at 05:10:32 UTC Fri Jul 09 2010. Info: The install operation will continue asynchronously. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)#RP/0/RP1/CPU0: Jul 9 05:11:55.634 : instdir[235]: %INSTALL-INSTMGR-6-INSTALL_OPERATION_COMPLETED_SUCCESSFULLY : Info: Install operation 6 completed successfully Info: The following package is now available to be activated: Info: disk0:asr9k-upgrade-p-4.0.0 Info: The package can be activated across the entire router. Info: Install operation 6 completed successfully at 05:11:55 UTC Fri Jul 09 2010. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install activate disk0:asr9k-mini-p-4.0.0 disk0:asr9k-upgrade-p-4.0.0 disk0:asr9k-mpls-p-4.0.0 Fri Jul 9 05:23:23.150 UTC Install operation 7 '(admin) install activate disk0:asr9k-mini-p-4.0.0 disk0:asr9k-upgrade-p-4.0.0 disk0:asr9k-mpls-p-4.0.0' Info: started by user 'lab'RP/0/RP1/CPU0:Jul 9 05:23:24.161 : instdir[235]: %INSTALL-INSTMGR-6-INSTALL_OPERATION_STARTED : Info: Install operation 7 '(admin) install activate disk0:asr9k-mini-p-4.0.0 disk0:asr9k-upgrade-p-4.0.0 disk0:asr9k-mpls-p-4.0.0' Info: started by user 'lab' via CLI at 05:23:24 UTC Fri Jul 09 2010.\ 1% complete: Info: The operation can still be aborted (ctrl-c for options) Info: This operation will reload the following nodes in parallel: Info: 0/RP1/CPU0 (HRP) (SDR: Owner) Info: 0/SM0/SP (Fabric-SP) (Admin Resource)Proceed with this install operation (y/n)? [y]| Info: 1% complete: The operation can still be aborted (ctrl-c for options) Info: Install Method: Parallel Reload/ 1% complete: The operation can still be aborted (ctrl-c for options) Info: The install operation will continue asynchronously. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)#SP/0/SM0/SP: Jul 9 05:36:41.152 : insthelper[62]: %INSTALL-INSTHELPER-6-RELOAD_NODE_INFO : Info: As part of install operation 7 this node (0/SM0/SP) will now reload. Info: The changes made to software configurations will not be persistent Info: across system reloads. Use the command '(admin) install commit' to Info: make changes persistent. Info: Please verify that the system is consistent following the software RP/0/RP1/CPU0:Jul 9 05:36:43.962 : instdir[235]: %INSTALL-INSTMGR-6-INSTALL_OPERATION_COMPLETED_SUCCESSFULLY : Info: Install operation 7 completed successfully Info: change using the following commands: Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 53 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Upgrading to Cisco IOS XR Software Release 4.0Info: show system verify Info: install verify packages Info: Install operation 7 completed successfully at 05:36:43 UTC Fri Jul 09 2010. rebooting .........................Initializing DDR SDRAM...found 4096 MB Initializing ECC on bank 0Initializing ECC on bank 1 Initializing ECC on bank 2 Initializing ECC on bank 3 Turning off data cache, using DDR for first time Initializing NVRAM...Testing a portion of DDR SDRAM ...done Reading ID EEPROMs ............................ Initializing SQUID ... Initializing PCI ...PCI0 device[1]: Vendor ID 0x10eePCI0 device[1]: Device ID 0x300ePCI1 device[1]: Device ID 0x1100PCI1 device[1]: Vendor ID 0x1013PCI1 device[2]: Device ID 0x680PCI1 device[2]: Vendor ID 0x1095PCI1 device[3]: Device ID 0x5618PCI1 device[3]: Vendor ID 0x14e4Configuring MPPs ... Configuring PCMCIA slots ...System Bootstrap, Version 1.53(20090311:225342) [CRS-1 ROMMON], Copyright (c) 1994-2009 by Cisco Systems, Inc. Acquiring backplane mastership ... successful Preparing for fan initialization............. ready Setting fan speed to 4000 RPMs successfulReading backplane EEPROM ... Released backplane mastership ...Board type is 0x100002 (1048578) Switch 0 initialized Switch 0 Port fe1: link up (100Mb Full Duplex Copper) Enabling watchdogG4(7457-NonSMP-MV64360 Rev 3) platform with 4096 MB of main memory.... CARD_RACK_NUMBER: 0 CARD_SLOT_NUMBER: 1 CPU_INSTANCE: 1 RACK_SERIAL_NUMBER: TBC08052402 MBI Validation starts ... using Control Plane Ethernet. DEBUG : Driving up signal strength for Intel LXT971 Our MAC address is 0005.9a3e.89da Interface link changed state to UP. Interface link state up. MBI validation sending request. HIT CTRL-C to abort MBI validation sending request. HIT CTRL-C to abort MBI validation sending request. HIT CTRL-C to abort MBI validation sending request. HIT CTRL-C to abort MBI validation sending request. HIT CTRL-C to abort No MBI confirmation received from dSCboot: booting from bootflash:disk0/asr9k-os-mbi-4.0.0/mbiasr9k-rp.vm .................................................................................... ################################################################################## Restricted Rights LegendUse, duplication, or disclosure by the Government is subject to restrictions as set forth in subparagraph(c) of the Commercial Computer Software - Restricted Rights clause at FAR sec. 52.227-19 and subparagraph(c) (1) (ii) of the Rights in Technical Data and Computer Software clause at DFARS sec. 252.227-7013. cisco Systems, Inc. 170 West Tasman Drive San Jose, California 95134-1706 Cisco IOS XR Software for the Cisco XR Router, Version 4.0.0 Copyright (c) 2010 by Cisco Systems, Inc. Jul 09 05:39:21.334 : Install (Node Preparation): Booting with software activated by previous install operation,errno=2 RP/0/RP1/CPU0Jul 9 05:44:45.941: syslogd_helper: [89]: dsc_event_handler: Got SysMgr dSC event : 1 RP/0/RP1/CPU0:Jul 9 05:45:11.354 : shelfmgr[306]: %PLATFORM-SHELFMGR-3-POWERDOWN_RESET : Node 0/2/SP is powered off due to admin power off request ios con0/RP1/CPU0 is now available Press RETURN to get started. RP/0/RP1/CPU0:Jul 9 05:45:27.453 : instdir[216]: %INSTALL-INSTMGR-4-ACTIVE_SOFTWARE_COMMITTED_INFO : The currently active software is not committed. If the system reboots then the committed software will be used. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 54 OL-26081-03 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Upgrading to Cisco IOS XR Software Release 4.0Use 'install commit' to commit the active software. SYSTEM CONFIGURATION IN PROCESS The startup configuration for this device is presently loading. This may take a few minutes. You will be notified upon completion. Please do not attempt to reconfigure the device until this process is complete. User Access VerificationUsername: labPassword: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# admin Fri Jul 9 05:45:55.941 UTC RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show platform Fri Jul 9 05:45:59.805 UTCNode Type PLIM State Config State --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 0/2/SP MSC(SP) N/A UNPOWERED NPWR,NSHUT,MON 0/RP1/CPU0 RP(Active) N/A IOS XR RUN PWR,NSHUT,MON 0/SM0/SP FC-40G/S(SP) N/A MBI-RUNNING PWR,NSHUT,MON 0/SM1/* UNKNOWN N/A PRESENT PWR,NSHUT,MON RP/0/RP1/CPU0:ios(admin)# RP/0/RP1/CPU0:Jul 9 05:46:08.411 : instdir_lr[217]: %INSTALL-INSTMGR-4-ACTIVE_SOFTWARE_COMMITTED_INFO : The currently active software is not committed. If the system reboots then the committed software will be used. Use 'install commit' to commit the active software. RP/0/RP1/CPU0:Jul 9 05:50:40.918 : placed[283]: LR-PLANE-READY DECLARATIONSYSTEM CONFIGURATION COMPLETED RP/0/RP1/CPU0:Jul 9 05:50:57.293 : ifmgr[213]: %PKT_INFRA-LINK-3-UPDOWN : Interface MgmtEth0/RP1/CPU0/0, changed state to Down RP/0/RP1/CPU0:Jul 9 05:50:57.313 : ifmgr[213]: %PKT_INFRA-LINK-3-UPDOWN : Interface MgmtEth0/RP1/CPU0/0, changed state to Up RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show platform Fri Jul 9 05:59:36.266 UTC Node Type PLIM State Config State --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 0/2/SP MSC(SP) N/A UNPOWERED NPWR,NSHUT,MON 0/RP1/CPU0 RP(Active) N/A IOS XR RUN PWR,NSHUT,MON 0/SM0/SP FC-40G/S(SP) N/A IOS XR RUN PWR,NSHUT,MON 0/SM1/* UNKNOWN N/A PRESENT PWR,NSHUT,MON RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install commit Fri Jul 9 05:59:41.851 UTC Install operation 8 '(admin) install commit' started by user 'lab' via CLI at 05:59:43 UTC Fri Jul 09 2010./ 20% complete: The operation can no longer be aborted (ctrl-c for options)- 20% complete: The operation can no longer be aborted (ctrl-c for options)\ 100% complete: The operation can no longer be aborted (ctrl-c for options) RP/0/RP1/CPU0:Jul 9 05:59:46.402 : instdir[216]: %INSTALL-INSTMGR-4-ACTIVE_SOFTWARE_COMMITTED_INFO : The currently active software is now the same as the committed software. Install operation 8 completed successfully at 05:59:46 UTC Fri Jul 09 2010. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install deactivate disk0: asr9k-upgrade-p-4.0.0 Fri Jul 9 05:59:58.082 UTC Install operation 9 '(admin) install deactivate disk0:asr9k-upgrade-p-4.0.0'started by user 'lab' via CLI at 05:59:59 UTC Fri Jul 09 2010. 1% complete: The operation can still be aborted (ctrl-c for options)- 1% complete: The operation can still be aborted (ctrl-c for options) Info: Install Method: Parallel Process Restart\ 1% complete: The operation can still be aborted (ctrl-c for options) The install operation will continue asynchronously. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# Info: The changes made to software configurations will not be persistent Info: across system reloads. Use the command '(admin) install commit' to Info: make changes persistent. Info: Please verify that the system is consistent following the software Info: change using the following commands: Info: show system verify Info: install verify packages RP/0/RP1/CPU0:Jul 9 06:01:45.662 : instdir[216]: Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 55 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Upgrading to Cisco IOS XR Software Release 4.0%INSTALL-INSTMGR-4-ACTIVE_SOFTWARE_COMMITTED_INFO : The currently active software is not committed. If the system reboots then the committed software will be used. Use 'install commit' to commit the active software. Install operation 9 completed successfully at 06:01:45 UTC Fri Jul 09 2010. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install commit Fri Jul 9 06:01:53.583 UTC Install operation 10 '(admin) install commit' started by user 'lab' via CLI at06:01:54 UTC Fri Jul 09 2010./ 20% complete: The operation can no longer be aborted (ctrl-c for options)- 20% complete: The operation can no longer be aborted (ctrl-c for options)\ 100% complete: The operation can no longer be aborted (ctrl-c for options) RP/0/RP1/CPU0:Jul 9 06:01:57.807 : instdir[216]: %INSTALL-INSTMGR-4-ACTIVE_SOFTWARE_COMMITTED_INFO : The currently active software is now the same as the committed software. Install operation 10 completed successfully at 06:01:57 UTC Fri Jul 09 2010. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install remove disk0: asr9k-upgrade-p-4.0.0 Fri Jul 9 06:04:57.676 UTC Install operation 11 '(admin) install remove disk0:asr9k-upgrade-p-4.0.0'started by user 'lab' via CLI at 06:04:58 UTC Fri Jul 09 2010./ 1% complete: The operation can no longer be aborted (ctrl-c for options) Info: This operation will remove the following packages: Info: disk0:asr9k-fpd-4.0.0 Info: disk0:asr9k-doc-4.0.0 Info: disk0:asr9k-k9sec-4.0.0 Info: disk0:asr9k-sbc-4.0.0 Info: disk0:asr9k-diags-4.0.0 Info: disk0:asr9k-mgbl-4.0.0 Info: disk0:asr9k-mcast-4.0.0 Info: disk0:asr9k-mpls-4.0.0 Info: disk0:asr9k-rout-4.0.0 Info: disk0:asr9k-fwdg-4.0.0 Info: disk0:asr9k-lc-4.0.0 Info: disk0:asr9k-admin-4.0.0 Info: disk0:asr9k-upgrade-p-4.0.0- 1% complete: The operation can no longer be aborted (ctrl-c for options) Info: After this install remove the following install rollback point will Info: no longer be reachable, as the required packages will not be present: Info: 7\ 1% complete: The operation can no longer be aborted (ctrl-c for options) Proceed with removing these packages? [confirm]| 1% complete: The operation can no longer be aborted (ctrl-c for options) The install operation will continue asynchronously. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)#SP/0/SM0/SP:Jul 9 06:05:03.902 : envmon[117]: %PLATFORM-ENVMON-4-ALARM : MINOR_HI alarm cleared by host__temp__Inlet0 Install operation 11 completed successfully at 06:05:33 UTC Fri Jul 09 2010. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show install act Fri Jul 9 06:08:11.372 UTC Secure Domain Router: Owner Node 0/RP1/CPU0 [HRP] [SDR: Owner] Boot Device: disk0: Boot Image: /disk0/asr9k-os-mbi-4.0.0/mbiasr9k-rp.vm Active Packages: disk0:asr9k-mpls-p-4.0.0 disk0:asr9k-mini-p-4.0.0 Admin Resources: Node 0/SM0/SP [Fabric-SP] [Admin Resource] Boot Device: bootflash: Boot Image: /disk0/asr9k-os-mbi-4.0.0/sp/mbiasr9k-sp.vm Active Packages: disk0:asr9k-mini-p-4.0.0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# Related Topics Activation and Deactivation Prerequisites, on page 27 Adding and Activating Packages, on page 41 Deactivating and Removing Cisco IOS XR Software Packages, on page 57 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 56 OL-26081-03 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Upgrading to Cisco IOS XR Software Release 4.0Deactivating and Removing Cisco IOS XR Software Packages When a package is deactivated, it is no longer active on the router, but the package files remain on the boot disk. The package files can be reactivated later, or they can be removed from the disk. A package is deactivated using the following methods: • When a newer version of a package is activated, the earlier version of the package is automatically deactivated. See Related Topics for more information. Activating a software maintenance upgrade (SMU) does not cause any earlier SMUs or the package to which the SMU applies to be automatically deactivated. Note • When an earlier version of a package is activated, the newer version is deactivated automatically. See Related Topics for more information. • A specific package is deactivated using the install deactivate command. This command turns off the package features for a card or card type. Before You Begin The following are the restrictions when deactivating and removing Cisco IOS XR Software packages: • A package cannot be deleted if it is part of the running or committed software of the SDR. • A package cannot be deactivated if that package is required by another active package. When a deactivation is attempted, the system runs an automatic check to ensure that the package is not required by other active packages. The deactivation is permitted only after all compatibility checks have been passed. • Router reloads: If the deactivation requires a router reload, a confirmation prompt appears. Use the install deactivate command with the prompt-level none keywords to automatically ignore any reload confirmation prompts and proceed with the package deactivation. The router reloads if required. • Node reloads: If a software operation requires a node reload, the configuration register for that node should be set to autoboot. If the config-register for the node is not set to autoboot, then the system automatically changes the setting and the node reloads. A message describing the change is displayed. • FPD versions must be compatible with the Cisco IOS XR software that is running on the router; if an incompatibility exists between an FPD version and the Cisco IOS XR software, the device with the field-programmable gate array (FPGA) may not operate properly until the incompatibility is resolved. For information on FPDs, including instructions to upgrade FPD images, see the Upgrading FPD Cisco IOS XR Software module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services RouterInterface and Hardware Component Configuration Guide. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 57 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Deactivating and Removing Cisco IOS XR Software PackagesSUMMARY STEPS 1. Connect to the console port and log in. 2. admin 3. install deactivate { id add-id | device : package } [ location node-id ][ test ] [ pause sw-change ] 4. (Optional) show install inactive summary 5. (Optional) install verify packages 6. exit 7. (Optional) show system verify start 8. (Optional) show system verify [ detail | report ] 9. admin 10. (Optional) install commit 11. (Optional) install remove { id add-id | device : package | inactive }[ test ] DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 Connect to the console port and log in. Establishes a CLI management session with the SDR. Connect to the console port for the active DSC. For more information on console connections, see Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Getting Started Guide. admin Enters administration EXEC mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# admin Step 2 install deactivate { id add-id | device : Deactivates a package on all SDRs a router. package } [ location node-id ][ test ] [ pause sw-change ] Step 3 • To deactivate all packagesthat were added in one or more specific install add operations, orspecify packages by name, use the id add-id keyword Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install deactivate disk0:asr9k-diags-3.7.2 and argument. The operation ID of an install add operation is indicated in the syslog displayed during the operation and in the output of the show install log command. • Use the location node-id keyword and argument to deactivate the package for a specific node, if supported. • Use the pause sw-change keywords to pause the operation after preparatory checks and before the configuration is locked for the actual deactivation. This enables you to hold the operation while you perform configuration changes, and proceed with the deactivation whenever you choose. This is useful, for example, if your workflow involves configuring a router out of the network during software changes and you want to minimize the time that the router is out of the network. Follow the onscreen instructions to control the pausing and completion of the operation. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 58 OL-26081-03 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Deactivating and Removing Cisco IOS XR Software PackagesCommand or Action Purpose Press ? after a partial package name to display all possible matches available for deactivation. If there is only one match, press [TAB] to fill in the rest of the package name. When a package is deactivated for an SDR from administration EXEC mode, a notification message appears on the console for that SDR, with information on the impact of the deactivation. Note (Optional) Displays the inactive packages on the router. show install inactive summary Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show install inactive summary Step 4 (Optional) Verifies the consistency of an installed software set with the package file from which it originated. This command can be used as a debugging tool to install verify packages Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install verify packages Step 5 verify the validity of the files that constitute the packages, to determine if there are any corrupted files. This command also checks for corruptions of installation state files and MBI image files. This command is particularly useful when issued after the activation of a package or upgrading the Cisco IOS XR software to a major release. The install verify packages command can take up to two minutes per package to process. Note exit Exits administration EXEC mode and returns to EXEC mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# exit Step 6 (Optional) Starts the system status check. show system verify start Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show system verify start Step 7 (Optional) Displays system status information. A variety of information is displayed including the memory and CPU usage, process status, protocol status, and show system verify [ detail | report ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show system verify Step 8 other status information. Use this information to verify that the system is stable. • detail—Displays additional information at the card and processor level, including actual numbers. • report—Displays the same information as the default show system verify command Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 59 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Deactivating and Removing Cisco IOS XR Software PackagesCommand or Action Purpose Although most of the output should display the status “OK,” some processes may show other output, such as “Warning.” This does not specifically indicate a problem. Contact your Cisco technicalsupport representative for more information on the output of this command. Note admin Enters administration EXEC mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# admin Step 9 (Optional) Commits the current set of packages so that these packages are used if the router isrestarted. Packages can be removed only if the deactivation operation is committed. install commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install commit Step 10 This command is entered in administration EXEC mode. Note (Optional) Removes the inactive package. install remove { id add-id | device : package | inactive }[ test ] Step 11 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install • Only inactive packages can be removed. • Packages can be removed only if they are deactivated from all cards in the router. remove disk0:asr9k-diags-3.8.30 • The package deactivation must be committed. • To remove a specific inactive package from a storage device, use the install remove command with the device: package arguments. • To remove all packages that were added in one or more specific install add operations, use the id add-id keyword and argument. The operation ID of an install add operation isindicated in the syslog displayed during the operation and in the output of the show install log command. If you specify packages according to operation ID, all the packages that were added by the specified operation must still be on the router. • To remove all inactive packages from all nodes in the system, use the install remove command with the inactive keyword. Related Topics Adding and Activating Packages, on page 41 Committing the Active Package Set, on page 49 Committing the Active Package Set, on page 49 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 60 OL-26081-03 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Deactivating and Removing Cisco IOS XR Software PackagesExamples In the following examples, a package is deactivated from the router. The changes are committed and the inactive package is removed from the router. Deactivating the Package: Example RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install deactivate disk0:asr9k -diags-.7.2 Install operation 27 'install deactivate disk0:asr9k-diags-3.7.2' started by user 'lab' at 23:29:37 UTC Sat Apr 15 2009. The install operation will continue asynchronously. Info: The changes made to software configuration Info: across system reloads. Use the command 'admin install commit' to make Info: changes persistent. Info: Please verify that the system is consistent following the software Info: change using the following commands: Info: show system verify Info: install verify packages Install operation 27 completed successfully at 23:30:22 UTC Sat Apr 15 2009. Committing the Active Software Set: Example RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install commit Install operation 29 'install commit' started by user 'lab' at 23:39:21 UTC Sat Apr 15 20090. Install operation 29 completed successfully at 23:39:24 UTC Sat Apr 15 2009. Displaying the Inactive Packages: Example RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show install inactive summary Default Profile: SDRs: Owner Inactive Packages: disk0:asr9k-diags-3.7.2 Removing the Inactive Package from the Router: Example The following example shows how to remove an inactive package. In this example, the operation is run in test mode. The operation is confirmed and the package is removed. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install remove disk0:asr9k-diags-3.7.2 test Install operation 30 'install remove disk0:hfr-diags-3.7.2 test' started by user 'lab' at 23:40:22 UTC Sat Apr 15 2009. Warning: No changes will occur due to 'test' option being specified. The Warning: following is the predicted output for this install command. Info: This operation will remove the following package: Info: disk0:asr9k-diags-3.7.2 Info: After this install remove the following install rollback points will Info: no longer be reachable, as the required packages will not be present: Info: 4, 9, 10, 14, 15, 17, 18 Proceed with removing these packages? [confirm] y The install operation will continue asynchronously. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 61 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Deactivating and Removing Cisco IOS XR Software PackagesInstall operation 30 completed successfully at 23. Pausing Before Configuration Lock: Example The following example shows how to deactivate a package, pausing the operation before locking the configuration for the actual software deactivation. While the operation is paused, you can enter a configuration mode and perform configurations. When you want to complete the operation, enter the install operationid complete command, or the install operation id attach synchronous command. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install deactivate disk0:comp-asr9k -3.7.2.07I.CSCsr09575-1.0.0 pause sw-change Install operation 12 '(admin) install deactivate disk0:comp-asr9k-3.7.2.07I.CSCsr09575-1.0.0 pause sw-change' started by user 'admin' via CLI at 09:06:26 BST Mon Jul 07 2009. Info: This operation will reload the following nodes in parallel: Info: 0/0/CPU0 (RP) (SDR: Owner) Info: 0/1/CPU0 (LC(E3-GE-4)) (SDR: Owner) Info: 0/5/CPU0 (LC(E3-OC3-POS-4)) (SDR: Owner) Proceed with this install operation (y/n)? [y] The install operation will continue asynchronously. Info: Install Method: Parallel Reload Info: Install operation 12 is pausing before the config lock is applied for Info: the software change as requested by the user. Info: No further install operations will be allowed until the operation is resumed. Info: Please continue the operation using one of the following steps: Info: - run the command '(admin) install operation 12 complete'. Info: - run the command '(admin) install operation 12 attach synchronous' and then Info: answer the query. Rolling Back to a Previous Software Set Cisco IOS XR software allows you to roll back one or more SDRs to a previous committed or uncommitted software set. Use the show install rollback ? command to view the available rollback points and use the install rollback to command to roll back the SDR to a previous software set. You can also use the install rollback to committed command to roll back to the most recent committed software set. Note Rollback operations can be performed by running the command in administration EXEC or EXEC mode. Displaying Rollback Points A rollback point is created every time a software package is activated, deactivated, or committed. Use the show install rollback ? command to display the eligible rollback points. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# admin RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show install rollback ? 0 ID of the rollback point to show package information for 2 ID of the rollback point to show package information for In this example, the rollback points are 0 and 2. The rollback point with the highest number is the current software point. For example, if the last installation operation was operation 3 (activating the MPLS package) then the highest rollback point is 3, which is the same as the current software (MPLS package activated). Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 62 OL-26081-03 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Rolling Back to a Previous Software SetTo easily identify specific rollback points, you can assign a label or description to a rollback point using the install label command. You can enter the command in either administration EXEC mode or EXEC mode. Displaying the Active Packages Associated with a Rollback Point To display the active packages associated with a rollback point, use the show install rollback command with the point-id argument. This command displays the packages that are active if you roll back one or more SDRs to that installation point. For example, the show install rollback 2 command displays the packages that are active if you roll back to rollback point 2. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show install rollback 0 Tue Jun 23 06:25:06.493 PST ID: 0, Label: Timestamp: 23:11:20 UTC Sat Oct 28 2000 Secure Domain Router: Owner Node 0/RSP0/CPU0 [RP] [SDR: Owner] Boot Device: disk0: Boot Image: /disk0/asr9k-os-mbi-3.9.0.12I/mbiasr9k-rp.vm Rollback Packages: disk0:comp-asr9k-mini-3.9.0.12I Node 0/1/CPU0 [LC] [SDR: Owner] Boot Device: mem: Boot Image: /disk0/asr9k-os-mbi-3.9.0.12I/lc/mbiasr9k-lc.vm Rollback Packages: disk0:comp-asr9k-mini-3.9.0.12I Node 0/4/CPU0 [LC] [SDR: Owner] Boot Device: mem: Boot Image: /disk0/asr9k-os-mbi-3.9.0.12I/lc/mbiasr9k-lc.vm Rollback Packages: disk0:comp-asr9k-mini-3.9.0.12I Node 0/6/CPU0 [LC] [SDR: Owner] Boot Device: mem: Boot Image: /disk0/asr9k-os-mbi-3.9.0.12I/lc/mbiasr9k-lc.vm Rollback Packages: disk0:comp-asr9k-mini-3.9.0.12I You can enter the command in either administration EXEC mode or EXEC mode. For more information on the command options, see the Software Package Management Commands on Cisco IOS XR Software module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Command Reference. Note Rolling Back to a Specific Rollback Point You can roll back to a specific rollback point, including a noncommitted software set: • If you roll back to the most recent noncommitted rollback point (with the highest number), you do not need to reload the router. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 63 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Displaying the Active Packages Associated with a Rollback Point• You can repeat the rollback process one rollback point at a time without reloading if you always choose the most recent rollback point. • If you choose a rollback point that is older than the most recent point, the impacted nodes reload, interrupting data traffic on those nodes. Before the reload occurs, you are prompted to confirm the install rollback operation. In the following example, the system is rolled back to noncommitted rollback point 8: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install rollback to 8 Install operation 10 'install rollback to 8' started by user 'cisco' at 07:49:26 UTC Mon Nov 14 2009. The install operation will continue asynchronously. Info: The changes made to software configurations will not be persistent Info: across system reloads. Use the command 'admin install commit' to make Info: changes persistent. Info: Please verify that the system is consistent following the software Info: change using the following commands: Info: show system verify Info: install verify packages The currently active software is the same as the committed software. Install operation 10 completed successfully at 07:51:24 UTC Mon Nov 14 2009. Rolling Back to the Last Committed Package Set Use the install rollback to committed command to roll back to the last committed package set. In the following example, the owner SDR is rolled back to the last committed package set: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# install rollback to committed Install operation 27 'install rollback to committed' started by user 'lab' at 16:41:38 UTC Sat Nov 19 2009. Info: The rollback to committed software will require a reload of impacted Info: nodes because it is over multiple activation & deactivation Info: operations. Info: This operation will reload the following node: Info: 0/RP1/CPU0 (RP) (SDR: Owner) Info: This operation will reload all RPs in the Owner SDR, and thereby Info: indirectly cause every node in the router to reload. Proceed with this install operation? [confirm] Updating Commit Database. Please wait...[OK] Info: The changes made to software configurations will not be persistent Info: across system reloads. Use the command 'admin install commit' to make Info: changes persistent. Info: Please verify that the system is consistent following the software Info: change using the following commands: Info: show system verify Info: install verify packages Install operation 27 completed successfully at 16:42:23 UTC Sat Nov 19 2009. Additional References The following sections provide referencesrelated to software package management on Cisco IOS XR software. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 64 OL-26081-03 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Rolling Back to the Last Committed Package SetRelated Documents Related Topic Document Title Software Package Management Commands on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Command Reference Cisco IOS XR install commands Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Getting Started Guide Cisco IOS XR getting started material Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Commands Master List Cisco IOS XR master command index Configuring AAA Services on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Security Configuration Guide Information about user groups and task IDs Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router ROM Monitor Guide ROM Monitor Standards Standards Title No new or modified standards are supported by this — feature, and support for existing standards has not been modified by this feature. MIBs MIBs MIBs Link To locate and download MIBs using Cisco IOS XR software, use the Cisco MIB Locator found at the following URL and choose a platform under the Cisco Access Products menu: http://cisco.com/public/ sw-center/netmgmt/cmtk/mibs.shtml — Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 65 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional ReferencesRFCs RFCs Title No new or modified RFCs are supported by this — feature, and support for existing RFCs has not been modified by this feature. Technical Assistance Description Link The Cisco Technical Support website contains http://www.cisco.com/techsupport thousands of pages of searchable technical content, including links to products, technologies, solutions, technical tips, and tools. Registered Cisco.com users can log in from this page to access even more content. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 66 OL-26081-03 Upgrading and Managing Software on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional ReferencesC H A P T E R 4 Configuring Disk Mirroring on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router This module describes the process to configure disk mirroring in Cisco IOS XR software. For complete descriptions of the commands listed in this module, see Related Documents, on page 77. To locate documentation for other commands that might appear in the course of performing a configuration task, search online in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Commands Master List. Table 10: Feature History for Disk Mirroring for Cisco IOS XR Software Release Modification Release 3.7.2 Disk mirroring was introduced. This module contains the following topics: • Disk Mirroring Prerequisites, page 67 • Information About Disk Mirroring, page 68 • How to Enable Disk Mirroring, page 69 • Configuration Examples for Enabling Disk Mirroring, page 76 • Additional References, page 77 Disk Mirroring Prerequisites Before enabling disk mirroring, the following conditions must be met: • You must be in a user group associated with a task group that includesthe proper task IDs. The command reference guides include the task IDs required for each command. If you suspect user group assignment is preventing you from using a command, contact your AAA administrator for assistance. • The secondary storage device specified for the mirroring must be installed in the same node as the primary boot device. The supported storage devices are disk0: and disk1:. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 67• The secondary storage device must be the same size or larger than the designated primary storage device. • The secondary storage device must be partitioned. The primary partition on the secondary storage device must be large enough to contain all data on the primary boot device. This can be an issue if the primary boot device has not yet been partitioned. For example, in the situation where both the primary boot device and the secondary storage device are 1 GB in size, the primary boot device contains 950 MB of data, and the secondary storage device is already partitioned to 800 MB in the primary partition and 200 MB in the secondary partition. In such a case, the 950 MB of data from the primary boot device does not fit on the secondary storage device because of the partition. Such a configuration is rejected and an error is displayed. You need to replace the secondary storage device with a higher capacity device. For information about disk partition sizes,see Related Topics. Note Although compactflash: can be used as the secondary device on a Performance Route Processor (PRP–2), there is an issue with the ROM Monitor not being able to boot the minimum boot image (MBI) from the secondary device if the device is not disk0: or disk1:. In such a situation, you would need to go into ROMMON mode and boot the PRP-2 manually using the MBI on the compactflash:. Note Related Topics Information About Disk Mirroring, on page 68 Information About Disk Mirroring The route switch processor (RSP) card has a primary storage device that is used to store installation packages and configuration files. This primary storage device is referred to as the primary boot device and is essential for booting the RSP and its normal operation. Disk mirroring replicates the critical data on the primary boot device onto another storage device on the same RSP, henceforth referred to as the secondary device. If the primary boot device fails, applications continue to be serviced transparently by the secondary device, thereby avoiding a switchover to the standby RSP. The failed primary storage device can be replaced or repaired without disruption of service. Disk mirroring should only mirror critical data on the primary boot device onto a secondary storage device and not any noncritical data such as logging data. To separate critical data from noncritical data, the disk devices need to be partitioned. Disk0: is partitioned to disk0: and disk0a:; disk1: is partitioned to disk1: and disk1a:. Disk0: and disk1: are used for critical data, whereas disk0a: and disk1a: are used for logging data and other noncritical data. Before you can configure disk mirroring on the RSP, you must have partitioned the secondary storage device. The sizes of disk partitions are related to the total disk size, and are provided in Table 11: Size of Disk Partitions in Relation to Size of Disk, on page 68. Table 11: Size of Disk Partitions in Relation to Size of Disk Size of Disk Primary Partition Percentage Secondary Partition Percentage less than 900 MB Partitioning not supported Partitioning not supported 900 MB to 1.5 GB 80% 20% Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 68 OL-26081-03 Configuring Disk Mirroring on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Information About Disk MirroringSize of Disk Primary Partition Percentage Secondary Partition Percentage 1.5 GB to 3 GB 60% 40% more than 3 GB 50% 50% How to Enable Disk Mirroring The tasks in this section describe how to enable and manage disk mirroring. Enabling Disk Mirroring Complete the following instructions to enable disk mirroring. After disk mirroring is configured, if there is a fault on the primary boot drive or it cannot be accessed for any reason, control is automatically transferred to the secondary storage device. SUMMARY STEPS 1. format secondary-device partition [ location node-id ] 2. Remove any noncritical data from the primary boot device. 3. configure 4. mirror location node-id Primary-device Secondary-device 5. Use one of these commands: • end • commit 6. show mirror [ location node-id ] 7. mirror verify location node-id DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose format secondary-device partition [ Partitions the secondary storage device into two partitions. location node-id ] Step 1 • If the device is already partitioned, you do not need to perform this step. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# format disk1: partition Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 69 Configuring Disk Mirroring on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router How to Enable Disk MirroringCommand or Action Purpose The primary boot device should contain installation packages and configuration files only. Log files can be copied to the “a” partition of the secondary device, for example disk1a: . Remove any noncritical data from the primary boot device. Step 2 configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 3 Enables disk mirroring of the primary-device to the secondary-device . mirror location node-id Primary-device Secondary-device Step 4 Example: If the primary boot device is not partitioned, the following occurs: • The contents of the primary device are replicated to the secondary device RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# mirror location 0/ rsp0/cpu0 disk0:disk1: • Control of the mirroring server switches to the secondary storage device. • The primary device is partitioned. • Data is replicated back to the primary boot device. Step 5 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 70 OL-26081-03 Configuring Disk Mirroring on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Enabling Disk MirroringCommand or Action Purpose Displays disk mirroring information for an RSP node. It also provides the status of the synchronization between the primary and secondary devices. show mirror [ location node-id ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show mirror location 0/ rsp0/cpu0 Step 6 mirror verify location node-id Verifies disk synchronization for disk mirroring on an RSP node. Example: Step 7 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# mirror verify location 0/ rsp0/cpu0 Replacing the Secondary Mirroring Device Follow this procedure if you need to replace the secondary boot device used in the disk mirroring process. SUMMARY STEPS 1. show mirror [location node-id] 2. mirror pause [location node-id] 3. show mirror [location node-id] 4. unmount secondary-device [location node-id] 5. Remove the device and insert a new device. 6. format secondary-device partition [location node-id] 7. show media [location node-id] 8. mirror resume [location node-id] 9. show mirror [location node-id] DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Verifies that mirroring is active. In the output, the Current Mirroring State should be redundant. show mirror [location node-id] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show mirror Step 1 mirror pause [location node-id] Temporarily pauses disk mirroring. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# mirror pause Step 2 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 71 Configuring Disk Mirroring on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Replacing the Secondary Mirroring DeviceCommand or Action Purpose Verifies that mirroring has paused. In the output, the Current Mirroring State should be paused. show mirror [location node-id] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show mirror Step 3 unmount secondary-device [location node-id] Unmounts the secondary device. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# unmount disk1: Step 4 Step 5 Remove the device and insert a new device. format secondary-device partition [location node-id] Formats the device. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# format disk1: partition Step 6 Verifies that the device is formatted. The output should display the device that you formatted. show media [location node-id] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show media Step 7 mirror resume [location node-id] Resumes mirroring. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# mirror resume Step 8 Verifies that mirroring has restarted. In the output, the Current Mirroring State should be Syncing. show mirror [location node-id] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show mirror Step 9 It can take 15 to 30 minutes for the mirroring process to complete. The exact time depends on the number of packages or files on the boot device. When the mirroring is complete, the Current Mirroring State should be Redundant. Replacing the Primary Mirroring Device In the event that your primary boot disk is defective and you need to replace it while disk mirroring is enabled, perform this task. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 72 OL-26081-03 Configuring Disk Mirroring on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Replacing the Primary Mirroring DeviceSUMMARY STEPS 1. show mirror [location node-id] 2. configure 3. mirror location node-id Primary-device Secondary-device 4. Use one of these commands: • end • commit 5. show mirror [location node-id] 6. mirror pause [location node-id] 7. show mirror 8. unmount secondary-device [location node-id] 9. Remove the device and insert a new device. 10. show media [location node-id] 11. (Optional) format secondary-device partition [location node-id] 12. mirror resume [location node-id] 13. show mirror [location node-id] 14. configure 15. mirror location node-id Primary-device Secondary-device 16. show mirror [location node-id] DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Verifies that mirroring is in the redundant state. In the output, the Current Mirroring State should be redundant. If mirroring is not in show mirror [location node-id] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show mirror Step 1 the redundant state, you cannot proceed with the procedure. You must wait until mirroring is in the redundant state. configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 2 Swaps the device roles such that the primary mirroring device now becomes the secondary device and the secondary mirroring device becomes the primary device. mirror location node-id Primary-device Secondary-device Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# mirror Step 3 location 0/ RSP0 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 73 Configuring Disk Mirroring on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Replacing the Primary Mirroring DeviceCommand or Action Purpose /CPU0 disk1:disk0: Step 4 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Verifies that the primary device is now the secondary device and vice versa. In the output, if disk0: was the primary disk that you want to replace, it should now be listed as the secondary device. show mirror [location node-id] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show mirror Step 5 mirror pause [location node-id] Temporarily pauses disk mirroring. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# mirror pause Step 6 Verifies that mirroring has paused. In the output, the Current Mirroring State should be paused. show mirror Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show mirror Step 7 Unmounts the secondary device which is the device that you want to replace. Initially, this was the primary device. unmount secondary-device [location node-id] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# unmount disk1: Step 8 Step 9 Remove the device and insert a new device. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 74 OL-26081-03 Configuring Disk Mirroring on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Replacing the Primary Mirroring DeviceCommand or Action Purpose Verifies that the new disk is partitioned. You should see that the new device is mounted. If the new device is not partitioned, format the device as indicated in the next step. show media [location node-id] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show media Step 10 (Optional) Formats the device. You only need to perform this step if the new device is not partitioned. format secondary-device partition [location node-id] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# format disk1: partition Step 11 mirror resume [location node-id] Resumes mirroring. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# mirror resume Step 12 Verifies that mirroring has restarted. In the output, the Current Mirroring State should be Syncing. show mirror [location node-id] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show mirror Step 13 It can take 15 to 30 minutes for the mirroring process to complete. The exact time depends on the number of packages or files on the boot device. When the mirroring is complete, the Current Mirroring State should be Redundant. configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 14 Swaps the device roles back so that the newly inserted device becomes the primary device. mirror location node-id Primary-device Secondary-device Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# mirror Step 15 location 0/ RSP0 /CPU0 disk0:disk1: show mirror [location node-id] Verifies that the new device is now the primary device. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show mirror Step 16 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 75 Configuring Disk Mirroring on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Replacing the Primary Mirroring DeviceConfiguration Examples for Enabling Disk Mirroring Enabling Disk Mirroring: Example In the following example, disk mirroring is enabled on a router: format disk1: partition This operation will destroy all data on "disk1:" and partition device. Continue? [confirm] y Device partition disk1: is now formated and is available for use. configure mirror location 0/0/cpu0 disk0:disk1: commit show mirror Command Output: Example RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show mirror location all Tue Dec 7 13:02:26.520 PST Mirror Information for 0/RSP0/CPU0. ======================================================== Mirroring Enabled Configured Primary: disk0: Configured Secondary: disk1: Current Mirroring State: Redundant Current Physical Primary: disk0: Current Physical Secondary: disk1: Mirroring Logical Device: disk0: Mirroring Logical Device2: disk1: Physical Device State Flags -------------------------------------------------------- disk0: Available Enabled disk1: Available Enabled compactflash: Available (null) Available disk0a: Available disk1a: Available compactflasha: Not Present harddisk: Available Mirroring Rommon Variable BOOT_DEV_SEQ_CONF = disk0:;disk1: BOOT_DEV_SEQ_OPER = disk0:;disk1: MIRROR_ENABLE = Y mirror verify Command Output: Example RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# mirror verify Mirror Verify Information for 0/0/CPU0. ======================================================== Primary device and secondary device are fully synchronized. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 76 OL-26081-03 Configuring Disk Mirroring on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuration Examples for Enabling Disk MirroringAdditional References The following sections provide references related to disk mirroring configuration. Related Documents Related Topic Document Title Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Getting Started Guide Initial system bootup and configuration information for a router using the Cisco IOS XR software Configuring AAA Services on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Security Configuration Guide Information about user groups and task IDs Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Commands Master List Cisco IOS XR command master list Boot Commands on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Command Reference Cisco IOS XR boot commands Standards Standards Title No new or modified standards are supported by this — feature, and support for existing standards has not been modified by this feature. MIBs MIBs MIBs Link To locate and download MIBs using Cisco IOS XR software, use the Cisco MIB Locator found at the following URL and choose a platform under the Cisco Access Products menu: http://cisco.com/public/ sw-center/netmgmt/cmtk/mibs.shtml — Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 77 Configuring Disk Mirroring on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional ReferencesRFCs RFCs Title No new or modified RFCs are supported by this — feature, and support for existing RFCs has not been modified by this feature. Technical Assistance Description Link The Cisco Technical Support website contains http://www.cisco.com/techsupport thousands of pages of searchable technical content, including links to products, technologies, solutions, technical tips, and tools. Registered Cisco.com users can log in from this page to access even more content. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 78 OL-26081-03 Configuring Disk Mirroring on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional ReferencesC H A P T E R 5 Software Entitlement on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Cisco IOS XR software contains all the supported features for a given release. Before the introduction of software entitlement on Cisco IOS XR software, you could freely activate all available software packages on your network devices and could enable all the bundled features. To enable the pay-as-you-grow model—where you pay only for the features that you need today—but can upgrade when necessary while keeping your investment safe, software entitlement has been introduced. Licensing enables you to purchase individual software features and upgrade hardware capacity in a safe and reliable way. For complete descriptions of the commands listed in this module, see Related Documents, on page 89. To locate documentation for other commands that might appear in the course of performing a configuration task, search online in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Commands Master List. Table 12: Feature History for Software Entitlement Release Modification Release 3.9.0 The software entitlement feature was introduced. This model contains the following topics: • Prerequisites for Configuring Software Entitlement, page 80 • Restrictions for Cisco IOS XR Software Entitlement, page 80 • Information About Cisco IOS XR Software Entitlement, page 80 • How to Configure Cisco IOS XR Software Entitlement, page 83 • Troubleshooting License Issues after a Software Upgrade, page 88 • Additional References, page 88 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 79Prerequisites for Configuring Software Entitlement You must be in a user group associated with a task group that includes the proper task IDs. The command reference guides include the task IDs required for each command. If you suspect user group assignment is preventing you from using a command, contact your AAA administrator for assistance. Restrictions for Cisco IOS XR Software Entitlement The following features may not work as expected unless the appropriate licenses are installed: • Layer 3 VPN routing and forwarding (VRF) • G.709 support for supported 10-Gigabit Ethernet line cards • Video monitoring If you configure and remove VRFs after installing the license, any VRFs configured prior to installing the license are not recognized. You need to reconfigure these VRFs. Note Information About Cisco IOS XR Software Entitlement To configure process placement policies, you need to understand the concepts described in this module. What Is Software Entitlement? Software entitlement is a system that consists of a license manager on a Cisco IOS XR device that manages licenses for various software and hardware features. The license manager parses and authenticates a license before accepting it. The software features on the router use the license manager APIs to check out and release licenses. Licenses are stored in persistent storage on the router. Core routing features are available for use without any license. The following features can be enabled on your router using licenses: Layer 3 VPN Layer 3 (virtual private network) VPN can be configured only if there is an available Layer 3 VPN license for the line card slot on which the feature is being configured. If the advanced IP license is enabled, 4096 Layer 3 VPN routing and forwarding instances (VRFs) can be configured on a line card. If the infrastructure VRF license is enabled, eight Layer 3 VRFs can be configured on the line card. See the following modulesin Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide for information about Layer 3 VPN configurations: • Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router • Implementing Virtual Private LAN Services on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 80 OL-26081-03 Software Entitlement on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Prerequisites for Configuring Software EntitlementG.709 If a G.709 license is available, G.709 can be enabled on 10-Gigabit Ethernet interfaces on the following line cards: • 2-port 10 Gigabit Ethernet / 20-port Gigabit Ethernet line card • 8-port 10 Gigabit Ethernet line card Refer to the Configuring Dense Wavelength Division Multiplexing Controllers on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Interface and Hardware Component Configuration Guide. Video Monitoring Video monitoring can be enabled for the Cisco ASR 9000 chassis by using a video monitoring license. Types of Licenses The following types of licenses are currently defined: • Permanent licenses—Licensesthat enable a designated feature permanently, aslong asthe license resides on the router. • Evaluation or metered licenses—Licenses that enable a feature for a limited period of time. The feature stops working immediately on license expiry. If multiple evaluation licenses are added for the same feature, the expiry period is counted from when the first evaluation license is added to the router. Router License Pools License pools are maintained by the router. By default, all added licenses are allocated to the owner SDR license pool, and they can be freely allocated to any slot in the router. Features on cards belonging to the owner SDR are granted licenses based on availability in the owner SDR license pool. Chassis-Locked Licenses Licenses are locked to a unique device identifier (UDI). The UDI is comprised of the chassis serial number, along with a license operation ID number. The license operation ID is incremented by the license manager every time there is a successful license add or remove operation. The complete set of UDI information can be displayed using the show license udi command. The license manager parses the user-provided license and verifies that it is valid for the chassis it is running on and determines if the license is being readded. Slot-Based Licenses Feature licenses are allocated to router slots and not cards. Therefore, if a card is replaced, the existing license is applied to the newly inserted card. For example, if you have eight licenses for Layer 3 VPN in the system, you can configure Layer 3 VPN features on any eight cards in the router, and the licenses are allocated to the slots within which the cards are installed. If a card is removed from one of these licensed slots, say slot 3, and Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 81 Software Entitlement on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Types of Licensesentered into an empty slot with no license, say slot 5, the license remains with slot 3 and the feature cannot be activated on slot 5 with the permanent license entered earlier by the user. In this case, you can release the license to the appropriate license pool by removing the configuration of the card (while it is inserted), or by using the license move slot command. When you configure the feature on slot 5, the license is checked out. Features that Require Licenses After a Software Image Upgrade When you upgrade your Cisco IOS XR software image from a release that does notsupportsoftware entitlement to one that does, a warning message is displayed to the console port for each feature that requires a license. You must acquire either an evaluation license or a permanent license in order to continue using any features that require a license. During an install activate operation, if the installation fails to acquire a license (through the license manager) for a package that requires licensing then the install operation is allowed but a warning message similar to the following is displayed: Install operation 10 '(admin) install activate disk0:asr9k-optic-4.0.1.06I' started by user 'root' via CLI at 09:57:15 pst Tue Aug 10 2010. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:Aug 10 09:57:15.058 : instdir[206]: %INSTALL-INSTMGR-6-INSTALL_OPERATION_STARTED : Install operation 10 '(admin) install activate disk0:asr9k-optic-4.0.1.06I' started by user 'root' / 1% complete: The operation can still be aborted (ctrl-c for options)RP/0/RSP0/CPU0: Aug 10 09:57:18.691 : licmgr[237]: %LICENSE-LICMGR-4-PACKAGE_LICENSE_INVALID : Package A9K-ADV-OPTIC-LIC activated without a valid license/ valid configuration Warning: There is no valid license for the following package: Warning: Warning: disk0:asr9k-optics-supp-4.0.1.06I Warning: Info: Install Method: Parallel Process Restart \ 1% complete: The operation can still be aborted (ctrl-c for options)RP/0/RSP0/CPU0: Aug 10 09:57:18.692 : instdir[206]: %INSTALL-INSTMGR-4-INSTALL_OPERATION_WARNING : A warning occurred during install operation 10. See 'show install log 10 detail' for more information. The install operation will continue asynchronously. LC/0/0/CPU0:Aug 10 09:57:46.358 : sysmgr[87]: %OS-SYSMGR-7-INSTALL_NOTIFICATION : notification of software installation received LC/0/0/CPU0:Aug 10 09:57:46.389 : sysmgr[87]: %OS-SYSMGR-7-INSTALL_FINISHED : software installation is finished LC/0/1/CPU0:Aug 10 09:57:46.477 : sysmgr[90]: %OS-SYSMGR-7-INSTALL_NOTIFICATION : notification of software installation received LC/0/1/CPU0:Aug 10 09:57:46.482 : sysmgr[90]: %OS-SYSMGR-7-INSTALL_FINISHED : software installation is finished RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:Aug 10 09:58:01.402 : sysmgr[95]: %OS-SYSMGR-7-INSTALL_NOTIFICATION : notification of software installation received RP/0/RSP0/CPU0: Aug 10 09:58:01.417 : sysmgr[95]: %OS-SYSMGR-7-INSTALL_FINISHED : software installation is finished Info: The changes made to software configurations will not be persistent Info: across system reloads. Use the command '(admin) install commit' to Info: make changes persistent. Info: Please verify that the system is consistent following the software Info: change using the following commands: Info: show system verify Info: install verify packages RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:Aug 10 09:58:11.154 : instdir[206]: %INSTALL-INSTMGR-4-ACTIVE_SOFTWARE_COMMITTED_INFO : The currently active software is not committed. If the system reboots then the committed software will be used. Use 'install commit' to commit the active software. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:Aug 10 09:58:11.155 : instdir[206]: %INSTALL-INSTMGR-6-INSTALL_OPERATION_COMPLETED_SUCCESSFULLY : Install operation 10 completed successfully Install operation 10 completed successfully at 09:58:11 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 82 OL-26081-03 Software Entitlement on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Features that Require Licenses After a Software Image Upgradepst Tue Aug 10 2010. If you activate an SMU whose corresponding package requires a license but a license was not acquired successfully, then the install operation is allowed but a warning message similar to the following is displayed: Wed Nov 25 15:02:23.418 PST Install operation 8 started by user 'lab' via CLI at 14:59:46 PST Wed Nov 25 2009. (admin) install activate id 7 Install operation 8 completed successfully at 15:02:13 PST Wed Nov 25 2009. Install logs: Install operation 8 '(admin) install activate id 7' started by user 'lab' via CLI at 14:59:46 PST Wed Nov 25 2009. Info: This operation will activate the following packages: Info: disk0:comp-asr9k-4.0.0.3P.CSCee40001-1.0.0 Info: disk0:comp-asr9k-4.0.0.3P.CSCee30001-1.0.0 Info: disk0:comp-asr9k-4.0.0.3P.CSCee20001-1.0.0 Info: disk0:comp-asr9k-4.0.0.3P.CSCee10001-1.0.0 Info: The following SMUs are not being activated as they do not apply to Info: any packages on the router: Info: Info: disk0:asr9k-diags-supp-4.0.0.3P.CSCee30001-1.0.0 Info: disk0:asr9k-fpd-4.0.0.3P.CSCee40001-1.0.0 Info: Warning: There is no valid license found for package 'disk0:asr9k-mcast-supp-4.0.0.3P' Warning: when activating SMU 'disk0:asr9k-mcast-supp-4.0.0.3P.CSCee10001-1.0.0'. Warning: There is no valid license found for package 'disk0:asr9k-mgbl-supp-4.0.0.3P' Warning: when activating SMU 'disk0:asr9k-mgbl-supp-4.0.0.3P.CSCee20001-1.0.0'. Warning: Info: The following sequence of sub-operations has been determined to minimize any Info: impact: Info: Sub-operation 1: Info: Install Method: Parallel Process Restart Info: asr9k-mcast-supp-4.0.0.3P.CSCee10001-1.0.0 Info: Info: Sub-operation 2: Info: Install Method: Parallel Process Restart Info: asr9k-mgbl-supp-4.0.0.3P.CSCee20001-1.0.0 Info: Info: The changes made to software configurations will not be persistent Info: across system reloads. Use the command '(admin) install commit' to Info: make changes persistent. Info: Please verify that the system is consistent following the software Info: change using the following commands: Info: show system verify Info: install verify packages Install operation 8 completed successfully at 15:02:13 PST Wed Nov 25 2009. Related Topics Adding a License for a New Feature, on page 83 How to Configure Cisco IOS XR Software Entitlement Adding a License for a New Feature This task describes how to acquire a permanent license for a feature that you have purchased or an evaluation license for a feature that you have arranged with your sales representative to try. Use this procedure to replace evaluation licenses with permanent licenses. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 83 Software Entitlement on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router How to Configure Cisco IOS XR Software EntitlementBefore You Begin You must have purchased the feature for which you are adding the license. When you purchase the feature, you are provided with a product authorization key (PAK) that you use to download the license. SUMMARY STEPS 1. admin 2. show license udi 3. http://www.cisco.com/go/license 4. Copy the license to your TFTP server. 5. admin 6. license add license-name [ sdr sdr-name ] 7. license license-name location { all | node-id } 8. exit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose admin Enters administration EXEC mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# admin Step 1 Displays the UDI of the chassis. This consists of a product identifier (PID), serial number (S/N), and operation identifier (Operation ID). show license udi Example: Step 2 RP/0/0/CPU0:router# admin Mon Jul 13 04:36:30.715 PST RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show license udi Mon Jul 13 04:36:32.715 PST Local Chassis UDI Information: PID : ASR-9010-AC S/N : FOX1232H67M Operation ID: 1 Go to the license tool on Cisco.com. You must log in to the site before you can access the license tool. Follow the instructions for Step 3 http://www.cisco.com/go/license product license registration. You are required to enter the feature PAK and the chassis UDI to acquire the license. If you are installing a permanent license, you should have received the PAK when you purchased the feature. If you are installing an evaluation license, your sales representative should provide you with the PAK. Note Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 84 OL-26081-03 Software Entitlement on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Adding a License for a New FeatureCommand or Action Purpose You will be issued a license. You can copy the license and store it on your computer, or alternatively, you can request that the Step 4 Copy the license to your TFTP server. license be sent to you in an e-mail. When you have received the license, copy it to a TFTP server that is accessible by your router. Enters administration EXEC mode on the router to which you want to add the license. admin Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# admin RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# Step 5 Adds the license to the SDR license pool. By default, the license is added to the owner SDR license pool. license add license-name [ sdr sdr-name ] Example: Step 6 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# license add tftp://192.10.10.10/mylicenses/lc40g_lic license license-name location { all | node-id } Binds the license to the slot where it is to be used. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin-config)# license A9K-ADV-OPTIC-LIC location 0/0/CPU0 Step 7 exit Exits administration EXEC mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# exit Step 8 What to Do Next To use the feature associated with the added license, you must configure it on your router. To configure Layer 3 VPN,see the Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs on Cisco IOS XR Software module in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide. To verify that your Layer 3 VPN configuration is operational, use the show rsi interface all global command. Backing Up Licenses When your router is configured with the licenses that you require, you should perform this task to back up all licenses. Backing up licenses makes it easier to restore them if there is a problem. SUMMARY STEPS 1. admin 2. license backup backup-file 3. show license backup backup-file Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 85 Software Entitlement on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Backing Up LicensesDETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose admin Enters administration EXEC mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# admin Step 1 Backs up all licenses on the router to a backup file in the specified location. The backup file can be a local file or a remote file on a TFTP or RCP server. license backup backup-file Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# license backup disk1:/license_back Step 2 License command "license backup disk1:/license_back" completed successfully. show license backup backup-file Displays the contents of the backup file. Example: Step 3 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show license backup disk1:/license_back Examples The following example shows sample output from the show license backup command. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show license backup disk1:/license_back Local Chassis UDI Information: S/N : TBA09370035 Operation ID: 5 Licenses : FeatureID Type #installed CRS-MSC-40G Slot based, Permanent 2 XC-L3VPN Slot based, Permanent 1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show license backup disk0:/lic_backup.pkg Tue Jul 27 17:12:44.982 pst Local Chassis UDI Information: S/N : FOX1316G5TL Operation ID: 9 FeatureID: A9K-ADV-OPTIC-LIC (Slot based, Permanent) Total licenses 1 Pool: Owner 1 Allocated Node(s): 0/0/CPU0 1 [Owner] Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 86 OL-26081-03 Software Entitlement on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Backing Up LicensesFeatureID: A9K-ADV-VIDEO-LIC (Slot based, Evaluation) Total licenses 1 Pool: Owner 1 Allocated Node(s): 0/RSP0/CPU0 1 [Owner] FeatureID: A9K-AIP-LIC-B (Slot based, Permanent) Total licenses 2 Pool: Owner 2 Allocated Node(s): 0/6/CPU0 1 [Owner] 0/1/CPU0 1 [Owner] FeatureID: A9K-AIP-LIC-E (Slot based, Permanent) Total licenses 2 Pool: Owner 2 Allocated Node(s): 0/4/CPU0 1 [Owner] FeatureID: A9K-iVRF-LIC (Slot based, Permanent) Total licenses 1 Pool: Owner 1 FeatureID: A9K-iVRF-LIC (Slot based, Evaluation) Total licenses 3 Pool: Owner 3 Allocated Node(s): 0/1/CPU0 1 [Owner] Restoring Licenses If your licenses become corrupted, and you have previously created a backup of your licenses, you can perform this task to restore the licenses to your router. Before You Begin You must have created a backup file of your licenses before you can restore them on your router. SUMMARY STEPS 1. admin 2. show license backup backup-file 3. license restore backup-file DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose admin Enters administration EXEC mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# admin Step 1 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 87 Software Entitlement on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Restoring LicensesCommand or Action Purpose Displays the contents of the backup file. You should verify the contents of the backup file before you restore your licenses. show license backup backup-file Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show license backup disk1:/license_back Step 2 Restores all licenses on the router from a backup file in the specified location. This can be a local file, or a remote file on a TFTP or RCP server. license restore backup-file Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# license restore disk1:/license_back Step 3 Examples The following example shows sample output from the license restore command. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# license restore disk1:/license_back Info: This command will erase all existing licenses. Info: It is strongly recommended to backup existing licenses first. Do you wish to proceed? [yes/no]: y License command "license restore disk1:/license_back" completed successfully. Troubleshooting License Issues after a Software Upgrade In the instance that you were running Cisco IOS XR Release 3.9.0 and had the optic feature enabled on a interface and the A9K-ADV-OPTIC-LIC license was active on a particular slot, when you upgrade to Cisco IOS XR Release 4.0.0, the A9K-ADV-OPTIC-LIC license is still active, but you may get the following warning message: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:Jul 27 14:22:22.594 : licmgr[236]: %LICENSE-LICMGR-4-PACKAGE_LOCATION_LICENSE_INVALID : Feature associated to package A9K-ADV-OPTIC-LIC configured on node 0/4/CPU0 without a valid license To solve this issue, configure the license command in administration EXEC mode. This binds the A9K-ADV-OPTIC-LIC license to the slot on which you are using the license. For example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin-config)# license A9K-ADV-OPTIC-LIC location 0/4/CPU0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin-config)# commit Additional References The following sections provide references related to Cisco IOS XR software entitlement. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 88 OL-26081-03 Software Entitlement on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Troubleshooting License Issues after a Software UpgradeRelated Documents Related Topic Document Title Software Entitlement Commands on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Command Reference Cisco IOS XR software entitlement commands Implementing MPLS Layer 2 VPNs module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide Layer 2 VPN configuration Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide Layer 3 VPN configuration Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Commands Master List Cisco IOS XR software commands Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Getting Started Guide Information on getting started with Cisco IOS XR software Configuring AAA Services on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Security Configuration Guide Information about user groups and task IDs Standards Standards Title No new or modified standards are supported by this — feature, and support for existing standards has not been modified by this feature. MIBs MIBs MIBs Link To locate and download MIBs using Cisco IOS XR software, use the Cisco MIB Locator found at the following URL and choose a platform under the Cisco Access Products menu: http://cisco.com/public/ sw-center/netmgmt/cmtk/mibs.shtml — Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 89 Software Entitlement on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional ReferencesRFCs RFCs Title No new or modified RFCs are supported by this — feature, and support for existing RFCs has not been modified by this feature. Technical Assistance Description Link The Cisco Technical Support website contains http://www.cisco.com/techsupport thousands of pages of searchable technical content, including links to products, technologies, solutions, technical tips, and tools. Registered Cisco.com users can log in from this page to access even more content. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 90 OL-26081-03 Software Entitlement on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional ReferencesC H A P T E R 6 Managing the Router Hardware This chapter describes the command-line interface (CLI) techniques and commands used to manage and configure the hardware components of a router running the Cisco IOS XR software. For complete descriptions of the commands listed in this module, see Additional References, on page 119. To locate documentation for other commands that might appear in the course of performing a configuration task, search online in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Commands Master List. Table 13: Feature History for Managing Router Hardware with Cisco IOS XR Software Release Modification Release 3.7.2 This feature was introduced. This module contains the following topics: • Prerequisites for Managing Router Hardware, page 92 • Displaying Hardware Status, page 92 • RSP Redundancy and Switchover, page 107 • Reloading, Shutting Down, or Power Cycling a Node, page 111 • Flash Disk Recovery, page 115 • Using Controller Commands to Manage Hardware Components, page 115 • Formatting Hard Drives, Flash Drives, and Other Storage Devices, page 115 • Removing and Replacing Cards, page 116 • Upgrading the CPU Controller Bits, page 119 • Additional References, page 119 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 91Prerequisites for Managing Router Hardware You must be in a user group associated with a task group that includes the proper task IDs. The command reference guides include the task IDs required for each command. If you suspect user group assignment is preventing you from using a command, contact your AAA administrator for assistance. Displaying Hardware Status This section describes how to display different types of hardware status information. Displaying SDR Hardware Version Information To display hardware version information for the components assigned to a secure domain router (SDR), connect to the designated shelf controller (DSC) and enter the show diag command in EXEC mode. The displayed information includes the card serial number and the ROMMON software version. The syntax for the show diag command in EXEC mode is: show diag [node-id | details | summary] In the following example, the show diag command displays information for all nodes in the SDR: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show diag Mon Jun 29 00:36:41.576 PST NODE module 0/RSP0/CPU0 : MAIN: board type 0x100302 S/N: FOC1230803H Top Assy. Number: 68-3160-04 PID: A2K-RSP-4G-HDD= UDI_VID: VP4 HwRev: V4.8 New Deviation Number: 0 CLEI: IPUCARJBAA Board State : IOS XR RUN PLD: Motherboard: N/A, Processor: 0x8004 (rev: 2.2), Power: N/A MONLIB: QNXFFS Monlib Version 3.2 ROMMON: Version 1.0(20081208:173612) [ASR9K ROMMON] Board FPGA/CPLD/ASIC Hardware Revision: Compact Flash : V1.0 XbarSwitch0 : V1.3 XbarSwitch1 : V1.3 XbarArbiter : V1.0 XbarInterface : V0.0 IntCtrl : V1.14 ClkCtrl : V1.13 PuntFPGA : V1.5 HD : V3.0 USB0 : V77.20 USB1 : V77.20 CPUCtrl : V1.17 UTI : V1.6 LIU : V1.0 MLANSwitch : V0.0 EOBCSwitch : V2.0 CBC (active partition) : v1.2 CBC (inactive partition) : v1.1 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 92 OL-26081-03 Managing the Router Hardware Prerequisites for Managing Router HardwareNODE module 0/1/CPU0 : MAIN: board type 0x20207 S/N: FOC123081J6 Top Assy. Number: 68-3182-03 PID: A9K-40GE-B UDI_VID: V1D HwRev: V0.0 New Deviation Number: 0 CLEI: Board State : IOS XR RUN PLD: Motherboard: N/A, Processor: 0x8004 (rev: 2.2), Power: N/A ROMMON: Version 1.0(20081208:174521) [ASR9K ROMMON] Board FPGA/CPLD/ASIC Hardware Revision: NP0 : V3.194 NP1 : V3.194 NP2 : V3.194 NP3 : V3.194 XbarInterface : V18.4 Bridge0 : V0.38 Bridge1 : V0.38 CPUCtrl : V0.15 USB : V77.20 PortCtrl : V0.8 PHYCtrl : V0.6 40 Port Gigabit Ethernet Daughter board : V0.0 CBC (active partition) : v2.2 CBC (inactive partition) : v2.1 NODE module 0/4/CPU0 : MAIN: board type 0x2020a S/N: FOC123081JA Top Assy. Number: 68-3183-02 PID: A9K-8T/4-B UDI_VID: V1D HwRev: V0.0 New Deviation Number: 0 CLEI: IPU3AE0CAA Board State : IOS XR RUN PLD: Motherboard: N/A, Processor: 0x8004 (rev: 2.2), Power: N/A ROMMON: Version 1.0(20081208:174521) [ASR9K ROMMON] Board FPGA/CPLD/ASIC Hardware Revision: NP0 : V3.194 NP1 : V3.194 NP2 : V3.194 NP3 : V3.194 XbarInterface : V18.4 Bridge0 : V0.38 Bridge1 : V0.38 CPUCtrl : V0.15 USB : V77.20 PortCtrl : V0.10 PHYCtrl : V0.7 PHY0 : V0.16 PHY1 : V0.16 PHY2 : V0.16 PHY3 : V0.16 PHY4 : V0.16 PHY5 : V0.16 PHY6 : V0.16 PHY7 : V0.16 8 Port Ten Gigabit Ethernet Daughter board : V0.0 CBC (active partition) : v2.2 CBC (inactive partition) : v2.1 NODE module 0/6/CPU0 : MAIN: board type 0x20208 S/N: FHH12250033 Top Assy. Number: 68-3184-02 PID: A9K-4T-B Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 93 Managing the Router Hardware Displaying SDR Hardware Version InformationUDI_VID: V1D HwRev: V0.0 New Deviation Number: 0 CLEI: Board State : IOS XR RUN PLD: Motherboard: N/A, Processor: 0x8004 (rev: 2.2), Power: N/A ROMMON: Version 1.0(20081208:174521) [ASR9K ROMMON] Board FPGA/CPLD/ASIC Hardware Revision: NP0 : V3.194 NP1 : V3.194 NP2 : V3.194 NP3 : V3.194 XbarInterface : V18.4 Bridge0 : V0.38 Bridge1 : V0.38 CPUCtrl : V0.15 USB : V77.20 PHY0 : V0.16 PHY1 : V0.16 PHY2 : V0.16 PHY3 : V0.16 PortCtrl : V0.10 PHYCtrl : V0.7 4 Port Ten Gigabit Ethernet Daughter board : V0.0 CBC (active partition) : v2.2 CBC (inactive partition) : v2.1 In the following example, the show diag command displays information for a single node: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show diag 0/6/cpu0 Mon Jun 29 00:41:43.450 PST NODE module 0/6/CPU0 : MAIN: board type 0x20208 S/N: FHH12250033 Top Assy. Number: 68-3184-02 PID: A9K-4T-B UDI_VID: V1D HwRev: V0.0 New Deviation Number: 0 CLEI: Board State : IOS XR RUN PLD: Motherboard: N/A, Processor: 0x8004 (rev: 2.2), Power: N/A ROMMON: Version 1.0(20081208:174521) [ASR9K ROMMON] Board FPGA/CPLD/ASIC Hardware Revision: NP0 : V3.194 NP1 : V3.194 NP2 : V3.194 NP3 : V3.194 XbarInterface : V18.4 Bridge0 : V0.38 Bridge1 : V0.38 CPUCtrl : V0.15 USB : V77.20 PHY0 : V0.16 PHY1 : V0.16 PHY2 : V0.16 PHY3 : V0.16 PortCtrl : V0.10 PHYCtrl : V0.7 4 Port Ten Gigabit Ethernet Daughter board : V0.0 CBC (active partition) : v2.2 CBC (inactive partition) : v2.1 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 94 OL-26081-03 Managing the Router Hardware Displaying SDR Hardware Version InformationDisplaying System Hardware Version Information To display hardware version information for all or some of the components assigned in a system, connect to the designated shelf controller (DSC) and enter the show diag command in administration EXEC mode. When this command is entered in administration EXEC mode, you can display information on RSPs, line cards, and system components such as the chassis, fan trays, and power supplies. If you enter the show diag command in EXEC mode, the software displays only the hardware assigned to the SDR to which you are connected. Note The syntax for the show diag command in administration EXEC mode is: show diag [node-id | chassis | details | fans | memory | power-supply | summary] Tip For information on the software version, use the show version command. In the following example, the show diag command displays information for all nodes in the system: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show diag Mon Jun 29 01:21:04.571 PST NODE module 0/RSP0/CPU0 : MAIN: board type 0x100302 S/N: FOC1230803H Top Assy. Number: 68-3160-04 PID: A2K-RSP-4G-HDD= UDI_VID: VP4 HwRev: V4.8 New Deviation Number: 0 CLEI: IPUCARJBAA Board State : IOS XR RUN PLD: Motherboard: N/A, Processor: 0x8004 (rev: 2.2), Power: N/A MONLIB: QNXFFS Monlib Version 3.2 ROMMON: Version 1.0(20081208:173612) [ASR9K ROMMON] Board FPGA/CPLD/ASIC Hardware Revision: Compact Flash : V1.0 XbarSwitch0 : V1.3 XbarSwitch1 : V1.3 XbarArbiter : V1.0 XbarInterface : V0.0 IntCtrl : V1.14 ClkCtrl : V1.13 PuntFPGA : V1.5 HD : V3.0 USB0 : V77.20 USB1 : V77.20 CPUCtrl : V1.17 UTI : V1.6 LIU : V1.0 MLANSwitch : V0.0 EOBCSwitch : V2.0 CBC (active partition) : v1.2 CBC (inactive partition) : v1.1 NODE fantray 0/FT0/SP : MAIN: board type 0x900211 S/N: Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 95 Managing the Router Hardware Displaying System Hardware Version InformationTop Assy. Number: 32-0000-00 PID: UDI_VID: HwRev: V32.0 New Deviation Number: 0 CLEI: PLD: Motherboard: N/A, Processor: N/A, Power: N/A ROMMON: Board FPGA/CPLD/ASIC Hardware Revision: CBC (active partition) : v4.0 CBC (inactive partition) : v0.13 NODE fantray 0/FT1/SP : MAIN: board type 0x900211 S/N: Top Assy. Number: 32-0000-00 PID: UDI_VID: HwRev: V32.0 New Deviation Number: 0 CLEI: PLD: Motherboard: N/A, Processor: N/A, Power: N/A ROMMON: Board FPGA/CPLD/ASIC Hardware Revision: CBC (active partition) : v4.0 CBC (inactive partition) : v0.13 NODE module 0/1/CPU0 : MAIN: board type 0x20207 S/N: FOC123081J6 Top Assy. Number: 68-3182-03 PID: A9K-40GE-B UDI_VID: V1D HwRev: V0.0 New Deviation Number: 0 CLEI: Board State : IOS XR RUN PLD: Motherboard: N/A, Processor: 0x8004 (rev: 2.2), Power: N/A ROMMON: Version 1.0(20081208:174521) [ASR9K ROMMON] Board FPGA/CPLD/ASIC Hardware Revision: NP0 : V3.194 NP1 : V3.194 NP2 : V3.194 NP3 : V3.194 XbarInterface : V18.4 Bridge0 : V0.38 Bridge1 : V0.38 CPUCtrl : V0.15 USB : V77.20 PortCtrl : V0.8 PHYCtrl : V0.6 40 Port Gigabit Ethernet Daughter board : V0.0 CBC (active partition) : v2.2 CBC (inactive partition) : v2.1 NODE module 0/4/CPU0 : MAIN: board type 0x2020a S/N: FOC123081JA Top Assy. Number: 68-3183-02 PID: A9K-8T/4-B UDI_VID: V1D HwRev: V0.0 New Deviation Number: 0 CLEI: IPU3AE0CAA Board State : IOS XR RUN PLD: Motherboard: N/A, Processor: 0x8004 (rev: 2.2), Power: N/A ROMMON: Version 1.0(20081208:174521) [ASR9K ROMMON] Board FPGA/CPLD/ASIC Hardware Revision: NP0 : V3.194 NP1 : V3.194 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 96 OL-26081-03 Managing the Router Hardware Displaying System Hardware Version InformationNP2 : V3.194 NP3 : V3.194 XbarInterface : V18.4 Bridge0 : V0.38 Bridge1 : V0.38 CPUCtrl : V0.15 USB : V77.20 PortCtrl : V0.10 PHYCtrl : V0.7 PHY0 : V0.16 PHY1 : V0.16 PHY2 : V0.16 PHY3 : V0.16 PHY4 : V0.16 PHY5 : V0.16 PHY6 : V0.16 PHY7 : V0.16 8 Port Ten Gigabit Ethernet Daughter board : V0.0 CBC (active partition) : v2.2 CBC (inactive partition) : v2.1 NODE module 0/6/CPU0 : MAIN: board type 0x20208 S/N: FHH12250033 Top Assy. Number: 68-3184-02 PID: A9K-4T-B UDI_VID: V1D HwRev: V0.0 New Deviation Number: 0 CLEI: Board State : IOS XR RUN PLD: Motherboard: N/A, Processor: 0x8004 (rev: 2.2), Power: N/A ROMMON: Version 1.0(20081208:174521) [ASR9K ROMMON] Board FPGA/CPLD/ASIC Hardware Revision: NP0 : V3.194 NP1 : V3.194 NP2 : V3.194 NP3 : V3.194 XbarInterface : V18.4 Bridge0 : V0.38 Bridge1 : V0.38 CPUCtrl : V0.15 USB : V77.20 PHY0 : V0.16 PHY1 : V0.16 PHY2 : V0.16 PHY3 : V0.16 PortCtrl : V0.10 PHYCtrl : V0.7 4 Port Ten Gigabit Ethernet Daughter board : V0.0 CBC (active partition) : v2.2 CBC (inactive partition) : v2.1 NODE power-module 0/PM0/SP : MAIN: board type 0xf00188 S/N: Top Assy. Number: 341-00032-01 PID: A9K-3KW-AC UDI_VID: V00 HwRev: V0.0 New Deviation Number: 0 CLEI: ACACACACAC PLD: Motherboard: N/A, Processor: N/A, Power: N/A ROMMON: Board FPGA/CPLD/ASIC Hardware Revision: NODE power-module 0/PM1/SP : MAIN: board type 0xf00188 S/N: Top Assy. Number: 341-00032-01 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 97 Managing the Router Hardware Displaying System Hardware Version InformationPID: A9K-3KW-AC UDI_VID: V00 HwRev: V0.0 New Deviation Number: 0 CLEI: ACACACACAC PLD: Motherboard: N/A, Processor: N/A, Power: N/A ROMMON: Board FPGA/CPLD/ASIC Hardware Revision: NODE power-module 0/PM2/SP : MAIN: board type 0xf00188 S/N: Top Assy. Number: 341-00032-01 PID: A9K-3KW-AC UDI_VID: V00 HwRev: V0.0 New Deviation Number: 0 CLEI: ACACACACAC PLD: Motherboard: N/A, Processor: N/A, Power: N/A ROMMON: Board FPGA/CPLD/ASIC Hardware Revision: Rack 0 - ASR-9010 Chassis, Includes Accessories RACK NUM: 0 S/N: PID: ASR-9010 Backplane VID: 0.1 Desc: ASR-9010 Chassis, Includes Accessories CLEI: NOCLEI Top Assy. Number: 68-1234-56 In the following example, the show diag command displays information for a single system component: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show diag chassis Mon Jun 29 01:25:05.711 PST Rack 0 - ASR-9010 Chassis, Includes Accessories RACK NUM: 0 S/N: PID: ASR-9010 Backplane VID: 0.1 Desc: ASR-9010 Chassis, Includes Accessories CLEI: NOCLEI Top Assy. Number: 68-1234-56 Displaying Software and Hardware Information The show version command displays a variety of system information, including the hardware and software versions, router uptime, boot settings (including the configuration register), and active software. The following is sample output from the show version command: RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router# show version Sat Aug 1 22:52:39.089 DST Cisco IOS XR Software, Version 3.9.0.16I[DT_IMAGE] Copyright (c) 2009 by Cisco Systems, Inc. ROM: System Bootstrap, Version 1.1(20090521:183759) [ASR9K ROMMON], router uptime is 1 day, 2 hours, 34 minutes Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 98 OL-26081-03 Managing the Router Hardware Displaying Software and Hardware InformationSystem image file is "bootflash:disk0/asr9k-os-mbi-3.9.0.16I/mbiasr9k-rp.vm" cisco ASR9K Series (MPC8641D) processor with 4194304K bytes of memory. MPC8641D processor at 1333MHz, Revision 2.2 2 Management Ethernet 12 TenGigE 40 GigabitEthernet 219k bytes of non-volatile configuration memory. 975M bytes of compact flash card. 33994M bytes of hard disk. 1605616k bytes of disk0: (Sector size 512 bytes). 1605616k bytes of disk1: (Sector size 512 bytes). Configuration register on node 0/RSP0/CPU0 is 0x102 Boot device on node 0/RSP0/CPU0 is disk0: Package active on node 0/RSP0/CPU0: asr9k-scfclient, V 3.9.0.16I[DT_IMAGE], Cisco Systems, at disk0:asr9k-scfclient-3.9.0.16I Built on Thu Jul 30 12:09:40 DST 2009 By sjc-lds-208 in /auto/ioxbuild7/production/3.9.0.16I.DT_IMAGE/asr9k/workspace for c4.2.1-p0 asr9k-adv-video, V 3.9.0.16I[DT_IMAGE], Cisco Systems, at disk0:asr9k-adv-video-3.9.0.16I Built on Thu Jul 30 13:49:37 DST 2009 By sjc-lds-208 in /auto/ioxbuild7/production/3.9.0.16I.DT_IMAGE/asr9k/workspace for c4.2.1-p0 asr9k-fpd, V 3.9.0.16I[DT_IMAGE], Cisco Systems, at disk0:asr9k-fpd-3.9.0.16I Built on Thu Jul 30 12:26:21 DST 2009 By sjc-lds-208 in /auto/ioxbuild7/production/3.9.0.16I.DT_IMAGE/asr9k/workspace for c4.2.1-p0 asr9k-diags, V 3.9.0.16I[DT_IMAGE], Cisco Systems, at disk0:asr9k-diags-3.9.0.16I Built on Thu Jul 30 12:09:43 DST 2009 By sjc-lds-208 in /auto/ioxbuild7/production/3.9.0.16I.DT_IMAGE/asr9k/workspace for c4.2.1-p0 asr9k-k9sec, V 3.9.0.16I[DT_IMAGE], Cisco Systems, at disk0:asr9k-k9sec-3.9.0.16I Built on Thu Jul 30 12:25:25 DST 2009 By sjc-lds-208 in /auto/ioxbuild7/production/3.9.0.16I.DT_IMAGE/asr9k/workspace for c4.2.1-p0 asr9k-mgbl, V 3.9.0.16I[DT_IMAGE], Cisco Systems, at disk0:asr9k-mgbl-3.9.0.16I Built on Thu Jul 30 13:48:16 DST 2009 --More-- Displaying SDR Node IDs and Status In EXEC mode, the show platform command displays information for all nodes assigned to the owner SDR. For each node, this information includes the host card type, the operational state, and the configuration state. To display information on a single node, enter the command with a node ID. The syntax for the show platform command is: show platform [node-id] The following example displays the status for all nodes in the SDR to which you are connected: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show platform Mon Aug 3 07:39:01.416 DST Node Type State Config State ----------------------------------------------------------------------------- 0/RSP0/CPU0 A9K-RSP-4G(Active) IOS XR RUN PWR,NSHUT,MON 0/1/CPU0 A9K-40GE-B IOS XR RUN PWR,NSHUT,MON 0/4/CPU0 A9K-8T/4-B IOS XR RUN PWR,NSHUT,MON Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 99 Managing the Router Hardware Displaying SDR Node IDs and Status0/6/CPU0 A9K-4T-B IOS XR RUN PWR,NSHUT,MON The node-id appears in the rack/slot/module notation, and the node-id components are as follows: • rack —In a single-shelf system the rack number is always “0.” • slot —Number of the physical slot in which the card is installed. • module —Subslot number of a system hardware component. Table 14: Node ID Components, on page 100 summarizes the node-id for each type of card. Table 14: Node ID Components Module (the entity on the card that is the target of the command) Slot (the physical slot in which the card is installed) Card Type (the card to Rack (always “0”) which your are issuing commands) Route switch processor 0 RSP0 and RSP1 CPU0 0-X (SFP and XFP module number on the line card) 4-7 (6-slot chassis) 0–7 (10-slot chassis) 40-Port Gigabit Ethernet 0-255 Line Card 8-Port 10-Gigabit Ethernet Line Card 4-Port 10-Gigabit Ethernet Line Card PM0-PM5 (10-slot — chassis) PM0-PM2 (6-slot chassis Power Modules 0 Fan controller cards 0 FC0–FC1 — Displaying Router Node IDs and Status In administration EXEC mode, the show platform command displays information for all router nodes. In administration EXEC mode, the command display also includes additional node IDs such as those for fabric cards, alarm modules, and fan controllers. For each node, this information includes the host card type, the operational state, and the configuration state. To display information on a single node, enter the command with a node ID. The syntax for the show platform command is: show platform [node-id] The following example displays the status for all nodes in the system: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show platform Sat Mar 24 05:02:18.569 DST Node Type State Config State ----------------------------------------------------------------------------- Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 100 OL-26081-03 Managing the Router Hardware Displaying Router Node IDs and Status0/RSP0/CPU0 A9K-RSP-4G(Active) IOS XR RUN PWR,NSHUT,MON 0/1/CPU0 A9K-40GE-B IOS XR RUN PWR,NSHUT,MON 0/4/CPU0 A9K-8T/4-B IOS XR RUN PWR,NSHUT,MON 0/6/CPU0 A9K-4T-B IOS XR RUN PWR,NSHUT,MON The node-id appears in the rack/slot/module notation, and the node-id components are as follows: • rack —In a single-shelf system the rack number is always “0.” • slot —Number of the physical slot in which the card is installed. • module —Subslot number of a system hardware component. Table 14: Node ID Components, on page 100 summarizes the node-id argument for each type of card. Displaying Router Environment Information The show environment command displays hardware information for the system, including fan speeds, LED indications, power supply voltage and current information, and temperatures. The syntax for the show environment command is: show environment [options] You can use the show environment command options to limit the detail in the command display. To view the command options, enter the show environment ? command. The following example shows the full environment status report: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show environment Mon Jun 29 04:32:07.587 PST Temperature Information --------------------------------------------- R/S/I Modules Inlet Hotspot Temperature Temperature (deg C) (deg C) 0/1/* host 31.5 39.5 0/RSP0/* host 26.6 36.6 0/4/* host 29.8 38.8 0/6/* host 32.7 42.0 0/FT0/* host 27.2 28.2 0/FT1/* host 27.4 30.2 Voltage Information Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 101 Managing the Router Hardware Displaying Router Environment Information--------------------------------------------- R/S/I Modules Sensor (mV) Margin 0/1/* host IBV 10647 n/a host 5.0V 4929 n/a host VP3P3_CAN 3288 n/a host 3.3V 3301 n/a host 2.5V 2516 n/a host 1.8VB 1810 n/a host 1.2VB 1193 n/a host 1.8VA 1800 n/a host 0.9VB 884 n/a host 1.2V_LDO_BRG0 1193 n/a host 1.2V_LDO_BRG1 1195 n/a host 1.8VC 1811 n/a host 1.5VB 1505 n/a host 1.5VA 1503 n/a host 1.1V(1.05V_CPU) 1052 n/a host 0.75VA 751 n/a host 0.75VB_0.75VC 754 n/a host 1.1VB 1102 n/a host 1.2V_TCAM0 1003 n/a host 1.2V_TCAM1 1000 n/a host 1.0V_Bridge_LDO 998 n/a host 1.0VB 1043 n/a host 0.75VD_and_0.75VE 752 n/a host 1.2V_TCAM2 1005 n/a host 1.2V_TCAM3 1002 n/a host 1.5VC 1504 n/a host 1.8VD 1803 n/a host 1.1VC 1099 n/a host ZARLINK_3.3V 3272 n/a host ZARLINK_1.8V 1808 n/a host 1.2V_DB 1195 n/a host 3.3V_DB 3316 n/a host 2.5V_DB 2534 n/a host 1.5V_DB 1509 n/a 0/RSP0/* host 0.75VTT 749 n/a host 0.9VTT_A 910 n/a host 0.9VTT_B 904 n/a host IBV 10586 n/a host 5.0V 5013 n/a host VP3P3_CAN 3277 n/a host 3.3V 3299 n/a host 2.5V 2518 n/a host 1.8VB 1807 n/a host 1.2VA 1205 n/a host 1.2VB 1202 n/a host 1.05V 1047 n/a host 1.2VD 1205 n/a host 1.8VA 1811 n/a host 1.5V 1496 n/a host 1.9V 1887 n/a 0/4/* host IBV 10627 n/a host 5.0V 4917 n/a host VP3P3_CAN 3279 n/a host 3.3V 3296 n/a host 2.5V 2522 n/a host 1.8VB 1805 n/a host 1.2VB 1188 n/a host 1.8VA 1796 n/a host 0.9VB 881 n/a host 1.2V_LDO_BRG0 1192 n/a host 1.2V_LDO_BRG1 1195 n/a Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 102 OL-26081-03 Managing the Router Hardware Displaying Router Environment Informationhost 1.8VC 1806 n/a host 1.5VB 1510 n/a host 1.5VA 1503 n/a host 1.1V(1.05V_CPU) 1048 n/a host 0.75VA 753 n/a host 0.75VB_0.75VC 757 n/a host 1.1VB 1105 n/a host 1.2V_TCAM0 1003 n/a host 1.2V_TCAM1 1000 n/a host 1.0V_Bridge_LDO 997 n/a host 1.0VB 1037 n/a host 0.75VD_and_0.75VE 755 n/a host 1.2V_TCAM2 1004 n/a host 1.2V_TCAM3 1005 n/a host 1.5VC 1505 n/a host 1.8VD 1808 n/a host 1.1VC 1104 n/a host ZARLINK_3.3V 3285 n/a host ZARLINK_1.8V 1806 n/a host 1.2V_DB 1205 n/a host 3.3V_DB 3318 n/a host 2.5V_DB 2493 n/a host 1.5V_DB 1497 n/a host 1.8V_DB 1825 n/a host 5.0V_XFP_DB 5001 n/a host 1.2VB_DB 1228 n/a 0/6/* host IBV 10628 n/a host 5.0V 4893 n/a host VP3P3_CAN 3281 n/a host 3.3V 3297 n/a host 2.5V 2524 n/a host 1.8VB 1804 n/a host 1.2VB 1204 n/a host 1.8VA 1795 n/a host 0.9VB 881 n/a host 1.2V_LDO_BRG0 1194 n/a host 1.2V_LDO_BRG1 1193 n/a host 1.8VC 1815 n/a host 1.5VB 1495 n/a host 1.5VA 1503 n/a host 1.1V(1.05V_CPU) 1052 n/a host 0.75VA 752 n/a host 0.75VB_0.75VC 749 n/a host 1.1VB 1001 n/a host 1.2V_TCAM0 999 n/a host 1.2V_TCAM1 1002 n/a host 1.0V_Bridge_LDO 995 n/a host 1.0VB 1050 n/a host 0.75VD_and_0.75VE 752 n/a host 1.2V_TCAM2 1002 n/a host 1.2V_TCAM3 995 n/a host 1.5VC 1502 n/a host 1.8VD 1802 n/a host 1.1VC 1101 n/a host ZARLINK_3.3V 3273 n/a host ZARLINK_1.8V 1804 n/a host 1.2V_DB 1200 n/a host 3.3V_DB 3314 n/a host 2.5V_DB 2496 n/a host 1.5V_DB 1496 n/a host 1.8V_DB 1824 n/a host 5.0V_XFP_DB 5004 n/a host 1.2VB_DB 1227 n/a LED Information --------------------------------------------- R/S/I Modules LED Status Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 103 Managing the Router Hardware Displaying Router Environment Information0/RSP0/* host Critical-Alarm Off host Major-Alarm Off host Minor-Alarm Off host ACO Off Fan Information --------------------------------------------- Fan speed (rpm): FAN0 FAN1 FAN2 FAN3 FAN4 FAN5 FAN6 FAN7 FAN8 FAN9 FAN10 FAN11 0/FT0/* 3510 3510 3510 3540 3510 3570 3480 3570 3510 3510 3510 3510 0/FT1/* 3540 3510 3450 3540 3480 3600 3480 3450 3540 3540 3480 3540 Power Supply Information --------------------------------------------- R/S/I Modules Sensor Watts 0/PM0/* host PM 3000 0/PM1/* host PM 3000 0/PM2/* host PM 3000 Power Shelves Type: AC Total Power Capacity: 9000W Protected Power Capacity: 4500W Worst Case Power Used: 3145W Slot Max Watts ---- --------- 0/1/CPU0 375 0/RSP0/CPU0 250 0/RSP1/CPU0 350 0/4/CPU0 375 0/6/CPU0 375 0/FT0/SP 710 (default) 0/FT1/SP 710 (default) Worst Case Protected Power Available: 1355W Displaying RP Redundancy Status The show redundancy command displays the redundancy status of the route switch processors (RSPs). This command also displays the boot and switch-over history for the RSPs. The show redundancy operates in EXEC and administration EXEC mode. In the following example, the show redundancy command displays the redundancy status for a redundant RSP pair: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show redundancy Mon Jun 29 04:49:26.098 PST Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 104 OL-26081-03 Managing the Router Hardware Displaying RP Redundancy StatusRedundancy information for node 0/RSP0/CPU0: ========================================== Node 0/RSP0/CPU0 is in ACTIVE role Node 0/RSP0/CPU0 has no valid partner Reload and boot info ---------------------- A9K-RSP-4G reloaded Thu Jun 11 15:20:50 2009: 2 weeks, 3 days, 13 hours, 28 minutes ago Active node booted Thu Jun 11 15:20:50 2009: 2 weeks, 3 days, 13 hours, 28 minutes ago Active node reload "Cause: Turboboot completed successfully" Displaying Field-Programmable Device Compatibility The show hw-module fpd command displaysfield-programmable device (FPD) compatibility for all modules or a specific module. The syntax for the show hw-module fpd command is: show hw-module fpd location {all | node-id} The show hw-module fpd operates in EXEC and administration EXEC mode. The following example shows how to display FPD compatibility for all modules in the router: RP/0/RSP1/CPU0:router# show hw-module fpd location all Mon Jun 29 05:38:50.332 PST ===================================== ========================================== Existing Field Programmable Devices ========================================== HW Current SW Upg/ Location Card Type Version Type Subtype Inst Version Dng? ============ ======================== ======= ==== ======= ==== =========== ==== 0/RSP0/CPU0 A9K-RSP-4G 4.8 lc fpga3 0 1.13 No lc fpga1 0 1.5 No lc fpga2 0 1.14 No lc cbc 0 1.2 No lc fpga4 0 1.6 No lc rommon 0 1.0 No -------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 0/RSP0/CPU0 ASR-9010-FAN 1.0 lc cbc 1 4.0 No -------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 0/RSP0/CPU0 ASR-9010-FAN 1.0 lc cbc 2 4.0 No -------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 0/1/CPU0 A9K-40GE-B 1.0 lc fpga1 0 0.38 No lc fpga2 0 0.8 No lc cbc 0 2.2 No lc cpld1 0 0.15 No lc rommon 0 1.0 No -------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 0/1/CPU0 A9K-40GE-B 1.0 lc fpga1 1 0.38 No -------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 0/4/CPU0 A9K-8T/4-B 1.0 lc fpga1 0 0.38 No lc fpga2 0 0.10 No lc cbc 0 2.2 No lc cpld2 0 0.7 No lc cpld1 0 0.15 No lc cpld3 0 0.3 No lc rommon 0 1.0 No lc fpga3 0 14.42 No -------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 0/4/CPU0 A9K-8T/4-B 1.0 lc fpga1 1 0.38 No -------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 0/6/CPU0 A9K-4T-B 1.0 lc fpga1 0 0.38 No lc fpga2 0 0.10 No lc cbc 0 2.2 No lc cpld2 0 0.7 No Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 105 Managing the Router Hardware Displaying Field-Programmable Device Compatibilitylc cpld1 0 0.15 No lc cpld3 0 0.3 No lc rommon 0 1.0 No lc fpga3 0 14.42 No -------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 0/6/CPU0 A9K-4T-B 1.0 lc fpga1 1 0.38 No -------------------------------------------------------------------------------- The following example shows how to display FPD compatibility for a specific module in the router: RP/0/RSP1/CPU0:router# show hw-module fpd location 0/4/cpu0 Thu Nov 19 21:43:49.599 UTC ===================================== ========================================== Existing Field Programmable Devices ========================================== HW Current SW Upg/ Location Card Type Version Type Subtype Inst Version Dng? ============ ======================== ======= ==== ======= ==== =========== ==== 0/4/CPU0 A9K-SIP-700 1.13 lc fpga1 0 0.22 No lc cbc 0 3.03 No lc hsbi 0 3.00 No lc rommon 0 1.02 No lc fpga2 0 5.14 No lc cpld1 0 0.14 No -------------------------------------------------------------------------------- Table 15: show hw-module fpd Field Descriptions Field Description Location of the module in the rack/slot/module notation. Location Card Type Module part number. HW Version Hardware model version for the module. Hardware type. Can be one of the following types: • spa—Shared port adapter • lc—Line card Type FPD type. Can be one of the following types: • fabldr—Fabric downloader • fpga1—Field-programmable gate array • fpga2—Field-programmable gate array 2 • fpga3—Field-programmable gate array 3 • fpga4—Field-programmable gate array 4 • fpga5—Field-programmable gate array 5 • rommonA—Read-only memory monitor A • rommon—Read-only memory monitor B Subtype Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 106 OL-26081-03 Managing the Router Hardware Displaying Field-Programmable Device CompatibilityField Description FPD instance. The FPD instance uniquely identifies an FPD and is used by the FPD process to register an FPD. Inst Current SW Version Currently running FPD image version. Specifies whether an FPD upgrade or downgrade is required. A downgrade isrequired in rare cases when the version of the FPD image has a higher major revision than the version of the FPD image in the current Cisco IOS XR software package. Upg/Dng? RSP Redundancy and Switchover This section describes RSP redundancy and switchover commands and issues. Establishing RSP Redundancy Your router has two slots for RSPs: RSP0 and RSP1 (see Figure 3: Redundant Set of RSPs Installed in Slots RSP0 and RSP1 in an 8-Slot Chassis, on page 108). RSP0 is the slot on the left, facing the fron of the chassis, Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 107 Managing the Router Hardware RSP Redundancy and Switchoverand RSP1 isthe slot on right. These slots are configured for redundancy by default, and the redundancy cannot be eliminated. To establish RSP redundancy, install RSPs into both slots. Figure 3: Redundant Set of RSPs Installed in Slots RSP0 and RSP1 in an 8-Slot Chassis Determining the Active RP in a Redundant Pair During system startup, one RSP in each redundant pair becomes the active RSP. You can tell which RSP is the active RSP in the following ways: • The active RSP can be identified by the green Primary LED on the faceplate of the card. The active RSP is indicated when the Primary LED is on. The alphanumeric LED display on the RSP displays ACTV RP. • The slot of the active RSP is indicated in the CLI prompt. For example: RP/0/RSP1/CPU0:router# In this example, the prompt indicates that you are communicating with the active RSP in slot RSP1. See Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Getting Started Guide for a complete description of the CLI prompt. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 108 OL-26081-03 Managing the Router Hardware Determining the Active RP in a Redundant Pair• Enter the show redundancy command in EXEC mode to display a summary of the active and standby RSP status. For example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show redundancy Mon Jun 29 04:49:26.098 PST Redundancy information for node 0/RSP0/CPU0: ========================================== Node 0/RSP0/CPU0 is in ACTIVE role Node 0/RSP0/CPU0 has no valid partner Reload and boot info ---------------------- A9K-RSP-4G reloaded Thu Jun 11 15:20:50 2009: 2 weeks, 3 days, 13 hours, 28 minutes ago Active node booted Thu Jun 11 15:20:50 2009: 2 weeks, 3 days, 13 hours, 28 minutes ago Active node reload "Cause: Turboboot completed successfully" Role of the Standby RSP The second RSP to boot in a redundant pair automatically becomes the standby RSP. While the active RSP manages the system and communicates with the user interface, the standby RSP maintains a complete backup of the software and configurations for all cards in the system. If the active RSP fails or goes off line for any reason, the standby RSP immediately takes control of the system. Summary of Redundancy Commands RSP redundancy is enabled by default in the Cisco IOS XR software, but you can use the commands described in Table 16: RSP Redundancy Commands, on page 109 to display the redundancy status of the cards or force a manual switchover. Table 16: RSP Redundancy Commands Command Description Displays the redundancy status of the RSPs. This command also displays the boot and switch-over history for the RSPs. show redundancy Forces a manualswitchover to the standby RSP. This command works only if the standby RSP is installed and in the “ready” state. redundancy switchover Displaysthe statusfor node, including the redundancy status of the RSP cards. In EXEC mode, this command displays status for the nodes assigned to the SDR. In administration EXEC mode, this command displays status for all nodes in the system. show platform Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 109 Managing the Router Hardware Role of the Standby RSPAutomatic Switchover Automatic switchover from the active RSP to the standby RSP occurs only if the active RSP encounters a serious system error, such as the loss of a mandatory process or a hardware failure. When an automatic switchover occurs, the RSPs respond as follows: • If a standby RSP is installed and “ready” for switchover, the standby RSP becomes the active RSP. The original active RSP attempts to reboot. • If the standby RSP is not in “ready” state, then both RSPs reboot. The first RSP to boot successfully assumes the role of active RSP. RSP Redundancy During RSP Reload The reload command causes the active RSP to reload the Cisco IOS XR software. When an RSP reload occurs, the RSPs respond as follows: • If a standby RSP is installed and “ready” for switchover, the standby RSP becomes the active RSP. The original active RSP reboots and becomes the standby RSP. • If the standby RSP is not in the “ready” state, then both RSPs reboot. The first RSP to boot successfully assumes the role of active RSP. You should not use the reload command to force an RSP switchover because the result could be a significant loss of router operations. Instead, use the redundancy switchover command to fail over to the standby RSP, then use the hw-module location node-id reload command to reload the new standby RSP. Caution Related Topics Reloading, Shutting Down, or Power Cycling a Node, on page 111 Manual Switchover You can force a manualswitchover from the active RSP to the standby RSP using the redundancy switchover command. If a standby RSP is installed and ready for switchover, the standby RSP becomes the active RSP. The original active RSP becomes the standby RSP. In the following example, partial output for a successful redundancy switchover operation is shown: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show redundancy This node (0/RSP0/CPU0) is in ACTIVE role Partner node (0/RSP1/CPU0) is in STANDBY role Standby node in 0/RSP1/CPU0 is ready RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# redundancy switchover Updating Commit Database. Please wait...[OK] Proceed with switchover 0/RSP0/CPU0 -> 0/RSP1/CPU0? [confirm] Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 110 OL-26081-03 Managing the Router Hardware Automatic SwitchoverInitiating switch-over. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# In the preceding example, the Telnet connection is lost when the previously active RP resets. To continue management of the router, you must connect to the newly activated RP as shown in the following example: User Access Verification Username: xxxxx Password: xxxxx Last switch-over Sat Apr 15 12:26:47 2009: 1 minute ago RP/0/RSP1/CPU0:router# If the standby RSP is not in “ready” state, the switchover operation is not allowed. In the following example, partial output for a failed redundancy switchover attempt is shown: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show redundancy Redundancy information for node 0/RP1/CPU0: ========================================== Node 0/RSP0/CPU0 is in ACTIVE role Partner node (0/RSP1/CPU0) is in UNKNOWN role Reload and boot info ---------------------- RP reloaded Wed Mar 29 17:22:08 2009: 2 weeks, 2 days, 19 hours, 14 minutes ago Active node booted Sat Apr 15 12:27:58 2009: 8 minutes ago Last switch-over Sat Apr 15 12:35:42 2009: 1 minute ago There have been 4 switch-overs since reload RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# redundancy switchover Switchover disallowed: Standby node is not ready. Communicating with a Standby RP The active RSP automatically synchronizes all system software, settings, and configurations with the standby RSP. If you connect to the standby RSP through the console port, you can view the status messages for the standby RSP. The standby RSP does not display a CLI prompt, so you cannot manage the standby card while it is in standby mode. If you connect to the standby RSP through the management Ethernet port, the prompt that appears is for the active RSP, and you can manage the router the same asif you had connected through the management Ethernet port on the active RSP. Reloading, Shutting Down, or Power Cycling a Node Use the commands described in this section to reload the Cisco IOS XR software on the active RSP or on any specified node in the system. This section also describes the commands used to administratively shut down a node and power a node on or off. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 111 Managing the Router Hardware Communicating with a Standby RPTable 17: Commands to Reload, Shut Down, or Power Cycle a Node, on page 112 summarizes the commands described in this section. Table 17: Commands to Reload, Shut Down, or Power Cycle a Node Command Description This command administratively turns the power off for a node. It is entered in administration configuration mode. The changes do not take effect until you enter the commit command. To power on a node, use the no form of this command. This command cannot be used to disable power on the RSP from which the command is entered. Note hw-module location node-id power disable This command works in EXEC mode and reloads the Cisco IOS XR software on a specific node or all nodes. To specify all nodes, enter the all keyword in place of the node-id argument. The node reloads with the current running configuration and active software set for that node. hw-module location node-id reload This command must be entered in administration configuration mode and administratively shuts down the specified node. Nodesthat are shut down still have power but cannot load or operate Cisco IOS XR software. To return a node to the up state, use the no form of this command. This command cannot be used to shut down the RSP from which the command is entered. Note hw-module shutdown location node-id Causes the active RSP to reload the Cisco IOS XR software according to the configuration register setting (for example, 0x0 to enter ROMMON bootstrap mode and 0x2102 to reload the RSP to EXEC mode). The reload command can be entered in EXEC or administration EXEC modes, and you can see additional options by entering the reload ? command. See the Reloading the Active RSP , on page 113 for more information. reload Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 112 OL-26081-03 Managing the Router Hardware Reloading, Shutting Down, or Power Cycling a NodeCommand Description Displays the configuration register setting for the router. • Use this command in administration EXEC mode to see the variables for both RSPs. • The configuration register setting determines how the router boots during a system reset. The most common configuration register settings are: ? 0x2102: The active RSP loads the Cisco IOS XR software and default configuration on the next system boot. After logging in, the user can access EXEC mode. ? 0x0: The active RSP enters the bootstrap ROM Monitor (rommon B1>) on the next system boot. show variables boot Reloading the Active RSP The reload command causes the active RSP to reload the Cisco IOS XR software according to the configuration register setting. This setting determines how the active RSP acts when reloaded. This section contains instructions to reload the Cisco IOS XR software and return to EXEC mode. For instructions to use the reload command for entering ROM Monitor bootstrap mode, see Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router ROM Monitor Guide. Because the reload command causes the active RSP to go off line and either reload the Cisco IOS XR software or enter ROM Monitor mode, the router experiences a loss of service unless a redundant standby RSP is installed and in “ready” state. To display the status of the standby RSP, use the show redundancy command in EXEC mode. Caution SUMMARY STEPS 1. show redundancy 2. admin 3. show variables boot 4. (Optional) config-register 0x2102 5. admin 6. reload Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 113 Managing the Router Hardware Reloading the Active RSPDETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 show redundancy Displays the RSP redundancy status. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show redundancy • If a standby RSP is in “ready” redundancy state, the reload command also causes the router to gracefully fail over to the standby RSP. admin Enters administration EXEC mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# admin Step 2 Step 3 show variables boot Displays the configuration register setting. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show variables boot • Enter this command in administration EXEC mode. • For normal operations, the configuration registersetting is 0x2102, which causes the active RSP to reload the Cisco IOS XR software. • Verify that the configuration register setting is 0x2102. If it is not, complete Step 4, on page 114 to reset the configuration register to 0x2102. For instructions on how to enter ROM Monitor bootstrap mode, see Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router ROM Monitor Guide. Note (Optional) Sets the configuration register to 0x2102. This step is necessary only if the register is not set to 0x2102 in the running configuration. config-register 0x2102 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# config-register 0x2102 Step 4 admin Enters administration EXEC mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# admin Step 5 Step 6 reload Reloads the active RSP according to the configuration register setting. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# reload • If the setting is 0x2102, then the RSP reloadsthe Cisco IOS XR software. • If the standby RSP is in “ready” redundancy state, the router switches over to the standby RSP. • If a standby RSP is not installed or not in a “ready” state, the router experiences a loss of service while the active RSP is reloading the Cisco IOS XR software. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 114 OL-26081-03 Managing the Router Hardware Reloading the Active RSPFlash Disk Recovery When an RSP is power cycled or experiences an ungraceful reset, the boot disk (PCMCIA flash disk used to boot the card) may experience a file-system corruption. If this occurs, an error message is displayed and the RSP fails to boot. The corrupted flash disk is automatically reformatted and the Cisco IOS XR software is restored from the designated system controller (DSC) for the system. For example, if a flash disk for an RSP is corrupted, the RP fails to boot and the following error message is displayed: ######################################################### Restricted Rights Legend Use, duplication, or disclosure by the Government is subject to restrictions as set forth in subparagraph (c) of the Commercial Computer Software - Restricted Rights clause at FAR sec. 52.227-19 and subparagraph (c) (1) (ii) of the Rights in Technical Data and Computer Software clause at DFARS sec. 252.227-7013. cisco Systems, Inc. 170 West Tasman Drive San Jose, California 95134-1706 Cisco IOS XR Software for the Cisco XR Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router-mbirp, Copyright (c) 2009 by Cisco Systems, Inc. Unable to mount /disk0:, filesystem is corrupted. Check fsck log at /tmp/chkfs_fd0.log init: special_commands:wait for disk0: failed If this occurs, then the flash disk is automatically reformatted and the Cisco IOS XR software is restored to the flash disk. If the flash disk is badly damaged and cannot be reformatted, the disk must be replaced. If the corrupted flash disk is the DSC, then the router fails over to the standby DSC. If no standby DSC is installed, then the system fails to boot. Note Using Controller Commands to Manage Hardware Components The controller , controllers , and show controllers commands are used to manage and display settings for various hardware components, including the switch fabric management, Ethernet control plane, and interface manager. These commands are primarily diagnostic and related to driver-level details. The information available with these commands varies widely and is hardware specific. For information on the use of these commands, see Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Interface and Hardware Component Command Reference. Formatting Hard Drives, Flash Drives, and Other Storage Devices To format a storage device on the router, use the format command in EXEC mode. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 115 Managing the Router Hardware Flash Disk RecoveryCaution Formatting a storage device deletes all data on that device. The following command syntax is used: format filesystem: [options] Table 18: format command Syntax Description, on page 116 describes the format command syntax. Table 18: format command Syntax Description Variable Description Specifiesthe memory device to format. The supported file systems are: • bootflash: • compactflash: • configflash: • harddisk: • harddiska: • disk0: • disk1: Enter format ? to see the devices supported on your router. filesystem Enter format filesystem: ? to see the available options. For more information, see Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Command Reference. options In the following example, the format command is used to format the hard disk: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# format harddisk: Removing and Replacing Cards This section describes card replacement issues and procedures. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 116 OL-26081-03 Managing the Router Hardware Removing and Replacing CardsRemoving Line Cards Line cards are designed for online insertion and removal (OIR). A line card is a single card that contains all service processing functions and physical line interfaces. The OIR feature allows you to remove and replace cards without removing power to the card or chassis. Removing a card interrupts all traffic passing through the card, but it does not remove the card configuration. When you remove a card, the configuration remains for all interfaces, but the interfaces do not appear in the output of the show interfaces command. You can view interface configurations by entering the show running-config command. The following example shows how the configuration appears when a card is removed: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show running-config Building configuration... hostname router router ospf 3269 area 0 interface POS0/3/0/0 cost 20 ! interface preconfigure POS0/3/0/0 ipv4 address 10.10.50.1 255.255.255.0 ! interface preconfigure POS0/3/0/1 description POS0/3/0/1 shutdown ! interface preconfigure POS0/3/0/2 description POS0/3/0/2 shutdown ! interface preconfigure POS0/3/0/3 description POS0/3/0/3 shutdown ! In this example, the line card in slot 3 isremoved, and the interface configuration for all four interfaces changes to “interface preconfigure.” However, the “router ospf” reference to a slot 3 interface does not change. If you replace a line card with another line card that uses the same media type and port count, the configuration becomes active on the replacement card. To remove the configuration for a slot after a card is removed, use the no interface preconfigure command to remove all interface configuration statements for that card in the running configuration. In addition, search the configuration for any references to the removed interfaces, such as the “router ospf” reference to slot 3 in the preceding example. To remove the configuration for a slot when a card is installed, use the no interface command to remove all interface configuration statements for that card in the running configuration. In addition, search the configuration for any references to the removed interfaces. Each line card supports a specific media type (Packet over SONET/SDH [POS] or Ethernet, for example) and port count. If you replace a line card with one that supports a different media type or port count, you should review the configuration and revise it to support the replacement line card. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 117 Managing the Router Hardware Removing Line CardsReplacing a Line Card with the Same Media Type and Port Count When you replace a line card or PLIM with a card that is of the same media type and has the same port count asthe replaced card, the guidelinesin the Removing Line Cards, on page 117 apply. Because the replacement card is of the same media type and port count, no special procedures are required for card removal and replacement. Replacing a Line Card with the Same Media Type and a Different Port Count When you replace a line card with a card that is of the same media type with a different port count, the guidelines in Removing Line Cards , on page 117 apply. If the new card has a greater port count than the replaced card, the configuration applies to the corresponding lower port numbers, and the ports that did not exist on the replaced card have no configuration and come up in the shutdown state. If the new card supports fewer ports, the existing configuration for the corresponding number of ports on the new card set is applied. The previous configuration for the removed ports remains in interface preconfigure state, as shown in the following example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show running-config Building configuration... hostname rtp-gsr1 interface POS0/3/0/0 ipv4 address 10.10.50.1 255.255.255.0 ! interface preconfigure POS0/3/0/1 description POS0/3/0/1 shutdown ! interface preconfigure POS0/3/0/2 description POS0/3/0/2 shutdown ! interface preconfigure POS0/3/0/3 description POS0/3/0/3 shutdown ! In the preceding example, a four-port card has been replaced with a single-port card. The configuration from port 1 on the four-port card is applied to the single port on the replacement card, and the remaining port configurations change to “interface preconfigure.” To remove the configuration for the missing interfaces, use the no interface preconfigure command. In addition,search for and remove any configuration references to the removed interfaces. Whenever you replace a line card with the same media type and a different port count, review the running configuration in the router and revise the configuration as necessary. Replacing a Line Card or PLIM with a Different Media Type When you replace a line card or PLIM with a card that is of a different media type (for example, if you replace a POS PLIM with an Ethernet PLIM), the guidelines in Removing Line Cards , on page 117 apply. Review the running configuration in the router and revise the configuration as necessary for the new media type. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 118 OL-26081-03 Managing the Router Hardware Removing Line CardsUpgrading the CPU Controller Bits Use this procedure to upgrade the CPU controller bits on all nodes that are installed in the router or on a specific node. SUMMARY STEPS 1. admin 2. upgrade cpuctrlbits {all | location node-id} DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose admin Enters administration EXEC mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# admin Step 1 Step 2 upgrade cpuctrlbits {all | location node-id} Upgrades the CPU controller bits on all nodes in the router. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# upgrade cpuctrlbits all Use the location node-id keyword and argument to upgrade the CPU controller bits on a specific node. Examples The following example shows how to upgrade the CPU controller bits on all nodes in a router: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# admin RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# upgrade cpucrtlbits all Please do not power cycle, reload the router or reset any nodes until all upgrades are completed. Please check the syslog to make sure that all nodes are upgraded successfully. If you need to perform multiple upgrades, please wait for current upgrade to be completed before proceeding to another upgrade. Failure to do so may render the cards under upgrade to be unusable. Additional References The following sections provide references related to hardware management on Cisco IOS XR software. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 119 Managing the Router Hardware Upgrading the CPU Controller BitsRelated Documents Related Topic Document Title Hardware Redundancy and Node Administration Commands on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Command Reference Cisco IOS XR hardware commands See Cisco Carrier Routing System Install and Upgrade Guides at: http://www.cisco.com/en/US/products/ ps5763/ prod_installation_guides_list.html Cisco IOS XR hardware documentation Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Getting Started Guide Information about getting started with Cisco IOS XR software Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router ROM Monitor Guide ROM Monitor Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Commands Master List Cisco IOS XR command master list Configuring AAA Services on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Security Configuration Guide Information about user groups and task IDs Standards Standards Title No new or modified standards are supported by this — feature, and support for existing standards has not been modified by this feature. MIBs MIBs MIBs Link To locate and download MIBs using Cisco IOS XR software, use the Cisco MIB Locator found at the following URL and choose a platform under the Cisco Access Products menu: http://cisco.com/public/ sw-center/netmgmt/cmtk/mibs.shtml — Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 120 OL-26081-03 Managing the Router Hardware Additional ReferencesRFCs RFCs Title No new or modified RFCs are supported by this — feature, and support for existing RFCs has not been modified by this feature. Technical Assistance Description Link The Cisco Technical Support website contains http://www.cisco.com/techsupport thousands of pages of searchable technical content, including links to products, technologies, solutions, technical tips, and tools. Registered Cisco.com users can log in from this page to access even more content. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 121 Managing the Router Hardware Additional References Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 122 OL-26081-03 Managing the Router Hardware Additional ReferencesC H A P T E R 7 Upgrading FPD on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router In general terms, field-programmable devices (FPDs) are hardware devices implemented on router cards thatsupportseparate software upgrades. A field-programmable gate array (FPGA) is a type of programmable memory device that exists on most hardware components of the router. The term FPD has been introduced to collectively and generically describe any type of programmable hardware device on SIPs and shared port adapters(SPAs), including FPGAs and the read-only memory monitor (ROMMON). Cisco IOS XR software provides the Cisco FPD upgrade feature to manage the upgrade of FPD images on SIPs and SPAs. This chapter describes the information that you must know to verify image versions and to perform an upgrade for SPA or SIP FPD images when incompatibilities arise. For complete descriptions of the FPD commands listed in this module, see Related Documents, on page 141. To locate documentation for other commandsthat might appear in the course of performing a configuration task, search online in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Commands Master List. Table 19: Feature History for Upgrading FPD Software on Cisco IOS XR Software Release Modification Release 3.9.0 Support for FPD upgrades was introduced. This module contains the following topics: • Prerequisites for FPD Image Upgrades, page 124 • Overview of FPD Image Upgrade Support, page 124 • How to Upgrade FPD Images, page 125 • Configuration Examples for FPD Image Upgrade, page 128 • Troubleshooting Problems with FPD Image Upgrades, page 140 • Additional References, page 141 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 123Prerequisites for FPD Image Upgrades Before upgrading the FPD on your router you must install and activate the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router-fpd.pie. For information about performing this task, see the Upgrading and Managing the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide. Overview of FPD Image Upgrade Support An FPD image is used to upgrade the software on an FPD. Whenever a Cisco IOS XR Software image is released thatsupports SIPs and SPAs, a companion SIP and SPA FPD image is bundled with the Cisco IOS XR software release. Generally, the FPD image is not automatically upgraded. You must manually upgrade the FPD image running on the SPA or SIP when you upgrade the Cisco IOS XR software image. FPD versions must be compatible with the Cisco IOS XR software that is running on the router; if an incompatibility exists between an FPD version and the Cisco IOS XR software, the device with the FPGA may not operate properly until the incompatibility is resolved. An FPGA incompatibility on a SPA does not necessarily affect the running of the SPA interfaces; an FPD incompatibility on a SIP disables all interfaces for all SPAs in the SIP until the incompatibility is addressed. Use the show hw-module fpd command to determine if an FPD upgrade is required. A value of ‘Yes’ in the Upg/Dng? (upgrade/downgrade) column indicates that an upgrade or downgrade is required. The Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router supports upgrades for FPGA devices on its SIPs and SPAs. FPGA and ROMMON software upgrades are part of an FPD image package that correspondsto a Cisco IOS XR software image. SIPs and SPAs support manual upgrades for FPGA devices using the Cisco FPD upgrade feature that is further described in this chapter. Related Topics show hw-module fpd Command Output: Example, on page 128 Automatic FPD Upgrade By default, the FPD image is not automatically upgraded. Generally, you must manually upgrade the FPD image running on the SPA or SIP when you upgrade the Cisco IOS XR software image. However, if you enable the fpd auto-upgrade command in administration configuration mode, FPD images are automatically updated whenever you perform a software upgrade. For the automatic FPD upgrade to work, the following conditions must be met: • The FPD package installation envelope (PIE) must already be installed on the router. • The FPD PIE must be activated together with the new Cisco IOS XR image. • The fpd auto-upgrade command must be enabled. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 124 OL-26081-03 Upgrading FPD on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Prerequisites for FPD Image UpgradesAlthough the FPD upgrade is performed during the install operation, there is no install commit performed. Therefore, once the FPD has been upgraded, if the image is rolled back to the original version, the FPD version is not downgraded to the previous version. Note The automatic FPD upgrade is not performed in the following instances: • Line cards or other cards such as RSPs, SPAs or alarm cards are added to an existing router. • A non-reload software maintenance upgrade (SMU) or PIE installation is performed, even where the FPD image version changes. Since a non-reload installation is, by definition, not supposed to reload the router, and an FPD upgrade requires a router reload, the automatic FPD upgrade is repressed. In all cases where the automatic FPD upgrade is not performed, you must perform a manual FPD upgrade using the upgrade hw-module fpd command. Note How to Upgrade FPD Images You must determine if an FPD image upgrade is needed using the show hw-module fpd command and perform the upgrade, if needed, under the following circumstances: • You migrate the software to a later Cisco IOS XR software release. • You swap SPAs or SIPs from a system running a different Cisco IOS XR software release. • You insert a new SPA or SIP. In the event that there is an FPD incompatibility with your card, you may receive an error message. If you upgrade to a newer version of the Cisco IOS XR software and there is an FPD incompatibility, you receive the following message: LC/0/1/CPU0:Dec 23 16:33:47.945 : spa_192_jacket_v2[203]: %PLATFORM-UPGRADE_FPD-4-DOWN_REV : spa fpga2 instance 0 is down-rev (V0.6), upgrade to (V1.0). Use the "upgrade hw-module fpd" CLI in admin mode. If the FPD image on the card is newer then what is required by the currently running Cisco IOS XR software image on the router, you receive the following error message: LC/0/1/CPU0:Dec 23 16:33:47.955 : spa_192_jacket_v2[203]: %PLATFORM-UPGRADE_FPD-4-UP_REV : spa fpga instance 1 is severely up-rev (V2.1), downgrade to (V1.6). Use the "upgrade hw-module fpd" CLI in admin mode. You should perform the FPD upgrade procedure if you receive such messages. Cards may not function properly if FPD incompatibilities are not resolved. Before You Begin • Before upgrading the FPD, you must install and activate the asr9k-fpd.pie. For information about performing this task, see the Upgrading and Managing Cisco IOS XR Software module. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 125 Upgrading FPD on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router How to Upgrade FPD Images• The FPD upgrade procedure is performed while the card is online. At the end of the procedure the card must be reloaded before the FPD upgrade is complete. To automatically reload the card, you can use the hw-module reload command during your next maintenance window. The upgrade procedure is not complete until the card is reloaded. • During the FPD upgrade, you must not do the following: ? Reload, perform an online insertion and removal (OIR) of a line card (LC), or power down the chassis. Doing so may cause the node to enter an unusable state. ? Press Ctrl-C if the console appears to hang without any output. Doing so may abort the upgrade. • If you are not sure whether a card requires an FPD upgrade, you can install the card and use the show hw-module fpd command to determine if the FPD image on the card is compatible with the currently running Cisco IOS XR software release. SUMMARY STEPS 1. show hw-module fpd location {all | node-id} 2. admin 3. (Optional) show fpd package 4. upgrade hw-module fpd {all | fpga-type} [force] location [all | node-id] 5. exit 6. (Optional) hw-module {location node-id | subslot subslot-id} reload 7. show platform DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Displays the current FPD image versions for the specified card or all cards installed in the router. Use this command to determine if you must upgrade the FPD image on your card. show hw-module fpd location {all | node-id} Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show hw-module fpd location all Step 1 or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show hw-module fpd location 0/4/cpu0 admin Enters administration EXEC mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# admin Step 2 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 126 OL-26081-03 Upgrading FPD on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router How to Upgrade FPD ImagesCommand or Action Purpose (Optional) Displays which cards are supported with your current Cisco IOS XR software release, which FPD image you need for each card, and what the minimum show fpd package Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# show fpd package Step 3 hardware requirements are for the various modules. (A minimum hardware requirement version of 0.0 indicates that all hardware can support this FPD image version.) If there are multiple FPD imagesfor your card, use this command to determine which FPD image to use if you want to upgrade only a specific FPD type. Upgrades all the current FPD images that must be upgraded on the specified card with new images. upgrade hw-module fpd {all | fpga-type} [force] location [all | node-id] Step 4 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# upgrade Before continuing to the next step, wait for confirmation that the FPD upgrade has successfully completed. Status messages, similar to these, are displayed to the screen until the FPD upgrade is completed: FPD upgrade started. hw-module fpd all force location 0/3/1 . . FPD upgrade in progress.. . FPD upgrade in progress.. Successfully upgraded 1 FPD for SPA-2XOC48POS/RPR on location 0/3/1 FPD upgrade sent to location xxxx FPD upgrade sent to location yyyy FPD upgrade in progress.. FPD upgrade finished for location xxx FPD upgrade in progress.. FPD upgrade finished for location yyyy FPD upgrade completed. The “FPD upgrade in progress.” message is printed every minute. These logs are information logs, and as such, are displayed if the logging console informational command is configured. If Ctrl-C is pressed while the FPD upgrade isin progress, the following warning message is displayed: FPD upgrade in progress on some hardware, aborting now is not recommended as it might cause HW programming failure and result in RMA of the hardware. Do you want to continue? [Confirm(y/n)] If you confirm that you want to abort the FPD upgrade procedure, this message is displayed: FPD upgrade process has been aborted, please check the status of the hardware and reissue the upgrade command if required. If your card supports multiple FPD images, you can use the show fpd package admin command to determine what specific image to upgrade in the upgrade hw-module fpd command. Note Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 127 Upgrading FPD on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router How to Upgrade FPD ImagesCommand or Action Purpose exit Exits administration EXEC mode and returns to EXEC mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# exit Step 5 (Optional) Use the hw-module subslot reload command to reload a SPA and the hw-module location reload command to reload a SIP or line card. hw-module {location node-id | subslot subslot-id} reload Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# hw-module subslot 0/3/1 reload Step 6 or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# hw-module location 0/3/cpu0 reload Verifies that the FPD image on the card has been successfully upgraded by displaying the status of all cards in the system. show platform Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show platform Step 7 Configuration Examples for FPD Image Upgrade The following examples indicates the use of commands associated with the FPD image upgrade procedure. show hw-module fpd Command Output: Example Use the show hw-module fpd to display the current version of FPD images on the SPAs, SIPs and other cards installed on your router. This command can be used to identify information about FPDs on any card. If you enter the location of a line card that is not a SPA, the output displays information about any programmable devices on that line card. The following example shows how to display FPD compatibility for all modules in the router: RP/0/RSP1/CPU0:router# show hw-module fpd location all Mon Jun 29 05:38:50.332 PST ===================================== ========================================== Existing Field Programmable Devices ========================================== HW Current SW Upg/ Location Card Type Version Type Subtype Inst Version Dng? ============ ======================== ======= ==== ======= ==== =========== ==== 0/RSP0/CPU0 A9K-RSP-4G 4.8 lc fpga3 0 1.13 No lc fpga1 0 1.5 No lc fpga2 0 1.14 No lc cbc 0 1.2 No Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 128 OL-26081-03 Upgrading FPD on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuration Examples for FPD Image Upgradelc fpga4 0 1.6 No lc rommon 0 1.0 No -------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 0/RSP0/CPU0 ASR-9010-FAN 1.0 lc cbc 1 4.0 No -------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 0/RSP0/CPU0 ASR-9010-FAN 1.0 lc cbc 2 4.0 No -------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 0/1/CPU0 A9K-40GE-B 1.0 lc fpga1 0 0.38 No lc fpga2 0 0.8 No lc cbc 0 2.2 No lc cpld1 0 0.15 No lc rommon 0 1.0 No -------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 0/1/CPU0 A9K-40GE-B 1.0 lc fpga1 1 0.38 No -------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 0/4/CPU0 A9K-8T/4-B 1.0 lc fpga1 0 0.38 No lc fpga2 0 0.10 No lc cbc 0 2.2 No lc cpld2 0 0.7 No lc cpld1 0 0.15 No lc cpld3 0 0.3 No lc rommon 0 1.0 No lc fpga3 0 14.42 No -------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 0/4/CPU0 A9K-8T/4-B 1.0 lc fpga1 1 0.38 No -------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 0/6/CPU0 A9K-4T-B 1.0 lc fpga1 0 0.38 No lc fpga2 0 0.10 No lc cbc 0 2.2 No lc cpld2 0 0.7 No lc cpld1 0 0.15 No lc cpld3 0 0.3 No lc rommon 0 1.0 No lc fpga3 0 14.42 No -------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 0/6/CPU0 A9K-4T-B 1.0 lc fpga1 1 0.38 No -------------------------------------------------------------------------------- The following example shows how to display FPD compatibility for a specific module in the router: RP/0/RSP1/CPU0:router# show hw-module fpd location 0/4/cpu0 Thu Nov 19 21:43:49.599 UTC ===================================== ========================================== Existing Field Programmable Devices ========================================== HW Current SW Upg/ Location Card Type Version Type Subtype Inst Version Dng? ============ ======================== ======= ==== ======= ==== =========== ==== 0/4/CPU0 A9K-SIP-700 1.13 lc fpga1 0 0.22 No lc cbc 0 3.03 No lc hsbi 0 3.00 No lc rommon 0 1.02 No lc fpga2 0 5.14 No lc cpld1 0 0.14 No -------------------------------------------------------------------------------- Table 20: show hw-module fpd Field Descriptions Field Description Location of the module in the rack/slot/module notation. Location Card Type Module part number. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 129 Upgrading FPD on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router show hw-module fpd Command Output: ExampleField Description HW Version Hardware model version for the module. Hardware type. Can be one of the following types: • spa—Shared port adapter • lc—Line card Type FPD type. Can be one of the following types: • fabldr—Fabric downloader • fpga1—Field-programmable gate array • fpga2—Field-programmable gate array 2 • fpga3—Field-programmable gate array 3 • fpga4—Field-programmable gate array 4 • fpga5—Field-programmable gate array 5 • rommonA—Read-only memory monitor A • rommon—Read-only memory monitor B Subtype FPD instance. The FPD instance uniquely identifies an FPD and is used by the FPD process to register an FPD. Inst Current SW Version Currently running FPD image version. Specifies whether an FPD upgrade or downgrade is required. A downgrade isrequired in rare cases when the version of the FPD image has a higher major revision than the version of the FPD image in the current Cisco IOS XR software package. Upg/Dng? show fpd package Command Output: Example Use the show fpd package command in administration EXEC mode to find out which SPAs and SIPs are supported with your current Cisco IOS XR software release, which FPD image package you need for each SPA or SIP, and what the minimum hardware requirements are for each module. If multiple FPD images are available for your card, they are listed as Subtype fpga2, fpga3, and so on. The following example shows sample output from the show fpd package command: RP/0/RP1/CPU0:router(admin)# show fpd package Thu Jul 7 04:34:48.351 DST =============================== ================================================ Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 130 OL-26081-03 Upgrading FPD on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router show fpd package Command Output: ExampleField Programmable Device Package ================================================ SW Min Req Min Req Card Type FPD Description Type Subtype Version SW Ver HW Vers ==================== ========================== ==== ======= =========== ======== ========= A9K-40GE-B Can Bus Ctrl (CBC) LC2 lc cbc 2.02 0.0 0.1 CPUCtrl LC2 lc cpld1 1.00 0.0 0.1 PHYCtrl LC2 lc cpld2 0.06 0.0 0.1 PortCtrl LC2 lc fpga2 0.10 0.0 0.1 Bridge LC2 lc fpga1 0.43 0.0 0.1 ROMMONA LC2 lc rommonA 1.05 0.0 0.1 ROMMONB LC2 lc rommon 1.05 0.0 0.1 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- A9K-4T-B Can Bus Ctrl (CBC) LC2 lc cbc 2.02 0.0 0.1 CPUCtrl LC2 lc cpld1 1.00 0.0 0.1 PHYCtrl LC2 lc cpld2 0.08 0.0 0.1 LCClkCtrl LC2 lc cpld3 0.03 0.0 0.1 PortCtrl LC2 lc fpga2 0.10 0.0 0.1 PHY LC2 lc fpga3 14.44 0.0 0.1 Bridge LC2 lc fpga1 0.43 0.0 0.1 ROMMONB LC2 lc rommon 1.05 0.0 0.1 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- A9K-8T/4-B Can Bus Ctrl (CBC) LC2 lc cbc 2.02 0.0 0.1 CPUCtrl LC2 lc cpld1 1.00 0.0 0.1 PHYCtrl LC2 lc cpld2 0.08 0.0 0.1 LCClkCtrl LC2 lc cpld3 0.03 0.0 0.1 PortCtrl LC2 lc fpga2 0.10 0.0 0.1 PHY LC2 lc fpga3 14.44 0.0 0.1 Bridge LC2 lc fpga1 0.43 0.0 0.1 ROMMONB LC2 lc rommon 1.05 0.0 0.1 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- A9K-2T20GE-B Can Bus Ctrl (CBC) LC2 lc cbc 2.02 0.0 0.1 CPUCtrl LC2 lc cpld1 1.00 0.0 0.1 PHYCtrl LC2 lc cpld2 0.11 0.0 0.1 LCClkCtrl LC2 lc cpld3 0.09 0.0 0.1 PortCtrl LC2 lc fpga2 0.16 0.0 0.1 Bridge LC2 lc fpga1 0.43 0.0 0.1 ROMMONB LC2 lc rommon 1.05 0.0 0.1 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- A9K-40GE-E Can Bus Ctrl (CBC) LC2 lc cbc 2.02 0.0 0.1 CPUCtrl LC2 lc cpld1 1.00 0.0 0.1 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 131 Upgrading FPD on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router show fpd package Command Output: ExamplePHYCtrl LC2 lc cpld2 0.06 0.0 0.1 PortCtrl LC2 lc fpga2 0.10 0.0 0.1 Bridge LC2 lc fpga1 0.43 0.0 0.1 ROMMONA LC2 lc rommonA 1.05 0.0 0.1 ROMMONB LC2 lc rommon 1.05 0.0 0.1 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- A9K-4T-E Can Bus Ctrl (CBC) LC2 lc cbc 2.02 0.0 0.1 CPUCtrl LC2 lc cpld1 1.00 0.0 0.1 PHYCtrl LC2 lc cpld2 0.08 0.0 0.1 LCClkCtrl LC2 lc cpld3 0.03 0.0 0.1 PortCtrl LC2 lc fpga2 0.10 0.0 0.1 PHY LC2 lc fpga3 14.44 0.0 0.1 Bridge LC2 lc fpga1 0.43 0.0 0.1 ROMMONB LC2 lc rommon 1.05 0.0 0.1 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- A9K-8T/4-E Can Bus Ctrl (CBC) LC2 lc cbc 2.02 0.0 0.1 CPUCtrl LC2 lc cpld1 1.00 0.0 0.1 PHYCtrl LC2 lc cpld2 0.08 0.0 0.1 LCClkCtrl LC2 lc cpld3 0.03 0.0 0.1 PortCtrl LC2 lc fpga2 0.10 0.0 0.1 PHY LC2 lc fpga3 14.44 0.0 0.1 Bridge LC2 lc fpga1 0.43 0.0 0.1 ROMMONB LC2 lc rommon 1.05 0.0 0.1 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- A9K-2T20GE-E Can Bus Ctrl (CBC) LC2 lc cbc 2.02 0.0 0.1 CPUCtrl LC2 lc cpld1 1.00 0.0 0.1 PHYCtrl LC2 lc cpld2 0.11 0.0 0.1 LCClkCtrl LC2 lc cpld3 0.09 0.0 0.1 PortCtrl LC2 lc fpga2 0.16 0.0 0.1 Bridge LC2 lc fpga1 0.43 0.0 0.1 ROMMONB LC2 lc rommon 1.05 0.0 0.1 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- A9K-8T-B Can Bus Ctrl (CBC) LC3 lc cbc 6.02 0.0 0.1 CPUCtrl LC3 lc cpld1 1.02 0.0 0.1 PHYCtrl LC3 lc cpld2 0.08 0.0 0.1 LCClkCtrl LC3 lc cpld3 0.03 0.0 0.1 DB CPUCtrl LC3 lc cpld4 1.03 0.0 0.1 PortCtrl LC3 lc fpga2 0.11 0.0 0.1 Raven LC3 lc fpga1 1.02 0.0 0.1 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 132 OL-26081-03 Upgrading FPD on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router show fpd package Command Output: ExampleROMMONB LC3 lc rommon 1.03 0.0 0.1 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- A9K-16T/8-B Can Bus Ctrl (CBC) LC3 lc cbc 6.02 0.0 0.1 CPUCtrl LC3 lc cpld1 1.02 0.0 0.1 PHYCtrl LC3 lc cpld2 0.04 0.0 0.1 LCClkCtrl LC3 lc cpld3 0.01 0.0 0.1 DB CPUCtrl LC3 lc cpld4 1.03 0.0 0.1 PortCtrl LC3 lc fpga2 0.01 0.0 0.1 Raven LC3 lc fpga1 1.02 0.0 0.1 ROMMONB LC3 lc rommon 1.03 0.0 0.1 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- A9K-16T/8-B Can Bus Ctrl (CBC) LC3 lc cbc 6.02 0.0 0.1 CPUCtrl LC3 lc cpld1 1.02 0.0 0.1 PHYCtrl LC3 lc cpld2 0.04 0.0 0.1 LCClkCtrl LC3 lc cpld3 0.01 0.0 0.1 DB CPUCtrl LC3 lc cpld4 1.03 0.0 0.1 PortCtrl LC3 lc fpga2 0.01 0.0 0.1 Raven LC3 lc fpga1 1.02 0.0 0.1 ROMMONB LC3 lc rommon 1.03 0.0 0.1 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- A9K-8T-E Can Bus Ctrl (CBC) LC3 lc cbc 6.02 0.0 0.1 CPUCtrl LC3 lc cpld1 1.02 0.0 0.1 PHYCtrl LC3 lc cpld2 0.08 0.0 0.1 LCClkCtrl LC3 lc cpld3 0.03 0.0 0.1 CPUCtrl LC3 lc cpld4 1.03 0.0 0.1 PortCtrl LC3 lc fpga2 0.11 0.0 0.1 Raven LC3 lc fpga1 1.02 0.0 0.1 ROMMONB LC3 lc rommon 1.03 0.0 0.1 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- A9K-16T/8-E Can Bus Ctrl (CBC) LC3 lc cbc 6.02 0.0 0.1 CPUCtrl LC3 lc cpld1 1.02 0.0 0.1 PHYCtrl LC3 lc cpld2 0.04 0.0 0.1 LCClkCtrl LC3 lc cpld3 0.01 0.0 0.1 DB CPUCtrl LC3 lc cpld4 1.03 0.0 0.1 PortCtrl LC3 lc fpga2 0.01 0.0 0.1 Raven LC3 lc fpga1 1.02 0.0 0.1 ROMMONB LC3 lc rommon 1.03 0.0 0.1 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- A9K-16T/8-E Can Bus Ctrl (CBC) LC3 lc cbc 6.02 0.0 0.1 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 133 Upgrading FPD on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router show fpd package Command Output: ExampleCPUCtrl LC3 lc cpld1 1.02 0.0 0.1 PHYCtrl LC3 lc cpld2 0.04 0.0 0.1 LCClkCtrl LC3 lc cpld3 0.01 0.0 0.1 DB CPUCtrl LC3 lc cpld4 1.03 0.0 0.1 PortCtrl LC3 lc fpga2 0.01 0.0 0.1 Raven LC3 lc fpga1 1.02 0.0 0.1 ROMMONB LC3 lc rommon 1.03 0.0 0.1 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- A9K-40GE-L Can Bus Ctrl (CBC) LC2 lc cbc 2.02 0.0 0.1 CPUCtrl LC2 lc cpld1 1.00 0.0 0.1 PHYCtrl LC2 lc cpld2 0.06 0.0 0.1 PortCtrl LC2 lc fpga2 0.10 0.0 0.1 Bridge LC2 lc fpga1 0.43 0.0 0.1 ROMMONB LC2 lc rommon 1.05 0.0 0.1 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- A9K-4T-L Can Bus Ctrl (CBC) LC2 lc cbc 2.02 0.0 0.1 CPUCtrl LC2 lc cpld1 1.00 0.0 0.1 PHYCtrl LC2 lc cpld2 0.08 0.0 0.1 LCClkCtrl LC2 lc cpld3 0.03 0.0 0.1 PortCtrl LC2 lc fpga2 0.10 0.0 0.1 Serdes Upgrade LC2 lc fpga3 14.44 0.0 0.1 Bridge LC2 lc fpga1 0.43 0.0 0.1 ROMMONB LC2 lc rommon 1.05 0.0 0.1 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- A9K-8T/4-L Can Bus Ctrl (CBC) LC2 lc cbc 2.02 0.0 0.1 CPUCtrl LC2 lc cpld1 1.00 0.0 0.1 PHYCtrl LC2 lc cpld2 0.08 0.0 0.1 LCClkCtrl LC2 lc cpld3 0.03 0.0 0.1 PortCtrl LC2 lc fpga2 0.10 0.0 0.1 Serdes Upgrade LC2 lc fpga3 14.44 0.0 0.1 Bridge LC2 lc fpga1 0.43 0.0 0.1 ROMMONB LC2 lc rommon 1.05 0.0 0.1 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- A9K-2T20GE-L Can Bus Ctrl (CBC) LC2 lc cbc 2.02 0.0 0.1 CPUCtrl LC2 lc cpld1 1.00 0.0 0.1 PHYCtrl LC2 lc cpld2 0.11 0.0 0.1 LCClkCtrl LC2 lc cpld3 0.09 0.0 0.1 Tomcat LC2 lc fpga2 0.16 0.0 0.1 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 134 OL-26081-03 Upgrading FPD on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router show fpd package Command Output: ExampleBridge LC2 lc fpga1 0.43 0.0 0.1 ROMMONB LC2 lc rommon 1.05 0.0 0.1 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- A9K-8T-L Can Bus Ctrl (CBC) LC3 lc cbc 6.02 0.0 0.1 CPUCtrl LC3 lc cpld1 1.02 0.0 0.1 PHYCtrl LC3 lc cpld2 0.08 0.0 0.1 LCClkCtrl LC3 lc cpld3 0.03 0.0 0.1 CPUCtrl LC3 lc cpld4 1.03 0.0 0.1 PortCtrl LC3 lc fpga2 0.11 0.0 0.1 Raven LC3 lc fpga1 1.02 0.0 0.1 ROMMONB LC3 lc rommon 1.03 0.0 0.1 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- A9K-16T/8-L Can Bus Ctrl (CBC) LC3 lc cbc 6.02 0.0 0.1 CPUCtrl LC3 lc cpld1 1.02 0.0 0.1 PHYCtrl LC3 lc cpld2 0.04 0.0 0.1 LCClkCtrl LC3 lc cpld3 0.01 0.0 0.1 DB CPUCtrl LC3 lc cpld4 1.03 0.0 0.1 PortCtrl LC3 lc fpga2 0.01 0.0 0.1 Raven LC3 lc fpga1 1.02 0.0 0.1 ROMMONB LC3 lc rommon 1.03 0.0 0.1 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- A9K-SIP-700 Can Bus Ctrl (CBC) LC5 lc cbc 3.05 0.0 0.1 CPUCtrl LC5 lc cpld1 0.15 0.0 0.1 QFPCPUBridge LC5 lc fpga2 5.14 0.0 0.1 NPUXBarBridge LC5 lc fpga1 0.22 0.0 0.1 ROMMONA LC5 lc rommonA 1.03 0.0 0.1 ROMMONB LC5 lc rommon 1.03 0.0 0.1 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- A9K-SIP-500 Can Bus Ctrl (CBC) LC5 lc cbc 3.05 0.0 0.1 CPUCtrl LC5 lc cpld1 0.15 0.0 0.1 QFPCPUBridge LC5 lc fpga2 5.14 0.0 0.1 NPUXBarBridge LC5 lc fpga1 0.22 0.0 0.1 ROMMONA LC5 lc rommonA 1.03 0.0 0.1 ROMMONB LC5 lc rommon 1.03 0.0 0.1 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- A9K-RSP-2G Can Bus Ctrl (CBC) RSP2 lc cbc 1.02 0.0 0.1 CPUCtrl RSP2 lc cpld2 1.17 0.0 0.1 IntCtrl RSP2 lc fpga2 1.15 0.0 0.1 ClkCtrl RSP2 lc fpga3 1.23 0.0 0.1 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 135 Upgrading FPD on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router show fpd package Command Output: ExampleUTI RSP2 lc fpga4 3.08 0.0 0.1 PUNT RSP2 lc fpga1 1.05 0.0 0.1 HSBI RSP2 lc hsbi 4.00 0.0 0.1 ROMMONA RSP2 lc rommonA 1.05 0.0 0.1 ROMMONB RSP2 lc rommon 1.05 0.0 0.1 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- A9K-RSP-4G Can Bus Ctrl (CBC) RSP2 lc cbc 1.02 0.0 0.1 CPUCtrl RSP2 lc cpld2 1.17 0.0 0.1 IntCtrl RSP2 lc fpga2 1.15 0.0 0.1 ClkCtrl RSP2 lc fpga3 1.23 0.0 0.1 UTI RSP2 lc fpga4 3.08 0.0 0.1 PUNT RSP2 lc fpga1 1.05 0.0 0.1 HSBI RSP2 lc hsbi 4.00 0.0 0.1 ROMMONA RSP2 lc rommonA 1.05 0.0 0.1 ROMMONB RSP2 lc rommon 1.05 0.0 0.1 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- A9K-RSP-8G Can Bus Ctrl (CBC) RSP2 lc cbc 1.02 0.0 0.1 CPUCtrl RSP2 lc cpld2 1.17 0.0 0.1 IntCtrl RSP2 lc fpga2 1.15 0.0 0.1 ClkCtrl RSP2 lc fpga3 1.23 0.0 0.1 UTI RSP2 lc fpga4 3.08 0.0 0.1 PUNT RSP2 lc fpga1 1.05 0.0 0.1 HSBI RSP2 lc hsbi 4.00 0.0 0.1 ROMMONA RSP2 lc rommonA 1.05 0.0 0.1 ROMMONB RSP2 lc rommon 1.05 0.0 0.1 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- ASR-9010-FAN Can Bus Ctrl (CBC) FAN lc cbc 4.00 0.0 0.1 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- ASR-9006-FAN Can Bus Ctrl (CBC) FAN lc cbc 5.00 0.0 0.1 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- A9K-BPID2-10-SLOT Can Bus Ctrl (CBC) BP2 lc cbc 7.103 0.0 0.1 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- A9K-BPID2-6-SLOT Can Bus Ctrl (CBC) BP2 lc cbc 7.103 0.0 0.1 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- A9K-ISM-100 Can Bus Ctrl (CBC) LC6 lc cbc 18.05 0.0 0.1 CPUCtrl LC6 lc cpld1 0.01 0.0 0.1 Maintenance LC6 lc fpga2 1.00 0.0 0.1 Amistad LC6 lc fpga1 0.25 0.0 0.20 ROMMONA LC6 lc rommonA 1.02 0.0 0.1 ROMMONB LC6 lc rommon 1.02 0.0 0.1 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 136 OL-26081-03 Upgrading FPD on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router show fpd package Command Output: Example---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- A9K-8T-B CPUCtrl LC3 lc cpld1 1.02 0.0 0.1 PHYCtrl LC3 lc cpld2 0.08 0.0 0.1 DB CPUCtrl LC3 lc cpld4 1.03 0.0 0.1 PortCtrl LC3 lc fpga2 0.11 0.0 0.1 Raven LC3 lc fpga1 1.02 0.0 0.1 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- A9K-8T-E CPUCtrl LC3 lc cpld1 1.02 0.0 0.1 DB CPUCtrl LC3 lc cpld4 1.03 0.0 0.1 PortCtrl LC3 lc fpga2 0.11 0.0 0.1 Raven LC3 lc fpga1 1.02 0.0 0.1 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- SPA-4XT3/E3 SPA E3 Subrate FPGA spa fpga2 1.04 0.0 0.0 SPA T3 Subrate FPGA spa fpga3 1.04 0.0 0.0 SPA I/O FPGA spa fpga1 1.01 0.0 0.0 SPA ROMMON spa rommon 2.12 0.0 0.0 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- SPA-2XT3/E3 SPA E3 Subrate FPGA spa fpga2 1.04 0.0 0.0 SPA T3 Subrate FPGA spa fpga3 1.04 0.0 0.0 SPA I/O FPGA spa fpga1 1.01 0.0 0.0 SPA ROMMON spa rommon 2.12 0.0 0.0 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- SPA-4XCT3/DS0 SPA T3 Subrate FPGA spa fpga2 0.11 0.0 0.100 SPA T3 Subrate FPGA spa fpga2 1.04 0.0 0.200 SPA I/O FPGA spa fpga1 2.08 0.0 0.100 SPA ROMMON spa rommon 2.12 0.0 0.100 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- SPA-2XCT3/DS0 SPA T3 Subrate FPGA spa fpga2 0.11 0.0 0.100 SPA T3 Subrate FPGA spa fpga2 1.04 0.0 0.200 SPA I/O FPGA spa fpga1 2.08 0.0 0.100 SPA ROMMON spa rommon 2.12 0.0 0.100 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- SPA-1XCHSTM1/OC3 SPA T3 Subrate FPGA spa fpga2 1.04 0.0 0.0 SPA I/O FPGA spa fpga1 1.08 0.0 0.0 SPA ROMMON spa rommon 2.12 0.0 0.0 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- SPA-1XCHOC48/DS3 SPA I/O FPGA spa fpga2 1.00 0.0 0.49 SPA I/O FPGA spa fpga3 1.00 0.0 0.52 SPA I/O FPGA spa fpga1 1.36 0.0 0.49 SPA ROMMON spa rommon 2.02 0.0 0.49 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- SPA-2XCHOC12/DS0 SPA FPGA2 swv1.00 spa fpga2 1.00 0.0 0.0 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 137 Upgrading FPD on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router show fpd package Command Output: ExampleSPA FPGA swv1.36 spa fpga1 1.36 0.0 0.49 SPA ROMMON swv2.2 spa rommon 2.02 0.0 0.49 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- SPA-8XOC12-POS SPA FPGA swv1.0 spa fpga1 1.00 0.0 0.5 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- SPA-8XCHT1/E1 SPA I/O FPGA spa fpga1 2.08 0.0 0.0 SPA ROMMON spa rommon 2.12 0.0 0.140 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- SPA-OC192POS-XFP SPA FPGA swv1.2 hwv2 spa fpga1 1.02 0.0 2.0 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- SPA-2XOC48POS/RPR SPA FPGA swv1.0 spa fpga1 1.00 0.0 0.0 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- SPA-8XOC3-POS SPA FPGA swv1.0 spa fpga1 1.00 0.0 0.5 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- SPA-10X1GE-V2 SPA FPGA swv1.10 spa fpga1 1.10 0.0 0.0 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- SPA-5X1GE-V2 SPA FPGA swv1.10 spa fpga1 1.10 0.0 0.0 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- SPA-1X10GE-L-V2 SPA FPGA swv1.9 spa fpga1 1.09 0.0 0.0 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- SPA-4XOC3-POS-V2 SPA FPGA swv1.0 spa fpga1 1.00 0.0 0.5 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- SPA-1X10GE-WL-V2 SPA FPGA swv1.9 spa fpga1 1.09 0.0 0.0 ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- This table describes the significant fields shown in the display: Table 21: show fpd package Field Descriptions Field Description Card Type Module part number. FPD Description Description of all FPD images available for the SPA. Hardware type. Possible types can be: • spa—Shared port adapter • lc—Line card Type FPD subtype. These values are used in the upgrade hw-module fpd command to indicate a specific FPD image type to upgrade. Subtype FPD software version recommended for the associated module running the current Cisco IOS XR software. SW Version Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 138 OL-26081-03 Upgrading FPD on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router show fpd package Command Output: ExampleField Description Minimum required FPD image software version to operate the card. Version 0.0 indicatesthat a minimum required image was not programmed into the card. Min Req SW Vers Minimum required hardware version for the associated FPD image. A minimum hardware requirement of version 0.0 indicates that all hardware can support this FPD image version. Min Req HW Vers In the show fpd package command output, the “subtype” column shows the FPDs that correspond with each SPA image. To upgrade a specific FPD with the upgrade hw-module fpd command, replace the fpga-type argument with the appropriate FPD from the “subtype” column, as shown in the following example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# upgrade hw-module fpd fpga2 location 0/3/1 reload Note upgrade hw-module fpd Command Output: Example Use the upgrade hw-module fpd command to upgrade the FPD image on a SPA, SIP or line card. The following example shows how to force the update of the FPGA on the SPA at location 0/1/cpu0. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# admin RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# upgrade hw-module fpd fpga force location 0/1/cpu0 Mon Jan 12 05:44:37.611 PST % RELOAD REMINDER: - The upgrade operation of the target module will not interrupt its normal operation. However, for the changes to take effect, the target module will need to be manually reloaded after the upgrade operation. This can be accomplished with the use of "hw-module reload" command. - If automatic reload operation is desired after the upgrade, please use the "reload" option at the end of the upgrade command. - The output of "show hw-module fpd location" command will not display correct version information after the upgrade if the target module is not reloaded. Continue? [confirm] y Starting the upgrade/download of following FPD: =========== ==== ======= ======= =========== ========= Current Upg/Dng Location Type Subtype Upg/Dng Version Version =========== ==== ======= ======= =========== ========= 0/1/CPU0 lc fpga upg 0.40 0.40 ------------------------------------------------------ LC/0/1/CPU0:Jan 12 05:44:43.700 : lc_fpd_upgrade[192]: %PLATFORM-UPGRADE_FPD-6-START : Starting to upgrade fpga subtype image from 0.4 to 0.4 for for this card on location 0/1/CPU0 SP/0/1/SP:Jan 12 05:44:41.150 : upgrade_daemon[280]: programming...with file /net/node0_RP1_CPU0/disk0:/asr9k-fpd-3.9.0.25I/fpd/ucode/fpga_jacket_hw80_sw0.4.xsvf LC/0/1/CPU0:Jan 12 05:44:42.990 : fabricq_mgr[152]: EES:Internal clock detect IDLE period(-106461) more than threshold(1200000) Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 139 Upgrading FPD on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router upgrade hw-module fpd Command Output: ExampleLC/0/1/CPU0:Jan 12 05:44:42.990 : ingressq[179]: EES:Internal clock detect IDLE period(-106461) more than threshold(1200000) LC/0/1/CPU0:Jan 12 05:45:09.240 : fabricq_mgr[152]: EES:Internal clock detect IDLE period(-105945) more than threshold(1200000) LC/0/1/CPU0:Jan 12 05:45:09.241 : ingressq[179]: EES:Internal clock detect IDLE period(-105944) more than threshold(1200000) SP/0/1/SP:Jan 12 05:45:16.020 : upgrade_daemon[280]: ...programming... SP/0/1/SP:Jan 12 05:45:16.034 : upgrade_daemon[280]: ...it will take a while... SP/0/1/SP:Jan 12 05:45:16.053 : upgrade_daemon[280]: ...it will take a while... SP/0/1/SP:Jan 12 05:47:42.967 : upgrade_daemon[280]: ...programming... SP/0/1/SP:Jan 12 05:47:42.981 : upgrade_daemon[280]: ...it will take a while... % SLC/0/1/CPU0:Jan 12 05:48:08.737 : lc_fpd_upgrade[192]: %PLATFORM-UPGRADE_FPD-6-PASSED : Successfully upgrade fpga subtype image for for this card on location 0/1/CPU0 show platform Command Output: Example Use the show platform command to verify that the SPA is up and running. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show platform Sat Jul 25 12:26:38.905 DST Node Type State Config State ----------------------------------------------------------------------------- 0/RSP0/CPU0 A9K-RSP-4G(Active) IOS XR RUN PWR,NSHUT,MON 0/FT0/SP FAN TRAY READY 0/FT1/SP FAN TRAY READY 0/1/CPU0 A9K-40GE-B IOS XR RUN PWR,NSHUT,MON 0/4/CPU0 A9K-8T/4-B IOS XR RUN PWR,NSHUT,MON 0/6/CPU0 A9K-4T-B IOS XR RUN PWR,NSHUT,MON 0/PM0/SP A9K-3KW-AC READY PWR,NSHUT,MON 0/PM1/SP A9K-3KW-AC READY PWR,NSHUT,MON 0/PM2/SP A9K-3KW-AC READY PWR,NSHUT,MON Troubleshooting Problems with FPD Image Upgrades This section contains information to help troubleshoot problems that can occur during the upgrade process. Power Failure or Removal of a SPA During an FPD Image Upgrade If the FPD upgrade operation is interrupted by a power failure or the removal of the SPA, it could corrupt the FPD image. This corruption of the FPD image file makes the SPA unusable by the router and the system displays the following messages when it tries to power up the SPA. When it cannot successfully power up the SPA, it places it in the failed state, as shown in the following example: LC/0/3/CPU0:Feb 4 08:23:16.672 : spa_192_jacket[188]: %L2-SPA-5-OIR_INSERTED : SPA discovered in bay 0 LC/0/3/CPU0:Feb 4 08:23:23.349 : spa_192_jacket[188]: %L2-SPA-5-OIR_ERROR : SPA (0): An error occurred (0x1002), error recovery action: reset SPA LC/0/3/CPU0:Feb 4 08:23:26.431 : spa_192_jacket[188]: %L2-SPA-5-OIR_INSERTED : SPA discovered in bay 0 LC/0/3/CPU0:Feb 4 08:23:32.593 : spa_192_jacket[188]: %L2-SPA-5-OIR_ERROR : SPA (0): Too many retries, error recovery stopped LC/0/3/CPU0:Feb 4 08:23:32.593 : spa_192_jacket[188]: %L2-SPA-5-OIR_ERROR : SPA (0): An error occurred (0x1002), error recovery action: hold SPA in reset Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 140 OL-26081-03 Upgrading FPD on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router show platform Command Output: ExampleWhen a SPA is in the failed state, it may not register itself with the FPD upgrade mechanism. In this case, you do not see the SPA listed when you use the show hw-module fpd command. To verify the state of a SPA, use the show hw-module subslot error command and the show hw-module subslotstatus command. Performing a SPA FPD Recovery Upgrade To recover a SPA from the failed state because of a corrupted FPD image, you must manually shut down the SPA. Use the hw-module subslot subslot-id shutdown command in global configuration mode to administratively shutdown the SPA. After the SPA is shut down, you can use the upgrade hw-module fpd command in administration EXEC mode, with the force option, to restart the FPD upgrade process, asshown in the following example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# admin RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)# upgrade hw-module fpd fpga force location 0/3/0 Performing a SPA FPD recovery upgrade as well as using the force keyword with the upgrade hw-module fpd command works only if the SPA has power. If the SPA is in the SHUT, NPWR state (you can determine the state by checking the output of the show platform command), the upgrade in general, as well as the force keyword,will not work. Note Performing a SIP FPD Recovery Upgrade If a SIP upgrade fails for whatever reason, do not reload the SIP. Try to perform the upgrade procedure again. You can perform the upgrade procedure multiple times, aslong as you do not reload the SIP. The FPD upgrade procedure takes several minutes to complete; do not interrupt the procedure. If you reload the SIP when the FPD image is corrupted, the SIP malfunctions and you must contact Cisco technical support for assistance. To recover a SIP from the failed state because of a corrupted FPD image, you must contact Cisco technical support. To recover a SIP from the failed state because of a corrupted FPD image, you must turn off the automatic reset of the SIP card. Use the hw-module reset auto disable command in administration configuration mode, as shown in the following example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin-config)# hw-module reset auto disable location 0/1/4 Additional References The following sections provide references related to FPD software upgrade. Related Documents Related Topic Document Title Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Commands Master List Cisco IOS XR command master list Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 141 Upgrading FPD on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Performing a SPA FPD Recovery UpgradeRelated Topic Document Title Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Command Reference Cisco IOS XR FPD upgrade-related commands Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Getting Started Guide Initial system bootup and configuration information for a router using the Cisco IOS XR Software. Configuring AAA Services on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Security Configuration Guide Information about user groups and task IDs Standards Standards Title No new or modified standards are supported by this — feature, and support for existing standards has not been modified by this feature. MIBs MIBs MIBs Link To locate and download MIBs for selected platforms using Cisco IOS XR Software, use the Cisco MIB Locator found at the following URL: http://cisco.com/ public/sw-center/netmgmt/cmtk/mibs.shtml There are no applicable MIBs for this module. RFCs RFCs Title No new or modified RFCs are supported by this — feature, and support for existing RFCs has not been modified by this feature. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 142 OL-26081-03 Upgrading FPD on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional ReferencesTechnical Assistance Description Link The Cisco Technical Support website contains http://www.cisco.com/techsupport thousands of pages of searchable technical content, including links to products, technologies, solutions, technical tips, and tools. Registered Cisco.com users can log in from this page to access even more content. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 143 Upgrading FPD on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional References Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 144 OL-26081-03 Upgrading FPD on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional ReferencesC H A P T E R 8 Configuring Manageability on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router This module describes the configuration required to enable the Extensible Markup Language (XML) agent services. The XML Parser Infrastructure provides parsing and generation of XML documents with Document Object Model (DOM), Simple Application Programming Interface (API) for XML (SAX), and Document Type Definition (DTD) validation capabilities: • DOM allows customers to programmatically create, manipulate, and generate XML documents. • SAX supports user-defined functions for XML tags. • DTD allows for validation of defined document types. Table 22: Feature History for Configuring Manageability on Cisco IOS XR Software Release 3.7.2 This feature was introduced The ability to enable XML requests over Secure Socket Layer (SSL) was introduced. The ability to configure an idle timeout for the XML agent was introduced. Release 3.9.0 The ability to configure a dedicated agent to receive and send messages via a specified VPN routing and forwarding (VRF) instance was introduced. The ability to control CPU time used by the XML agent was introduced. Release 4.0.0 This module contains the following topics: • Information About XML Manageability, page 146 • How to Configure Manageability, page 146 • Configuration Examples for Manageability, page 147 • Additional References, page 148 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 145Information About XML Manageability The Cisco IOS XR Extensible Markup Language (XML) API provides a programmable interface to the router for use by external management applications. This interface provides a mechanism for router configuration and monitoring utilizing XML formatted request and response streams. The XML interface is built on top of the Management Data API (MDA), which provides a mechanism for Cisco IOS XR components to publish their data models through MDA schema definition files. Cisco IOS XR software provides the ability to access the router via XML using a dedicated TCP connection, Secure Socket Layer (SSL), or a specific VPN routing and forwarding (VRF) instance. How to Configure Manageability Configuring the XML Agent SUMMARY STEPS 1. xml agent [ssl] 2. iteration on size iteration-size 3. session timeout timeout 4. throttle {memory size | process-rate tags} 5. vrf { default | vrf-name} [access-list access-list-name] DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Enables Extensible Markup Language (XML) requests over a dedicated TCP connection and enters XML agent configuration xml agent [ssl] Example: Step 1 mode. Use the ssl keyword to enable XML requests over RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router:router(config)# xml agent Secure Socket Layer (SSL). Configures the iteration size for large XML agent responses in KBytes. The default is 48. iteration on size iteration-size Example: Step 2 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router:router(config-xml-agent)# iteration on size 500 Configures an idle timeout for the XML agent in minutes. By default, there is no timeout. session timeout timeout Example: Step 3 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router:router(config-xml-agent)# session timeout 5 Step 4 throttle {memory size | process-rate tags} Configures the XML agent processing capabilities. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 146 OL-26081-03 Configuring Manageability on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Information About XML ManageabilityCommand or Action Purpose Example: • Specify the memory size in Mbytes. Values can range from 100 to 600. The default is 300. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router:router(config-xml-agent)# throttle memory 300 • Specify the process-rate as the number of tags that the XML agent can process per second. Values can range from 1000 to 30000. By default the process rate is not throttled. Configures the dedicated agent or SSL agent to receive and send messages via the specified VPN routing and forwarding (VRF) instance. vrf { default | vrf-name} [access-list access-list-name] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router:router(config-xml-agent)# vrf my-vrf Step 5 Configuration Examples for Manageability Enabling VRF on an XML Agent: Examples The following example illustrates how to configure the dedicated XML agent to receive and send messages via VRF1, VRF2 and the default VRF: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router:router(config)# xml agent RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router:router(config-xml-agent)# vrf VRF1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router:router(config-xml-agent)# vrf VRF2 The following example illustrates how to remove access to VRF2 from the dedicated agent: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router:router(config)# xml agent RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router:router(config-xml-agent)# no vrf VRF2 The following example shows how to configure the XML SSL agent to receive and send messages through VRF1, VRF2 and the default VRF: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router:router(config)# xml agent ssl RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router:router(config-xml-agent)# vrf VRF1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router:router(config-xml-agent)# vrf VRF2 The following example removes access for VRF2 from the dedicated XML agent: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router:router(config)# xml agent ssl RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router:router(config-xml-agent)# no vrf VRF2 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 147 Configuring Manageability on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuration Examples for ManageabilityAdditional References The following sections provide references related to configuring manageability on Cisco IOS XR software. Related Documents Related Topic Document Title Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Commands Master List Cisco IOS XR commands Configuring AAA Services on Cisco IOS XR Software module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Security Configuration Guide Information about user groups and task IDs Standards and RFCs Standard/RFC Title No new or modified standards are supported by this — feature, and support for existing standards has not been modified by this feature. MIBs MIB MIBs Link To locate and download MIBsforselected platforms, Cisco IOS releases, and feature sets, use Cisco MIB Locator found at the following URL: http://www.cisco.com/go/mibs — RFCs RFCs Title No new or modified RFCs are supported by this — feature, and support for existing RFCs has not been modified by this feature. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 148 OL-26081-03 Configuring Manageability on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional ReferencesTechnical Assistance Description Link The Cisco Support website provides extensive online http://www.cisco.com/support resources, including documentation and tools for troubleshooting and resolving technical issues with Cisco products and technologies. To receive security and technical information about your products, you can subscribe to various services, such as the Product Alert Tool (accessed from Field Notices), the Cisco Technical Services Newsletter, and Really Simple Syndication (RSS) Feeds. Access to most tools on the Cisco Support website requires a Cisco.com user ID and password. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 149 Configuring Manageability on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional References Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 150 OL-26081-03 Configuring Manageability on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional ReferencesC H A P T E R 9 Configuring Call Home on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router This module describes the configuring of the Call Home feature. Table 23: Feature History for Configuring Call Home Release Modification Release 4.1.0 Call Home was introduced This model contains the following topics: • About Call Home, page 151 • Configuring Call Home, page 155 • Configuring Contact Information, page 155 • Configuring and Activating Destination Profiles, page 158 • Associating an Alert Group with a Destination Profile, page 160 • Configuring Email, page 163 • Enabling Call Home, page 165 About Call Home Call Home provides an email-based notification for critical system policies. A range of message formats are available for compatibility with pager services or XML-based automated parsing applications. You can use this feature to page a network support engineer, email a Network Operations Center, or use Cisco Smart Call Home services to generate a case with the Technical Assistance Center. The Call Home feature can deliver alert messages containing information about diagnostics and environmental faults and events. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 151The Call Home feature can deliver alerts to multiple recipients, referred to as Call Home destination profiles. Each profile includes configurable message formats and content categories. A predefined destination profile is provided for sending alerts to the Cisco TAC, but you also can define your own destination profiles. When you configure Call Home to send messages, the appropriate CLI show command is executed and the command output is attached to the message. Call Home messages are delivered in the following formats: • Short text format which provides a one or two line description of the fault that is suitable for pagers or printed reports. • Full text format which provides fully formatted message with detailed information that is suitable for human reading. • XML machine readable format that uses Extensible Markup Language (XML) and Adaptive Messaging Language (AML) XML schema definition (XSD). The AML XSD is published on the Cisco.com website at http://www.cisco.com/. The XML format enables communication with the Cisco Systems Technical Assistance Center. Destination Profiles A destination profile includes the following information: • One or more alert groups—The group of alerts that trigger a specific Call Home message if the alert occurs. • One or more e-mail destinations—The list of recipients for the Call Home messages generated by alert groups assigned to this destination profile. • Message format—The format for the Call Home message (short text, full text, or XML). • Message severity level—The Call Home severity level that the alert must meet before a Call Home message is sent to all e-mail addresses in the destination profile. An alert is not generated if the Call Home severity level of the alert is lower than the message severity level set for the destination profile. You can also configure a destination profile to allow periodic inventory update messages by using the inventory alert group that will send out periodic messages daily, weekly, or monthly. The following predefined destination profiles are supported: • CiscoTAC-1—Supports the Cisco-TAC alert group in XML message format. Call Home Alert Groups An alert group is a predefined subset of alerts or events that Call Home detects and reports to one or more destinations. Alert groups allow you to select the set of alerts that you want to send to a predefined or custom destination profile. Alerts are sent to e-mail destinations in a destination profile only if that alert belongs to one of the alert groups associated with that destination profile and if the alert has a Call Home message severity at or above the message severity set in the destination profile. The following table lists supported alert groups and the default CLI command output included in Call Home messages generated for the alert group. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 152 OL-26081-03 Configuring Call Home on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Destination ProfilesTable 24: Alert Groups and Executed Commands Alert Group Description Executed Commands show environment show logging show ineventory show environment trace show diag Events related to power, fan, and environment-sensing elementssuch as temperature alarms. Environmental admin show platform admin show version admin show diag admin show inventory oid Inventory status that is provided whenever a unit is cold booted, or when FRUs are inserted or removed. This alert is considered a noncritical event, and the information is used for status and entitlement. Inventory admin show version admin show logging admin show inventory Events generated by specific interesting syslog messages Syslog Call Home maps the syslog severity level to the corresponding Call Home severity level for syslog port group messages. Call Home Message Levels Call Home allows you to filter messages based on their level of urgency. You can associate each destination profile (predefined and user-defined) with a Call Home message level threshold. The Call Home message level rangesfrom 0 (lowest level of urgency) to 9 (highest level of urgency). Call Home messages are generated if they have a severity level equal to or greater than the Call Home message level threshold for the destination profile. Call Home messages that are sent for syslog alert groups have the syslog severity level mapped to the Call Home message level. Note Call Home does not change the syslog message level in the message text. The following table lists each Call Home message level keyword and the corresponding syslog level for the syslog port alert group. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 153 Configuring Call Home on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Call Home Message LevelsTable 25: Severity and syslog Level Mapping Call Home Level Keyword syslog Level Description Network-wide catastrophic failure. 9 Catastrophic N/A Significant network impact. 8 Disaster N/A 7 Fatal Emergency (0) System is unusable. Critical conditions that indicate that immediate attention is needed. 6 Critical Alert (1) 5 Major Critical (2) Major conditions. 4 Minor Error (3) Minor conditions. 3 Warning Warning (4) Warning conditions. Basic notification and informational messages. Possibly independently insignificant. 2 Notification Notice (5) Normal event signifying return to normal state. 1 Normal Information (6) 0 Debugging Debug (7) Debugging messages. Obtaining Smart Call Home If you have a service contract directly with Cisco Systems, you can register your devices for the Smart Call Home service. Smart Call Home providesfast resolution ofsystem problems by analyzing Call Home messages sent from your devices and providing background information and recommendations. For issues that can be identified as known, particularly GOLD diagnostics failures, Automatic Service Requests will be generated with the Cisco-TAC. Smart Call Home offers the following features: • Continuous device health monitoring and real-time diagnostic alerts. • Analysis of Call Home messages from your device and, where appropriate, Automatic Service Request generation, routed to the appropriate TAC team, including detailed diagnostic information to speed problem resolution. • Secure message transport directly from your device or through a downloadable Transport Gateway (TG) aggregation point. You can use a TG aggregation point in cases that require support for multiple devices Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 154 OL-26081-03 Configuring Call Home on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Obtaining Smart Call Homeor in cases where security requirements mandate that your devices may not be connected directly to the Internet. • Web-based accessto Call Home messages and recommendations, inventory and configuration information for all Call Home devices. Provides accessto associated field notices,security advisories and end-of-life information. You need the following items to register: • The SMARTnet contract number for your device • Your e-mail address • Your Cisco.com ID For more information about Smart Call Home, see the Smart Call Home page at this URL: http:// www.cisco.com/go/smartcall/ Configuring Call Home The tasks in this module describe how to configure the sending of Call Home messages. The following steps are involved: 1 Assign contact information. 2 Configure and enable one or more destination profiles. 3 Associate one or more alert groups to each profile. 4 Configure the email server options. 5 Enable Call Home. Configuring Contact Information Each router must include a contact e-mail address. You can optionally include other identifying information for your system installation. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 155 Configuring Call Home on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Call HomeSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. call-home 3. contact-email-addr email-address 4. (Optional) contract-id contract-id-string 5. (Optional) customer-id customer-id-string 6. (Optional) phone-number phone-number-string 7. (Optional) street-address street-address 8. (Optional) site-id site-id-string 9. Use one of these commands: • end • commit 10. show call-home DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 call-home Enters call home configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# call-home RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-call-home)# Step 2 Configures the customer email address. Enter up to 200 characters in email address format with no spaces. contact-email-addr email-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-call-home)# contact-email-addr user1@cisco.com Step 3 (Optional) Configures the contract ID. Enter up to 64 characters. If you include spaces, you must enclose the entry in quotes (""). contract-id contract-id-string Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-call-home)# contract-id Contract-identifier Step 4 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 156 OL-26081-03 Configuring Call Home on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Contact InformationCommand or Action Purpose (Optional) Configuresthe customer ID. Enter up to 64 characters. If you include spaces, you must enclose the entry in quotes (""). customer-id customer-id-string Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-call-home)# customer-id Customer1 Step 5 (Optional) Configures the customer phone number. The number must begin with a plus(+) prefix, and may contain only dashes(-) and numbers. Enter up to 16 characters. phone-number phone-number-string Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-call-home)# phone-number +405-123-4567 Step 6 (Optional) Configures the customer street address where RMA equipment can be shipped. Enter up to 200 characters. If you include spaces, you must enclose the entry in quotes (""). street-address street-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-call-home)# Step 7 street-address "300 E. Tasman Dr. San Jose, CA 95134" (Optional) Configures the site ID for the system. Enter up to 200 characters. If you include spaces, you must enclose the entry in quotes (""). site-id site-id-string Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-call-home)# site-id SJ-RouterRoom1 Step 8 Step 9 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 157 Configuring Call Home on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Contact InformationCommand or Action Purpose show call-home Displays information about the system contacts. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show call-home Step 10 Configuring and Activating Destination Profiles You must have at least one activated destination profile for Call Home messages to be sent. The CiscoTAC-1 profile exists by default but is not active. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. call-home 3. profile profile-name 4. destination address email email-address 5. destination message-size-limit max-size 6. destination preferred-msg-format {short-text | long-text | xml} 7. destination transport-method email 8. active 9. Use one of these commands: • end • commit 10. show call-home profile {all | profile-name} DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 158 OL-26081-03 Configuring Call Home on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring and Activating Destination ProfilesCommand or Action Purpose call-home Enters call home configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# call-home RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-call-home)# Step 2 Enters call home profile configuration mode to configure a new or existing profile. profile profile-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-call-home)# profile Step 3 my_profile RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-call-home-profile)# Configures an email address to which Call Home messages are sent for this profile. destination address email email-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-call-home-profile)# destination address email support_me@cisco.com Step 4 Configures the maximum size of Call Home messages for this profile. Values can be between 50 and 3145728 characters. destination message-size-limit max-size Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-call-home-profile)# destination message-size-limit 1000 Step 5 Configures the message format for this profile. The default is xml. destination preferred-msg-format {short-text | long-text | xml} Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-call-home-profile)# destination preferred-msg-format xml Step 6 Configures the transport method for this profile. Email is the only supported method. destination transport-method email Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-call-home-profile)# destination transport-method email Step 7 Step 8 active Activates the destination profile. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-call-home-profile)# active At least one destination profile must be active for Call Home messages to be sent. Note Step 9 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 159 Configuring Call Home on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring and Activating Destination ProfilesCommand or Action Purpose • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • end • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. show call-home profile {all | profile-name} Displays information about the destination profile. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show call-home profile all Step 10 Associating an Alert Group with a Destination Profile An alert is sent only to destination profiles that have subscribed to the Call Home alert group. Before You Begin Use the show call-home alert-group command to view available alert groups. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 160 OL-26081-03 Configuring Call Home on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Associating an Alert Group with a Destination ProfileSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. call-home 3. profile profile-name 4. subscribe-to-alert-group environment [severity severity-level 5. subscribe-to-alert-group inventory [periodic {daily | monthly day-of-month | weekly day-of-week} hh:mm 6. subscribe-to-alert-group syslog severity severity-level pattern string 7. Use one of these commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 call-home Enters call home configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# call-home RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-call-home)# Step 2 Enters call home profile configuration mode to configure a new or existing profile. profile profile-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-call-home)# profile Step 3 my_profile RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-call-home-profile)# Configures a destination profile to receive messages for the environment alert group. Alerts with a severity the same or greater subscribe-to-alert-group environment [severity severity-level Step 4 than the specified severity level are sent. The default severity is debugging. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-call-home-profile)# • catastrophic—Includes network-wide catastrophic events subscribe-to-alert-group environment severity in the alert. This is the highest severity. major • critical—Includes events requiring immediate attention (system log level 1). • debugging—Includes debug events (system log level 7). This is the lowest severity. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 161 Configuring Call Home on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Associating an Alert Group with a Destination ProfileCommand or Action Purpose • disaster—Includes events with significant network impact. • fatal—Includes events where the system is unusable (system log level 0). • major—Includes events classified as major conditions (system log level 2). • minor—Includes events classified as minor conditions (system log level 3) • normal—Specifies the normal state and includes events classified as informational (system log level 6). This is the default. • notification—Includes eventsinformational message events (system log level 5). • warning—Includes events classified as warning conditions (system log level 4). Configures a destination profile to receive messages for the inventory alert group. Either alerts are sent periodically, or any non-normal event triggers an alert. subscribe-to-alert-group inventory [periodic {daily | monthly day-of-month | weekly day-of-week} hh:mm Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-call-home-profile)# Step 5 subscribe-to-alert-group inventory periodic monthly 1 10:00 Configures a destination profile to receive messages for the syslog alert group. Alerts with a severity the same or greater than the specified severity level are sent. subscribe-to-alert-group syslog severity severity-level pattern string Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-call-home-profile)# Step 6 • catastrophic—Includes network-wide catastrophic events in the alert. This is the highest severity. subscribe-to-alert-group syslog severity major pattern • critical—Includes events requiring immediate attention (system log level 1). • debugging—Includes debug events (system log level 7). This is the lowest severity. • disaster—Includes events with significant network impact. • fatal—Includes events where the system is unusable (system log level 0). • major—Includes events classified as major conditions (system log level 2). • minor—Includes events classified as minor conditions (system log level 3) Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 162 OL-26081-03 Configuring Call Home on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Associating an Alert Group with a Destination ProfileCommand or Action Purpose • normal—Specifies the normal state and includes events classified as informational (system log level 6). This is the default. • notification—Includes eventsinformational message events (system log level 5). • warning—Includes events classified as warning conditions (system log level 4). You can specify a pattern to be matched in the syslog message. If the pattern contains spaces, you must enclose it in quotes (""). Step 7 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yessaves configuration changesto the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. What to Do Next Use the show call-home profile command to view the profile configurations. Configuring Email Call Home messages are sent via email. You must configure your email server before Call Home messages can be sent. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 163 Configuring Call Home on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring EmailSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. call-home 3. (Optional) sender from email-address 4. (Optional) sender reply-to email-address 5. mail-server address priority priority 6. rate-limit events-count 7. Use one of these commands: • end • commit 8. show call-home mail-server status DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 call-home Enters call home configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# call-home RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-call-home)# Step 2 (Optional) Specifies the email message “from” address. sender from email-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-call-home)# sender from my_email@cisco.com Step 3 (Optional) Specifies the email message “reply-to” address. sender reply-to email-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-call-home)# sender reply-to my_email@cisco.com Step 4 Specifies the mail server to use to send Call Home messages. You can specify an IP address or mail server name. You can specify up mail-server address priority priority Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-call-home)# mail-server 198.51.100.10 priority 1 Step 5 to five mail servers to use. The server with the lower priority is tried first. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 164 OL-26081-03 Configuring Call Home on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring EmailCommand or Action Purpose Specifies the maximum trigger rate per minute. The default is five events per minute and the maximum is also five. rate-limit events-count Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-call-home)# rate-limit 4 Step 6 Step 7 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yessaves configuration changesto the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. show call-home mail-server status Displays the status of the specified mail server. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show call-home mail-server status Step 8 Enabling Call Home By default the sending of Call Home messages is disabled. You must peform this task to enable the sending of Call Home messages. Before You Begin Before enabling the sending of Call Home messages, you should complete the configuration tasks described in this module. Specifically, you must have enabled a destination profile for any Call Home messages to be sent. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 165 Configuring Call Home on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Enabling Call HomeSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. call-home 3. service active 4. Use one of these commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 call-home Enters call home configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# call-home RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-call-home)# Step 2 service active Enables the sending of Call Home messages. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-call-home)# service active Step 3 Step 4 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exitsthe configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leavesthe router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 166 OL-26081-03 Configuring Call Home on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Enabling Call HomeCommand or Action Purpose • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 167 Configuring Call Home on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Enabling Call Home Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 168 OL-26081-03 Configuring Call Home on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Enabling Call HomeC H A P T E R 10 Implementing NTP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Network Time Protocol (NTP) is a protocol designed to time-synchronize devices within a network. Cisco IOS XR software implements NTPv4. NTPv4 retains backwards compatibility with the older versions of NTP, including NTPv3 and NTPv2 but excluding NTPv1, which has been discontinued due to security vulnerabilities. This module describes the tasks you need to implement NTP on the Cisco IOS XR software. For more information about NTP on the Cisco IOS XR software and complete descriptions of the NTP commands listed in this module, see Related Documents, on page 189. To locate documentation for other commands that might appear in the course of running a configuration task, search online in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Commands Master List. Table 26: Feature History for Implementing NTP on Cisco IOS XR Software Release Modification Release 3.7.2 This feature was introduced. Support was added for IPv6 addresses, VRFs, multicast-based associations, and burst and iburst modes for poll-based associations. Release 3.9.0 This module contains the following topics: • Prerequisites for Implementing NTP on Cisco IOS XR Software, page 170 • Information About Implementing NTP, page 170 • How to Implement NTP on Cisco IOS XR Software, page 171 • Configuration Examples for Implementing NTP, page 186 • Additional References, page 189 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 169Prerequisites for Implementing NTP on Cisco IOS XR Software You must be in a user group associated with a task group that includes the proper task IDs. The command reference guides include the task IDs required for each command. If you suspect user group assignment is preventing you from using a command, contact your AAA administrator for assistance. Information About Implementing NTP NTP synchronizes timekeeping among a set of distributed time servers and clients. This synchronization allows events to be correlated when system logs are created and other time-specific events occur. NTP uses the User Datagram Protocol (UDP) as its transport protocol. All NTP communication uses Coordinated Universal Time (UTC). An NTP network usually receives its time from an authoritative time source, such as a radio clock or an atomic clock attached to a time server. NTP distributes this time across the network. NTP is extremely efficient; no more than one packet per minute is necessary to synchronize two machines to within a millisecond of each other. NTP usesthe concept of a “stratum” to describe how many NTP “hops” away a machine isfrom an authoritative time source. A “stratum 1” time server typically has an authoritative time source (such as a radio or atomic clock, or a GPS time source) directly attached, a “stratum 2” time server receives its time via NTP from a “stratum 1” time server, and so on. NTP avoids synchronizing to a machine whose time may not be accurate, in two ways. First, NTP never synchronizes to a machine that is not synchronized itself. Second, NTP compares the time reported by several machines and does not synchronize to a machine whose time is significantly different than the others, even if its stratum is lower. This strategy effectively builds a self-organizing tree of NTP servers. The Cisco implementation of NTP does not support stratum 1 service; in other words, it is not possible to connect to a radio or atomic clock (for some specific platforms, however, you can connect a GPS time-source device). We recommend that time service for your network be derived from the public NTP servers available in the IP Internet. If the network isisolated from the Internet, the Cisco implementation of NTP allows a machine to be configured so that it acts as though it is synchronized via NTP, when in fact it has determined the time using other means. Other machines can then synchronize to that machine via NTP. Several manufacturers include NTP software for their host systems, and a publicly available version for systemsrunning UNIX and its various derivativesis also available. Thissoftware also allows UNIX-derivative serversto acquire the time directly from an atomic clock, which would subsequently propagate time information along to Cisco routers. The communications between machinesrunning NTP (known as associations) are usually statically configured; each machine is given the IP address of all machines with which it should form associations. Accurate timekeeping is made possible by exchanging NTP messages between each pair of machines with an association. The Cisco implementation of NTP supportstwo waysthat a networking device can obtain NTP time information on a network: • By polling host servers • By listening to NTP broadcasts In a LAN environment, NTP can be configured to use IP broadcast messages. As compared to polling, IP broadcast messagesreduce configuration complexity, because each machine can simply be configured to send Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 170 OL-26081-03 Implementing NTP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Prerequisites for Implementing NTP on Cisco IOS XR Softwareor receive broadcast or multicast messages. However, the accuracy of timekeeping is marginally reduced because the information flow is one-way only. An NTP broadcast client listens for broadcast messages sent by an NTP broadcast server at a designated IPv4 address. The client synchronizes the local clock using the first received broadcast message. The time kept on a machine is a critical resource, so we strongly recommend that you use the security features of NTP to avoid the accidental or malicioussetting of incorrect time. Two mechanisms are available: an access list-based restriction scheme and an encrypted authentication mechanism. When multiple sources of time (VINES, hardware clock, manual configuration) are available, NTP is always considered to be more authoritative. NTP time overrides the time set by any other method. How to Implement NTP on Cisco IOS XR Software Configuring Poll-Based Associations Note No specific command enables NTP; the first NTP configuration command that you issue enables NTP. You can configure the following types of poll-based associations between the router and other devices (which may also be routers): • Client mode • Symmetric active mode The client and the symmetric active modes should be used when NTP is required to provide a high level of time accuracy and reliability. When a networking device is operating in the client mode, it polls its assigned time serving hosts for the current time. The networking device then picks a host from all the polled time servers to synchronize with. Because the relationship that is established in this case is a client-host relationship, the host does not capture or use any time information sent by the local client device. This mode is most suited for file-server and workstation clients that are not required to provide any form of time synchronization to other local clients. Use the server command to individually specify the time-serving hoststhat you want your networking device to consider synchronizing with and to set your networking device to operate in the client mode. When a networking device is operating in the symmetric active mode, it polls its assigned time-serving hosts for the current time and it responds to polls by its hosts. Because this is a peer-to-peer relationship, the host also retains time-related information about the local networking device that it is communicating with. This mode should be used when there are several mutually redundant servers that are interconnected via diverse network paths. Most stratum 1 and stratum 2 servers on the Internet today adopt this form of network setup. Use the peer command to individually specify the time-serving hosts that you want your networking device to consider synchronizing with and to set your networking device to operate in the symmetric active mode. When the router pollsseveral other devicesfor the time, the routerselects one device with which to synchronize. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 171 Implementing NTP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router How to Implement NTP on Cisco IOS XR SoftwareTo configure a peer-to-peer association between the router and another device, you must also configure the router as a peer on the other device. You can configure multiple peers and servers, but you cannot configure a single IP address as both a peer and a server at the same time. To change the configuration of a specific IP address from peer to server or from server to peer, use the no form of the peer or server command to remove the current configuration before you perform the new configuration. If you do not remove the old configuration before performing the new configuration, the new configuration does not overwrite the old configuration. Note SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. ntp 3. server ip-address [version number] [key key-id] [minpoll interval] [maxpoll interval] [source type interface-path-id] [prefer] [burst] [iburst] 4. peer ip-address [version number] [key key-id] [minpoll interval] [maxpoll interval] [source type interface-path-id] [prefer] 5. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 ntp Enters NTP configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# ntp Step 2 Forms a server association with another system. This step can be repeated as necessary to form associations with multiple devices. server ip-address [version number] [key key-id] [minpoll interval] [maxpoll interval] [source type interface-path-id] [prefer] [burst] [iburst] Step 3 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ntp)# server 172.16.22.44 minpoll 8 maxpoll 12 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 172 OL-26081-03 Implementing NTP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Poll-Based AssociationsCommand or Action Purpose Forms a peer association with another system. This step can be repeated as necessary to form associations with multiple systems. peer ip-address [version number] [key key-id] [minpoll interval] [maxpoll interval] [source type interface-path-id] [prefer] Step 4 To complete the configuration of a peer-to-peer association between the router and the remote device, the router must also be configured as a peer on the remote device. Note Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ntp)# peer 192.168.22.33 minpoll 8 maxpoll 12 source pos 0/0/0/1 Step 5 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ntp)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ntp)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuring Broadcast-Based NTP Associates In a broadcast-based NTP association, an NTP server propagates NTP broadcast packetsthroughout a network. Broadcast clients listen for the NTP broadcast packets propagated by the NTP server and do not engage in any polling. Broadcast-based NTP associationsshould be used when time accuracy and reliability requirements are modest and if your network is localized and has a large number of clients (more than 20). Broadcast-based NTP associations also are recommended for use on networks that have limited bandwidth, system memory, or CPU resources. Time accuracy is marginally reduced in broadcast-based NTP associations because information flows only one way. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 173 Implementing NTP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Broadcast-Based NTP AssociatesUse the broadcast client command to set your networking device to listen for NTP broadcast packets propagated through a network. For broadcast client mode to work, the broadcast server and its clients must be located on the same subnet. The time server that is transmitting NTP broadcast packets must be enabled on the interface of the given device using the broadcast command. Use the broadcast command to set your networking device to send NTP broadcast packets. Note No specific command enables NTP; the first NTP configuration command that you issue enables NTP. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. ntp 3. (Optional) broadcastdelay microseconds 4. interface type interface-path-id 5. broadcast client 6. broadcast [destination ip-address] [key key-id] [version number] 7. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 ntp Enters NTP configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# ntp Step 2 (Optional) Adjusts the estimated round-trip delay for NTP broadcasts. broadcastdelay microseconds Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ntp)# broadcastdelay 5000 Step 3 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 174 OL-26081-03 Implementing NTP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Broadcast-Based NTP AssociatesCommand or Action Purpose interface type interface-path-id Enters NTP interface configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ntp)# interface POS 0/1/0/0 Step 4 Step 5 broadcast client Configures the specified interface to receive NTP broadcast packets. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ntp-int)# broadcast client Go to Step 6, on page 175 to configure the interface to send NTP broadcast packets. Note broadcast [destination ip-address] [key key-id] Configures the specified interface to send NTP broadcast packets. [version number] Step 6 Go to Step 5, on page 175 to configure the interface to receive NTP broadcast packets. Note Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ntp-int)# broadcast destination 10.50.32.149 Step 7 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ntp-int)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ntp-int)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 175 Implementing NTP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Broadcast-Based NTP AssociatesConfiguring NTP Access Groups Note No specific command enables NTP; the first NTP configuration command that you issue enables NTP. The access list-based restriction scheme allows you to grant or deny certain access privileges to an entire network, a subnet within a network, or a host within a subnet. The access group options are scanned in the following order, from least restrictive to most restrictive: 1 peer—Allows time requests and NTP control queries and allows the system to synchronize itself to a system whose address passes the access list criteria. 2 serve—Allows time requests and NTP control queries, but does not allow the system to synchronize itself to a system whose address passes the access list criteria. 3 serve-only—Allows only time requests from a system whose address passes the access list criteria. 4 query-only—Allows only NTP control queriesfrom a system whose address passesthe accesslist criteria. If the source IP address matches the access lists for more than one access type, the first type is granted. If no access groups are specified, all access types are granted to all systems. If any access groups are specified, only the specified access types are granted. For details on NTP control queries, see RFC 1305 (NTP version 3). SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. ntp 3. access-group{peer | query-only | serve | serve-only} access-list-name 4. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 ntp Enters NTP configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# ntp Step 2 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 176 OL-26081-03 Implementing NTP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring NTP Access GroupsCommand or Action Purpose Creates an access group and applies a basic IPv4 or IPv6 access list to it. access-group{peer | query-only | serve | serve-only} access-list-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ntp)# access-group peer access1 Step 3 Step 4 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ntp)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exitsthe configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ntp)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuring NTP Authentication This task explains how to configure NTP authentication. Note No specific command enables NTP; the first NTP configuration command that you issue enables NTP. The encrypted NTP authentication scheme should be used when a reliable form of access control is required. Unlike the access-list-based restriction scheme that is based on IP addresses, the encrypted authentication scheme uses authentication keys and an authentication process to determine if NTP synchronization packets sent by designated peers or servers on a local network are deemed as trusted, before the time information that it carries along is accepted. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 177 Implementing NTP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring NTP AuthenticationThe authentication process begins from the moment an NTP packet is created. A message authentication code (MAC) is computed using the MD5 Message Digest Algorithm and the MAC is embedded into an NTP synchronization packet. The NTP synchronization packet together with the embedded MAC and key number are transmitted to the receiving client. If authentication is enabled and the key is trusted, the receiving client computes the MAC in the same way. If the computed MAC matches the embedded MAC, the system is allowed to sync to the server that uses this key in its packets. After NTP authentication is properly configured, your networking device only synchronizes with and provides synchronization to trusted time sources. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. ntp 3. authenticate 4. authentication-key key-number md5 [clear | encrypted] key-name 5. trusted-key key-number 6. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 ntp Enters NTP configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# ntp Step 2 authenticate Enables the NTP authentication feature. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ntp)# authenticate Step 3 authentication-key key-number md5 [clear | Defines the authentication keys. encrypted] key-name Step 4 • Each key has a key number, a type, a value, and, optionally, a name. Currently the only key type supported is md5. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ntp)# authentication-key 42 md5 clear key1 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 178 OL-26081-03 Implementing NTP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring NTP AuthenticationCommand or Action Purpose Step 5 trusted-key key-number Defines trusted authentication keys. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ntp)# trusted-key 42 • If a key is trusted, this router only synchronizes to a system that uses this key in its NTP packets. Step 6 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ntp)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ntp)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Disabling NTP Services on a Specific Interface NTP services are disabled on all interfaces by default. NTP is enabled globally when any NTP commands are entered. You can selectively prevent NTP packets from being received through a specific interface by turning off NTP on a given interface. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 179 Implementing NTP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Disabling NTP Services on a Specific InterfaceSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. ntp 3. Use one of the following commands: • no interface type interface-path-id • interface type interface-path-id disable 4. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 ntp Enters NTP configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# ntp Step 2 Step 3 Use one of the following commands: Disables NTP services on the specified interface. • no interface type interface-path-id • interface type interface-path-id disable Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ntp)# no interface pos 0/0/0/1 or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ntp)# interface POS 0/0/0/1 disable Step 4 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 180 OL-26081-03 Implementing NTP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Disabling NTP Services on a Specific InterfaceCommand or Action Purpose Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ntp)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ntp)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuring the Source IP Address for NTP Packets By default, the source IP address of an NTP packet sent by the router is the address of the interface through which the NTP packet is sent. Use this procedure to set a different source address. Note No specific command enables NTP; the first NTP configuration command that you issue enables NTP. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. ntp 3. source type interface-path-id 4. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 181 Implementing NTP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring the Source IP Address for NTP PacketsDETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 ntp Enters NTP configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# ntp Step 2 Step 3 source type interface-path-id Configures an interface from which the IP source address is taken. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ntp)# source POS 0/0/0/1 This interface is used for the source address for all packets sent to all destinations. If a source addressisto be used for a specific association, use the source keyword in the peer or server command shown in Configuring Poll-Based Associations, on page 171. Note Step 4 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ntp)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ntp)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuring the System as an Authoritative NTP Server You can configure the router to act as an authoritative NTP server, even if the system is not synchronized to an outside time source. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 182 OL-26081-03 Implementing NTP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring the System as an Authoritative NTP ServerNote No specific command enables NTP; the first NTP configuration command that you issue enables NTP. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. ntp 3. master stratum 4. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 ntp Enters NTP configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# ntp Step 2 Step 3 master stratum Makes the router an authoritative NTP server. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ntp)# master 9 Use the master command with caution. It is very easy to override valid time sources using this command, especially if a low stratum number is configured. Configuring multiple machines in the same network with the master command can cause instability in timekeeping if the machines do not agree on the time. Note Step 4 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ntp)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ntp)# commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 183 Implementing NTP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring the System as an Authoritative NTP ServerCommand or Action Purpose ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leavesthe router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Updating the Hardware Clock On devices that have hardware clocks (system calendars), you can configure the hardware clock to be periodically updated from the software clock. This is advisable for devices using NTP, because the time and date on the software clock (set using NTP) is more accurate than the hardware clock. The time setting on the hardware clock has the potential to drift slightly over time. Note No specific command enables NTP; the first NTP configuration command that you issue enables NTP. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. ntp 3. update-calendar 4. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 184 OL-26081-03 Implementing NTP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Updating the Hardware ClockCommand or Action Purpose ntp Enters NTP configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# ntp Step 2 Configuresthe router t o update itssystem calendar from the software clock at periodic intervals. update-calendar Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ntp)# update-calendar Step 3 Step 4 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ntp)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ntp)# commit ? Entering no exitsthe configuration session and returnsthe router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Verifying the Status of the External Reference Clock This task explains how to verify the status of NTP components. Note The commands can be entered in any order. SUMMARY STEPS 1. show ntp associations [detail] [location node-id] 2. show ntp status [location node-id] Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 185 Implementing NTP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Verifying the Status of the External Reference ClockDETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose show ntp associations [detail] [location node-id] Displays the status of NTP associations. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show ntp associations Step 1 show ntp status [location node-id] Displays the status of NTP. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show ntp status Step 2 Examples The following is sample output from the show ntp associations command: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show ntp associations address ref clock st when poll reach delay offset disp +~127.127.1.1 127.127.1.1 5 5 1024 37 0.0 0.00 438.3 *~172.19.69.1 172.24.114.33 3 13 1024 1 2.0 67.16 0.0 * master (synced), # master (unsynced), + selected, - candidate, ~ configured The following is sample output from the show ntp status command: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show ntp status Clock is synchronized, stratum 4, reference is 172.19.69.1 nominal freq is 1000.0000 Hz, actual freq is 999.9988 Hz, precision is 2**26 reference time is C54C131B.9EECF6CA (07:26:19.620 UTC Mon Nov 24 2008) clock offset is 66.3685 msec, root delay is 7.80 msec root dispersion is 950.04 msec, peer dispersion is 3.38 msec Configuration Examples for Implementing NTP Configuring Poll-Based Associations: Example The following example shows an NTP configuration in which the router’s system clock is configured to form a peer association with the time server host at IP address 192.168.22.33, and to allow the system clock to be synchronized by time server hosts at IP address 10.0.2.1 and 172.19.69.1: ntp server 10.0.2.1 minpoll 5 maxpoll 7 peer 192.168.22.33 server 172.19.69.1 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 186 OL-26081-03 Implementing NTP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuration Examples for Implementing NTPConfiguring Broadcast-Based Associations: Example The following example shows an NTP client configuration in which Gigabit Ethernet interface 0/2/0/0 is configured to receive NTP broadcast packets, and the estimated round-trip delay between an NTP client and an NTP broadcast server is set to 2 microseconds: ntp interface GigabitEthernet 0/2/0/0 broadcast client exit broadcastdelay 2 The following example shows an NTP server configuration where Gigabit Ethernet interface 0/2/0/2 is configured to be a broadcast server: ntp interface GigabitEthernet 0/2/0/2 broadcast Configuring NTP Access Groups: Example The following example shows a NTP access group configuration where the following access group restrictions are applied: • Peer restrictions are applied to IP addresses that pass the criteria of the access list named peer-acl. • Serve restrictions are applied to IP addresses that pass the criteria of access list named serve-acl. • Serve-only restrictions are applied to IP addresses that pass the criteria of the access list named serve-only-acl. • Query-only restrictions are applied to IP addresses that pass the criteria of the access list named query-only-acl. ntp peer 10.1.1.1 peer 10.1.1.1 peer 10.2.2.2 peer 10.3.3.3 peer 10.4.4.4 peer 10.5.5.5 peer 10.6.6.6 peer 10.7.7.7 peer 10.8.8.8 access-group peer peer-acl access-group serve serve-acl access-group serve-only serve-only-acl access-group query-only query-only-acl exit ipv4 access-list peer-acl 10 permit ip host 10.1.1.1 any 20 permit ip host 10.8.8.8 any exit ipv4 access-list serve-acl 10 permit ip host 10.4.4.4 any 20 permit ip host 10.5.5.5 any exit ipv4 access-list query-only-acl 10 permit ip host 10.2.2.2 any 20 permit ip host 10.3.3.3 any exit ipv4 access-list serve-only-acl 10 permit ip host 10.6.6.6 any 20 permit ip host 10.7.7.7 any Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 187 Implementing NTP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuration Examples for Implementing NTPexit Configuring NTP Authentication: Example The following example shows an NTP authentication configuration. In this example, the following is configured: • NTP authentication is enabled. • Two authentication keys are configured (key 2 and key 3). • The router is configured to allow its software clock to be synchronized with the clock of the peer (or vice versa) at IP address 10.3.32.154 using authentication key 2. • The router is configured to allow its software clock to be synchronized with the clock by the device at IP address 10.32.154.145 using authentication key 3. • The router is configured to synchronize only to systems providing authentication key 3 in their NTP packets. ntp authenticate authentication-key 2 md5 encrypted 06120A2D40031D1008124 authentication-key 3 md5 encrypted 1311121E074110232621 trusted-key 3 server 10.3.32.154 key 3 peer 10.32.154.145 key 2 Disabling NTP on an Interface: Example The following example shows an NTP configuration in which Gigabit Ethernet 0/2/0/0 interface is disabled: ntp interface GigabitEthernet0/2/0/0 disable exit authentication-key 2 md5 encrypted 06120A2D40031D1008124 authentication-key 3 md5 encrypted 1311121E074110232621 authenticate trusted-key 3 server 10.3.32.154 key 3 peer 10.32.154.145 key 2 Configuring the Source IP Address for NTP Packets: Example The following example shows an NTP configuration in which Ethernet management interface 0/0/CPU0/0 is configured as the source address for NTP packets: ntp authentication-key 2 md5 encrypted 06120A2D40031D1008124 authentication-key 3 md5 encrypted 1311121E074110232621 authenticate trusted-key 3 server 10.3.32.154 key 3 peer 10.32.154.145 key 2 source MgmtEth0/0/CPU0/0 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 188 OL-26081-03 Implementing NTP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuration Examples for Implementing NTPConfiguring the System as an Authoritative NTP Server: Example The following example shows a NTP configuration in which the router is configured to use its own NTP master clock to synchronize with peers when an external NTP source becomes unavailable: ntp master 6 Updating the Hardware Clock: Example The following example shows an NTP configuration in which the router is configured to update its hardware clock from the software clock at periodic intervals: ntp server 10.3.32.154 update-calendar Additional References The following sections provide references related to implementing NTP on Cisco IOS XR software. Related Documents Related Topic Document Title Clock Commands on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Command Reference Cisco IOS XR clock commands NTP Commands on module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Command Reference Cisco IOS XR NTP commands Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Getting Started Guide Information about getting started with Cisco IOS XR Software Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Commands Master List Cisco IOS XR master command index Configuring AAA Services on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Security Configuration Guide Information about user groups and task IDs Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 189 Implementing NTP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional ReferencesStandards Standards Title No new or modified standards are supported by this — feature, and support for existing standards has not been modified by this feature. MIBs MIBs MIBs Link To locate and download MIBs using Cisco IOS XR software, use the Cisco MIB Locator found at the following URL and choose a platform under the Cisco Access Products menu: http://cisco.com/public/ sw-center/netmgmt/cmtk/mibs.shtml — RFCs RFCs Title RFC 1059 Network Time Protocol, Version 1: Specification and Implementation RFC 1119 Network Time Protocol, Version 2: Specification and Implementation Network Time Protocol, Version 3: Specification, Implementation, and Analysis RFC 1305 Technical Assistance Description Link The Cisco Technical Support website contains http://www.cisco.com/techsupport thousands of pages of searchable technical content, including links to products, technologies, solutions, technical tips, and tools. Registered Cisco.com users can log in from this page to access even more content. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 190 OL-26081-03 Implementing NTP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional ReferencesC H A P T E R 11 Implementing Object Tracking on Cisco IOS XR Software This module describes the configuration of object tracking on your Cisco IOS XR network. For information about its application in IPSec, see Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Security Configuration Guide. For complete descriptions of the commands listed in this module, see Related Documents, on page 206. To locate documentation for other commands that might appear in the course of performing a configuration task, search online in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Commands Master List. Table 27: Feature History for Implementing Object Tracking on Cisco IOS XR Software Contents Release Modification Release 4.2.1 This feature was introduced. This module contains the following topics: • Prerequisites for Implementing Object Tracking, page 191 • Information About Object Tracking, page 192 • How to Implement Object Tracking, page 192 • Configuration Examples for Configuring Object Tracking, page 204 • Additional References, page 206 Prerequisites for Implementing Object Tracking You must be in a user group associated with a task group that includes the proper task IDs. The command reference guides include the task IDs required for each command. If you suspect user group assignment is preventing you from using a command, contact your AAA administrator for assistance. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 191Information About Object Tracking Object tracking is a mechanism to track an object and to take an action on another object with no relationship to the tracked objects, based on changes to the properties of the object being tracked. Each tracked object is identified by a unique name specified on the tracking command-line interface (CLI). Cisco IOS XR processes then use this name to track a specific object. The tracking process periodically polls the tracked object and reports any changes to its state in terms of its being up or down, either immediately or after a delay, as configured by the user. Multiple objects can also be tracked by means of a list, using a flexible method for combining objects with Boolean logic. This functionality includes: • Boolean AND function—When a tracked list has been assigned a Boolean AND function, each object defined within a subset must be in an up state, so that the tracked object can also be in the up state. • Boolean OR function—When the tracked list has been assigned a Boolean OR function, it means that at least one object defined within a subset must also be in an up state, so that the tracked object can also be in the up state. How to Implement Object Tracking This section describes the various object tracking procedures. Tracking Whether an Interface Is Up or Down Perform this optional task in global configuration mode to track, in increments of from 1 to 10 seconds, whether the state of an interface is up or down. When the tracked object state changes to down, the tracking object (in the case of IPSec, this is the service virtual interface [SVI]) is brought down, which results in the following: • All existing tunnels on the SVI are torn down. • New tunnels cannot be established on this SVI. • All the routes, whether static or dynamic, pointing to the SVI are removed, including reverse-route injections (RRI). SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. track track-name 3. (Optional) delay {up seconds|down seconds} 4. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 192 OL-26081-03 Implementing Object Tracking on Cisco IOS XR Software Information About Object TrackingDETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Step 2 track track-name Enters track configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# track track1 • track-name—Specifies a name for the object to be tracked. (Optional) Schedules the delay that can occur between tracking whether the object is up or down. delay {up seconds|down seconds} Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track)# delay up 10 Step 3 Step 4 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track)# commit ? Entering no exitsthe configuration session and returnsthe router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Tracking the Line Protocol State of an Interface Perform this task in global configuration mode to track the line protocol state of an interface. A tracked object is considered up when a line protocol of the interface is up. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 193 Implementing Object Tracking on Cisco IOS XR Software Tracking the Line Protocol State of an InterfaceAfter configuring the tracked object, you may associate the interface whose state should be tracked and specify the number of seconds to wait before the tracking object polls the interface for its state. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. track track-name 3. type line-protocol state 4. interface type interface-path-id 5. (Optional) delay {up seconds|down seconds} 6. interface { service-gre numeric-name | service-ipsec numeric-name} 7. line-protocol track object-name 8. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Step 2 track track-name Enters track configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# track track1 • track-name—Specifies a name for the object to be tracked. type line-protocol state Creates a track based on the line protocol of an interface. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track)# type line-protocol state Step 3 Step 4 interface type interface-path-id Enters interface configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track-line-prot)#interface atm 0/2/0/0.1 • type—Specifies the interface type. For more information, use the question mark (?) online help function. • interface-path-id—Identifies a physical interface or a virtual interface. Use the show interfaces command to see a list of all possible interfaces currently configured on the router. Note Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 194 OL-26081-03 Implementing Object Tracking on Cisco IOS XR Software Tracking the Line Protocol State of an InterfaceCommand or Action Purpose The loopback and null interfaces are always in the up state and, therefore, cannot be tracked. Note (Optional) Schedules the delay that can occur between tracking whether the object is up or down. delay {up seconds|down seconds} Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track)# delay up 10 Step 5 Enters the service-ipsec interface mode, in which you associate a service-ipsec interface with the interface interface { service-gre numeric-name | service-ipsec numeric-name} Step 6 whose state should be tracked. For example, if the state Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track)# interface service-ipsec 23 of the selected interface, such as, ATM, goes down or up, the state of the service-ipsec interface follows suit. • numeric-name—Numeric name of the service-ipsec interface, which can be from 1-65535. Although service-gre interfaces can be tracked as an interface object, it is currently unsupported as a means to monitor the state of another interface object. Note Associates a specific track to an IP Sec or GRE interface. The state of the interface changes when the state of the track changes. line-protocol track object-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# line-protocol track track12 Step 7 Step 8 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track)# end before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track)# commit configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returnsthe router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 195 Implementing Object Tracking on Cisco IOS XR Software Tracking the Line Protocol State of an InterfaceCommand or Action Purpose • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Tracking IP Route Reachability When a host or a network goes down on a remote site, routing protocols notify the router and the routing table is updated accordingly. The routing process is configured to notify the tracking process when the route state changes due to a routing update. A tracked object is considered up when a routing table entry exists for the route and the route is accessible. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. track track-name 3. type route reachability 4. Use one of the following commands: • vrf vrf-table-name • route ipv4 IP-prefix/mask 5. (Optional) delay {up seconds|down seconds} 6. interface { service-gre numeric-name | service-ipsec numeric-name} 7. line-protocol track object-name 8. Use one of these commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Step 2 track track-name Enters track configuration mode. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 196 OL-26081-03 Implementing Object Tracking on Cisco IOS XR Software Tracking IP Route ReachabilityCommand or Action Purpose Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# track track1 • track-name—Specifies a name for the object to be tracked. Configures the routing process to notify the tracking process when the state of the route changes due to a routing update. type route reachability Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track)# type route reachability vrf internet Step 3 Configures the type of IP route to be tracked, which can consist of either of the following, depending on your router type: Step 4 Use one of the following commands: • vrf vrf-table-name • vrf-table-name—A VRF table name. • route ipv4 IP-prefix/mask • IP-prefix/mask—An IP prefix consisting of the network and subnet mask (for example, 10.56.8.10/16). Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track-route)# vrf vrf-table-4 or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track-route)# route ipv4 10.56.8.10/16 (Optional) Schedulesthe delay that can occur between tracking whether the object is up or down. delay {up seconds|down seconds} Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track)# delay up 10 Step 5 Enters the service-ipsec interface mode, in which you associate a service-ipsec interface with the interface whose state should be tracked. interface { service-gre numeric-name | service-ipsec numeric-name} Step 6 For example, if the state of the selected interface, such as, ATM, goes down or up, the state of the service-ipsec interface follows suit. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track)# interface service-ipsec 23 • numeric-name—Numeric name of the service-ipsec interface, which can be from 1-65535. Although service-gre interfaces can be tracked as an interface object, it is currently unsupported as a means to monitor the state of another interface object. Note Associates the track with an IPSec or GRE interface. The state of the interface changes when the state of the track changes. line-protocol track object-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# line-protocol track track1 Step 7 Step 8 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 197 Implementing Object Tracking on Cisco IOS XR Software Tracking IP Route ReachabilityCommand or Action Purpose • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • end • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Building a Track Based on a List of Objects Perform this task in the global configuration mode to create a tracked list of objects (which, in this case, are lists of interfaces or prefixes) using a Boolean expression to determine the state of the list. A tracked list contains one or more objects. The Boolean expression enables two types of calculations by using either AND or OR operators. For example, when tracking two interfaces, using the AND operator, up means that both interfaces are up, and down means that either interface is down. An object must exist before it can be added to a tracked list. The NOT operator is specified for one or more objects and negates the state of the object. Note After configuring the tracked object, you must associate the interface whose state should be tracked and you may optionally specify the number of seconds to wait before the tracking object polls the interface for its state. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 198 OL-26081-03 Implementing Object Tracking on Cisco IOS XR Software Building a Track Based on a List of ObjectsSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. track track-name 3. type list boolean { and | or } 4. object object-name [ not ] 5. (Optional) delay {up seconds|down seconds} 6. interface { service-gre numeric-name | service-ipsec numeric-name} 7. line-protocol track object-name 8. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Step 2 track track-name Enters track configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# track track1 • track-name—Specifies a name for the object to be tracked. Step 3 type list boolean { and | or } Configures a Boolean list object and enterstrack list configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track-list)# type list boolean and • boolean—Specifies that the state of the tracked list is based on a Boolean calculation. • and—Specifies that the list is up if all objects are up, or down if one or more objects are down. For example when tracking two interfaces, up means that both interfaces are up, and down means that either interface is down. • or—Specifies that the list is up if at least one object is up. For example, when tracking two interfaces, up means that either interface is up, and down means that both interfaces are down. Step 4 object object-name [ not ] Specifies the object to be tracked by the list Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track-list)# object 3 not • obect-name—Name of the object to track. • not—Negates the state of the object. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 199 Implementing Object Tracking on Cisco IOS XR Software Building a Track Based on a List of ObjectsCommand or Action Purpose (Optional) Schedules the delay that can occur between tracking whether the object is up or down. delay {up seconds|down seconds} Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track)# delay up 10 Step 5 Enters the service-ipsec interface mode, in which you associate a service-ipsec interface with the interface whose state should be tracked. interface { service-gre numeric-name | service-ipsec numeric-name} Step 6 For example, if the state of the selected interface, such as, ATM, goes down or up, the state of the service-ipsec interface follows suit. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track)# interface service-ipsec 23 • numeric-name—Numeric name of the service-ipsec interface, which can be from 1-65535. Although service-gre interfaces can be tracked as an interface object, it is currently unsupported as a means to monitor the state of another interface object. Note Associates the track to an IP Sec or GRE interface. The state of the interface changes when the state of the track changes. line-protocol track object-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# line-protocol track track1 Step 7 Step 8 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exitsthe configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leavesthe router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 200 OL-26081-03 Implementing Object Tracking on Cisco IOS XR Software Building a Track Based on a List of ObjectsBuilding a Track Based on a List of Objects - Threshold Percentage Perform this task in the global configuration mode to create a tracked list of objects (which, in this case, are lists of interfaces or prefixes) using a threshold percentage to determine the state of the list. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. track track-name 3. type list threshold percentage 4. object object-name 5. threshold percentage up percentage down percentage 6. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Step 2 track track-name Enters track configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# track track1 • track-name—Specifies a name for the object to be tracked. type list threshold percentage Configures a track of type threshold percentage list. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track-list)# type list threshold percentage Step 3 Configures object 1, object 2, object 3 and object 4 as members of track type track1. object object-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track-list-threshold)# Step 4 object 1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track-list-threshold)# object 2 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track-list-threshold)# object 3 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track-list-threshold)# Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 201 Implementing Object Tracking on Cisco IOS XR Software Building a Track Based on a List of Objects - Threshold PercentageCommand or Action Purpose object 4 Configures the percentage of objects that need to be UP or DOWN for the list to be considered UP or Down respectively. threshold percentage up percentage down percentage Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track-list-threshold)# threshold percentage up 50 down 33 Step 5 For example, if object 1, object 2, and object 3 are in the UP state and object 4 is in the DOWN state, the list is considered to be in the UP state. Step 6 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exitsthe configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Building a Track Based on a List of Objects - Threshold Weight Perform this task in the global configuration mode to create a tracked list of objects (which, in this case, are lists of interfaces or prefixes) using a threshold weight to determine the state of the list. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 202 OL-26081-03 Implementing Object Tracking on Cisco IOS XR Software Building a Track Based on a List of Objects - Threshold WeightSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. track track-name 3. type list threshold weight 4. object object-nameweight weight 5. threshold weight up weight down weight 6. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Step 2 track track-name Enters track configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# track track1 • track-name—Specifies a name for the object to be tracked. type list threshold weight Configures a a track of type, threshold weighted list. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track-list)# type list threshold weight Step 3 Configures object 1, object 2 and object 3 as members of track t1 and with weights 10, 5 and 3 respectively. object object-nameweight weight Example: Step 4 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track-list-threshold)# object 1 weight 10 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track-list-threshold)# object 2 weight 5 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track-list-threshold)# object 3 weight 3 Configures the range of weights for the objects that need to be UP or DOWN for the list to be considered UP or DOWN threshold weight up weight down weight Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track-list-threshold)# threshold weight up 10 down 5 Step 5 respectively. In this example, the list is considered to be in the DOWN state because objects 1 and 2 are in the UP state and the cumulative weight is 15 (not in the 10-5 range). Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 203 Implementing Object Tracking on Cisco IOS XR Software Building a Track Based on a List of Objects - Threshold WeightCommand or Action Purpose Step 6 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exitsthe configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-track)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuration Examples for Configuring Object Tracking For examples illustrating how to use object tracking in a variety of scenarios in IPSec, see the Implementing IPSec Network Security on Cisco IOS XR Software module in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Monitoring Configuration Guide. Tracking Whether the Interface Is Up or Down: Example track connection100 type list boolean and object object3 not delay up 10 ! interface service-ipsec 23 line-protocol track connection100 ! Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 204 OL-26081-03 Implementing Object Tracking on Cisco IOS XR Software Configuration Examples for Configuring Object TrackingTracking the Line Protocol State of an Interface: Example In this example, traffic arrives from interface service-ipsec1 and exits through interface GigabitEthernet 0/0/0/3: track IPSec1 type line-protocol state interface gigabitethernet0/0/0/3 ! interface service-ipsec 1 ipv4 address 70.0.0.1 255.255.255.0 profile vrf1_profile_ipsec line-protocol track IPSec1 tunnel source 80.0.0.1 tunnel destination 80.0.0.2 service-location preferred-active 0/0/1 ! Displaying the Line Protocol State of an Interface: Example This example displays the output from the show track command after performing the previous example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show track Track IPSec1 Interface GigabitEthernet0_0_0_3 line-protocol ! Line protocol is UP 1 change, last change 10:37:32 UTC Thu Sep 20 2007 Tracked by: service-ipsec1 ! Tracking IP Route Reachability: Example In this example, traffic arriving from interface service-ipsec1 has its destination in network 7.0.0.0/24. This tracking procedure follows the state of the routing protocol prefix to signal when there are changes in the routing table. track PREFIX1 type route reachability route ipv4 7.0.0.0/24 ! interface service-ipsec 1 vrf 1 ipv4 address 70.0.0.2 255.255.255.0 profile vrf_1_ipsec line-protocol track PREFIX1 tunnel source 80.0.0.2 tunnel destination 80.0.0.1 service-location preferred-active 0/2/0 Building a Track Based on a List of Objects: Example In this example, traffic arriving from interface service-ipsec1 exits through interface GigabitEthernet 0/0/0/3 and interface ATM 0/2/0/0.1. The destination of the traffic is at network 7.0.0.0/24. If either one of the interfaces or the remote network goes down, the flow of traffic must stop. To do this, we use a Boolean AND expression. track LIST2 type list boolean and Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 205 Implementing Object Tracking on Cisco IOS XR Software Configuration Examples for Configuring Object Trackingobject IPSec1 object IPSec2 object PREFIX1 ! track IPSec1 type line-protocol state interface GigabitEthernet0/0/0/3 ! track IPSec2 type line-protocol state interface ATM0/2/0.1 ! track PREFIX1 type route reachability route ipv4 7.0.0.0/24 ! interface service-ipsec1 vrf 1 ipv4 address 70.0.0.2 255.255.255.0 profile vrf_1_ipsec line-protocol track LIST2 tunnel source 80.0.0.2 tunnel destination 80.0.0.1 service-location preferred-active 0/2/0 ! Additional References The following sections provide referencesrelated to implementing object tracking for IPSec network security. Related Documents Related Topic Document Title IPSec Network Security Commands on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Security Configuration Guide IPSec network security commands Internet Key Exchange Security Protocol Commands on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Security Command Reference Internet Key Exchange (IKE) security protocol commands Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Command Reference IP-Sec-related object tracking commands Standards Standards Title No new or modified standards are supported by this — feature, and support for existing standards has not been modified by this feature. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 206 OL-26081-03 Implementing Object Tracking on Cisco IOS XR Software Additional ReferencesMIBs MIBs MIBs Link To locate and download MIBs using Cisco IOS XR software, use the Cisco MIB Locator found at the following URL and choose a platform under the Cisco Access Products menu: http://cisco.com/public/ sw-center/netmgmt/cmtk/mibs.shtml — RFCs RFCs Title RFC 2401 Security Architecture for the Internet Protocol Technical Assistance Description Link The Cisco Technical Support website contains http://www.cisco.com/techsupport thousands of pages of searchable technical content, including links to products, technologies, solutions, technical tips, and tools. Registered Cisco.com users can log in from this page to access even more content. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 207 Implementing Object Tracking on Cisco IOS XR Software Additional References Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 208 OL-26081-03 Implementing Object Tracking on Cisco IOS XR Software Additional ReferencesC H A P T E R 12 Implementing Physical and Virtual Terminals on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Line templates define standard attribute settings for incoming and outgoing transport over physical and virtual terminal lines (vtys). Vty pools are used to apply template settings to ranges of vtys. Before creating or modifying the vty pools, enable the telnet server using the telnet server command in global configuration mode. See Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router IP Addresses and Services Configuration Guide and Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router IP Addresses and Services Command Reference for more information. Note This module describes the new and revised tasks you need to implement physical and virtual terminals on your Cisco IOS XR network. For more information about physical and virtual terminals on the Cisco IOS XR software and complete descriptions of the terminal services commands listed in this module, see Related Documents, on page 219. To locate documentation for other commands that might appear in the course of running a configuration task, search online in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Commands Master List. Table 28: Feature History for Implementing Physical and Virtual Templates on Cisco IOS XR Software Release Modification Release 3.7.2 This feature was introduced. This module contains the following topics: • Prerequisites for Implementing Physical and Virtual Terminals, page 210 • Information About Implementing Physical and Virtual Terminals, page 210 • How to Implement Physical and Virtual Terminals on Cisco IOS XR Software, page 212 • Configuration Examples for Implementing Physical and Virtual Terminals, page 217 • Additional References, page 219 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 209Prerequisites for Implementing Physical and Virtual Terminals You must be in a user group associated with a task group that includes the proper task IDs. The command reference guides include the task IDs required for each command. If you suspect user group assignment is preventing you from using a command, contact your AAA administrator for assistance. Information About Implementing Physical and Virtual Terminals To implement physical and virtual terminals, you need to understand the concepts in this section. Line Templates The following line templates are available in the Cisco IOS XR software. • Default line template—The default line template that applies to a physical and virtual terminal lines. • Console line template—The line template that applies to the console line. • User-defined line templates—User-defined line templatesthat can be applied to a range of virtual terminal lines. Line Template Configuration Mode Changes to line template attributes are made in line template configuration mode. To enter line template configuration mode, issue the line command from global configuration mode, specifying the template to be modified. The line templates that are available to be configured with the line command can be displayed using the online help feature ( ? ): RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# line ? console console template default default template template user defined template After you specify a template with the line command, the router will enter line template configuration mode where you can set the terminal attributes that will apply to specified line template. This example shows how to specify the console template and to enter line template configuration mode for the console template: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# line console RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-line)# From line template configuration mode, the following terminal attribute setting commands can be configured: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# ? absolute-timeout Set absolute timeout for line disconnection. access-class Filter connections based on an IP access list accounting Accounting parameters authorization Authorization parameters clear Clear the uncommitted configuration clear Clear the configuration cli Set the behaviour of cli. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 210 OL-26081-03 Implementing Physical and Virtual Terminals on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Prerequisites for Implementing Physical and Virtual Terminalscommit Commit the configuration changes to running databits Set the number of databits. describe Describe a command without taking real actions disconnect-character Define the disconnect character do Run an exec command escape-character Change the current line template's escape character exec-timeout Set EXEC timeout exit Exit from this submode flowcontrol Configure flow control. interactive Interactive behaviour length Set number of lines on a screen. login Line login configuration no Negate a command or set its defaults parity Set the parity used. password Specify the password for the user pwd Commands used to reach current submode root Exit to the global configuration mode secret Provide a secure one way encrypted password session-limit Set the number of outgoing connections session-timeout Set interval for closing connection when there is no input traffic show Show contents of configuration stopbits Set the stopbits used. telnet Telnet protocol-specific configuration timeout Timeouts for the line timestamp To enable timestamp printing before each command. transport Define transport protocols for line users Users characteristics width Set width of the display terminal Line Template Guidelines The following guidelines apply to modifying the console template and to configuring a user-defined template: • Modify the templates for the physical terminal lines on the router (the console port) from line template configuration mode. Use the line console command from global configuration mode to enter line template configuration mode for the console template. • Modify the template for virtual lines by configuring a user-defined template with the line template-name command, configuring the terminal attributes for the user-defined template from line template configuration, and applying the template to a range of virtual terminal lines using the vty pool command. Attributes not defined in the console template, or any virtual template, are taken from the default template. The default settings for the default template are described for all commands in line template configuration mode in the Terminal Services Commands on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Command Reference. Before creating or modifying the vty pools, enable the telnet server using the telnet server command in global configuration mode. See Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router IP Addresses and Services Configuration Guide and Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router IP Addresses and Services Command Reference for more information. Note Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 211 Implementing Physical and Virtual Terminals on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Line Template GuidelinesTerminal Identification The physical terminal lines for the console port is identified by its location, expressed in the format of rack/slot/module , on the active or standby route processor (RP) where the respective console port resides. For virtual terminals, physical location is not applicable; the Cisco IOS XR software assigns a vty identifier to vtys according to the order in which the vty connection has been established. vty Pools Each virtual line is a member of a pool of connections using a common line template configuration. Multiple vty pools may exist, each containing a defined number of vtys as configured in the vty pool. The Cisco IOS XR software supports the following vty pools by default: • Default vty pool—The default vty pool consists of five vtys (vtys 0 through 4) that each reference the default line template. • Default fault manager pool—The default fault manager pool consists of six vtys (vtys 100 through 105) that each reference the default line template. In addition to the default vty pool and default fault manager pool, you can also configure a user-defined vty pool that can reference the default template or a user-defined template. When configuring vty pools, follow these guidelines: • The vty range for the default vty pool must start at vty 0 and must contain a minimum of five vtys. • The vty range from 0 through 99 can reference the default vty pool. • The vty range from 5 through 99 can reference a user-defined vty pool. • The vty range from 100 is reserved for the fault manager vty pool. • The vty range for fault manager vty pools must start at vty 100 and must contain a minimum of six vtys. • A vty can be a member of only one vty pool. A vty pool configuration will fail if the vty pool includes a vty that is already in another pool. • If you attempt to remove an active vty from the active vty pool when configuring a vty pool, the configuration for that vty pool will fail. How to Implement Physical and Virtual Terminals on Cisco IOS XR Software Modifying Templates Thistask explains how to modify the terminal attributesfor the console and default line templates. The terminal attributes that you set will modify the template settings for the specified template. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 212 OL-26081-03 Implementing Physical and Virtual Terminals on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Terminal IdentificationSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. line {console | default} 3. Configure the terminal attribute settings for the specified template using the commands in line template configuration mode. 4. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Step 2 line {console | default} Enters line template configuration mode for the specified line template. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# line console • console—Enters line template configuration mode for the console template. • default —Enters line template configuration mode for the default or line template. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# line default Configure the terminal attribute settings for the — specified template using the commands in line template configuration mode. Step 3 Step 4 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-line)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-line)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 213 Implementing Physical and Virtual Terminals on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Modifying TemplatesCommand or Action Purpose ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Creating and Modifying vty Pools This task explains how to create and modify vty pools. You can omit Step 3, on page 215 to Step 5, on page 215 if you are configuring the default line template to reference a vty pool. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. telnet {ipv4 | ipv6} server max-servers limit 3. line template template-name 4. Configure the terminal attribute settingsfor the specified line template using the commandsin line template configuration mode. 5. exit 6. vty-pool {default | pool-name | eem} first-vty last-vty [line-template {default | template-name}] 7. Use one of these commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 214 OL-26081-03 Implementing Physical and Virtual Terminals on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Creating and Modifying vty PoolsCommand or Action Purpose Specifies the number of allowable Telnet servers. Up to 100 Telnet servers are allowed. telnet {ipv4 | ipv6} server max-servers limit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# telnet Step 2 By default no Telnet servers are allowed. You must configure this command in order to enable the use of Telnet servers. Note ipv4 server max-servers 10 line template template-name Enters line template configuration mode for a user-defined template. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# line template 1 Step 3 Configure the terminal attribute settings for — the specified line template using the Step 4 commands in line template configuration mode. Exits line template configuration mode and returns the router to global configuration mode. exit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-line)# exit Step 5 vty-pool {default | pool-name | eem} first-vty Creates or modifies vty pools. last-vty [line-template {default | template-name}] Step 6 • If you do notspecify a line template with the line-template keyword, a vty pool defaults to the default line template. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# vty-pool • default —Configures the default vty pool. ? The default vty pool must start at vty 0 and must contain a minimum of five vtys (vtys 0 through 4). default 0 5 line-template default or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# vty-pool ? You can resize the default vty pool by increasing the range of vtys that compose the default vty pool. pool1 5 50 line-template template1 • pool-name —Creates a user-defined vty pool. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# vty-pool ? A user-defined pool must start at least at vty 5, depending on whether the default vty pool has been resized. eem 100 105 line-template template1 ? If the range of vtys for the default vty pool has been resized, use the first range value free from the default line template. For example, if the range of vtys for the default vty pool has been configured to include 10 vtys (vty 0 through 9), the range value for the user-defined vty pool must start with vty 10. • eem —Configures the embedded event manager pool. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 215 Implementing Physical and Virtual Terminals on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Creating and Modifying vty PoolsCommand or Action Purpose ? The default embedded event manager vty pool must start at vty 100 and must contain a minimum of six vtys (vtys 100 through 105). • line-template template-name —Configures the vty pool to reference a user-defined template. Step 7 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit ? Entering no exitsthe configuration session and returnsthe router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Monitoring Terminals and Terminal Sessions Thistask explains how to monitor terminals and terminalsessions using the show EXEC commands available for physical and terminal lines. Note The commands can be entered in any order. SUMMARY STEPS 1. (Optional) show line [aux location node-id | console location node-id | vty number] 2. (Optional) show terminal 3. (Optional) show users Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 216 OL-26081-03 Implementing Physical and Virtual Terminals on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Monitoring Terminals and Terminal SessionsDETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose (Optional) Displays the terminal parameters of terminal lines. show line [aux location node-id | console location node-id | vty number] Step 1 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show line • Specifying the show line aux location node-id EXEC command displays the terminal parameters of the auxiliary line. • Specifying the show line console location node-id EXEC command displays the terminal parameters of the console. ? For the location node-id keyword and argument, enter the location of the Route Processor (RP) on which the respective auxiliary or console port resides. ? The node-id argument is expressed in the format of rack/slot/module . • Specifying the show line vty number EXEC command displays the terminal parameters for the specified vty. (Optional) Displays the terminal attribute settings for the current terminal line. show terminal Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show terminal Step 2 (Optional) Displays information about the active lines on the router. show users Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show users Step 3 Configuration Examples for Implementing Physical and Virtual Terminals Modifying the Console Template: Example This configuration example shows how to modify the terminal attribute settings for the console line template: line console exec-timeout 0 0 escape-character 0x5a session-limit 10 disconnect-character 0x59 session-timeout 100 transport input telnet transport output telnet Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 217 Implementing Physical and Virtual Terminals on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuration Examples for Implementing Physical and Virtual TerminalsIn this configuration example, the following terminal attributes are applied to the console line template: • The EXEC time out for terminal sessions is set to 0 minutes, 0 seconds. Setting the EXEC timeout to 0 minutes and 0 seconds disables the EXEC timeout function; thus, the EXEC session for the terminal session will never time out. • The escape character is set to the 0x5a hexadecimal value (the 0x5a hexadecimal value translates into the “Z” character). • The session limit for outgoing terminal sessions is set to 10 connections. • The disconnect character is set to 0x59 hexadecimal value (the 0x59 hexidecimal character translates into the “Y” character). • The session time out for outgoing terminal sessions is set to 100 minutes (1 hour and 40 minutes). • The allowed transport protocol for incoming terminal sessions is Telnet. • The allowed transport protocol for outgoing terminal sessions is Telnet. To verify that the terminal attributes for the console line template have been applied to the console, use the show line command: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show line console location 0/0/CPU0 Tty Speed Modem Uses Noise Overruns Acc I/O * con0/0/CPU0 9600 - - - 0/0 -/- Line con0_0_CPU0, Location "Unknown", Type "Unknown" Length: 24 lines, Width: 80 columns Baud rate (TX/RX) is 9600, 1 parity, 2 stopbits, 8 databits Template: console Config: Allowed transports are telnet. Modifying the Default Template: Example This configuration example shows how to override the terminal settings for the default line template: line default exec-timeout 0 0 width 512 length 512 In this example, the following terminal attributes override the default line template default terminal attribute settings: • The EXEC timeout for terminal sessions is set to 0 minutes and 0 seconds. Setting the EXEC timeout to 0 minutes and 0 seconds disables the EXEC timeout function; thus, the EXEC session for the terminal session will never time out (the default EXEC timeout for the default line template is 10 minutes). • The width of the terminal screen for the terminals referencing the default template is set to 512 characters (the default width for the default line template is 80 characters). • The length, the number of lines that will display at one time on the terminal referencing the default template, is set to 512 lines (the default length for the default line template is 24 lines). Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 218 OL-26081-03 Implementing Physical and Virtual Terminals on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuration Examples for Implementing Physical and Virtual TerminalsConfiguring a User-Defined Template to Reference the Default vty Pool: Example This configuration example shows how to configure a user-defined line template (named test in this example) for vtys and to configure the line template test to reference the default vty pool: line template test exec-timeout 100 0 width 100 length 100 exit vty-pool default 0 4 line-template test Configuring a User-Defined Template to Reference a User-Defined vty Pool: Example This configuration example shows how to configure a user-defined line template (named test2 in this example) for vtys and to configure the line template test to reference a user-defined vty pool (named pool1 in this example): line template test2 exec-timeout 0 0 session-limit 10 session-timeout 100 transport input all transport output all exit vty-pool pool1 5 50 line-template test2 Configuring a User-Defined Template to Reference the Fault Manager vty Pool: Example This configuration example shows how to configure a user-defined line template (named test3 in this example) for vtys and to configure the line template test to reference the fault manager vty pool: line template test3 width 110 length 100 session-timeout 100 exit vty-pool eem 100 106 line-template test3 Additional References The following sections provide references related to implementing physical and virtual terminals on Cisco IOS XR software. Related Documents Related Topic Document Title Terminal Services Commands on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Command Reference Cisco IOS XR terminal services commands Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Commands Master List Cisco IOS XR command master index Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 219 Implementing Physical and Virtual Terminals on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional ReferencesRelated Topic Document Title Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Getting Started Guide Information about getting started with Cisco IOS XR software Configuring AAA Services on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Security Configuration Guide Information about user groups and task IDs Standards Standards Title No new or modified standards are supported by this — feature, and support for existing standards has not been modified by this feature. MIBs MIBs MIBs Link To locate and download MIBs using Cisco IOS XR software, use the Cisco MIB Locator found at the following URL and choose a platform under the Cisco Access Products menu: http://cisco.com/public/ sw-center/netmgmt/cmtk/mibs.shtml — RFCs RFCs Title No new or modified RFCs are supported by this — feature, and support for existing RFCs has not been modified by this feature. Technical Assistance Description Link The Cisco Technical Support website contains http://www.cisco.com/techsupport thousands of pages of searchable technical content, including links to products, technologies, solutions, technical tips, and tools. Registered Cisco.com users can log in from this page to access even more content. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 220 OL-26081-03 Implementing Physical and Virtual Terminals on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional ReferencesCisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 221 Implementing Physical and Virtual Terminals on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional References Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 222 OL-26081-03 Implementing Physical and Virtual Terminals on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional ReferencesC H A P T E R 13 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) is an application-layer protocol that provides a message format for communication between SNMP managers and agents. SNMP provides a standardized framework and a common language used for the monitoring and management of devices in a network. This module describes the new and revised tasks you need to implement SNMP on your Cisco IOS XR network. For detailed conceptual information about SNMP on the Cisco IOS XR software and complete descriptions of the SNMP commandslisted in this module,see Related Documents, on page 251. To locate documentation for other commands that might appear in the course of performing a configuration task, search online in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Commands Master List. Table 29: Feature History for Implementing SNMP on Cisco IOS XR Software Release Modification Release 3.7.2 This feature was introduced. Support was added for 3DES and AES encryption. The ability to preserve ENTITY-MIB and CISCO-CLASS-BASED-QOS-MIB data was added. Release 3.9.0 Release 4.2.0 Support was added for SNMP over IPv6. This module contains the following topics: • Prerequisites for Implementing SNMP, page 224 • Restrictions for SNMP Use on Cisco IOS XR Software, page 224 • Information About Implementing SNMP, page 224 • How to Implement SNMP on Cisco IOS XR Software, page 231 • Configuration Examples for Implementing SNMP, page 247 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 223• Additional References, page 251 Prerequisites for Implementing SNMP You must be in a user group associated with a task group that includes the proper task IDs. The command reference guides include the task IDs required for each command. If you suspect user group assignment is preventing you from using a command, contact your AAA administrator for assistance. Restrictions for SNMP Use on Cisco IOS XR Software SNMP outputs are only 32-bits wide and therefore cannot display any information greater than 2 32 . 2 32 is equal to 4.29 Gigabits. Note that a 10 Gigabit interface is greater than this and so if you are trying to display speed information regarding the interface, you might see concatenated results. Information About Implementing SNMP To implement SNMP, you need to understand the concepts described in this section. SNMP Functional Overview The SNMP framework consists of three parts: • SNMP manager • SNMP agent • Management Information Base (MIB) SNMP Manager The SNMP manager is the system used to control and monitor the activities of network hosts using SNMP. The most common managing system is called a network management system (NMS). The term NMS can be applied to either a dedicated device used for network management, or the applications used on such a device. A variety of network management applications are available for use with SNMP. These features range from simple command-line applications to feature-rich graphical user interfaces (such as the CiscoWorks 2000 line of products). SNMP Agent The SNMP agent is the software component within the managed device that maintains the data for the device and reports these data, as needed, to managing systems. The agent and MIB reside on the router. To enable the SNMP agent, you must define the relationship between the manager and the agent. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 224 OL-26081-03 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Prerequisites for Implementing SNMPMIB The Management Information Base (MIB) is a virtual information storage area for network management information, which consists of collections of managed objects. Within the MIB there are collections of related objects, defined in MIB modules. MIB modules are written in the SNMP MIB module language, as defined in STD 58, RFC 2578, RFC 2579, and RFC 2580. Note that individual MIB modules are also referred to as MIBs; for example, the Interfaces Group MIB (IF-MIB) is a MIB module within the MIB on your system. The SNMP agent contains MIB variables whose values the SNMP manager can request or change through Get or Set operations. A manager can get a value from an agent or store a value into that agent. The agent gathers data from the MIB, the repository for information about device parameters and network data. The agent can also respond to manager requests to get or set data. Figure 4: Communication Between an SNMP Agent and Manager, on page 225 illustratesthe communications relationship between the SNMP manager and agent. A manager can send the agent requests to get and set MIB values. The agent can respond to these requests. Independent of this interaction, the agent can send unsolicited notifications (traps) to the manager to notify the manager of network conditions. Figure 4: Communication Between an SNMP Agent and Manager Related Topics Additional References, on page 251 SNMP Notifications A key feature of SNMP is the ability to generate notifications from an SNMP agent. These notifications do not require that requests be sent from the SNMP manager. On Cisco IOS XR software, unsolicited (asynchronous) notifications can be generated only as traps. Traps are messages alerting the SNMP manager to a condition on the network. Notifications can indicate improper user authentication, restarts, the closing of a connection, loss of connection to a neighbor router, or other significant events. Note Inform requests (inform operations) are not supported in Cisco IOS XR software. Traps are less reliable than informs because the receiver does not send any acknowledgment when it receives a trap. The sender cannot determine if the trap was received. An SNMP manager that receives an inform request acknowledges the message with an SNMP response protocol data unit (PDU). If the manager does not receive an inform request, it does not send a response. If the sender never receives a response, the inform request can be sent again. Thus, informs are more likely to reach their intended destination. However, traps are often preferred because informs consume more resources in the router and in the network. Unlike a trap, which is discarded as soon as it is sent, an inform request must be held in memory until a response is received or the request times out. Also, traps are sent only once, and an inform may be retried Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 225 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router SNMP Notificationsseveral times. The retries increase traffic and contribute to a higher overhead on the network. Thus, traps and inform requests provide a trade-off between reliability and resources. In this illustration, the agent router sends a trap to the SNMP manager. Although the manager receives the trap, it does notsend any acknowledgment to the agent. The agent has no way of knowing that the trap reached its destination. Figure 5: Trap Received by the SNMP Manager In this illustration, the agent sends a trap to the manager, but the trap does not reach the manager. Because the agent has no way of knowing that the trap did not reach its destination, the trap is not sent again. The manager never receives the trap. Figure 6: Trap Not Received by the SNMP Manager SNMP Versions Cisco IOS XR software supports the following versions of SNMP: • Simple Network Management Protocol Version 1 (SNMPv1) • Simple Network Management Protocol Version 2c (SNMPv2c) • Simple Network Management Protocol Version 3 (SNMPv3) Both SNMPv1 and SNMPv2c use a community-based form of security. The community of managers able to access the agent MIB is defined by an IP address access control list and password. SNMPv2c support includes a bulk retrieval mechanism and more detailed error message reporting to management stations. The bulk retrieval mechanism supports the retrieval of tables and large quantities of information, minimizing the number of round-trips required. The SNMPv2c improved error handling support includes expanded error codesthat distinguish different kinds of error conditions; these conditions are reported Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 226 OL-26081-03 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router SNMP Versionsthrough a single error code in SNMPv1. Error return codes now report the error type. Three kinds of exceptions are also reported: no such object exceptions, no such instance exceptions, and end of MIB view exceptions. SNMPv3 is a security model. A security model is an authentication strategy that is set up for a user and the group in which the user resides. A security level is the permitted level of security within a security model. A combination of a security model and a security level will determine which security mechanism is employed when an SNMP packet is handled. See Table 31: SNMP Security Models and Levels, on page 228 for a list of security levels available in SNMPv3. The SNMPv3 feature supports RFCs 3411 to 3418. You must configure the SNMP agent to use the version of SNMP supported by the management station. An agent can communicate with multiple managers; for thisreason, you can configure the Cisco IOS-XR software to support communications with one managementstation using the SNMPv1 protocol, one using the SNMPv2c protocol, and another using SMNPv3. Comparison of SNMPv1, v2c, and v3 SNMP v1, v2c, and v3 all support the following operations: • get-request—Retrieves a value from a specific variable. • get-next-request—Retrieves the value following the named variable; this operation is often used to retrieve variables from within a table. With this operation, an SNMP manager does not need to know the exact variable name. The SNMP manager searches sequentially to find the needed variable from within the MIB. • get-response—Operation that replies to a get-request, get-next-request, and set-request sent by an NMS. • set-request—Operation that stores a value in a specific variable. • trap—Unsolicited message sent by an SNMP agent to an SNMP manager when some event has occurred. Table 30: SNMPv1, v2c, and v3 Feature Support, on page 227 identifies other key SNMP features supported by the SNMP v1, v2c, and v3. Table 30: SNMPv1, v2c, and v3 Feature Support Feature SNMP v1 SNMP v2c SNMP v3 Get-Bulk Operation No Yes Yes Yes (No on the Cisco IOS XR software) Yes (No on the Cisco IOS XR software) Inform Operation No 64 Bit Counter No Yes Yes Textual Conventions No Yes Yes Authentication No No Yes Privacy (Encryption) No No Yes Authorization and Access No No Yes Controls (Views) Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 227 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router SNMP VersionsSecurity Models and Levels for SNMPv1, v2, v3 The security level determines if an SNMP message needs to be protected from disclosure and if the message needs to be authenticated. The various security levels that exist within a security model are as follows: • noAuthNoPriv—Security level that does not provide authentication or encryption. • authNoPriv—Security level that provides authentication but does not provide encryption. • authPriv—Security level that provides both authentication and encryption. Three security models are available: SNMPv1, SNMPv2c, and SNMPv3. The security model combined with the security level determine the security mechanism applied when the SNMP message is processed. Table 31: SNMP Security Models and Levels, on page 228 identifies what the combinations ofsecurity models and levels mean. Table 31: SNMP Security Models and Levels Model Level Authentication Encryption What Happens Uses a community string match for authentication. v1 noAuthNoPriv Community string No Uses a community string match for authentication. v2c noAuthNoPriv Community string No Uses a username match for authentication. v3 noAuthNoPriv Username No Provides authentication based on the HMAC 2 -MD5 3 algorithm or the HMAC-SHA 4 . HMAC-MD5 or No HMAC-SHA v3 authNoPriv Provides authentication based on the HMAC-MD5 or HMAC-SHA algorithms. Provides DES 5 56-bit encryption in addition to authentication based on the CBC 6 DES (DES-56) standard. HMAC-MD5 or DES HMAC-SHA v3 authPriv Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 228 OL-26081-03 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router SNMP VersionsModel Level Authentication Encryption What Happens Provides authentication based on the HMAC-MD5 or HMAC-SHA algorithms. Provides 168-bit 3DES 7 level of encryption. HMAC-MD5 or 3DES HMAC-SHA v3 authPriv Provides authentication based on the HMAC-MD5 or HMAC-SHA algorithms. Provides 128-bit AES 8 level of encryption. HMAC-MD5 or AES HMAC-SHA v3 authPriv 2 Hash-Based Message Authentication Code 3 Message Digest 5 4 Secure Hash Algorithm 5 Data Encryption Standard 6 Cipher Block Chaining 7 Triple Data Encryption Standard 8 Advanced Encryption Standard Use of 3DES and AES encryption standards requires that the security package (k9sec) be installed. For information on installing software packages, see Upgrading and Managing Cisco IOS XR Software. SNMPv3 Benefits SNMPv3 provides secure access to devices by providing authentication, encryption and access control. These added security benefits secure SNMP against the following security threats: • Masquerade—The threat that an SNMP user may assume the identity of another SNMP user to perform management operations for which that SNMP user does not have authorization. • Message stream modification—The threat that messages may be maliciously reordered, delayed, or replayed (to an extent that is greater than can occur through the natural operation of a subnetwork service) to cause SNMP to perform unauthorized management operations. • Disclosure—The threat that exchanges between SNMP engines could be eavesdropped. Protecting against this threat may be required as a matter of local policy. In addition, SNMPv3 provides access control over protocol operations on SNMP managed objects. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 229 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router SNMPv3 BenefitsSNMPv3 Costs SNMPv3 authentication and encryption contribute to a slight increase in the response time when SNMP operations on MIB objects are performed. This cost is far outweighed by the security advantages provided by SNMPv3. Table 32: Order of Response Times from Least to Greatest, on page 230 shows the order of response time (from least to greatest) for the various security model and security level combinations. Table 32: Order of Response Times from Least to Greatest Security Model Security Level SNMPv2c noAuthNoPriv SNMPv3 noAuthNoPriv SNMPv3 authNoPriv SNMPv3 authPriv User-Based Security Model SNMPv3 User-Based Security Model (USM) refers to SNMP message-level security and offers the following services: • Message integrity—Ensuresthat messages have not been altered or destroyed in an unauthorized manner and that data sequences have not been altered to an extent greater than can occur nonmaliciously. • Message origin authentication—Ensures that the claimed identity of the user on whose behalf received data was originated is confirmed. • Message confidentiality—Ensures that information is not made available or disclosed to unauthorized individuals, entities, or processes. SNMPv3 authorizes management operations only by configured users and encrypts SNMP messages. USM uses two authentication protocols: • HMAC-MD5-96 authentication protocol • HMAC-SHA-96 authentication protocol USM uses Cipher Block Chaining (CBC)-DES (DES-56) as the privacy protocol for message encryption. View-Based Access Control Model The View-Based Access Control Model (VACM) enables SNMP users to control access to SNMP managed objects by supplying read, write, or notify access to SNMP objects. It prevents access to objects restricted by views. These access policies can be set when user groups are configured with the snmp-server group command. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 230 OL-26081-03 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router SNMPv3 CostsMIB Views For security reasons, it is often valuable to be able to restrict the access rights of some groups to only a subset of the management information within the management domain. To provide this capability, access to a management object is controlled through MIB views, which contain the set of managed object types (and, optionally, the specific instances of object types) that can be viewed. Access Policy Access policy determines the access rights of a group. The three types of access rights are as follows: • read-view access—The set of object instances authorized for the group when objects are read. • write-view access—The set of object instances authorized for the group when objects are written. • notify-view access—The set of object instances authorized for the group when objects are sent in a notification. IP Precedence and DSCP Support for SNMP SNMP IP Precedence and differentiated services code point (DSCP) support delivers QoS specifically for SNMP traffic. You can change the priority setting so that SNMP traffic generated in a router is assigned a specific QoS class. The IP Precedence or IP DSCP code point value is used to determine how packets are handled in weighted random early detection (WRED). After the IP Precedence or DSCP is set for the SNMP traffic generated in a router, different QoS classes cannot be assigned to different types of SNMP traffic in that router. The IP Precedence value is the first three bits in the type of service (ToS) byte of an IP header. The IP DSCP code point value is the first six bits of the differentiate services (DiffServ Field) byte. You can configure up to eight different IP Precedence markings or 64 different IP DSCP markings. How to Implement SNMP on Cisco IOS XR Software This section describes how to implement SNMP. The snmp-server commands enable SNMP on Management Ethernet interfaces by default. For information on how to enable SNMP server support on other inband interfaces, see the Implementing Management Plane Protection on Cisco IOS XR Software module in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Security Configuration Guide. Configuring SNMPv3 This task explains how to configure SNMPv3 for network management and monitoring. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 231 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router IP Precedence and DSCP Support for SNMPNo specific command enables SNMPv3; the first snmp-server global configuration command that you issue enables SNMPv3. Therefore, the sequence in which you issue the snmp-server commands for this task does not matter. Note SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. (Optional) snmp-server engineid local engine-id 3. snmp-server view view-name oid-tree {included | excluded} 4. snmp-server group name {v1 | v2c | v3 {auth | noauth | priv}} [read view] [write view] [notify view] [access-list-name] 5. snmp-server user username groupname {v1 | v2c | v3 [auth {md5 | sha} {clear | encrypted} auth-password [priv des56 {clear | encrypted} priv-password]]} [access-list-name] 6. Use one of these commands: • end • commit 7. (Optional) show snmp 8. (Optional) show snmp engineid 9. (Optional) show snmp group 10. (Optional) show snmp users 11. (Optional) show snmp view DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 (Optional) Specifiesthe identification number of the local SNMP engine. snmp-server engineid local engine-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# snmp-server Step 2 engineID local 00:00:00:09:00:00:00:a1:61:6c:20:61 snmp-server view view-name oid-tree {included | Creates or modifies a view record. excluded} Step 3 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 232 OL-26081-03 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring SNMPv3Command or Action Purpose Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# snmp-server view view_name 1.3.6.1.2.1.1.5 included Configures a new SNMP group or a table that maps SNMP users to SNMP views. snmp-server group name {v1 | v2c | v3 {auth | noauth | priv}} [read view] [write view] [notify view] [access-list-name] Step 4 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# snmp-server group group_name v3 noauth read view_name1 write view_name2 snmp-server user username groupname Configures a new user to an SNMP group. {v1 | v2c | v3 [auth {md5 | sha} {clear | encrypted} Step 5 auth-password [priv des56 {clear | encrypted} priv-password]]} [access-list-name] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# snmp-server user noauthuser group_name v3 Step 6 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exitsthe configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 233 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring SNMPv3Command or Action Purpose (Optional) Displays information about the status of SNMP. show snmp Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show snmp Step 7 (Optional) Displays information about the local SNMP engine. show snmp engineid Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show snmp engineid Step 8 (Optional) Displaysinformation about each SNMP group on the network. show snmp group Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show snmp group Step 9 (Optional) Displays information about each SNMP username in the SNMP users table. show snmp users Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show snmp users Step 10 (Optional) Displays information about the configured views, including the associated MIB view family name, storage type, and status. show snmp view Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show snmp view Step 11 Configuring SNMP Trap Notifications This task explains how to configure the router to send SNMP trap notifications. You can omit Step 2, on page 232 to Step 4, on page 233 if you have already completed the steps documented under the Configuring SNMPv3, on page 231 task. Note Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 234 OL-26081-03 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring SNMP Trap NotificationsSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. (Optional) snmp-server engineid local engine-id 3. snmp-server group name {v1 | v2c | v3 {auth | noauth | priv}} [read view] [write view] [notify view] [access-list-name] 4. snmp-server user username groupname {v1 | v2c | v3 [auth {md5 | sha} {clear | encrypted} auth-password [priv des56 {clear | encrypted} priv-password]]} [access-list-name] 5. snmp-server host address [traps] [version {1 | 2c | 3 [auth | noauth | priv]}] community-string [udp-port port] [notification-type] 6. snmp-server traps [notification-type] 7. Use one of these commands: • end • commit 8. (Optional) show snmp host DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 (Optional) Specifies the identification number of the local SNMP engine. snmp-server engineid local engine-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# snmp-server Step 2 engineID local 00:00:00:09:00:00:00:a1:61:6c:20:61 Configures a new SNMP group or a table that maps SNMP users to SNMP views. snmp-server group name {v1 | v2c | v3 {auth | noauth | priv}} [read view] [write view] [notify view] [access-list-name] Step 3 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# snmp-server group group_name v3 noauth read view_name1 write view_name2 snmp-server user username groupname Configures a new user to an SNMP group. {v1 | v2c | v3 [auth {md5 | sha} {clear | encrypted} Step 4 auth-password [priv des56 {clear | encrypted} priv-password]]} [access-list-name] Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 235 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring SNMP Trap NotificationsCommand or Action Purpose Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# snmp-server user noauthuser group_name v3 Specifies SNMP trap notifications, the version of SNMP to use, the security level of the notifications, and the recipient (host) of the notifications. snmp-server host address [traps] [version {1 | 2c | 3 [auth | noauth | priv]}] community-string [udp-port port] [notification-type] Example: RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config)# snmp-server host 12.26.25.61 traps version 3 noauth userV3noauth Step 5 Enables the sending of trap notifications and specifies the type of trap notifications to be sent. snmp-server traps [notification-type] Example: RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config)# snmp-server traps bgp Step 6 • If a trap is not specified with the notification-type argument, all supported trap notifications are enabled on the router. To display which trap notifications are available on your router, enter the snmp-server traps ? command. Step 7 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit ? Entering no exitsthe configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changesto the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. (Optional) Displays information about the configured SNMP notification recipient (host), port number, and security model. show snmp host Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show snmp host Step 8 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 236 OL-26081-03 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring SNMP Trap NotificationsSetting the Contact, Location, and Serial Number of the SNMP Agent This task explains how to set the system contact string, system location string, and system serial number of the SNMP agent. Note The sequence in which you issue the snmp-server commands for this task does not matter. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. (Optional) snmp-server contact system-contact-string 3. (Optional) snmp-server location system-location 4. (Optional) snmp-server chassis-id serial-number 5. Use one of these commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 (Optional) Sets the system contact string. snmp-server contact system-contact-string Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# snmp-server Step 2 contact Dial System Operator at beeper # 27345 (Optional) Sets the system location string. snmp-server location system-location Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# snmp-server location Building 3/Room 214 Step 3 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 237 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Setting the Contact, Location, and Serial Number of the SNMP AgentCommand or Action Purpose (Optional) Sets the system serial number. snmp-server chassis-id serial-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# snmp-server chassis-id 1234456 Step 4 Step 5 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yessaves configuration changesto the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Defining the Maximum SNMP Agent Packet Size This task shows how to configure the largest SNMP packet size permitted when the SNMP server is receiving a request or generating a reply. Note The sequence in which you issue the snmp-server commands for this task does not matter. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 238 OL-26081-03 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Defining the Maximum SNMP Agent Packet SizeSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. (Optional) snmp-server packetsize byte-count 3. Use one of these commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 (Optional) Sets the maximum packet size. snmp-server packetsize byte-count Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# snmp-server packetsize 1024 Step 2 Step 3 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 239 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Defining the Maximum SNMP Agent Packet SizeChanging Notification Operation Values After SNMP notifications have been enabled, you can specify a value other than the default for the source interface, message queue length, or retransmission interval. This task explains how to specify a source interface for trap notifications, the message queue length for each host, and the retransmission interval. Note The sequence in which you issue the snmp-server commands for this task does not matter. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. (Optional) snmp-server trap-source type interface-path-id 3. (Optional) snmp-server queue-length length 4. (Optional) snmp-server trap-timeout seconds 5. Use one of these commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 (Optional) Specifies a source interface for trap notifications. snmp-server trap-source type interface-path-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# snmp-server trap-source POS 0/0/1/0 Step 2 (Optional) Establishes the message queue length for each notification. snmp-server queue-length length Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# snmp-server queue-length 20 Step 3 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 240 OL-26081-03 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Changing Notification Operation ValuesCommand or Action Purpose (Optional) Defines how often to resend notifications on the retransmission queue. snmp-server trap-timeout seconds Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# snmp-server trap-timeout 20 Step 4 Step 5 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Setting IP Precedence and DSCP Values This task describes how to configure IP Precedence or IP DSCP for SNMP traffic. Before You Begin SNMP must be configured. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 241 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Setting IP Precedence and DSCP ValuesSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. Use one of the following commands: • snmp-server ipv4 precedence value • snmp-server ipv4 dscp value 3. Use one of these commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Step 2 Use one of the following commands: Configures an IP precedence or IP DSCP value for SNMP traffic. • snmp-server ipv4 precedence value • snmp-server ipv4 dscp value Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# snmp-server dscp 24 Step 3 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 242 OL-26081-03 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Setting IP Precedence and DSCP ValuesCommand or Action Purpose ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuring MIB Data to be Persistent Many SNMP MIB definitions define arbitrary 32-bit indices for their object tables. MIB implementations often do a mapping from the MIB indices to some internal data structure that is keyed by some other set of data. In these MIB tables the data contained in the table are often other identifiers of the element being modelled. For example, in the ENTITY-MIB, entries in the entPhysicalTable are indexed by the 31-bit value, entPhysicalIndex, but the entities could also be identified by the entPhysicalName or a combination of the other objects in the table. Because of the size of some MIB tables, significant processing is required to discover all the mappings from the 32-bit MIB indices to the other data which the network management station identifies the entry. For this reason, it may be necessary for some MIB indices to be persistent across process restarts, switchovers, or device reloads. The ENTITY-MIB entPhysicalTable and CISCO-CLASS-BASED-QOS-MIB are two such MIBs that often require index values to be persistent. Also, because of query response times and CPU utilization during CISCO-CLASS-BASED-QOS-MIB statistics queries, it is desirable to cache service policy statistics. SUMMARY STEPS 1. (Optional) snmp-server entityindex persist 2. (Optional) snmp-server mibs cbqosmib persist 3. (Optional) snmp-server cbqosmib cache refresh time time 4. (Optional) snmp-server cbqosmib cache service-policy count count 5. snmp-server ifindex persist DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose (Optional) Enables the persistent storage of ENTITY-MIB data. snmp-server entityindex persist Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# snmp-server entityindex persist Step 1 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 243 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring MIB Data to be PersistentCommand or Action Purpose (Optional) Enables persistent storage of the CISCO-CLASS-BASED-QOS-MIB data. snmp-server mibs cbqosmib persist Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# snmp-server mibs cbqosmib persist Step 2 (Optional) Enables QoS MIB caching with a specified cache refresh time. snmp-server cbqosmib cache refresh time time Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# snmp-server mibs cbqosmib cache refresh time 45 Step 3 (Optional) Enables QoS MIB caching with a limited number of service policies to cache. snmp-server cbqosmib cache service-policy count count Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# snmp-server mibs cbqosmib cache service-policy count 50 Step 4 Enables ifIndex persistence globally on all Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) interfaces. snmp-server ifindex persist Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# snmp-server ifindex persist Step 5 Configuring LinkUp and LinkDown Traps for a Subset of Interfaces By specifying a regular expression to represent the interfaces for which you are interested in setting traps, you can enable or disable linkUp and linkDown traps for a large number of interfaces simultaneously. Before You Begin SNMP must be configured. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 244 OL-26081-03 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring LinkUp and LinkDown Traps for a Subset of InterfacesSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. snmp-server interface subset subset-number regular-expression expression 3. notification linkupdown disable 4. Use one of these commands: • end • commit 5. (Optional) show snmp interface notification subset subset-number 6. (Optional) show snmp interface notification regular-expression expression 7. (Optional) show snmp interface notification type interface-path-id DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Enters snmp-server interface mode for the interfaces identified by the regular expression. snmp-server interface subset subset-number regular-expression expression Step 2 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# snmp-server The subset-number argument identifies the set of interfaces, and also assigns a priority to the subset in the event that an interface is included in more than one subset. Lower numbers have higher priority and their configuration takes precedent over interface subsets with higher numbers. interface subset 10 regular-expression "^Gig[a-zA-Z]+[0-9/]+\." RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-snmp-if-subset)# The expression argument must be entered surrounded by double quotes. Refer to the Understanding Regular Expressions, Special Characters, and Patterns module in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Getting Started Guide for more information regarding regular expressions. Disables linkUp and linkDown traps for all interfaces being configured. To enable previously disabled interfaces, use the no form of this command. notification linkupdown disable Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-snmp-if-subset)# notification linkupdown disable Step 3 Step 4 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 245 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring LinkUp and LinkDown Traps for a Subset of InterfacesCommand or Action Purpose • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • end • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# end ? Entering yessaves configuration changesto the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. (Optional) Displays the linkUp and linkDown notification status for all interfaces identified by the subset priority. show snmp interface notification subset subset-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show snmp interface notification subset 10 Step 5 (Optional) Displays the linkUp and linkDown notification status for all interfaces identified by the regular expression. show snmp interface notification regular-expression expression Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show snmp interface Step 6 notification regular-expression "^Gig[a-zA-Z]+[0-9/]+\." (Optional) Displays the linkUp and linkDown notification status for the specified interface. show snmp interface notification type interface-path-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show snmp interface Step 7 notification GigabitEthernet0/4/0/3.10 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 246 OL-26081-03 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring LinkUp and LinkDown Traps for a Subset of InterfacesConfiguration Examples for Implementing SNMP Configuring SNMPv3: Examples Setting an Engine ID This example shows how to set the identification of the local SNMP engine: snmp-server engineID local 00:00:00:09:00:00:00:a1:61:6c:20:61 Note After the engine ID has been configured, the SNMP agent restarts. Verifying the Identification of the Local SNMP Engines This example shows how to verify the identification of the local SNMP engine: config show snmp engineid SNMP engineID 00000009000000a1ffffffff Creating a View There are two ways to create a view: • You can include the object identifier (OID) of an ASN.1 subtree of a MIB family from a view by using the included keyword of the snmp-server view command. • You can exclude the OID subtree of the ASN.1 subtree of a MIB family from a view by using the excluded keyword of the snmp-server view command. This example shows how to create a view that includes the sysName (1.3.6.1.2.1.1.5) object: config snmp-server view view_name 1.3.6.1.2.1.1.5 included This example shows how to create a view that includes all the OIDs of a system group: config snmp-server view view_name 1.3.6.1.2.1.1 included This example shows how to create a view that includes all the OIDs under the system group except the sysName object (1.3.6.1.2.1.1.5), which has been excluded: config snmp-server view view_name 1.3.6.1.2.1.1 included snmp-server view view_name 1.3.6.1.2.1.1.5 excluded Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 247 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuration Examples for Implementing SNMPVerifying Configured Views This example shows how to display information about the configured views: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show snmp view v1default 1.3.6.1 - included nonVolatile active view_name 1.3.6.1.2.1.1 - included nonVolatile active view_name 1.3.6.1.2.1.1.5 - excluded nonVolatile active Creating Groups If you do not explicitly specify a notify, read, or write view, the Cisco IOS XR software uses the v1 default (1.3.6.1). This example shows how to create a group that utilizes the default view: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# snmp-server group group-name v3 auth The following configuration example shows how to create a group that has read access to all the OIDs in the system except the sysUpTime object (1.3.6.1.2.1.1.3), which has been excluded from the view applied to the group, but write access only to the sysName object (1.3.6.1.2.1.1.5): ! snmp-server view view_name1 1.3.6.1.2.1.1 included snmp-server view view_name1 1.3.6.1.2.1.1.3 excluded snmp-server view view_name2 1.3.6.1.2.1.1.5 included snmp-server group group_name v3 auth read view_name1 write view_name2 ! Verifying Groups This example shows how to verify the attributes of configured groups: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show snmp group groupname: group_name security model:usm readview : view_name1 writeview: view_name2 notifyview: v1default row status: nonVolatile Creating and Verifying Users Given the following SNMPv3 view and SNMPv3 group configuration: ! snmp-server view view_name1 1.3.6.1.2.1.1 included snmp-server group group_name v3 noauth read view_name write view-name ! This example shows how to create a noAuthNoPriv user with read and write view access to a system group: config snmp-server user noauthuser group_name v3 Note The user must belong to a noauth group before a noAuthNoPriv user can be created. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 248 OL-26081-03 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring SNMPv3: ExamplesThis example shows how to verify the attributes that apply to the SNMP user: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show snmp user User name: noauthuser Engine ID: localSnmpID storage-type: nonvolatile active Given the following SNMPv3 view and SNMPv3 group configuration: ! snmp-server view view_name 1.3.6.1.2.1.1 included snmp group group_name v3 priv read view_name write view_name ! This example shows how to create authNoPriv user with read and write view access to a system group: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# snmp-server user authuser group_name v3 auth md5 clear auth_passwd Because the group is configured at a security level of Auth, the user must be configured as “auth” at a minimum to access this group (“priv” users could also access this group). The authNoPriv user configured in this group, authuser, must supply an authentication password to access the view. In the example, auth_passwd is set as the authentication password string. Note that clear keyword is specified before the auth_passwd password string. The clear keyword indicates that the password string being supplied is unencrypted. Note This example shows how to verify the attributes that apply to SNMP user: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show snmp user User name: authuser Engine ID: localSnmpID storage-type: nonvolatile active Given the following SNMPv3 view and SNMPv3 group configuration: ! snmp view view_name 1.3.6.1.2.1.1 included snmp group group_name v3 priv read view_name write view_name ! This example shows how to create an authPriv user with read and write view access to a system group: config snmp-server user privuser group_name v3 auth md5 clear auth_passwd priv des56 clear priv_passwd Because the group has a security level of Priv, the user must be configured as a “priv” user to access this group. In this example, the user, privuser, must supply both an authentication password and privacy password to access the OIDs in the view. Note This example shows how to verify the attributes that apply to the SNMP user: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show snmp user Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 249 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring SNMPv3: ExamplesUser name: privuser Engine ID: localSnmpID storage-type: nonvolatile active Configuring Trap Notifications: Example The following example configures an SNMP agent to send out different types of traps. The configuration includes a v2c user, a noAuthNoPriv user, anauthNoPriv user, and an AuthPriv user. The default User Datagram Protocol (UDP) port is 161. If you do not a specify a UDP port with the udp-port keyword and port argument, then the configured SNMP trap notifications are sent to port 161. Note ! snmp-server host 10.50.32.170 version 2c userv2c udp-port 2345 snmp-server host 10.50.32.170 version 3 auth userV3auth udp-port 2345 snmp-server host 10.50.32.170 version 3 priv userV3priv udp-port 2345 snmp-server host 10.50.32.170 version 3 noauth userV3noauth udp-port 2345 snmp-server user userv2c groupv2c v2c snmp-server user userV3auth groupV3auth v3 auth md5 encrypted 140F0A13 snmp-server user userV3priv groupV3priv v3 auth md5 encrypted 021E1C43 priv des56 encrypted 1110001C snmp-server user userV3noauth groupV3noauth v3 LROwner snmp-server view view_name 1.3 included snmp-server community public RW snmp-server group groupv2c v2c read view_name snmp-server group groupV3auth v3 auth read view_name snmp-server group groupV3priv v3 priv read view_name snmp-server group groupV3noauth v3 noauth read view_name ! This example shows how to verify the configuration SNMP trap notification recipients host, the recipients of SNMP trap notifications. The output displays the following information: • IP address of the configured notification host • UDP port where SNMP notification messages are sent • Type of trap configured • Security level of the configured user • Security model configured config show snmp host Notification host: 10.50.32.170 udp-port: 2345 type: trap user: userV3auth security model: v3 auth Notification host: 10.50.32.170 udp-port: 2345 type: trap user: userV3noauth security model: v3 noauth Notification host: 10.50.32.170 udp-port: 2345 type: trap user: userV3priv security model: v3 priv Notification host: 10.50.32.170 udp-port: 2345 type: trap user: userv2c security model: v2c Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 250 OL-26081-03 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Trap Notifications: ExampleSetting an IP Precedence Value for SNMP Traffic: Example The following example shows how to set the SNMP IP Precedence value to 7: configure snmp-server ipv4 precedence 7 exit Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: y Setting an IP DSCP Value for SNMP Traffic: Example The following example shows how to set the IP DSCP value of SNMP traffic to 45: configure snmp-server ipv4 dscp 45 exit Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: y Additional References The following sections provide references related to Implementing SNMP on Cisco IOS XR software. Related Documents Related Topic Document Title SNMP Server Commands on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Command Reference Cisco IOS XR SNMP commands Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Commands Master List Cisco IOS XR commands Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Getting Started Guide Getting started with Cisco IOS XR software Configuring AAA Services on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Security Configuration Guide Information about user groups and task IDs Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Modular Quality of Service Configuration Guide Cisco IOS XR Quality of Service Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 251 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Setting an IP Precedence Value for SNMP Traffic: ExampleStandards Standards Title No new or modified standards are supported by this — feature, and support for existing standards has not been modified by this feature. MIBs MIBs MIBs Link To locate and download MIBs using Cisco IOS XR software, use the Cisco MIB Locator found at the following URL and choose a platform under the Cisco Access Products menu: http://cisco.com/public/ sw-center/netmgmt/cmtk/mibs.shtml — RFCs RFCs Title An Architecture for Describing Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) Management Frameworks RFC 3411 Message Processing and Dispatching for the Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) RFC 3412 Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) Applications RFC 3413 User-based Security Model (USM) for version 3 of the Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMPv3) RFC 3414 View-based Access Control Model (VACM) for the Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) RFC 3415 Version 2 of the Protocol Operations for the Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) RFC 3416 Transport Mappings for the Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) RFC 3417 Management Information Base (MIB) for the Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) RFC 3418 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 252 OL-26081-03 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional ReferencesTechnical Assistance Description Link The Cisco Technical Support website contains http://www.cisco.com/techsupport thousands of pages of searchable technical content, including links to products, technologies, solutions, technical tips, and tools. Registered Cisco.com users can log in from this page to access even more content. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 253 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional References Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 254 OL-26081-03 Implementing SNMP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional ReferencesC H A P T E R 14 Configuring Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router This document describes how to periodically transfer selected MIB data from your router to a specified Network Management System (NMS). The periodic MIB data collection and transfer feature is also known as bulk statistics. Table 33: Feature History for Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer Release Modification The periodic MIB data collection and transfer feature wasintroduced and supported the IF-MIB only. Release 4.2.0 Release 4.2.1 Additional MIBs were supported. This module contains the following topics: • Prerequisites for Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer, page 255 • Information About Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer, page 256 • How to Configure Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer, page 257 • Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer: Example, page 265 Prerequisites for Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer To use periodic MIB data collection and transfer, you should be familiar with the Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) model of management information. You should also know what MIB information you want to monitor on your network devices, and the OIDs or object names for the MIB objects to be monitored. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 255Information About Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer SNMP Objects and Instances A type (or class) of SNMP management information is called an object. A specific instance from a type of management information is called an object instance (or SNMP variable). To configure a bulk statistics collection, you must specify the object types to be monitored using a bulk statistics object list and the specific instances of those objects to be collected using a bulk statistics schema. MIBs, MIB tables, MIB objects, and object indices can all be specified using a series of numbers called an object identifier (OID). OIDs are used in configuring a bulk statistics collection in both the bulk statistics object lists (for general objects) and in the bulk statistics schemas (for specific object instances). Bulk Statistics Object Lists To group the MIB objects to be polled, you need to create one or more object lists. A bulk statistics object list is a user-specified set of MIB objects that share the same MIB index. Object lists are identified using a name that you specify. Named bulk statistics object lists allow the same configuration to be reused in different bulk statistics schemas. All the objects in an object list must share the same MIB index. However, the objects do not need to be in the same MIB and do not need to belong to the same MIB table. For example, it is possible to group ifInOctets and a CISCO-IF-EXTENSION-MIB object in the same schema, because the containing tablesfor both objects are indexed by the ifIndex. Bulk Statistics Schemas Data selection for the Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer Mechanism requires the definition of a schema with the following information: • Name of an object list. • Instance (specific instance or series of instances defined using a wild card) that needs to be retrieved for objects in the specified object list. • How often the specified instances need to be sampled (polling interval). The default polling interval is 5 minutes. A bulk statistics schema is also identified using a name that you specify. This name is used when configuring the transfer options. Bulk Statistics Transfer Options After configuring the data to be collected, a single virtual file (VFile or bulk statistics file) with all collected data is created. This file can be transferred to a network management station using FTP or TFTP. You can specify how often this file should be transferred. The default transfer interval is once every 30 minutes. You can also configure a secondary destination for the file to be used if, for whatever reason, the file cannot be transferred to the primary network management station. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 256 OL-26081-03 Configuring Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Information About Periodic MIB Data Collection and TransferThe value of the transfer interval is also the collection period (collection interval) for the local bulk statistics file. After the collection period ends, the bulk statistics file is frozen, and a new local bulk statistics file is created for storing data. The frozen bulk statistics file is then transferred to the specified destination. By default, the local bulk statistics file is deleted after successful transfer to an network management station. Benefits of Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer Periodic MIB data collection and transfer (bulk statistics feature) allows many of the same functions as the bulk file MIB (CISCO-BULK-FILE-MIB.my), but offers some key advantages. The main advantage is that this feature can be configured through the CLI and does not require an external monitoring application. Periodic MIB data collection and transfer is mainly targeted for medium to high-end platforms that have sufficient local storage (volatile or permanent) to store bulk statistics files. Locally storing bulk statistics files helps minimize loss of data during temporary network outages. This feature also has more powerful data selection features than the bulk file MIB; it allows grouping of MIB objectsfrom different tablesinto data groups(object lists). It also incorporates a more flexible instance selection mechanism, where the application is not restricted to fetching an entire MIB table. How to Configure Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer Configuring a Bulk Statistics Object List The first step in configuring the Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer Mechanism is to configure one or more object lists. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. snmp-server mib bulkstat object-list list-name 3. add {oid | object-name} 4. Use one of these commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 257 Configuring Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Benefits of Periodic MIB Data Collection and TransferCommand or Action Purpose Defines an SNMP bulk statistics object list and enters bulk statistics object list configuration mode. snmp-server mib bulkstat object-list list-name Example: snmp-server mib bulkstat object-list ifMib Step 2 Adds a MIB object to the bulk statistics object list. Repeat as desired until all objects to be monitored in this list are added. add {oid | object-name} Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bulk-objects)# Step 3 All the objectsin a bulk statistics object list have to be indexed by the same MIB index. However, the objects in the object list do not need to belong to the same MIB or MIB table. When specifying an object name instead of an OID (using the add command), only object names with mappings shown in the show snmp mib object command output can be used. Note add 1.3.6.1.2.1.2.2.1.11 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bulk-objects)# add ifAdminStatus RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bulk-objects)# add ifDescr Step 4 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leavesthe router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. What to Do Next Configure a bulk statistics schema. Configuring a Bulk Statistics Schema The second step in configuring periodic MIB data collection and transfer is to configure one or more schemas. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 258 OL-26081-03 Configuring Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring a Bulk Statistics SchemaBefore You Begin The bulk statistics object list to be used in the schema must be defined. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. snmp-server mib bulkstat schema schema-name 3. object-list list-name 4. Do one of the following: • instance exact {interface interface-id [sub-if] | oid oid} • instance wild {interface interface-id [sub-if] | oid oid} • instance range start oid end oid • instance repetition oid max repeat-number 5. poll-interval minutes 6. Use one of these commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 snmp-server mib bulkstatschema schema-name Namesthe bulk statisticsschema and enters bulk statisticsschema mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# snmp-server Step 2 mib bulkstat schema intE0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bulk-sc)# Specifies the bulk statistics object list to be included in this schema. Specify only one object list perschema. If multiple object-list commands are executed, the earlier ones are overwritten by newer commands. object-list list-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bulk-sc)# object-list ifMib Step 3 Step 4 Do one of the following: Specifies the instance information for objects in this schema: • instance exact {interface interface-id [sub-if] | oid oid} • The instance exact command indicatesthat the specified instance, when appended to the object list, represents the complete OID. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 259 Configuring Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring a Bulk Statistics SchemaCommand or Action Purpose • The instance wild command indicates that all subindices of the specified OID belong to this schema. The wild keyword allows you to specify a partial, “wild carded” instance. • instance wild {interface interface-id [sub-if] | oid oid} • instance range start oid end oid • The instance range command indicates a range of instances on which to collect data. • instance repetition oid max repeat-number • The instance repetition command indicates data collection to repeat for a certain number of instances of a MIB object. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bulk-sc)# instance wild oid 1 Only one instance command can be configured per schema. If multiple instance commands are executed, the earlier ones are overwritten by new commands. Note or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bulk-sc)# instance exact interface FastEthernet 0/1.25 or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bulk-sc)# instance range start 1 end 2 or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bulk-sc)# instance repetition 1 max 4 Sets how often data should be collected from the object instances specified in thisschema, in minutes. The default is once every 5 minutes. The valid range is from 1 to 20000. poll-interval minutes Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bulk-sc)# poll-interval 10 Step 5 Step 6 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exitsthe configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 260 OL-26081-03 Configuring Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring a Bulk Statistics SchemaWhat to Do Next Configure the bulk statistics transfer options. Configuring Bulk Statistics Transfer Options The final step in configuring periodic MIB data collection and transfer is to configure the transfer options. The collected MIB data are kept in a local file-like entity called a VFile (virtual file, referred to as a bulk statisticsfile in this document). Thisfile can be transferred to a remote network managementstation at intervals you specify. Before You Begin The bulk statistics object lists and bulk statistics schemas must be defined before configuring the bulk statistics transfer options. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. snmp-server mib bulkstat transfer-id transfer-id 3. buffer-size bytes 4. format {bulkBinary | bulkASCII | schemaASCII} 5. schema schema-name 6. transfer-interval minutes 7. url primary url 8. url secondary url 9. retry number 10. retain minutes 11. enable 12. Use one of these commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 261 Configuring Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Bulk Statistics Transfer OptionsCommand or Action Purpose Identifies the transfer configuration with a name (transfer-id argument) and enters bulk statistics transfer configuration mode. snmp-server mib bulkstat transfer-id transfer-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# snmp-server mib bulkstat transfer bulkstat1 Step 2 (Optional) Specifies the maximum size for the bulk statistics data file, in bytes. The valid range is from 1024 to 2147483647 bytes. The default buffer size is 2048 bytes. buffer-size bytes Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bulk-tr)# buffersize 3072 Step 3 If the maximum buffer size for a bulk statistics file is reached before the transfer interval time expires, all additional data received is deleted. To correct this behavior, you can decrease the polling frequency, or increase the size of the bulk statistics buffer. Note (Optional) Specifies the format of the bulk statistics data file (VFile). The default is schemaASCII. format {bulkBinary | bulkASCII | schemaASCII} Step 4 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bulk-tr)# format schemaASCII Transfers can only be performed using schemaASCII (cdcSchemaASCII) format. SchemaASCII is a human-readable format that contains parser-friendly hintsfor parsing data values. Note Specifies the bulk statistics schema to be transferred. Repeat this command as desired. Multiple schemas can be associated with a single schema schema-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bulk-tr)# Step 5 transfer configuration; all collected data are placed in a single bulk data file (VFile). schema ATM2/0-IFMIB RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bulk-tr)# schema ATM2/0-CAR RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bulk-tr)# schema Ethernet2/1-IFMIB (Optional) Specifies how often the bulk statistics file are transferred, in minutes. The default value is once every 30 minutes. The transfer interval is the same as the collection interval. transfer-interval minutes Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bulk-tr)# transfer-interval 20 Step 6 Specifies the network management system (host) that the bulk statistics data file is transferred to, and the protocol to use for transfer. The url primary url Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bulk-tr)# url primary ftp://user:password@host/folder/bulkstat1 Step 7 destination is specified as a Uniform Resource Locator (URL). FTP or TFTP can be used for the bulk statistics file transfer. (Optional) Specifies a backup transfer destination and protocol for use in the event that transfer to the primary location fails. FTP or TFTP can be used for the bulk statistics file transfer. url secondary url Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bulk-tr)# url secondary tftp://10.1.0.1/tftpboot/user/bulkstat1 Step 8 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 262 OL-26081-03 Configuring Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Bulk Statistics Transfer OptionsCommand or Action Purpose (Optional) Specifiesthe number of transmission retries. The default value is 0 (in other words, no retries). If an attempt to send the bulk statistics retry number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bulk-tr)# retry 1 Step 9 file fails, the system can be configured to attempt to send the file again using this command. One retry includes an attempt first to the primary destination then, if the transmission fails, to the secondary location. For example, if the retry value is 1, an attempt is made first to the primary URL, then to the secondary URL, then to the primary URL again, then to the secondary URL again. The valid range is from 0 to 100. If all retries fail, the next normal transfer occurs after the configured transfer-interval time. (Optional) Specifies how long the bulk statistics file should be kept in system memory, in minutes, after the completion of the collection interval retain minutes Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bulk-tr)# retain 60 Step 10 and a transmission attempt is made. The default value is 0. Zero (0) indicatesthat the file is deleted immediately after the transfer is attempted. The valid range is from 0 to 20000. If the retry command is used, you should configure a retain interval larger than 0. The interval between retries is the retain interval divided by the retry number. For example, if retain 10 and retry 2 are configured, two retries are attempted once every 5 minutes. Therefore, if retain 0 is configured, no retries are attempted. Note Begins the bulk statistics data collection and transfer process for this configuration. enable Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bulk-tr)# enable Step 11 • For successful execution of this action, at least one schema with non-zero number of objects must be configured. • Periodic collection and file transfer begins only if this command is configured. Conversely, the no enable command stopsthe collection process. A subsequent enable starts the operations again. • Each time the collection process is started using the enable command, data is collected into a new bulk statistics file. When the no enable command is used, the transfer process for any collected data immediately begins(in other words, the existing bulk statistics file is transferred to the specified management station). Step 12 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 263 Configuring Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Bulk Statistics Transfer OptionsCommand or Action Purpose ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. What to Do Next If the maximum buffer size for a bulk statistics file is reached before the transfer interval time expires, the transfer operation isstill initiated, but any bulk statistics data received after the file wasfull, and before it wastransferred, are deleted. To correct this behavior, you can decrease the polling frequency, or increase the size of the bulk statistics buffer. If retain 0 is configured, no retries are attempted. This is because the interval between retries is the retain value divided by the retry value. For example, if retain 10 and retry 2 are configured, retries are attempted once every 5 minutes. Therefore, if you configure the retry command, you should also configure an appropriate value for the retain command. Note Monitoring Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer SUMMARY STEPS 1. show snmp mib bulkstat transfer transfer-name DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose (Optional) The show command for this feature lists all bulk statistics virtual files (VFiles) on the system that have finished collecting data. (Data files that are not complete are not displayed.) show snmp mib bulkstat transfer transfer-name Step 1 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 264 OL-26081-03 Configuring Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Monitoring Periodic MIB Data Collection and TransferCommand or Action Purpose The output lists all of the completed local bulk statistics files, the remaining time left before the bulk statistics file is deleted (remaining retention period), and the state of the bulk statistics file. The “STATE” of the bulk statistics file is one of the following: • Queued--Indicates that the data collection for this bulk statistics file is completed (in other words, the transfer interval has been met) and that the bulk statistics file is waiting for transfer to the configured destination(s). • Retry--Indicates that one or more transfer attempts have failed and that the file transfer will be attempted again. The number of retry attempts remaining are displayed in parenthesis. • Retained--Indicates that the bulk statistics file has either been successfully transmitted or that the configured number of retries have been completed. To display only the status of a named transfer (as opposed to all configured transfers), specify the name of the transfer in the transfer-name argument. show snmp mib bulkstat transfer Sample Output RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show snmp mib bulkstat transfer Transfer Name : ifmib Retained files File Name : Time Left (in seconds) :STATE --------------------------------------------------------------------- ifmib_Router_020421_100554683 : 173 : Retry (2 Retry attempt(s) Left) Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer: Example This example shows how to configure periodic MIB data collection and transfer: snmp-server mib bulkstat object-list cempo add cempMemPoolName add cempMemPoolType ! snmp-server mib bulkstat schema cempWild object-list cempo instance wild oid 8695772 poll-interval 1 ! snmp-server mib bulkstat schema cempRepeat object-list cempo instance repetition 8695772.1 max 4294967295 poll-interval 1 ! snmp-server mib bulkstat transfer-id cempt1 enable url primary tftp://223.255.254.254/auto/tftp-sjc-users3/dseeniva/dumpdcm schema cempWild schema cempRepeat transfer-interval 2 ! Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 265 Configuring Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer: ExampleThis example shows sample bulk statistics file content: Schema-def cempt1.cempWild "%u, %s, %s, %d" Epochtime instanceoid 1.3.6.1.4.1.9.9.221.1.1.1.1.3 1.3.6.1.4.1.9.9.221.1.1.1.1.2 cempt1.cempWild: 1339491515, 8695772.1, processor, 2 cempt1.cempWild: 1339491515, 8695772.2, reserved, 11 cempt1.cempWild: 1339491515, 8695772.3, image, 12 cempt1.cempWild: 1339491575, 8695772.1, processor, 2 cempt1.cempWild: 1339491575, 8695772.2, reserved, 11 cempt1.cempWild: 1339491575, 8695772.3, image, 12 Schema-def cempt1.cempRepeat "%u, %s, %s, %d" Epochtime instanceoid 1.3.6.1.4.1.9.9.221.1.1.1.1.3 1.3.6.1.4.1.9.9.221.1.1.1.1.2 cempt1.cempRepeat: 1339491515, 8695772.1, processor, 2 cempt1.cempRepeat: 1339491515, 8695772.2, reserved, 11 cempt1.cempRepeat: 1339491515, 8695772.3, image, 12 cempt1.cempRepeat: 1339491515, 26932192.1, processor, 2 cempt1.cempRepeat: 1339491515, 26932192.2, reserved, 11 cempt1.cempRepeat: 1339491515, 26932192.3, image, 12 cempt1.cempRepeat: 1339491515, 35271015.1, processor, 2 cempt1.cempRepeat: 1339491515, 35271015.2, reserved, 11 cempt1.cempRepeat: 1339491515, 35271015.3, image, 12 cempt1.cempRepeat: 1339491515, 36631989.1, processor, 2 cempt1.cempRepeat: 1339491515, 36631989.2, reserved, 11 cempt1.cempRepeat: 1339491515, 36631989.3, image, 12 cempt1.cempRepeat: 1339491515, 52690955.1, processor, 2 cempt1.cempRepeat: 1339491515, 52690955.2, reserved, 11 cempt1.cempRepeat: 1339491515, 52690955.3, image, 12 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 266 OL-26081-03 Configuring Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Periodic MIB Data Collection and Transfer: ExampleC H A P T E R 15 Implementing CDP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Cisco Discovery Protocol (CDP) is a media- and protocol-independent protocol that runs on all Cisco-manufactured equipment including routers, bridges, access and communication servers, and switches. Using CDP, you can view information about all the Cisco devices that are directly attached to the device. This module describesthe new and revised tasks you need to implement CDP on your Cisco IOS XR network. For more information about CDP on the Cisco IOS XR software and complete descriptions of the CDP commandslisted in this module, refer to Related Documents, on page 276. To locate documentation for other commands that might appear in the course of running a configuration task, search online in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Commands Master List. Table 34: Feature History for Implementing CDP on Cisco IOS XR Software Release Modification Release 3.7.2 This feature was introduced. This module contains the following topics: • Prerequisites for Implementing CDP, page 267 • Information About Implementing CDP, page 268 • How to Implement CDP on Cisco IOS XR Software, page 269 • Configuration Examples for Implementing CDP, page 275 • Additional References, page 275 Prerequisites for Implementing CDP You must be in a user group associated with a task group that includes the proper task IDs. The command reference guides include the task IDs required for each command. If you suspect user group assignment is preventing you from using a command, contact your AAA administrator for assistance. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 267Information About Implementing CDP CDP is primarily used to obtain protocol addresses of neighboring devices and discover the platform of those devices. CDP can also be used to display information about the interfaces your router uses. CDP is mediaand protocol-independent, and runs on all equipment manufactured by Cisco, including routers, bridges, access servers, and switches. Use of SNMP with the CDP MIB allows network management applications to learn the device type and the SNMP agent address of neighboring devices and to send SNMP queries to those devices. CDP uses the CISCO-CDP-MIB. CDP runs on all media that support Subnetwork Access Protocol (SNAP), including LAN, Frame Relay, and ATM physical media. CDP runs over the data link layer only. Therefore, two systems that support different network-layer protocols can learn about each other. Each device configured for CDP sends periodic messages, known as advertisements, to a multicast address. Each device advertises at least one address at which it can receive SNMP messages. The advertisements also contain time-to-live, or hold-time, information, which indicates the length of time a receiving device holds CDP information before discarding it. Each device also listens to the periodic CDP messages sent by others to learn about neighboring devices and determine when their interfaces to the media go up or down. CDP Version-2 (CDPv2) is the most recent release of the protocol and provides more intelligent device tracking features. These features include a reporting mechanism that allows for more rapid error tracking, thereby reducing costly downtime. Reported error messages can be sent to the console or to a logging server, and can cover instances of unmatching native VLAN IDs(IEEE 802.1Q) on connecting ports, and unmatching port duplex states between connecting devices. CDPv2 show commands can provide detailed output on VLAN Trunking Protocol (VTP) management domain and duplex modes of neighbor devices, CDP-related counters, and VLAN IDs of connecting ports. Type-length-value fields (TLVs) are blocks of information embedded in CDP advertisements. Table 35: Type-Length-Value Definitions for CDPv2, on page 268 summarizes the TLV definitions for CDP advertisements. Table 35: Type-Length-Value Definitions for CDPv2 TLV Definition Device-ID TLV Identifies the device name in the form of a character string. Contains a list of network addresses of both receiving and sending devices. Address TLV Port-ID TLV Identifies the port on which the CDP packet is sent. Describes the functional capability for the device in the form of a device type; for example, a switch. Capabilities TLV Contains information about the software release version on which the device is running. Version TLV Describes the hardware platform name of the device, for example, Cisco 4500. Platform TLV Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 268 OL-26081-03 Implementing CDP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Information About Implementing CDPTLV Definition Advertises the system’s configured VTP management domain name-string. Used by network operators to verify VTP domain configuration in adjacent network nodes. VTP Management Domain TLV Indicates, per interface, the assumed VLAN for untagged packets on the interface. CDP learns the native VLAN for an interface. This feature is implemented only for interfaces that support the IEEE 802.1Q protocol. Native VLAN TLV Indicates status (duplex configuration) of CDP broadcast interface. Used by network operatorsto diagnose connectivity problems between adjacent network elements. Full/Half Duplex TLV How to Implement CDP on Cisco IOS XR Software Enabling CDP To enable CDP, you must first enable CDP globally on the router and then enable CDP on a per-interface basis. This task explains how to enable CDP globally on the router and then enable CDP on an interface. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. cdp 3. interface type interface-path-id 4. cdp 5. Use one of these commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 269 Implementing CDP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router How to Implement CDP on Cisco IOS XR SoftwareCommand or Action Purpose cdp Enables CDP globally. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# cdp Step 2 interface type interface-path-id Enters interface configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# interface pos 0/0/0/1 Step 3 cdp Enables CDP on an interface. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# cdp Step 4 Step 5 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exitsthe configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leavesthe router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Modifying CDP Default Settings This task explains how to modify the default version, hold-time setting, and timer settings. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 270 OL-26081-03 Implementing CDP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Modifying CDP Default SettingsNote The commands can be entered in any order. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. cdp advertise v1 3. cdp holdtime seconds 4. cdp timer seconds 5. Use one of these commands: • end • commit 6. (Optional) show cdp DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Configures CDP to use only version 1 (CDPv1) in communicating with neighboring devices. cdp advertise v1 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# cdp advertise v1 Step 2 • By default, when CDP is enabled, the router sends CDPv2 packets. CDP also sends and receives CDPv1 packetsif the device with which CDP isinteracting does not process CDPv2 packets. • In this example, the router is configured to send and receive only CDPv1 packets. Specifies the amount of time that the receiving networking device will hold a CDP packet sent from the router before discarding it. cdp holdtime seconds Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# cdp holdtime 30 Step 3 • By default, when CDP is enabled, the receiving networking device holds a CDP packet for 180 seconds before discarding it. The CDP hold time must be set to a higher number of seconds than the time between CDP transmissions, which is set with the cdp timer command. Note • In this example, the value of hold-time for the seconds argument is set to 30. Step 4 cdp timer seconds Specifies the frequency at which CDP update packets are sent. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 271 Implementing CDP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Modifying CDP Default SettingsCommand or Action Purpose Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# cdp timer 20 • By default, when CDP is enabled, CDP update packets are sent at a frequency of once every 60 seconds. Note A lower timersetting causes CDP updatesto be sent more frequently. • In this example, CDP update packets are configured to be sent at a frequency of once every 20 seconds. Step 5 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC or mode. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. (Optional) Displays global CDP information. show cdp Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show cdp Step 6 The output displays the CDP version running on the router, the hold time setting, and the timer setting. Monitoring CDP This task shows how to monitor CDP. Note The commands can be entered in any order. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 272 OL-26081-03 Implementing CDP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Monitoring CDPSUMMARY STEPS 1. show cdp entry {* | entry-name} [protocol | version] 2. show cdp interface [type interface-path-id | location node-id] 3. show cdp neighbors [type interface-path-id | location node-id] [detail] 4. show cdp traffic [location node-id] DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Displays information about a specific neighboring device or all neighboring devices discovered using CDP. show cdp entry {* | entry-name} [protocol | version] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show cdp entry * Step 1 Displays information about the interfaces on which CDP is enabled. show cdp interface [type interface-path-id | location node-id] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show cdp interface pos 0/0/0/1 Step 2 Displays detailed information about neighboring devices discovered using CDP. show cdp neighbors [type interface-path-id | location node-id] [detail] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show cdp neighbors Step 3 Displaysinformation about the traffic gathered between devices using CDP. show cdp traffic [location node-id] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show cdp traffic Step 4 Examples The following is sample output for the show cdp neighbors command: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show cdp neighbors Capability Codes: R - Router, T - Trans Bridge, B - Source Route Bridge S - Switch, H - Host, I - IGMP, r - Repeater Device ID Local Intrfce Holdtme Capability Platform Port ID router1 Mg0/0/CPU0/0 177 T S WS-C2924M Fa0/12 router2 PO0/4/0/0 157 R 12008/GRP PO0/4/0/1 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 273 Implementing CDP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Monitoring CDPThe following is sample output for the show cdp neighbors command. In this example, the optional type instance arguments are used in conjunction with the detail optional keyword to display detailed information about a CDP neighbor. The output includes information on both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show cdp neighbors POS 0/4/0/0 detail ------------------------- Device ID: uut-user SysName : uut-user Entry address(es): IPv4 address: 1.1.1.1 IPv6 address: 1::1 IPv6 address: 2::2 Platform: cisco 12008/GRP, Capabilities: Router Interface: POS0/4/0/3 Port ID (outgoing port): POS0/2/0/3 Holdtime : 177 sec Version : Cisco IOS XR Software, Version 0.0.0[Default] Copyright (c) 2005 by cisco Systems, Inc. advertisement version: 2 The following is sample output for the show cdp entry command. In this example, the optional entry argument is used to display entry information related to a specific CDP neighbor. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show cdp entry router2 advertisement version: 2 ------------------------- Device ID: router2 SysName : router2 Entry address(es): Platform: cisco 12008/GRP, Capabilities: Router Interface: POS0/4/0/0 Port ID (outgoing port): POS0/4/0/1 Holdtime : 145 sec Version : Cisco IOS XR Software, Version 0.48.0[Default] Copyright (c) 2004 by cisco Systems, Inc. advertisement version: 2 The following is sample output for the show cdp interface command. In this example, CDP information related to Packet over SONET/SDH (POS) interface 0/4/0/0 is displayed. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show cdp interface pos 0/4/0/0 POS0/4/0/0 is Up Encapsulation HDLC Sending CDP packets every 60 seconds Holdtime is 180 seconds The following is sample output for the show cdp traffic command: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show cdp traffic CDP counters : Packets output: 194, Input: 99 Hdr syntax: 0, Chksum error: 0, Encaps failed: 0 No memory: 0, Invalid packet: 0, Truncated: 0 CDP version 1 advertisements output: 0, Input: 0 CDP version 2 advertisements output: 194, Input: 99 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 274 OL-26081-03 Implementing CDP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Monitoring CDPUnrecognize Hdr version: 0, File open failed: 0 The following is sample output for the show cdp traffic command. In this example, the optional location keyword and node-id argument are used to display information about the traffic gathered between devices using CDP from the specified node. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show cdp traffic location 0/4/cpu0 CDP counters : Packets output: 16, Input: 13 Hdr syntax: 0, Chksum error: 0, Encaps failed: 0 No memory: 0, Invalid packet: 0, Truncated: 0 CDP version 1 advertisements output: 0, Input: 0 CDP version 2 advertisements output: 16, Input: 13 Unrecognize Hdr version: 0, File open failed: 0 Configuration Examples for Implementing CDP Enabling CDP: Example The following example shows how to configure CDP globally and then enable CDP on Packet over SONET/SDH (POS) interface 0/3/0/0: cdp interface POS0/3/0/0 cdp Modifying Global CDP Settings: Example The following example shows how to modify global CDP settings. In this example, the timer setting is set to 20 seconds, the hold-time setting is set to 30 seconds, and the version of CDP used to communicate with neighboring devices is set to CDPv1: cdp timer 20 cdp holdtime 30 cdp advertise v1 The following example shows how to use the show cdp command to verify the CDP global settings: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show cdp Global CDP information: Sending CDP packets every 20 seconds Sending a holdtime value of 30 seconds Sending CDPv2 advertisements is not enabled Additional References The following sections provide references related to implementing CDP on Cisco IOS XR software. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 275 Implementing CDP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuration Examples for Implementing CDPRelated Documents Related Topic Document Title CDP Commands on Cisco IOS XR Software module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Command Reference Cisco IOS XR CDP commands Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Commands Master List Cisco IOS XR commands Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Getting Started Guide Getting started with Cisco IOS XR Software Configuring AAA Services on Cisco IOS XR Software module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Security Configuration Guide Information about user groups and task IDs Standards Standards Title No new or modified standards are supported by this — feature, and support for existing standards has not been modified by this feature. MIBs MIBs MIBs Link To locate and download MIBs using Cisco IOS XR software, use the Cisco MIB Locator found at the following URL and choose a platform under the Cisco Access Products menu: http://cisco.com/public/ sw-center/netmgmt/cmtk/mibs.shtml — RFCs RFCs Title No new or modified RFCs are supported by this — feature, and support for existing RFCs has not been modified by this feature. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 276 OL-26081-03 Implementing CDP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional ReferencesTechnical Assistance Description Link The Cisco Technical Support website contains http://www.cisco.com/techsupport thousands of pages of searchable technical content, including links to products, technologies, solutions, technical tips, and tools. Registered Cisco.com users can log in from this page to access even more content. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 277 Implementing CDP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional References Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 278 OL-26081-03 Implementing CDP on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional ReferencesI N D E X A access-group command 176, 177 admin configure command 3, 5, 32, 46, 49, 60, 84, 86, 87, 114, 119, 126 admin-config submode, See admin configure command alert group 152, 160 asdf 5 associating an alert group with 160 authenticate command 178 authentication-key command 178 B broadcast client command 174, 175 broadcast command 174, 175 broadcastdelay command 174 bulk statistics 255, 256, 258 object lists 256 prerequisites 255 schema 256, 258 transfer options 256 C call home 154 smart call home feature 154 Call Home 151, 152, 155, 158, 160, 163, 165 alert group 152 contact information 155 configure 155 destination profile 158, 160 associating an alert group with 160 configure and activate 158 email 163 configure 163 enable 165 introduction 151 Call Home messages 153 configuring levels 153 CDP 268, 269, 270, 272 enabling 269 functional overview 268 modifying default settings 270 monitoring 272 cdp (global) command 269, 270 cdp (interface) command 269, 270 cdp advertise v1 command 271 cdp holdtime command 271 cdp timer command 271 Cisco IOS XR Software Selector tool 28 committing packages 49 config-register command 113, 114 controllers command 115 copy ftp command 30 copy rcp command 30 copy tftp command 30 CPU controller bits 119 D Designated Shelf Controller, See DSC destination profile for Call Home 158 configure and activate 158 drives, formatting 115 DSC 12 definition 12 F field programmable device (FPD) images 42, 46 field programmable devices 123 See FPD images 123 File Transfer Protocol (FTP) 29 format command 115 formatting drives 115 FPD images 42, 46, 123, 124, 126, 127, 128, 140, 141 troubleshooting 140, 141 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 IN-1FPD images (continued) upgrade 127, 128 verifying 128 description 123 displaying 126, 127 default information 127 minimum and current versions 126 overview for SPAs 124 upgrade 127, 128 FPGA 124 devices, methods of upgrading 124 FTP 29 H hardware 92 displaying status 92 hw-module reload command 126, 128 I install activate command 42, 44, 51, 52 install rollback to committed command 62, 64 install verify packages command 32, 33 interface preconfigure command 117, 118 L line card 117, 118 removal 117 replacement 118 line command 210 line console command 210, 213 line default command 210 line template command 210, 214, 215 line template configuration submode 210 See also line command description 210 See also line command M master command 183 MIB data collection 255 prerequisites 255 MIB object 256 MIB, description 225 N node 111 power cycle 111 reload 111 shutdown 111 NTP 171, 173, 176, 177, 179, 181, 182, 184 configuring an authoritative NTP server 182 configuring broadcast-based NTP associations 173 configuring NTP access groups 176 configuring NTP authentication 177 configuring poll-based associations 171 configuring the source IP address 181 disabling NTP services on an interface 179 updating the hardware clock 184 O object identifier 256 object instance 256 object lists 256 bulk statistics 256 OID 256 online insertion and removal, See OIR P package 21, 22, 49, 57 addition, introduction 21 deactivation 57 rollback 22 set 49 committing 49 periodic mib data collection and transfer 255 physical terminals 210, 211, 212 aux line template 212 modifying 212 console line template 210, 212 description 210 modifying 212 default line template 210, 212 description 210 modifying 212 line template configuration submode, description 210 line template guidelines 211 PIE files 19 names 19 version numbers 19 PLIM 118 replacement 118 different media type 118 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x IN-2 OL-26081-03 IndexPLIM (continued) replacement (continued) same media type and port count 118 same media type, different port count 118 power cycle 111 R rcp 29 redundancy 108, 109, 110 commands 109 manual switchover 110 primary RP 108 standby RP 109 redundancy switchover command 110 reload command 110, 113 reloading software 111 Remote Copy Protocol (rcp) 29 RFC 3411, An Architecture for Describing Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) Management Frameworks 252 RFC 3412, Message Processing and Dispatching for the Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) 252 RFC 3413, Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) Applications 252 RFC 3414, User-based Security Model (USM) for version 3 of the Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMPv3) 252 RFC 3415, View-based Access Control Model (VACM) for the Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) 252 RFC 3416, Version 2 of the Protocol Operations for the Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) 252 RFC 3417, Transport Mappings for the Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) 252 RFC 3418, Management Information Base (MIB) for the Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) 252 rollback 22, 62, 63, 64 packages 22, 62, 63, 64 displaying rollback points 62 introduction 22 last committed set 64 rolling back to points 63 ROM Monitor mode 16 RP reload 110 S sample output 128, 130, 139, 140 schema 256 bulk statistics 256 server command 172 SFTP 29 show cdp command 271, 272 show cdp entry command 273 show cdp interface command 273 show cdp neighbors command 273 show cdp traffic command 273 show clock command 32, 34 show controllers command 115 show diag command 92, 95 show environment command 101 show fpd package command 126, 127, 130 show hw-module fpd command 126, 128 show hw-module subslot command 126, 128 show install active command 32 show install pie-info command 32, 33 show install rollback command 62, 63 show interfaces command 117 show line command 216, 217 show platform command 100, 140 administration EXEC mode 100 show redundancy command 104, 113, 114 show running-config command 117 show snmp command 232, 234 show snmp engineid command 232, 234 show snmp group command 232, 234 show snmp host command 235, 236 show snmp users command 232, 234 show snmp view command 232, 234 show system verify command 32, 33, 42, 46, 58, 59 show terminal command 216, 217 show users command 216, 217 show variables boot command 113, 114 show version command 98 shutting down a node 111 smart call home 154 description 154 registration requirements 154 Transport Gateway (TG) aggregation point 154 SMARTnet 154 smart call home registration 154 SMU 17 filenames 17 version numbers 17 SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol) 224, 225, 226, 227, 228, 229, 230, 231, 234 manager, description 224 agent, description 224 MIB, description 225 trap notifications 234 configuring 234 versions 226, 227, 228, 229, 230, 231 security models and levels 228 SNMPv1,v2c, and v3 comparison 227 SNMPv3 benefits 229 SNMPv3 costs 230 SNMPv3, configuring 231 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26081-03 IN-3 Indexsnmp-server chassis-id command 237, 238 snmp-server contact command 237 snmp-server enable traps command 235, 236 snmp-server engineid local command 232, 235 snmp-server group command 232, 233, 235 snmp-server host command 235, 236 snmp-server ipv4 dscp command 242 snmp-server ipv4 precedence command 242 snmp-server location command 237 snmp-server packetsize command 239 snmp-server queue-length command 240 snmp-server trap source command 240 snmp-server trap-timeout command 240, 241 snmp-server user command 232, 233, 235 snmp-server view command 232 software packages 17, 19, 20, 23, 24, 27, 28, 49, 63, 64 activation 24, 27 impact on system 24 prerequisites 27 Cisco IOS XR Software Selector tool 28 committing 49 deactivation 24, 27 impact on system 24 prerequisites 27 downgrading 23 impact of version changes 24 management overview 20 rollback 63, 64 SMUs 17 upgrading 23 version numbers 19 source command 181, 182 SPA (shared port adapter) 124, 125 See also FPD images See also FPD images 124 SPA (shared port adapter) (continued) See also FPD images SSH File Transfer Protocol 29 T TFTP 29 trap notifications 225 Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) 29 trusted-key command 178, 179 U update-calendar command 184, 185 upgrade cpuctrlbits command 119 upgrade hw-module fpd command 126, 127, 139 V virtual terminals 210, 212, 214 default line template 210, 212 description 210 modifying 212 line template configuration submode 210 description 210 user-defined line templates 210 description 210 vty pools 212, 214 description 212 creating 214 modifying 214 vm files 16 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x IN-4 OL-26081-03 Index Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x Americas Headquarters Cisco Systems, Inc. 170 West Tasman Drive San Jose, CA 95134-1706 USA http://www.cisco.com Tel: 408 526-4000 800 553-NETS (6387) Fax: 408 527-0883 Text Part Number: OL-26048-02THE SPECIFICATIONS AND INFORMATION REGARDING THE PRODUCTS IN THIS MANUAL ARE SUBJECT TO CHANGE WITHOUT NOTICE. ALL STATEMENTS, INFORMATION, AND RECOMMENDATIONS IN THIS MANUAL ARE BELIEVED TO BE ACCURATE BUT ARE PRESENTED WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED. USERS MUST TAKE FULL RESPONSIBILITY FOR THEIR APPLICATION OF ANY PRODUCTS. THE SOFTWARE LICENSE AND LIMITED WARRANTY FOR THE ACCOMPANYING PRODUCT ARE SET FORTH IN THE INFORMATION PACKET THAT SHIPPED WITH THE PRODUCT AND ARE INCORPORATED HEREIN BY THIS REFERENCE. IF YOU ARE UNABLE TO LOCATE THE SOFTWARE LICENSE OR LIMITED WARRANTY, CONTACT YOUR CISCO REPRESENTATIVE FOR A COPY. The Cisco implementation of TCP header compression is an adaptation of a program developed by the University of California, Berkeley (UCB) as part of UCB's public domain version of the UNIX operating system. All rights reserved. Copyright © 1981, Regents of the University of California. NOTWITHSTANDING ANY OTHER WARRANTY HEREIN, ALL DOCUMENT FILES AND SOFTWARE OF THESE SUPPLIERS ARE PROVIDED “AS IS" WITH ALL FAULTS. CISCO AND THE ABOVE-NAMED SUPPLIERS DISCLAIM ALL WARRANTIES, EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, THOSE OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT OR ARISING FROM A COURSE OF DEALING, USAGE, OR TRADE PRACTICE. IN NO EVENT SHALL CISCO OR ITS SUPPLIERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY INDIRECT, SPECIAL, CONSEQUENTIAL, OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES, INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, LOST PROFITS OR LOSS OR DAMAGE TO DATA ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THIS MANUAL, EVEN IF CISCO OR ITS SUPPLIERS HAVE BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. Cisco and the Cisco logo are trademarks or registered trademarks of Cisco and/or its affiliates in the U.S. and other countries. To view a list of Cisco trademarks, go to this URL: http:// www.cisco.com/go/trademarks. Third-party trademarks mentioned are the property of their respective owners. The use of the word partner does not imply a partnership relationship between Cisco and any other company. (1110R) Any Internet Protocol (IP) addresses used in this document are not intended to be actual addresses. Any examples, command display output, and figures included in the document are shown for illustrative purposes only. Any use of actual IP addresses in illustrative content is unintentional and coincidental. © 2012 Cisco Systems, Inc. All rights reserved.C O N T E N T S P r e f a c e Preface xxi Changes to This Document xxi Obtaining Documentation and Submitting a Service Request xxi C H A P T E R 1 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router 1 Prerequisites for Implementing BGP 2 Information About Implementing BGP 3 BGP Functional Overview 3 BGP Router Identifier 3 BGP Default Limits 4 BGP Next Hop Tracking 4 Scoped IPv4/VPNv4 Table Walk 6 Reordered Address Family Processing 6 New Thread for Next-Hop Processing 6 show, clear, and debug Commands 6 Autonomous System Number Formats in BGP 7 2-byte Autonomous System Number Format 7 4-byte Autonomous System Number Format 7 as-format Command 7 BGP Configuration 7 Configuration Modes 7 Router Configuration Mode 8 Router Address Family Configuration Mode 8 Neighbor Configuration Mode 8 Neighbor Address Family Configuration Mode 8 VRF Configuration Mode 8 VRF Address Family Configuration Mode 8 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 iiiVRF Neighbor Configuration Mode 9 VRF Neighbor Address Family Configuration Mode 9 VPNv4 Address Family Configuration Mode 9 L2VPN Address Family Configuration Mode 9 Neighbor Submode 9 Configuration Templates 10 Template Inheritance Rules 12 Viewing Inherited Configurations 15 show bgp neighbors 15 show bgp af-group 16 show bgp session-group 18 show bgp neighbor-group 18 No Default Address Family 20 Routing Policy Enforcement 20 Table Policy 22 Update Groups 22 BGP Update Generation and Update Groups 23 BGP Update Group 23 BGP Cost Community 23 How BGP Cost Community Influences the Best Path Selection Process 23 Cost Community Support for Aggregate Routes and Multipaths 24 Influencing Route Preference in a Multiexit IGP Network 26 BGP Cost Community Support for EIGRP MPLS VPN PE-CE with Back-door Links 26 Adding Routes to the Routing Information Base 27 BGP Best Path Algorithm 28 Comparing Pairs of Paths 28 Order of Comparisons 30 Best Path Change Suppression 31 Administrative Distance 31 Multiprotocol BGP 33 Route Dampening 35 Minimizing Flapping 36 BGP Routing Domain Confederation 36 BGP Route Reflectors 36 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x iv OL-26048-02 ContentsDefault Address Family for show Commands 40 Distributed BGP 40 MPLS VPN Carrier Supporting Carrier 41 BGP Keychains 42 BGP Nonstop Routing 42 BGP Prefix Independent Convergence Unipath Primary/Backup 43 BGP Local Label Retention 44 Command Line Interface (CLI) Consistency for BGP Commands 44 BGP Additional Paths 44 iBGP Multipath Load Sharing 45 Accumulated Interior Gateway Protocol Attribute 45 Per VRF and Per CE Label for IPv6 Provider Edge 46 IPv4 BGP-Policy Accounting on Cisco ASR 9000's A9K-SIP-700 46 IPv6 Unicast Routing on Cisco ASR 9000's A9K-SIP-700 46 IPv6 uRPF Support on Cisco ASR 9000's A9K-SIP-700 47 Remove and Replace Private AS Numbers from AS Path in BGP 47 Selective VRF Download 48 Line Card Roles and Filters 48 BGP DMZ Link Bandwidth for Unequal Cost Recursive Load Balancing 49 BFD Multihop Support for BGP 49 BGP Multi-Instance/Multi-AS Support 49 BGP Prefix Origin Validation Based on RPKI 49 BGP 3107 PIC Updates for Global Prefixes 50 BGP Prefix Independent Convergence for RIB and FIB 51 How to Implement BGP on Cisco IOS XR Software 51 Enabling BGP Routing 51 Configuring a Routing Domain Confederation for BGP 55 Resetting an eBGP Session Immediately Upon Link Failure 57 Logging Neighbor Changes 57 Adjusting BGP Timers 57 Changing the BGP Default Local Preference Value 59 Configuring the MED Metric for BGP 60 Configuring BGP Weights 62 Tuning the BGP Best-Path Calculation 64 Indicating BGP Back-door Routes 66 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 v ContentsConfiguring Aggregate Addresses 67 Redistributing iBGP Routes into IGP 69 Redistributing Prefixes into Multiprotocol BGP 71 Configuring BGP Route Dampening 73 Applying Policy When Updating the Routing Table 78 Setting BGP Administrative Distance 80 Configuring a BGP Neighbor Group and Neighbors 82 Configuring a Route Reflector for BGP 85 Configuring BGP Route Filtering by Route Policy 87 Configuring BGP Next-Hop Trigger Delay 89 Disabling Next-Hop Processing on BGP Updates 91 Configuring BGP Community and Extended-Community Advertisements 93 Configuring the BGP Cost Community 95 Configuring Software to Store Updates from a Neighbor 99 Configuring Distributed BGP 101 Configuring a VPN Routing and Forwarding Instance in BGP 104 Defining the Virtual Routing and Forwarding Tables in Provider Edge Routers 104 Configuring the Route Distinguisher 106 Configuring PE-PE or PE-RR Interior BGP Sessions 108 Configuring Route Reflector to Hold Routes That Have a Defined Set of RT Communities 111 Configuring BGP as a PE-CE Protocol 113 Redistribution of IGPs to BGP 118 Configuring Keychains for BGP 121 Disabling a BGP Neighbor 123 Resetting Neighbors Using BGP Inbound Soft Reset 124 Resetting Neighbors Using BGP Outbound Soft Reset 125 Resetting Neighbors Using BGP Hard Reset 126 Clearing Caches, Tables, and Databases 127 Displaying System and Network Statistics 128 Displaying BGP Process Information 129 Monitoring BGP Update Groups 131 Configuring BGP Nonstop Routing 132 Installing Primary Backup Path for Prefix Independent Convergence (PIC) 133 Retaining Allocated Local Label for Primary Path 135 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x vi OL-26048-02 ContentsConfiguring BGP Additional Paths 137 Configuring iBGP Multipath Load Sharing 139 Originating Prefixes with AiGP 141 Enabling BGP Unequal Cost Recursive Load Balancing 143 Configuring RPKI Cache 146 Configuring RPKI Prefix Validation 149 Configuring RPKI Bestpath Computation 150 Configuration Examples for Implementing BGP 152 Enabling BGP: Example 152 Displaying BGP Update Groups: Example 153 BGP Neighbor Configuration: Example 154 BGP Confederation: Example 155 BGP Route Reflector: Example 157 BGP Nonstop Routing Configuration: Example 157 Primary Backup Path Installation: Example 157 Allocated Local Label Retention: Example 157 iBGP Multipath Loadsharing Configuration: Example 158 Configuring BGP Additional Paths: Example 158 Originating Prefixes With AiGP: Example 158 BGP Unequal Cost Recursive Load Balancing: Example 159 Where to Go Next 161 Additional References 161 C H A P T E R 2 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router 165 Prerequisites for Implementing EIGRP 166 Restrictions for Implementing EIGRP 166 Information About Implementing EIGRP 166 EIGRP Functional Overview 166 EIGRP Features 167 EIGRP Components 167 EIGRP Configuration Grouping 168 EIGRP Configuration Modes 168 EIGRP Interfaces 169 Redistribution for an EIGRP Process 169 Metric Weights for EIGRP Routing 170 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 vii ContentsMismatched K Values 170 Goodbye Message 171 Percentage of Link Bandwidth Used for EIGRP Packets 171 Floating Summary Routes for an EIGRP Process 171 Split Horizon for an EIGRP Process 173 Adjustment of Hello Interval and Hold Time for an EIGRP Process 174 Stub Routing for an EIGRP Process 174 Route Policy Options for an EIGRP Process 175 EIGRP Layer 3 VPN PE-CE Site-of-Origin 176 Router Interoperation with the Site-of-Origin Extended Community 176 EIGRP v4/v6 Authentication Using Keychain 177 How to Implement EIGRP 177 Enabling EIGRP Routing 177 Configuring Route Summarization for an EIGRP Process 180 Redistributing Routes for EIGRP 182 Creating a Route Policy and Attaching It to an EIGRP Process 184 Configuring Stub Routing for an EIGRP Process 187 Configuring EIGRP as a PE-CE Protocol 189 Redistributing BGP Routes into EIGRP 192 Monitoring EIGRP Routing 194 Configuring an EIGRP Authentication Keychain 197 Configuring an Authentication Keychain for an IPv4/IPv6 Interface on a Default VRF 198 Configuring an Authentication Keychain for an IPv4/IPv6 Interface on a Nondefault VRF 199 Configuration Examples for Implementing EIGRP 201 Configuring a Basic EIGRP Configuration: Example 201 Configuring an EIGRP Stub Operation: Example 202 Configuring an EIGRP PE-CE Configuration with Prefix-Limits: Example 202 Configuring an EIGRP Authentication Keychain: Example 203 Additional References 203 C H A P T E R 3 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router 205 Prerequisites for Implementing IS-IS 206 Restrictions for Implementing IS-IS 206 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x viii OL-26048-02 ContentsInformation About Implementing IS-IS 206 IS-IS Functional Overview 206 Key Features Supported in the Cisco IOS XR IS-IS Implementation 207 IS-IS Configuration Grouping 207 IS-IS Configuration Modes 207 Router Configuration Mode 207 Router Address Family Configuration Mode 208 Interface Configuration Mode 208 Interface Address Family Configuration Mode 208 IS-IS Interfaces 208 Multitopology Configuration 209 IPv6 Routing and Configuring IPv6 Addressing 209 Limit LSP Flooding 209 Flood Blocking on Specific Interfaces 209 Mesh Group Configuration 210 Maximum LSP Lifetime and Refresh Interval 210 Single-Topology IPv6 Support 210 Multitopology IPv6 Support 210 IS-IS Authentication 210 Nonstop Forwarding 211 Multi-Instance IS-IS 212 Multiprotocol Label Switching Traffic Engineering 212 Overload Bit on Router 212 Overload Bit Configuration During Multitopology Operation 213 IS-IS Overload Bit Avoidance 213 Default Routes 213 Attached Bit on an IS-IS Instance 214 IS-IS Support for Route Tags 214 Multicast-Intact Feature 214 Multicast Topology Support Using IS-IS 215 MPLS Label Distribution Protocol IGP Synchronization 215 MPLS LDP-IGP Synchronization Compatibility with LDP Graceful Restart 215 MPLS LDP-IGP Synchronization Compatibility with IGP Nonstop Forwarding 216 Label Distribution Protocol IGP Auto-configuration 216 MPLS TE Forwarding Adjacency 216 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 ix ContentsMPLS TE Interarea Tunnels 216 IP Fast Reroute 217 How to Implement IS-IS 217 Enabling IS-IS and Configuring Level 1 or Level 2 Routing 217 Configuring Single Topology for IS-IS 219 Configuring Multitopology Routing 225 Restrictions for Configuring Multitopology Routing 225 Information About Multitopology Routing 225 Configuring a Global Topology and Associating It with an Interface 225 Enabling an IS-IS Topology 227 Placing an Interface in a Topology in IS-IS 229 Configuring a Routing Policy 230 Configuring Multitopology for IS-IS 232 Controlling LSP Flooding for IS-IS 232 Configuring Nonstop Forwarding for IS-IS 236 Configuring Authentication for IS-IS 239 Configuring Keychains for IS-IS 241 Configuring MPLS Traffic Engineering for IS-IS 243 Tuning Adjacencies for IS-IS 246 Setting SPF Interval for a Single-Topology IPv4 and IPv6 Configuration 249 Customizing Routes for IS-IS 252 Configuring MPLS LDP IS-IS Synchronization 255 Enabling Multicast-Intact 256 Tagging IS-IS Interface Routes 258 Setting the Priority for Adding Prefixes to the RIB 260 Configuring IP/LDP Fast Reroute 262 Configuring IS-IS Overload Bit Avoidance 266 Configuration Examples for Implementing IS-IS 266 Configuring Single-Topology IS-IS for IPv6: Example 267 Configuring Multitopology IS-IS for IPv6: Example 267 Redistributing IS-IS Routes Between Multiple Instances: Example 267 Tagging Routes: Example 268 Configuring IS-IS Overload Bit Avoidance: Example 268 Where to Go Next 269 Additional References 269 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x x OL-26048-02 ContentsC H A P T E R 4 Implementing OSPF on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router 273 Prerequisites for Implementing OSPF 274 Information About Implementing OSPF 274 OSPF Functional Overview 275 Key Features Supported in the Cisco IOS XR Software OSPF Implementation 276 Comparison of Cisco IOS XR Software OSPFv3 and OSPFv2 276 OSPF Hierarchical CLI and CLI Inheritance 277 OSPF Routing Components 277 Autonomous Systems 278 Areas 278 Backbone Area 279 Stub Area 279 Not-so-Stubby Area 279 Routers 279 Area Border Routers 279 Autonomous System Boundary Routers (ASBR) 280 Interior Routers 280 OSPF Process and Router ID 280 Supported OSPF Network Types 281 Route Authentication Methods for OSPF 281 Plain Text Authentication 281 MD5 Authentication 281 Authentication Strategies 281 Key Rollover 282 Neighbors and Adjacency for OSPF 282 Designated Router (DR) for OSPF 282 Default Route for OSPF 282 Link-State Advertisement Types for OSPF Version 2 283 Link-State Advertisement Types for OSPFv3 283 Virtual Link and Transit Area for OSPF 285 OSPFv2 Sham Link Support for MPLS VPN 285 OSPF SPF Prefix Prioritization 287 Route Redistribution for OSPF 289 OSPF Shortest Path First Throttling 289 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 xi ContentsNonstop Forwarding for OSPF Version 2 290 Graceful Restart for OSPFv3 290 Modes of Graceful Restart Operation 291 Restart Mode 291 Helper Mode 291 Graceful Restart Requirements and Restrictions 292 Warm Standby and Nonstop Routing for OSPF Version 2 293 Warm Standby for OSPF Version 3 293 Multicast-Intact Support for OSPF 293 Load Balancing in OSPF Version 2 and OSPFv3 294 Multi-Area Adjacency for OSPF Version 2 294 Label Distribution Protocol IGP Auto-configuration for OSPF 295 OSPF Authentication Message Digest Management 295 GTSM TTL Security Mechanism for OSPF 296 Path Computation Element for OSPFv2 296 OSPF IP Fast Reroute Loop Free Alternate 296 Management Information Base (MIB) for OSPFv3 297 How to Implement OSPF 297 Enabling OSPF 297 Configuring Stub and Not-So-Stubby Area Types 300 Configuring Neighbors for Nonbroadcast Networks 303 Configuring Authentication at Different Hierarchical Levels for OSPF Version 2 308 Controlling the Frequency That the Same LSA Is Originated or Accepted for OSPF 312 Creating a Virtual Link with MD5 Authentication to Area 0 for OSPF 314 Examples 318 Summarizing Subnetwork LSAs on an OSPF ABR 319 Redistributing Routes from One IGP into OSPF 321 Configuring OSPF Shortest Path First Throttling 324 Examples 327 Configuring Nonstop Forwarding Specific to Cisco for OSPF Version 2 327 Configuring OSPF Version 2 for MPLS Traffic Engineering 330 Examples 333 Configuring OSPFv3 Graceful Restart 334 Displaying Information About Graceful Restart 336 Configuring an OSPFv2 Sham Link 337 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x xii OL-26048-02 ContentsEnabling Nonstop Routing for OSPFv2 341 Enabling Nonstop Routing for OSPFv3 342 Configuring OSPF SPF Prefix Prioritization 343 Enabling Multicast-intact for OSPFv2 346 Associating Interfaces to a VRF 347 Configuring OSPF as a Provider Edge to Customer Edge (PE-CE) Protocol 349 Creating Multiple OSPF Instances (OSPF Process and a VRF) 352 Configuring Multi-area Adjacency 354 Configuring Label Distribution Protocol IGP Auto-configuration for OSPF 356 Configuring LDP IGP Synchronization: OSPF 358 Configuring Authentication Message Digest Management for OSPF 359 Examples 361 Configuring Generalized TTL Security Mechanism (GTSM) for OSPF 363 Examples 365 Verifying OSPF Configuration and Operation 366 Configuring IP Fast Reroute Loop-free Alternate 368 Enabling IPFRR LFA 368 Excluding an Interface From IP Fast Reroute Per-link Computation 370 Configuration Examples for Implementing OSPF 371 Cisco IOS XR Software for OSPF Version 2 Configuration: Example 371 CLI Inheritance and Precedence for OSPF Version 2: Example 372 MPLS TE for OSPF Version 2: Example 373 ABR with Summarization for OSPFv3: Example 374 ABR Stub Area for OSPFv3: Example 374 ABR Totally Stub Area for OSPFv3: Example 374 Configuring OSPF SPF Prefix Prioritization: Example 374 Route Redistribution for OSPFv3: Example 375 Virtual Link Configured Through Area 1 for OSPFv3: Example 376 Virtual Link Configured with MD5 Authentication for OSPF Version 2: Example 376 VPN Backbone and Sham Link Configured for OSPF Version 2: Example 377 Where to Go Next 378 Additional References 378 C H A P T E R 5 Implementing and Monitoring RIB on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router 381 Prerequisites for Implementing RIB 382 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 xiii ContentsInformation About RIB Configuration 382 Overview of RIB 382 RIB Data Structures in BGP and Other Protocols 382 RIB Administrative Distance 383 RIB Support for IPv4 and IPv6 383 RIB Statistics 384 IPv6 Provider Edge IPv6 and IPv6 VPN Provider Edge Transport over MPLS 384 RIB Quarantining 384 Route and Label Consistency Checker (RCC and LCC) 385 System-wide Route Prioritization for IOS XR Software 386 How to Deploy and Monitor RIB 386 Verifying RIB Configuration Using the Routing Table 386 Verifying Networking and Routing Problems 387 Disabling RIB Next-hop Dampening 389 Configuring RCC and LCC 390 Enabling RCC and LCC On-demand Scan 390 Enabling RCC and LCC Background Scan 391 Configuration Examples for RIB Monitoring 393 Output of show route Command: Example 394 Output of show route backup Command: Example 394 Output of show route best-local Command: Example 394 Output of show route connected Command: Example 395 Output of show route local Command: Example 395 Output of show route longer-prefixes Command: Example 395 Output of show route next-hop Command: Example 395 Enabling RCC and LCC: Example 396 Where to Go Next 396 Additional References 397 C H A P T E R 6 Implementing RIP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router 399 Prerequisites for Implementing RIP 400 Information About Implementing RIP 400 RIP Functional Overview 400 Split Horizon for RIP 401 Route Timers for RIP 401 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x xiv OL-26048-02 ContentsRoute Redistribution for RIP 401 Default Administrative Distances for RIP 402 Routing Policy Options for RIP 403 Authentication Using Keychain in RIP 403 In-bound RIP Traffic on an Interface 404 Out-bound RIP Traffic on an Interface 405 How to Implement RIP 405 Enabling RIP 405 Customizing RIP 407 Control Routing Information 410 Creating a Route Policy for RIP 413 Configuring RIP Authentication Keychain 415 Configuring RIP Authentication Keychain for IPv4 Interface on a Non-default VRF 415 Configuring RIP Authentication Keychain for IPv4 Interface on Default VRF 417 Configuration Examples for Implementing RIP 419 Configuring a Basic RIP Configuration: Example 419 Configuring RIP on the Provider Edge: Example 420 Adjusting RIP Timers for each VRF Instance: Example 420 Configuring Redistribution for RIP: Example 421 Configuring Route Policies for RIP: Example 421 Configuring Passive Interfaces and Explicit Neighbors for RIP: Example 422 Controlling RIP Routes: Example 422 Configuring RIP Authentication Keychain: Example 422 Additional References 423 C H A P T E R 7 Implementing Routing Policy on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router 425 Prerequisites for Implementing Routing Policy 426 Restrictions for Implementing Routing Policy 426 Information About Implementing Routing Policy 427 Routing Policy Language 427 Routing Policy Language Overview 427 Routing Policy Language Structure 427 Names 428 Sets 428 as-path-set 429 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 xv Contentscommunity-set 430 extcommunity-set 431 prefix-set 434 Enhanced Prefix-length Manipulation 435 rd-set 435 Routing Policy Language Components 436 Routing Policy Language Usage 436 Routing Policy Configuration Basics 438 Policy Definitions 438 Parameterization 439 Parameterization at Attach Points 440 Global Parameterization 441 Semantics of Policy Application 441 Boolean Operator Precedence 441 Multiple Modifications of the Same Attribute 442 When Attributes Are Modified 443 Default Drop Disposition 443 Control Flow 443 Policy Verification 444 Range Checking 444 Incomplete Policy and Set References 444 Attached Policy Modification 445 Verification of Attribute Comparisons and Actions 445 Policy Statements 445 Remark 446 Disposition 446 Action 448 If 448 Boolean Conditions 449 apply 450 Attach Points 450 BGP Policy Attach Points 451 Aggregation 451 Dampening 452 Default Originate 453 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x xvi OL-26048-02 ContentsNeighbor Export 453 Neighbor Import 454 Network 454 Redistribute 454 Show BGP 455 Table Policy 456 Import 457 Export 457 Retain Route-Target 458 Allocate-Label 459 Neighbor-ORF 459 Next-hop 460 Clear-Policy 460 Debug 460 BGP Attributes and Operators 461 OSPF Policy Attach Points 475 Default-Information Originate 475 Redistribute 475 Area-in 476 Area-out 476 OSPF Attributes and Operators 477 OSPFv3 Policy Attach Points 478 Default-Information Originate 478 Redistribute 478 OSPFv3 Attributes and Operators 479 IS-IS Policy Attach Points 479 Redistribute 479 Default-Information Originate 480 Inter-area-propagate 480 IS-IS Attributes and Operators 480 EIGRP Policy Attach Points 481 Default-Accept-In 481 Default-Accept-Out 482 Policy-In 482 Policy-Out 482 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 xvii ContentsIf-Policy-In 483 If-Policy-Out 483 Redistribute 483 EIGRP Attributes and Operators 483 RIP Policy Attach Points 485 Default-Information Originate 485 Redistribute 485 Global-Inbound 486 Global-Outbound 486 Interface-Inbound 486 Interface-Outbound 486 RIP Attributes and Operators 486 PIM Policy Attach Points 488 Attached Policy Modification 488 Nonattached Policy Modification 488 Editing Routing Policy Configuration Elements 488 Editing Routing Policy Configuration Elements Using the Nano Editor 489 Editing Routing Policy Configuration Elements Using the Emacs Editor 489 Editing Routing Policy Configuration Elements Using the Vim Editor 490 Editing Routing Policy Configuration Elements Using the CLI 490 Editing Routing Policy Language set elements Using XML 490 Hierarchical Conditions 491 Apply Condition Policies 491 Nested Wildcard Apply Policy 492 How to Implement Routing Policy 492 Defining a Route Policy 492 Attaching a Routing Policy to a BGP Neighbor 494 Modifying a Routing Policy Using a Text Editor 496 Configuration Examples for Implementing Routing Policy 497 Routing Policy Definition: Example 497 Simple Inbound Policy: Example 497 Modular Inbound Policy: Example 498 Additional References 499 C H A P T E R 8 Implementing Static Routes on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router 501 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x xviii OL-26048-02 ContentsPrerequisites for Implementing Static Routes 502 Information About Implementing Static Routes 502 Static Route Functional Overview 502 Default Administrative Distance 502 Directly Connected Routes 503 Recursive Static Routes 503 Fully Specified Static Routes 504 Floating Static Routes 504 Default VRF 504 IPv4 and IPv6 Static VRF Routes 504 Dynamic ECMP Support for IGP Prefixes 505 How to Implement Static Routes 505 Configuring a Static Route 505 Configuring a Floating Static Route 507 Configuring Static Routes Between PE-CE Routers 508 Changing the Maximum Number of Allowable Static Routes 510 Associating a VRF with a Static Route 512 Enabling Object Tracking for Static Routes 514 Configuration Examples 516 Configuring Traffic Discard: Example 516 Configuring a Fixed Default Route: Example 516 Configuring a Floating Static Route: Example 516 Configuring a Static Route Between PE-CE Routers: Example 516 Additional References 517 C H A P T E R 9 Implementing RCMD on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router 519 Route Convergence Monitoring and Diagnostics 519 Configuring Route Convergence Monitoring and Diagnostics 520 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 xix Contents Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x xx OL-26048-02 ContentsPreface The Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide preface contains these sections: • Changes to This Document, page xxi • Obtaining Documentation and Submitting a Service Request, page xxi Changes to This Document This table lists the technical changes made to this document since it was first printed. Table 1: Changes to This Document Revision Date Change Summary Republished with documentation updates for Cisco IOS XR Release 4.2.1 features. OL-26048-02 June, 2012 OL-26048-01 December, 2011 Initial release of this document. Obtaining Documentation and Submitting a Service Request For information on obtaining documentation,submitting a service request, and gathering additional information, see the monthly What's New in Cisco Product Documentation, which also lists all new and revised Cisco technical documentation, at: http://www.cisco.com/en/US/docs/general/whatsnew/whatsnew.html Subscribe to the What's New in Cisco Product Documentation as a Really Simple Syndication (RSS) feed and set content to be delivered directly to your desktop using a reader application. The RSS feeds are a free service and Cisco currently supports RSS version 2.0. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 xxi Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x xxii OL-26048-02 Preface Obtaining Documentation and Submitting a Service RequestC H A P T E R 1 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) is an Exterior Gateway Protocol (EGP) that allows you to create loop-free interdomain routing between autonomous systems. An autonomous system is a set of routers under a single technical administration. Routers in an autonomous system can use multiple Interior Gateway Protocols (IGPs) to exchange routing information inside the autonomous system and an EGP to route packets outside the autonomous system. This module provides the conceptual and configuration information for BGP on Cisco IOS XR software. For more information about BGP and complete descriptions of the BGP commands listed in this module, see Related Documents, on page 161 section of this module. To locate documentation for other commands that might appear while performing a configuration task, search online in the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router software master command index. Note Feature History for Implementing BGP Release Modification Release 3.7.2 This feature was introduced. The following features were supported: • BGP Prefix Independent Convergence Unipath Primary Backup • BGP Local Label Retention • Asplain notation for 4-byte Autonomous System Number • BGP Nonstop Routing • Command Line Interface (CLI) consistency for BGP commands • L2VPN Address Family Configuration Mode Release 3.9.0 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 1Release Modification The following features were supported: • BGP Add Path Advertisement • Accumulated iGP (AiGP) • Pre-route • IPv4 BGP-Policy Accounting • IPv6 uRPF Release 4.0.0 Release 4.1.0 Support for 5000 BGP NSR sessions was added BGP DMZ Link Bandwidth for Unequal Cost Recursive Load Balancing feature was added Release 4.1.1 The following features were supported: • Selective VRF Download • BGP Multi-Instance/Multi-AS • BFD Multihop Support for BGP Release 4.2.0 The following features were supported: • BGP 3107 PIC Updates for Global Prefixes • BGP Prefix Independent Convergence for RIB and FIB • BGP Prefix Origin Validation Based on RPKI Release 4.2.1 • Prerequisites for Implementing BGP, page 2 • Information About Implementing BGP, page 3 • How to Implement BGP on Cisco IOS XR Software, page 51 • Configuration Examples for Implementing BGP, page 152 • Where to Go Next, page 161 • Additional References, page 161 Prerequisites for Implementing BGP You must be in a user group associated with a task group that includes the proper task IDs. The command reference guides include the task IDs required for each command. If you suspect user group assignment is preventing you from using a command, contact your AAA administrator for assistance. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 2 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Prerequisites for Implementing BGPInformation About Implementing BGP To implement BGP, you need to understand the following concepts: BGP Functional Overview BGP uses TCP as its transport protocol. Two BGP routers form a TCP connection between one another (peer routers) and exchange messages to open and confirm the connection parameters. BGP routers exchange network reachability information. This information is mainly an indication of the full paths (BGP autonomous system numbers) that a route should take to reach the destination network. This information helps construct a graph that shows which autonomous systems are loop free and where routing policies can be applied to enforce restrictions on routing behavior. Any two routersforming a TCP connection to exchange BGP routing information are called peers or neighbors. BGP peers initially exchange their full BGP routing tables. After this exchange, incremental updates are sent as the routing table changes. BGP keeps a version number of the BGP table, which is the same for all of its BGP peers. The version number changes whenever BGP updatesthe table due to routing information changes. Keepalive packets are sent to ensure that the connection is alive between the BGP peers and notification packets are sent in response to error or special conditions. For information on configuring BGP to distribute Multiprotocol Label Switching (MPLS) Layer 3 virtual private network (VPN) information, see the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide For information on BGP support for Bidirectional Forwarding Detection (BFD), see the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Interface and Hardware Configuration Guide and the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Interface and Hardware Command Reference. Note BGP Router Identifier For BGP sessions between neighbors to be established, BGP must be assigned a router ID. The router ID is sent to BGP peers in the OPEN message when a BGP session is established. BGP attempts to obtain a router ID in the following ways (in order of preference): • By means of the address configured using the bgp router-id command in router configuration mode. • By using the highest IPv4 address on a loopback interface in the system if the router is booted with saved loopback address configuration. • By using the primary IPv4 address of the first loopback address that gets configured if there are not any in the saved configuration. If none of these methodsfor obtaining a router ID succeeds, BGP does not have a router ID and cannot establish any peering sessions with BGP neighbors. In such an instance, an error message is entered in the system log, and the show bgp summary command displays a router ID of 0.0.0.0. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 3 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Information About Implementing BGPAfter BGP has obtained a router ID, it continues to use it even if a better router ID becomes available. This usage avoids unnecessary flapping for all BGP sessions. However, if the router ID currently in use becomes invalid (because the interface goes down or its configuration is changed), BGP selects a new router ID (using the rules described) and all established peering sessions are reset. We strongly recommend that the bgp router-id command is configured to prevent unnecessary changes to the router ID (and consequent flapping of BGP sessions). Note BGP Default Limits Cisco IOS XR BGP imposes maximum limits on the number of neighbors that can be configured on the router and on the maximum number of prefixes that are accepted from a peer for a given address family. This limitation safeguards the router from resource depletion caused by misconfiguration, either locally or on the remote neighbor. The following limits apply to BGP configurations: • The default maximum number of peers that can be configured is 4000. The default can be changed using the bgp maximum neighbor command. The limit range is 1 to 15000. Any attempt to configure additional peers beyond the maximum limit or set the maximum limit to a number that is less than the number of peers currently configured will fail. • To prevent a peer from flooding BGP with advertisements, a limit is placed on the number of prefixes that are accepted from a peer for each supported address family. The default limits can be overridden through configuration of the maximum-prefix limit command for the peer for the appropriate address family. The following default limits are used if the user does not configure the maximum number of prefixes for the address family: ? 512K (524,288) prefixes for IPv4 unicast ? 128K (131,072) prefixes for IPv4 multicast ? 128K (131,072) prefixes for IPv6 unicast ? 512K (524,288) prefixes for VPNv4 unicast A cease notification message is sent to the neighbor and the peering with the neighbor is terminated when the number of prefixes received from the peer for a given address family exceeds the maximum limit (either set by default or configured by the user) for that address family. It is possible that the maximum number of prefixes for a neighbor for a given address family has been configured after the peering with the neighbor has been established and a certain number of prefixes have already been received from the neighbor for that address family. A cease notification message is sent to the neighbor and peering with the neighbor is terminated immediately after the configuration if the configured maximum number of prefixesisfewer than the number of prefixesthat have already been received from the neighbor for the address family. BGP Next Hop Tracking BGP receives notifications from the Routing Information Base (RIB) when next-hop information changes (event-driven notifications). BGP obtains next-hop information from the RIB to: Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 4 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP Default Limits• Determine whether a next hop is reachable. • Find the fully recursed IGP metric to the next hop (used in the best-path calculation). • Validate the received next hops. • Calculate the outgoing next hops. • Verify the reachability and connectedness of neighbors. BGP is notified when any of the following events occurs: • Next hop becomes unreachable • Next hop becomes reachable • Fully recursed IGP metric to the next hop changes • First hop IP address or first hop interface change • Next hop becomes connected • Next hop becomes unconnected • Next hop becomes a local address • Next hop becomes a nonlocal address Note Reachability and recursed metric events trigger a best-path recalculation. Event notificationsfrom the RIB are classified as critical and noncritical. Notificationsfor critical and noncritical events are sent in separate batches. However, a noncritical event is sent along with the critical events if the noncritical event is pending and there is a request to read the critical events. • Critical events are related to the reachability (reachable and unreachable), connectivity (connected and unconnected), and locality (local and nonlocal) of the next hops. Notifications for these events are not delayed. • Noncritical eventsinclude only the IGP metric changes. These events are sent at an interval of 3 seconds. A metric change event is batched and sent 3 seconds after the last one was sent. The next-hop trigger delay for critical and noncritical events can be configured to specify a minimum batching interval for critical and noncritical events using the nexthop trigger-delay command. The trigger delay is address family dependent. The BGP next-hop tracking feature allows you to specify that BGP routes are resolved using only next hops whose routes have the following characteristics: • To avoid the aggregate routes, the prefix length must be greater than a specified value. • The source protocol must be from a selected list, ensuring that BGP routes are not used to resolve next hops that could lead to oscillation. This route policy filtering is possible because RIB identifies the source protocol of route that resolved a next hop as well as the mask length associated with the route. The nexthop route-policy command is used to specify the route-policy. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 5 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP Next Hop TrackingFor information on route policy filtering for next hops using the next-hop attach point, see the Implementing Routing Policy Language on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide (this publication). Scoped IPv4/VPNv4 Table Walk To determine which address family to process, a next-hop notification is received by first dereferencing the gateway context associated with the next hop, then looking into the gateway context to determine which address families are using the gateway context. The IPv4 unicast and VPNv4 unicast address families share the same gateway context, because they are registered with the IPv4 unicast table in the RIB. As a result, both the global IPv4 unicast table and the VPNv4 table are processed when an IPv4 unicast next-hop notification is received from the RIB. A mask is maintained in the next hop, indicating whether the next hop belongs to IPv4 unicast or VPNv4 unicast, or both. This scoped table walk localizes the processing in the appropriate address family table. Reordered Address Family Processing The Cisco IOS XR software walks address family tables based on the numeric value of the address family. When a next-hop notification batch is received, the order of address family processing is reordered to the following order: • IPv4 tunnel • VPNv4 unicast • IPv4 labeled unicast • IPv4 unicast • IPv4 multicast • IPv6 unicast New Thread for Next-Hop Processing The critical-event thread in the spkr process handles only next-hop, Bidirectional Forwarding Detection (BFD), and fast-external-failover (FEF) notifications. This critical-event thread ensures that BGP convergence is not adversely impacted by other events that may take a significant amount of time. show, clear, and debug Commands The show bgp nexthops command provides statistical information about next-hop notifications, the amount of time spent in processing those notifications, and details about each next hop registered with the RIB. The clear bgp nexthop performance-statistics command ensures that the cumulative statistics associated with the processing part of the next-hop show command can be cleared to help in monitoring. The clear bgp nexthop registration command performs an asynchronous registration of the next hop with the RIB. See the BGP Commands on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Command Referencefor information on the next-hop show and clear commands. The debug bgp nexthop command displays information on next-hop processing. The out keyword provides debug information only about BGP registration of next hops with RIB. The in keyword displays debug information about next-hop notifications received from RIB. The out keyword displays debug information Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 6 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP Next Hop Trackingabout next-hop notifications sent to the RIB. See the BGP Debug Commands on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Debug Command Reference . Autonomous System Number Formats in BGP Autonomous system numbers (ASNs) are globally unique identifiers used to identify autonomous systems (ASs) and enable ASs to exchange exterior routing information between neighboring ASs. A unique ASN is allocated to each AS for use in BGP routing. ASNs are encoded as 2-byte numbers and 4-byte numbers in BGP. 2-byte Autonomous System Number Format The 2-byte ASNs are represented in asplain notation. The 2-byte range is 1 to 65535. 4-byte Autonomous System Number Format To prepare for the eventual exhaustion of 2-byte Autonomous System Numbers(ASNs), BGP hasthe capability to support 4-byte ASNs. The 4-byte ASNs are represented both in asplain and asdot notations. The byte range for 4-byte ASNs in asplain notation is 1-4294967295. The AS is represented as a 4-byte decimal number. The 4-byte ASN asplain representation is defined in draft-ietf-idr-as-representation-01.txt. For 4-byte ASNs in asdot format, the 4-byte range is 1.0 to 65535.65535 and the format is: high-order-16-bit-value-in-decimal . low-order-16-bit-value-in-decimal The BGP 4-byte ASN capability is used to propagate 4-byte-based AS path information across BGP speakers that do not support 4-byte AS numbers. See draft-ietf-idr-as4bytes-12.txt for information on increasing the size of an ASN from 2 bytes to 4 bytes. AS is represented as a 4-byte decimal number as-format Command The as-format command configures the ASN notation to asdot. The default value, if the as-format command is not configured, is asplain. BGP Configuration BGP in Cisco IOS XR software follows a neighbor-based configuration model that requires that all configurations for a particular neighbor be grouped in one place under the neighbor configuration. Peer groups are not supported for either sharing configuration between neighbors or for sharing update messages. The concept of peer group has been replaced by a set of configuration groups to be used as templates in BGP configuration and automatically generated update groups to share update messages between neighbors. Configuration Modes BGP configurations are grouped into modes. The following sections show how to enter some of the BGP configuration modes. From a mode, you can enter the ? command to display the commands available in that mode. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 7 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Autonomous System Number Formats in BGPRouter Configuration Mode The following example shows how to enter router configuration mode: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configuration RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 140 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# Router Address Family Configuration Mode The following example shows how to enter router address family configuration mode: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 112 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 multicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# Neighbor Configuration Mode The following example shows how to enter neighbor configuration mode: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 140 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 10.0.0.1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# Neighbor Address Family Configuration Mode The following example shows how to enter neighbor address family configuration mode: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 112 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 10.0.0.1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# VRF Configuration Mode The following example shows how to enter VPN routing and forwarding (VRF) configuration mode: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 140 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# vrf vrf_A RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# VRF Address Family Configuration Mode The following example shows how to enter VRF address family configuration mode: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 112 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# vrf vrf_A RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)# Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 8 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP ConfigurationVRF Neighbor Configuration Mode The following example shows how to enter VRF neighbor configuration mode: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 140 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# vrf vrf_A RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# neighbor 11.0.1.2 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr)# VRF Neighbor Address Family Configuration Mode The following example shows how to enter VRF neighbor address family configuration mode: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 112 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# vrf vrf_A RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# neighbor 11.0.1.2 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr-af)# VPNv4 Address Family Configuration Mode The following example shows how to enter VPNv4 address family configuration mode: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 152 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family vpnv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# L2VPN Address Family Configuration Mode The following example shows how to enter L2VPN address family configuration mode: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 100 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family l2vpn vpls-vpws RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# Neighbor Submode Cisco IOS XR BGP uses a neighbor submode to make it possible to enter configurations without having to prefix every configuration with the neighbor keyword and the neighbor address: • Cisco IOS XR software has a submode available for neighbors in which it is not necessary for every command to have a “neighbor x.x.x.x” prefix: In Cisco IOS XR software, the configuration is as follows: RP/0/RSP0 /CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 192.23.1.2 RP/0/RSP0 /CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 2002 RP/0/RSP0 /CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 multicast Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 9 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP Configuration• An address family configuration submode inside the neighbor configuration submode is available for entering address family-specific neighbor configurations. In Cisco IOS XR software, the configuration is as follows: RP/0/RSP0 /CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 2002::2 RP/0/RSP0 /CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 2023 RP/0/RSP0 /CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv6 unicast RP/0/RSP0 /CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# next-hop-self RP/0/RSP0 /CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy one in • You must enter neighbor-specific IPv4, IPv6, VPNv4, or VPNv6 commands in neighbor address-family configuration submode. In Cisco IOS XR software, the configuration is as follows: RP/0/RSP0 /CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 109 RP/0/RSP0 /CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 192.168.40.24 RP/0/RSP0 /CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 1 RP/0/RSP0 /CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0 /CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# maximum-prefix 1000 • You must enter neighbor-specific IPv4 and IPv6 commandsin VRF neighbor address-family configuration submode. In Cisco IOS XR software, the configuration is as follows: RP/0/RSP0 /CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 110 RP/0/RSP0 /CPU0:router(config-bgp)# vrf vrf_A RP/0/RSP0 /CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# neighbor 11.0.1.2 RP/0/RSP0 /CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0 /CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr-af)# route-policy pass all in Configuration Templates The af-group, session-group, and neighbor-group configuration commands provide template support for the neighbor configuration in Cisco IOS XR software. The af-group command is used to group address family-specific neighbor commands within an IPv4, IPv6, or VPNv4, address family. Neighbors that have the same address family configuration are able to use the address family group (af-group) name for their address family-specific configuration. A neighbor inherits the configuration from an address family group by way of the use command. If a neighbor is configured to use an address family group, the neighbor (by default) inherits the entire configuration from the address family group. However, a neighbor does not inherit all of the configuration from the address family group if items Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 10 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP Configurationare explicitly configured for the neighbor. The address family group configuration is entered under the BGP router configuration mode. The following example shows how to enter address family group configuration mode. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 140 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# af-group afmcast1 address-family ipv4 multicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# The session-group command allows you to create a session group from which neighbors can inherit address family-independent configuration. A neighbor inherits the configuration from a session group by way of the use command. If a neighbor is configured to use a session group, the neighbor (by default) inherits the entire configuration of the session group. A neighbor does not inherit all of the configuration from a session group if a configuration is done directly on that neighbor. The following example shows how to enter session group configuration mode: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# router bgp 140 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# session-group session1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# The neighbor-group command helps you apply the same configuration to one or more neighbors. Neighbor groups can include session groups and address family groups and can comprise the complete configuration for a neighbor. After a neighbor group is configured, a neighbor can inherit the configuration of the group using the use command. If a neighbor is configured to use a neighbor group, the neighbor inherits the entire BGP configuration of the neighbor group. The following example shows how to enter neighbor group configuration mode: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 123 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor-group nbrgroup1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# The following example shows how to enter neighbor group address family configuration mode: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 140 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor-group nbrgroup1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# address-family ipv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp-af)# • However, a neighbor does not inherit all of the configuration from the neighbor group if items are explicitly configured for the neighbor. In addition, some part of the configuration of the neighbor group could be hidden if a session group or address family group was also being used. Configuration grouping has the following effects in Cisco IOS XR software: • Commands entered at the session group level define address family-independent commands (the same commands as in the neighbor submode). • Commands entered at the address family group level define address family-dependent commands for a specified addressfamily (the same commands asin the neighbor-addressfamily configuration submode). • Commands entered at the neighbor group level define addressfamily-independent commands and address family-dependent commands for each address family (the same as all available neighbor commands), and define the use command for the address family group and session group commands. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 11 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP ConfigurationTemplate Inheritance Rules In Cisco IOS XR software, BGP neighbors or groups inherit configuration from other configuration groups. For address family-independent configurations: • Neighbors can inherit from session groups and neighbor groups. • Neighbor groups can inherit from session groups and other neighbor groups. • Session groups can inherit from other session groups. • If a neighbor uses a session group and a neighbor group, the configurations in the session group are preferred over the global address family configurations in the neighbor group. For address family-dependent configurations: • Address family groups can inherit from other address family groups. • Neighbor groups can inherit from address family groups and other neighbor groups. • Neighbors can inherit from address family groups and neighbor groups. Configuration group inheritance rules are numbered in order of precedence as follows: 1 If the item is configured directly on the neighbor, that value is used. In the example that follows, the advertisement interval is configured both on the neighbor group and neighbor configuration and the advertisement interval being used is from the neighbor configuration: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 140 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor-group AS_1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# advertisement-interval 15 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 10.1.1.1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# use neighbor-group AS_1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# advertisement-interval 20 The following output from the show bgp neighbors command shows that the advertisement interval used is 20 seconds: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp neighbors 10.1.1.1 BGP neighbor is 10.1.1.1, remote AS 1, local AS 140, external link Remote router ID 0.0.0.0 BGP state = Idle Last read 00:00:00, hold time is 180, keepalive interval is 60 seconds Received 0 messages, 0 notifications, 0 in queue Sent 0 messages, 0 notifications, 0 in queue Minimum time between advertisement runs is 20 seconds For Address Family: IPv4 Unicast BGP neighbor version 0 Update group: 0.1 eBGP neighbor with no inbound or outbound policy; defaults to 'drop' Route refresh request: received 0, sent 0 0 accepted prefixes Prefix advertised 0, suppressed 0, withdrawn 0, maximum limit 524288 Threshold for warning message 75% Connections established 0; dropped 0 Last reset 00:00:14, due to BGP neighbor initialized External BGP neighbor not directly connected. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 12 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP Configuration2 Otherwise, if an item is configured to be inherited from a session-group or neighbor-group and on the neighbor directly, then the configuration on the neighbor is used. If a neighbor is configured to be inherited from session-group or af-group, but no directly configured value, then the value in the session-group or af-group is used. In the example that follows, the advertisement interval is configured on a neighbor group and a session group and the advertisement interval value being used is from the session group: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 140 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# session-group AS_2 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# advertisement-interval 15 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor-group AS_1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# advertisement-interval 20 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 192.168.0.1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# use session-group AS_2 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# use neighbor-group AS_1 The following output from the show bgp neighbors command shows that the advertisement interval used is 15 seconds: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp neighbors 192.168.0.1 BGP neighbor is 192.168.0.1, remote AS 1, local AS 140, external link Remote router ID 0.0.0.0 BGP state = Idle Last read 00:00:00, hold time is 180, keepalive interval is 60 seconds Received 0 messages, 0 notifications, 0 in queue Sent 0 messages, 0 notifications, 0 in queue Minimum time between advertisement runs is 15 seconds For Address Family: IPv4 Unicast BGP neighbor version 0 Update group: 0.1 eBGP neighbor with no inbound or outbound policy; defaults to 'drop' Route refresh request: received 0, sent 0 0 accepted prefixes Prefix advertised 0, suppressed 0, withdrawn 0, maximum limit 524288 Threshold for warning message 75% Connections established 0; dropped 0 Last reset 00:03:23, due to BGP neighbor initialized External BGP neighbor not directly connected. 3 Otherwise, if the neighbor uses a neighbor group and does not use a session group or addressfamily group, the configuration value can be obtained from the neighbor group either directly or through inheritance. In the example that follows, the advertisement interval from the neighbor group is used because it is not configured directly on the neighbor and no session group is used: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 150 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# session-group AS_2 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# advertisement-interval 20 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor-group AS_1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# advertisement-interval 15 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 192.168.1.1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# use neighbor-group AS_1 The following output from the show bgp neighbors command shows that the advertisement interval used is 15 seconds: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp neighbors 192.168.1.1 BGP neighbor is 192.168.2.2, remote AS 1, local AS 140, external link Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 13 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP ConfigurationRemote router ID 0.0.0.0 BGP state = Idle Last read 00:00:00, hold time is 180, keepalive interval is 60 seconds Received 0 messages, 0 notifications, 0 in queue Sent 0 messages, 0 notifications, 0 in queue Minimum time between advertisement runs is 15 seconds For Address Family: IPv4 Unicast BGP neighbor version 0 Update group: 0.1 eBGP neighbor with no outbound policy; defaults to 'drop' Route refresh request: received 0, sent 0 Inbound path policy configured Policy for incoming advertisements is POLICY_1 0 accepted prefixes Prefix advertised 0, suppressed 0, withdrawn 0, maximum limit 524288 Threshold for warning message 75% Connections established 0; dropped 0 Last reset 00:01:14, due to BGP neighbor initialized External BGP neighbor not directly connected. To illustrate the same rule, the following example shows how to set the advertisement interval to 15 (from the session group) and 25 (from the neighbor group). The advertisement interval set in the session group overrides the one set in the neighbor group. The inbound policy is set to POLICY_1 from the neighbor group. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:routerconfig)# router bgp 140 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# session-group ADV RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# advertisement-interval 15 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor-group ADV_2 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# advertisement-interval 25 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# address-family ipv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp-af)# route-policy POLICY_1 in RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp-af)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 192.168.2.2 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# use session-group ADV RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# use neighbor-group ADV_2 The following output from the show bgp neighbors command shows that the advertisement interval used is 15 seconds: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp neighbors 192.168.2.2 BGP neighbor is 192.168.2.2, remote AS 1, local AS 140, external link Remote router ID 0.0.0.0 BGP state = Idle Last read 00:00:00, hold time is 180, keepalive interval is 60 seconds Received 0 messages, 0 notifications, 0 in queue Sent 0 messages, 0 notifications, 0 in queue Minimum time between advertisement runs is 15 seconds For Address Family: IPv4 Unicast BGP neighbor version 0 Update group: 0.1 eBGP neighbor with no inbound or outbound policy; defaults to 'drop' Route refresh request: received 0, sent 0 0 accepted prefixes Prefix advertised 0, suppressed 0, withdrawn 0, maximum limit 524288 Threshold for warning message 75% Connections established 0; dropped 0 Last reset 00:02:03, due to BGP neighbor initialized External BGP neighbor not directly connected. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 14 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP Configuration4 Otherwise, the default value is used. In the example that follows, neighbor 10.0.101.5 has the minimum time between advertisement runs set to 30 seconds (default) because the neighbor is not configured to use the neighbor configuration or the neighbor group configuration: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 140 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor-group AS_1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# remote-as 1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor-group adv_15 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# remote-as 10 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# advertisement-interval 15 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 10.0.101.5 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# use neighbor-group AS_1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 10.0.101.10 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# use neighbor-group adv_15 The following output from the show bgp neighbors command shows that the advertisement interval used is 30 seconds: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp neighbors 10.0.101.5 BGP neighbor is 10.0.101.5, remote AS 1, local AS 140, external link Remote router ID 0.0.0.0 BGP state = Idle Last read 00:00:00, hold time is 180, keepalive interval is 60 seconds Received 0 messages, 0 notifications, 0 in queue Sent 0 messages, 0 notifications, 0 in queue Minimum time between advertisement runs is 30 seconds For Address Family: IPv4 Unicast BGP neighbor version 0 Update group: 0.2 eBGP neighbor with no inbound or outbound policy; defaults to 'drop' Route refresh request: received 0, sent 0 0 accepted prefixes Prefix advertised 0, suppressed 0, withdrawn 0, maximum limit 524288 Threshold for warning message 75% Connections established 0; dropped 0 Last reset 00:00:25, due to BGP neighbor initialized External BGP neighbor not directly connected. The inheritance rules used when groups are inheriting configuration from other groups are the same as the rules given for neighbors inheriting from groups. Viewing Inherited Configurations You can use the following show commands to view BGP inherited configurations: show bgp neighbors Use the show bgp neighbors command to display information about the BGP configuration for neighbors. • Use the configuration keyword to display the effective configuration for the neighbor, including any settings that have been inherited from session groups, neighbor groups, or address family groups used by this neighbor. • Use the inheritance keyword to display the session groups, neighbor groups, and address family groups from which this neighbor is capable of inheriting configuration. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 15 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP ConfigurationThe show bgp neighbors command examples that follow are based on this sample configuration: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 142 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# af-group GROUP_3 address-family ipv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# next-hop-self RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# route-policy POLICY_1 in RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# session-group GROUP_2 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# advertisement-interval 15 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor-group GROUP_1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# use session-group GROUP_2 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# ebgp-multihop 3 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# address-family ipv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp-af)# weight 100 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp-af)# send-community-ebgp RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp-af)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# address-family ipv4 multicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp-af)# default-originate RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp-af)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 192.168.0.1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 2 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# use neighbor-group GROUP_1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# use af-group GROUP_3 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# weight 200 The following example displayssample output from the show bgp neighbors command using the inheritance keyword. The example shows that the neighbor inherits session parameters from neighbor group GROUP_1, which in turn inherits from session group GROUP_2. The neighbor inherits IPv4 unicast parameters from address family group GROUP_3 and IPv4 multicast parameters from neighbor group GROUP_1: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp neighbors 192.168.0.1 inheritance Session: n:GROUP_1 s:GROUP_2 IPv4 Unicast: a:GROUP_3 IPv4 Multicast: n:GROUP_1 The following example displays sample output from the show bgp neighbors command using the configuration keyword. The example shows from where each item of configuration was inherited, or if it was configured directly on the neighbor (indicated by [ ]). For example, the ebgp-multihop 3 command was inherited from neighbor group GROUP_1 and the next-hop-self command was inherited from the address family group GROUP_3: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp neighbors 192.168.0.1 configuration neighbor 192.168.0.1 remote-as 2 [] advertisement-interval 15 [n:GROUP_1 s:GROUP_2] ebgp-multihop 3 [n:GROUP_1] address-family ipv4 unicast [] next-hop-self [a:GROUP_3] route-policy POLICY_1 in [a:GROUP_3] weight 200 [] address-family ipv4 multicast [n:GROUP_1] default-originate [n:GROUP_1] show bgp af-group Use the show bgp af-group command to display address family groups: Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 16 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP Configuration• Use the configuration keyword to display the effective configuration for the address family group, including any settings that have been inherited from address family groups used by this address family group. • Use the inheritance keyword to display the addressfamily groupsfrom which this addressfamily group is capable of inheriting configuration. • Use the users keyword to display the neighbors, neighbor groups, and address family groups that inherit configuration from this address family group. The show bgp af-group sample commands that follow are based on this sample configuration: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 140 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# af-group GROUP_3 address-family ipv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# remove-private-as RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# route-policy POLICY_1 in RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# af-group GROUP_1 address-family ipv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# use af-group GROUP_2 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# maximum-prefix 2500 75 warning-only RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# default-originate RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# af-group GROUP_2 address-family ipv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# use af-group GROUP_3 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# send-community-ebgp RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# send-extended-community-ebgp RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# capability orf prefix both The following example displays sample output from the show bgp af-group command using the configuration keyword. This example shows from where each configuration item was inherited. The default-originate command was configured directly on this address family group (indicated by [ ]). The remove-private-as command was inherited from address family group GROUP_2, which in turn inherited from address family group GROUP_3: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp af-group GROUP_1 configuration af-group GROUP_1 address-family ipv4 unicast capability orf prefix-list both [a:GROUP_2] default-originate [] maximum-prefix 2500 75 warning-only [] route-policy POLICY_1 in [a:GROUP_2 a:GROUP_3] remove-private-AS [a:GROUP_2 a:GROUP_3] send-community-ebgp [a:GROUP_2] send-extended-community-ebgp [a:GROUP_2] The following example displays sample output from the show bgp af-group command using the users keyword: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp af-group GROUP_2 users IPv4 Unicast: a:GROUP_1 The following example displays sample output from the show bgp af-group command using the inheritance keyword. This shows that the specified address family group GROUP_1 directly uses the GROUP_2 address family group, which in turn uses the GROUP_3 address family group: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp af-group GROUP_1 inheritance IPv4 Unicast: a:GROUP_2 a:GROUP_3 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 17 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP Configurationshow bgp session-group Use the show bgp session-group command to display session groups: • Use the configuration keyword to display the effective configuration for the session group, including any settings that have been inherited from session groups used by this session group. • Use the inheritance keyword to display the session groups from which this session group is capable of inheriting configuration. • Use the users keyword to display the session groups, neighbor groups, and neighbors that inherit configuration from this session group. The output from the show bgp session-group command is based on the following session group configuration: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 113 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# session-group GROUP_1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# use session-group GROUP_2 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# update-source Loopback 0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# session-group GROUP_2 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# use session-group GROUP_3 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# ebgp-multihop 2 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# session-group GROUP_3 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# dmz-link-bandwidth The following issample output from the show bgp session-group command with the configuration keyword in EXEC mode: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp session-group GROUP_1 configuration session-group GROUP_1 ebgp-multihop 2 [s:GROUP_2] update-source Loopback0 [] dmz-link-bandwidth [s:GROUP_2 s:GROUP_3] The following is sample output from the show bgp session-group command with the inheritance keyword showing that the GROUP_1 session group inherits session parameters from the GROUP_3 and GROUP_2 session groups: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp session-group GROUP_1 inheritance Session: s:GROUP_2 s:GROUP_3 The following issample output from the show bgp session-group command with the users keyword showing that both the GROUP_1 and GROUP_2 session groupsinheritsession parametersfrom the GROUP_3 session group: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp session-group GROUP_3 users Session: s:GROUP_1 s:GROUP_2 show bgp neighbor-group Use the show bgp neighbor-group command to display neighbor groups: Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 18 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP Configuration• Use the configuration keyword to display the effective configuration for the neighbor group, including any settings that have been inherited from neighbor groups used by this neighbor group. • Use the inheritance keyword to display the address family groups, session groups, and neighbor groups from which this neighbor group is capable of inheriting configuration. • Use the users keyword to display the neighbors and neighbor groups that inherit configuration from this neighbor group. The examples are based on the following group configuration: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 140 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# af-group GROUP_3 address-family ipv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# remove-private-as RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# soft-reconfiguration inbound RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# af-group GROUP_2 address-family ipv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# use af-group GROUP_3 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# send-community-ebgp RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# send-extended-community-ebgp RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# capability orf prefix both RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# session-group GROUP_3 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# timers 30 90 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor-group GROUP_1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# remote-as 1982 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# use neighbor-group GROUP_2 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# address-family ipv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp-af)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-nbrgrp)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor-group GROUP_2 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# use session-group GROUP_3 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# address-family ipv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:routerconfig-bgp-nbrgrp-af)# use af-group GROUP_2 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp-af)# weight 100 The following is sample output from the show bgp neighbor-group command with the configuration keyword. The configuration setting source is shown to the right of each command. In the output shown previously, the remote autonomous system is configured directly on neighbor group GROUP_1, and the send community setting isinherited from neighbor group GROUP_2, which in turn inheritsthe setting from address family group GROUP_3: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp neighbor-group GROUP_1 configuration neighbor-group GROUP_1 remote-as 1982 [] timers 30 90 [n:GROUP_2 s:GROUP_3] address-family ipv4 unicast [] capability orf prefix-list both [n:GROUP_2 a:GROUP_2] remove-private-AS [n:GROUP_2 a:GROUP_2 a:GROUP_3] send-community-ebgp [n:GROUP_2 a:GROUP_2] send-extended-community-ebgp [n:GROUP_2 a:GROUP_2] soft-reconfiguration inbound [n:GROUP_2 a:GROUP_2 a:GROUP_3] weight 100 [n:GROUP_2] The following issample output from the show bgp neighbor-group command with the inheritance keyword. This output shows that the specified neighbor group GROUP_1 inherits session (address family-independent) configuration parameters from neighbor group GROUP_2. Neighbor group GROUP_2 inherits its session parameters from session group GROUP_3. It also shows that the GROUP_1 neighbor group inherits IPv4 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 19 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP Configurationunicast configuration parameters from the GROUP_2 neighbor group, which in turn inherits them from the GROUP_2 address family group, which itself inherits them from the GROUP_3 address family group: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp neighbor-group GROUP_1 inheritance Session: n:GROUP-2 s:GROUP_3 IPv4 Unicast: n:GROUP_2 a:GROUP_2 a:GROUP_3 The following is sample output from the show bgp neighbor-group command with the users keyword. This output shows that the GROUP_1 neighbor group inherits session (address family-independent) configuration parameters from the GROUP_2 neighbor group. The GROUP_1 neighbor group also inherits IPv4 unicast configuration parameters from the GROUP_2 neighbor group: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp neighbor-group GROUP_2 users Session: n:GROUP_1 IPv4 Unicast: n:GROUP_1 No Default Address Family BGP does notsupport the concept of a default addressfamily. An addressfamily must be explicitly configured under the BGP router configuration for the address family to be activated in BGP. Similarly, an address family must be explicitly configured under a neighbor for the BGP session to be activated under that address family. It is not required to have any addressfamily configured under the BGP router configuration level for a neighbor to be configured. However, it is a requirement to have an address family configured at the BGP router configuration level for the address family to be configured under a neighbor. Routing Policy Enforcement External BGP (eBGP) neighbors must have an inbound and outbound policy configured. If no policy is configured, no routes are accepted from the neighbor, nor are any routes advertised to it. This added security measure ensures that routes cannot accidentally be accepted or advertised in the case of a configuration omission error. This enforcement affects only eBGP neighbors (neighbors in a different autonomous system than this router). For internal BGP (iBGP) neighbors (neighbors in the same autonomous system), all routes are accepted or advertised if there is no policy. Note In the following example, for an eBGP neighbor, if all routes should be accepted and advertised with no modifications, a simple pass-all policy is configured: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# route-policy pass-all RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# pass RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# end-policy RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 20 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router No Default Address FamilyUse the route-policy (BGP) command in the neighbor address-family configuration mode to apply the pass-all policy to a neighbor. The following example shows how to allow all IPv4 unicast routes to be received from neighbor 192.168.40.42 and advertise all IPv4 unicast routes back to it: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 192.168.40.24 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 21 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy pass-all in RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy pass-all out RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# commit Use the show bgp summary command to display eBGP neighbors that do not have both an inbound and outbound policy for every active addressfamily. In the following example,such eBGP neighbors are indicated in the output with an exclamation (!) mark: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp all all summary Address Family: IPv4 Unicast ============================ BGP router identifier 10.0.0.1, local AS number 1 BGP generic scan interval 60 secs BGP main routing table version 41 BGP scan interval 60 secs BGP is operating in STANDALONE mode. Process RecvTblVer bRIB/RIB SendTblVer Speaker 41 41 41 Neighbor Spk AS MsgRcvd MsgSent TblVer InQ OutQ Up/Down St/PfxRcd 10.0.101.1 0 1 919 925 41 0 0 15:15:08 10 10.0.101.2 0 2 0 0 0 0 0 00:00:00 Idle Address Family: IPv4 Multicast ============================== BGP router identifier 10.0.0.1, local AS number 1 BGP generic scan interval 60 secs BGP main routing table version 1 BGP scan interval 60 secs BGP is operating in STANDALONE mode. Process RecvTblVer bRIB/RIB SendTblVer Speaker 1 1 1 Some configured eBGP neighbors do not have both inbound and outbound policies configured for IPv4 Multicast address family. These neighbors will default to sending and/or receiving no routes and are marked with ’!’ in the output below. Use the ’show bgp neighbor ’ command for details. Neighbor Spk AS MsgRcvd MsgSent TblVer InQ OutQ Up/Down St/PfxRcd 10.0.101.2 0 2 0 0 0 0 0 00:00:00 Idle! Address Family: IPv6 Unicast ============================ BGP router identifier 10.0.0.1, local AS number 1 BGP generic scan interval 60 secs BGP main routing table version 2 BGP scan interval 60 secs BGP is operating in STANDALONE mode. Process RecvTblVer bRIB/RIB SendTblVer Speaker 2 2 2 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 21 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Routing Policy EnforcementNeighbor Spk AS MsgRcvd MsgSent TblVer InQ OutQ Up/Down St/PfxRcd 2222::2 0 2 920 918 2 0 0 15:15:11 1 2222::4 0 3 0 0 0 0 0 00:00:00 Idle Address Family: IPv6 Multicast ============================== BGP router identifier 10.0.0.1, local AS number 1 BGP generic scan interval 60 secs BGP main routing table version 1 BGP scan interval 60 secs BGP is operating in STANDALONE mode. Process RecvTblVer bRIB/RIB SendTblVer Speaker 1 1 1 Some configured eBGP neighbors do not have both inbound and outbound policies configured for IPv6 Multicast address family. These neighbors will default to sending and/or receiving no routes and are marked with ’!’ in the output below. Use the ’show bgp neighbor ’ command for details. Neighbor Spk AS MsgRcvd MsgSent TblVer InQ OutQ Up/Down St/PfxRcd 2222::2 0 2 920 918 0 0 0 15:15:11 0 2222::4 0 3 0 0 0 0 0 00:00:00 Idle! Table Policy The table policy feature in BGP allows you to configure traffic index values on routes as they are installed in the global routing table. This feature is enabled using the table-policy command and supports the BGP policy accounting feature. BGP policy accounting uses traffic indices that are set on BGP routes to track various counters. See the Implementing Routing Policy on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module in the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide for details on table policy use. See the Cisco Express Forwarding Commands on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module in the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router IP Addresses and Services Command Reference for details on BGP policy accounting. Table policy also provides the ability to drop routes from the RIB based on match criteria. This feature can be useful in certain applications and should be used with caution as it can easily create a routing ‘black hole’ where BGP advertises routes to neighbors that BGP does not install in its global routing table and forwarding table. Update Groups The BGP Update Groups feature contains an algorithm that dynamically calculates and optimizes update groups of neighborsthatshare outbound policies and can share the update messages. The BGP Update Groups feature separates update group replication from peer group configuration, improving convergence time and flexibility of neighbor configuration. To use this feature, you must understand the following concepts: Related Topics BGP Update Generation and Update Groups , on page 23 BGP Update Group , on page 23 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 22 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Table PolicyBGP Update Generation and Update Groups The BGP Update Groups feature separates BGP update generation from neighbor configuration. The BGP Update Groups feature introduces an algorithm that dynamically calculates BGP update group membership based on outbound routing policies. This feature does not require any configuration by the network operator. Update group-based message generation occurs automatically and independently. BGP Update Group When a change to the configuration occurs, the router automatically recalculates update group memberships and applies the changes. For the best optimization of BGP update group generation, we recommend that the network operator keeps outbound routing policy the same for neighbors that have similar outbound policies. This feature contains commands for monitoring BGP update groups. For more information about the commands, see Monitoring BGP Update Groups, on page 131. BGP Cost Community The BGP cost community is a nontransitive extended community attribute that is passed to internal BGP (iBGP) and confederation peers but not to external BGP (eBGP) peers. The cost community feature allows you to customize the local route preference and influence the best-path selection process by assigning cost values to specific routes. The extended community format defines generic points of insertion (POI) that influence the best-path decision at different points in the best-path algorithm. The cost community attribute is applied to internal routes by configuring the set extcommunity cost command in a route policy. See the Routing Policy Language Commands on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Command Reference for information on the set extcommunity cost command. The cost community set clause is configured with a cost community ID number (0–255) and cost community number (0–4294967295). The cost community number determines the preference for the path. The path with the lowest cost community number is preferred. Paths that are not specifically configured with the cost community number are assigned a default cost community number of 2147483647 (the midpoint between 0 and 4294967295) and evaluated by the best-path selection process accordingly. When two paths have been configured with the same cost community number, the path selection process prefers the path with the lowest cost community ID. The cost-extended community attribute is propagated to iBGP peers when extended community exchange is enabled. The following commands include the route-policy keyword, which you can use to apply a route policy that is configured with the cost community set clause: • aggregate-address • redistribute • network How BGP Cost Community Influences the Best Path Selection Process The cost community attribute influences the BGP best-path selection process at the point of insertion (POI). By default, the POI follows the Interior Gateway Protocol (IGP) metric comparison. When BGP receives multiple paths to the same destination, it uses the best-path selection process to determine which path is the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 23 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP Cost Communitybest path. BGP automatically makesthe decision and installsthe best path in the routing table. The POI allows you to assign a preference to a specific path when multiple equal cost paths are available. If the POI is not valid for local best-path selection, the cost community attribute is silently ignored. Cost communities are sorted first by POI then by community ID. Multiple paths can be configured with the cost community attribute for the same POI. The path with the lowest cost community ID is considered first. In other words, all cost community paths for a specific POI are considered, starting with the one with the lowest cost community. Paths that do not contain the cost community cost (for the POI and community ID being evaluated) are assigned the default community cost value (2147483647). If the cost community values are equal, then cost community comparison proceeds to the next lowest community ID for this POI. To select the path with the lower cost community, simultaneously walk through the cost communities of both paths. Thisis done by maintaining two pointersto the cost community chain, one for each path, and advancing both pointers to the next applicable cost community at each step of the walk for the given POI, in order of community ID, and stop when a best path is chosen or the comparison is a tie. At each step of the walk, the following checks are done: If neither pointer refers to a cost community, Declare a tie; Elseif a cost community is found for one path but not for the other, Choose the path with cost community as best path; Elseif the Community ID from one path is less than the other, Choose the path with the lesser Community ID as best path; Elseif the Cost from one path is less than the other, Choose the path with the lesser Cost as best path; Else Continue. Paths that are not configured with the cost community attribute are considered by the best-path selection process to have the default cost value (half of the maximum value [4294967295] or 2147483647). Note Applying the cost community attribute at the POI allows you to assign a value to a path originated or learned by a peer in any part of the local autonomous system or confederation. The cost community can be used as a “tie breaker” during the best-path selection process. Multiple instances of the cost community can be configured for separate equal cost paths within the same autonomous system or confederation. For example, a lower cost community value can be applied to a specific exit path in a network with multiple equal cost exit points, and the specific exit path is preferred by the BGP best-path selection process. See the scenario described inInfluencing Route Preference in a Multiexit IGP Network, on page 26. The cost community comparison in BGP is enabled by default. Use the bgp bestpath cost-community ignore command to disable the comparison. Note SeeBGP Best Path Algorithm, on page 28 for information on the BGP best-path selection process. Cost Community Support for Aggregate Routes and Multipaths The BGP cost community feature supports aggregate routes and multipaths. The cost community attribute can be applied to either type of route. The cost community attribute is passed to the aggregate or multipath route from component routes that carry the cost community attribute. Only unique IDs are passed, and only the highest cost of any individual component route is applied to the aggregate for each ID. If multiple component routes contain the same ID, the highest configured cost is applied to the route. For example, the following two component routes are configured with the cost community attribute using an inbound route policy: Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 24 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP Cost Community• 10.0.0.1 ? POI=IGP ? cost community ID=1 ? cost number=100 • 192.168.0.1 ? POI=IGP ? cost community ID=1 ? cost number=200 If these component routes are aggregated or configured as a multipath, the cost value 200 is advertised, because it has the highest cost. If one or more component routes do not carry the cost community attribute or the component routes are configured with different IDs, then the default value (2147483647) is advertised for the aggregate or multipath route. For example, the following three component routes are configured with the cost community attribute using an inbound route policy. However, the component routes are configured with two different IDs. • 10.0.0.1 ? POI=IGP ? cost community ID=1 ? cost number=100 • 172.16.0.1 ? POI=IGP ? cost community ID=2 ? cost number=100 • 192.168.0.1 ? POI=IGP ? cost community ID=1 ? cost number=200 The single advertised path includes the aggregate cost communities as follows: {POI=IGP, ID=1, Cost=2147483647} {POI-IGP, ID=2, Cost=2147483647} Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 25 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP Cost CommunityInfluencing Route Preference in a Multiexit IGP Network This figure shows an IGP network with two autonomous system boundary routers (ASBRs) on the edge. Each ASBR has an equal cost path to network 10.8/16. Figure 1: Multiexit Point IGP Network Both paths are considered to be equal by BGP. If multipath loadsharing is configured, both pathsto the routing table are installed and are used to balance the load of traffic. If multipath load balancing is not configured, the BGP selects the path that was learned first as the best path and installs this path to the routing table. This behavior may not be desirable under some conditions. For example, the path is learned from ISP1 PE2 first, but the link between ISP1 PE2 and ASBR1 is a low-speed link. The configuration of the cost community attribute can be used to influence the BGP best-path selection process by applying a lower-cost community value to the path learned by ASBR2. For example, the following configuration is applied to ASBR2: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# route-policy ISP2_PE1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# set extcommunity cost (1:1) The preceding route policy applies a cost community number of 1 to the 10.8.0.0 route. By default, the path learned from ASBR1 is assigned a cost community number of 2147483647. Because the path learned from ASBR2 has a lower-cost community number, the path is preferred. BGP Cost Community Support for EIGRP MPLS VPN PE-CE with Back-door Links Back-door links in an EIGRP MPLS VPN topology is preferred by BGP if the back-door link is learned first. (A back-door link, or route, is a connection that is configured outside of the VPN between a remote and main site; for example, a WAN leased line that connects a remote site to the corporate network.) The “prebest path” point of insertion (POI) in the BGP cost community feature supports mixed EIGRP VPN network topologies that contain VPN and back-door links. This POI is applied automatically to EIGRP routes that are redistributed into BGP. The “prebest path” POI carries the EIGRP route type and metric. This POI influencesthe best-path calculation process by influencing BGP to consider the POI before any other comparison step. No configuration is required. This feature is enabled automatically for EIGRP VPN sites when Cisco IOS XR software is installed on a PE, CE, or back-door router. For information about configuring EIGRP MPLS VPNs,see the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 26 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP Cost CommunityThis figure shows how cost community can be used to support backdoor links in a network. Figure 2: Network Showing How Cost Community Can be Used to Support Backdoor Links The following sequence of events happens in PE1: 1 PE1 learns IPv4 prefix 10.1.1.0/24 from CE1 through EIGRP running a virtual routing and forwarding (VRF) instance. EIGRP selects and installs the best path in the RIB. It also encodes the cost-extended community and adds the information to the RIB. 2 The route is redistributed into BGP (assuming that IGP-to-BGP redistribution is configured). BGP also receives the cost-extended community from the route through the redistribution process. 3 After BGP has determined the best path for the newly redistributed prefix, the path is advertised to PE peers (PE2). 4 PE2 receives the BGP VPNv4 prefix route_distinguisher:10.1.1.0/24 along with the cost community. It is likely that CE2 advertises the same prefix (because of the back-door link between CE1 and CE2) to PE2 through EIGRP. PE2 BGP would have already learned the CE route through the redistribution process along with the cost community value 5 PE2 has two paths within BGP: one with cost community cost1 through multipath BGP (PE1) and another with cost community cost2 through the EIGRP neighbor (CE2). 6 PE2 runs the enhanced BGP best-path calculation. 7 PE2 installs the best path in the RIB passing the appropriate cost community value. 8 PE2 RIB has two paths for 10.1.1.0/24: one with cost community cost2 added by EIGRP and another with the cost community cost1 added by BGP. Because both the route paths have cost community, RIB compares the costs first. The BGP path has the lower cost community, so it is selected and downloaded to the RIB. 9 PE2 RIB redistributes the BGP path into EIGRP with VRF. EIGRP runs a diffusing update algorithm (DUAL) because there are two paths, and selects the BGP-redistributed path. 10 PE2 EIGRP advertises the path to CE2 making the path the next hop for the prefix to send the traffic over the MPLS network. Adding Routes to the Routing Information Base If a nonsourced path becomes the best path after the best-path calculation, BGP adds the route to the Routing Information Base (RIB) and passes the cost communities along with the other IGP extended communities. When a route with paths is added to the RIB by a protocol, RIB checks the current best paths for the route and the added pathsfor cost extended communities. If cost-extended communities are found, the RIB compares Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 27 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP Cost Communitythe set of cost communities. If the comparison does not result in a tie, the appropriate best path is chosen. If the comparison results in a tie, the RIB proceeds with the remaining steps of the best-path algorithm. If a cost community is not present in either the current best paths or added paths, then the RIB continues with the remaining steps of the best-path algorithm. See BGP Best Path Algorithm, on page 28 for information on the BGP best-path algorithm. BGP Best Path Algorithm BGP routerstypically receive multiple pathsto the same destination. The BGP best-path algorithm determines the best path to install in the IP routing table and to use for forwarding traffic. This section describes the Cisco IOS XR software implementation of BGP best-path algorithm, as specified in Section 9.1 of the Internet Engineering Task Force (IETF) Network Working Group draft-ietf-idr-bgp4-24.txt document. The BGP best-path algorithm implementation is in three parts: • Part 1—Compares two paths to determine which is better. • Part 2—Iterates over all paths and determines which order to compare the paths to select the overall best path. • Part 3—Determines whether the old and new best paths differ enough so that the new best path should be used. The order of comparison determined by Part 2 is important because the comparison operation is not transitive; that is, if three paths, A, B, and C exist, such that when A and B are compared, A is better, and when B and C are compared, B is better, it is not necessarily the case that when A and C are compared, A is better. This nontransitivity arises because the multi exit discriminator (MED) is compared only among paths from the same neighboring autonomous system (AS) and not among all paths. Note Comparing Pairs of Paths Perform the following steps to compare two paths and determine the better path: 1 If either path isinvalid (for example, a path hasthe maximum possible MED value or it has an unreachable next hop), then the other path is chosen (provided that the path is valid). 2 If the paths have unequal pre-bestpath cost communities, the path with the lower pre-bestpath cost community is selected as the best path. Note See BGP Cost Community, on page 23 for details on how cost communities are compared. 3 If the paths have unequal weights, the path with the highest weight is chosen. The weight is entirely local to the router, and can be set with the weight command or using a routing policy. Note Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 28 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP Best Path Algorithm4 If the paths have unequal local preferences, the path with the higher local preference is chosen. If a local preference attribute was received with the path or was set by a routing policy, then that value is used in this comparison. Otherwise, the default local preference value of 100 is used. The default value can be changed using the bgp default local-preference command. Note 5 If one of the paths is a redistributed path, which results from a redistribute or network command, then it is chosen. Otherwise, if one of the paths is a locally generated aggregate, which results from an aggregate-address command, it is chosen. Note Step 1 through Step 4 implement the “Path Selection with BGP”of RFC 1268. 6 If the paths have unequal AS path lengths, the path with the shorter AS path is chosen. This step is skipped if bgp bestpath as-path ignore command is configured. Note When calculating the length of the AS path, confederation segments are ignored, and AS sets count as 1. eiBGP specifies internal and external BGP multipath peers. eiBGP allows simultaneous use of internal and external paths. Note 7 If the paths have different origins, the path with the lower origin is selected. Interior Gateway Protocol (IGP) is considered lower than EGP, which is considered lower than INCOMPLETE. 8 If appropriate, the MED of the paths is compared. If they are unequal, the path with the lower MED is chosen. A number of configuration options exist that affect whether or not this step is performed. In general, the MED is compared if both paths were received from neighbors in the same AS; otherwise the MED comparison is skipped. However, this behavior is modified by certain configuration options, and there are also some corner cases to consider. If the bgp bestpath med always command is configured, then the MED comparison is always performed, regardless of neighbor AS in the paths. Otherwise, MED comparison depends on the AS paths of the two paths being compared, as follows: • If a path has no AS path or the AS path starts with an AS_SET, then the path is considered to be internal, and the MED is compared with other internal paths. • If the AS path starts with an AS_SEQUENCE, then the neighbor AS is the first AS number in the sequence, and the MED is compared with other paths that have the same neighbor AS. • If the AS path contains only confederation segments or starts with confederation segments followed by an AS_SET, then the MED is not compared with any other path unless the bgp bestpath med confed command is configured. In that case, the path is considered internal and the MED is compared with other internal paths. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 29 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP Best Path Algorithm• If the AS path starts with confederation segmentsfollowed by an AS_SEQUENCE, then the neighbor AS is the first AS number in the AS_SEQUENCE, and the MED is compared with other paths that have the same neighbor AS. If no MED attribute wasreceived with the path, then the MED is considered to be 0 unlessthe bgp bestpath med missing-as-worst command is configured. In that case, if no MED attribute was received, the MED is considered to be the highest possible value. Note 9 If one path is received from an external peer and the other is received from an internal (or confederation) peer, the path from the external peer is chosen. 10 If the paths have different IGP metrics to their next hops, the path with the lower IGP metric is chosen. 11 If the paths have unequal IP cost communities, the path with the lower IP cost community is selected as the best path. Note See the BGP Cost Community, on page 23 for details on how cost communities are compared. 12 If all path parameters in Step 1 through Step 10 are the same, then the router IDs are compared. If the path was received with an originator attribute, then that is used as the router ID to compare; otherwise, the router ID of the neighbor from which the path was received is used. If the paths have different router IDs, the path with the lower router ID is chosen. Where the originator is used as the router ID, it is possible to have two paths with the same router ID. It is also possible to have two BGP sessions with the same peer router, and therefore receive two paths with the same router ID. Note 13 If the paths have different cluster lengths, the path with the shorter cluster length is selected. If a path was not received with a cluster list attribute, it is considered to have a cluster length of 0. 14 Finally, the path received from the neighbor with the lower IP address is chosen. Locally generated paths (for example, redistributed paths) are considered to have a neighbor IP address of 0. Order of Comparisons The second part of the BGP best-path algorithm implementation determines the order in which the paths should be compared. The order of comparison is determined as follows: 1 The paths are partitioned into groups such that within each group the MED can be compared among all paths. The same rules as in Comparing Pairs of Paths, on page 28 are used to determine whether MED can be compared between any two paths. Normally, this comparison resultsin one group for each neighbor AS. If the bgp bestpath med always command is configured, then there is just one group containing all the paths. 2 The best path in each group is determined. Determining the best path is achieved by iterating through all pathsin the group and keeping track of the best one seen so far. Each path is compared with the best-so-far, and if it is better, it becomes the new best-so-far and is compared with the next path in the group. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 30 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP Best Path Algorithm3 A set of paths is formed containing the best path selected from each group in Step 2. The overall best path is selected from this set of paths, by iterating through them as in Step 2. Best Path Change Suppression The third part of the implementation is to determine whether the best-path change can be suppressed or not—whether the new best path should be used, or continue using the existing best path. The existing best path can continue to be used if the new one is identical to the point at which the best-path selection algorithm becomes arbitrary (if the router-id is the same). Continuing to use the existing best path can avoid churn in the network. This suppression behavior does not comply with the IETF Networking Working Group draft-ietf-idr-bgp4-24.txt document, but is specified in the IETF Networking Working Group draft-ietf-idr-avoid-transition-00.txt document. Note The suppression behavior can be turned off by configuring the bgp bestpath compare-routerid command. If this command is configured, the new best path is always preferred to the existing one. Otherwise, the following steps are used to determine whether the best-path change can be suppressed: 1 If the existing best path is no longer valid, the change cannot be suppressed. 2 If either the existing or new best paths were received from internal (or confederation) peers or were locally generated (for example, by redistribution), then the change cannot be suppressed. That is, suppression is possible only if both paths were received from external peers. 3 If the paths were received from the same peer (the paths would have the same router-id), the change cannot be suppressed. The router ID is calculated using rules in Comparing Pairs of Paths, on page 28. 4 If the paths have different weights, local preferences, origins, or IGP metrics to their next hops, then the change cannot be suppressed. Note that all these values are calculated using the rules in Comparing Pairs of Paths, on page 28. 5 If the paths have different-length AS paths and the bgp bestpath as-path ignore command is not configured, then the change cannot be suppressed. Again, the AS path length is calculated using the rulesin Comparing Pairs of Paths, on page 28. 6 If the MED of the paths can be compared and the MEDs are different, then the change cannot be suppressed. The decision as to whether the MEDs can be compared is exactly the same as the rules in Comparing Pairs of Paths, on page 28, as is the calculation of the MED value. 7 If all path parameters in Step 1 through Step 6 do not apply, the change can be suppressed. Administrative Distance An administrative distance is a rating of the trustworthiness of a routing information source. In general, the higher the value, the lower the trust rating. For information on specifying the administrative distance for BGP, see the BGP Commands module of the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Command Reference Normally, a route can be learned through more than one protocol. Administrative distance is used to discriminate between routes learned from more than one protocol. The route with the lowest administrative distance is Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 31 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Administrative Distanceinstalled in the IP routing table. By default, BGP uses the administrative distances shown in Table 2: BGP Default Administrative Distances, on page 32. Table 2: BGP Default Administrative Distances Distance Default Value Function Applied to routes learned from eBGP. External 20 Applied to routes learned from iBGP. Internal 200 Applied to routes originated by the router. Local 200 Distance does not influence the BGP path selection algorithm, but it does influence whether BGP-learned routes are installed in the IP routing table. Note In most cases, when a route is learned through eBGP, it is installed in the IP routing table because of its distance (20). Sometimes, however, two ASs have an IGP-learned back-door route and an eBGP-learned route. Their policy might be to use the IGP-learned path as the preferred path and to use the eBGP-learned path when the IGP path is down. See Figure 3: Back Door Example , on page 32. Figure 3: Back Door Example In Figure 3: Back Door Example , on page 32, Routers A and C and Routers B and C are running eBGP. Routers A and B are running an IGP (such as Routing Information Protocol [RIP], Interior Gateway Routing Protocol [IGRP], Enhanced IGRP, or Open Shortest Path First [OSPF]). The default distances for RIP, IGRP, Enhanced IGRP, and OSPF are 120, 100, 90, and 110, respectively. All these distances are higher than the default distance of eBGP, which is 20. Usually, the route with the lowest distance is preferred. Router A receives updates about 160.10.0.0 from two routing protocols: eBGP and IGP. Because the default distance for eBGP is lower than the default distance of the IGP, Router A chooses the eBGP-learned route Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 32 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Administrative Distancefrom Router C. If you want Router A to learn about 160.10.0.0 from Router B (IGP), establish a BGP back door. See . In the following example, a network back-door is configured: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 100 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# network 160.10.0.0/16 backdoor Router A treats the eBGP-learned route as local and installs it in the IP routing table with a distance of 200. The network is also learned through Enhanced IGRP (with a distance of 90), so the Enhanced IGRP route is successfully installed in the IP routing table and is used to forward traffic. If the Enhanced IGRP-learned route goes down, the eBGP-learned route is installed in the IP routing table and is used to forward traffic. Although BGP treats network 160.10.0.0 as a local entry, it does not advertise network 160.10.0.0 asit normally would advertise a local entry. Multiprotocol BGP Multiprotocol BGP is an enhanced BGP that carries routing information for multiple network layer protocols and IP multicast routes. BGP carries two sets of routes, one set for unicast routing and one set for multicast routing. The routes associated with multicast routing are used by the Protocol Independent Multicast (PIM) feature to build data distribution trees. Multiprotocol BGP is useful when you want a link dedicated to multicast traffic, perhaps to limit which resources are used for which traffic. Multiprotocol BGP allows you to have a unicast routing topology different from a multicast routing topology providing more control over your network and resources. In BGP, the only way to perform interdomain multicast routing was to use the BGP infrastructure that was in place for unicast routing. Perhaps you want all multicast traffic exchanged at one network access point (NAP). If those routers were not multicast capable, or there were differing policies for which you wanted multicast traffic to flow, multicast routing could not be supported without multiprotocol BGP. It is possible to configure BGP peers that exchange both unicast and multicast network layer reachability information (NLRI), but you cannot connect multiprotocol BGP clouds with a BGP cloud. That is, you cannot redistribute multiprotocol BGP routes into BGP. Note Figure 4: Noncongruent Unicast and Multicast Routes, on page 34 illustrates simple unicast and multicast topologies that are incongruent, and therefore are not possible without multiprotocol BGP. Autonomous systems 100, 200, and 300 are each connected to two NAPs that are FDDI rings. One is used for unicast peering (and therefore the exchange of unicast traffic). The Multicast Friendly Interconnect (MFI) Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 33 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Multiprotocol BGPring is used for multicast peering (and therefore the exchange of multicast traffic). Each router is unicast and multicast capable. Figure 4: Noncongruent Unicast and Multicast Routes Figure 5: Multicast BGP Environment, on page 35 is a topology of unicast-only routers and multicast-only routers. The two routers on the left are unicast-only routers (that is, they do not support or are not configured to perform multicast routing). The two routers on the right are multicast-only routers. Routers A and B support both unicast and multicast routing. The unicast-only and multicast-only routers are connected to a single NAP. In Figure 5: Multicast BGP Environment, on page 35, only unicast traffic can travel from Router A to the unicast routers to Router B and back. Multicast traffic could not flow on that path, so another routing table is required. Multicast traffic uses the path from Router A to the multicast routers to Router B and back. Figure 5: Multicast BGP Environment, on page 35 illustrates a multiprotocol BGP environment with a separate unicast route and multicast route from Router A to Router B. Multiprotocol BGP allows these routes to be incongruent. Both of the autonomous systems must be configured for internal multiprotocol BGP (IMBGP) in the figure. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 34 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Multiprotocol BGPA multicast routing protocol,such as PIM, usesthe multicast BGP database to perform Reverse Path Forwarding (RPF) lookupsfor multicast-capable sources. Thus, packets can be sent and accepted on the multicast topology but not on the unicast topology. Figure 5: Multicast BGP Environment Route Dampening Route dampening is a BGP feature that minimizes the propagation of flapping routes across an internetwork. A route is considered to be flapping when it is repeatedly available, then unavailable, then available, then unavailable, and so on. For example, consider a network with three BGP autonomous systems: autonomous system 1, autonomous system 2, and autonomoussystem 3. Suppose the route to network A in autonomoussystem 1 flaps(it becomes unavailable). Under circumstances without route dampening, the eBGP neighbor of autonomous system 1 to autonomous system 2 sends a withdraw message to autonomous system 2. The border router in autonomous system 2, in turn, propagates the withdrawal message to autonomous system 3. When the route to network A reappears, autonomous system 1 sends an advertisement message to autonomous system 2, which sends it to autonomous system 3. If the route to network A repeatedly becomes unavailable, then available, many withdrawal and advertisement messages are sent. Route flapping is a problem in an internetwork connected to the Internet, because a route flap in the Internet backbone usually involves many routes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 35 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Route DampeningMinimizing Flapping The route dampening feature minimizes the flapping problem as follows. Suppose again that the route to network A flaps. The router in autonomous system 2 (in which route dampening is enabled) assigns network A a penalty of 1000 and moves it to history state. The router in autonomous system 2 continues to advertise the status of the route to neighbors. The penalties are cumulative. When the route flaps so often that the penalty exceeds a configurable suppression limit, the router stops advertising the route to network A, regardless of how many times it flaps. Thus, the route is dampened. The penalty placed on network A is decayed until the reuse limit is reached, upon which the route is once again advertised. At half of the reuse limit, the dampening information for the route to network A is removed. No penalty is applied to a BGP peer reset when route dampening is enabled, even though the reset withdraws the route. Note BGP Routing Domain Confederation One way to reduce the iBGP mesh is to divide an autonomous system into multiple subautonomous systems and group them into a single confederation. To the outside world, the confederation looks like a single autonomous system. Each autonomous system is fully meshed within itself and has a few connections to other autonomous systems in the same confederation. Although the peers in different autonomous systems have eBGP sessions, they exchange routing information as if they were iBGP peers. Specifically, the next hop, MED, and local preference information is preserved. This feature allows you to retain a single IGP for all of the autonomous systems. BGP Route Reflectors BGP requires that all iBGP speakers be fully meshed. However, this requirement does not scale well when there are many iBGP speakers. Instead of configuring a confederation, you can reduce the iBGP mesh by using a route reflector configuration. Figure 6: Three Fully Meshed iBGP Speakers, on page 37 illustrates a simple iBGP configuration with three iBGP speakers(routers A, B, and C). Without route reflectors, when Router A receives a route from an external neighbor, it must advertise it to both routers B and C. Routers B and C do not readvertise the iBGP learned Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 36 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP Routing Domain Confederationroute to other iBGP speakers because the routers do not pass on routes learned from internal neighbors to other internal neighbors, thus preventing a routing information loop. Figure 6: Three Fully Meshed iBGP Speakers With route reflectors, all iBGP speakers need not be fully meshed because there is a method to pass learned routes to neighbors. In this model, an iBGP peer is configured to be a route reflector responsible for passing iBGP learned routes to a set of iBGP neighbors. In Figure 7: Simple BGP Model with a Route Reflector, on page 38 , Router B is configured as a route reflector. When the route reflector receives routes advertised from Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 37 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP Route ReflectorsRouter A, it advertisesthem to Router C, and vice versa. Thisscheme eliminatesthe need for the iBGP session between routers A and C. Figure 7: Simple BGP Model with a Route Reflector The internal peers of the route reflector are divided into two groups: client peers and all other routers in the autonomous system (nonclient peers). A route reflector reflects routes between these two groups. The route reflector and its client peers form a cluster. The nonclient peers must be fully meshed with each other, but the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 38 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP Route Reflectorsclient peers need not be fully meshed. The clients in the cluster do not communicate with iBGP speakers outside their cluster. Figure 8: More Complex BGP Route Reflector Model Figure 8: More Complex BGP Route Reflector Model, on page 39 illustrates a more complex route reflector scheme. Router A is the route reflector in a cluster with routers B, C, and D. Routers E, F, and G are fully meshed, nonclient routers. When the route reflector receives an advertised route, depending on the neighbor, it takesthe following actions: • A route from an external BGP speaker is advertised to all clients and nonclient peers. • A route from a nonclient peer is advertised to all clients. • A route from a client is advertised to all clients and nonclient peers. Hence, the clients need not be fully meshed. Along with route reflector-aware BGP speakers, it is possible to have BGP speakers that do not understand the concept of route reflectors. They can be members of either client or nonclient groups, allowing an easy and gradual migration from the old BGP model to the route reflector model. Initially, you could create a single cluster with a route reflector and a few clients. All other iBGP speakers could be nonclient peers to the route reflector and then more clusters could be created gradually. An autonomous system can have multiple route reflectors. A route reflector treats other route reflectors just like other iBGP speakers. A route reflector can be configured to have other route reflectors in a client group or nonclient group. In a simple configuration, the backbone could be divided into many clusters. Each route Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 39 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP Route Reflectorsreflector would be configured with other route reflectors as nonclient peers (thus, all route reflectors are fully meshed). The clients are configured to maintain iBGP sessions with only the route reflector in their cluster. Usually, a cluster of clients has a single route reflector. In that case, the cluster is identified by the router ID of the route reflector. To increase redundancy and avoid a single point of failure, a cluster might have more than one route reflector. In this case, all route reflectors in the cluster must be configured with the cluster ID so that a route reflector can recognize updates from route reflectors in the same cluster. All route reflectors serving a cluster should be fully meshed and all of them should have identical sets of client and nonclient peers. By default, the clients of a route reflector are not required to be fully meshed and the routes from a client are reflected to other clients. However, if the clients are fully meshed, the route reflector need not reflect routes to clients. As the iBGP learned routes are reflected, routing information may loop. The route reflector model has the following mechanisms to avoid routing loops: • Originator ID is an optional, nontransitive BGP attribute. It is a 4-byte attributed created by a route reflector. The attribute carriesthe router ID of the originator of the route in the local autonomoussystem. Therefore, if a misconfiguration causesrouting information to come back to the originator, the information is ignored. • Cluster-list is an optional, nontransitive BGP attribute. It is a sequence of cluster IDs that the route has passed. When a route reflector reflects a route from its clients to nonclient peers, and vice versa, it appends the local cluster ID to the cluster-list. If the cluster-list is empty, a new cluster-list is created. Using this attribute, a route reflector can identify if routing information is looped back to the same cluster due to misconfiguration. If the local cluster ID is found in the cluster-list, the advertisement is ignored. Default Address Family for show Commands Most of the show commands provide address family (AFI) and subaddress family (SAFI) arguments (see RFC 1700 and RFC 2858 for information on AFI and SAFI). The Cisco IOS XR software parser provides the ability to set the afi and safi so that it is not necessary to specify them while running a show command. The parser commands are: • set default-afi { ipv4 | ipv6 | all } • set default-safi { unicast | multicast | all } The parser automatically sets the default afi value to ipv4 and default safi value to unicast . It is necessary to use only the parser commands to change the default afi value from ipv4 or default safi value from unicast . Any afi or safi keyword specified in a show command overrides the values set using the parser commands. Use the following show default-afi-safi-vrf command to check the currently set value of the afi and safi. Distributed BGP Distributed BGP splits BGP functionality into three process types: • BGP process manager—Responsible for verifying configuration changes and for calculating and publishing the distribution of neighbors among BGP speaker processes. There is a single instance of this process. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 40 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Default Address Family for show Commands• bRIB process—Responsible for performing the best-path calculation of routes (receives partial best paths from the speaker). The best route is installed into the bRIB and is advertised back to all speakers. See the BGP Best Path Algorithm, on page 28 for information on best-path calculation. The bRIB process is also responsible for installing routes in the RIB, and for handling routes redistributed from the RIB. To accommodate route leaking from one RIB to another, bRIB may register for redistribution from multiple RIB routes into a single route in the bRIB process. There is a single instance of this process for each address family. • BGP speaker process—Responsible for handling all BGP connections to peers. The speaker stores received paths in the RIB and performs a partial best-path calculation, advertising the partial best paths to the bRIB (limited best-path calculation). Speakers perform a limited best-path calculation because to compare Multi Exit Discriminators (MEDs), paths need to be compared from the same AS but may not be received on the same speaker. Because BGP speakers do not have access to the entire BGP local RIB, BGP speakers can perform only a limited best-path calculation. (These are Step 1 through Step 7 in the BGP Best Path Algorithm, on page 28.) Only the best paths are advertised to the bRIB to reduce speaker/bRIB interprocess communications (IPC) and to reduce the number of paths to be processed in the bRIB. BGP speakers can only mark a path as active only after learning the result of the full best-path calculation from the bRIB. Neighbor import and export policies are imposed by the speaker. If the bgp bestpath med always command is enabled, complete best-path calculation happens inside speaker process. When the bgp bestpath med always command is not enabled,speakers calculate partial best paths only (performs the best-path steps up to the MED comparison) and send them to bRIB. bRIB calculatesthe final best path (performs all the stepsin the best-path calculation).When the bgp bestpath med always command is enabled, speakers can compare the MED across all ASs, allowing the speaker to calculate a single best path to send it to bRIB. bRIB is the ultimate process that calculates the final best path, but when the bgp bestpath med always command is enabled, the speakers send a single best path instead of potentially sending multiple partial best paths. There are multiple instances of this process in which each instance is responsible for a subset of BGP peer connections. Up to a total 15 speakers for all address families and one bRIB for each address family (IPv4, IPv6, and VPNv4) are supported. Distributed BGP is used to reduce the impact that a fault in one address family has on another address family. For example, you can have one speaker with only IPv6 neighbors (peering to IPv6 addresses) and a separate speaker with only IPv4 neighbors (peering to IPv4 addresses), and yet another speaker with only VPNv4 provider edge (PE) or customer edge (CE) neighbors (peering to IPv4 addresses distinct from the non-VPN neighbors). In this scenario, there is no overlap in processes (bgp, brib, and rib) between IPv4, IPv6, and VPNv4. Therefore, a bgp, brib, or rib process crash affects only one address family. Distributed BGP also allows more CPU capacity for receiving, computing, and sending BGP routing updates. When in distributed BGP mode, you can control the number of distributed speakers that are enabled, as well as which neighbors are assigned to each speaker. If no distributed speakers are enabled, BGP operates in standalone mode. If at least one distributed speaker is enabled, BGP operates in distributed mode. MPLS VPN Carrier Supporting Carrier Carrier supporting carrier (CSC) is a term used to describe a situation in which one service provider allows another service provider to use a segment of its backbone network. The service provider that provides the segment of the backbone network to the other provider is called the backbone carrier. The service provider that uses the segment of the backbone network is called the customer carrier. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 41 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router MPLS VPN Carrier Supporting CarrierA backbone carrier offers Border Gateway Protocol and Multiprotocol Label Switching (BGP/MPLS) VPN services. The customer carrier can be either: • An Internet service provider (ISP) (By definition, an ISP does not provide VPN service.) • A BGP/MPLS VPN service provider You can configure a CSC network to enable BGP to transport routes and MPLS labels between the backbone carrier provider edge (PE) routers and the customer carrier customer edge (CE) routers using multiple paths. The benefits of using BGP to distribute IPv4 routes and MPLS label routes are: • BGP takes the place of an Interior Gateway Protocol (IGP) and Label Distribution Protocol (LDP) in a VPN routing and forwarding (VRF) table. You can use BGP to distribute routes and MPLS labels. Using a single protocol instead of two simplifies the configuration and troubleshooting. • BGP is the preferred routing protocol for connecting two ISPs, mainly because of its routing policies and ability to scale. ISPs commonly use BGP between two providers. This feature enables those ISPs to use BGP. For detailed information on configuring MPLS VPN CSC with BGP, see the Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide. BGP Keychains BGP keychains enable keychain authentication between two BGP peers. The BGP endpoints must both comply with draft-bonica-tcp-auth-05.txt and a keychain on one endpoint and a password on the other endpoint does not work. See the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Security Configuration Guide for information on keychain management. BGP is able to use the keychain to implement hitless key rollover for authentication. Key rolloverspecification is time based, and in the event of clock skew between the peers, the rollover process is impacted. The configurable tolerance specification allows for the accept window to be extended (before and after) by that margin. This accept window facilitates a hitless key rollover for applications (for example, routing and management protocols). The key rollover does not impact the BGP session, unless there is a keychain configuration mismatch at the endpoints resulting in no common keys for the session traffic (send or accept). BGP Nonstop Routing The Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) Nonstop Routing (NSR) with Stateful Switchover (SSO) feature enables all bgp peerings to maintain the BGP state and ensure continuous packet forwarding during events that could interrupt service. Under NSR, events that might potentially interrupt service are not visible to peer routers. Protocolsessions are not interrupted and routing states are maintained across processrestarts and switchovers. BGP NSR provides nonstop routing during the following events: • Route processor switchover • Process crash or process failure of BGP or TCP Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 42 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP KeychainsIn case of process crash or process failure, NSR will be maintained only if nsr process-failures switchover command is configured. In the event of process failures of active instances, the nsr process-failuresswitchover configuresfailover as a recovery action and switches over to a standby route processor (RP) or a standby distributed route processor (DRP) thereby maintaining NSR. The nsr process-failures switchover command maintains both the NSR and BGP sessions in the event of a BGP or TCP process restart. Without configuring the nsr process-failures switchover, restarting the BGP or TCP process causes BGP flap. This is an expected behavior. Note During route processor switchover and In-Service System Upgrade (ISSU), NSR is achieved by stateful switchover (SSO) of both TCP and BGP. NSR does not force any software upgrades on other routers in the network, and peer routers are not required to support NSR. When a route processor switchover occurs due to a fault, the TCP connections and the BGP sessions are migrated transparently to the standby route processor, and the standby route processor becomes active. The existing protocol state is maintained on the standby route processor when it becomes active, and the protocol state does not need to be refreshed by peers. Events such as soft reconfiguration and policy modifications can trigger the BGP internal state to change. To ensure state consistency between active and standby BGP processes during such events, the concept of post-it is introduced that act as synchronization points. BGP NSR provides the following features: • NSR-related alarms and notifications • Configured and operational NSR states are tracked separately • NSR statistics collection • NSR statistics display using show commands • XML schema support • Auditing mechanisms to verify state synchronization between active and standby instances • CLI commands to enable and disable NSR • Support for 5000 NSR sessions BGP Prefix Independent Convergence Unipath Primary/Backup The Border Gateway Protocol Prefix Independent Convergence Unipath (BGP PIC Unipath) primary/backup feature provides the capability to install a backup path into the forwarding table. Installing the backup path provides prefix independent convergence in the event of a primary PE–CE link failure. The primary/backup path provides a mechanism for BGP to determine a backup best path. The backup best path acts as a backup to the overall best path, which is the primary best path. BGP programs both the paths into the Forwarding Information Base (FIB). The procedure to determine the backup best path is as follows: Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 43 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP Prefix Independent Convergence Unipath Primary/Backup1 Determine the best path from the entire set of paths available for a prefix. 2 Eliminate the current best path. 3 Eliminate all the paths that have the same next hop as that of the current best path. 4 Rerun the best path algorithm on the remaining set of paths to determine the backup best path. The PE-CE local convergence is in the order of four to five seconds for 10000 prefixes. Installing a backup path on the linecards, so that the Forwarding Information Base (FIB) can immediately switch to an alternate path, in the event of a primary PE-CE link failure reduces the convergence time. In the case of primary PE-CE link failure, the FIB starts forwarding the received traffic towards the backup PE. FIB will continue forwarding the received traffic towards the backup PE for the duration of the network convergence. Since the approach of using a backup path is independent to the prefixes, Prefix Independent Convergence Unipath functionality provides a prefix independent sub second convergence. The additional-paths selection command installs the backup path in the Forwarding Information Base (FIB) to enable primary backup path. BGP Local Label Retention When a primary PE-CE link fails, BGP withdraws the route corresponding to the primary path along with its local label and programsthe backup path in the Routing Information Base (RIB) and the Forwarding Information Base (FIB), by default. However, until all the internal peers of the primary PE reconverge to use the backup path as the new bestpath, the traffic continues to be forwarded to the primary PE with the local label that was allocated for the primary path. Hence the previously allocated local label for the primary path must be retained on the primary PE for some configurable time after the reconvergence. BGP Local Label Retention feature enables the retention of the local label for a specified period. If no time is specified, the local lable is retained for a default value of five minutes. The retain local-label command enables the retention of the local label until the network is converged. Command Line Interface (CLI) Consistency for BGP Commands From Cisco IOS XR Release 3.9.0 onwards, the Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) commands use disable keyword to disable a feature. The keyword inheritance-disable disables the inheritance of the feature properties from the parent level. BGP Additional Paths The Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) Additional Paths feature modifies the BGP protocol machinery for a BGP speaker to be able to send multiple paths for a prefix. This gives 'path diversity' in the network. The add path enables BGP prefix independent convergence (PIC) at the edge routers. BGP add path enables add path advertisement in an iBGP network and advertises the following types of paths for a prefix: • Backup paths—to enable fast convergence and connectivity restoration. • Group-best paths—to resolve route oscillation. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 44 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP Local Label Retention• All paths—to emulate an iBGP full-mesh. Add path is not be supported with MDT, tunnel, and L2VPN addressfamilies and eBGP peerings. Note iBGP Multipath Load Sharing When a Border Gateway Protocol (BGP)speaking router that has no local policy configured, receives multiple network layer reachability information (NLRI) from the internal BGP (iBGP) for the same destination, the router will choose one iBGP path as the best path. The best path is then installed in the IP routing table of the router. The iBGP Multipath Load Sharing feature enables the BGP speaking router to select multiple iBGP paths as the best paths to a destination. The best paths or multipaths are then installed in the IP routing table of the router. When there are multiple border BGP routers having reachability information heard over eBGP, if no local policy is applied, the border routers will choose their eBGP paths as best. They advertise that bestpath inside the ISP network. For a core router, there can be multiple paths to the same destination, but it will select only one path as best and use that path for forwarding. iBGP multipath load sharing adds the ability to enable load sharing among multiple equi-distant paths. Configuring multiple iBGP best paths enables a router to evenly share the traffic destined for a particular site. The iBGP Multipath Load Sharing feature functions similarly in a Multiprotocol Label Switching (MPLS) Virtual Private Network (VPN) with a service provider backbone. For multiple paths to the same destination to be considered as multipaths, the following criteria must be met: • All attributes must be the same. The attributes include weight, local preference, autonomous system path (entire attribute and not just length), origin code, Multi Exit Discriminator (MED), and Interior Gateway Protocol (iGP) distance. • The next hop router for each multipath must be different. Even if the criteria are met and multiple paths are considered multipaths, the BGP speaking router will still designate one of the multipaths as the best path and advertise this best path to its neighbors. Accumulated Interior Gateway Protocol Attribute The Accumulated Interior Gateway Protocol (AiGP)Attribute is an optional non-transitive BGP Path Attribute. The attribute type code for the AiGP Attribute isto be assigned by IANA. The value field of the AiGP Attribute is defined as a set of Type/Length/Value elements (TLVs). The AiGP TLV contains the Accumulated IGP Metric. The AiGP feature is required in the 3107 network to simulate the current OSPF behavior of computing the distance associated with a path. OSPF/LDP carries the prefix/label information only in the local area. Then, BGP carries the prefix/lable to all the remote areas by redistributing the routes into BGP at area boundaries. The routes/labels are then advertised using LSPs. The next hop for the route is changed at each ABR to local router which removes the need to leak OSPF routes across area boundaries. The bandwidth available on each Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 45 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router iBGP Multipath Load Sharingof the core links is mapped to OSPF cost, hence it is imperative that BGP carries this cost correctly between each of the PEs. This functionality is achieved by using the AiGP. Per VRF and Per CE Label for IPv6 Provider Edge The per VRF and per CE label for IPv6 feature makes it possible to save label space by allocating labels per default VRF or per CE nexthop. All IPv6 Provider Edge (6PE) labels are allocated per prefix by default. Each prefix that belongs to a VRF instance is advertised with a single label, causing an additional lookup to be performed in the VRF forwarding table to determine the customer edge (CE) next hop for the packet. However, use the label-allocation-mode command with the per-ce keyword or the per-vrf keyword to avoid the additional lookup on the PE router and conserve label space. Use per-ce keyword to specify that the same label be used for all the routes advertised from a unique customer edge (CE) peer router. Use the per-vrf keyword to specify that the same label be used for all the routes advertised from a unique VRF. IPv4 BGP-Policy Accounting on Cisco ASR 9000's A9K-SIP-700 Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) policy accounting measures and classifies IP traffic that is sent to, or received from, different peers. Policy accounting is enabled on an individual input or output interface basis. Counters based on parameters such as community list, autonomous system number, or autonomous system path are assigned to identify the IP traffic. Using BGP policy accounting, you can account for traffic according to the route it traverses. Service providers can identify and account for all traffic by customer and bill accordingly. For more information on BGP policy accounting and how to configure BGP policy accounting, refer the Implementing Cisco Express Forwarding module in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router IP Addresses and Services Configuration Guide. IPv6 Unicast Routing on Cisco ASR 9000's A9K-SIP-700 Cisco ASR 9000's A9K-SIP-700 provides complete Internet Protocol Version 6 (IPv6) unicast capability. An IPv6 unicast address is an identifier for a single interface, on a single node. A packet that is sent to a unicast address is delivered to the interface identified by that address. Cisco IOS XR software supports the following IPv6 unicast address types: • Global aggregatable address • Site-local address • Link-local address • IPv4-compatible IPv6 address For more information on IPv6 unicase addressing, refer the Implementing Network Stack IPv4 and IPv6 module in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router IP Addresses and Services Configuration Guide. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 46 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Per VRF and Per CE Label for IPv6 Provider EdgeIPv6 uRPF Support on Cisco ASR 9000's A9K-SIP-700 Unicast IPv6 Reverse Path Forwarding (uRPF) mitigates problems caused by the introduction of malformed orspoofed IP source addressesinto a network by discarding IP packetsthat lack a verifiable IP source address. Unicast RPF does this by doing a reverse lookup in the Cisco Express Forwarding (CEF) table. Therefore, uRPF is possible only if CEF is enabled on the router. Use the ipv6 verify unicast source reachable-via {any | rx} [allow-default] [allow-self-ping] command in interface configuration mode to enable IPV6 uRPF. For more information on IPv6 uRPF, refer Implementing Cisco Express Forwarding module in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router IP Addresses and Services Command Reference Remove and Replace Private AS Numbers from AS Path in BGP Private autonomous system numbers (ASNs) are used by Internet Service Providers (ISPs) and customer networks to conserve globally unique AS numbers. Private AS numbers cannot be used to access the global Internet because they are not unique. AS numbers appear in eBGP AS paths in routing updates. Removing private ASNs from the AS path is necessary if you have been using private ASNs and you want to access the global Internet. Public AS numbers are assigned by InterNIC and are globally unique. They range from 1 to 64511. Private AS numbers are used to conserve globally unique AS numbers, and they range from 64512 to 65535. Private AS numbers cannot be leaked to a global BGP routing table because they are not unique, and BGP best path calculationsrequire unique AS numbers. Therefore, it might be necessary to remove private AS numbersfrom an AS path before the routes are propagated to a BGP peer. External BGP (eBGP) requires that globally unique AS numbers be used when routing to the global Internet. Using private AS numbers (which are not unique) would prevent access to the global Internet. The remove and replace private AS Numbers from AS Path in BGP feature allows routers that belong to a private AS to accessthe global Internet. A network administrator configuresthe routersto remove private AS numbersfrom the AS path contained in outgoing update messages and optionally, to replace those numbers with the ASN of the local router, so that the AS Path length remains unchanged. The ability to remove and replace private AS numbers from the AS Path is implemented in the following ways: • The remove-private-as command removes private AS numbers from the AS path even if the path contains both public and private ASNs. • The remove-private-as command removes private AS numbers even if the AS path contains only private AS numbers. There is no likelihood of a 0-length AS path because this command can be applied to eBGP peers only, in which case the AS number of the local router is appended to the AS path. • The remove-private-as command removes private AS numbers even if the private ASNs appear before the confederation segments in the AS path. • The replace-as command replaces the private AS numbers being removed from the path with the local AS number, thereby retaining the same AS path length. The feature can be applied to neighbors per address family (address family configuration mode). Therefore, you can apply the feature for a neighbor in one address family and not on another, affecting update messages on the outbound side for only the address family for which the feature is configured. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 47 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router IPv6 uRPF Support on Cisco ASR 9000's A9K-SIP-700Use show bgp neighbors and show bgp update-group commands to verify that the that private AS numbers were removed or replaced. Selective VRF Download Selective VRF Download (SVD) feature is a solution to download only those prefixes and labels to a line card that are actively required to forward traffic through that line card. To meet the demand for a consolidated edge MSE platform, the number of VRFs, VRF interfaces, and prefix capacity increases. Convergence timings are different in different line card engines. One of the major factors that determine convergence timing is the time taken to process and program a prefix and its associated data structures. Hence, less number of prefixes and labels ensure better convergence timing. SVD reducesscalability and convergence problems in L3VPNs by enabling selective download of VRF routes to both Engine-3 (E3) and Engine-5 (E5) Linecards. SVD is enabled by default on the line cards. Use selective-vrf-download disable command to disable SVD. Use show svd role and show svd state commands to display the role and state information of SVD on the line cards. For more information on Selective VRF Download, see Cisco white paper, Selective Virtual Routing and Forwarding Table Download: A solution to increase Layer3 VPN scale at this URL http://www.cisco.com/ en/US/technologies/collateral/tk648/tk365/white_paper_c11-681649.html Line Card Roles and Filters In a Selective VRF Download (SVD) context, the line cards have these roles: • Core LC: A line card which has only core facing interfaces (interfaces that connect to other P/PEs • Customer LC: A line card which has one or more customer facing interfaces (interfaces that connect to CEs in different VRFs) The line cards handle these prefixes: • Local Prefix: A prefix that is received from a CE connected to the router in a configured VRF context • Remote Prefix: A prefix received from another PE and is imported to a configured VRF These filters are applicable to each line card type: • A core LC needs all the local prefixes and VRF labels so that the label and/or IP forwarding is set up correctly. • A customer LC needs both the local and remote prefixes for all the VRFs that it is connected to and for any other VRFs that some connected VRF has dependency on (This is based on the import/export RT configuration; VRF ‘A’ may have imported routes from VRF ‘B’, so the imported route in VRF ‘A’ points to a next-hop that is in VRF ‘B’. For route resolution, VRF ‘B’ routes need to be downloaded to each line card that has a VRF ‘A’ interface.) • If a line card is hosting both core facing and customer facing interfaces then it does not need to do any filtering at all. All the tables and all routes will be present on such line cards. These line cards will have a role called “standard”. All RPs and DRPs will have the standard role. • While the IPv4 default table needs to be present an all nodes, to correctly resolve L3VPN routes, if the line card does not have any IPv6 interfaces it can filter out all IPv6 tables and routes. In such a case the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 48 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Selective VRF Downloadline card can be deemed “not interested” in the IPv6 AFI and should behave similar to if IPv6 is not supported by the line card. BGP DMZ Link Bandwidth for Unequal Cost Recursive Load Balancing Border Gateway Protocol demilitarized zone (BGP DMZ) Link Bandwidth for Unequal Cost Recursive Load Balancing provides support for unequal cost load balancing for recursive prefixes on local node using BGP DMZ Link Bandwidth. The unequal load balance is achieved by using the dmz-link-bandwidth command in BGP Neighbor configuration mode and the bandwidth command in Interface configuration mode. BFD Multihop Support for BGP Bi-directional Forwarding Detection Multihop (BFD-MH) support is enabled for BGP. BFD Multihop establishes a BFD session between two addressesthat may span multiple network hops. Cisco IOS XR Software BFD Multihop is based on RFC 5883. For more information on BFD Multihop, refer Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Interface and Hardware Component Configuration Guide and Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Interface and Hardware Component Command Reference. BGP Multi-Instance/Multi-AS Support Multi-Instance BGP is support for multiple BGP instances. Each BGP instance is a separate process running on the same or on a different RP/DRP node. The BGP instances do not share any prefix table between them. No need for a common adj-rib-in (bRIB) as is the case with distributed BGP. The BGP instances do not communicate with each other and do not set up peering with each other. Each individual instance can set up peering with another router independently. Multi-AS BGP enables configuring each instance of a multi-instance BGP with a different AS number. Multi-Instance/Multi-AS BGP provides these capabilities: • Mechanism to consolidate the services provided by multiple routers using a common routing infrastructure into a single IOS-XR router. • Mechanism to achieve AF isolation by configuring the different AFs in different BGP instances. • Means to achieve higher session scale by distributing the overall peering sessions between multiple instances. • Mechanism to achieve higher prefix scale (especially on a RR) by having different instances carrying different BGP tables. • Improved BGP convergence under certain scenarios. • All BGP functionalities including NSR are supported for all the instances. BGP Prefix Origin Validation Based on RPKI A BGP route associates an address prefix with a set of autonomous systems (AS) that identify the interdomain path the prefix has traversed in the form of BGP announcements. This set is represented as the AS_PATH attribute in BGP and starts with the AS that originated the prefix. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 49 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP DMZ Link Bandwidth for Unequal Cost Recursive Load BalancingTo help reduce well-known threats against BGP including prefix mis-announcing and monkey-in-the-middle attacks, one of the security requirements is the ability to validate the origination AS of BGP routes. The AS number claiming to originate an address prefix (as derived from the AS_PATH attribute of the BGP route) needs to be verified and authorized by the prefix holder. The Resource Public Key Infrastructure (RPKI) is an approach to build a formally verifiable database of IP addresses and AS numbers as resources. The RPKI is a globally distributed database containing, among other things, information mapping BGP (internet) prefixes to their authorized origin-AS numbers. Routers running BGP can connect to the RPKI to validate the origin-AS of BGP paths. BGP 3107 PIC Updates for Global Prefixes The BGP 3107 PIC Updates for Global Prefixes feature supports Prefix Independent Convergence (PIC) updates for global IPv4 and IPv6 prefixes in an MPLS VPN provider network. This feature is based on RFC 3107 that describes using BGP to distribute MPLS labels for global IPv4 or IPv6 prefixes. This enables IGP to scale better and also provides PIC updates for fast convergence. RFC 3107 enables routes and labels to be carried in BGP. When BGP is used to distribute a particular route, it can also be used to distribute an MPLS label that is mapped to that route. The label mapping information for a particular route is piggybacked in the same BGP Update message that is used to distribute the route itself. RFC 3107 allows filtering of Next-Hop Loops from OSPF and reduces labels advertised by LDP. This implementation significantly reduces OSPF and LDP database. The 3107 PIC implementation supports the following address-families with additional-path configuration. • address-family ipv4 unicast • address-family ipv6 unicast • address-family vpnv4 unicast • address-family vpnv6 unicast The address-family l2vpn vpls-vpws does not support additional-path. Hence, the l2vpn service that uses address-family l2vpn vpls-vpws does not guarantee PIC convergence time. Note The 3107 PIC implementation supports these Cisco IOS XR features: • PIC Edge for 3107 • Traffic Engineering Fast-reroute (TE FRR)—Traffic convergence for core link failure is guaranteed within 50 milliseconds using verbatim tunnel. • L2VPN Service • L3VPN VPNv4 Service • 6 PE Service • 6 VPE Service • VPLS Service BGP 3107 PIC Updates for Global Prefixes implementation uses a shared recursive Load Info (RLDI) forwarding object in place of a Light-Weight recursive (LW-RLDI) object. The RLDI is shared between Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 50 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP 3107 PIC Updates for Global Prefixesmultiple leaves, while the LW-RLDI is instantiated per leaf. Sharing helps in handling PIC updates since it will be prefix independent. BGP Prefix Independent Convergence for RIB and FIB BGP PIC for RIB and FIB adds support for static recursive as PE-CE and faster backup activation by using fast re-route trigger. The BGP PIC for RIB and FIB feature supports: • FRR-like trigger for faster PE-CE link down detection, to further reduce the convergence time (Fast PIC-edge activation). • PIC-edge for static recursive routes. • BFD single-hop trigger for PIC-Edge without any explicit /32 static route configuration. • Recursive PIC activation at third level and beyond, on failure trigger at the first (IGP) level. • BGP path recursion constraints in FIB to ensure that FIB is in sync with BGP with respect to BGP next-hop resolution. • IPv6 loop-free alternate fast-reroute (LFA FRR) How to Implement BGP on Cisco IOS XR Software Enabling BGP Routing Perform this task to enable BGP routing and establish a BGP routing process. Configuring BGP neighbors is included as part of enabling BGP routing. At least one neighbor and at least one address family must be configured to enable BGP routing. At least one neighbor with both a remote AS and an address family must be configured globally using the address family and remote as commands. Note Before You Begin BGP must be able to obtain a router identifier (for example, a configured loopback address). At least, one address family must be configured in the BGP router configuration and the same address family must also be configured under the neighbor. If the neighbor is configured as an external BGP (eBGP) peer, you must configure an inbound and outbound route policy on the neighbor using the route-policy command. Note Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 51 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP Prefix Independent Convergence for RIB and FIBSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. route-policy route-policy-name 3. end-policy 4. Do one of the following: • end • commit 5. configure 6. router bgp as-number 7. bgp router-id ip-address 8. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast 9. exit 10. neighbor ip-address 11. remote-as as-number 12. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast 13. route-policy route-policy-name { in | out } 14. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 (Optional) Creates a route policy and enters route policy configuration mode, where you can define the route policy. route-policy route-policy-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# route-policy Step 2 drop-as-1234 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# if as-path passes-through '1234' then RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# apply check-communities RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# else RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# pass RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# endif Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 52 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Enabling BGP RoutingCommand or Action Purpose (Optional) Ends the definition of a route policy and exits route policy configuration mode. end-policy Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# end-policy Step 3 Step 4 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. ? Entering no exitsthe configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 5 Specifies the BGP AS number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 Step 6 bgp router-id ip-address Configures the local router with a specified router ID. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp router-id 192.168.70.24 Step 7 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 53 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Enabling BGP RoutingCommand or Action Purpose Specifies either the IPv4 or IPv6 addressfamily and enters address family configuration submode. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast Step 8 To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?). exit Exits the current configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# exit Step 9 Placesthe router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer. neighbor ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 172.168.40.24 Step 10 Creates a neighbor and assigns a remote autonomous system number to it. remote-as as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 2002 Step 11 Specifies either the IPv4 or IPv6 addressfamily and enters address family configuration submode. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast Step 12 To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?). (Optional) Applies the specified policy to inbound IPv4 unicast routes. route-policy route-policy-name { in | out } Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy drop-as-1234 in Step 13 Step 14 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# commit ? Entering no exitsthe configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 54 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Enabling BGP RoutingCommand or Action Purpose ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuring a Routing Domain Confederation for BGP Perform this task to configure the routing domain confederation for BGP. This includes specifying a confederation identifier and autonomous systems that belong to the confederation. Configuring a routing domain confederation reducesthe internal BGP (iBGP) mesh by dividing an autonomous system into multiple autonomous systems and grouping them into a single confederation. Each autonomous system is fully meshed within itself and has a few connections to another autonomous system in the same confederation. The confederation maintains the next hop and local preference information, and that allows you to retain a single Interior Gateway Protocol (IGP) for all autonomous systems. To the outside world, the confederation looks like a single autonomous system. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. bgp confederation identifier as-number 4. bgp confederation peers as-number 5. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 55 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring a Routing Domain Confederation for BGPCommand or Action Purpose Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# router bgp 120 Step 2 bgp confederation identifier as-number Specifies a BGP confederation identifier. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp confederation identifier 5 Step 3 Specifies that the BGP autonomous systems belong to a specified BGP confederation identifier. You can associate multiple AS bgp confederation peers as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp Step 4 numbers to the same confederation identifier, as shown in the example. confederation peers 1091 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp confederation peers 1092 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp confederation peers 1093 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp confederation peers 1094 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp confederation peers 1095 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp confederation peers 1096 Step 5 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# commit ? Entering yessaves configuration changesto the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 56 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring a Routing Domain Confederation for BGPCommand or Action Purpose Resetting an eBGP Session Immediately Upon Link Failure By default, if a link goes down, all BGP sessions of any directly adjacent external peers are immediately reset. Use the bgp fast-external-fallover disable command to disable automatic resetting. Turn the automatic reset back on using the no bgp fast-external-fallover disable command. eBGP sessions flap when the node reaches 3500 eBGP sessions with BGP timer values set as 10 and 30. To support more than 3500 eBGP sessions, increase the packet rate by using the lpts pifib hardware police location location-id command. Following is a sample configuration to increase the eBGP sessions: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router#configure RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)#lpts pifib hardware police location 0/2/CPU0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-pifib-policer-per-node)#flow bgp configured rate 4000 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-pifib-policer-per-node)#flow bgp known rate 4000 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-pifib-policer-per-node)#flow bgp default rate 4000 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-pifib-policer-per-node)#commit Logging Neighbor Changes Logging neighbor changes is enabled by default. Use the log neighbor changes disable command to turn off logging. The no log neighbor changes disable command can also be used to turn logging back on if it has been disabled. Adjusting BGP Timers Perform this task to set the timers for BGP neighbors. BGP uses certain timers to control periodic activities, such as the sending of keepalive messages and the interval after which a neighbor is assumed to be down if no messages are received from the neighbor during the interval. The values set using the timers bgp command in router configuration mode can be overridden on particular neighbors using the timers command in the neighbor configuration mode. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. timers bgp keepalive hold-time 4. neighbor ip-address 5. timers keepalive hold-time 6. Do one of the following: • end • commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 57 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Resetting an eBGP Session Immediately Upon Link FailureDETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 123 Step 2 timers bgp keepalive hold-time Sets a default keepalive time and a default hold time for all neighbors. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# timers bgp 30 90 Step 3 Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer. neighbor ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 172.168.40.24 Step 4 (Optional) Sets the keepalive timer and the hold-time timer for the BGP neighbor. timers keepalive hold-time Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# timers 60 220 Step 5 Step 6 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# commit ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 58 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Adjusting BGP TimersCommand or Action Purpose ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Changing the BGP Default Local Preference Value Perform this task to set the default local preference value for BGP paths. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. bgp default local-preference value 4. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 Step 2 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 59 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Changing the BGP Default Local Preference ValueCommand or Action Purpose Sets the default local preference value from the default of 100, making it either a more preferable path (over 100) or less preferable path (under 100). bgp default local-preference value Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp default local-preference 200 Step 3 Step 4 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# commit ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exitsthe configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leavesthe router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuring the MED Metric for BGP Perform this task to set the multi exit discriminator (MED) to advertise to peers for routes that do not already have a metric set (routes that were received with no MED attribute). Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 60 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring the MED Metric for BGPSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. default-metric value 4. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifiesthe autonomoussystem number and entersthe BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 Step 2 Sets the default metric, which is used to set the MED to advertise to peers for routes that do not already have a metric set (routes that were received with no MED attribute). default-metric value Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# default metric 10 Step 3 Step 4 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:routerr(config-bgp)# commit ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. ? Entering no exitsthe configuration session and returnsthe router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 61 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring the MED Metric for BGPCommand or Action Purpose • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuring BGP Weights Perform this task to assign a weight to routes received from a neighbor. A weight is a number that you can assign to a path so that you can control the best-path selection process. If you have particular neighbors that you want to prefer for most of your traffic, you can use the weight command to assign a higher weight to all routes learned from that neighbor. Before You Begin Note The clear bgp command must be used for the newly configured weight to take effect. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. neighbor ip-address 4. remote-as as-number 5. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast 6. weight weight-value 7. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 62 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring BGP WeightsCommand or Action Purpose Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 Step 2 Placesthe router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer. neighbor ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 172.168.40.24 Step 3 Creates a neighbor and assigns a remote autonomous system number to it. remote-as as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 2002 Step 4 Specifies either the IPv4 or IPv6 addressfamily and enters address family configuration submode. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast Step 5 To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?). weight weight-value Assigns a weight to all routes learned through the neighbor. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# weight 41150 Step 6 Step 7 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# commit ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 63 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring BGP WeightsCommand or Action Purpose • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Tuning the BGP Best-Path Calculation Perform this task to change the default BGP best-path calculation behavior. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. bgp bestpath med missing-as-worst 4. bgp bestpath med always 5. bgp bestpath med confed 6. bgp bestpath as-path ignore 7. bgp bestpath compare-routerid 8. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 126 Step 2 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 64 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Tuning the BGP Best-Path CalculationCommand or Action Purpose Directs the BGP software to consider a missing MED attribute in a path as having a value of infinity, making this path the least desirable path. bgp bestpath med missing-as-worst Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp bestpath med missing-as-worst Step 3 Configures the BGP speaker in the specified autonomous system to compare MEDs among all the paths for the prefix, regardless of the autonomous system from which the paths are received. bgp bestpath med always Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp bestpath med always Step 4 Enables BGP software to compare MED valuesfor pathslearned from confederation peers. bgp bestpath med confed Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp bestpath med confed Step 5 Configures the BGP software to ignore the autonomous system length when performing best-path selection. bgp bestpath as-path ignore Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp bestpath as-path ignore Step 6 Configure the BGP speaker in the autonomous system to compare the router IDs of similar paths. bgp bestpath compare-routerid Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp bestpath compare-routerid Step 7 Step 8 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 65 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Tuning the BGP Best-Path CalculationCommand or Action Purpose • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Indicating BGP Back-door Routes Perform this task to set the administrative distance on an external Border Gateway Protocol (eBGP) route to that of a locally sourced BGP route, causing it to be less preferred than an Interior Gateway Protocol (IGP) route. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast 4. network { ip-address / prefix-length | ip-address mask } backdoor 5. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 Step 2 Specifies either the IPv4 or IPv6 address family and enters address family configuration submode. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast Step 3 To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?). Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 66 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Indicating BGP Back-door RoutesCommand or Action Purpose Configures the local router to originate and advertise the specified network. network { ip-address / prefix-length | ip-address mask } backdoor Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# network 172.20.0.0/16 Step 4 Step 5 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leavesthe router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuring Aggregate Addresses Perform this task to create aggregate entries in a BGP routing table. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 67 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Aggregate AddressesSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast 4. aggregate-address address/mask-length [ as-set ] [ as-confed-set ] [ summary-only ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] 5. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 Step 2 Specifies either the IPv4 or IPv6 addressfamily and enters addressfamily configuration submode. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast Step 3 To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?). Creates an aggregate address. The path advertised for this route is an autonomous system set consisting of all elements contained in all paths that are being summarized. aggregate-address address/mask-length [ as-set ] [ as-confed-set ] [ summary-only ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] Step 4 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# aggregate-address 10.0.0.0/8 as-set • The as-set keyword generates autonomous system set path information and community information from contributing paths. • The as-confed-set keyword generates autonomous system confederation set path information from contributing paths. • The summary-only keyword filters all more specific routes from updates. • The route-policy route-policy-name keyword and argument specify the route policy used to set the attributes of the aggregate route. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 68 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Aggregate AddressesCommand or Action Purpose Step 5 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# commit ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Redistributing iBGP Routes into IGP Perform this task to redistribute iBGP routes into an Interior Gateway Protocol (IGP), such as Intermediate System-to-Intermediate System (IS-IS) or Open Shortest Path First (OSPF). Use of the bgp redistribute-internal command requires the clear route * command to be issued to reinstall all BGP routes into the IP routing table. Note Redistributing iBGP routes into IGPs may cause routing loops to form within an autonomous system. Use this command with caution. Caution Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 69 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Redistributing iBGP Routes into IGPSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. bgp redistribute-internal 4. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifiesthe autonomoussystem number and entersthe BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 Step 2 Allows the redistribution of iBGP routes into an IGP, such as IS-IS or OSPF. bgp redistribute-internal Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp redistribute-internal Step 3 Step 4 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 70 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Redistributing iBGP Routes into IGPCommand or Action Purpose • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Redistributing Prefixes into Multiprotocol BGP Perform this task to redistribute prefixes from another protocol into multiprotocol BGP. Redistribution is the process of injecting prefixes from one routing protocol into another routing protocol. This task shows how to inject prefixes from another routing protocol into multiprotocol BGP. Specifically, prefixes that are redistributed into multiprotocol BGP using the redistribute command are injected into the unicast database, the multicast database, or both. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast 4. Do one of the following: • redistribute connected [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • redistribute eigrp process-id [ match { external | internal }] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • redistribute isis process-id [ level { 1 | 1-inter-area | 2 }] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • redistribute ospf process-id [ match { external [ 1 | 2 ] | internal | nssa-external [ 1 | 2 ]]} [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • redistribute ospfv3 process-id [ match { external [ 1 | 2 ] | internal | nssa-external [ 1 | 2 ]]} [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • redistribute rip [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • redistribute static [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] 5. Do one of the following: • end • commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 71 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Redistributing Prefixes into Multiprotocol BGPDETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 Step 2 Specifies either the IPv4 or IPv6 address family and enters address family configuration submode. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast Step 3 To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?). Causesroutesfrom the specified instance to be redistributed into BGP. Step 4 Do one of the following: • redistribute connected [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • redistribute eigrp process-id [ match { external | internal }] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • redistribute isis process-id [ level { 1 | 1-inter-area | 2 }] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • redistribute ospf process-id [ match { external [ 1 | 2 ] | internal | nssa-external [ 1 | 2 ]]} [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • redistribute ospfv3 process-id [ match { external [ 1 | 2 ] | internal | nssa-external [ 1 | 2 ]]} [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • redistribute rip [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • redistribute static [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# redistribute ospf 110 Step 5 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 72 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Redistributing Prefixes into Multiprotocol BGPCommand or Action Purpose • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: • end • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exitsthe configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuring BGP Route Dampening Perform this task to configure and monitor BGP route dampening. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 73 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring BGP Route DampeningSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast 4. bgp dampening [ half-life [ reuse suppress max-suppress-time ] | route-policy route-policy-name ] 5. Do one of the following: • end • commit 6. show bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] flap-statistics 7. show bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] flap-statistics regexp regular-expression 8. show bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | labeled all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] flap-statistics route-policy route-policy-name 9. show bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | labeled all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] flap-statistics { ip-address { mask | /prefix-length }} 10. show bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] flap-statistics { ip-address [{ mask | /prefix-length } [ longer-prefixes ]]} 11. clear bgp { ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast | vrf { vrf-name | all } { ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast } } flap-statistics 12. clear bgp { ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast | vrf { vrf-name | all } { ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast }} flap-statistics regexp regular-expression 13. clear bgp { ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast | vrf { vrf-name | all } { ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast } } flap-statistics route-policy route-policy-name 14. clear bgp { ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast | vrf { vrf-name | all } { ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast } } flap-statistics network / mask-length 15. clear bgp { ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast | vrf { vrf-name | all } { ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast } } flap-statistics ip-address / mask-length 16. show bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | labeled all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] dampened-paths Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 74 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring BGP Route Dampening17. clear bgp { ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast | vrf { vrf-name | all } { ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast } } dampening [ ip-address / mask-length ] DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 Step 2 Specifies either the IPv4 or IPv6 address family and enters addressfamily configuration submode. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast Step 3 To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?). Configures BGP dampening for the specified address family. bgp dampening [ half-life [ reuse suppress max-suppress-time ] | route-policy route-policy-name ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# bgp dampening 30 1500 10000 120 Step 4 Step 5 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# end them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# commit ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returnsthe router to EXEC mode. ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 75 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring BGP Route DampeningCommand or Action Purpose ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. show bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | Displays BGP flap statistics. ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } Step 6 | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] flap-statistics Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp flap statistics Displays BGP flap statistics for all paths that match the regular expression. show bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { Step 7 unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] flap-statistics regexp regular-expression Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp flap-statistics regexp _1$ Displays BGP flap statistics for the specified route policy. show bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | labeled all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name Step 8 | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] flap-statistics route-policy route-policy-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# show bgp flap-statistics route-policy policy_A show bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | Displays BGP flap for the specified prefix. ipv6 unicast | labeled all { unicast | multicast | all | Step 9 labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] flap-statistics { ip-address { mask | /prefix-length }} Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp flap-statistics 172.20.1.1 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 76 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring BGP Route DampeningCommand or Action Purpose Displays BGP flap statistics for more specific entries for the specified IP address. show bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { Step 10 unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] flap-statistics { ip-address [{ mask | /prefix-length } [ longer-prefixes ]]} Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp flap-statistics 172.20.1.1 longer-prefixes clear bgp { ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | Clears BGP flap statistics for all routes. ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast Step 11 } | vpnv4 unicast | vrf { vrf-name | all } { ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast } } flap-statistics Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# clear bgp all all flap-statistics Clears BGP flap statisticsfor all pathsthat match the specified regular expression. clear bgp { ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast | vrf { vrf-name | all } { ipv4 { Step 12 unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast }} flap-statistics regexp regular-expression Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# clear bgp ipv4 unicast flap-statistics regexp _1$ Clears BGP flap statistics for the specified route policy. clear bgp { ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast | vrf { vrf-name | all } { ipv4 { unicast | Step 13 labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast } } flap-statistics route-policy route-policy-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# clear bgp ipv4 unicast flap-statistics route-policy policy_A Clears BGP flap statistics for the specified network. clear bgp { ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast | vrf { vrf-name | all } { ipv4 { unicast | Step 14 labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast } } flap-statistics network / mask-length Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# clear bgp ipv4 unicast flap-statistics 192.168.40.0/24 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 77 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring BGP Route DampeningCommand or Action Purpose Clears BGP flap statistics for routes received from the specified neighbor. clear bgp { ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast | vrf { vrf-name | all } { ipv4 { unicast | Step 15 labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast } } flap-statistics ip-address / mask-length Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# clear bgp ipv4 unicast flap-statistics 172.20.1.1 Displaysthe dampened routes, including the time remaining before they are unsuppressed. show bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | labeled all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name Step 16 | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] dampened-paths Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp dampened paths Clears route dampening information and unsuppresses the suppressed routes. clear bgp { ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } Step 17 | vpnv4 unicast | vrf { vrf-name | all } { ipv4 { unicast | Always use the clear bgp dampening command for an individual address-family. The all option for address-families with clear bgp dampening should never be used during normal functioning of the system. For example, use clear bgp ipv4 unicast dampening prefix x.x.x./y Caution labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast } } dampening [ ip-address / mask-length ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# clear bgp dampening Applying Policy When Updating the Routing Table Perform this task to apply a routing policy to routes being installed into the routing table. Before You Begin See the Implementing Routing Policy on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide (this publication) for a list of the supported attributes and operations that are valid for table policy filtering. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 78 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Applying Policy When Updating the Routing TableSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast 4. table-policy policy-name 5. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120.6 Step 2 Specifies either the IPv4 or IPv6 address family and enters address family configuration submode. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast Step 3 To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?). Applies the specified policy to routes being installed into the routing table. table-policy policy-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# table-policy tbl-plcy-A Step 4 Step 5 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 79 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Applying Policy When Updating the Routing TableCommand or Action Purpose ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leavesthe router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Setting BGP Administrative Distance Perform this task to specify the use of administrative distances that can be used to prefer one class of route over another. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast 4. distance bgp external-distance internal-distance local-distance 5. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 80 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Setting BGP Administrative DistanceCommand or Action Purpose Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 Step 2 Specifies either an IPv4 or IPv6 address family unicast and enters address family configuration submode. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast Step 3 To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?). Sets the external, internal, and local administrative distances to prefer one class of routes over another. The higher the value, the lower the trust rating. distance bgp external-distance internal-distance local-distance Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# distance bgp 20 20 200 Step 4 Step 5 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exitsthe configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leavesthe router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 81 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Setting BGP Administrative DistanceConfiguring a BGP Neighbor Group and Neighbors Perform thistask to configure BGP neighbor groups and apply the neighbor group configuration to a neighbor. A neighbor group is a template that holds address family-independent and address family-dependent configurations associated with the neighbor. After a neighbor group is configured, each neighbor can inherit the configuration through the use command. If a neighbor is configured to use a neighbor group, the neighbor (by default) inherits the entire configuration of the neighbor group, which includes the address family-independent and address family-dependent configurations. The inherited configuration can be overridden if you directly configure commands for the neighbor or configure session groups or address family groups through the use command. You can configure an address family-independent configuration under the neighbor group. An address family-dependent configuration requires you to configure the address family under the neighbor group to enter address family submode. From neighbor group configuration mode, you can configure address family-independent parameters for the neighbor group. Use the address-family command when in the neighbor group configuration mode. After specifying the neighbor group name using the neighbor group command, you can assign options to the neighbor group. Note All commandsthat can be configured under a specified neighbor group can be configured under a neighbor. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast 4. exit 5. neighbor-group name 6. remote-as as-number 7. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast 8. route-policy route-policy-name { in | out } 9. exit 10. exit 11. neighbor ip-address 12. use neighbor-group group-name 13. remote-as as-number 14. Do one of the following: • end • commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 82 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring a BGP Neighbor Group and NeighborsDETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 Step 2 Specifies either an IPv4 or IPv6 addressfamily unicast and enters address family configuration submode. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast Step 3 To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?). exit Exits the current configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# exit Step 4 neighbor-group name Places the router in neighbor group configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor-group nbr-grp-A Step 5 Creates a neighbor and assigns a remote autonomous system number to it. remote-as as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# remote-as 2002 Step 6 Specifies either an IPv4 or IPv6 addressfamily unicast and enters address family configuration submode. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast Step 7 To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?). (Optional) Applies the specified policy to inbound IPv4 unicast routes. route-policy route-policy-name { in | out } Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp-af)# route-policy drop-as-1234 in Step 8 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 83 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring a BGP Neighbor Group and NeighborsCommand or Action Purpose exit Exits the current configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp-af)# exit Step 9 exit Exits the current configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# exit Step 10 Placesthe router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer. neighbor ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 172.168.40.24 Step 11 (Optional) Specifies that the BGP neighbor inherit configuration from the specified neighbor group. use neighbor-group group-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# use neighbor-group nbr-grp-A Step 12 Creates a neighbor and assigns a remote autonomous system number to it. remote-as as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 2002 Step 13 Step 14 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# commit ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. ? Entering no exitsthe configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 84 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring a BGP Neighbor Group and NeighborsCommand or Action Purpose • Use the commit command to save the configuration changesto the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuring a Route Reflector for BGP Perform this task to configure a route reflector for BGP. All the neighbors configured with the route-reflector-clientcommand are members of the client group, and the remaining iBGP peers are members of the nonclient group for the local route reflector. Together, a route reflector and its clients form a cluster. A cluster of clients usually has a single route reflector. In such instances, the cluster is identified by the software as the router ID of the route reflector. To increase redundancy and avoid a single point of failure in the network, a cluster can have more than one route reflector. If it does, all route reflectors in the cluster must be configured with the same 4-byte cluster ID so that a route reflector can recognize updates from route reflectors in the same cluster. The bgp cluster-id command is used to configure the cluster ID when the cluster has more than one route reflector. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. bgp cluster-id cluster-id 4. neighbor ip-address 5. remote-as as-number 6. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast 7. route-reflector-client 8. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 85 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring a Route Reflector for BGPCommand or Action Purpose Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 Step 2 Configures the local router as one of the route reflectors serving the cluster. It is configured with a specified cluster ID to identify the cluster. bgp cluster-id cluster-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp cluster-id 192.168.70.1 Step 3 Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer. neighbor ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor Step 4 172.168.40.24 Creates a neighbor and assigns a remote autonomous system number to it. remote-as as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 2003 Step 5 Specifies either an IPv4 or IPv6 address family unicast and enters address family configuration submode. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast Step 6 To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?). Configures the router as a BGP route reflector and configures the neighbor as its client. route-reflector-client Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-reflector-client Step 7 Step 8 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# commit ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 86 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring a Route Reflector for BGPCommand or Action Purpose ? Entering no exitsthe configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuring BGP Route Filtering by Route Policy Perform this task to configure BGP routing filtering by route policy. Before You Begin See the Implementing Routing Policy on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide (this publication) for a list of the supported attributes and operations that are valid for inbound and outbound neighbor policy filtering. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. route-policy name 3. end-policy 4. router bgp as-number 5. neighbor ip-address 6. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast 7. route-policy route-policy-name { in | out } 8. Do one of the following: • end • commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 87 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring BGP Route Filtering by Route PolicyDETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 (Optional) Creates a route policy and enters route policy configuration mode, where you can define the route policy. route-policy name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# route-policy Step 2 drop-as-1234 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# if as-path passes-through '1234' then RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# apply check-communities RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# else RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# pass RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# endif (Optional) Ends the definition of a route policy and exits route policy configuration mode. end-policy Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# end-policy Step 3 Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 Step 4 Placesthe router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer. neighbor ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 172.168.40.24 Step 5 Specifies either an IPv4 or IPv6 addressfamily unicast and enters address family configuration submode. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast Step 6 To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?). route-policy route-policy-name { in | out } Applies the specified policy to inbound routes. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy drop-as-1234 in Step 7 Step 8 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 88 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring BGP Route Filtering by Route PolicyCommand or Action Purpose • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • end • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# commit ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. ? Entering no exitsthe configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuring BGP Next-Hop Trigger Delay Perform this task to configure BGP next-hop trigger delay. The Routing Information Base (RIB) classifies the dampening notifications based on the severity of the changes. Event notifications are classified as critical and noncritical. This task allows you to specify the minimum batching interval for the critical and noncritical events. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast 4. nexthop trigger-delay { critical delay | non-critical delay } 5. Do one of the following: • end • commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 89 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring BGP Next-Hop Trigger DelayDETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 Step 2 Specifies either an IPv4 or IPv6 address family unicast and enters address family configuration submode. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast Step 3 To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?). nexthop trigger-delay { critical delay | Sets the critical next-hop trigger delay. non-critical delay } Step 4 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# nexthop trigger-delay critical 15000 Step 5 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leavesthe router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 90 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring BGP Next-Hop Trigger DelayCommand or Action Purpose Disabling Next-Hop Processing on BGP Updates Perform this task to disable next-hop calculation for a neighbor and insert your own address in the next-hop field of BGP updates. Disabling the calculation of the best next hop to use when advertising a route causes all routes to be advertised with the network device as the next hop. Note Next-hop processing can be disabled for addressfamily group, neighbor group, or neighbor addressfamily. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. neighbor ip-address 4. remote-as as-number 5. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast 6. next-hop-self 7. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 Step 2 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 91 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Disabling Next-Hop Processing on BGP UpdatesCommand or Action Purpose Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer. neighbor ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 172.168.40.24 Step 3 Creates a neighbor and assigns a remote autonomous system number to it. remote-as as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 206 Step 4 Specifies either an IPv4 or IPv6 address family unicast and enters address family configuration submode. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast Step 5 To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?). Sets the next-hop attribute for all routes advertised to the specified neighbor to the address of the local router. Disabling the calculation next-hop-self Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# next-hop-self Step 6 of the best next hop to use when advertising a route causes all routes to be advertised with the local network device as the next hop. Step 7 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# end ? Entering yessaves configuration changesto the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 92 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Disabling Next-Hop Processing on BGP UpdatesConfiguring BGP Community and Extended-Community Advertisements Perform this task to specify that community/extended-community attributes should be sent to an eBGP neighbor. These attributes are not sent to an eBGP neighbor by default. By contrast, they are always sent to iBGP neighbors. This section provides examples on how to enable sending community attributes. The send-community-ebgp keyword can be replaced by the send-extended-community-ebgp keyword to enable sending extended-communities. If the send-community-ebgp command is configured for a neighbor group or address family group, all neighbors using the group inherit the configuration. Configuring the command specifically for a neighbor overrides inherited values. BGP community and extended-community filtering cannot be configured for iBGP neighbors. Communities and extended-communities are alwayssent to iBGP neighbors under IPv4, IPv6, VPNv4, and MDT address families. Note SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. neighbor ip-address 4. remote-as as-number 5. address-family{ipv4{labeled-unicast | mdt | multicast | mvpn | tunnel | unicast} | ipv6 {labeled-unicast | mvpn | unicast}} 6. Use one of these commands: • send-community-ebgp • send-extended-community-ebgp 7. Use one of these commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 93 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring BGP Community and Extended-Community AdvertisementsCommand or Action Purpose Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 Step 2 Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer. neighbor ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 172.168.40.24 Step 3 Creates a neighbor and assigns a remote autonomous system number to it. remote-as as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 2002 Step 4 Enters neighbor address family configuration mode for the specified address family. Use either ipv4 or ipv6 address family keyword with one of the specified address family sub mode identifiers. address-family{ipv4{labeled-unicast | mdt | multicast | mvpn | tunnel | unicast} | ipv6 {labeled-unicast | mvpn | unicast}} Step 5 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv6 unicast IPv6 address family mode supports these sub modes: • labeled-unicast • mvpn • unicast IPv4 address family mode supports these sub modes: • labeled-unicast • mdt • multicast • mvpn • tunnel • unicast Refer the address-family (BGP) command in BGP Commands module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Command Reference for more information on the Address Family Submode support. Specifies that the router send community attributes or extended community attributes (which are disabled by default for eBGP neighbors) to a specified eBGP neighbor. Step 6 Use one of these commands: • send-community-ebgp • send-extended-community-ebgp Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 94 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring BGP Community and Extended-Community AdvertisementsCommand or Action Purpose Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# send-community-ebgp or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# send-extended-community-ebgp Step 7 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exitsthe configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leavesthe router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuring the BGP Cost Community Perform this task to configure the BGP cost community. BGP receives multiple paths to the same destination and it uses the best-path algorithm to decide which is the best path to install in RIB. To enable users to determine an exit point after partial comparison, the cost community is defined to tie-break equal paths during the best-path selection process. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 95 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring the BGP Cost CommunitySUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. route-policy name 3. set extcommunity cost { cost-extcommunity-set-name | cost-inline-extcommunity-set } [ additive ] 4. end-policy 5. router bgp as-number 6. Do one of the following: • default-information originate • aggregate-address address/mask-length [ as-set ] [ as-confed-set ] [summary-only ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv6 unicast | vpnv4 unicast } redistribute connected [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv6 unicast | vpnv4 unicast } redistribute eigrp process-id [ match { external | internal }] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv6 unicast | vpnv4 unicast } redistribute isis process-id [ level { 1 | 1-inter-area | 2 }] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv6 unicast | vpnv4 unicast } redistribute ospf process-id [ match { external [ 1 | 2 ] | internal | nssa-external [ 1 | 2 ]}] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] 7. Do one of the following: • address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv4 mdt | ipv6 unicast | ipv6 multicast | vpnv4 unicast | vpnv6 unicast } redistribute ospfv3 process-id [ match { external [ 1 | 2 ] | internal | nssa-external [ 1 | 2 ]}] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv6 unicast | vpnv4 unicast } redistribute rip [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv6 unicast | vpnv4 unicast } redistribute static [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv6 unicast | vpnv4 unicast } network { ip-address/prefix-length | ip-address mask } [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • neighbor ip-address remote-as as-number address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv4 ipv6 unicast | vpnv4 unicast } • route-policy route-policy-name { in | out } 8. Do one of the following: • end • commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 96 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring the BGP Cost Community9. show bgp [ vrf vrf-name ] ip-address DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Enters route policy configuration mode and specifies the name of the route policy to be configured. route-policy name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# route-policy costA Step 2 Specifiesthe BGP extended community attribute for cost. set extcommunity cost { cost-extcommunity-set-name | cost-inline-extcommunity-set } [ additive ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# set extcommunity cost cost_A Step 3 Ends the definition of a route policy and exits route policy configuration mode. end-policy Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end-policy Step 4 Enters BGP configuration mode allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 Step 5 Applies the cost community to the attach point (route policy). Step 6 Do one of the following: • default-information originate • aggregate-address address/mask-length [ as-set ] [ as-confed-set ] [ summary-only ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv6 unicast | vpnv4 unicast } redistribute connected [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv6 unicast | vpnv4 unicast } redistribute eigrp process-id [ match { external | internal }] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv6 unicast | vpnv4 unicast } redistribute isis process-id Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 97 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring the BGP Cost CommunityCommand or Action Purpose [ level { 1 | 1-inter-area | 2 }] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv6 unicast | vpnv4 unicast } redistribute ospf process-id [ match { external [ 1 | 2 ] | internal | nssa-external [ 1 | 2 ]}] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] Step 7 Do one of the following: • address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv4 mdt | ipv6 unicast | ipv6 multicast | vpnv4 unicast | vpnv6 unicast } redistribute ospfv3 process-id [ match { external [ 1 | 2 ] | internal | nssa-external [ 1 | 2 ]}] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv6 unicast | vpnv4 unicast } redistribute rip [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv6 unicast | vpnv4 unicast } redistribute static [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv6 unicast | vpnv4 unicast } network { ip-address/prefix-length | ip-address mask } [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • neighbor ip-address remote-as as-number address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv4 ipv6 unicast | vpnv4 unicast } • route-policy route-policy-name { in | out } Step 8 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# end them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# commit file, exits the configuration session, and returnsthe router to EXEC mode. ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 98 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring the BGP Cost CommunityCommand or Action Purpose EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Displays the cost community in the following format: show bgp [ vrf vrf-name ] ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp 172.168.40.24 Step 9 Cost: POI : cost-community-ID : cost-number Configuring Software to Store Updates from a Neighbor Perform this task to configure the software to store updates received from a neighbor. The soft-reconfiguration inbound command causes a route refresh request to be sent to the neighbor if the neighbor is route refresh capable. If the neighbor is not route refresh capable, the neighbor must be reset to relearn received routes using the clear bgp soft command. See the Resetting Neighbors Using BGP Inbound Soft Reset, on page 124. Storing updates from a neighbor works only if either the neighbor is route refresh capable or the soft-reconfiguration inbound command is configured. Even if the neighbor is route refresh capable and the soft-reconfiguration inbound command is configured, the original routes are not stored unless the always option is used with the command. The original routes can be easily retrieved with a route refresh request. Route refresh sends a request to the peer to resend itsrouting information. The soft-reconfiguration inbound command stores all pathsreceived from the peer in an unmodified form and refersto these stored paths during the clear. Soft reconfiguration is memory intensive. Note Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 99 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Software to Store Updates from a NeighborSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. neighbor ip-address 4. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast 5. soft-reconfiguration inbound [ always] 6. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 Step 2 Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer. neighbor ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 172.168.40.24 Step 3 Specifies either an IPv4 or IPv6 address family unicast and enters address family configuration submode. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast Step 4 To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?). Configures the software to store updates received from a specified neighbor. Soft reconfiguration inbound causes the software to store soft-reconfiguration inbound [ always] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# soft-reconfiguration inbound always Step 5 the original unmodified route in addition to a route that is modified or filtered. This allows a “soft clear” to be performed after the inbound policy is changed. Soft reconfiguration enables the software to store the incoming updates before apply policy if route refresh is not supported by the peer (otherwise a copy of the update is not stored). The always Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 100 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Software to Store Updates from a NeighborCommand or Action Purpose keyword forcesthe software to store a copy even when route refresh is supported by the peer. Step 6 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# commit ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuring Distributed BGP Perform this task to configure distributed BGP. Configuring distributed BGP includes starting the speaker process and allocating the speaker process to a neighbor. Before You Begin If BGP is running in standalone mode, the clear bgp current-mode or clear bgp vrf all * command must be used to switch from standalone mode to distributed mode. Note Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 101 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Distributed BGPSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. distributed speaker id 4. commit 5. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast 6. exit 7. neighbor ip-address 8. remote-as as-number 9. speaker-id id 10. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast 11. end 12. clear bgp current-mode DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 Step 2 distributed speaker id Specifies the speaker process to start. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# distributed speaker 2 Step 3 Saves the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remains within the configuration session. commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# commit Step 4 Specifies either an IPv4 or IPv6 address family unicast and enters address family configuration submode. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast Step 5 To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?). Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 102 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Distributed BGPCommand or Action Purpose exit Exits address family mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# exit Step 6 Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer. neighbor ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 172.168.40.24 Step 7 Creates a neighbor and assigns a remote autonomous system number to it. remote-as as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 2002 Step 8 speaker-id id Allocates a neighbor to a specified speaker process. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# speaker-id 2 Step 9 Specifies either an IPv4 or IPv6 address family unicast and enters address family configuration submode. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast Step 10 To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?). Step 11 end Saves configuration changes. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returnsthe router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 103 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Distributed BGPCommand or Action Purpose clear bgp current-mode Switches from standalone mode to distributed mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# clear bgp current-mode Step 12 Configuring a VPN Routing and Forwarding Instance in BGP Layer 2 and Layer 3 (virtual private network) VPN can be configured only if there is an available Layer 3 VPN license for the line card slot on which the feature is being configured. If the advanced IP license is enabled, 4096 Layer 3 VPN routing and forwarding instances (VRFs) can be configured on an interface. If the infrastructure VRF license is enabled, eight Layer 3 VRFs can be configured on the line card. See the Software Entitlement on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide for more information on advanced IP licencing. The following error message appears if the appropriate licence is not enabled: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router#LC/0/0/CPU0:Dec 15 17:57:53.653 : rsi_agent[247]: %LICENSE-ASR9K_LICENSE-2-INFRA_VRF_NEEDED : 5 VRF(s) are configured without license A9K-iVRF-LIC in violation of the Software Right To Use Agreement. This feature may be disabled by the system without the appropriate license. Contact Cisco to purchase the license immediately to avoid potential service interruption. The following tasks are used to configure a VPN routing and forwarding (VRF) instance in BGP: Defining the Virtual Routing and Forwarding Tables in Provider Edge Routers Perform this task to define the VPN routing and forwarding (VRF) tables in the provider edge (PE) routers. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. vrf vrf-name 3. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast 4. maximum prefix maximum [ threshold ] 5. import route-policy policy-name 6. import route-target [ as-number : nn | ip-address : nn ] 7. export route-policy policy-name 8. export route-target [ as-number : nn | ip-address : nn ] 9. Do one of the following: • end • commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 104 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring a VPN Routing and Forwarding Instance in BGPDETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 vrf vrf-name Configures a VRF instance. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# vrf vrf_pe Step 2 Specifies either the IPv4 or IPv6 address family and enters address family configuration submode. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast Step 3 To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?). Step 4 maximum prefix maximum [ threshold ] Configures a limit to the number of prefixes allowed in a VRF table. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf-af)# maximum prefix 2300 A maximum number of routes is applicable only to dynamic routing protocols and not to static or connected routes. You can specify a threshold percentage of the prefix limit using the mid-threshold argument. (Optional) Provides finer control over what gets imported into a VRF. This import filter discards prefixes that do not match the specified policy-name argument. import route-policy policy-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf-af)# import route-policy policy_a Step 5 Specifies a list of route target (RT) extended communities. Only prefixes that are associated with the specified import route target extended communities are imported into the VRF. import route-target [ as-number : nn | ip-address : nn ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf-af)# import route-target 234:222 Step 6 (Optional) Provides finer control over what gets exported into a VRF. This export filter discards prefixes that do not match the specified policy-name argument. export route-policy policy-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf-af)# export route-policy policy_b Step 7 Specifies a list of route target extended communities. Export route target communities are associated with prefixes when they are export route-target [ as-number : nn | ip-address : nn ] Step 8 advertised to remote PEs. The remote PEs import them into VRFs Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 105 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring a VPN Routing and Forwarding Instance in BGPCommand or Action Purpose Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:routerr(config-vrf-af)# export route-target 123;234 which have import RTs that match these exported route target communities. Step 9 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf-af)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf-af)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leavesthe router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuring the Route Distinguisher The route distinguisher (RD) makes prefixes unique across multiple VPN routing and forwarding (VRF) instances. In the L3VPN multipath same route distinguisher (RD)environment, the determination of whether to install a prefix in RIB or not is based on the prefix's bestpath. In a rare misconfiguration situation, where the best pah is not a valid path to be installed in RIB, BGP drops the prefix and does not consider the other paths. The behavior is different for different RD setup, where the non-best multipath will be installed if the best multipath is invalid to be installed in RIB. Perform this task to configure the RD. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 106 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring a VPN Routing and Forwarding Instance in BGPSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. bgp router-id ip-address 4. vrf vrf-name 5. rd { as-number : nn | ip-address : nn | auto } 6. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Enters BGP configuration mode allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 Step 2 bgp router-id ip-address Configures a fixed router ID for the BGP-speaking router. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp router-id 10.0.0.0 Step 3 vrf vrf-name Configures a VRF instance. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# vrf vrf_pe Step 4 Step 5 rd { as-number : nn | ip-address : nn | auto } Configures the route distinguisher. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# rd 345:567 Use the auto keyword if you want the router to automatically assign a unique RD to the VRF. Automatic assignment of RDs is possible only if a router ID is configured using the bgp router-id command in router configuration mode. This allows you to configure a globally unique router ID that can be used for automatic RD generation. The router ID for the VRF does not need to be globally unique, and using the VRF router ID Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 107 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring a VPN Routing and Forwarding Instance in BGPCommand or Action Purpose would be incorrect for automatic RD generation. Having a single router ID also helpsin checkpointing RD information for BGP graceful restart, because it is expected to be stable across reboots. Step 6 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuring PE-PE or PE-RR Interior BGP Sessions To enable BGP to carry VPN reachability information between provider edge (PE) routers you must configure the PE-PE interior BGP (iBGP) sessions. A PE uses VPN information carried from the remote PE router to determine VPN connectivity and the label value to be used so the remote (egress) router can demultiplex the packet to the correct VPN during packet forwarding. The PE-PE, PE-route reflector (RR) iBGP sessions are defined to all PE and RR routers that participate in the VPNs configured in the PE router. Perform this task to configure PE-PE iBGP sessions and to configure global VPN options on a PE. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 108 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring a VPN Routing and Forwarding Instance in BGPSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. address-family vpnv4 unicast 4. exit 5. neighbor ip-address 6. remote-as as-number 7. description text 8. password { clear | encrypted } password 9. shutdown 10. timers keepalive hold-time 11. update-source type interface-id 12. address-family vpnv4 unicast 13. route-policy route-policy-name in 14. route-policy route-policy-name out 15. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 Step 2 address-family vpnv4 unicast Enters VPN address family configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family vpvn4 unicast Step 3 exit Exits the current configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# exit Step 4 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 109 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring a VPN Routing and Forwarding Instance in BGPCommand or Action Purpose neighbor ip-address Configures a PE iBGP neighbor. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 172.16.1.1 Step 5 remote-as as-number Assigns the neighbor a remote autonomous system number. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 1 Step 6 (Optional) Provides a description of the neighbor. The description is used to save comments and does not affect software function. description text Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# description neighbor 172.16.1.1 Step 7 Enables Message Digest 5 (MD5) authentication on the TCP connection between the two BGP neighbors. password { clear | encrypted } password Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# password encrypted 123abc Step 8 Terminates any active sessions for the specified neighbor and removes all associated routing information. shutdown Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# shutdown Step 9 timers keepalive hold-time Set the timers for the BGP neighbor. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# timers 12000 200 Step 10 Allows iBGP sessions to use the primary IP address from a specific interface as the local address when forming an iBGP session with a neighbor. update-source type interface-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# update-source gigabitEthernet 0/1/5/0 Step 11 address-family vpnv4 unicast Enters VPN neighbor address family configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family vpvn4 unicast Step 12 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 110 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring a VPN Routing and Forwarding Instance in BGPCommand or Action Purpose Specifies a routing policy for an inbound route. The policy can be used to filter routes or modify route attributes. route-policy route-policy-name in Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy pe-pe-vpn-in in Step 13 Specifies a routing policy for an outbound route. The policy can be used to filter routes or modify route attributes. route-policy route-policy-name out Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy pe-pe-vpn-out out Step 14 Step 15 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuring Route Reflector to Hold Routes That Have a Defined Set of RT Communities A provider edge (PE) needsto hold the routesthat match the import route targets(RTs) of the VPNs configured on it. The PE router can discard all other VPNv4 routes. But, a route reflector (RR) must retain all VPNv4 routes, because it might peer with PE routers and different PEs might require different RT-tagged VPNv4 (making RRs non-scalable). You can configure an RR to only hold routes that have a defined set of RT communities. Also, a number of the RRs can be configured to service a differentset of VPNs(thereby achieving some scalability). A PE is then made to peer with all RRs that service the VRFs configured on the PE. When a new VRF is configured with an RT for which the PE does not already hold routes, the PE issues route refreshes to the RRs and retrieves the relevant VPN routes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 111 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring a VPN Routing and Forwarding Instance in BGPNote that this process can be more efficient if the PE-RR session supports extended community outbound route filter (ORF). Note Perform this task to configure a reflector to retain routes tagged with specific RTs. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. address-family vpnv4 unicast 4. retain route-target { all | route-policy route-policy-name } 5. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 Step 2 address-family vpnv4 unicast Enters VPN address family configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family vpvn4 unicast Step 3 Configures a reflector to retain routes tagged with particular RTs. Use the route-policy-name argument for the policy name that lists retain route-target { all | route-policy route-policy-name } Step 4 the extended communities that a path should have in order for the RR to retain that path. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# retain route-target route-policy rr_ext-comm The all keyword is not required, because thisisthe default behavior of a route reflector. Note Step 5 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 112 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring a VPN Routing and Forwarding Instance in BGPCommand or Action Purpose • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • end • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# commit ? Entering yessaves configuration changesto the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuring BGP as a PE-CE Protocol Perform this task to configure BGP on the PE and establish PE-CE communication using BGP. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 113 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring a VPN Routing and Forwarding Instance in BGPSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. vrf vrf-name 4. bgp router-id ip-address 5. label-allocation-mode per-ce 6. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast 7. network { ip-address / prefix-length | ip-address mask } 8. aggregate-address address / mask-length 9. exit 10. neighbor ip-address 11. remote-as as-number 12. password { clear | encrypted } password 13. ebgp-multihop [ ttl-value ] 14. Do one of the following: • address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast • address-family {ipv4 {unicast | labeled-unicast} | ipv6 unicast} 15. site-of-origin [ as-number : nn | ip-address : nn ] 16. as-override 17. allowas-in [ as-occurrence-number ] 18. route-policy route-policy-name in 19. route-policy route-policy-name out 20. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 Step 2 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 114 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring a VPN Routing and Forwarding Instance in BGPCommand or Action Purpose vrf vrf-name Enables BGP routing for a particular VRF on the PE router. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# vrf vrf_pe_2 Step 3 bgp router-id ip-address Configures a fixed router ID for a BGP-speaking router. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# bgp router-id 172.16.9.9 Step 4 Step 5 label-allocation-mode per-ce • Configures the per-CE label allocation mode to avoid an extra lookup on the PE router and conserve labelspace Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# label-allocation-mode per-ce (per-prefix is the default label allocation mode). In this mode, the PE router allocates one label for every immediate next-hop (in most cases, this would be a CE router). This label is directly mapped to the next hop, so there is no VRF route lookup performed during data forwarding. However, the number of labels allocated would be one for each CE rather than one for each VRF. Because BGP knows all the next hops, it assigns a label for each next hop (not for each PE-CE interface). When the outgoing interface is a multiaccess interface and the media access control (MAC) address of the neighbor is not known, Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) is triggered during packet forwarding. • The per-vrf keyword configures the same label to be used for all the routes advertised from a unique VRF. Specifies either an IPv4 or IPv6 address family unicast and enters address family configuration submode. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast Step 6 To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?). Originates a network prefix in the address family table in the VRF context. network { ip-address / prefix-length | ip-address mask } Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)# network Step 7 172.16.5.5/24 Configures aggregation in the VRF address family context to summarize routing information to reduce the state maintained aggregate-address address / mask-length Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)# aggregate-address 10.0.0.0/24 Step 8 in the core. This summarization introduces some inefficiency in the PE edge, because an additional lookup is required to determine the ultimate next hop for a packet.When configured, Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 115 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring a VPN Routing and Forwarding Instance in BGPCommand or Action Purpose a summary prefix is advertised instead of a set of component prefixes, which are more specifics of the aggregate. The PE advertises only one label for the aggregate. Because component prefixes could have different next hops to CEs, an additional lookup has to be performed during data forwarding. exit Exits the current configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)# exit Step 9 Configures a CE neighbor. The ip-address argument must be a private address. neighbor ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# neighbor 10.0.0.0 Step 10 remote-as as-number Configures the remote AS for the CE neighbor. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr)# remote-as 2 Step 11 Enable Message Digest 5 (MD5) authentication on a TCP connection between two BGP neighbors. password { clear | encrypted } password Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr)# password encrypted 234xyz Step 12 Configures the CE neighbor to accept and attempt BGP connections to external peers residing on networks that are not directly connected. ebgp-multihop [ ttl-value ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr)# ebgp-multihop 55 Step 13 Specifies either an IPv4 or IPv6 address family unicast and enters address family configuration submode. Step 14 Do one of the following: • address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?). • address-family {ipv4 {unicast | labeled-unicast} | ipv6 unicast} Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 116 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring a VPN Routing and Forwarding Instance in BGPCommand or Action Purpose Configures the site-of-origin (SoO) extended community. Routes that are learned from this CE neighbor are tagged with site-of-origin [ as-number : nn | ip-address : nn ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr-af)# site-of-origin 234:111 Step 15 the SoO extended community before being advertised to the rest of the PEs. SoO is frequently used to detect loops when as-override is configured on the PE router. If the prefix is looped back to the same site, the PE detects this and does not send the update to the CE. Configures AS override on the PE router. This causes the PE router to replace the CE’s ASN with its own (PE) ASN. as-override Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr-af)# as-override Step 16 This loss of information could lead to routing loops; to avoid loops caused by as-override, use it in conjunction with site-of-origin. Note Allows an AS path with the PE autonomous system number (ASN) a specified number of times. allowas-in [ as-occurrence-number ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr-af)# allowas-in 5 Step 17 Hub and spoke VPN networks need the looping back of routing information to the HUB PE through the HUB CE. When this happens, due to the presence of the PE ASN, the looped-back information is dropped by the HUB PE. To avoid this, use the allowas-in command to allow prefixes even if they have the PEs ASN up to the specified number of times. Specifies a routing policy for an inbound route. The policy can be used to filter routes or modify route attributes. route-policy route-policy-name in Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr-af)# route-policy pe_ce_in_policy in Step 18 Specifies a routing policy for an outbound route. The policy can be used to filter routes or modify route attributes. route-policy route-policy-name out Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr-af)# route-policy pe_ce_out_policy out Step 19 Step 20 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr-af)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr-af)# commit ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 117 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring a VPN Routing and Forwarding Instance in BGPCommand or Action Purpose ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Redistribution of IGPs to BGP Perform this task to configure redistribution of a protocol into the VRF address family. Even if Interior Gateway Protocols (IGPs) are used as the PE-CE protocol, the import logic happens through BGP. Therefore, all IGP routes have to be imported into the BGP VRF table. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 118 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring a VPN Routing and Forwarding Instance in BGPSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. vrf vrf-name 4. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast 5. Do one of the following: • redistribute connected [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • redistribute eigrp process-id [ match { external | internal }] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • redistribute isis process-id [ level { 1 | 1-inter-area | 2 }] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • redistribute ospf process-id [ match { external [ 1 | 2 ] | internal | nssa-external [ 1 | 2 ]}] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • redistribute ospfv3 process-id [ match { external [ 1 | 2 ] | internal | nssa-external [ 1 | 2 ]}] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • redistribute rip [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • redistribute static [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] 6. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 Step 2 vrf vrf-name Enables BGP routing for a particular VRF on the PE router. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# vrf vrf_a Step 3 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 119 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring a VPN Routing and Forwarding Instance in BGPCommand or Action Purpose Specifies either an IPv4 or IPv6 address family unicast and enters address family configuration submode. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast Step 4 To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?). Configures redistribution of a protocol into the VRF address family context. Step 5 Do one of the following: • redistribute connected [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] The redistribute command is used if BGP is not used between the PE-CE routers. If BGP is used between PE-CE routers, the • redistribute eigrp process-id [ match { external | internal }] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] IGP that is used has to be redistributed into BGP to establish VPN connectivity with other PE sites. Redistribution is also required for inter-table import and export. • redistribute isis process-id [ level { 1 | 1-inter-area | 2 }] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • redistribute ospf process-id [ match { external [ 1 | 2 ] | internal | nssa-external [ 1 | 2 ]}] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • redistribute ospfv3 process-id [ match { external [ 1 | 2 ] | internal | nssa-external [ 1 | 2 ]}] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • redistribute rip [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] • redistribute static [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)# redistribute eigrp 23 Step 6 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)# commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 120 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring a VPN Routing and Forwarding Instance in BGPCommand or Action Purpose ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuring Keychains for BGP Keychains provide secure authentication by supporting different MAC authentication algorithms and provide graceful key rollover. Perform this task to configure keychains for BGP. This task is optional. If a keychain is configured for a neighbor group or a session group, a neighbor using the group inherits the keychain. Values of commands configured specifically for a neighbor override inherited values. Note SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. neighbor ip-address 4. remote-as as-number 5. keychain name 6. Do one of the following: • end • commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 121 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Keychains for BGPDETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 Step 2 Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer. neighbor ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 172.168.40.24 Step 3 Creates a neighbor and assigns a remote autonomoussystem number to it. remote-as as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 2002 Step 4 keychain name Configures keychain-based authentication. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# keychain kych_a Step 5 Step 6 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# commit ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 122 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Keychains for BGPCommand or Action Purpose ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Disabling a BGP Neighbor Perform this task to administratively shut down a neighbor session without removing the configuration. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. neighbor ip-address 4. shutdown 5. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 127 Step 2 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 123 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Disabling a BGP NeighborCommand or Action Purpose Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer. neighbor ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 172.168.40.24 Step 3 shutdown Disables all active sessions for the specified neighbor. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# shutdown Step 4 Step 5 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Resetting Neighbors Using BGP Inbound Soft Reset Perform this task to trigger an inbound soft reset of the specified address families for the specified group or neighbors. The group is specified by the * , ip-address , as-number , or external keywords and arguments. Resetting neighbors is useful if you change the inbound policy for the neighbors or any other configuration that affects the sending or receiving of routing updates. If an inbound soft reset is triggered, BGP sends a REFRESH request to the neighbor if the neighbor has advertised the ROUTE_REFRESH capability. To determine whether the neighbor has advertised the ROUTE_REFRESH capability, use the show bgp neighbors command. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 124 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Resetting Neighbors Using BGP Inbound Soft ResetSUMMARY STEPS 1. show bgp neighbors 2. clear bgp { ipv4 { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | vpnv4 unicast | vrf { vrf-name | all } { ipv4 unicast | ipv6 unicast } { * | ip-address | as as-number | external } soft [ in [ prefix-filter ] | out ] DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Verifies that received route refresh capability from the neighbor is enabled. show bgp neighbors Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp neighbors Step 1 clear bgp { ipv4 { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } Soft resets a BGP neighbor. | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel Step 2 • The * keyword resets all BGP neighbors. } | vpnv4 unicast | vrf { vrf-name | all } { ipv4 unicast | ipv6 unicast } { * | ip-address | as as-number | external } soft [ in [ prefix-filter ] | out ] • The ip-address argument specifies the address of the neighbor to be reset. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# clear bgp ipv4 unicast 10.0.0.1 soft in • The as-number argument specifies that all neighbors that match the autonomous system number be reset. • The external keyword specifies that all external neighbors are reset. Resetting Neighbors Using BGP Outbound Soft Reset Perform this task to trigger an outbound soft reset of the specified address families for the specified group or neighbors. The group is specified by the * , ip-address , as-number , or external keywords and arguments. Resetting neighbors is useful if you change the outbound policy for the neighbors or any other configuration that affects the sending or receiving of routing updates. If an outbound soft reset is triggered, BGP resends all routes for the address family to the given neighbors. To determine whether the neighbor has advertised the ROUTE_REFRESH capability, use the show bgp neighbors command. SUMMARY STEPS 1. show bgp neighbors 2. clear bgp { ipv4 { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | vpnv4 unicast | vrf { vrf-name | all } { ipv4 unicast | ipv6 unicast } { * | ip-address | as as-number | external } soft [ in [ prefix-filter ] | ] Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 125 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Resetting Neighbors Using BGP Outbound Soft ResetDETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Verifies that received route refresh capability from the neighbor is enabled. show bgp neighbors Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp neighbors Step 1 clear bgp { ipv4 { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | Soft resets a BGP neighbor. ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel Step 2 • The * keyword resets all BGP neighbors. } | vpnv4 unicast | vrf { vrf-name | all } { ipv4 unicast | ipv6 unicast } { * | ip-address | as as-number | external } soft [ in [ prefix-filter ] | ] • The ip-address argument specifies the address of the neighbor to be reset. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# clear bgp ipv4 unicast 10.0.0.2 soft out • The as-number argument specifies that all neighbors that match the autonomous system number be reset. • The external keyword specifies that all external neighbors are reset. Resetting Neighbors Using BGP Hard Reset Perform this task to reset neighbors using a hard reset. A hard reset removes the TCP connection to the neighbor, removes all routes received from the neighbor from the BGP table, and then re-establishes the session with the neighbor. If the graceful keyword is specified, the routes from the neighbor are not removed from the BGP table immediately, but are marked as stale. After the session is re-established, any stale route that has not been received again from the neighbor is removed. SUMMARY STEPS 1. clear bgp { ipv4 { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | vpnv4 unicast | vrf { vrf-name | all } { ipv4 unicast | ipv6 unicast } | { * | ip-address | as as-number | external } [ graceful ] soft [ in [ prefix-filter ] | out ] DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose clear bgp { ipv4 { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | Clears a BGP neighbor. ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } Step 1 • The * keyword resets all BGP neighbors. | vpnv4 unicast | vrf { vrf-name | all } { ipv4 unicast | ipv6 unicast } | { * | ip-address | as as-number | external } [ graceful ] soft [ in [ prefix-filter ] | out ] • The ip-address argument specifies the address of the neighbor to be reset. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 126 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Resetting Neighbors Using BGP Hard ResetCommand or Action Purpose Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# clear bgp ipv4 unicast 10.0.0.3 graceful soft out • The as-number argument specifies that all neighbors that match the autonomous system number be reset. • The external keyword specifies that all external neighbors are reset. The graceful keyword specifies a graceful restart. Clearing Caches, Tables, and Databases Perform this task to remove all contents of a particular cache, table, or database. The clear bgp command resets the sessions of the specified group of neighbors (hard reset); it removes the TCP connection to the neighbor, removes all routes received from the neighbor from the BGP table, and then re-establishes the session with the neighbor. Clearing a cache, table, or database can become necessary when the contents of the particular structure have become, or are suspected to be, invalid. SUMMARY STEPS 1. clear bgp { ipv4 { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | vpnv4 unicast | vrf { vrf-name | all } { ipv4 unicast | ipv6 unicast } ip-address 2. clear bgp external 3. clear bgp * DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose clear bgp { ipv4 { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | ipv6 unicast Clears a specified neighbor. | all { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | vpnv4 unicast | vrf { vrf-name | all } { ipv4 unicast | ipv6 unicast } ip-address Step 1 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# clear bgp ipv4 172.20.1.1 clear bgp external Clears all external peers. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# clear bgp external Step 2 clear bgp * Clears all BGP neighbors. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# clear bgp * Step 3 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 127 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Clearing Caches, Tables, and DatabasesDisplaying System and Network Statistics Perform thistask to display specific statistics,such asthe contents of BGP routing tables, caches, and databases. Information provided can be used to determine resource usage and solve network problems. You can also display information about node reachability and discover the routing path that the packets of your device are taking through the network. SUMMARY STEPS 1. show bgp cidr-only 2. show bgp community community-list [ exact-match ] 3. show bgp regexp regular-expression 4. show bgp 5. show bgp neighbors ip-address [ advertised-routes | dampened-routes | flap-statistics | performance-statistics | received prefix-filter | routes ] 6. show bgp paths 7. show bgp neighbor-group group-name configuration 8. show bgp summary DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Displays routes with nonnatural network masks (classless interdomain routing [CIDR]) routes. show bgp cidr-only Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp cidr-only Step 1 show bgp community community-list [ Displays routes that match the specified BGP community. exact-match ] Step 2 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp community 1081:5 exact-match Displaysroutesthat match the specified autonomoussystem path regular expression. show bgp regexp regular-expression Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp regexp "^3 " Step 3 show bgp Displays entries in the BGP routing table. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp Step 4 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 128 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Displaying System and Network StatisticsCommand or Action Purpose Displays information about the BGP connection to the specified neighbor. show bgp neighbors ip-address [ advertised-routes | dampened-routes | Step 5 flap-statistics | performance-statistics | received prefix-filter | routes ] • The advertised-routes keyword displays all routes the router advertised to the neighbor. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp neighbors 10.0.101.1 • The dampened-routes keyword displays the dampened routes that are learned from the neighbor. • The flap-statistics keyword displays flap statistics of the routes learned from the neighbor. • The performance-statistics keyword displays performance statistics relating to work done by the BGP process for this neighbor. • The received prefix-filter keyword and argument display the received prefix list filter. • The routes keyword displays routes learned from the neighbor. show bgp paths Displays all BGP paths in the database. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp paths Step 6 Displays the effective configuration for a specified neighbor group, including any configuration inherited by this neighbor group. show bgp neighbor-group group-name configuration Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp neighbor-group group_1 configuration Step 7 show bgp summary Displays the status of all BGP connections. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp summary Step 8 Displaying BGP Process Information Perform this task to display specific BGP process information. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 129 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Displaying BGP Process InformationSUMMARY STEPS 1. show bgp process 2. show bgp ipv4 unicast summary 3. show bgp vpnv4 unicast summary 4. show bgp vrf ( vrf-name | all } 5. show bgp process detail 6. show bgp summary 7. show placement program bgp 8. show placement program brib DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Displays status and summary information for the BGP process. The output shows various global and address family-specific BGP show bgp process Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp process Step 1 configurations. A summary of the number of neighbors, update messages, and notification messages sent and received by the process is also displayed. Displays a summary of the neighbors for the IPv4 unicast address family. show bgp ipv4 unicast summary Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp ipv4 unicast summary Step 2 Displays a summary of the neighbors for the VPNv4 unicast address family. show bgp vpnv4 unicast summary Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp vpnv4 unicast summary Step 3 show bgp vrf ( vrf-name | all } Displays BGP VPN virtual routing and forwarding (VRF) information. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp vrf vrf_A Step 4 Displays detailed process information including the memory used by each of various internal structure types. show bgp process detail Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp processes detail Step 5 show bgp summary Displays the status of all BGP connections. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp summary Step 6 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 130 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Displaying BGP Process InformationCommand or Action Purpose Step 7 show placement program bgp Displays BGP program information. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show placement program bgp • If a program isshown as having ‘rejected locations’ (for example, locations where program cannot be placed), the locations in question can be viewed using the show placement program bgp command. • If a program has been placed but not started, the amount of elapsed time since the program was placed is displayed in the Waiting to start column. Step 8 show placement program brib Displays bRIB program information. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show placement program brib • If a program isshown as having ‘rejected locations’ (for example, locations where program cannot be placed), the locations in question can be viewed using the show placement program bgp command. • If a program has been placed but not started, the amount of elapsed time since the program was placed is displayed in the Waiting to start column. Monitoring BGP Update Groups This task displays information related to the processing of BGP update groups. SUMMARY STEPS 1. show bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | ipv6 { unicast | all } | all { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | vpnv4 unicast | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 unicast ] update-group [ neighbor ip-address | process-id.index [ summary | performance-statistics ]] DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose show bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | all | Displays information about BGP update groups. tunnel } | ipv6 { unicast | all } | all { unicast | Step 1 • The ip-address argument displays the update groups to which that neighbor belongs. multicast | all | tunnel } | vpnv4 unicast | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 unicast ] update-group [ neighbor ip-address | process-id.index [ summary | performance-statistics ]] • The process-id.index argument selects a particular update group to display and is specified as follows: process ID (dot) index. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 131 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Monitoring BGP Update GroupsCommand or Action Purpose Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp update-group 0.0 Process ID range is from 0 to 254. Index range is from 0 to 4294967295. • The summary keyword displays summary information for neighbors in a particular update group. • If no argument is specified, this command displays information for all update groups (for the specified address family). • The performance-statistics keyword displays performance statistics for an update group. Configuring BGP Nonstop Routing Perform this task to configure BGP Nonstop Routing (NSR). SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. nsr 4. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the BGP AS number, and enters the BGP configuration mode, for configuring BGP routing processes. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 Step 2 Step 3 nsr Activates BGP Nonstop routing. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 132 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring BGP Nonstop RoutingCommand or Action Purpose Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# nsr BGP supports 5000 NSR sessions. Note Step 4 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting (yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Installing Primary Backup Path for Prefix Independent Convergence (PIC) Perform the following tasks to install a backup path into the forwarding table and provide prefix independent convergence (PIC) in case of a PE-CE link failure: Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 133 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Installing Primary Backup Path for Prefix Independent Convergence (PIC)SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. Do one of the following • address-family {vpnv4 unicast | vpnv6 unicast} • vrf vrf-name {ipv4 unicast | ipv6 unicast} 4. additional-paths selection route-policy route-policy-name 5. Use one of these commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifiesthe autonomoussystem number and entersthe BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 100 Step 2 Specifies the address family or VRF address family and enters the address family or VRF address family configuration submode. Step 3 Do one of the following • address-family {vpnv4 unicast | vpnv6 unicast} • vrf vrf-name {ipv4 unicast | ipv6 unicast} Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family vpnv4 unicast Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 134 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Installing Primary Backup Path for Prefix Independent Convergence (PIC)Command or Action Purpose Configures additional paths selection mode for a prefix. Use the additional-pathsselection command with an appropriate route-policy to calculate backup paths and to enable Prefix Independent Convergence (PIC) functionality. Note additional-paths selection route-policy route-policy-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# additional-paths selection route-policy ap1 Step 4 The route-policy configuration is a pre-requisite for configuring the additional-pathsselection mode for a prefix . Thisis an example route-policy configuration to use with additional-selection command: route-policy ap1 set path-selection backup 1 install end-policy Step 5 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit ? Entering no exitsthe configuration session and returnsthe router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Retaining Allocated Local Label for Primary Path Perform the following tasks to retain the previously allocated local label for the primary path on the primary PE for some configurable time after reconvergence: Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 135 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Retaining Allocated Local Label for Primary PathSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. address-family { vpnv4 unicast | vpnv6 unicast } 4. retain local-label minutes 5. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 100 Step 2 Specifies the address family and enters the address family configuration submode. address-family { vpnv4 unicast | vpnv6 unicast } Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family vpnv4 unicast Step 3 Retains the previously allocated local label for the primary path on the primary PE for 10 minutes after reconvergence. retain local-label minutes Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# retain local-label 10 Step 4 Step 5 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting (yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# end Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 136 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Retaining Allocated Local Label for Primary PathCommand or Action Purpose ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exitsthe configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leavesthe router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session Configuring BGP Additional Paths Perform these tasks to configure BGP Additional Paths capability: SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. route-policy route-policy-name 3. if conditional-expression then action-statement else 4. pass endif 5. end-policy 6. router bgp as-number 7. address-family {ipv4 {unicast | multicast} | ipv6 {unicast | multicast | l2vpn vpls-vpws| vpnv4 unicast | vpnv6 unicast } 8. additional-paths receive 9. additional-paths send 10. additional-paths selection route-policy route-policy-name 11. Use one of these commands: • end • commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 137 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring BGP Additional PathsDETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Defines the route policy and enters route-policy configuration mode. route-policy route-policy-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router (config)#route-policy add_path_policy Step 2 if conditional-expression then action-statement else Decidesthe actions and dispositionsfor the given route. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router (config-rpl)#if community matches-any (*) then Step 3 set path-selection all advertise else pass endif Passesthe route for processing and endsthe ifstatement. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl-else)#pass RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl-else)#endif Step 4 Ends the route policy definition of the route policy and exits route-policy configuration mode. end-policy Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)#end-policy Step 5 Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)#router bgp 100 Step 6 Specifies the address family and enters address family configuration submode. address-family {ipv4 {unicast | multicast} | ipv6 {unicast | multicast | l2vpn vpls-vpws | vpnv4 unicast | vpnv6 unicast } Step 7 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)#address-family ipv4 unicast Configures receive capability of multiple paths for a prefix to the capable peers. additional-paths receive Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)#additional-paths receive Step 8 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 138 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring BGP Additional PathsCommand or Action Purpose Configuressend capability of multiple pathsfor a prefix to the capable peers . additional-paths send Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)#additional-paths send Step 9 Configures additional paths selection capability for a prefix. additional-paths selection route-policy route-policy-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)#additional-paths selection route-policy add_path_policy Step 10 Step 11 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit configuration session, and returnsthe router to EXEC mode. ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changesto the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuring iBGP Multipath Load Sharing Perform this task to configure the iBGP Multipath Load Sharing: Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 139 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring iBGP Multipath Load SharingSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. address-family {ipv4|ipv6} {unicast|multicast} 4. maximum-paths ibgp number 5. Use one of these commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 100 Step 2 Specifies either the IPv4 or IPv6 address family and enters address family configuration submode. address-family {ipv4|ipv6} {unicast|multicast} Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 multicast Step 3 Configures the maximum number of iBGP paths for load sharing. maximum-paths ibgp number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# maximum-paths ibgp 30 Step 4 Step 5 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exitsthe configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 140 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring iBGP Multipath Load SharingCommand or Action Purpose ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Originating Prefixes with AiGP Perform this task to configure origination of routes with the AiGP metric: Before You Begin Origination of routes with the accumulated interior gateway protocol (AiGP) metric is controlled by configuration. AiGP attributes are attached to redistributed routes that satisfy following conditions: • The protocol redistributing the route is enabled for AiGP. • The route is an interior gateway protocol (iGP) route redistributed into border gateway protocol (BGP). The value assigned to the AiGP attribute is the value of iGP next hop to the route or as set by a route-policy. • The route is a static route redistributed into BGP. The value assigned is the value of next hop to the route or as set by a route-policy. • The route is imported into BGP through network statement. The value assigned is the value of next hop to the route or as set by a route-policy. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 141 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Originating Prefixes with AiGPSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. route-policy aigp_policy 3. set aigp-metricigp-cost 4. exit 5. router bgp as-number 6. address-family {ipv4 | ipv6} unicast 7. redistribute ospf osp route-policy plcy_namemetric value 8. Use one of these commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Enters route-policy configuration mode and sets the route-policy route-policy aigp_policy Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# route-policy aip_policy Step 2 set aigp-metricigp-cost Sets the internal routing protocol cost as the aigp metric. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# set aigp-metric igp-cost Step 3 exit Exits route-policy configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# exit Step 4 Specifies the BGP AS number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 100 Step 5 Specifies either the IPv4 or IPv6 address family and enters address family configuration submode. address-family {ipv4 | ipv6} unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 unicast Step 6 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 142 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Originating Prefixes with AiGPCommand or Action Purpose redistribute ospf osp route-policy plcy_namemetric value Allows the redistribution of AiBGP metric into OSPF. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)#redistribute ospf osp route-policy aigp_policy metric 1 Step 7 Step 8 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exitsthe configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Enabling BGP Unequal Cost Recursive Load Balancing Perform this task to enable unequal cost recursive load balancing for external BGP (eBGP), interior BGP (iBGP), and eiBGP and to enable BGP to carry link bandwidth attribute of the demilitarized zone (DMZ) link. When the PE router includes the link bandwidth extended community in its updates to the remote PE through the Multiprotocol Interior BGP (MP-iBGP)session (either IPv4 or VPNv4), the remote PE automatically does load balancing if the maximum-paths command is enabled. Unequal cost recursive load balancing happens across maximum eight paths only. Note Enabling BGP unequal cost recursive load balancing feature is not supported on CPP based cards. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 143 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Enabling BGP Unequal Cost Recursive Load BalancingSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast 4. maximum-paths { ebgp | ibgp | eibgp } maximum [ unequal-cost ] 5. exit 6. neighbor ip-address 7. dmz-link-bandwidth 8. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 Step 2 Specifies either an IPv4 or IPv6 address family unicast and enters address family configuration submode. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast Step 3 To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?). Configures the maximum number of parallel routes that BGP installs in the routing table. maximum-paths { ebgp | ibgp | eibgp } maximum [ unequal-cost ] Step 4 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)# maximum-paths ebgp 3 Valid values for maximum-paths are eight, inclusive. Note • ebgp maximum : Consider only eBGP paths for multipath. • ibgp maximum [ unequal-cost ]: Consider load balancing between iBGP learned paths. • eibgp maximum : Consider both eBGP and iBGP learned pathsfor load balancing. eiBGP load balancing always does unequal-cost load balancing. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 144 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Enabling BGP Unequal Cost Recursive Load BalancingCommand or Action Purpose When eiBGP is applied, eBGP or iBGP load balancing cannot be configured; however, eBGP and iBGP load balancing can coexist. exit Exits the current configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)# exit Step 5 Configures a CE neighbor. The ip-address argument must be a private address. neighbor ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# neighbor 10.0.0.0 Step 6 Originates a demilitarized-zone (DMZ) link-bandwidth extended community for the link to an eBGP/iBGP neighbor. dmz-link-bandwidth Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr)# dmz-link-bandwidth Step 7 Step 8 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr)# commit ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 145 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Enabling BGP Unequal Cost Recursive Load BalancingConfiguring RPKI Cache Perform this task to configure Resource Public Key Infrastructure (RPKI) cache parameters. Configure the RPKI cache configuration in rpki-cache submode under the router-bgp submode. Use the rpki cache ip_addres command to enter into the rpki-cache submode SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. rpki cache {host-name | ip-address} 4. Use one of these commands: • transport ssh port port_number • transport tcp port port_number 5. (Optional) username user_name 6. (Optional) password 7. preference preference_value 8. purge-time time 9. Use one of these commands. • refresh-time time • refresh-time off 10. Use one these commands. • response-time time • response-time off 11. shutdown 12. Use one of these commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 146 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring RPKI CacheCommand or Action Purpose Specifies the BGP AS number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)#router bgp 100 Step 2 Entersrpki-cache submode and enables configuration of RPKI cache parameters. rpki cache {host-name | ip-address} Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)#rpki cache 10.2.3.4 Step 3 Step 4 Use one of these commands: Specifies a transport method for the RPKI cache. • ssh—Select ssh to connect to the RPKI cache using SSH. • transport ssh port port_number • transport tcp port port_number • tcp—Select tcp to connect to the RPKI cache using TCP (unencrypted). Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-rpki-cache)#transport ssh port 1 • port port_number—Specify a port number for the specified RPKI cache transport. Range for the port number is 1 to 65535 for both ssh and tcp. Or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-rpki-cache)#transport tcp port 2 You can set the transport to either tcp or ssh. Change of transport causes the cache session to flap. Note (Optional) Specifies a (SSH) username for the RPKI cache. username user_name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-rpki-cache)#username ssh_rpki_cache Step 5 (Optional) Specifies a (SSH) password for the RPKI cache. password Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-rpki-cache)#password ssh_rpki_pass Step 6 The “username” and “password” configurations only apply if the SSH method of transport is active. Note Specifies a preference value for the RPKI cache. Range for the preference value is 1 to 10. Setting a lower preference value is better. preference preference_value Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-rpki-cache)#preference 1 Step 7 Configures the time BGP waits to keep routes from a cache after the cache session drops. Set purge time purge-time time Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-rpki-cache)#purge-time 30 Step 8 in seconds. Range for the purge time is 30 to 360 seconds. Configures the time BGP waits in between sending periodic serial queries to the cache. Set refresh-time Step 9 Use one of these commands. • refresh-time time in seconds. Range for the refresh time is 15 to 3600 • refresh-time off seconds. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 147 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring RPKI CacheCommand or Action Purpose Configure the off option to specify not to send serial-queries periodically. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-rpki-cache)#refresh-time 20 Or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-rpki-cache)#refresh-time off Configures the time BGP waits for a response after sending a serial or reset query. Set response-time in Step 10 Use one these commands. • response-time time seconds. Range for the response time is 15 to 3600 • response-time off seconds. Configure the off option to wait indefinitely for a response. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-rpki-cache)#response-time 30 Or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-rpki-cache)#response-time off shutdown Configures shut down of the RPKI cache. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-rpki-cache)#shutdown Step 11 Step 12 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: ? Entering yessaves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit the configuration session, and returnsthe router to EXEC mode. ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 148 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring RPKI CacheCommand or Action Purpose configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuring RPKI Prefix Validation Perform this task to control the behavior of RPKI prefix validation processing. • SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. Use one of these commands. • rpki origin-as validation disable • rpki origin-as validation time {off | prefix_validation_time 4. origin-as validity signal ibgp 5. Use one of these commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the BGP AS number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)#router bgp 100 Step 2 Step 3 Use one of these commands. Sets the BGP origin-AS validation parameters. • rpki origin-as validation disable • disable—Use disable option to disable RPKI origin-AS validation. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 149 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring RPKI Prefix ValidationCommand or Action Purpose • time—Use time option to eitherset prefix validation time (in seconds) or to set off the automatic prefix validation after an RPKI update. • rpki origin-as validation time {off | prefix_validation_time Range for prefix validation time is 5 to 60 seconds. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)#rpki origin-as validation disable Configuring the disable option disables prefix validation for all eBGP paths and all eBGP paths are marked as "valid" by default. The rpki origin-as validation options can also configured in neighbor and neighbor address family submodes. The neighbor must be an ebgp neighbor. If configured at the neighbor or neighor address family level, prefix validation disable or time options will be valid only for that specific neighbor or neighbor address family. Note Or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)#rpki origin-as validation time 50 Or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)#rpki origin-as validation time off Step 4 origin-as validity signal ibgp Enablesthe iBGP signaling of validity state through an extended-community. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)#rpki origin-as validity signal ibgp This can also be configured in global address family submode. Step 5 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuring RPKI Bestpath Computation Perform this task to configure RPKI bestpath computation options. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 150 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring RPKI Bestpath ComputationSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. rpki bestpath use origin-as validity 4. rpki bestpath origin-as allow invalid 5. Use one of these commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the BGP AS number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)#router bgp 100 Step 2 Enables the validity states of BGP paths to affect the path's preference in the BGP bestpath process. This configuration can also be done in router BGP address family submode. rpki bestpath use origin-as validity Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)#rpki bestpath use origin-as validity Step 3 Allows all "invalid" paths to be considered for BGP bestpath computation. This configuration can also be done at global address family, neighbor, and neighbor address family submodes. Configuring rpki bestpath origin-as allow invalid in router BGP and address family submodes allow all "invalid" paths to be considered for BGP bestpath computation. By default, all such paths are not bestpath candidates. Configuring pki bestpath origin-as allow invalid in neighbor and neighbor addressfamily submodes allow all "invalid" paths from that specific neighbor or neighbor address family to be considered as bestpath candidates. The neighbor must be an eBGP neighbor. Note rpki bestpath origin-as allow invalid Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)#rpki bestpath origin-as allow invalid Step 4 This configuration takes effect only when the rpki bestpath use origin-as validity configuration is enabled. Step 5 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 151 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring RPKI Bestpath ComputationCommand or Action Purpose • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • end • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuration Examples for Implementing BGP This section provides the following configuration examples: Enabling BGP: Example The following shows how to enable BGP. prefix-set static 2020::/64, 2012::/64, 10.10.0.0/16, 10.2.0.0/24 end-set route-policy pass-all pass end-policy route-policy set_next_hop_agg_v4 set next-hop 10.0.0.1 end-policy route-policy set_next_hop_static_v4 if (destination in static) then set next-hop 10.1.0.1 else drop endif end-policy route-policy set_next_hop_agg_v6 set next-hop 2003::121 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 152 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuration Examples for Implementing BGPend-policy route-policy set_next_hop_static_v6 if (destination in static) then set next-hop 2011::121 else drop endif end-policy router bgp 65000 bgp fast-external-fallover disable bgp confederation peers 65001 65002 bgp confederation identifier 1 bgp router-id 1.1.1.1 address-family ipv4 unicast aggregate-address 10.2.0.0/24 route-policy set_next_hop_agg_v4 aggregate-address 10.3.0.0/24 redistribute static route-policy set_next_hop_static_v4 address-family ipv4 multicast aggregate-address 10.2.0.0/24 route-policy set_next_hop_agg_v4 aggregate-address 10.3.0.0/24 redistribute static route-policy set_next_hop_static_v4 address-family ipv6 unicast aggregate-address 2012::/64 route-policy set_next_hop_agg_v6 aggregate-address 2013::/64 redistribute static route-policy set_next_hop_static_v6 address-family ipv6 multicast aggregate-address 2012::/64 route-policy set_next_hop_agg_v6 aggregate-address 2013::/64 redistribute static route-policy set_next_hop_static_v6 neighbor 10.0.101.60 remote-as 65000 address-family ipv4 unicast address-family ipv4 multicast neighbor 10.0.101.61 remote-as 65000 address-family ipv4 unicast address-family ipv4 multicast neighbor 10.0.101.62 remote-as 3 address-family ipv4 unicast route-policy pass-all in route-policy pass-all out address-family ipv4 multicast route-policy pass-all in route-policy pass-all out neighbor 10.0.101.64 remote-as 5 update-source Loopback0 address-family ipv4 unicast route-policy pass-all in route-policy pass-all out address-family ipv4 multicast route-policy pass-all in route-policy pass-all out Displaying BGP Update Groups: Example The following is sample output from the show bgp update-group command run in EXEC mode: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp update-group Update group for IPv4 Unicast, index 0.1: Attributes: Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 153 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Displaying BGP Update Groups: ExampleOutbound Route map:rm Minimum advertisement interval:30 Messages formatted:2, replicated:2 Neighbors in this update group: 10.0.101.92 Update group for IPv4 Unicast, index 0.2: Attributes: Minimum advertisement interval:30 Messages formatted:2, replicated:2 Neighbors in this update group: 10.0.101.91 BGP Neighbor Configuration: Example The following example shows how BGP neighbors on an autonomous system are configured to share information. In the example, a BGP router is assigned to autonomous system 109, and two networks are listed as originating in the autonomous system. Then the addresses of three remote routers (and their autonomous systems) are listed. The router being configured shares information about networks 172 .16 .0.0 and 192.168 .7.0 with the neighbor routers. The first router listed is in a different autonomous system; the second neighbor and remote-as commandsspecify an internal neighbor (with the same autonomoussystem number) at address 172 .26 .234.2; and the third neighbor and remote-as commandsspecify a neighbor on a different autonomous system. route-policy pass-all pass end-policy router bgp 109 address-family ipv4 unicast network 172 .16 .0.0 255.255 .0.0 network 192.168 .7.0 255.255 .0.0 neighbor 172 .16 .200.1 remote-as 167 exit address-family ipv4 unicast route-policy pass-all in route-policy pass-out out neighbor 172 .26 .234.2 remote-as 109 exit address-family ipv4 unicast neighbor 172 .26 .64.19 remote-as 99 exit address-family ipv4 unicast route-policy pass-all in route-policy pass-all out Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 154 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP Neighbor Configuration: ExampleBGP Confederation: Example The following is a sample configuration thatshowsseveral peersin a confederation. The confederation consists of three internal autonomous systems with autonomous system numbers 6001, 6002, and 6003. To the BGP speakers outside the confederation, the confederation lookslike a normal autonomoussystem with autonomous system number 666 (specified using the bgp confederation identifier command). In a BGP speaker in autonomous system 6001, the bgp confederation peers command marks the peers from autonomous systems 6002 and 6003 as special eBGP peers. Hence, peers 171.16 .232.55 and 171.16 .232.56 get the local preference, next hop, and MED unmodified in the updates. The router at 171 .19 .69.1 is a normal eBGP speaker, and the updates received by it from this peer are just like a normal eBGP update from a peer in autonomous system 666. router bgp 6001 bgp confederation identifier 666 bgp confederation peers 6002 6003 exit address-family ipv4 unicast neighbor 171.16 .232.55 remote-as 6002 exit address-family ipv4 unicast neighbor 171.16 .232.56 remote-as 6003 exit address-family ipv4 unicast neighbor 171 .19 .69.1 remote-as 777 In a BGP speaker in autonomous system 6002, the peers from autonomous systems 6001 and 6003 are configured as special eBGP peers. Peer 171 .17 .70.1 is a normal iBGP peer, and peer 199.99.99.2 is a normal eBGP peer from autonomous system 700. router bgp 6002 bgp confederation identifier 666 bgp confederation peers 6001 6003 exit address-family ipv4 unicast neighbor 171 .17 .70.1 remote-as 6002 exit address-family ipv4 unicast neighbor 171.19 .232.57 remote-as 6001 exit address-family ipv4 unicast neighbor 171.19 .232.56 remote-as 6003 exit address-family ipv4 unicast neighbor 171 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 155 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP Confederation: Example.19 .99.2 remote-as 700 exit address-family ipv4 unicast route-policy pass-all in route-policy pass-all out In a BGP speaker in autonomous system 6003, the peers from autonomous systems 6001 and 6002 are configured as special eBGP peers. Peer 192 .168 .200.200 is a normal eBGP peer from autonomous system 701. router bgp 6003 bgp confederation identifier 666 bgp confederation peers 6001 6002 exit address-family ipv4 unicast neighbor 171.19 .232.57 remote-as 6001 exit address-family ipv4 unicast neighbor 171.19 .232.55 remote-as 6002 exit address-family ipv4 unicast neighbor 192 .168 .200.200 remote-as 701 exit address-family ipv4 unicast route-policy pass-all in route-policy pass-all out The following is a part of the configuration from the BGP speaker 192 .168 .200.205 from autonomoussystem 701 in the same example. Neighbor 171.16 .232.56 is configured as a normal eBGP speaker from autonomous system 666. The internal division of the autonomous system into multiple autonomous systems is not known to the peers external to the confederation. router bgp 701 address-family ipv4 unicast neighbor 172 .16 .232.56 remote-as 666 exit address-family ipv4 unicast route-policy pass-all in route-policy pass-all out exit address-family ipv4 unicast neighbor 192 .168 .200.205 remote-as 701 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 156 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP Confederation: ExampleBGP Route Reflector: Example The following example shows how to use an address family to configure internal BGP peer 10.1.1.1 as a route reflector client for both unicast and multicast prefixes: router bgp 140 address-family ipv4 unicast neighbor 10.1.1.1 remote-as 140 address-family ipv4 unicast route-reflector-client exit address-family ipv4 multicast route-reflector-client BGP Nonstop Routing Configuration: Example The following example shows how to enable BGP NSR: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# nsr RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# end The following example shows how to disable BGP NSR: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# no nsr RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# end Primary Backup Path Installation: Example The following example shows how to enable installation of primary backup path: router bgp 120 address-family ipv4 unicast additional-paths receive additional-paths send additional-paths selection route-policy bgp_add_path ! ! end Allocated Local Label Retention: Example The following example shows how to retain the previously allocated local label for the primary path on the primary PE for 10 minutes after reconvergence: router bgp 100 address-family l2vpn vpls-vpws retain local-label 10 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 157 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP Route Reflector: Exampleend iBGP Multipath Loadsharing Configuration: Example The following is a sample configuration where 30 paths are used for loadsharing: router bgp 100 address-family ipv4 multicast maximum-paths ibgp 30 ! ! end Configuring BGP Additional Paths: Example This is a sample configuration for enabling BGP Additional Paths send, receive, and selcetion capabilities: route-policy add_path_policy if community matches-any (*) then set path-selection all advertise else pass endif end-policy ! router bgp 100 address-family ipv4 unicast additional-paths receive additional-paths send additional-paths selection route-policy add_path_policy ! ! end Originating Prefixes With AiGP: Example The following is a sample configuration for originating prefixes with the AiGP metric attribute: route-policy aigp-policy set aigp-metric 4 set aigp-metric igp-cost end-policy ! router bgp 100 address-family ipv4 unicast network 10.2.3.4/24 route-policy aigp-policy redistribute ospf osp1 metric 4 route-policy aigp-policy ! ! end Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 158 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router iBGP Multipath Loadsharing Configuration: ExampleBGP Unequal Cost Recursive Load Balancing: Example This is a sample configuration for unequal cost recursive load balancing: interface Loopback0 ipv4 address 20.20.20.20 255.255.255.255 ! interface MgmtEth0/RSP0/CPU0/0 ipv4 address 8.43.0.10 255.255.255.0 ! interface TenGigE0/3/0/0 bandwidth 8000000 ipv4 address 11.11.11.11 255.255.255.0 ipv6 address 11:11:0:1::11/64 ! interface TenGigE0/3/0/1 bandwidth 7000000 ipv4 address 11.11.12.11 255.255.255.0 ipv6 address 11:11:0:2::11/64 ! interface TenGigE0/3/0/2 bandwidth 6000000 ipv4 address 11.11.13.11 255.255.255.0 ipv6 address 11:11:0:3::11/64 ! interface TenGigE0/3/0/3 bandwidth 5000000 ipv4 address 11.11.14.11 255.255.255.0 ipv6 address 11:11:0:4::11/64 ! interface TenGigE0/3/0/4 bandwidth 4000000 ipv4 address 11.11.15.11 255.255.255.0 ipv6 address 11:11:0:5::11/64 ! interface TenGigE0/3/0/5 bandwidth 3000000 ipv4 address 11.11.16.11 255.255.255.0 ipv6 address 11:11:0:6::11/64 ! interface TenGigE0/3/0/6 bandwidth 2000000 ipv4 address 11.11.17.11 255.255.255.0 ipv6 address 11:11:0:7::11/64 ! interface TenGigE0/3/0/7 bandwidth 1000000 ipv4 address 11.11.18.11 255.255.255.0 ipv6 address 11:11:0:8::11/64 ! interface TenGigE0/4/0/0 description CONNECTED TO IXIA 1/3 transceiver permit pid all ! interface TenGigE0/4/0/2 ipv4 address 9.9.9.9 255.255.0.0 ipv6 address 9:9::9/64 ipv6 enable ! route-policy pass-all pass end-policy ! router static address-family ipv4 unicast 202.153.144.0/24 8.43.0.1 ! ! Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 159 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP Unequal Cost Recursive Load Balancing: Examplerouter bgp 100 bgp router-id 20.20.20.20 address-family ipv4 unicast maximum-paths eibgp 8 redistribute connected ! neighbor 11.11.11.12 remote-as 200 dmz-link-bandwidth address-family ipv4 unicast route-policy pass-all in route-policy pass-all out ! ! neighbor 11.11.12.12 remote-as 200 dmz-link-bandwidth address-family ipv4 unicast route-policy pass-all in route-policy pass-all out ! ! neighbor 11.11.13.12 remote-as 200 dmz-link-bandwidth address-family ipv4 unicast route-policy pass-all in route-policy pass-all out ! ! neighbor 11.11.14.12 remote-as 200 dmz-link-bandwidth address-family ipv4 unicast route-policy pass-all in route-policy pass-all out ! ! neighbor 11.11.15.12 remote-as 200 dmz-link-bandwidth address-family ipv4 unicast route-policy pass-all in route-policy pass-all out ! ! neighbor 11.11.16.12 remote-as 200 dmz-link-bandwidth address-family ipv4 unicast route-policy pass-all in route-policy pass-all out ! ! neighbor 11.11.17.12 remote-as 200 dmz-link-bandwidth address-family ipv4 unicast route-policy pass-all in route-policy pass-all out ! ! neighbor 11.11.18.12 remote-as 200 dmz-link-bandwidth address-family ipv4 unicast route-policy pass-all in route-policy pass-all out ! ! ! end Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 160 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router BGP Unequal Cost Recursive Load Balancing: ExampleWhere to Go Next For detailed information about BGP commands, see Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Command Reference Additional References The following sections provide references related to implementing BGP. Related Documents Related Topic Document Title Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Command Reference BGP commands: complete command syntax, command modes, command history, defaults, usage guidelines, and examples Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router IP Addresses and Services Command Reference Cisco Express Forwarding (CEF) commands: complete command syntax, command modes, command history, defaults, usage guidelines, and examples Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide MPLS VPN configuration information. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Interface and Hardware Component Configuration Guide and Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Interface and Hardware Component Command Reference Bidirectional Forwarding Detection (BFD) Configuring AAA Services on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Security Configuration Guide Task ID information. Standards Standards Title Authentication for TCP-based Routing and Management Protocols, by R. Bonica, B. Weis, S. Viswanathan, A. Lange, O. Wheeler draft-bonica-tcp-auth-05.txt A Border Gateway Protocol 4, by Y. Rekhter, T.Li, S. Hares draft-ietf-idr-bgp4-26.txt Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 161 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Where to Go NextStandards Title Definitions of Managed Objects for the Fourth Version of Border Gateway Protocol (BGP-4), by J. Hass and S. Hares draft-ietf-idr-bgp4-mib-15.txt Subcodes for BGP Cease Notification Message, by Enke Chen, V. Gillet draft-ietf-idr-cease-subcode-05.txt Avoid BGP Best Path Transitions from One External to Another, by Enke Chen, Srihari Sangli draft-ietf-idr-avoid-transition-00.txt BGP Support for Four-octet AS Number Space, by Quaizar Vohra, Enke Chen draft-ietf-idr-as4bytes-12.txt MIBs MIBs MIBs Link To locate and download MIBs using Cisco IOS XR software, use the Cisco MIB Locator found at the following URL and choose a platform under the Cisco Access Products menu: http://cisco.com/public/ sw-center/netmgmt/cmtk/mibs.shtml — RFCs RFCs Title RFC 1700 Assigned Numbers RFC 1997 BGP Communities Attribute Protection of BGP Sessions via the TCP MD5 Signature Option RFC 2385 RFC 2439 BGP Route Flap Damping Use of BGP-4 Multiprotocol Extensions for IPv6 Inter-Domain Routing RFC 2545 BGP Route Reflection - An Alternative to Full Mesh IBGP RFC 2796 RFC 2858 Multiprotocol Extensions for BGP-4 RFC 2918 Route Refresh Capability for BGP-4 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 162 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional ReferencesRFCs Title RFC 3065 Autonomous System Confederations for BGP RFC 3392 Capabilities Advertisement with BGP-4 RFC 4271 A Border Gateway Protocol 4 (BGP-4) RFC 4364 BGP/MPLS IP Virtual Private Networks (VPNs) RFC 4724 Graceful Restart Mechanism for BGP Technical Assistance Description Link The Cisco Technical Support website contains http://www.cisco.com/techsupport thousands of pages of searchable technical content, including links to products, technologies, solutions, technical tips, and tools. Registered Cisco.com users can log in from this page to access even more content. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 163 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional References Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 164 OL-26048-02 Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional ReferencesC H A P T E R 2 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router The Enhanced Interior Gateway Routing Protocol (EIGRP) is an enhanced version of IGRP developed by Cisco. This module describes the concepts and tasks you need to implement basic EIGRP configuration using Cisco IOS XR software. EIGRP uses distance vector routing technology, which specifies that a router need not know all the router and link relationships for the entire network. Each router advertises destinations with a corresponding distance and upon receiving routes, adjuststhe distance and propagatesthe information to neighboring routes. For EIGRP configuration information related to the following features, see the Related Documents, on page 203 section of this module. • Multiprotocol Label Switching (MPLS) Layer 3 Virtual Private Network (VPN) • Site of Origin (SoO) Support For more information about EIGRP on the Cisco IOS XR software and complete descriptions of the EIGRP commandslisted in this module,see the Related Documents, on page 203 section of this module. To locate documentation for other commands that might appear while executing a configuration task, search online in the Cisco IOS XR software master command index. Note Feature History for Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Software Release Modification Release 3.7.2 This feature was introduced. Release 3.9.0 No modification. • Prerequisites for Implementing EIGRP, page 166 • Restrictions for Implementing EIGRP , page 166 • Information About Implementing EIGRP, page 166 • How to Implement EIGRP , page 177 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 165• Configuration Examples for Implementing EIGRP , page 201 • Additional References, page 203 Prerequisites for Implementing EIGRP You must be in a user group associated with a task group that includes the proper task IDs. The command reference guides include the task IDs required for each command. If you suspect user group assignment is preventing you from using a command, contact your AAA administrator for assistance. Restrictions for Implementing EIGRP The following restrictions are employed when running EIGRP on this version of Cisco IOS XR software: • Only one instance of an EIGRP process is supported. • Bidirectional Forwarding Detection (BFD) feature and the Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) MIB are not supported. • Interface static routes are not automatically redistributed into EIGRP, because there are no network commands. • Metric configuration (either through the default-metric command or a route policy) is required for redistribution of connected and static routes. • Auto summary is disabled by default. • Stub leak maps are not supported. Information About Implementing EIGRP To implement EIGRP, you need to understand the following concepts: EIGRP Functional Overview Enhanced Interior Gateway Routing Protocol (EIGRP) is an interior gateway protocolsuited for many different topologies and media. EIGRP scales well and provides extremely quick convergence times with minimal network traffic. EIGRP has very low usage of network resources during normal operation. Only hello packets are transmitted on a stable network. When a change in topology occurs, only the routing table changes are propagated and not the entire routing table. Propagation reduces the amount of load the routing protocol itself places on the network. EIGRP also provides rapid convergence times for changes in the network topology. The distance information in EIGRP isrepresented as a composite of available bandwidth, delay, load utilization, and link reliability with improved convergence properties and operating efficiency. The fine-tuning of link characteristics achieves optimal paths. The convergence technology that EIGRP usesis based on research conducted at SRI International and employs an algorithm referred to as the Diffusing Update Algorithm (DUAL). This algorithm guarantees loop-free Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 166 OL-26048-02 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Prerequisites for Implementing EIGRPoperation at every instant throughout a route computation and allows all devicesinvolved in a topology change to synchronize at the same time. Routers that are not affected by topology changes are not involved in recomputations. The convergence time with DUAL rivals that of any other existing routing protocol. EIGRP Features EIGRP offers the following features: • Fast convergence—The DUAL algorithm allows routing information to converge as quickly as any currently available routing protocol. • Partial updates—EIGRP sends incremental updates when the state of a destination changes, instead of sending the entire contents of the routing table. Thisfeature minimizesthe bandwidth required for EIGRP packets. • Neighbor discovery mechanism—This is a simple hello mechanism used to learn about neighboring routers. It is protocol independent. • Variable-length subnet masks (VLSMs). • Arbitrary route summarization. • Scaling—EIGRP scales to large networks. The following key features are supported in the Cisco IOS XR implementation: • Provider Edge (PE)-Customer Edge (CE) protocolsupport with Site of Origin (SoO) and Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) cost community support. • PECE protocol support for MPLS. EIGRP Components EIGRP has the following four basic components: • Neighbor discovery or neighbor recovery • Reliable transport protocol • DUAL finite state machine • Protocol-dependent modules Neighbor discovery or neighbor recovery is the process that routers use to dynamically learn of other routers on their directly attached networks. Routers must also discover when their neighbors become unreachable or inoperative. Neighbor discovery or neighbor recovery is achieved with low overhead by periodically sending small hello packets. As long as hello packets are received, the Cisco IOS XR software can determine that a neighbor is alive and functioning. After this status is determined, the neighboring routers can exchange routing information. The reliable transport protocol isresponsible for guaranteed, ordered delivery of EIGRP packetsto all neighbors. It supports intermixed transmission of multicast and unicast packets. Some EIGRP packets must be sent reliably and others need not be. For efficiency, reliability is provided only when necessary. For example, on a multiaccess network that has multicast capabilities (such as Ethernet) it is not necessary to send hello packets reliably to all neighbors individually. Therefore, EIGRP sends a single multicast hello with an indication in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 167 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router EIGRP Featuresthe packet informing the receivers that the packet need not be acknowledged. Other types of packets (such as updates) require acknowledgment, which is indicated in the packet. The reliable transport has a provision to send multicast packets quickly when unacknowledged packets are pending. This provision helps to ensure that convergence time remains low in the presence of various speed links. The DUAL finite state machine embodies the decision process for all route computations. It tracks all routes advertised by all neighbors. DUAL uses the distance information (known as a metric) to select efficient, loop-free paths. DUAL selectsroutesto be inserted into a routing table based on a calculation of the feasibility condition. A successor is a neighboring router used for packet forwarding that has a least-cost path to a destination that is guaranteed not to be part of a routing loop. When there are no feasible successors but there are neighbors advertising the destination, a recomputation must occur. This is the process whereby a new successor is determined. The amount of time required to recompute the route affects the convergence time. Recomputation is processor intensive; it is advantageous to avoid unneeded recomputation. When a topology change occurs, DUAL testsfor feasible successors. If there are feasible successors, it uses any it findsto avoid unnecessary recomputation. The protocol-dependent modules are responsible for network layer protocol-specific tasks. An example is the EIGRP module, which is responsible for sending and receiving EIGRP packets that are encapsulated in IP. It is also responsible for parsing EIGRP packets and informing DUAL of the new information received. EIGRP asks DUAL to make routing decisions, but the results are stored in the IP routing table. EIGRP is also responsible for redistributing routes learned by other IP routing protocols. EIGRP Configuration Grouping Cisco IOS XR software groups all EIGRP configuration under router EIGRP configuration mode, including interface configuration portions associated with EIGRP. To display EIGRP configuration in its entirety, use the show running-config router eigrp command. The command output displays the running configuration for the configured EIGRP instance, including the interface assignments and interface attributes. EIGRP Configuration Modes The following examples show how to enter each of the configuration modes. From a mode, you can enter the ? command to display the commands available in that mode. Router Configuration Mode The following example shows how to enter router configuration mode: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configuration RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router eigrp 100 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp)# VRF Configuration Mode The following example shows how to enter VRF configuration mode: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configuration RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router eigrp 100 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp)# vrf customer1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf)# Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 168 OL-26048-02 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router EIGRP Configuration GroupingIPv4 Address Family Configuration Mode The following example shows how to enter IPv4 address family configuration mode: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configuration RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router eigrp 100 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp)# address-family ipv4 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af)# IPv4 VRF Address Family Configuration Mode The following example shows how to enter IPv4 VRF address family configuration mode: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configuration RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router eigrp 100 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp)# vrf customer1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf)# address-family ipv4 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf-af)# Interface Configuration Mode The following example shows how to enter interface configuration mode in IPv4 addressfamily configuration mode: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configuration RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router eigrp 100 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp)# address-family ipv4 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af)# interface GigabitEthernet 0/3/0/0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af-if)# EIGRP Interfaces EIGRP interfaces can be configured as either of the following types: • Active—Advertises connected prefixes and forms adjacencies. This is the default type for interfaces. • Passive—Advertises connected prefixes but does not form adjacencies. The passive command is used to configure interfaces as passive. Passive interfaces should be used sparingly for important prefixes, such as loopback addresses, that need to be injected into the EIGRP domain. If many connected prefixes need to be advertised, then the redistribution of connected routes with the appropriate policy should be used instead. Redistribution for an EIGRP Process Routes from other protocols can be redistributed into EIGRP. A route policy can be configured along with the redistribute command. A metric is required, configured either through the default-metric command or under the route policy configured with the redistribute command to import routes into EIGRP. A route policy allows the filtering of routes based on attributes such as the destination, origination protocol, route type, route tag, and so on. When redistribution is configured under a VRF, EIGRP retrieves extended communities attached to the route in the routing information base (RIB). The SoO is used to filter out routing loops in the presence of MPSL VPN backdoor links. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 169 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router EIGRP InterfacesMetric Weights for EIGRP Routing EIGRP uses the minimum bandwidth on the path to a destination network and the total delay to compute routing metrics. You can use the metric weights command to adjust the default behavior of EIGRP routing and metric computations. For example, this adjustment allows you to tune system behavior to allow forsatellite transmission. EIGRP metric defaults have been carefully selected to provide optimal performance in most networks. By default, the EIGRP composite metric is a 32-bit quantity that is a sum of the segment delays and lowest segment bandwidth (scaled and inverted) for a given route. For a network of homogeneous media, this metric reduces to a hop count. For a network of mixed media (FDDI, Ethernet, and serial lines running from 9600 bits per second to T1 rates), the route with the lowest metric reflects the most desirable path to a destination. Mismatched K Values Mismatched K values (EIGRP metrics) can prevent neighbor relationships from being established and can negatively impact network convergence. The following example explains this behavior between two EIGRP peers (ROUTER-A and ROUTER-B). The following error message is displayed in the console of ROUTER-B because the K values are mismatched: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:Mar 13 08:19:55:eigrp[163]:%ROUTING-EIGRP-5-NBRCHANGE:IP-EIGRP(0) 1:Neighbor 11.0.0.20 (GigabitEthernet0/6/0/0) is down: K-value mismatch Two scenarios occur in which this error message can be displayed: • The two routers are connected on the same link and configured to establish a neighbor relationship. However, each router is configured with different K values. The following configuration is applied to ROUTER-A. The K values are changed with the metric weights command. A value of 2 is entered for the k1 argument to adjust the bandwidth calculation. The value of 1 is entered for the k3 argument to adjust the delay calculation. hostname ROUTER-A! interface GigabitEthernet0/6/0/0 ipv4 address 10.1.1.1 255.255.255.0 router eigrp 100 metric weights 0 2 0 1 0 0 interface GigabitEthernet0/6/0/0 The following configuration is applied to ROUTER-B. However, the metric weights command is not applied and the default K values are used. The default K values are 1, 0, 1, 0, and 0. hostname ROUTER-B! interface GigabitEthernet0/6/0/1 ipv4 address 10.1.1.2 255.255.255.0 router eigrp 100 interface GigabitEthernet0/6/0/1 The bandwidth calculation is set to 2 on ROUTER-A and set to 1 (by default) on ROUTER-B. This configuration prevents these peers from forming a neighbor relationship. • The K-value mismatch error message can also be displayed if one of the two peers has transmitted a “goodbye” message and the receiving router does not support this message. In this case, the receiving router interprets this message as a K-value mismatch. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 170 OL-26048-02 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Metric Weights for EIGRP RoutingGoodbye Message The goodbye message is a feature designed to improve EIGRP network convergence. The goodbye message is broadcast when an EIGRP routing process is shut down to inform adjacent peers about the impending topology change. This feature allows supporting EIGRP peers to synchronize and recalculate neighbor relationships more efficiently than would occur if the peers discovered the topology change after the hold timer expired. The following message is displayed by routers that run a supported release when a goodbye message is received: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:Mar 13 09:13:17:eigrp[163]:%ROUTING-EIGRP-5-NBRCHANGE: IP-EIGRP(0) 1: Neighbor 10.0.0.20 (GigabitEthernet0/6/0/0) is down: Interface Goodbye received A Cisco router that runs a software release that does not support the goodbye message can misinterpret the message as a K-value mismatch and display the following message: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:Mar 13 09:13:17:eigrp[163]:%ROUTING-EIGRP-5-NBRCHANGE: IP-EIGRP(0) 1: Neighbor 10.0.0.20 (GigabitEthernet0/6/0/0) is down: K-value mismatch The receipt of a goodbye message by a nonsupporting peer does not disrupt normal network operation. The nonsupporting peer terminates the session when the hold timer expires. The sending and receiving routers reconverge normally after the sender reloads. Note Percentage of Link Bandwidth Used for EIGRP Packets By default, EIGRP packets consume a maximum of 50 percent of the link bandwidth, as configured with the bandwidth interface configuration command. You might want to change that value if a different level of link utilization is required or if the configured bandwidth does not match the actual link bandwidth (it may have been configured to influence route metric calculations). Floating Summary Routes for an EIGRP Process You can also use a floating summary route when configuring the summary-address command. The floating summary route is created by applying a default route and administrative distance at the interface level. The following scenario illustrates the behavior of this enhancement. Figure 9: Floating Summary Route Is Applied to Router-B, on page 172 shows a network with three routers, Router-A, Router-B, and Router-C. Router-A learns a default route from elsewhere in the network and then advertises this route to Router-B. Router-B is configured so that only a default summary route is advertised to Router-C. The defaultsummary route is applied to interface 0/1 on Router-B with the following configuration: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router eigrp 100 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp)# address-family ipv4 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af)# interface GigabitEthernet 0/3/0/0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af-if)# summary-address 100.0.0.0 0.0.0.0 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 171 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Percentage of Link Bandwidth Used for EIGRP PacketsFigure 9: Floating Summary Route Is Applied to Router-B The configuration of the default summary route on Router-B sends a 0.0.0.0/0 summary route to Router-C and blocks all other routes, including the 10.1.1.0/24 route, from being advertised to Router-C. However, this configuration also generates a local discard route on Router-B, a route for 0.0.0.0/0 to the null 0 interface with an administrative distance of 5. When this route is created, it overrides the EIGRP learned default route. Router-B is no longer able to reach destinations that it would normally reach through the 0.0.0.0.0/0 route. This problem is resolved by applying a floating summary route to the interface on Router-B that connects to Router-C. The floating summary route is applied by relating an administrative distance to the default summary route on the interface of Router-B with the following statement: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# summary-address 100 0.0.0.0 0.0.0.0 250 The administrative distance of 250, applied in the above statement, is now assigned to the discard route generated on Router-B. The 0.0.0.0/0, from Router-A, is learned through EIGRP and installed in the local routing table. Routing to Router-C is restored. If Router-A loses the connection to Router-B, Router-B continues to advertise a default route to Router-C, which allows traffic to continue to reach destinations attached to Router-B. However, traffic destined for networks to Router-A or behind Router-A is dropped when the traffic reaches Router-B. Figure 10: Floating Summary Route Applied for Dual-Homed Remotes, on page 173 shows a network with two connectionsfrom the core: Router-A and Router-D. Both routers have floating summary routes configured on the interfaces connected to Router-C. If the connection between Router-E and Router-C fails, the network Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 172 OL-26048-02 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Floating Summary Routes for an EIGRP Processcontinues to operate normally. All traffic flows from Router-C through Router-B to the hosts attached to Router-A and Router-D. Figure 10: Floating Summary Route Applied for Dual-Homed Remotes However, if the link between Router-D and Router-E fails, the network may dump traffic into a black hole because Router-E continues to advertise the default route (0.0.0.0/0) to Router-C, as long as at least one link (other than the link to Router-C) to Router-E is still active. In this scenario, Router-C still forwards traffic to Router-E, but Router-E drops the traffic creating the black hole. To avoid this problem, you should configure the summary address with an administrative distance on only single-homed remote routers or areas in which only one exit point exists between the segments of the network. If two or more exit points exist (from one segment of the network to another), configuring the floating default route can cause a black hole to form. Split Horizon for an EIGRP Process Split horizon controls the sending of EIGRP update and query packets. When split horizon is enabled on an interface, update and query packets are not sent for destinations for which this interface is the next hop. Controlling update and query packets in this manner reduces the possibility of routing loops. By default, split horizon is enabled on all interfaces. Split horizon blocks route information from being advertised by a router on any interface from which that information originated. This behavior usually optimizes communications among multiple routing devices, particularly when links are broken. However, with nonbroadcast networks (such as Frame Relay and SMDS), situations can arise for which this behavior islessthan ideal. For these situations, including networksin which you have EIGRP configured, you may want to disable split horizon. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 173 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Split Horizon for an EIGRP ProcessAdjustment of Hello Interval and Hold Time for an EIGRP Process You can adjust the interval between hello packets and the hold time. Routing devices periodically send hello packets to each other to dynamically learn of other routers on their directly attached networks. This information is used to discover neighbors and learn when neighbors become unreachable or inoperative. By default, hello packets are sent every 5 seconds. You can configure the hold time on a specified interface for a particular EIGRP routing process designated by the autonomous system number. The hold time is advertised in hello packets and indicates to neighbors the length of time they should consider the sender valid. The default hold time is three times the hello interval, or 15 seconds. Stub Routing for an EIGRP Process The EIGRP Stub Routing feature improves network stability, reduces resource usage, and simplifies stub router configuration. Stub routing is commonly used in a hub-and-spoke network topology. In a hub-and-spoke network, one or more end (stub) networks are connected to a remote router (the spoke) that is connected to one or more distribution routers (the hub). The remote router is adjacent only to one or more distribution routers. The only route for IP traffic to follow into the remote router is through a distribution router. This type of configuration is commonly used in WAN topologies in which the distribution router is directly connected to a WAN. The distribution router can be connected to many more remote routers. Often, the distribution router is connected to 100 or more remote routers. In a hub-and-spoke topology, the remote router must forward all nonlocal traffic to a distribution router, so it becomes unnecessary for the remote router to hold a complete routing table. Generally, the distribution router need not send anything more than a default route to the remote router. When using the EIGRP Stub Routing feature, you need to configure the distribution and remote routers to use EIGRP and configure only the remote router as a stub. Only specified routes are propagated from the remote (stub) router. The stub router responds to all queries for summaries, connected routes, redistributed static routes, external routes, and internal routes with the message “inaccessible.” A router that is configured as a stub sends a special peer information packet to all neighboring routers to report its status as a stub router. Any neighbor that receives a packet informing it of the stub status does not query the stub router for any routes, and a router that has a stub peer does not query that peer. The stub router depends on the distribution router to send the proper updates to all peers. This figure shows a simple hub-and-spoke configuration. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 174 OL-26048-02 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Adjustment of Hello Interval and Hold Time for an EIGRP ProcessFigure 11: Simple Hub-and-Spoke Network The stub routing feature by itself does not prevent routes from being advertised to the remote router. In the example in Figure 11: Simple Hub-and-Spoke Network, on page 174 , the remote router can access the corporate network and the Internet through the distribution router only. Having a full route table on the remote router, in this example, would serve no functional purpose because the path to the corporate network and the Internet would always be through the distribution router. The larger route table would only reduce the amount of memory required by the remote router. Bandwidth and memory can be conserved by summarizing and filtering routes in the distribution router. The remote router need not receive routes that have been learned from other networks because the remote router must send all nonlocal traffic, regardless of destination, to the distribution router. If a true stub network is desired, the distribution router should be configured to send only a default route to the remote router. The EIGRP Stub Routing feature does not automatically enable summarization on the distribution router. In most cases, the network administrator needs to configure summarization on the distribution routers. Without the stub feature, even after the routes that are sent from the distribution router to the remote router have been filtered orsummarized, a problem might occur. If a route islostsomewhere in the corporate network, EIGRP could send a query to the distribution router, which in turn sends a query to the remote router even if routes are being summarized. If there is a problem communicating over the WAN link between the distribution router and the remote router, an EIGRP stuck in active (SIA) condition could occur and cause instability elsewhere in the network. The EIGRP Stub Routing feature allows a network administrator to prevent queries from being sent to the remote router. Route Policy Options for an EIGRP Process Route policies comprise series of statements and expressions that are bracketed with the route-policy and end-policy keywords. Rather than a collection of individual commands (one for each line), the statements within a route policy have context relative to each other. Thus, instead of each line being an individual command, each policy orset is an independent configuration object that can be used, entered, and manipulated as a unit. Each line of a policy configuration is a logical subunit. At least one new line must follow the then , else , and end-policy keywords. A new line must also follow the closing parenthesis of a parameter list and the name string in a reference to an AS path set, community set, extended community set, or prefix set (in the EIGRP context). At least one new line must precede the definition of a route policy or prefix set. A new line must appear at the end of a logical unit of policy expression and may not appear anywhere else. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 175 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Route Policy Options for an EIGRP ProcessThis is the command to set the EIGRP metric in a route policy: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# set eigrp-metric bandwidth delay reliability loading mtu This is the command to provide EIGRP offset list functionality in a route policy: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# add eigrp-metric bandwidth delay reliability loading mtu A route policy can be used in EIGRP only if all the statements are applicable to the particular EIGRP attach point. The following commands accept a route policy: • default-information allowed—Match statements are allowed for destination. No set statements are allowed. • route-policy—Match statements are allowed for destination, next hop, and tag. Set statements are allowed for eigrp-metric and tag. • redistribute—Match statements are allowed for destination, next hop,source-protocol, tag and route-type. Set statements are allowed for eigrp-metric and tag. The range for setting a tag is 0 to 255 for internal routes and 0 to 4294967295 for external routes. EIGRP Layer 3 VPN PE-CE Site-of-Origin The EIGRP MPLS and IP VPN PE-CE Site-of-Origin (SoO) feature introduces the capability to filter Multiprotocol Label Switching (MPLS) and IP Virtual Private Network (VPN) traffic on a per-site basis for EIGRP networks. SoO filtering is configured at the interface level and is used to manage MPLS and IP VPN traffic and to prevent transient routing loops from occurring in complex and mixed network topologies. Router Interoperation with the Site-of-Origin Extended Community The configuration of the SoO extended community allows routers that support this feature to identify the site from which each route originated. When this feature is enabled, the EIGRP routing process on the PE or CE router checks each received route for the SoO extended community and filters based on the following conditions: • A received route from BGP or a CE router contains a SoO value that matches the SoO value on the receiving interface: ? If a route is received with an associated SoO value that matches the SoO value that is configured on the receiving interface, the route is filtered out because it was learned from another PE router or from a backdoor link. This behavior is designed to prevent routing loops. • A received route from a CE router is configured with a SoO value that does not match: ? If a route is received with an associated SoO value that does not match the SoO value that is configured on the receiving interface, the route is accepted into the EIGRP topology table so that it can be redistributed into BGP. ? If the route is already installed in the EIGRP topology table but is associated with a different SoO value, the SoO value from the topology table is used when the route is redistributed into BGP. • A received route from a CE router does not contain a SoO value: Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 176 OL-26048-02 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router EIGRP Layer 3 VPN PE-CE Site-of-OriginIf a route is received without a SoO value, the route is accepted into the EIGRP topology table, and the SoO value from the interface that is used to reach the next-hop CE router is appended to the route before it is redistributed into BGP. ? When BGP and EIGRP peers that support the SoO extended community receive these routes, they also receive the associated SoO values and pass them to other BGP and EIGRP peers that support the SoO extended community. This filtering is designed to prevent transient routes from being relearned from the originating site, which prevents transient routing loops from occurring. In conjunction with BGP cost community, EIGRP, BGP, and the RIB ensure that paths over the MPLS VPN core are preferred over backdoor links. For MPLS and IP VPN and SoO configuration information, see Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs in the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide. EIGRP v4/v6 Authentication Using Keychain EIGRP authentication using keychain introduces the capability to authenticate EIGRP protocol packets on a per-interface basis. The EIGRP routing authentication provides a mechanism to authenticate all EIGRP protocol traffic on one or more interfaces, based on Message Digest 5 (MD5) authentication. The EIGRP routing authentication uses the Cisco IOS XR software security keychain infrastructure to store and retrieve secret keys and to authenticate incoming and outgoing traffic on a per-interface basis. How to Implement EIGRP This section contains instructions for the following tasks: Note To save configuration changes, you must commit changes when the system prompts you. Enabling EIGRP Routing This task enables EIGRP routing and establishes an EIGRP routing process. Before You Begin Although you can configure EIGRP before you configure an IP address, no EIGRP routing occurs until at least one IP address is configured. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 177 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router EIGRP v4/v6 Authentication Using KeychainSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router eigrp as-number 3. address-family { ipv4 } 4. router-id id 5. default-metric bandwidth delay reliability loading mtu 6. distance internal-distance external-distance 7. interface type interface-path-id 8. holdtime seconds 9. bandwidth-percent percent 10. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the autonomous system number of the routing process to configure an EIGRP routing process. router eigrp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router eigrp 100 Step 2 address-family { ipv4 } Enters an address family configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp)# address-family ipv4 Step 3 Step 4 router-id id (Optional) Configures a router-id for an EIGRP process. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp)# router-id 172.20.1.1 It is good practice to use the router-id command to explicitly specify a unique 32-bit numeric value for the router ID. This action ensures that EIGRP can function regardless of the interface address configuration. Note default-metric bandwidth delay reliability (Optional) Sets metrics for an EIGRP process. loading mtu Step 5 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 178 OL-26048-02 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Enabling EIGRP RoutingCommand or Action Purpose Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af)# default-metric 1000 100 250 100 1500 (Optional) Allows the use of two administrative distances—internal and external—that could be a better route to a node. distance internal-distance external-distance Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af)# distance 80 130 Step 6 interface type interface-path-id Defines the interfaces on which the EIGRP routing protocol runs. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af)# interface GigabitEthernet 0/1/0/0 Step 7 Step 8 holdtime seconds (Optional) Configures the hold time for an interface. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af-if)# holdtime 30 To ensure nonstop forwarding during RP failovers, as the number of neighbors increase, a higher holdtime than the default value is recommended. With 256 neighbors across all VRFs, we recommend 60 seconds. Note (Optional) Configuresthe percentage of bandwidth that may be used by EIGRP on an interface. bandwidth-percent percent Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af-if)# bandwidth-percent 75 Step 9 Step 10 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af-if)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and or returns the router to EXEC mode. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af-if)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 179 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Enabling EIGRP RoutingCommand or Action Purpose • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuring Route Summarization for an EIGRP Process This task configures route summarization for an EIGRP process. You can configure a summary aggregate address for a specified interface. If any more specific routes are in the routing table, EIGRP advertisesthe summary addressfrom the interface with a metric equal to the minimum of all more specific routes. Before You Begin You should not use the summary-addresssummarization command to generate the default route (0.0.0.0) from an interface. This command creates an EIGRP summary default route to the null 0 interface with an administrative distance of 5. The low administrative distance of this default route can cause this route to displace default routes learned from other neighbors from the routing table. If the default route learned from the neighbors is displaced by the summary default route or the summary route is the only default route present, all traffic destined for the default route does not leave the router; instead, this traffic is sent to the null 0 interface, where it is dropped. The recommended way to send only the default route from a given interface is to use a route-policy command. Note SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router eigrp as-number 3. address-family { ipv4 } 4. route-policy name out 5. interface type interface-path-id 6. summary-address ip-address { / length | mask } [ admin-distance ] 7. Do one of the following: • end • commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 180 OL-26048-02 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Route Summarization for an EIGRP ProcessDETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RRP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the AS number of the routing process to configure an EIGRP routing process router eigrp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router eigrp 100 Step 2 address-family { ipv4 } Enters an address family configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp)# address-family ipv4 Step 3 Applies a routing policy to updates advertised to or received from an EIGRP neighbor. route-policy name out Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af)# route-policy FILTER_DEFAULT out Step 4 interface type interface-path-id Defines the interfaces on which the EIGRP routing protocol runs. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af)# interface GigabitEthernet 0/1/0/0 Step 5 Configures a summary aggregate addressfor the specified EIGRP interface. summary-address ip-address { / length | mask } [ admin-distance ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af-if)# summary-address 192.168.0.0/16 95 Step 6 Step 7 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af-if)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: ? Entering yessaves configuration changesto the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 181 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Route Summarization for an EIGRP ProcessCommand or Action Purpose or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af-if)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Redistributing Routes for EIGRP This task explains how to redistribute routes, apply limits on the number of routes, and set timers for nonstop forwarding. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router eigrp as-number 3. address-family { ipv4 } 4. redistribute {{ bgp | connected | isis | ospf | rip | static } [ as-number ]} [ route-policy name ] 5. redistribute maximum-prefix maximum [ threshold ] [[ dampened ] [ reset-time minutes ] [ restart minutes ] [ restart-count number ] | [ warning-only ]] 6. timers nsf route-hold seconds 7. maximum paths maximum 8. maximum-prefix maximum [ threshold ] [[ dampened ] [ reset-time minutes ] [ restart minutes ] [ restart-count number ] | [ warning-only]] 9. Do one of the following: • end • commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 182 OL-26048-02 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Redistributing Routes for EIGRPDETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the AS number of the routing process to configure an EIGRP routing process. router eigrp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router eigrp 100 Step 2 address-family { ipv4 } Enters an address family configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp)# address-family ipv4 Step 3 Redistributes the routes from the specified protocol and AS number to the EIGRP process. Optionally, the redistributed redistribute {{ bgp | connected | isis | ospf | rip | static } [ as-number ]} [ route-policy name ] Step 4 routes can be filtered into the EIGRP process by providing the route policy. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af)# redistribute bgp 100 Limits the maximum number of prefixes that are redistributed to the EIGRP process. redistribute maximum-prefix maximum [ threshold ] [[ dampened ] [ reset-time minutes ] [ restart minutes ] [ restart-count number ] | [ warning-only ]] Step 5 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af)# redistribute maximum-prefix 5000 95 warning-only Sets the timer that determines how long an NSF-aware EIGRP router holds routes for an inactive peer. timers nsf route-hold seconds Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af)# timers nsf route-hold 120 Step 6 Controls the maximum number of parallel routes that the EIGRP can support. maximum paths maximum Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af)# maximum paths 10 Step 7 Limits the number of prefixes that are accepted under an address family by EIGRP. maximum-prefix maximum [ threshold ] [[ dampened ] [ reset-time minutes ] [ restart minutes ] [ restart-count number ] | [ warning-only]] Step 8 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 183 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Redistributing Routes for EIGRPCommand or Action Purpose Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af)# maximum-prefix 50000 Step 9 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Creating a Route Policy and Attaching It to an EIGRP Process This task defines a route policy and shows how to attach it to an EIGRP process. A route policy definition consists of the route-policy command and name argument followed by a sequence of optional policy statements, and then closed with the end-policy command. A route policy is not useful until it is applied to routes of a routing protocol. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 184 OL-26048-02 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Creating a Route Policy and Attaching It to an EIGRP ProcessSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. route-policy name 3. set eigrp-metric bandwidth delay reliability load mtu 4. end-policy 5. Do one of the following: • end • commit 6. configure 7. router eigrp as-number 8. address-family { ipv4 } 9. route-policy route-policy-name { in | out } 10. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 route-policy name Defines a route policy and enters route-policy configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# route-policy IN-IPv4 Step 2 set eigrp-metric bandwidth delay reliability (Optional) Sets the EIGRP metric attribute. load mtu Step 3 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# set eigrp metric 42 100 200 100 1200 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 185 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Creating a Route Policy and Attaching It to an EIGRP ProcessCommand or Action Purpose Endsthe definition of a route policy and exitsroute-policy configuration mode. end-policy Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# end-policy Step 4 Step 5 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exitsthe configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leavesthe router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router Step 6 Specifies the autonomous system number of the routing process to configure an EIGRP routing process. router eigrp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router eigrp 100 Step 7 address-family { ipv4 } Enters an address family configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp)# address-family ipv4 Step 8 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 186 OL-26048-02 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Creating a Route Policy and Attaching It to an EIGRP ProcessCommand or Action Purpose Applies a routing policy to updates advertised to or received from an EIGRP neighbor. route-policy route-policy-name { in | out } Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af)# route-policy IN-IPv4 in Step 9 Step 10 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exitsthe configuration session, and returns or the router to EXEC mode. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leavesthe router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuring Stub Routing for an EIGRP Process This task configures the distribution and remote routers to use an EIGRP process for stub routing. Before You Begin EIGRP stub routing should be used only on remote routers. A stub router is defined as a router connected to the network core or distribution layer through which core transit traffic should not flow. A stub router should not have any EIGRP neighbors other than distribution routers. Ignoring this restriction causes undesirable behavior. Note Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 187 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Stub Routing for an EIGRP ProcessSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router eigrp as-number 3. address-family { ipv4 } 4. stub [ receive-only | {[ connected ] [ redistributed ] [ static ] [ summary ]}] 5. Do one of the following: • end • commit 6. show eigrp [ ipv4 ] [ vrf { vrf-name | all }] neighbors [ as-number ] [ detail ] [ type interface-path-id | static ] DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RRP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the autonomous system number of the routing process to configure an EIGRP routing process. router eigrp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router eigrp 100 Step 2 address-family { ipv4 } Enters an address family configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp)# address-family ipv4 Step 3 stub [ receive-only | {[ connected ] [ Configures a router as a stub for EIGRP. redistributed ] [ static ] [ summary ]}] Step 4 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af)# stub receive-only Step 5 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 188 OL-26048-02 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Stub Routing for an EIGRP ProcessCommand or Action Purpose Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: ? Entering yessaves configuration changesto the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Verifies that a remote router has been configured as a stub router with EIGRP. show eigrp [ ipv4 ] [ vrf { vrf-name | all }] neighbors [ as-number ] [ detail ] [ type interface-path-id | static ] Step 6 The last line of the output shows the stub status of the remote or spoke router. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show eigrp neighbors detail Configuring EIGRP as a PE-CE Protocol Perform thistask to configure EIGRP on the provider edge (PE) and establish provider edge-to-customer edge (PE-CE) communication using EIGRP. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 189 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring EIGRP as a PE-CE ProtocolSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router eigrp as-number 3. vrf vrf-name 4. address-family { ipv4 } 5. router-id router-id 6. autonomous-system as-number 7. redistribute {{ bgp | connected | isis | ospf | ospfv3 | rip | static } [ as-number | instance-name ]} [ route-policy name ] 8. interface type interface-path-id 9. site-of-origin { as-number:number | ip-address : number } 10. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the autonomous system number of the routing process to configure an EIGRP routing process router eigrp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router eigrp 100 Step 2 vrf vrf-name Configures a VPN routing and forwarding (VRF) instance. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp)# vrf vrf_A Step 3 address-family { ipv4 } Enters a VRF address family configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf)# address-family ipv4 Step 4 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 190 OL-26048-02 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring EIGRP as a PE-CE ProtocolCommand or Action Purpose router-id router-id Configures a router ID for the EIGRP process. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf-af)# router-id 33 Step 5 Configures an EIGRP routing process to run within the VRF instance. autonomous-system as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf-af)# autonomous-system 2 Step 6 You must configure the autonomoussystem under VRF configuration to bring-up the VRF interface. Note redistribute {{ bgp | connected | isis | ospf | ospfv3 Injects routes from one routing domain into EIGRP. | rip | static } [ as-number | instance-name ]} [ route-policy name ] Step 7 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf-af)# redistribute bgp 100 Configures the interface on which EIGRP the routing protocol runs. interface type interface-path-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf-af)# interface gigabitEthernet 0/1/5/0 Step 8 Configuresthe site-of-origin (SoO) filtering on the EIGRP interface. site-of-origin { as-number:number | ip-address : number } Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf-af-if)# site-of-origin 3:4 Step 9 Step 10 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf-af-if)# end before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf-af-if)# commit ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 191 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring EIGRP as a PE-CE ProtocolCommand or Action Purpose ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Redistributing BGP Routes into EIGRP Perform this task to redistribute BGP routes into EIGRP. Typically, EIGRP routes are redistributed into BGP with extended community information appended to the route. BGP carries the route over the VPN backbone with the EIGRP-specific information encoded in the BGP extended community attributes. After the peering customer site receives the route, EIGRP redistributes the BGP route then extractsthe BGP extended community information and reconstructsthe route asit appeared in the original customer site. When redistributing BGP routes into EIGRP, the receiving provider edge (PE) EIGRP router looks for BGP extended community information. If the information is received, it is used to recreate the original EIGRP route. If the information is missing, EIGRP uses the configured default metric value. If the metric values are not derived from the BGP extended community and a default metric is not configured, the route is not advertised to the customer edge (CE) router by the PE EIGRP. When BGP is redistributed into BGP, metrics may not be added to the BGP prefix as extended communities; for example, if EIGRP is not running on the other router. In this case, EIGRP is redistributed into BGP with a “no-metrics” option. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 192 OL-26048-02 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Redistributing BGP Routes into EIGRPSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router eigrp as-number 3. vrf vrf-name 4. address-family { ipv4 } 5. redistribute {{ bgp | connected | isis | ospf | ospfv3 | rip | static } [ as-number | instance-name ]} [ route-policy name ] 6. route-policy route-policy-name { in | out } 7. default-metric bandwidth delay reliability loading mtu 8. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the autonomous system number of the routing process to configure an EIGRP routing process. router eigrp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router eigrp 100 Step 2 vrf vrf-name Configures a VRF instance. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp)# router eigrp 100 Step 3 address-family { ipv4 } Enters a VRF address family configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf)# address-family ipv4 Step 4 redistribute {{ bgp | connected | isis | ospf | Injects routes from one routing domain into EIGRP. ospfv3 | rip | static } [ as-number | instance-name ]} [ route-policy name ] Step 5 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 193 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Redistributing BGP Routes into EIGRPCommand or Action Purpose Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf-af)# redistribute bgp 100 Applies a routing policy to updates advertised to or received from an EIGRP neighbor. route-policy route-policy-name { in | out } Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf-af)# route-policy policy_A in Step 6 default-metric bandwidth delay reliability loading mtu Configures metrics for EIGRP. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf-af)# default-metric 1000 100 250 100 1500 Step 7 Step 8 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf-af)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf-af)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Monitoring EIGRP Routing The commands in this section are used to log neighbor adjacency changes, monitor the stability of the routing system, and help detect problems. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 194 OL-26048-02 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Monitoring EIGRP RoutingSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router eigrp as-number 3. address-family [ ipv4 ] 4. log-neighbor-changes 5. log-neighbor-warnings 6. Do one of the following: • end • commit 7. clear eigrp [ as-number ] [ vrf { vrf | all }] [ ipv4 ] neighbors [ ip-address | type interface-path-id ] 8. clear eigrp [ as-number ] [ vrf { vrf | all }] [ ipv4 ] topology [ prefix mask ] [ prefix / length ] 9. show eigrp [ as-number ] [ vrf { vrf | all }] [ ipv4 ] accounting 10. show eigrp [ as-number ] [ vrf { vrf | all }] [ ipv4 ] interfaces [ type interface-path-id ] [ detail ] 11. show eigrp [ as-number ] [ vrf { vrf | all }] [ ipv4 ] neighbors [ detail ] [ type interface-path-id | static ] 12. show protocols eigrp [ vrf vrf-name ] 13. show eigrp [ as-number ] [ vrf { vrf | all }] [ ipv4 ] topology [ ip-address mask ] [ active | all-links | detail-links | pending | summary | zero-successors ] 14. show eigrp [ as-number ] [ vrf { vrf | all }] [ ipv4 ] traffic DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the autonomous system number of the routing process to configure an EIGRP routing process. router eigrp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router eigrp 100 Step 2 address-family [ ipv4 ] Enters an address family configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp)# address-family ipv4 Step 3 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 195 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Monitoring EIGRP RoutingCommand or Action Purpose Enables the logging of changes in EIGRP neighbor adjacencies. log-neighbor-changes Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af)# log-neighbor-changes Step 4 Enables the logging of EIGRP neighbor warning messages. log-neighbor-warnings Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af)# log-neighbor-warnings Step 5 Step 6 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af)# commit configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returnsthe router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changesto the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Deletes EIGRP and VPN neighbor entries from the appropriate table. clear eigrp [ as-number ] [ vrf { vrf | all }] [ ipv4 ] neighbors [ ip-address | type interface-path-id ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:routerr# clear eigrp 20 neighbors GigabitEthernet 0/1/0/0 Step 7 Deletes EIGRP and VRF topology entries from the appropriate tab. clear eigrp [ as-number ] [ vrf { vrf | all }] [ ipv4 ] topology [ prefix mask ] [ prefix / length ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# clear eigrp topology Step 8 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 196 OL-26048-02 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Monitoring EIGRP RoutingCommand or Action Purpose Displays prefix accounting information for EIGRP processes. show eigrp [ as-number ] [ vrf { vrf | all }] [ ipv4 ] accounting Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show eigrp vrf all accounting Step 9 Displays information about interfaces configured for EIGRP. show eigrp [ as-number ] [ vrf { vrf | all }] [ ipv4 ] interfaces [ type interface-path-id ] [ detail ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show eigrp interfaces detail Step 10 show eigrp [ as-number ] [ vrf { vrf | all }] [ ipv4 ] Displays the neighbors discovered by EIGRP. neighbors [ detail ] [ type interface-path-id | static ] Step 11 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show eigrp neighbors 20 detail static Displays information about the EIGRP process configuration. show protocols eigrp [ vrf vrf-name ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show protocols eigrp Step 12 show eigrp [ as-number ] [ vrf { vrf | all }] [ ipv4 ] Displays entries in the EIGRP topology table. topology [ ip-address mask ] [ active | all-links | detail-links | pending | summary | zero-successors ] Step 13 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show eigrp topology 10.0.0.1 253.254.255.255 summary show eigrp [ as-number ] [ vrf { vrf | all }] [ ipv4 ] Displaysthe number of EIGRP packetssent and received. traffic Step 14 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show eigrp traffic Configuring an EIGRP Authentication Keychain Perform the following tasks to configure an authentication keychain on EIGRP interfaces. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 197 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring an EIGRP Authentication KeychainConfiguring an Authentication Keychain for an IPv4/IPv6 Interface on a Default VRF Perform this task to configure an authentication keychain for an IPv4/IPv6 interface on a default VRF. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router eigrp as-number 3. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } 4. interface type interface-path-id 5. authentication keychain keychain-name 6. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the autonomous system number of the routing process to configure an EIGRP routing process. router eigrp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router eigrp 100 Step 2 address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } Enters a VRF address family configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp)# address-family ipv4 Step 3 Configures the interface on which EIGRP the routing protocol runs. interface type interface-path-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af)# Step 4 interface gigabitEthernet 0/1/5/0 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 198 OL-26048-02 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring an EIGRP Authentication KeychainCommand or Action Purpose Authenticates all EIGRP protocol traffic on the interface, based on the MD5 algorithm. authentication keychain keychain-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af-if)# authentication keychain Step 5 Step 6 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf-af-if)#end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf-af-if)#commit configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. ? Entering no exitsthe configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changesto the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuring an Authentication Keychain for an IPv4/IPv6 Interface on a Nondefault VRF Perform this task to configure an authentication keychain for an IPv4/IPv6 interface on a nondefault VRF. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 199 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring an EIGRP Authentication KeychainSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router eigrp as-number 3. vrf vrf-name 4. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } 5. interface type interface-path-id 6. authentication keychain keychain-name 7. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Specifies the autonomous system number of the routing process to configure an EIGRP routing process. router eigrp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router eigrp 100 Step 2 Creates a VRF instance and enters VRF configuration mode. vrf vrf-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp)# vrf vrf1 Step 3 address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } Enters a VRF address family configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf)# address-family ipv4 Step 4 interface type interface-path-id Configures the interface on which EIGRP runs. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf-af)# Step 5 interface gigabitEthernet 0/1/5/0 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 200 OL-26048-02 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring an EIGRP Authentication KeychainCommand or Action Purpose Authenticates all EIGRP protocol traffic on the interface, based on the MD5 algorithm. authentication keychain keychain-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf-af-if)# authentication keychain Step 6 Step 7 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf-af-if)#end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf-af-if)#commit configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. ? Entering no exitsthe configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leavesthe router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changesto the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuration Examples for Implementing EIGRP This section provides the following configuration examples: Configuring a Basic EIGRP Configuration: Example The following example shows how to configure EIGRP with a policy that filters incoming routes. This is a typical configuration for a router that has just one neighbor, but advertises other connected subnets. router eigrp 144 address-family ipv4 metric maximum-hops 20 router-id 10.10.9.4 route-policy GLOBAL_FILTER_POLICY in log-neighbor-changes Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 201 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuration Examples for Implementing EIGRPlog-neighbor-warnings interface Loopback0 ! interface GigabitEthernet 0/2/0/0 passive-interface ! interface GigabitEthernet 0/6/0/0 hello-interval 8 hold-time 30 summary-address 10.0.0.0 255.255.0.0 ! Configuring an EIGRP Stub Operation: Example The following example shows how to configure an EIGRP stub. Stub operation allows only connected, static, and summary routes to be advertised to neighbors. router eigrp 200 address-family ipv4 stub connected static summary router-id 172.16.82.22 log-neighbor-changes log-neighbor-warnings redistribute connected route-policy CONN_POLICY interface GigabitEthernet0/6/0/0 passive-interface neighbor 10.0.0.31 ! interface GigabitEthernet0/6/0/1 passive-interface neighbor 10.0.1.21 ! ! ! Configuring an EIGRP PE-CE Configuration with Prefix-Limits: Example The following example shows how to configure EIGRP to operate as a PE-CE protocol on a PE router. The configuration is under VRF CUSTOMER_1. A maximum prefix is typically configured to ensure that one set of customer routes do not overwhelm the EIGRP process. router eigrp 500 vrf CUSTOMER_1 address-family ipv4 timers nsf route-hold 300 router-id 172.16.6.11 maximum-prefix 450 70 default-metric 200000 10000 195 10 1500 log-neighbor-changes log-neighbor-warnings redistribute maximum-prefix 350 70 redistribute bgp 1.65500 route-policy SITE_1_POLICY interface GigabitEthernet 0/4/0/5 neighbor 10.22.1.1 ! ! ! Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 202 OL-26048-02 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring an EIGRP Stub Operation: ExampleConfiguring an EIGRP Authentication Keychain: Example The following example shows how to configure an authentication keychain for an IPv4 interface on a nondefault VRF: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)#router eigrp 100 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp)#vrf vrf1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf)#address-family ipv4 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf-af)#interface POS 0/1/0/0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf-af-if)#authentication keychain key1 The following example shows how to configure an authentication keychain for an IPv6 interface on a default VRF: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)#router eigrp 100 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp)#address-family ipv6 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af)#interface POS 0/1/0/0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-af-if)#authentication keychain key2 Additional References The following sections provide references related to implementing EIGRP. Related Documents Related Topic Document Title Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Command Reference EIGRP commands: complete command syntax, command modes, command history, defaults, usage guidelines, and examples Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs module and Implementing MPLS Layer 2 VPNs module in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide MPLS VPN support for EIGRP feature information Implementing MPLS Traffic Engineering on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide Site of Origin (SoO) support for EIGRP feature information Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MIB Specification Guide. MIB Reference Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 203 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring an EIGRP Authentication Keychain: ExampleStandards Standards Title No new or modified standards are supported by this — feature, and support for existing standards has not been modified by this feature. MIBs MIBs MIBs Link To locate and download MIBs using Cisco IOS XR software, use the Cisco MIB Locator found at the following URL and choose a platform under the Cisco Access Products menu: http://cisco.com/public/ sw-center/netmgmt/cmtk/mibs.shtml — RFCs RFCs Title No new or modified RFCs are supported by this — feature, and support for existing standards has not been modified by this feature. Technical Assistance Description Link The Cisco Technical Support website contains http://www.cisco.com/techsupport thousands of pages of searchable technical content, including links to products, technologies, solutions, technical tips, and tools. Registered Cisco.com users can log in from this page to access even more content. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 204 OL-26048-02 Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional ReferencesC H A P T E R 3 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Integrated Intermediate System-to-Intermediate System (IS-IS), Internet Protocol Version 4 (IPv4), is a standards-based Interior Gateway Protocol (IGP). Cisco IOS XR software implements the IP routing capabilities described in International Organization for Standardization (ISO)/International Engineering Consortium (IEC) 10589 and RFC 1995, and adds the standard extensions for single topology and multitopology IS-IS for IP Version 6 (IPv6). This module describes how to implement IS-IS (IPv4 and IPv6) on your Cisco IOS XR network. This module describes how to implement IS-IS (IPv4 and IPv6) on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Routers. For more information about IS-IS on Cisco IOS XR software and complete descriptions of the IS-IS commands listed in this module, refer to the Related Documents, on page 269 section of this module. To locate documentation for other commands that might appear while executing a configuration task, search online in the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Commands Master List. Note Feature History for Implementing IS-IS Release Modification Release 3.7.2 This feature was introduced. Release 3.9.0 Support for IPv6 and was added. Support was added for the following features: • IP Fast Re-route Per Prefix Computation. • IP Fast Re-route Per Link Computation. Release 4.0.1 • Prerequisites for Implementing IS-IS, page 206 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 205• Restrictions for Implementing IS-IS, page 206 • Information About Implementing IS-IS , page 206 • How to Implement IS-IS, page 217 • Configuration Examples for Implementing IS-IS , page 266 • Where to Go Next, page 269 • Additional References, page 269 Prerequisites for Implementing IS-IS You must be in a user group associated with a task group that includes the proper task IDs. The command reference guides include the task IDs required for each command. If you suspect user group assignment is preventing you from using a command, contact your AAA administrator for assistance. Restrictions for Implementing IS-IS When multiple instances of IS-IS are being run, an interface can be associated with only one instance (process). Instances may not share an interface. Information About Implementing IS-IS To implement IS-IS you need to understand the following concepts: IS-IS Functional Overview Small IS-IS networks are typically built as a single area that includes all routers in the network. As the network grows larger, it may be reorganized into a backbone area made up of the connected set of all Level 2 routers from all areas, which is in turn connected to local areas. Within a local area, routers know how to reach all system IDs. Between areas, routers know how to reach the backbone, and the backbone routers know how to reach other areas. The IS-IS routing protocolsupportsthe configuration of backbone Level 2 and Level 1 areas and the necessary support for moving routing information between the areas. Routers establish Level 1 adjacencies to perform routing within a local area (intra-area routing). Routers establish Level 2 adjacencies to perform routing between Level 1 areas (interarea routing). For Cisco IOS XR software software, each IS-IS instance can support either a single Level 1 or Level 2 area, or one of each. By default, all IS-IS instances automatically support Level 1 and Level 2 routing. You can change the level of routing to be performed by a particular routing instance using the is-type command. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 206 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Prerequisites for Implementing IS-ISKey Features Supported in the Cisco IOS XR IS-IS Implementation The Cisco IOS XR implementation of IS-IS conforms to the IS-IS Version 2 specifications detailed in RFC 1195 and the IPv6 IS-IS functionality based on the Internet Engineering Task Force (IETF) IS-IS Working Group draft-ietf-isis-ipv6.txt document. The following list outlines key features supported in the Cisco IOS XR implementation: • Single topology IPv6 • Multitopology • Nonstop forwarding (NSF), both Cisco proprietary and IETF • Three-way handshake • Mesh groups • Multiple IS-IS instances • Configuration of a broadcast medium connecting two networking devices as a point-to-point link • Fast-flooding with different threads handling flooding and shortest path first (SPF). For information on IS-IS support for Bidirectional Forwarding Detection (BFD), see Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Interface and Hardware Component Configuration Guide and Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Interface and Hardware Component Command Reference. Note IS-IS Configuration Grouping Cisco IOS XR groups all of the IS-IS configuration in router IS-IS configuration mode, including the portion of the interface configurations associated with IS-IS. To display the IS-IS configuration in its entirety, use the show running router isis command. The command output displays the running configuration for all configured IS-IS instances, including the interface assignments and interface attributes. IS-IS Configuration Modes The following sections show how to enter each of the configuration modes. From a mode, you can enter the ? command to display the commands available in that mode. Router Configuration Mode The following example shows how to enter router configuration mode: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configuration RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router isis isp RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 207 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Key Features Supported in the Cisco IOS XR IS-IS ImplementationRouter Address Family Configuration Mode The following example shows how to enter router address family configuration mode: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router isis isp RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# address-family ipv4 u nicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-af)# Interface Configuration Mode The following example shows how to enter interface configuration mode: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router isis isp RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# interface GigabitEthernet 0 /3/0/0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if)# Interface Address Family Configuration Mode The following example shows how to enter interface address family configuration mode: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router isis isp RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# interface GigabitEthernet 0 /3/0/0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if)# address-family ipv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if-af)# IS-IS Interfaces IS-IS interfaces can be configured as one of the following types: • Active—advertises connected prefixes and forms adjacencies. This is the default for interfaces. • Passive—advertises connected prefixes but does not form adjacencies. The passive command is used to configure interfaces as passive. Passive interfaces should be used sparingly for important prefixes such as loopback addresses that need to be injected into the IS-IS domain. If many connected prefixes need to be advertised then the redistribution of connected routes with the appropriate policy should be used instead. • Suppressed—does not advertise connected prefixes but forms adjacencies. The suppress command is used to configure interfaces as suppressed. • Shutdown—does not advertise connected prefixes and does not form adjacencies. The shutdown command is used to disable interfaces without removing the IS-IS configuration. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 208 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router IS-IS InterfacesMultitopology Configuration Cisco IOS XR software supports multitopology for IPv6 IS-IS unless single topology is explicitly configured in IPv6 address-family configuration mode. IS-IS supports IP routing and not Open Systems Interconnection (OSI) Connectionless Network Service (CLNS) routing. Note IPv6 Routing and Configuring IPv6 Addressing By default, IPv6 routing is disabled in the Cisco IOS XR software. To enable IPv6 routing, you must assign IPv6 addresses to individual interfaces in the router using the ipv6 enable or ipv6 address command. See the Network Stack IPv4 and IPv6 Commands on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router IP Addresses and Services Command Reference. Limit LSP Flooding Limiting link-state packets (LSP) may be desirable in certain “meshy” network topologies. An example of such a network might be a highly redundant one such as a fully meshed set of point-to-point links over a nonbroadcast multiaccess(NBMA) transport. In such networks, full LSP flooding can limit network scalability. One way to restrict the size of the flooding domain is to introduce hierarchy by using multiple Level 1 areas and a Level 2 area. However, two other techniques can be used instead of or with hierarchy: Block flooding on specific interfaces and configure mesh groups. Both techniques operate by restricting the flooding of LSPs in some fashion. A direct consequence is that although scalability of the network isimproved, the reliability of the network (in the face of failures) isreduced because a series of failures may prevent LSPs from being flooded throughout the network, even though links exist that would allow flooding if blocking or mesh groups had not restricted their use. In such a case, the link-state databases of different routers in the network may no longer be synchronized. Consequences such as persistent forwarding loops can ensue. For this reason, we recommend that blocking or mesh groups be used only if specifically required, and then only after careful network design. Flood Blocking on Specific Interfaces With this technique, certain interfaces are blocked from being used for flooding LSPs, but the remaining interfaces operate normally for flooding. This technique is simple to understand and configure, but may be more difficult to maintain and more error prone than mesh groups in the long run. The flooding topology that IS-IS usesisfine-tuned rather than restricted. Restricting the topology too much (blocking too many interfaces) makes the network unreliable in the face of failures. Restricting the topology too little (blocking too few interfaces) may fail to achieve the desired scalability. To improve the robustness of the network in the event that all nonblocked interfaces drop, use the csnp-interval command in interface configuration mode to force periodic complete sequence number PDUs(CSNPs) packets to be used on blocked point-to-point links. The use of periodic CSNPs enables the network to become synchronized. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 209 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Multitopology ConfigurationMesh Group Configuration Configuring mesh groups (a set of interfaces on a router) can help to limit flooding. All routers reachable over the interfaces in a particular mesh group are assumed to be densely connected with each router having at least one link to every other router. Many links can fail without isolating one or more routers from the network. In normal flooding, a new LSP is received on an interface and is flooded out over all other interfaces on the router. With mesh groups, when a new LSP is received over an interface that is part of a mesh group, the new LSP is not flooded over the other interfaces that are part of that mesh group. Maximum LSP Lifetime and Refresh Interval By default, the routersends a periodic LSP refresh every 15 minutes. LSPsremain in a database for 20 minutes by default. If they are not refreshed by that time, they are deleted. You can change the LSP refresh interval or maximum LSP lifetime. The LSP interval should be less than the LSP lifetime or else LSPs time out before they are refreshed. In the absence of a configured refresh interval, the software adjuststhe LSP refresh interval, if necessary, to prevent the LSPs from timing out. Single-Topology IPv6 Support Single-topology IPv6 support on Cisco IOS XR software software allows IS-IS for IPv6 to be configured on interfaces along with an IPv4 network protocol. All interfaces must be configured with the identical set of network protocols, and all routers in the IS-IS area (for Level 1 routing) or the domain (for Level 2 routing) must support the identical set of network layer protocols on all interfaces. In single-topology mode, IPv6 topologies work with both narrow and wide metric styles in IPv4 unicast topology. During single-topology operation, one shortest path first (SPF) computation for each level is used to compute both IPv4 and IPv6 routes. Using a single SPF is possible because both IPv4 IS-IS and IPv6 IS-IS routing protocols share a common link topology. Multitopology IPv6 Support Multitopology IPv6 support on Cisco IOS XR software for IS-IS assumes that multitopology support is required as soon as it detects interfaces configured for both IPv6 and IPv4 within the IS-IS stanza. Because multitopology is the default behavior in the software, you must explicitly configure IPv6 to use the same topology asIPv4 to enable single-topology IPv6. Configure the single-topology command in IPv6 router address family configuration submode of the IS-IS router stanza. IS-IS Authentication Authentication is available to limit the establishment of adjacencies by using the hello-password command, and to limit the exchange of LSPs by using the lsp-password command. IS-IS supports plain-text authentication, which does not provide security against unauthorized users. Plain-text authentication allows you to configure a password to prevent unauthorized networking devices from forming adjacencies with the router. The password is exchanged as plain text and is potentially visible to an agent able to view the IS-IS packets. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 210 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Maximum LSP Lifetime and Refresh IntervalWhen an HMAC-MD5 password is configured, the password is never sent over the network and is instead used to calculate a cryptographic checksum to ensure the integrity of the exchanged data. IS-IS stores a configured password using simple encryption. However, the plain-text form of the password is used in LSPs, sequence number protocols (SNPs), and hello packets, which would be visible to a process that can view IS-IS packets. The passwords can be entered in plain text (clear) or encrypted form. To set the domain password, configure the lsp-password command for Level 2; to set the area password, configure the lsp-password command for Level 1. The keychain feature allows IS-IS to reference configured keychains. IS-IS key chains enable hello and LSP keychain authentication. Keychains can be configured at the router level (in the case of the lsp-password command) and at the interface level (in the case of the hello-password command) within IS-IS. These commands reference the global keychain configuration and instruct the IS-IS protocol to obtain security parameters from the global set of configured keychains. IS-IS is able to use the keychain to implement hitless key rollover for authentication. ey rollover specification is time based, and in the event of clock skew between the peers, the rollover process is impacted. The configurable tolerance specification allows for the accept window to be extended (before and after) by that margin. This accept window facilitates a hitless key rollover for applications (for example, routing and management protocols). See Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Security Guide for information on keychain management. Nonstop Forwarding On Cisco IOS XR software, NSF minimizes the amount of time a network is unavailable to its users following a route processor (RP) failover. The main objective of NSF is to continue forwarding IP packets and perform a graceful restart following an RP failover. When a router restarts, all routing peers of that device usually detect that the device went down and then came back up. This transition results in what is called a routing flap, which could spread across multiple routing domains. Routing flaps caused by routing restarts create routing instabilities, which are detrimental to the overall network performance. NSF helps to suppress routing flaps in NSF-aware devices, thus reducing network instability. NSF allows for the forwarding of data packets to continue along known routes while the routing protocol information is being restored following an RP failover. When the NSF feature is configured, peer networking devices do not experience routing flaps. Data traffic is forwarded through intelligent line cards while the standby RP assumes control from the failed active RP during a failover. The ability of line cards to remain up through a failover and to be kept current with the Forwarding Information Base (FIB) on the active RP is key to NSF operation. When the Cisco IOS XR router running IS-IS routing performs an RP failover, the router must perform two tasks to resynchronize its link-state database with its IS-IS neighbors. First, it must relearn the available IS-IS neighbors on the network without causing a reset of the neighbor relationship. Second, it must reacquire the contents of the link-state database for the network. The IS-IS NSF feature offers two options when configuring NSF: • IETF NSF • Cisco NSF Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 211 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Nonstop ForwardingIf neighbor routers on a network segment are NSF aware, meaning that neighbor routers are running a software version that supports the IETF Internet draft for router restartability, they assist an IETF NSF router that is restarting. With IETF NSF, neighbor routers provide adjacency and link-state information to help rebuild the routing information following a failover. In Cisco IOS XR software, Cisco NSF checkpoints (stores persistently) all the state necessary to recover from a restart without requiring any special cooperation from neighboring routers. The state is recovered from the neighboring routers, but only using the standard features of the IS-IS routing protocol. This capability makes Cisco NSF suitable for use in networksin which other routers have not used the IETF standard implementation of NSF. If you configure IETF NSF on the Cisco IOS XR router and a neighbor router does not support IETF NSF, the affected adjacencies flap, but nonstop forwarding is maintained to all neighbors that do support IETF NSF. A restart reverts to a cold start if no neighbors support IETF NSF. Note Multi-Instance IS-IS You can configure up to five IS-IS instances. MPLS can run on multiple IS-IS processes as long as the processesrun on differentsets of interfaces. Each interface may be associated with only a single IS-IS instance. Cisco IOS XR software preventsthe double-booking of an interface by two instances at configuration time—two instances of MPLS configuration causes an error. Because the Routing Information Base (RIB) treats each of the IS-IS instances as equal routing clients, you must be careful when redistributing routes between IS-IS instances. The RIB does not know to prefer Level 1 routes over Level 2 routes. For this reason, if you are running Level 1 and Level 2 instances, you must enforce the preference by configuring different administrative distances for the two instances. Multiprotocol Label Switching Traffic Engineering The MPLS TE feature enables an MPLS backbone to replicate and expand the traffic engineering capabilities of Layer 2 ATM and Frame Relay networks. MPLS is an integration of Layer 2 and Layer 3 technologies. For IS-IS, MPLS TE automatically establishes and maintains MPLS TE label-switched paths across the backbone by using Resource Reservation Protocol (RSVP). The route that a label-switched path uses is determined by the label-switched paths resource requirements and network resources, such as bandwidth. Available resources are flooded by using special IS-IS TLV extensions in the IS-IS. The label-switched paths are explicit routes and are referred to as traffic engineering (TE) tunnels. Overload Bit on Router The overload bit is a special bit of state information that is included in an LSP of the router. If the bit is set on the router, it notifies routers in the area that the router is not available for transit traffic. This capability is useful in four situations: 1 During a serious but nonfatal error, such as limited memory. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 212 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Multi-Instance IS-IS2 During the startup and restart of the process. The overload bit can be set until the routing protocol has converged. However, it is not employed during a normal NSF restart or failover because doing so causes a routing flap. 3 During a trial deployment of a new router. The overload bit can be set until deployment is verified, then cleared. 4 During the shutdown of a router. The overload bit can be set to remove the router from the topology before the router is removed from service. Overload Bit Configuration During Multitopology Operation Because the overload bit applies to forwarding for a single topology, it may be configured and cleared independently for IPv4 and IPv6 during multitopology operation. For this reason, the overload is set from the router address family configuration mode. If the IPv4 overload bit is set, all routers in the area do not use the router for IPv4 transit traffic. However, they can still use the router for IPv6 transit traffic. IS-IS Overload Bit Avoidance The IS-IS overload bit avoidance feature allows network administratorsto prevent labelswitched paths(LSPs) from being disabled when a router in that path has its Intermediate System-to-Intermediate System (IS-IS) overload bit set. When the IS-IS overload bit avoidance feature is activated, all nodes with the overload bit set, including head nodes, mid nodes, and tail nodes, are ignored, which means that they are still available for use with label switched paths (LSPs). The IS-IS overload bit avoidance feature does not change the default behavior on nodes that have their overload bit set if those nodes are not included in the path calculation (PCALC). Note The IS-IS overload bit avoidance feature is activated using the following command: mpls traffic-eng path-selection ignore overload The IS-IS overload bit avoidance feature is deactivated using the no form of this command: no mpls traffic-eng path-selection ignore overload When the IS-IS overload bit avoidance feature is deactivated, nodes with the overload bit set cannot be used as nodes of last resort. Default Routes You can force a default route into an IS-IS routing domain. Whenever you specifically configure redistribution of routes into an IS-IS routing domain, the Cisco IOS XR software does not, by default, redistribute the default route into the IS-IS routing domain. The default-information originate command generates a default route into IS-IS, which can be controlled by a route policy. You can use the route policy to identify the level into which the default route is to be announced, and you can specify other filtering options configurable under a route policy. You can use a route policy to conditionally advertise the default route, depending on the existence of another route in the routing table of the router. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 213 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Overload Bit Configuration During Multitopology OperationAttached Bit on an IS-IS Instance The attached bit is set in a router that is configured with the is-type command and level-1-2 keyword. The attached bit indicates that the router is connected to other areas (typically through the backbone). This functionality means that the router can be used by Level 1 routers in the area as the default route to the backbone. The attached bit is usually set automatically as the router discovers other areas while computing its Level 2 SPF route. The bit is automatically cleared when the router becomes detached from the backbone. If the connectivity for the Level 2 instance is lost, the attached bit in the Level 1 instance LSP would continue sending traffic to the Level 2 instance and cause the traffic to be dropped. Note To simulate this behavior when using multiple processes to represent the level-1-2 keyword functionality, you would manually configure the attached bit on the Level 1 process. IS-IS Support for Route Tags The IS-IS Support for route tags feature provides the capability to associate and advertise a tag with an IS-IS route prefix. Additionally, the feature allows you to prioritize the order of installation of route prefixes in the RIB based on a tag of a route. Route tags may also be used in route policy to match route prefixes(for example, to select certain route prefixes for redistribution). Multicast-Intact Feature The multicast-intact feature provides the ability to run multicast routing (PIM) when IGP shortcuts are configured and active on the router. Both OSPFv2 and IS-IS support the multicast-intact feature. MPLS TE and IP multicast coexistence is supported in Cisco IOS XR software by using the mpls traffic-eng multicast-intact IS-IS or OSPF router command. You can enable multicast-intact in the IGP when multicast routing protocols (PIM) are configured and IGP shortcuts are configured on the router. IGP shortcuts are MPLS tunnels that are exposed to IGP. The IGPs route the IP traffic over these tunnels to destinations that are downstream from the egress router of the tunnel (from an SPF perspective). PIM cannot use IGP shortcuts for propagating PIM joins because reverse path forwarding (RPF) cannot work across a unidirectional tunnel. When you enable multicast-intact on an IGP, the IGP publishes a parallel or alternate set of equal-cost next-hops for use by PIM. These next-hops are called mcast-intact next-hops. The mcast-intact next-hops have the following attributes: • They are guaranteed not to contain any IGP shortcuts. • They are not used for unicast routing but are used only by PIM to look up an IPv4 next-hop to a PIM source. • They are not published to the FIB. • When multicast-intact is enabled on an IGP, all IPv4 destinations that were learned through link-state advertisements are published with a set equal-cost mcast-intact next-hops to the RIB. This attribute applies even when the native next-hops have no IGP shortcuts. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 214 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Attached Bit on an IS-IS Instance• In IS-IS, the max-paths limit is applied by counting both the native and mcast-intact next-hops together. (In OSPFv2, the behavior is slightly different.) Multicast Topology Support Using IS-IS Multicast topology support allowsfor the configuration of IS-IS multicast topologiesfor IPv4 or IPv6 routing. IS-IS maintains a separate topology for multicast and runs a separate Shortest Path First (SPF) over the multicast topology. IS-IS multicast inserts routes from the IS-IS multicast topology into the multicast-unicast Routing Information Base (muRIB) table in the RIB for the corresponding address family. Since PIM uses the muRIB, PIM uses routes from the multicast topology instead of routes from the unicast topology. MPLS Label Distribution Protocol IGP Synchronization Multiprotocol Label Switching (MPLS) Label Distribution Protocol (LDP) Interior Gateway Protocol (IGP) Synchronization ensures that LDP has completed label exchange before the IGP path is used for switching. MPLS traffic loss can occur in the following two situations: • When an IGP adjacency is established, the router begins forwarding packets using the new adjacency before LDP has exchanged labels with peers on that link. • When an LDP session closes, the router continues to forward traffic using the link associated with the LDP peer rather than using an alternate path with an established LDP session. This feature provides a mechanism to synchronize LDP and IS-IS to minimize MPLS packet loss. The synchronization is accomplished by changing the link metric for a neighbor IS-IS link-state packet (LSP), based on the state of the LDP session. When an IS-IS adjacency is established on a link but the LDP session is lost or LDP has not yet completed exchanging labels, IS-IS advertisesthe maximum metric on that link. In thisinstance, LDP IS-IS synchronization is not yet achieved. In IS-IS, a link with a maximum wide metric (0xFFFFFF) is not considered for shortest path first (SPF). Therefore, the maximum wide metric of -1 (0XFFFFFE) is used with MPLS LDP IGP synchronization. Note When LDP IS-IS synchronization is achieved, IS-IS advertises a regular (configured or default) metric on that link. MPLS LDP-IGP Synchronization Compatibility with LDP Graceful Restart LDP graceful restart protects traffic when an LDP session is lost. If a graceful restart-enabled LDP session fails, MPLS LDP IS-IS synchronization is still achieved on the interface while it is protected by graceful restart. MPLS LDP IGP synchronization is eventually lost under the following circumstances: • LDP fails to restart before the LDP graceful restart reconnect timer expires. • The LDP session on the protected interface fails to recover before the LDP graceful restart recovery timer expires. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 215 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Multicast Topology Support Using IS-ISMPLS LDP-IGP Synchronization Compatibility with IGP Nonstop Forwarding IS-IS nonstop forwarding (NSF) protectstraffic during IS-IS processrestarts and route processor (RP) failovers. LDP IS-IS synchronization is supported with IS-IS NSF only if LDP graceful restart is also enabled over the interface. If IS-IS NSF is not enabled, the LDP synchronization state is not retained acrossrestarts and failovers. Label Distribution Protocol IGP Auto-configuration Label Distribution Protocol (LDP) Interior Gateway Protocol (IGP) auto-configuration simplifiesthe procedure to enable LDP on a set of interfaces used by an IGP instance. LDP IGP auto-configuration can be used on a large number interfaces(for example, when LDP is used for transport in the core) and on multiple IGP instances simultaneously. This feature supports the IPv4 address family for the default VPN routing and forwarding (VRF) instance. LDP IGP auto-configuration can also be explicitly disabled on individual interfaces under LDP using the igp auto-config disable command. This allows LDP to receive all IGP interfaces except the ones explicitly disabled. See Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide for information on configuring LDP IGP auto-configuration. MPLS TE Forwarding Adjacency MPLS TE forwarding adjacency allows a network administrator to handle a traffic engineering, label switch path (LSP) tunnel as a link in an Interior Gateway Protocol (IGP) network, based on the Shortest Path First (SPF) algorithm. A forwarding adjacency can be created between routers in the same IS-IS level. The routers can be located multiple hopsfrom each other. As a result, a TE tunnel is advertised as a link in an IGP network, with the cost of the link associated with it. Routers outside of the TE domain see the TE tunnel and use it to compute the shortest path for routing traffic throughout the network. MPLS TE forwarding adjacency is considered in IS-IS SPF only if a two-way connectivity check is achieved. This is possible if the forwarding adjacency is bidirectional or the head end and tail end routers of the MPLS TE tunnel are adjacent. The MPLS TE forwarding adjacency feature is supported by IS-IS. For details on configuring MPLS TE forwarding adjacency, see the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide. MPLS TE Interarea Tunnels MPLS TE interarea tunnels allow you to establish MPLS TE tunnels that span multiple IGP areas (Open Shorted Path First [OSPF]) and levels (IS-IS), removing the restriction that required that both the tunnel headend and tailend routers be in the same area. The IGP can be either IS-IS or OSPF. See the Configuring MPLS Traffic Engineering for IS-IS, on page 243 for information on configuring MPLS TE for IS-IS. For details on configuring MPLS TE interarea tunnels, see the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 216 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Label Distribution Protocol IGP Auto-configurationIP Fast Reroute The IP Fast Reroute (IPFRR) loop-free alternate (LFA) computation provides protection against link failure. Locally computed repair paths are used to prevent packet loss caused by loops that occur during network reconvergence after a failure. See IETF draft-ietf-rtgwg-ipfrr-framework-06.txt and draft-ietf-rtgwg-lf-conv-frmwk-00.txt for detailed information on IPFRR LFA. IPFRR LFA is different from Multiprotocol Label Switching (MPLS) as it is applicable to networks using conventional IP routing and forwarding. See Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide for information on configuring MPLS IPFRR. How to Implement IS-IS This section contains the following procedures: Note To save configuration changes, you must commit changes when the system prompts you. Enabling IS-IS and Configuring Level 1 or Level 2 Routing This task explains how to enable IS-IS and configure the routing level for an area. Configuring the routing level in Step 4 is optional, but is highly recommended to establish the proper level of adjacencies. Note Before You Begin Although you can configure IS-IS before you configure an IP address, no IS-IS routing occurs until at least one IP address is configured. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router isis instance-id 3. net network-entity-title 4. is-type { level-1 | level-1-2 | level-2-only } 5. Do one of the following: • end • commit 6. show isis [ instance instance-id ] protocol Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 217 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router IP Fast RerouteDETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Enables IS-IS routing for the specified routing instance, and places the router in router configuration mode. router isis instance-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router isis isp Step 2 • By default, all IS-IS instances are automatically Level 1 and Level 2. You can change the level of routing to be performed by a particular routing instance by using the is-type router configuration command. Step 3 net network-entity-title Configures network entity titles (NETs) for the routing instance. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# net 47.0004.004d.0001.0001.0c11.1110.00 • Specify a NET for each routing instance if you are configuring multi-instance IS-IS. • This example configures a router with area ID 47.0004.004d.0001 and system ID 0001.0c11.1110.00. • To specify more than one area address, specify additional NETs. Although the area address portion of the NET differs, the systemID portion of the NET must match exactly for all of the configured items. Step 4 is-type { level-1 | level-1-2 | level-2-only } (Optional) Configures the system type (area or backbone router). Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# is-type level-2-only • By default, every IS-IS instance acts as a level-1-2 router. • The level-1 keyword configures the software to perform Level 1 (intra-area) routing only. Only Level 1 adjacencies are established. The software learns about destinations inside its area only. Any packets containing destinations outside the area are sent to the nearest level-1-2 router in the area. • The level-2-only keyword configures the software to perform Level 2 (backbone) routing only, and the router establishes only Level 2 adjacencies, either with other Level 2-only routers or with level-1-2 routers. • The level-1-2 keyword configures the software to perform both Level 1 and Level 2 routing. Both Level 1 and Level 2 adjacencies are established. The router acts as a border router between the Level 2 backbone and its Level 1 area. Step 5 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 218 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Enabling IS-IS and Configuring Level 1 or Level 2 RoutingCommand or Action Purpose • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • end • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exitsthe configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leavesthe router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. show isis [ instance instance-id ] protocol (Optional) Displays summary information about the IS-IS instance. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show isis protocol Step 6 Configuring Single Topology for IS-IS After an IS-IS instance is enabled, it must be configured to compute routes for a specific network topology. This task explains how to configure the operation of the IS-IS protocol on an interface for an IPv4 or IPv6 topology. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 219 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Single Topology for IS-ISBefore You Begin To enable the router to run in single-topology mode, configure each of the IS-IS interfaces with all of the address families enabled and “single-topology” in the address-family IPv6 unicast in the IS-IS router stanza. You can use either the IPv6 address family or both IPv4 and IPv6 address families, but your configuration must represent the set of all active address families on the router. Additionally, explicitly enable single-topology operation by configuring it in the IPv6 router address family submode. Two exceptions to these instructions exist: Note 1 If the address-family stanza in the IS-IS process contains the adjacency-check disable command, then an interface is not required to have the address family enabled. 2 The single-topology command is not valid in the ipv4 address-family submode. The default metric style for single topology is narrow metrics. However, you can use either wide metrics or narrow metrics. How to configure them depends on how single topology is configured. If both IPv4 and IPv6 are enabled and single topology is configured, the metric style is configured in the address-family ipv4 stanza. You may configure the metric style in the address-family ipv6 stanza, but it is ignored in this case. If only IPv6 is enabled and single topology is configured, then the metric style is configured in the address-family ipv6 stanza. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 220 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Single Topology for IS-ISSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. interface type interface-path-id 3. Do one of the following: • ipv4 address address mask • ipv6 address ipv6-prefix / prefix-length [ eui-64 ] • ipv6 address ipv6-address { / prefix-length | link-local } • ipv6 enable 4. exit 5. router isis instance-id 6. net network-entity-title 7. address-family ipv6 [ unicast ] 8. single-topology 9. exit 10. interface type interface-path-id 11. circuit-type { level-1 | level-1-2 | level-2-only } 12. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } [ unicast | multicast ] 13. Do one of the following: • end • commit 14. show isis [ instance instance-id ] interface [ type interface-path-id ] [ detail ] [ level { 1 | 2 }] 15. show isis [ instance instance-id ] topology [ systemid system-id ] [ level { 1 | 2 }] [ summary ] DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 interface type interface-path-id Enters interface configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# interface GigabitEthernet 0/1/0/3 Step 2 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 221 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Single Topology for IS-ISCommand or Action Purpose Definesthe IPv4 addressfor the interface. An IP addressisrequired on all interfaces in an area enabled for IS-IS if any one interface is configured for IS-IS routing. Step 3 Do one of the following: • ipv4 address address mask • ipv6 address ipv6-prefix / prefix-length [ eui-64 ] or Specifies an IPv6 network assigned to the interface and enables • IPv6 processing on the interface with the eui-64 keyword. ipv6 address ipv6-address { / prefix-length | link-local } or • ipv6 enable Specifies an IPv6 address assigned to the interface and enablesIPv6 processing on the interface with the link-local keyword. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# ipv4 address 10.0.1.3 255.255.255.0 or Automatically configures an IPv6 link-local address on the interface while also enabling the interface for IPv6 processing. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# ipv6 address 3ffe:1234:c18:1::/64 eui-64 • The link-local address can be used only to communicate with nodes on the same link. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# ipv6 • Specifying the ipv6 address ipv6-prefix / prefix-length interface configuration command without the eui-64 keyword configures site-local and global IPv6 addresses. address FE80::260:3EFF:FE11:6770 link-local RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# ipv6 enable or • Specifying the ipv6 address ipv6-prefix / prefix-length command with the eui-64 keyword configures site-local and global IPv6 addresses with an interface ID in the low-order 64 bits of the IPv6 address. Only the 64-bit network prefix for the address needs to be specified; the last 64 bits are automatically computed from the interface ID. • Specifying the ipv6 address command with the link-local keyword configures a link-local address on the interface that is used instead of the link-local address that is automatically configured when IPv6 is enabled on the interface. Exits interface configuration mode, and returns the router to global configuration mode. exit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# exit Step 4 Enables IS-IS routing for the specified routing instance, and places the router in router configuration mode. router isis instance-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router isis isp Step 5 • By default, all IS-IS instances are Level 1 and Level 2. You can change the level of routing to be performed by a particular routing instance by using the is-type command. Step 6 net network-entity-title Configures NETs for the routing instance. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 222 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Single Topology for IS-ISCommand or Action Purpose Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# net 47.0004.004d.0001.0001.0c11.1110.00 • Specify a NET for each routing instance if you are configuring multi-instance IS-IS. You can specify a name for a NET and for an address. • This example configures a router with area ID 47.0004.004d.0001 and system ID 0001.0c11.1110.00. • To specify more than one area address, specify additional NETs. Although the area address portion of the NET differs, the system ID portion of the NET must match exactly for all of the configured items. Specifies the IPv6 address family and enters router address family configuration mode. address-family ipv6 [ unicast ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# address-family ipv6 unicast Step 7 • This example specifies the unicast IPv6 address family. (Optional) Configures the link topology for IPv4 when IPv6 is configured. single-topology Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-af)# single-topology Step 8 • The single-topology command is valid only in IPv6 submode. The command instructs IPv6 to use the single topology rather than the default configuration of a separate topology in the multitopology mode. • See the Single-Topology IPv6 Support, on page 210 for more information. Exits router address family configuration mode, and returns the router to router configuration mode. exit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-af)# exit Step 9 interface type interface-path-id Enters interface configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# interface GigabitEthernet 0/1/0/3 Step 10 Step 11 circuit-type { level-1 | level-1-2 | level-2-only } (Optional) Configures the type of adjacency. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if)# circuit-type level-1-2 • The default circuit type is the configured system type (configured through the is-type command). • Typically, the circuit type must be configured when the router is configured as only level-1-2 and you want to constrain an interface to form only level-1 or level-2-only adjacencies. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 223 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Single Topology for IS-ISCommand or Action Purpose Specifies the IPv4 or IPv6 address family, and enters interface address family configuration mode. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } [ unicast | multicast ] Step 12 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if)# address-family ipv4 unicast • This example specifiesthe unicast IPv4 addressfamily on the interface. Step 13 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if-af)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if-af)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. show isis [ instance instance-id ] interface [ type (Optional) Displays information about the IS-IS interface. interface-path-id ] [ detail ] [ level { 1 | 2 }] Step 14 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show isis interface GigabitEthernet 0/1/0/1 show isis [ instance instance-id ] topology [ (Optional) Displays a list of connected routers in all areas. systemid system-id ] [ level { 1 | 2 }] [ summary ] Step 15 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show isis topology Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 224 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Single Topology for IS-ISConfiguring Multitopology Routing This set of procedures configures multitopology routing, which is used by PIM for reverse-path forwarding (RPF) path selection. Restrictions for Configuring Multitopology Routing • Only the default VRF is currently supported in a multitopology solution. • Only protocol-independent multicast (PIM) and intermediate system-intermediate system (IS-IS) routing protocols are currently supported. • Topology selection is restricted solely to (S, G) route sources for both SM and SSM. Static and IS-IS are the only interior gateway protocols (IGPs) that support multitopology deployment. For non-(S, G) route sources like a rendezvous point or bootstrap router (BSR), or when a route policy is not configured, the current policy default remains in effect. In other words, either a unicast-default or multicast-default table is selected for all sources, based on OSFP/IS-IS/Multiprotocol Border Gateway Protocol (MBGP) configuration. Although both multicast and unicast keywords are available when using the address-family {ipv4 | ipv6} command in routing policy language (RPL), only topologies under multicast SAFI can be configured globally. Note Information About Multitopology Routing Configuring multitopology networks requires the following tasks: Configuring a Global Topology and Associating It with an Interface Follow these stepsto enable a global topology in the default VRF and to enable its use with a specific interface. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } multicast topology topo-name 3. maximum prefix limit 4. interface type interface-path-id 5. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } multicast topology topo-name 6. Repeat Step 4 and Step 5 until you have specified all the interface instances you want to associate with your topologies. 7. Do one of the following: • end • commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 225 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Multitopology RoutingDETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Configures a topology in the default VRF table that will be associated with a an interface. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } multicast topology topo-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# address-family ipv4 multicast topology green Step 2 (Optional) Limits the number of prefixes allowed in a topology routing table. Range is 32 to 2000000. maximum prefix limit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-af)# maximum prefix 100 Step 3 Specifiesthe interface to be associated with the previously specified VRF table that will add the connected and local routes to the appropriate routing table. interface type interface-path-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-af)# interface GigabitEthernet 0/3/0/0 Step 4 Enablesthe topology for the interface specified in Step 4, on page 226, adding the connected and local routesto the appropriate routing table. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } multicast topology topo-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# address-family ipv4 multicast topology green Step 5 Repeat Step 4 and Step 5 until you have specified all the — interface instances you want to associate with your topologies. Step 6 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if-af)# interface gigabitethernet 0/3/2/0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:routerrouter(config-if)# address-family ipv4 multicast topology purple RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if-af)# Step 7 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-mcast-default-ipv4)# end before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 226 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Multitopology RoutingCommand or Action Purpose ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-mcast-default-ipv4)# commit configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leavesthe router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changesto the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Enabling an IS-IS Topology To enable a topology in IS-IS, you must associate an IS-IS topology ID with the named topology. IS-IS uses the topology ID to differentiate topologies in the domain. Note This command must be configured prior to other topology commands. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router isis instance-id 3. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } multicast topology topo-name 4. topology-id multitoplogy-id 5. Do one of the following: • end • commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 227 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Multitopology RoutingDETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 router isis instance-id Enters IS-IS configuration submode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router isis purple Step 2 address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } multicast Associates an IS-IS topology ID with the named topology. topology topo-name Step 3 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# address-family ipv4 multicast topology green Configures the numeric multitopologyID in IS-IS that identifies the topology. Range is 6 to 4095. topology-id multitoplogy-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-af)# toplogy-id 122 Step 4 Step 5 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if-af)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if-af)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 228 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Multitopology RoutingCommand or Action Purpose Placing an Interface in a Topology in IS-IS To associate an interface with a topology in IS-IS, follow these steps. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router isis instance-id 3. net network-entity-title 4. interface type interface-path-id 5. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } multicast topology topo-name 6. Repeat Step 4, on page 230 and Step 5, on page 230 until you have specified all the interface instances and associated topologies you want to configure in your network. 7. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 router isis instance-id Enters IS-IS configuration submode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router isis purple Step 2 net network-entity-title Creates a network entity title for the configured isis interface. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# net netname Step 3 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 229 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Multitopology RoutingCommand or Action Purpose Enters isis interface configuration submode and creates an interface instance. interface type interface-path-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# interface gigabitethernet 0/3/0/0 Step 4 address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } multicast topology topo-name Step 5 • Entersisis address-family interface configuration submode. • Places the interface instance into a topology. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if)# address-family ipv4 multicast topology green Repeat Step 4, on page 230 and Step 5, on page 230 — until you have specified all the interface instances and Step 6 associated topologies you want to configure in your network. Step 7 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if-af)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if-af)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returnsthe router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changesto the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuring a Routing Policy For more information about creating a routing policy and about the set rpf-topology command, see Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Command Reference. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 230 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Multitopology RoutingSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. route-policy policy-name 3. end-policy 4. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Defines a routing policy and enters routing policy configuration submode. route-policy policy-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# route-policy Step 2 For detailed information about the use of the set-rpf-topology and other routing configuration commands,see Cisco ASR 9000 Series mt1 Aggregation Services Router Routing Command Reference. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# if destination in 225.0.0.1, 225.0.0.11 then RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl-if)# if source in (10.10.10.10) then RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl-if-2)# set rpf-topology ipv4 multicast topology greentable RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl-if-2)# else RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl-if-else-2)# set rpf-topology ipv4 multicast topology bluetable RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl-if-else-2)# endif RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl-if)# endif Signifies the end of route policy definition and exits routing policy configuration submode. end-policy Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# end-policy Step 3 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# Step 4 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 231 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Multitopology RoutingCommand or Action Purpose • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • end • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: ? Entering yessaves configuration changesto the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuring Multitopology for IS-IS Multitopology is configured in the same way asthe single topology. However, the single - topology command is omitted, invoking the default multitopology behavior. This task is optional. Controlling LSP Flooding for IS-IS Flooding of LSPs can limit network scalability. You can control LSP flooding by tuning your LSP database parameters on the router globally or on the interface. This task is optional. Many of the commands to control LSP flooding contain an option to specify the level to which they apply. Without the option, the command applies to both levels. If an option is configured for one level, the other level continues to use the default value. To configure options for both levels, use the command twice. For example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# lsp-refresh-interval 1200 level 2 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# lsp-refresh-interval 1100 level 1 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 232 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Multitopology for IS-ISSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router isis instance-id 3. lsp-refresh-interval seconds [ level { 1 | 2 }] 4. lsp-check-interval seconds [ level { 1 | 2 }] 5. lsp-gen-interval { [ initial-wait initial | secondary-wait secondary | maximum-wait maximum ] ... } [ level { 1 | 2 }] 6. lsp-mtu bytes [ level { 1 | 2 }] 7. max-lsp-lifetime seconds [ level { 1 | 2 }] 8. ignore-lsp-errors disable 9. interface type interface-path-id 10. lsp-interval milliseconds [ level { 1 | 2 }] 11. csnp-interval seconds [ level { 1 | 2 }] 12. retransmit-interval seconds [ level { 1 | 2 }] 13. retransmit-throttle-interval milliseconds [ level { 1 | 2 }] 14. mesh-group { number | blocked } 15. Do one of the following: • end • commit 16. show isis interface [ type interface-path-id | level { 1 | 2 }] [ brief ] 17. show isis [ instance instance-id ] database [ level { 1 | 2 }] [ detail | summary | verbose ] [ * | lsp-id ] 18. show isis [ instance instance-id ] lsp-log [ level { 1 | 2 }] 19. show isis database-log [ level { 1 | 2 }] DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Enables IS-IS routing for the specified routing instance, and places the router in router configuration mode. router isis instance-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router isis isp Step 2 • You can change the level of routing to be performed by a particular routing instance by using the is-type router configuration command. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 233 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Controlling LSP Flooding for IS-ISCommand or Action Purpose (Optional) Sets the time between regeneration of LSPs that contain different sequence numbers lsp-refresh-interval seconds [ level { 1 | 2 }] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# lsp-refresh-interval 10800 Step 3 • The refresh interval should always be set lower than the max-lsp-lifetime command. (Optional) Configuresthe time between periodic checks of the entire database to validate the checksums of the LSPs in the database. lsp-check-interval seconds [ level { 1 | 2 }] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# lsp-check-interval 240 Step 4 • This operation is costly in terms of CPU and so should be configured to occur infrequently. (Optional) Reduces the rate of LSP generation during periods of instability in the network. Helps reduce the CPU load on the router and number of LSP transmissions to its IS-IS neighbors. lsp-gen-interval { [ initial-wait initial | secondary-wait secondary | maximum-wait maximum ] ... } [ level { 1 | 2 }] Step 5 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# • During prolonged periods of network instability, repeated recalculation of LSPs can cause an increased CPU load on the local router. Further, the flooding of these recalculated lsp-gen-interval maximum-wait 15 LSPsto the other Intermediate Systemsin the network causes initial-wait 5 increased traffic and can result in other routers having to spend more time running route calculations. (Optional) Sets the maximum transmission unit (MTU) size of LSPs. lsp-mtu bytes [ level { 1 | 2 }] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# lsp-mtu 1300 Step 6 (Optional) Sets the initial lifetime given to an LSP originated by the router. max-lsp-lifetime seconds [ level { 1 | 2 }] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# max-lsp-lifetime 11000 Step 7 • Thisisthe amount of time that the LSP persistsin the database of a neighbor unless the LSP is regenerated or refreshed. (Optional) Sets the router to purge LSPs received with checksum errors. ignore-lsp-errors disable Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# ignore-lsp-errors disable Step 8 interface type interface-path-id Enters interface configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# interface GigabitEthernet 0/1/0/3 Step 9 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 234 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Controlling LSP Flooding for IS-ISCommand or Action Purpose (Optional) Configures the amount of time between each LSP sent on an interface. lsp-interval milliseconds [ level { 1 | 2 }] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if)# lsp-interval 100 Step 10 (Optional) Configures the interval at which periodic CSNP packets are sent on broadcast interfaces. csnp-interval seconds [ level { 1 | 2 }] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if)# csnp-interval 30 level 1 Step 11 • Sending more frequent CSNPs means that adjacent routers must work harder to receive them. • Sending less frequent CSNP means that differences in the adjacent routers may persist longer. (Optional) Configures the amount of time that the sending router waits for an acknowledgment before it considers that the LSP was not received and subsequently resends. retransmit-interval seconds [ level { 1 | 2 }] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if)# retransmit-interval 60 Step 12 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if)# retransmit-interval 60 (Optional) Configures the amount of time between retransmissions on each LSP on a point-to-point interface. retransmit-throttle-interval milliseconds [ level { 1 | 2 }] Step 13 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if)# retransmit-throttle-interval 1000 • This time is usually greater than or equal to the lsp-interval command time because the reason for lost LSPs may be that a neighboring router is busy. A longer interval gives the neighbor more time to receive transmissions. (Optional) Optimizes LSP flooding in NBMA networks with highly meshed, point-to-point topologies. mesh-group { number | blocked } Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if)# mesh-group blocked Step 14 • This command is appropriate only for an NBMA network with highly meshed, point-to-point topologies. Step 15 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if)# commit ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 235 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Controlling LSP Flooding for IS-ISCommand or Action Purpose ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. show isis interface [ type interface-path-id | (Optional) Displays information about the IS-IS interface. level { 1 | 2 }] [ brief ] Step 16 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show isis interface GigabitEthernet 0/1/0/1 brief show isis [ instance instance-id ] database [ (Optional) Displays the IS-IS LSP database. level { 1 | 2 }] [ detail | summary | verbose ] [ * | lsp-id ] Step 17 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show isis database level 1 show isis [ instance instance-id ] lsp-log [ level (Optional) Displays LSP log information. { 1 | 2 }] Step 18 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show isis lsp-log show isis database-log [ level { 1 | 2 }] (Optional) Display IS-IS database log information. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show isis database-log level 1 Step 19 Configuring Nonstop Forwarding for IS-IS This task explains how to configure your router with NSF that allows the Cisco IOS XR software to resynchronize the IS-IS link-state database with its IS-IS neighbors after a process restart. The process restart could be due to an: • RP failover (for a warm restart) Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 236 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Nonstop Forwarding for IS-IS• Simple process restart (due to an IS-IS reload or other administrative request to restart the process) • IS-IS software upgrade In all cases, NSF mitigates link flaps and loss of user sessions. This task is optional. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router isis instance-id 3. nsf { cisco | ietf } 4. nsf interface-expires number 5. nsf interface-timer seconds 6. nsf lifetime seconds 7. Do one of the following: • end • commit 8. show running-config [ command ] DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Enables IS-IS routing for the specified routing instance, and places the router in router configuration mode. router isis instance-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router isis isp Step 2 • You can change the level of routing to be performed by a particular routing instance by using the is-type router configuration command. Step 3 nsf { cisco | ietf } Enables NSF on the next restart. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# nsf ietf • Enter the cisco keyword to run IS-IS in heterogeneous networks that might not have adjacent NSF-aware networking devices. • Enter the ietf keyword to enable IS-IS in homogeneous networks where all adjacent networking devices support IETF draft-based restartability. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 237 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Nonstop Forwarding for IS-ISCommand or Action Purpose Configures the number of resends of an acknowledged NSF-restart acknowledgment. nsf interface-expires number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# nsf interface-expires 1 Step 4 • If the resend limit is reached during the NSF restart, the restart falls back to a cold restart. nsf interface-timer seconds Configuresthe number ofsecondsto wait for each restart acknowledgment. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis) nsf interface-timer 15 Step 5 Step 6 nsf lifetime seconds Configures the maximum route lifetime following an NSF restart. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# nsf lifetime 20 • This command should be configured to the length of time required to perform a full NSF restart because it is the amount of time that the Routing Information Base (RIB) retains the routes during the restart. • Setting this value too high results in stale routes. • Setting this value too low could result in routes purged too soon. Step 7 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 238 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Nonstop Forwarding for IS-ISCommand or Action Purpose (Optional) Displays the entire contents of the currently running configuration file or a subset of that file. show running-config [ command ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show running-config router isis isp Step 8 • Verify that “nsf” appearsin the IS-IS configuration of the NSF-aware device. • This example shows the contents of the configuration file for the “isp” instance only. Configuring Authentication for IS-IS This task explains how to configure authentication for IS-IS. This task is optional. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router isis instance-id 3. lsp-password { hmac-md5 | text } { clear | encrypted } password [ level { 1 | 2 }] [ send-only ] [ snp send-only ] 4. interface type interface-path-id 5. hello-password { hmac-md5 | text } { clear | encrypted } password [ level { 1 | 2 }] [ send-only ] 6. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Enables IS-IS routing for the specified routing instance, and places the router in router configuration mode. router isis instance-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router isis isp Step 2 • You can change the level of routing to be performed by a particular routing instance by using the is-type command. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 239 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Authentication for IS-ISCommand or Action Purpose lsp-password { hmac-md5 | text } { clear | encrypted } Configures the LSP authentication password. password [ level { 1 | 2 }] [ send-only ] [ snp send-only ] Step 3 • The hmac-md5 keyword specifies that the password is used in HMAC-MD5 authentication. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# lsp-password hmac-md5 clear password1 level 1 • The text keyword specifies that the password uses cleartext password authentication. • The clear keyword specifies that the password is unencrypted when entered. • The encrypted keyword specifies that the password is encrypted using a two-way algorithm when entered. • The level 1 keyword sets a password for authentication in the area (in Level 1 LSPs and Level SNPs). • The level 2 keywordsset a password for authentication in the backbone (the Level 2 area). • The send-only keyword adds authentication to LSP and sequence number protocol data units (SNPs) when they are sent. It does not authenticate received LSPs or SNPs. • The snp send-only keyword adds authentication to SNPs when they are sent. It does not authenticate received SNPs. To disable SNP password checking, the snp send-only keywords must be specified in the lsp-password command. Note interface type interface-path-id Enters interface configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# interface GigabitEthernet 0/1/0/3 Step 4 hello-password { hmac-md5 | text } { clear | encrypted Configuresthe authentication password for an IS-IS interface. } password [ level { 1 | 2 }] [ send-only ] Step 5 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if)#hello-password text clear mypassword Step 6 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: • commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 240 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Authentication for IS-ISCommand or Action Purpose Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if)# commit ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuring Keychains for IS-IS This task explains how to configure keychains for IS-IS. This task is optional. Keychains can be configured at the router level ( lsp-password command) and at the interface level ( hello-password command) within IS-IS. These commands reference the global keychain configuration and instruct the IS-IS protocol to obtain security parameters from the global set of configured keychains. The router-level configuration (lsp-password command) sets the keychain to be used for all IS-IS LSPs generated by this router, as well as for all Sequence Number Protocol Data Units (SN PDUs). The keychain used for HELLO PDUs is set at the interface level, and may be set differently for each interface configured for IS-IS. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router isis instance-id 3. l sp-password keychain keychain-name [ level { 1 | 2 }] [ send-only ] [ snp send-only ] 4. interface type interface-path-id 5. h ello-password keychain keychain-name [ level { 1 | 2 }] [ send-only ] 6. Do one of the following: • end • commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 241 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Keychains for IS-ISDETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Enables IS-IS routing for the specified routing instance, and places the router in router configuration mode. router isis instance-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router isis isp Step 2 • You can change the level of routing to be performed by a particular routing instance by using the is-type command. l sp-password keychain keychain-name [ level { 1 | 2 }] Configures the keychain. [ send-only ] [ snp send-only ] Step 3 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# lsp-password keychain isis_a level 1 interface type interface-path-id Enters interface configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# interface GigabitEthernet 0/1/0/3 Step 4 Configures the authentication password for an IS-IS interface. h ello-password keychain keychain-name [ level { 1 | 2 }] [ send-only ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if)#hello-password keychain isis_b Step 5 Step 6 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if)# end before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if)# commit configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 242 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Keychains for IS-ISCommand or Action Purpose ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuring MPLS Traffic Engineering for IS-IS This task explains how to configure IS-IS for MPLS TE. This task is optional. For a description of the MPLS TE tasks and commands that allow you to configure the router to support tunnels, configure an MPLS tunnel that IS-IS can use, and troubleshoot MPLS TE, see Implementing MPLS Traffic Engineering on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide Before You Begin Your network must support the MPLS Cisco IOS XR software feature before you enable MPLS TE for IS-IS on your router. You must enter the commands in the following task list on every IS-IS router in the traffic-engineered portion of your network. Note MPLS traffic engineering currently does not support routing and signaling of LSPs over unnumbered IP links. Therefore, do not configure the feature over those links. Note Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 243 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring MPLS Traffic Engineering for IS-ISSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router isis instance-id 3. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } [ unicast | multicast ] 4. mpls traffic-eng level { 1 | 2 } 5. mpls traffic-eng router-id { ip-address | interface-name interface-instance } 6. metric-style wide [ level { 1 | 2 }] 7. Do one of the following: • end • commit 8. show isis [ instance instance-id ] mpls traffic-eng tunnel 9. show isis [ instance instance-id ] mpls traffic-eng adjacency-log 10. show isis [ instance instance-id ] mpls traffic-eng advertisements DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Enables IS-IS routing for the specified routing instance, and places the router in router configuration mode. router isis instance-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router isis isp Step 2 • You can change the level of routing to be performed by a particular routing instance by using the is-type router configuration command. Specifies the IPv4 or IPv6 address family, and enters router address family configuration mode. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } [ unicast | multicast ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)#address-family ipv4 unicast Step 3 Configures a router running IS-IS to flood MPLS TE link information into the indicated IS-IS level. mpls traffic-eng level { 1 | 2 } Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-af)# mpls traffic-eng level 1 Step 4 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 244 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring MPLS Traffic Engineering for IS-ISCommand or Action Purpose Specifies that the MPLS TE router identifier for the node is the given IP address or an IP address associated with the given interface. mpls traffic-eng router-id { ip-address | interface-name interface-instance } Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-af)# mpls traffic-eng router-id loopback0 Step 5 Configures a router to generate and accept only wide link metrics in the Level 1 area. metric-style wide [ level { 1 | 2 }] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-af)# metric-style wide level 1 Step 6 Step 7 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-af)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exitsthe configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-af)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. show isis [ instance instance-id ] mpls traffic-eng (Optional) Displays MPLS TE tunnel information. tunnel Step 8 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show isis instance isp mpls traffic-eng tunnel Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 245 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring MPLS Traffic Engineering for IS-ISCommand or Action Purpose (Optional) Displays a log of MPLS TE IS-IS adjacency changes. show isis [ instance instance-id ] mpls traffic-eng adjacency-log Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show isis instance isp mpls traffic-eng adjacency-log Step 9 (Optional) Displays the latest flooded record from MPLS TE. show isis [ instance instance-id ] mpls traffic-eng advertisements Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show isis instance isp mpls traffic-eng advertisements Step 10 Tuning Adjacencies for IS-IS This task explains how to enable logging of adjacency state changes, alter the timers for IS-IS adjacency packets, and display various aspects of adjacency state. Tuning your IS-IS adjacencies increases network stability when links are congested. This task is optional. For point-to-point links, IS-IS sends only a single hello for Level 1 and Level 2, which means that the level modifiers are meaningless on point-to-point links. To modify hello parameters for a point-to-point interface, omit the specification of the level options. The options configurable in the interface submode apply only to that interface. By default, the values are applied to both Level 1 and Level 2. The hello-password command can be used to prevent adjacency formation with unauthorized or undesired routers. This ability is particularly useful on a LAN, where connections to routers with which you have no desire to establish adjacencies are commonly found. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 246 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Tuning Adjacencies for IS-ISSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router isis instance-id 3. log adjacency changes 4. interface type interface-path-id 5. hello-padding { disable | sometimes } [ level { 1 | 2 }] 6. hello-interval seconds [ level { 1 | 2 }] 7. hello-multiplier multiplier [ level { 1 | 2 }] 8. h ello-password { hmac-md5 | text } { clear | encrypted } password [ level { 1 | 2 }] [ send-only ] 9. Do one of the following: • end • commit 10. show isis [ instance instance-id ] adjacency t ype interface- path-id ] [ detail ] [ systemid system-id ] 11. show isis adjacency-log 12. show isis [ instance instance-id ] interface [ type interface-path-id ] [ brief | detail ] [ level { 1 | 2 }] 13. show isis [ instance instance-id ] neighbors [ interface-type interface-instance ] [ summary ] [ detail ] [ systemid system-id ] DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Enables IS-IS routing for the specified routing instance, and places the router in router configuration mode. router isis instance-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router isis isp Step 2 • You can change the level of routing to be performed by a particular routing instance by using the is-type command. Generates a log message when an IS-IS adjacency changes state (up or down). log adjacency changes Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# log adjacency changes Step 3 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 247 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Tuning Adjacencies for IS-ISCommand or Action Purpose interface type interface-path-id Enters interface configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# interface GigabitEthernet 0/1/0/3 Step 4 Configures padding on IS-IS hello PDUs for an IS-IS interface on the router. hello-padding { disable | sometimes } [ level { 1 | 2 }] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if)# hello-padding sometimes Step 5 • Hello padding appliesto only thisinterface and not to all interfaces. Specifies the length of time between hello packets that the software sends. hello-interval seconds [ level { 1 | 2 }] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if)#hello-interval 6 Step 6 Specifies the number of IS-IS hello packets a neighbor must miss before the routershould declare the adjacency as down. hello-multiplier multiplier [ level { 1 | 2 }] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if)# hello-multiplier 10 Step 7 • A higher value increases the networks tolerance for dropped packets, but also may increase the amount of time required to detect the failure of an adjacent router. • Conversely, not detecting the failure of an adjacent router can result in greater packet loss. Specifies that this system include authentication in the hello packets and requires successful authentication of h ello-password { hmac-md5 | text } { clear | encrypted } password [ level { 1 | 2 }] [ send-only ] Step 8 the hello packet from the neighbor to establish an adjacency. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if)# hello-password text clear mypassword Step 9 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if)# end before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if)# commit configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 248 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Tuning Adjacencies for IS-ISCommand or Action Purpose ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returnsthe router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. show isis [ instance instance-id ] adjacency t ype interface- (Optional) Displays IS-IS adjacencies. path-id ] [ detail ] [ systemid system-id ] Step 10 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show isis instance isp adjacency (Optional) Displays a log of the most recent adjacency state transitions. show isis adjacency-log Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show isis adjacency-log Step 11 show isis [ instance instance-id ] interface [ type (Optional) Displaysinformation about the IS-IS interface. interface-path-id ] [ brief | detail ] [ level { 1 | 2 }] Step 12 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show isis interface GigabitEthernet 0/1/0/1 brief show isis [ instance instance-id ] neighbors [ interface-type (Optional) Displays information about IS-IS neighbors. interface-instance ] [summary ] [ detail ] [systemid system-id ] Step 13 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show isis neighbors summary Setting SPF Interval for a Single-Topology IPv4 and IPv6 Configuration This task explains how to make adjustments to the SPF calculation to tune router performance. This task is optional. Because the SPF calculation computes routes for a particular topology, the tuning attributes are located in the router address family configuration submode. SPF calculation computes routes for Level 1 and Level 2 separately. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 249 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Setting SPF Interval for a Single-Topology IPv4 and IPv6 ConfigurationWhen IPv4 and IPv6 address families are used in a single-topology mode, only a single SPF for the IPv4 topology exists. The IPv6 topology “borrows” the IPv4 topology; therefore, no SPF calculation is required for IPv6. To tune the SPF calculation parameters for single-topology mode, configure the address-family ipv4 unicast command. The incremental SPF algorithm can be enabled separately. When enabled, the incremental shortest path first (ISPF) is not employed immediately. Instead, the full SPF algorithm is used to “seed” the state information required for the ISPF to run. The startup delay prevents the ISPF from running for a specified interval after an IS-IS restart (to permit the database to stabilize). After the startup delay elapses, the ISPF is principally responsible for performing all of the SPF calculations. The reseed interval enables a periodic running of the full SPF to ensure that the iSFP state remains synchronized. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router isis instance-id 3. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } [ unicast | multicast ] 4. spf-interval {[ initial-wait initial | secondary-wait secondary | maximum-wait maximum ] ...} [ level { 1 | 2 }] 5. ispf [ level { 1 | 2 }] 6. Do one of the following: • end • commit 7. show isis [ instance instance-id ] [[ ipv4 | ipv6 | afi-all ] [ unicast | multicast | safi-all ]] spf-log [ level { 1 | 2 }] [ ispf | fspf | prc | nhc ] [ detail | verbose ] [ last number | first number ] DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Enables IS-IS routing for the specified routing instance, and places the router in router configuration mode. router isis instance-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router isis isp Step 2 • You can change the level of routing to be performed by a particular routing instance by using the is-type router configuration command. Specifies the IPv4or IPv6 address family, and enters router address family configuration mode. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } [ unicast | multicast ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)#address-family ipv4 unicast Step 3 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 250 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Setting SPF Interval for a Single-Topology IPv4 and IPv6 ConfigurationCommand or Action Purpose (Optional) Controlsthe minimum time between successive SPF calculations. spf-interval {[ initial-wait initial | secondary-wait secondary | maximum-wait maximum ] ...} [ level { 1 | 2 }] Step 4 • This value imposes a delay in the SPF computation after an event trigger and enforces a minimum elapsed time between SPF runs. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-af)# spf-interval initial-wait 10 maximum-wait 30 • If this value is configured too low, the router can lose too many CPU resources when the network is unstable. • Configuring the value too high delays changes in the network topology that result in lost packets. • The SPF interval does not apply to the running of the ISPF because that algorithm runs immediately on receiving a changed LSP. (Optional) Configures incremental IS-IS ISPF to calculate network topology. ispf [ level { 1 | 2 }] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-af)# ispf Step 5 Step 6 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-af)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-af)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. (Optional) Displays how often and why the router has run a full SPF calculation. show isis [ instance instance-id ] [[ ipv4 | ipv6 | afi-all ] [ unicast | multicast | safi-all ]] spf-log [ level { 1 | 2 }] [ ispf | fspf | prc | nhc ] [ detail | verbose ] [ last number | first number ] Step 7 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 251 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Setting SPF Interval for a Single-Topology IPv4 and IPv6 ConfigurationCommand or Action Purpose Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show isis instance 1 spf-log ipv4 Customizing Routes for IS-IS This task explains how to perform route functions that include injecting default routes into your IS-IS routing domain and redistributing routes learned in another IS-IS instance. This task is optional. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router isis instance-id 3. set-overload-bit [ on-startup { delay | wait-for-bgp }] [ level { 1 | 2 }] 4. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } [ unicast | multicast ] 5. default-information originate [ route-policy route-policy-name ] 6. redistribute isis instance [ level-1 | level-2 | level-1-2 ] [ metric metric ] [ metric-type { internal | external }] [ policy policy-name ] 7. Do one of the following: • summary-prefix address / prefix-length [ level { 1 | 2 }] • summary-prefix ipv6-prefix / prefix-length [ level { 1 | 2 }] 8. maximum-paths route-number 9. distance weight [ address / prefix-length [ route-list-name ]] 10. set-attached-bit 11. Do one of the following: • end • commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 252 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Customizing Routes for IS-ISDETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Enables IS-IS routing for the specified routing process, and places the router in router configuration mode. router isis instance-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router isis isp Step 2 • By default, all IS-IS instances are automatically Level 1 and Level 2. You can change the level of routing to be performed by a particular routing instance by using the is-type command. set-overload-bit [ on-startup { delay | (Optional) Sets the overload bit. wait-for-bgp }] [ level { 1 | 2 }] Step 3 The configured overload bit behavior does not apply to NSF restarts because the NSF restart does not set the overload bit during restart. Note Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# set-overload-bit Specifies the IPv4 or IPv6 address family, and enters router address family configuration mode. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } [ unicast | multicast ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# address-family ipv4 unicast Step 4 (Optional) Injects a default IPv4 or IPv6 route into an IS-IS routing domain. default-information originate [ route-policy route-policy-name ] Step 5 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-af)# default-information originate • The route-policy keyword and route-policy-name argument specify the conditions under which the IPv4 or IPv6 default route is advertised. • If the route-policy keyword is omitted, then the IPv4 or IPv6 default route is unconditionally advertised at Level 2. (Optional) Redistributes routes from one IS-IS instance into another instance. redistribute isis instance [ level-1 | level-2 | level-1-2 ] [ metric metric ] [ metric-type { internal | external }] [ policy policy-name ] Step 6 • In this example, an IS-IS instance redistributes Level 1 routes from another IS-IS instance. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-af)# redistribute isis 2 level-1 (Optional) Allows a Level 1-2 router to summarize Level 1 IPv4 and IPv6 prefixes at Level 2, instead of advertising the Level 1 prefixes directly when the router advertises the summary. Step 7 Do one of the following: • summary-prefix address / prefix-length [ level { 1 | 2 }] Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 253 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Customizing Routes for IS-ISCommand or Action Purpose • This example specifies an IPv4 address and mask. • summary-prefix ipv6-prefix / prefix-length [ level { 1 | 2 }] or Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-af)# summary-prefix 10.1.0.0/16 level 1 • This example specifies an IPv6 prefix, and the command must be in the form documented in RFC 2373 in which the address is specified in hexadecimal using 16-bit values between colons. • Note that IPv6 prefixes must be configured only in the IPv6 router address family configuration submode, and IPv4 prefixes in the IPv4 router address family configuration submode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-af)# summary-prefix 3003:xxxx::/24 level 1 (Optional) Configuresthe maximum number of parallel paths allowed in a routing table. maximum-paths route-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-af)# maximum-paths 16 Step 8 (Optional) Defines the administrative distance assigned to routes discovered by the IS-IS protocol. distance weight [ address / prefix-length [ route-list-name ]] Step 9 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-af)# distance 90 • A different administrative distance may be applied for IPv4 and IPv6. (Optional) Configures an IS-IS instance with an attached bit in the Level 1 LSP. set-attached-bit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-af)# set-attached-bit Step 10 Step 11 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-af)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-af)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 254 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Customizing Routes for IS-ISCommand or Action Purpose • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuring MPLS LDP IS-IS Synchronization This task explains how to enable Multiprotocol Label Switching (MPLS) Label Distribution Protocol (LDP) IS-IS synchronization. MPLS LDP synchronization can be enabled for an address family under interface configuration mode. Only IPv4 unicast address family is supported. This task is optional. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router isis instance-id 3. interface type interface-path-id 4. address-family ipv4 unicast 5. mpls ldp sync [ level { 1 | 2 }] 6. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 EnablesIS-IS routing for the specified routing process, and places the router in router configuration mode. router isis instance-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router isis isp Step 2 • By default, all IS-IS instances are automatically Level 1 and Level 2. You can change the level of routing to be performed by a particular routing instance by using the is-type command. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 255 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring MPLS LDP IS-IS SynchronizationCommand or Action Purpose interface type interface-path-id Enters interface configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# interface GigabitEthernet 0/1/0/3 Step 3 Specifiesthe IPv4 addressfamily and entersrouter addressfamily configuration mode. address-family ipv4 unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if)# address-family ipv4 unicast Step 4 Enables MPLS LDP synchronization for the IPv4 address family under interface GigabitEthernet 0/1/0/3. mpls ldp sync [ level { 1 | 2 }] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if-af)# mpls ldp sync level 1 Step 5 Step 6 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if-af)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if-af)# commit ? Entering no exitsthe configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commitcommand to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Enabling Multicast-Intact This optional task describes how to enable multicast-intact for IS-IS routes that use IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 256 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Enabling Multicast-IntactSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router isis instance-id 3. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } [ unicast | multicast ] 4. mpls traffic-eng multicast-intact 5. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Enables IS-IS routing for the specified routing process, and places the router in router configuration mode. In this example, the IS-IS instance is called isp. router isis instance-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router isis isp Step 2 Specifies the IPv4 or IPv6 address family, and enters router address family configuration mode. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } [ unicast | multicast ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# address-family ipv4 unicast Step 3 mpls traffic-eng multicast-intact Enables multicast-intact. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-af)# mpls traffic-eng multicast-intact Step 4 Step 5 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-af)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 257 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Enabling Multicast-IntactCommand or Action Purpose ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-af)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Tagging IS-IS Interface Routes This optional task describes how to associate a tag with a connected route of an IS-IS interface. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router isis instance-id 3. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } [ unicast | multicast ] 4. metric-style wide [ transition ] [ level { 1 | 2 }] 5. exit 6. interface type number 7. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } [ unicast | multicast ] 8. tag tag 9. Do one of the following: • end • commit 10. show isis [ ipv4 | ipv6 | afi-all ] [ unicast | multicast | safi-all ] route [ detail ] Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 258 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Tagging IS-IS Interface RoutesDETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Enables IS-IS routing for the specified routing process, and placesthe router in router configuration mode. In this example, the IS-IS instance is called isp. router isis instance-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router isis isp Step 2 Specifies the IPv4 or IPv6 address family, and enters router address family configuration mode. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } [ unicast | multicast ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# address-family ipv4 unicast Step 3 Configures a router to generate and accept only wide link metrics in the Level 1 area. metric-style wide [ transition ] [ level { 1 | 2 }] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-af)# metric-style wide level 1 Step 4 Exits router address family configuration mode, and returns the router to router configuration mode. exit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-af)# exit Step 5 interface type number Enters interface configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# interface GigabitEthernet 0/1/0/3 Step 6 Specifies the IPv4 or IPv6 address family, and enters address family configuration mode. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } [ unicast | multicast ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if)# address-family ipv4 unicast Step 7 Sets the value of the tag to associate with the advertised connected route. tag tag Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if-af)# tag 3 Step 8 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 259 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Tagging IS-IS Interface RoutesCommand or Action Purpose Step 9 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if-af)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if-af)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Displays tag information. Verify that all tags are present in the RIB. show isis [ ipv4 | ipv6 | afi-all ] [ unicast | multicast | safi-all ] route [ detail ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if-af)# show isis ipv4 route detail Step 10 Setting the Priority for Adding Prefixes to the RIB This optional task describes how to set the priority (order) for which specified prefixes are added to the RIB. The prefixes can be chosen using an access list (ACL), prefix list, or by matching a tag value. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 260 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Setting the Priority for Adding Prefixes to the RIBSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router isis instance-id 3. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } [ unicast | multicast ] 4. metric-style wide [ transition ] [ level { 1 | 2 }] 5. spf prefix-priority [ level { 1 | 2 }] { critical | high | medium } { access-list-name | tag tag } 6. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Enables IS-IS routing for the specified routing process, and places the router in router configuration mode. In this example, the IS-IS instance is called isp. router isis instance-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router isis isp Step 2 Specifies the IPv4 or IPv6 address family, and enters router address family configuration mode. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } [ unicast | multicast ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# address-family ipv4 unicast Step 3 Configures a router to generate and accept only wide-link metrics in the Level 1 area. metric-style wide [ transition ] [ level { 1 | 2 }] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-af)# metric-style wide level 1 Step 4 spf prefix-priority [ level { 1 | 2 }] { critical | Installs all routes tagged with the value 3 first. high | medium } { access-list-name | tag tag } Step 5 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-af)# spf prefix-priority high tag 3 Step 6 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 261 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Setting the Priority for Adding Prefixes to the RIBCommand or Action Purpose • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before • end • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-af)# end exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: ? Entering yessaves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-af)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuring IP/LDP Fast Reroute This optional task describes how to enable the IP/LDP fast reroute computation to converge traffic flows around link failures. To enable node protection on broadcast links, fast reroute and bidirectional forwarding detection (BFD) must be enabled on the interface under IS-IS. Note Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 262 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring IP/LDP Fast RerouteSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router isis instance-id 3. interface type interface-path-id 4. circuit-type { level-1 | level-1-2 | level-2-only } 5. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } [ unicast | multicast ] 6. fast-reroute {per-link | per-prefix} 7. Do one of the following: • fast-reroute per-link { level { 1 | 2 }} • fast-reroute per-prefix { level { 1 | 2 }} 8. Do one of the following: • fast-reroute per-link exclude interface type interface-path-id { level { 1 | 2 }} • fast-reroute per-prefix exclude interface type interface-path-id { level { 1 | 2 }} 9. Do one of the following: • fast-reroute per-link lfa-candidate interface type interface-path-id { level { 1 | 2 }} • fast-reroute per-prefix lfa-candidate interface type interface-path-id { level { 1 | 2 }} 10. Do one of the following: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Enables IS-IS routing for the specified routing process, and places the router in router configuration mode. In this example, the IS-IS instance is called isp. router isis instance-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router isis isp Step 2 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 263 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring IP/LDP Fast RerouteCommand or Action Purpose interface type interface-path-id Enters interface configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# interface POS 0/1/0/3 Step 3 circuit-type { level-1 | level-1-2 | level-2-only } (Optional) Configures the type of adjacency. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if)# circuit-type level-1 Step 4 Specifies the address family, and enters router address family configuration mode. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } [ unicast | multicast ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if)# address-family ipv4 unicast Step 5 • This example specifies the unicast IPv4 address family. Specifies fast-reroute computation on per-link or per-prefix basis. fast-reroute {per-link | per-prefix} Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router8(config-isis-if-af)# fast-reroute per-link Step 6 • per-link—Used for prefix independent per-link computation. • per-prefix—Used for prefix dependent computation. Configures fast-reroute per-link or per-prefix computation for one level; use either level 1 or level 2. Step 7 Do one of the following: • fast-reroute per-link { level { 1 | 2 }} • fast-reroute per-prefix { level { 1 | 2 }} Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if-af)#fast-reroute per-link level 1 Or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if-af)#fast-reroute per-prefix level 2 Step 8 Do one of the following: Excludes an interface from fast-reroute computation. • fast-reroute per-link exclude interface type interface-path-id { level { 1 | 2 }} • fast-reroute per-prefix exclude interface type interface-path-id { level { 1 | 2 }} Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 264 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring IP/LDP Fast RerouteCommand or Action Purpose Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if-af)#fast-reroute per-link exclude interface Loopback0 level 1 Or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if-af)#fast-reroute per-prefix exclude interface POS0/6/0/0 level 2 Configures to include an interface to LFA candidate in fast-reroute computation. Step 9 Do one of the following: • fast-reroute per-link lfa-candidate interface type interface-path-id { level { 1 | 2 }} • fast-reroute per-prefix lfa-candidate interface type interface-path-id { level { 1 | 2 }} Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if-af)#fast-reroute per-link lfa-candidate interface MgmtEth0/RP0/CPU0/0 level 1 Or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if-af)#fast-reroute per-prefix lfa-candidate interface MgmtEth0/RP1/CPU0/0 level 2 Step 10 Do one of the following: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if-af)# end before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]: or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-af)# commit ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returnsthe router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 265 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring IP/LDP Fast RerouteCommand or Action Purpose Configuring IS-IS Overload Bit Avoidance This task describes how to activate IS-IS overload bit avoidance. Before You Begin The IS-IS overload bit avoidance feature is valid only on networks that support the following Cisco IOS XR features: • MPLS • IS-IS SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. mpls traffic-eng path-selection ignore overload DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 mpls traffic-eng path-selection ignore overload Activates IS-IS overload bit avoidance. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# mpls traffic-eng path-selection ignore overload Step 2 Configuration Examples for Implementing IS-IS This section provides the following configuration examples: Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 266 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring IS-IS Overload Bit AvoidanceConfiguring Single-Topology IS-IS for IPv6: Example The following example shows single-topology mode being enabled. An IS-IS instance is created, the NET is defined, IPv6 is configured along with IPv4 on an interface, and IPv4 link topology is used for IPv6. This configuration allows POS interface 0/3/0/0 to form adjacencies for both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. router isis isp net 49.0000.0000.0001.00 address-family ipv6 unicast single-topology interface POS0/3/0/0 address-family ipv4 unicast ! address-family ipv6 unicast ! exit ! interface POS0/3/0/0 ipv4 address 10.0.1.3 255.255.255.0 ipv6 address 2001::1/64 Configuring Multitopology IS-IS for IPv6: Example The following example shows multitopology IS-IS being configured in IPv6. router isis isp net 49.0000.0000.0001.00 interface POS0/3/0/0 address-family ipv6 unicast metric-style wide level 1 exit ! interface POS0/3/0/0 ipv6 address 2001::1/64 Redistributing IS-IS Routes Between Multiple Instances: Example The following example shows usage of the set- attached-bit and redistribute commands. Two instances, instance “1” restricted to Level 1 and instance “2” restricted to Level 2, are configured. The Level 1 instance is propagating routes to the Level 2 instance using redistribution. Note that the administrative distance is explicitly configured higher on the Level 2 instance to ensure that Level 1 routes are preferred. Attached bit is being set for the Level 1 instance since it is redistributing routes into the Level 2 instance. Therefore, instance “1” is a suitable candidate to get from the area to the backbone. router isis 1 is-type level-2-only net 49.0001.0001.0001.0001.00 address-family ipv4 unicast distance 116 redistribute isis 2 level 2 ! interface GigabitEthernet 0/3/0/0 address-family ipv4 unicast Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 267 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Configuring Single-Topology IS-IS for IPv6: Example! ! router isis 2 is-type level-1 net 49.0002.0001.0001.0002.00 address-family ipv4 unicast set -attached -bit ! interface GigabitEthernet 0/1/0/0 address-family ipv4 unicast Tagging Routes: Example The following example shows how to tag routes. route-policy isis-tag-55 end-policy ! route-policy isis-tag-555 if destination in (5.5.5.0/24 eq 24) then set tag 555 pass else drop endif end-policy ! router static address-family ipv4 unicast 0.0.0.0/0 2.6.0.1 5.5.5.0/24 Null0 ! ! router isis uut net 00.0000.0000.12a5.00 address-family ipv4 unicast metric-style wide redistribute static level-1 route-policy isis-tag-555 spf prefix-priority critical tag 13 spf prefix-priority high tag 444 spf prefix-priority medium tag 777 Configuring IS-IS Overload Bit Avoidance: Example The following example shows how to activate IS-IS overload bit avoidance: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# config RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# mpls traffic-eng path-selection ignore overload RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# The following example shows how to deactivate IS-IS overload bit avoidance: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# config RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# no mpls traffic-eng path-selection ignore overload RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 268 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Tagging Routes: ExampleWhere to Go Next To implement more IP routing protocols, see the following document modules in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide: • Implementing OSPF • Implementing BGP • Implementing EIGRP • Implementing RIP Additional References The following sections provide references related to implementing IS-IS. Related Documents Related Topic Document Title Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Command Reference IS-IS commands: complete command syntax, command modes, command history, defaults, usage guidelines, and examples Implementing MPLS Traffic Engineering on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide MPLS TE feature information Intermediate System-to-Intermediate System (IS-IS) TLVs at: http://www.cisco.com/en/US/tech/tk365/ technologies_tech_note09186a0080094bbd.shtml IS-IS TLVs Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Interface and Hardware Component Configuration Guide and Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Interface and Hardware Component Command Reference Bidirectional Forwarding Detection (BFD) Standards Standards Title Draft-ietf-isis-ipv6-05.txt Routing IPv6 with IS-IS, by Christian E. Hopps M-ISIS: Multi Topology (MT) Routing in IS-IS, by Tony Przygienda, Naiming Shen, and Nischal Sheth Draft-ietf-isis-wg-multi-topology-06.txt Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 269 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Where to Go NextStandards Title IS-IS Extensions for Traffic Engineering, by Henk Smit and Toni Li Draft-ietf-isis-traffic-05.txt Restart Signaling for IS-IS, by M. Shand and Les Ginsberg Draft-ietf-isis-restart-04.txt Point-to-point operation over LAN in link-state routing protocols, by Naiming Shen Draft-ietf-isis-igp-p2p-over-lan-05.txt IP Fast Reroute Framework, by M. Shand and S. Bryant Draft-ietf-rtgwg-ipfrr-framework-06.txt A Framework for Loop-free Convergence, by M. Shand and S. Bryant Draft-ietf-rtgwg-lf-conv-frmwk-00.txt MIBs MIBs MIBs Link To locate and download MIBs using Cisco IOS XR software, use the Cisco MIB Locator found at the following URL and choose a platform under the Cisco Access Products menu: http://cisco.com/public/ sw-center/netmgmt/cmtk/mibs.shtml — RFCs RFCs Title RFC 1142 OSI IS-IS Intra-domain Routing Protocol Use of OSI IS-IS for Routing in TCP/IP and Dual Environments RFC 1195 RFC 2763 Dynamic Hostname Exchange Mechanism for IS-IS Domain-wide Prefix Distribution with Two-Level IS-IS RFC 2966 RFC 2973 IS-IS Mesh Groups RFC 3277 IS-IS Transient Blackhole Avoidance Three-Way Handshake for IS-IS Point-to-Point Adjacencies RFC 3373 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 270 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional ReferencesRFCs Title RFC 3567 IS-IS Cryptographic Authentication RFC 4444 IS-IS Management Information Base Technical Assistance Description Link The Cisco Technical Support website contains http://www.cisco.com/techsupport thousands of pages of searchable technical content, including links to products, technologies, solutions, technical tips, and tools. Registered Cisco.com users can log in from this page to access even more content. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 271 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional References Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 272 OL-26048-02 Implementing IS-IS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Additional ReferencesC H A P T E R 4 Implementing OSPF on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Open Shortest Path First (OSPF) is an Interior Gateway Protocol (IGP) developed by the OSPF working group of the Internet Engineering Task Force (IETF). Designed expressly for IP networks, OSPF supports IP subnetting and tagging of externally derived routing information. OSPF also allows packet authentication and uses IP multicast when sending and receiving packets. OSPF Version 3 (OSPFv3) expands on OSPF Version 2, providing support for IPv6 routing prefixes. This module describes the concepts and tasks you need to implement both versions of OSPF on your Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router . The term “OSPF? implies both versions of the routing protocol, unless otherwise noted. For more information about OSPF on Cisco IOS XR software and complete descriptions of the OSPF commandslisted in this module,see the Related Documents, on page 378 section of this module. To locate documentation for other commands that might appear during execution of a configuration task, search online in the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Commands Master List Note Feature History for Implementing OSPF Release Modification Release 3.7.2 This feature was introduced. Support was added for the following features: • OSPFv2 SPF Prefix Prioritization. • IP fast reroute loop-free alternates computation • Warm Standby for OSPF Version 3 Release 3.9.0 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26048-02 273 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x Americas Headquarters Cisco Systems, Inc. 170 West Tasman Drive San Jose, CA 95134-1706 USA http://www.cisco.com Tel: 408 526-4000 800 553-NETS (6387) Fax: 408 527-0883 Text Part Number: OL-26127-02© 2012 Cisco Systems, Inc. All rights reserved.C O N T E N T S P r e f a c e Preface v Changes to this Document v Obtaining Documentation and Submitting a Service Request v C H A P T E R 1 Configuring NetFlow 1 Prerequisites for Configuring NetFlow 2 Restrictions for Configuring NetFlow 2 Information About Configuring NetFlow 2 NetFlow Overview 2 Monitor Map Overview 3 Sampler Map Overview 3 Exporter Map Overview 3 NetFlow Configuration Submodes 4 Flow Exporter Map Configuration Submode 5 Flow Exporter Map Version Configuration Submode 5 Flow Monitor Map Configuration Submode 6 Sampler Map Configuration Submode 6 Enabling the NetFlow BGP Data Export Function 6 MPLS Flow Monitor with IPv4 and IPv6 Support 7 MPLS Cache Reorganization to Support Both IPv4 and IPv6 7 MPLS Packets with IPv6 Flows 7 Destination-based NetFlow Accounting 8 How to Configure NetFlow on Cisco IOS XR Software 9 Configuring an Exporter Map 9 Configuring a Sampler Map 12 Configuring a Monitor Map 14 Applying a Monitor Map and a Sampler Map to an Interface 18 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26127-02 iiiClearing NetFlow Data 19 Configuring NetFlow Collection of MPLS Packets with IPv6 Fields 20 Configuring Destination-based NetFlow Accounting 25 Trident Netflow 27 Supported features 27 Punt path policer rate 27 Calculating Punt path policer rate 27 Trident base line cards supported features 28 Configuration Examples for NetFlow 28 Sampler Map: Example 28 Exporter Map: Example 28 Flow Monitor Map: Examples 29 MPLS Flow Monitor with IPv4 and IPv6 Support: Examples 30 Destination-based NetFlow Accounting: Example 30 Additional References 31 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x iv OL-26127-02 ContentsPreface This guide describes the Cisco IOS XR Netflow configurations. The preface for the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration guide contains the following sections • Changes to this Document, page v • Obtaining Documentation and Submitting a Service Request, page v Changes to this Document This table lists the changes made to this document since it was first printed Revision Date Change Summary Republished with documentation updates for Cisco IOS XR Release 4.2.1 OL-26127-02 June 2012 OL-26127-01 December 2011 Initial release of this document. Obtaining Documentation and Submitting a Service Request For information on obtaining documentation,submitting a service request, and gathering additional information, see the monthly What's New in Cisco Product Documentation, which also lists all new and revised Cisco technical documentation, at: http://www.cisco.com/en/US/docs/general/whatsnew/whatsnew.html Subscribe to the What's New in Cisco Product Documentation as a Really Simple Syndication (RSS) feed and set content to be delivered directly to your desktop using a reader application. The RSS feeds are a free service and Cisco currently supports RSS version 2.0. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26127-02 v Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x vi OL-26127-02 Preface Obtaining Documentation and Submitting a Service RequestC H A P T E R 1 Configuring NetFlow This module describes the configuration of NetFlow . A NetFlow flow is a unidirectional sequence of packets that arrive on a single interface (or subinterface), and have the same values for key fields. NetFlow is useful for the following: • Accounting/Billing—NetFlow data provides fine grained metering for highly flexible and detailed resource utilization accounting. • Network Planning and Analysis—NetFlow data provides key information forstrategic network planning. • Network Monitoring—NetFlow data enables near real-time network monitoring capabilities. Feature History for Configuring NetFlow Release Modification Release 3.9.1 This feature was introduced. Release 4.0.0 IPv6 Sampled NetFlow feature was introduced. Release 4.2.0 Destination-based Netflow Accounting feature was introduced. This module includes the following sections: • Prerequisites for Configuring NetFlow, page 2 • Restrictions for Configuring NetFlow, page 2 • Information About Configuring NetFlow, page 2 • How to Configure NetFlow on Cisco IOS XR Software, page 9 • Configuration Examples for NetFlow, page 28 • Additional References, page 31 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26127-02 1Prerequisites for Configuring NetFlow To perform these configuration tasks, your Cisco IOS XR software system administrator must assign you to a user group associated with a task group that includes the corresponding command task IDs. If you need assistance with your task group assignment, contact your system administrator. Restrictions for Configuring NetFlow Consider the following restrictions when configuring NetFlow in Cisco IOS XR software: • You must configure a source interface. If you do not configure a source interface, the exporter will remain in a disabled state. • Supports export format Version 9 only. • You must configure a valid record map name for every flow monitor map. We recommend that you do not use the management interface to export NetFlow packets. Exporting the management interface does not work efficiently. Tip Information About Configuring NetFlow To implement NetFlow, you must understand the following concepts: NetFlow Overview A flow is exported as part of a NetFlow export User Datagram Protocol (UDP) datagram under the following circumstances: • The flow has been inactive or active for too long. • The flow cache is getting full. • One of the counters (packets and or bytes) has wrapped. • The user forces the flow to export. NetFlow export UDP datagrams are sent to an external flow collector device that provides NetFlow export data filtering and aggregation. The export of data consists of expired flows and control information. The NetFlow infrastructure is based on the configuration and use of the following maps: • Monitor map • Sampler map • Exporter map Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 2 OL-26127-02 Configuring NetFlow Prerequisites for Configuring NetFlowThese maps are described in the sections that follow. Monitor Map Overview A monitor map contains name references to the flow record map and flow exporter map. Monitor maps are applied to an interface. You can configure the following monitor map attributes: • Number of entries in the flow cache • Type of cache (permanent or normal). Permanent caches do not have their entries removed from the cache unless they are explicitly cleared by the user • Active flow timeout • Inactive flow timeout • Update timeout • Default timeouts • Record type of packets sampled and collected The record name specifiesthe type of packetsthat NetFlow samples asthey passthrough the router. Currently, MPLS, IPv4, and IPv6 packet sampling is supported. Note The active flow and inactive flow timeouts are associated with a normal cache type. The update timeout is associated with the permanent cache type. Note Sampler Map Overview The sampler map specifies the rate at which packets (one out of n packets) are sampled. On high bandwidth interfaces, applying NetFlow processing to every single packet can result in significant CPU utilization. Sampler map configuration is typically geared towards such high speed interfaces. The Policer rate is based on the network processor (NP). If netflow is applied on 1 NP, the aggregated maximum flow packet processing rate per line card (LC) is 100k flow packets per second (irrespective of the direction and the number of interface netflow that is applied in that NP). However, depending on the Netflow monitor configuration distribution among NPs in an LC, policing of flow packet can take effect with an aggregated rate that is less than 100k. For example, if Netflow is applied to 1 interface per NP in a 4 NP LC, then the Policer rate per NP is 25K packets per second. Exporter Map Overview An exporter map contains user network specification and transport layer detailsfor the NetFlow export packet. The flow exporter-map command allows you to configure collector and version attributes. You can configure the following collector information: Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26127-02 3 Configuring NetFlow Monitor Map Overview• Export destination IP address • DSCP value for export packet • Source interface • UDP port number (This is where the collector is listening for NetFlow packets.) • Transport protocol for export packets Note In Cisco IOS XR Software, UDP is the only supported transport protocol for export packets. NetFlow export packets use the IP address that is assigned to the source interface. If the source interface does not have an IP address assigned to it, the exporter will be inactive. Note You can also configure the following export version attributes: • Template timeout • Template data timeout • Template options timeout • Interface table timeout • Sampler table timeout Note A single flow monitor map can support up to eight exporters. NetFlow Configuration Submodes In Cisco IOS XR Software, NetFlow map configuration takes place in map-specific submodes. Cisco IOS XR Software supports the following NetFlow map configuration submodes: The Cisco IOS XR Software allows you to issue most commands available under submodes as one single command string from global configuration mode. For example, you can issue the record ipv4 command from the flow monitor map configuration submode as follows: Note RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# flow monitor-map fmm RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# record ipv4 Alternatively, you can issue the same command from global configuration mode, as shown in the following example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# flow monitor-map fmm record ipv4 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 4 OL-26127-02 Configuring NetFlow NetFlow Configuration SubmodesFlow Exporter Map Configuration Submode When you issue the flow exporter-map fem-name command in global configuration mode, the command-line interface (CLI) prompt changes to “config-fem,” indicating that you have entered the flow exporter map configuration submode. In the following sample output, the question mark (?) online help function displays all the commands available under the flow exporter map configuration submode: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# flow exporter-map fem RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem)# ? clear Clear the uncommitted configuration clear Clear the configuration commit Commit the configuration changes to running describe Describe a command without taking real actions destination Export destination configuration do Run an exec command dscp Specify DSCP value for export packets exit Exit from this submode no Negate a command or set its defaults pwd Commands used to reach current submode root Exit to the global configuration mode show Show contents of configuration source Source interface transport Specify the transport protocol for export packets version Specify export version parameters Note If you enter the version command, you enter the flow exporter map version configuration submode. Note A single flow monitor map can support up to eight exporters. Flow Exporter Map Version Configuration Submode When you issue the version v9 command in the flow exporter map configuration submode, the CLI prompt changes to “config-fem-ver,” indicating that you have entered the flow exporter map version configuration submode. In the following sample output, the question mark (?) online help function displays all the commands available under the flow exporter map version configuration submode: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem)# version v9 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem-ver)# ? commit Commit the configuration changes to running describe Describe a command without taking real actions do Run an exec command exit Exit from this submode no Negate a command or set its defaults options Specify export of options template show Show contents of configuration template Specify template export parameters Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26127-02 5 Configuring NetFlow NetFlow Configuration SubmodesFlow Monitor Map Configuration Submode When you issue the flow monitor-map map_name command in global configuration mode, the CLI prompt changes to “config-fmm,” indicating that you have entered the flow monitor map configuration submode. In the following sample output, the question mark (?) online help function displays all the commands available under the flow monitor map configuration submode: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# flow monitor-map fmm RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# ? cache Specify flow cache attributes commit Commit the configuration changes to running describe Describe a command without taking real actions do Run an exec command exit Exit from this submode exporter Specify flow exporter map name no Negate a command or set its defaults record Specify a flow record map name show Show contents of configuration Sampler Map Configuration Submode When you issue the sampler-map map_name command in global configuration mode, the CLI prompt changes to “config-sm,” indicating that you have entered the sampler map configuration submode. In the following sample output, the question mark (?) online help function displays all the commands available under the sampler map configuration submode: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0(config)# sampler-map fmm RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-sm)# ? clear Clear the uncommitted configuration clear Clear the configuration commit Commit the configuration changes to running describe Describe a command without taking real actions do Run an exec command exit Exit from this submode no Negate a command or set its defaults pwd Commands used to reach current submode random Use random mode for sampling packets root Exit to the global configuration mode show Show contents of configuration RP/0/RSP0/CPU0(config-sm)#RP/0/RP0/CP0:router(config-sm)# Enabling the NetFlow BGP Data Export Function Use the bgp attribute-download command to enable NetFlow BGP routing attribute collection. The routing attributes are then exported. When no routing attributes are collected, zeroes (0) are exported. When BGP attribute download is enabled, BGP downloads the attribute information for prefixes (community, extended community, and as-path) to the Routing Information Base (RIB) and Forwarding Information Base (FIB). This enables FIB to associate the prefixes with attributes and send the NetFlow statistics along with the associated attributes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 6 OL-26127-02 Configuring NetFlow NetFlow Configuration SubmodesMPLS Flow Monitor with IPv4 and IPv6 Support Cisco IOS XR Software supports the NetFlow collection of MPLS packets. It also supports the NetFlow collection of MPLS packets carrying IPv4, IPv6, or both IPv4 and IPv6 payloads. MPLS Cache Reorganization to Support Both IPv4 and IPv6 In Cisco IOS XR Software, at a time, you can have only one MPLS flow monitor running on an interface. If you apply an additional MPLS flow monitor to the interface, the new flow monitor overwrites the existing one. At a time, you can apply only one flow monitor on an interface per direction. You can apply either the same flow monitor to an interface in both directions, or each direction can have its own flow monitor. You can configure the MPLS flow monitor to collect IPv4 fields, IPv6 fields, or IPv4-IPv6 fields. IPv4-IPv6 configuration collects both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses using one MPLS flow monitor. IPv4 configuration collects only IPv4 addresses. IPv6 configuration collects only IPv6 addresses. The MPLS flow monitor supports up to 1,000,000 cache entries. NetFlow entries include the following types of fields: • IPv4 fields • IPv6 fields • MPLS with IPv4 fields • MPLS with IPv6 fields The maximum number of bytes per NetFlow cache entry is as follows: • IPv4–88 bytes per entry • MPLS–88 bytes per entry • IPv6–108 bytes per entry • MPLS with IPv4 fields–108 bytes per entry • MPLS with IPv6 fields–128 bytes per entry The different types of NetFlow entries are stored in separate caches. Consequently, the number of NetFlow entries on a line card can significantly impact the amount of available memory on the line card. Also, even though the sampling rate for IPv6 is the same as the sampling rate for IPv4, the CPU utilization for IPv6 is higher due to the longer keys used by the IPv6 fields. Note MPLS Packets with IPv6 Flows The collection of IPv6 flows in MPLS packets is an option. The CPU uses 128 bytes for each IPv6 field. IPv6 flows may contain the following types of information: • Source IP address Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26127-02 7 Configuring NetFlow MPLS Flow Monitor with IPv4 and IPv6 Support• Destination IP address • Traffic class value • Layer 4 protocol number • Layer 4 source port number • Layer 4 destination port number • Flow ID • Header option mask To collect the IPv6 fields in MPLS packets, you must activate the MPLS record type, ipv6-fields by running the record mpls ipv6-fields command. You can also specify the number of labels to be used for aggregation with this command. Destination-based NetFlow Accounting Destination-based NetFlow accounting (DBA) is a usage-based billing application that tracks and records traffic according to its destination and enables service providers to do destination-specific accounting and billing. The destination-based NetFlow accounting record includes the destination peer autonomous system (AS) number and the BGP next-hop IP address. DBA is supported on ASR9000 Gigabit Ethernet and ASR9000 Enhanced Gigabit Ethernet linecards. In destination-based NetFlow accounting, the following fields are collected and exported: • Destination peer AS number • BGP next-hop IP address • Ingress interface • Egress interface • Forwarding status • Incoming IPv4 TOS • Counter of packets in the flow • Counter of bytes in the flow • Timestamp for the first and last packets in the flow Destination-based NetFlow accounting supports the following features: • Only IPv4 addresses • Configuration on physical interfaces, bundle interfaces, and logical subinterfaces • IPv4 unicast and multicast traffic • Only ingress traffic • Only full mode NetFlow • NetFlow export format Version 9 over User Datagram Protocols (UDPs) Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 8 OL-26127-02 Configuring NetFlow Destination-based NetFlow AccountingDestination-based NetFlow accounting does not support the following features : • IPv6 addresses • MPLS IPv4 and IPv6 • Configuration for individual Modular QoS Command-Line Interface (MQC) classes • Simultaneous configuration of destination-based NetFlow accounting with IPv4 sampled NetFlow on the same interface, in the same direction. • Layer 2 switched MPLS traffic • Egress traffic • Sampled mode NetFlow • NetFlow export formats version 5, version 8, IP Flow Information Export (IPFIX), or Stream Control Transmission Protocol (SCTP). How to Configure NetFlow on Cisco IOS XR Software The steps that follow provide a general overview of NetFlow configuration: SUMMARY STEPS 1. Create and configure an exporter map. 2. Create and configure a monitor map and a sampler map. 3. Apply the monitor map and sampler map to an interface. DETAILED STEPS Step 1 Create and configure an exporter map. Step 2 Create and configure a monitor map and a sampler map. The monitor map must reference the exporter map you created in Step 1. If you do not apply an exporter-map to the monitor-map, the flow records are not exported, and aging is done according to the cache parameters specified in the monitor-map. Note Step 3 Apply the monitor map and sampler map to an interface. These steps are described in detail in the following sections: Configuring an Exporter Map Configure an exporter map and apply it to the monitor map with the flow monitor-map map_name exporter map_name command. You can configure the exporter map prior to configuring the monitor map, or you can configure the monitor map first and then configure and apply an exporter map later on. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26127-02 9 Configuring NetFlow How to Configure NetFlow on Cisco IOS XR SoftwareNote Cisco IOS XR Software supports the configuration of a single collector only in the exporter map. The steps that follow describe how to create and configure an exporter map. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. flow exporter-map map_name 3. destination hostname_or_IP_address 4. dscp dscp_value 5. source type interface-path-id 6. transport udp port 7. version v9 8. options {interface-table | sampler-table} [timeout seconds] 9. template [data | options] timeout seconds 10. Use one of these commands: • end • commit 11. exit 12. exit 13. show flow exporter-map map_name DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Creates an exporter map, configures the exporter map name, and enters flow exporter map configuration mode. flow exporter-map map_name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# flow exporter-map fem Step 2 Configures the export destination for the flow exporter map. The destination can be a hostname or an IP address. destination hostname_or_IP_address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem)# destination nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn Step 3 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 10 OL-26127-02 Configuring NetFlow Configuring an Exporter MapCommand or Action Purpose (Optional) Specifies the differentiated services codepoint (DSCP) value for export packets. Replace the dscp_value argument with a value in the range from 0 through 63. dscp dscp_value Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem)# dscp 55 Step 4 source type interface-path-id Specifies a source interface, in the format type interface-path-id. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem)# source gigabitEthernet 0/0/0/0 Step 5 (Optional) Specifiesthe destination port for UDP packets. Replace port with the destination UDP port value, in the range from 1024 through 65535. transport udp port Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem)# transport udp 9991 Step 6 (Optional) Enters flow exporter map version configuration submode. version v9 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem-ver)# version v9 Step 7 (Optional) Configures the export timeout value for the sampler table. Replace seconds with the export timeout value, in the range from 1 through 604800 seconds. options {interface-table | sampler-table} [timeout seconds] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem-ver)# options sampler-table timeout 2000 Step 8 Default is 1800 seconds. (Optional) Configures the export period for data packets. Replace seconds with the export timeout value, in the range from 1 through 604800 seconds. template [data | options] timeout seconds Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem-ver)# template data timeout 10000 Step 9 Step 10 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yessaves configuration changesto the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26127-02 11 Configuring NetFlow Configuring an Exporter MapCommand or Action Purpose ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. exit Exits flow exporter map version configuration submode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem-ver)# exit Step 11 exit Enters EXEC mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# exit Step 12 show flow exporter-map map_name Displays exporter map data. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show flow exporter-map fem Step 13 Configuring a Sampler Map The steps that follow describe how to create and configure a sampler map. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 12 OL-26127-02 Configuring NetFlow Configuring a Sampler MapSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. sampler-map map_name 3. random 1 out-of sampling_interval 4. Use one of these commands: • end • commit 5. exit 6. exit 7. show sampler-map map_name DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router configure Step 1 Step 2 sampler-map map_name Creates a sampler map and enters sampler map configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# Keep the following in mind when configuring a sampler map: • • sampler-map sm RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-sm)# Configures the sampling interval to use random mode for sampling packets. Replace the sampling_interval argument with a number, in the range from 1 through 65535 units. random 1 out-of sampling_interval Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-sm)# random 1 out-of 65535 Step 3 Step 4 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exitsthe configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26127-02 13 Configuring NetFlow Configuring a Sampler MapCommand or Action Purpose ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leavesthe router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Exits sampler map configuration mode and enters global configuration mode. exit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-sm)# exit Step 5 exit Exits global configuration mode and enters EXEC mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# exit Step 6 show sampler-map map_name Displays sampler map data. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show sampler-map fsm Step 7 Configuring a Monitor Map The steps that follow describe how to create and configure a monitor map. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 14 OL-26127-02 Configuring NetFlow Configuring a Monitor MapSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. flow monitor-map map_name 3. Do one of the following: • record ipv4 • record ipv4 [peer as] • record ipv6 • record mpls [labels number] • record mpls [ipv4-fields] [labels number] • record mpls [ipv6-fields] [labels number] • record mpls [ipv4-ipv6-fields] [labels number] 4. cache entries number 5. cache permanent 6. cache timeout {active timeout_value | inactive timeout_value | update timeout_value} 7. exporter map_name 8. Use one of these commands: • end • commit 9. exit 10. exit 11. show flow monitor-map map_name DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Creates a monitor map and configures a monitor map name and entersflow monitor map configuration submode. flow monitor-map map_name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# flow Step 2 monitor-map fmm RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# Step 3 Do one of the following: Configures the flow record map name for IPv4, IPv6, or MPLS. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26127-02 15 Configuring NetFlow Configuring a Monitor MapCommand or Action Purpose • Use the record ipv4 command to configure the flow record map name for IPv4. By default, you collect and export the originating autonomous system (AS) numbers. • record ipv4 • record ipv4 [peer as] • record ipv6 • Use the record ipv4 [peer as] command to record peer AS. Here, you collect and export the peer AS numbers. • record mpls [labels number] • record mpls [ipv4-fields] [labels number] Ensure that the bgp attribute-download command is configured. Else, no AS is collected when the record ipv4 [peer-as] command is configured. Note • record mpls [ipv6-fields] [labels number] • Use the record ipv6 command to configure the flow record map name for IPv6. • record mpls [ipv4-ipv6-fields] [labels number] • Use the record mpls labels command with the number argument to specify the number of labels that you want to aggregate. By default, Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# record ipv4 MPLS-aware NetFlow aggregates the top six labels of the MPLS label stack. The maximum value is 6. • Use the record mpls ipv4-fields command to collect IPv4 fields in the MPLS-aware NetFlow. • Use the record mpls ipv6-fields command to collect IPV6 fields in the MPLS-aware NetFlow. • Use the record mpls ipv4-ipv6-fields command to collect IPv4 and IPv6 fields in the MPLS-aware NetFlow. (Optional) Configures the number of entries in the flow cache. Replace the number argument with the number of flow entries allowed in the flow cache, in the range from 4096 through 1000000. cache entries number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# cache entries 10000 Step 4 The default number of cache entries is 65535. cache permanent (Optional) Disables removal of entries from flow cache. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# flow monitor-map fmm cache permanent Step 5 (Optional) Configures the active, inactive, or update flow cache timeout value. cache timeout {active timeout_value | inactive timeout_value | update timeout_value} Step 6 • The default timeout value for the inactive flow cache is 15 seconds. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# cache timeout inactive 1000 • The default timeout value for the active flow cache is 1800 seconds. • The default timeout value for the update flow cache is 1800 seconds. The update timeout_value keyword argument is used for permanent caches only. It specifies the timeout value that is used to export entries from permanent caches. In this case, the entries are exported but remain the cache. Note Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 16 OL-26127-02 Configuring NetFlow Configuring a Monitor MapCommand or Action Purpose Step 7 exporter map_name Associates an exporter map with a monitor map. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# exporter fem A single flow monitor map can support up to eight exporters. Note Step 8 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit ? Entering no exitsthe configuration session and returnsthe router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. exit Exits flow monitor map configuration submode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# exit Step 9 exit Exits global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# exit Step 10 show flow monitor-map map_name Displays flow monitor map data. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show flow monitor-map fmm Step 11 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26127-02 17 Configuring NetFlow Configuring a Monitor MapApplying a Monitor Map and a Sampler Map to an Interface SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. interface type number 3. flow [ipv4 | ipv6 | mpls] monitor monitor_map sampler sampler_map {egress | ingress} 4. Use one of these commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 interface type number Enters interface configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# interface Step 2 gigabitEthernet 0/0/0/0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# flow [ipv4 | ipv6 | mpls] monitor monitor_map Associates a monitor map and a sampler map with an interface. sampler sampler_map {egress | ingress} Step 3 Enter ipv4 to enable IPV4 NetFlow on the specified interface. Enter ipv6 to enable IPV6 NetFlow on the specified interface. Enter mpls to enable Example: MPLS-aware NetFlow on the specified interface. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# flow ipv4 monitor fmm sampler fsm egress Step 4 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 18 OL-26127-02 Configuring NetFlow Applying a Monitor Map and a Sampler Map to an InterfaceCommand or Action Purpose ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Clearing NetFlow Data The steps that follow describe how to clear flow exporter map and flow monitor map data. SUMMARY STEPS 1. clear flow exporter [exporter_name] {restart | statistics} location node-id 2. clear flow monitor [monitor_name] cache [force-export | statistics] location node-id} DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose clear flow exporter [exporter_name] {restart |statistics} Clears the flow exporter data. location node-id Step 1 Specify the statistics option to clear exporter statistics. Specify the restart option to export all of the templatesthat are currently Example: configured on the specified node. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# clear flow exporter statistics location 0/0/CPU0 clear flow monitor [monitor_name] cache [force-export Clears the flow monitor data. | statistics] location node-id} Step 2 Specify the statistics option to clear cache statistics. Specify the force-export option to export the data from cache to server Example: first and then clear the entries from cache. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# clear flow monitor cache force-export location 0/0/CPU0 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26127-02 19 Configuring NetFlow Clearing NetFlow DataConfiguring NetFlow Collection of MPLS Packets with IPv6 Fields The following steps show how to configure NetFlow collection of MPLS packets with IPv6 fields. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. flow exporter-map map_name 3. version v9 4. options {interface-table | sampler-table} [timeout seconds] 5. template [data | options] timeout seconds 6. exit 7. transport udp port 8. source type interface-path-id 9. destination hostname_or_IP_address 10. exit 11. flow monitor-map map_name 12. record mpls [ipv4-ipv6-fields] [labels number] 13. exporter map_name 14. cache entries number 15. cache timeout {active timeout_value | inactive timeout_value | update timeout_value} 16. cache permanent 17. exit 18. sampler-map map_name 19. random 1 out-of sampling_interval 20. exit 21. interface type number 22. flow [ipv4 | ipv6 | mpls] monitor monitor_map sampler sampler_map {egress | ingress} 23. Use one of these commands: • end • commit 24. exit 25. exit 26. show flow monitor-map map_name 27. show flow exporter-map map_name Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 20 OL-26127-02 Configuring NetFlow Configuring NetFlow Collection of MPLS Packets with IPv6 FieldsDETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Creates an exporter map, configures the exporter map name, and enters flow exporter map configuration mode. flow exporter-map map_name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# flow Step 2 exporter-map exp1 version v9 (Optional) Entersflow exporter map version configuration submode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem)# version Step 3 v9 (Optional) Configures the export timeout value for the interface table or the sampler table. Replace seconds with the export timeout options {interface-table | sampler-table} [timeout seconds] Step 4 value, in the range from 1 through 604800 seconds. The default is 1800 seconds for both the interface table and the sample table. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem-ver)# options interface-table timeout 300 You must perform this step twice to configure the export timeout value for both an interface table and a sample table. (Optional) Configures the export period for data packets or options packets. Replace seconds with the export timeout value, in the range from 1 through 604800 seconds. template [data | options] timeout seconds Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem-ver)# template data timeout 300 Step 5 You must perform this step twice to configure the export period for both data packets and options packets. Exits flow exporter map version configuration mode, and enters flow exporter map configuration mode. exit Example: RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem-ver)# exit Step 6 (Optional) Specifies the destination port for UDP packets. Replace port with the destination UDP port value, in the range from 1024 through 65535. transport udp port Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem)# transport udp 12515 Step 7 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26127-02 21 Configuring NetFlow Configuring NetFlow Collection of MPLS Packets with IPv6 FieldsCommand or Action Purpose Specifies a source interface, in the format type interface-path-id. For example: POS 0/1/0/1 or Loopback0 source type interface-path-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem)# source Loopback0 Step 8 Configures the export destination for the flow exporter map. The destination can be a hostname or an IP address. destination hostname_or_IP_address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem)# destination 170.1.1.11 Step 9 Exits flow exporter map configuration mode, and enters flow exporter map configuration mode. exit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem)# exit Step 10 Creates a monitor map and configures a monitor map name and enters flow monitor map configuration submode. flow monitor-map map_name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# flow monitor-map MPLS-IPv6-fmm Step 11 Configures the flow record map name for IPv4, IPv6, or MPLS. Use the ipv4-ipv6-fields keyword to collect IPv4 and IPv6 fields in an MPLS-aware NetFlow. record mpls [ipv4-ipv6-fields] [labels number] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# record mpls ipv6-fields labels 3 Step 12 Step 13 exporter map_name Associates an exporter map with a monitor map. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# exporter exp1 A single flow monitor map can support up to eight exporters. Note (Optional) Configures the number of entries in the flow cache. Replace the number argument with the number of flow entries allowed in the flow cache, in the range from 4096 through 1000000. cache entries number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# cache entries 10000 Step 14 The default number of cache entries is 65535. (Optional) Configures the active, inactive, or update flow cache timeout value. cache timeout {active timeout_value | inactive timeout_value | update timeout_value} Step 15 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# cache timeout inactive 1800 • The default timeout value for the inactive flow cache is 15 seconds. • The default timeout value for the active flow cache is 1800 seconds. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 22 OL-26127-02 Configuring NetFlow Configuring NetFlow Collection of MPLS Packets with IPv6 FieldsCommand or Action Purpose • The default timeout value for the update flow cache is 1800 seconds. The inactive and active keywords are not applicable to permanent caches. Note The update keyword is used for permanent caches only. It specifies the timeout value that is used to export entries from permanent caches. In this case, the entries are exported but remain the cache. Note cache permanent (Optional) Disables the removal of entries from flow cache. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# flow monitor-map fmm cache permanent Step 16 exit Exits flow monitor map configuration submode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# exit Step 17 Step 18 sampler-map map_name Creates a sampler map and enterssampler map configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# sampler-map Keep the following in mind when configuring a sampler map: fsm RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-sm)# Configures the sampling interval to use random mode for sampling packets. Replace the sampling_interval argument with a number, in the range from 1 through 65535 units. random 1 out-of sampling_interval Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-sm)# random 1 out-of 65535 Step 19 Exits sampler map configuration mode and enters global configuration mode. exit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-sm)#exit Step 20 interface type number Enters interface configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# interface Step 21 gigabitEthernet 0/0/0/0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# flow [ipv4 | ipv6 | mpls] monitor monitor_map Associates a monitor map and a sampler map with an interface. sampler sampler_map {egress | ingress} Step 22 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26127-02 23 Configuring NetFlow Configuring NetFlow Collection of MPLS Packets with IPv6 FieldsCommand or Action Purpose Enter ipv4 to enable IPV4 NetFlow on the specified interface. Enter ipv6 to enable IPV6 NetFlow on the specified interface. Enter mpls to enable MPLS-aware NetFlow on the specified interface. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# flow ipv4 monitor MPLS-IPv6-fmm sampler fsm egress Step 23 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. exit Exits interface configuration submode for the Ethernet interface. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# exit Step 24 exit Exits global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# exit Step 25 show flow monitor-map map_name Displays flow monitor map data. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show flow monitor-map fmm Step 26 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 24 OL-26127-02 Configuring NetFlow Configuring NetFlow Collection of MPLS Packets with IPv6 FieldsCommand or Action Purpose show flow exporter-map map_name Displays exporter map data. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show flow exporter-map fem Step 27 Configuring Destination-based NetFlow Accounting You configure destination-based NetFlow accounting by configuring the flow monitor map, flow record, and flow monitor as described in the following steps. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. flow monitor-map map_name 3. record ipv4 destination 4. exit 5. interface type interface-path-id 6. flow ipv4 monitor name ingress 7. Use one of these commands: • end • commit 8. show flow exporter-map map_name DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Creates a monitor map and configures a monitor map name and enters flow monitor map configuration submode. flow monitor-map map_name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# flow Step 2 monitor-map map1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26127-02 25 Configuring NetFlow Configuring Destination-based NetFlow AccountingCommand or Action Purpose Configures the flow record for an IPv4 destination-based NetFlow accounting record. The destination keyword specifies that the record is for IPv4 destination-based NetFlow accounting. record ipv4 destination Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# record ipv4 destination. Step 3 exit Exits flow monitor map mode to global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# exit Step 4 Interface type and physical interface-path-id in the format type rack/slot/module/port. interface type interface-path-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# interface POS 0/1/0/0 Step 5 type—POS, Ethernet, ATM, etc. rack—Chassis number of the rack. slot—Physical slot number of the line card or modular services card. module—Module number. A physical layer interface module (PLIM) is always 0. port—Physical port number of the interface. Configures an IPv4 flow monitor for the ingress direction and assigns the name of the monitor. flow ipv4 monitor name ingress Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# flow ipv4 monitor monitor1 ingress Step 6 Step 7 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exitsthe configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 26 OL-26127-02 Configuring NetFlow Configuring Destination-based NetFlow AccountingCommand or Action Purpose • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. show flow exporter-map map_name Verifies exporter map data. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show flow exporter-map fem Step 8 Trident Netflow Trident Netflow exports using only the V9 (Version 9) format. V9 is the most flexible NetFlow export. This format is flexible and extensible. It provides the flexibility to support new fields and record types. Supported features • Flow monitor type of IPv4, IPv6, and MPLS can all be configured to an interface per direction. • Sampled Netflow. There is no support for full mode sampling. • Non-deterministic Random Sampling Algorithm. • Different traffic types, including unicast and multicast traffic. Punt path policer rate In order to achieve the maximum flow processing without overloading the LC CPU, all flow packets that are punted from each Network Processor are policed. This is done to avoid overloading the CPU. The aggregate punt policer rate is 100 Kpps. To avoid having flow packets arrive at the CPU at a huge rate, the punt path policer needs to be applied on all NPs that have the netflow feature applied on them. The Punt path policer rate can be calculated in following way: Calculating Punt path policer rate The policer rate of each NP_NetflowMonitor is 100k, where NP_NetflowMonitor is NP that has Netflow monitor configured to its associated interfaces; or any of its associated interfaces are member of a bundle interfaces or bundle sub-interfaces that has Netflow monitor applied. Determining NP for NP_NetflowMonitor or non - NP_NetflowMonitor: 1 If any of its associated interface or sub-interface has any flow monitor applied, then it is NP_NetflowMonitor. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26127-02 27 Configuring NetFlow Trident Netflow2 If any of its interfaces is a member of a bundle interface or bundle sub-interface that has Netflow monitor configured, the NP is considered as non- NP_NetflowMonitor. Trident base line cards supported features • Supports ingress and egress Netflow (IPv4, IPv6, MPLS) on L3 physical interface, L3-sub-interface, L3-Bundle interface, and L3 bundle sub-interface. • Supports configurable Sampling Rate 1:1 ~ 1: 65535 • Supports only up to 4 Sampling Rates (or Intervals) per LC. • Supports up to 8k (Large memory LC) or 4k (Small Memory LC) interfaces/subinterfaces • Supports configuration with flow monitor per NP. • Supports maximum aggregate Netflow processing rate of 50k flow packets perseconds per LC, enforced by Netflow Punt Policer on each NPs. • Supports netflow processing of 100Kpps, with CPU utilization not exceeding 50%. • Supports up to 4 flow exporters per flow monitor. • Supports exporting packet rates of up to 100k flows per second. Configuration Examples for NetFlow The following examples show NetFlow configurations: Sampler Map: Example The following example shows how to create a new sampler map called “fsm1,” which samples 1 out of 65535 packets: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# sampler-map fsm1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-sm)# random 1 out-of 65535 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# exit Exporter Map: Example The following example shows how to create a new flow exporter map called “fem1,” which uses the version 9 (V9) export format for NetFlow export packets. The data template flow-set is inserted into the V9 export packets once every 10 minutes, and the options interface table flow-set is inserted into the V9 export packet. The export packets are sent to the flow collector destination 10.1.1.1, where the source address is identical to the interface IP address of Loopback 0. The UDP destination port is 1024, and the DSCP value is 10: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# flow exporter-map fem1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem)# destination 10.1.1.1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem)# source Loopback 0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem)# transport udp 1024 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem)# dscp 10 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 28 OL-26127-02 Configuring NetFlow Configuration Examples for NetFlowRP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem)# version v9 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem-ver)# template data timeout 600 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem-ver)# options interface-table RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem-ver)# exit Flow Monitor Map: Examples The following example shows how to create a new flow monitor map with name “fmm1”. This flow monitor map references the flow exporter map “fem1,” and sets the flow cache attributes to 10000 cache entries. The active entries from the cache are aged every 30 seconds, while the inactive entries from the cache are aged every 15 seconds. The record map for this monitor map is IPv4: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# flow monitor-map fmm1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# record ipv4 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# exporter fem1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# cache entries 10000 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# cache timeout active 30 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# cache timeout inactive 15 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# exit The following example shows how to apply the flow monitor “fmm1”and the sampler “fsm1” to the TenGigE 0/0/0/0 interface in the ingress direction: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# interface TenGigE 0/0/0/0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# flow ipv4 monitor fmm1 sampler fsm1 ingress RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# exit The following example shows how to configure the NetFlow monitor to collect MPLS packets with IPv6 fields: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# config RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# flow exporter-map exp1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem)# version v9 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem-ver)# options interface-table timeout 300 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem-ver)# options sampler-table timeout 300 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem-ver)# template data timeout 300 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem-ver)# template options timeout 300 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem-ver)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem)# transport udp 12515 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem)# source Loopback0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fem)# destination 170.1.1.11 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# flow monitor-map MPLS-IPv6-fmm RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# record mpls ipv6-fields labels 3 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# exporter exp1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# cache entries 10000 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# cache permanent RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# sampler-map FSM RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-sm)# random 1 out-of 65535 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-sm)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 0/0/0/0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# flow mpls monitor MPLS-IPv6-fmm sampler FSM ingress Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26127-02 29 Configuring NetFlow Flow Monitor Map: ExamplesMPLS Flow Monitor with IPv4 and IPv6 Support: Examples The following configuration collects MPLS traffic, but no payload information is collected. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# flow monitor-map MPLS-fmm RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# record mpls labels 3 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# cache permanent RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 0/0/0/0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# flow mpls monitor MPLS-fmm sampler fsm ingress The following configuration collects MPLS traffic with IPv4 payloads. It also collects MPLS traffic without IPv4 payloads, but it populates the IPv4 fields with zeros (0). RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# flow monitor-map MPLS-IPv4-fmm RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# record mpls IPv4-fields labels 3 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# cache permanent RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 0/0/0/0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# flow mpls monitor MPLS-IPv4-fmm sampler fsm ingress The following configuration collects MPLS traffic with IPv6 payloads. It also collects MPLS traffic without IPv6 payloads, but it populates the IPv6 fields with zeros (0). RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# flow monitor-map MPLS-IPv6-fmm RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# record mpls IPv6-fields labels 3 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# cache permanent RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 0/0/0/0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# flow mpls monitor MPLS-IPv6-fmm sampler fsm ingress The following configuration collects MPLS traffic with both IPv6 and IPv4 fields. It also collects MPLS traffic without IPv4 or IPv6 payloads, but it populates the IPv6 and IPv4 fields with zeros (0). RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# flow monitor-map MPLS-IPv4-IPv6-fmm RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# record mpls IPv4-IPv6-fields labels 3 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# cache permanent RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 0/0/0/0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# flow mpls monitor MPLS-IPv4-IPv6-fmm sampler fsm ingress Note Flow records are exported using the Version 9 format. Destination-based NetFlow Accounting: Example The following example shows how to configure an IPv4 flow record for destination-based NetFlow accounting: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# flow monitor-map map1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# record ipv4 destination RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# exporter fem RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-fmm)# exit RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# interface pos 0/1/0/0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# flow ipv4 monitor map1 ingress Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 30 OL-26127-02 Configuring NetFlow MPLS Flow Monitor with IPv4 and IPv6 Support: ExamplesRP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# end RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show flow exporter-map fem RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show flow monitor-map map1 Additional References The following sections provide references related to interface configuration. Related Documents Related Topic Document Title Cisco IOS XR master command reference Cisco IOS XR Master Commands List Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Interface and Hardware Component Command Reference Cisco IOS XR interface configuration commands Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Getting Started Guide Initial system bootup and configuration information for a router using the Cisco IOS XR software. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Interface and Hardware Component Command Reference Information about user groups and task IDs Information about configuring interfaces and other Cisco Craft Works Interface User Guide components from a remote Craft Works Interface (CWI) client management application. Standards Standards Title No new or modified standards are supported by this — feature, and support for existing standards has not been modified by this feature. MIBs MIBs MIBs Link To locate and download MIBs using Cisco IOS XR software, use the Cisco MIB Locator found at the following URL and choose a platform under the Cisco Access Products menu: http://cisco.com/public/ sw-center/netmgmt/cmtk/mibs.shtml — Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26127-02 31 Configuring NetFlow Additional ReferencesRFCs RFCs Title 3954 NetFlow services export protocol Version 9. Technical Assistance Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 32 OL-26127-02 Configuring NetFlow Additional ReferencesI N D E X A accounting for IPv4, destination-based 8, 25 Additional References command 31 C cache entries command 14 cache permanent command 14 cache timeout command 14 Configuration Examples for NetFlow command 28 configuring 9 D destination command 9 Destination-based NetFlow Accounting 30 Example command 30 dscp command 9 E exporter command 14 exporter map 3 Exporter Map 28 Example command 28 F flow exporter map configuration submode 5 flow exporter map version configuration submode 5 flow exporter-map command 9 Flow Monitor Map 29 Examples 29 flow monitor map configuration submode 6 flow monitor-map command 9, 14, 25 M monitor map 3 MPLS Flow Monitor with IPv4 and IPv6 Support 30 Examples 30 N NetFlow 1, 2, 3, 5, 6, 8, 9, 25 accounting for IPv4, destination-based 8, 25 configuring 9 exporter map 3 flow exporter map configuration submode 5 flow exporter map version configuration submode 5 flow monitor map configuration submode 6 monitor map 3 overview 1, 2 restrictions 2 sampler map 3 sampler map configuration submode 6 O options command 9 overview 1, 2 R random command 12 record ipv4 command 14 record ipv4 destination command 25 record ipv6 command 14 restrictions 2 S sampler map 3 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26127-02 IN-1Sampler Map 28 Example command 28 sampler map configuration submode 6 sampler-map command 12 show flow exporter-map command 9, 25 show flow monitor map command 14 show sampler-map command 12 source command 9 T template command 9 transport udp command 9 Trident Netflow 27 V version v9 command 9 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Netflow Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x IN-2 OL-26127-02 Index Americas Headquarters Cisco Systems, Inc. 170 West Tasman Drive San Jose, CA 95134-1706 USA http://www.cisco.com Tel: 408 526-4000 800 553-NETS (6387) Fax: 408 527-0883 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide Cisco IOS XR Software Release 4.2.x Text Part Number: OL-26115-02THE SPECIFICATIONS AND INFORMATION REGARDING THE PRODUCTS IN THIS MANUAL ARE SUBJECT TO CHANGE WITHOUT NOTICE. ALL STATEMENTS, INFORMATION, AND RECOMMENDATIONS IN THIS MANUAL ARE BELIEVED TO BE ACCURATE BUT ARE PRESENTED WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED. USERS MUST TAKE FULL RESPONSIBILITY FOR THEIR APPLICATION OF ANY PRODUCTS. THE SOFTWARE LICENSE AND LIMITED WARRANTY FOR THE ACCOMPANYING PRODUCT ARE SET FORTH IN THE INFORMATION PACKET THAT SHIPPED WITH THE PRODUCT AND ARE INCORPORATED HEREIN BY THIS REFERENCE. IF YOU ARE UNABLE TO LOCATE THE SOFTWARE LICENSE OR LIMITED WARRANTY, CONTACT YOUR CISCO REPRESENTATIVE FOR A COPY. The Cisco implementation of TCP header compression is an adaptation of a program developed by the University of California, Berkeley (UCB) as part of UCB’s public domain version of the UNIX operating system. All rights reserved. Copyright © 1981, Regents of the University of California. NOTWITHSTANDING ANY OTHER WARRANTY HEREIN, ALL DOCUMENT FILES AND SOFTWARE OF THESE SUPPLIERS ARE PROVIDED “AS IS” WITH ALL FAULTS. CISCO AND THE ABOVE-NAMED SUPPLIERS DISCLAIM ALL WARRANTIES, EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, THOSE OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT OR ARISING FROM A COURSE OF DEALING, USAGE, OR TRADE PRACTICE. IN NO EVENT SHALL CISCO OR ITS SUPPLIERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY INDIRECT, SPECIAL, CONSEQUENTIAL, OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES, INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, LOST PROFITS OR LOSS OR DAMAGE TO DATA ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THIS MANUAL, EVEN IF CISCO OR ITS SUPPLIERS HAVE BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. Cisco and the Cisco logo are trademarks or registered trademarks of Cisco and/or its affiliates in the U.S. and other countries. To view a list of Cisco trademarks, go to this URL: www.cisco.com/go/trademarks. Third-party trademarks mentioned are the property of their respective owners. The use of the word partner does not imply a partnership relationship between Cisco and any other company. (1110R) Any Internet Protocol (IP) addresses and phone numbers used in this document are not intended to be actual addresses and phone numbers. Any examples, command display output, network topology diagrams, and other figures included in the document are shown for illustrative purposes only. Any use of actual IP addresses or phone numbers in illustrative content is unintentional and coincidental. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide © 2012 Cisco Systems, Inc. All rights reserved.iii Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 C O N T E N T S Preface VPC-vii Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs VPC-9 Contents VPC-10 Prerequisites for Implementing MPLS L3VPN VPC-10 MPLS L3VPN Restrictions VPC-11 Information About MPLS Layer 3 VPNs VPC-11 MPLS L3VPN Overview VPC-11 MPLS L3VPN Benefits VPC-12 How MPLS L3VPN Works VPC-13 Virtual Routing and Forwarding Tables VPC-13 VPN Routing Information: Distribution VPC-13 BGP Distribution of VPN Routing Information VPC-14 MPLS Forwarding VPC-14 Automatic Route Distinguisher Assignment VPC-15 MPLS L3VPN Major Components VPC-15 Inter-AS Support for L3VPN VPC-15 Inter-AS Support: Overview VPC-16 Inter-AS and ASBRs VPC-16 Confederations VPC-17 MPLS VPN Inter-AS BGP Label Distribution VPC-18 Exchanging IPv4 Routes with MPLS labels VPC-19 BGP Routing Information VPC-20 BGP Messages and MPLS Labels VPC-20 Sending MPLS Labels with Routes VPC-21 Generic Routing Encapsulation Support for L3VPN VPC-21 GRE Restriction for L3VPN VPC-21 VPNv4 Forwarding Using GRE Tunnels VPC-21 Carrier Supporting Carrier Support for L3VPN VPC-23 CSC Prerequisites VPC-23 CSC Benefits VPC-23 Configuration Options for the Backbone and Customer Carriers VPC-24 Customer Carrier: ISP with IP Core VPC-24 Customer Carrier: MPLS Service Provider VPC-25Contents iv Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs VPC-26 Configuring the Core Network VPC-26 Assessing the Needs of MPLS VPN Customers VPC-26 Configuring Routing Protocols in the Core VPC-27 Configuring MPLS in the Core VPC-27 Determining if FIB Is Enabled in the Core VPC-27 Configuring Multiprotocol BGP on the PE Routers and Route Reflectors VPC-28 Connecting MPLS VPN Customers VPC-29 Defining VRFs on the PE Routers to Enable Customer Connectivity VPC-30 Configuring VRF Interfaces on PE Routers for Each VPN Customer VPC-32 Configuring BGP as the Routing Protocol Between the PE and CE Routers VPC-34 Configuring RIPv2 as the Routing Protocol Between the PE and CE Routers VPC-38 Configuring Static Routes Between the PE and CE Routers VPC-41 Configuring OSPF as the Routing Protocol Between the PE and CE Routers VPC-42 Configuring EIGRP as the Routing Protocol Between the PE and CE Routers VPC-45 Configuring EIGRP Redistribution in the MPLS VPN VPC-48 Providing VPN Connectivity Across Multiple Autonomous Systems with MPLS VPN Inter-AS with ASBRs Exchanging IPv4 Routes and MPLS Labels VPC-50 Configuring ASBRs to Exchange IPv4 Routes and MPLS Labels VPC-50 Configuring the Route Reflectors to Exchange VPN-IPv4 Routes VPC-53 Configuring the Route Reflector to Reflect Remote Routes in its AS VPC-56 Providing VPN Connectivity Across Multiple Autonomous Systems with MPLS VPN Inter-AS with ASBRs Exchanging VPN-IPv4 Addresses VPC-59 Configuring the ASBRs to Exchange VPN-IPv4 Addresses VPC-59 Configuring a Static Route to an ASBR Peer VPC-62 Configuring EBGP Routing to Exchange VPN Routes Between Subautonomous Systems in a Confederation VPC-64 Configuring MPLS Forwarding for ASBR Confederations VPC-66 Configuring a Static Route to an ASBR Confederation Peer VPC-68 Configuring Carrier Supporting Carrier VPC-70 Identifying the Carrier Supporting Carrier Topology VPC-70 Configuring the Backbone Carrier Core VPC-71 Configuring the CSC-PE and CSC-CE Routers VPC-71 Configuring a Static Route to a Peer VPC-78 Verifying the MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration VPC-80 Configuring L3VPN over GRE VPC-83 Creating a GRE Tunnel between Provider Edge Routers VPC-83 Configuring IGP between Provider Edge Routers VPC-85 Configuring LDP/GRE on the Provider Edge Routers VPC-87 Configuring L3VPN VPC-89Contents v Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Configuration Examples for Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs VPC-95 Configuring an MPLS VPN Using BGP: Example VPC-95 Configuring the Routing Information Protocol on the PE Router: Example VPC-96 Configuring the PE Router Using EIGRP: Example VPC-96 Configuration Examples for MPLS VPN CSC VPC-97 Configuring the Backbone Carrier Core: Examples VPC-97 Configuring the Links Between CSC-PE and CSC-CE Routers: Examples VPC-97 Configuring a Static Route to a Peer: Example VPC-98 Configuring L3VPN over GRE: Example VPC-98 Additional References VPC-102 Related Documents VPC-102 Standards VPC-102 MIBs VPC-102 RFCs VPC-103 Technical Assistance VPC-103 Implementing IPv6 VPN Provider Edge Transport over MPLS VPC-105 Contents VPC-105 Prerequisites for Implementing 6PE/VPE VPC-106 Information About 6PE/VPE VPC-106 Overview of 6PE/VPE VPC-106 Benefits of 6PE/VPE VPC-107 Deploying IPv6 over MPLS Backbones VPC-107 IPv6 on the Provider Edge and Customer Edge Routers VPC-107 IPv6 Provider Edge Multipath VPC-108 OSPFv3 6VPE VPC-108 Multiple VRF Support VPC-108 OSPFv3 PE-CE Extensions VPC-109 VRF Lite VPC-109 How to Implement 6PE/VPE VPC-109 Configuring 6PE/VPE VPC-109 Configuring PE to PE Core VPC-111 Configuring PE to CE Core VPC-115 Configuring OSPFv3 as the Routing Protocol Between the PE and CE Routers VPC-118 Configuration Examples for 6PE VPC-122 Configuring 6PE on a PE Router: Example VPC-122 Configuring 6VPE on a PE Router: Example VPC-122 Configuring OSPFv3 between PE to CE: Example: VPC-123 Additional References VPC-124Contents vi Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Related Document VPC-124 Standards VPC-124 MIBs VPC-124 RFCs VPC-124 Technical Assistance VPC-125 Indexvii Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Preface The preface consists of these sections: • Changes to This Document, page VPC-vii • Obtaining Documentation and Submitting a Service Request, page VPC-vii Changes to This Document Table 1 lists the technical changes made to this document since it was first printed. Obtaining Documentation and Submitting a Service Request For information on obtaining documentation, submitting a service request, and gathering additional information, see the monthly What’s New in Cisco Product Documentation, which also lists all new and revised Cisco technical documentation, at: http://www.cisco.com/en/US/docs/general/whatsnew/whatsnew.html Subscribe to the What’s New in Cisco Product Documentation as a Really Simple Syndication (RSS) feed and set content to be delivered directly to your desktop using a reader application. The RSS feeds are a free service and Cisco currently supports RSS version 2.0. Table 1 Changes to This Document Revision Date Change Summary OL-26115-02 May 2012 Support for GRE tunnel interfaces was increased to 2000. OL-26115-01 December 2011 Initial release of this document.Preface viii Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-029 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs A Multiprotocol Label Switching (MPLS) Layer 3 Virtual Private Network (VPN) consists of a set of sites that are interconnected by means of an MPLS provider core network. At each customer site, one or more customer edge (CE) routers attach to one or more provider edge (PE) routers. This module provides the conceptual and configuration information for MPLS Layer 3 VPNs on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Routers. Note You must acquire an evaluation or permanent license in order to use MPLS Layer 3 VPN functionality. However, if you are upgrading from a previous version of the software, MPLS Layer 3 VPN functionality will continue to work using an implicit license for 90 days (during which time, you can purchase a permanent license). For more information about licenses, see the Software Entitlement on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routers module in the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide. Note For a complete description of the commands listed in this module, refer to the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Command Reference . To locate documentation of other commands that appear in this chapter, use the command reference master index, or search online. Feature History for Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routers Release Modification Release 3.7.2 This feature was introduced. Release 4.2.0 Support for Generic Routing Encapsulation (GRE) was added on A9K-SIP-700 line card. Release 4.2.1 The maximum number of supported tunnel interfaces was increased to 2000 for the ASR 9000 Enhanced Ethernet and ASR 9000 Ethernet line cards.Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs Contents 10 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Contents • Prerequisites for Implementing MPLS L3VPN, page VPC-10 • MPLS L3VPN Restrictions, page VPC-11 • Information About MPLS Layer 3 VPNs, page VPC-11 • How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs, page VPC-26 • Configuration Examples for Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs, page VPC-95 • Additional References, page VPC-102 Prerequisites for Implementing MPLS L3VPN These prerequisites are required to configure MPLS Layer 3 VPN: • You must be in a user group associated with a task group that includes the proper task IDs. The command reference guides include the task IDs required for each command. If you suspect user group assignment is preventing you from using a command, contact your AAA administrator for assistance. These prerequisites are required for configuring MPLS VPN Inter-AS with autonomous system boundary routers (ASBRs) exchanging VPN-IPV4 addresses or IPv4 routes and MPLS labels: • Before configuring external Border Gateway Protocol (eBGP) routing between autonomous systems or subautonomous systems in an MPLS VPN, ensure that all MPLS VPN routing instances and sessions are properly configured (see the How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs, page VPC-26 for procedures). • These tasks must be performed: – Define VPN routing instances – Configure BGP routing sessions in the MPLS core – Configure PE-to-PE routing sessions in the MPLS core – Configure BGP PE-to-CE routing sessions – Configure a VPN-IPv4 eBGP session between directly connected ASBRs To configure MPLS Layer 3 VPNs, routers must support MPLS forwarding and Forwarding Information Base (FIB).Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs MPLS L3VPN Restrictions 11 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 MPLS L3VPN Restrictions These are restrictions for implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs: • Multihop VPN-IPv4 eBGP is not supported for configuring eBGP routing between autonomous systems or subautonomous systems in an MPLS VPN. • MPLS VPN supports only IPv4 address families. These restrictions apply when configuring MPLS VPN Inter-AS with ASBRs exchanging IPv4 routes and MPLS labels: • For networks configured with eBGP multihop, a label switched path (LSP) must be configured between nonadjacent routers. • Inter-AS supports IPv4 routes only. IPv6 is not supported. Note The physical interfaces that connect the BGP speakers must support FIB and MPLS. These restrictions apply to routing protocols OSPF and RIP: • IPv6 is not supported on OSPF and RIP. Information About MPLS Layer 3 VPNs To implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs, you need to understand these concepts: • MPLS L3VPN Overview, page VPC-11 • MPLS L3VPN Benefits, page VPC-12 • How MPLS L3VPN Works, page VPC-13 • MPLS L3VPN Major Components, page VPC-15 • Generic Routing Encapsulation Support for L3VPN, page VPC-21 MPLS L3VPN Overview Before defining an MPLS VPN, VPN in general must be defined. A VPN is: • An IP-based network delivering private network services over a public infrastructure • A set of sites that are allowed to communicate with each other privately over the Internet or other public or private networks Conventional VPNs are created by configuring a full mesh of tunnels or permanent virtual circuits (PVCs) to all sites in a VPN. This type of VPN is not easy to maintain or expand, as adding a new site requires changing each edge device in the VPN. MPLS-based VPNs are created in Layer 3 and are based on the peer model. The peer model enables the service provider and the customer to exchange Layer 3 routing information. The service provider relays the data between the customer sites without customer involvement. MPLS VPNs are easier to manage and expand than conventional VPNs. When a new site is added to an MPLS VPN, only the edge router of the service provider that provides services to the customer site needs to be updated. Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs Information About MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 12 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 The components of the MPLS VPN are described as follows: • Provider (P) router—Router in the core of the provider network. PE routers run MPLS switching and do not attach VPN labels to routed packets. VPN labels are used to direct data packets to the correct private network or customer edge router. • PE router—Router that attaches the VPN label to incoming packets based on the interface or subinterface on which they are received, and also attaches the MPLS core labels. A PE router attaches directly to a CE router. • Customer (C) router—Router in the Internet service provider (ISP) or enterprise network. • Customer edge (CE) router—Edge router on the network of the ISP that connects to the PE router on the network. A CE router must interface with a PE router. Figure 1 shows a basic MPLS VPN topology. Figure 1 Basic MPLS VPN Topology MPLS L3VPN Benefits MPLS L3VPN provides these benefits: • Service providers can deploy scalable VPNs and deliver value-added services. • Connectionless service guarantees that no prior action is necessary to establish communication between hosts. • Centralized Service: Building VPNs in Layer 3 permits delivery of targeted services to a group of users represented by a VPN. • Scalability: Create scalable VPNs using connection-oriented, point-to-point overlays, Frame Relay, or ATM virtual connections. • Security: Security is provided at the edge of a provider network (ensuring that packets received from a customer are placed on the correct VPN) and in the backbone. • Integrated Quality of Service (QoS) support: QoS provides the ability to address predictable performance and policy implementation and support for multiple levels of service in an MPLS VPN. MPLS Backbone Customer Site Customer Site Provider Edge (PE) router Provider Edge (PE) router Provider (P) routers Provider (P) routers 103875 Customer Edge (CE) router Customer Edge (CE) routerImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs Information About MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 13 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 • Straightforward Migration: Service providers can deploy VPN services using a straightforward migration path. • Migration for the end customer is simplified. There is no requirement to support MPLS on the CE router and no modifications are required for a customer intranet. How MPLS L3VPN Works MPLS VPN functionality is enabled at the edge of an MPLS network. The PE router performs these tasks: • Exchanges routing updates with the CE router • Translates the CE routing information into VPN version 4 (VPNv4) routes • Exchanges VPNv4 routes with other PE routers through the Multiprotocol Border Gateway Protocol (MP-BGP) Virtual Routing and Forwarding Tables Each VPN is associated with one or more VPN routing and forwarding (VRF) instances. A VRF defines the VPN membership of a customer site attached to a PE router. A VRF consists of these components: • An IP version 4 (IPv4) unicast routing table • A derived FIB table • A set of interfaces that use the forwarding table • A set of rules and routing protocol parameters that control the information that is included in the routing table These components are collectively called a VRF instance. A one-to-one relationship does not necessarily exist between customer sites and VPNs. A site can be a member of multiple VPNs. However, a site can associate with only one VRF. A VRF contains all the routes available to the site from the VPNs of which it is a member. Packet forwarding information is stored in the IP routing table and the FIB table for each VRF. A separate set of routing and FIB tables is maintained for each VRF. These tables prevent information from being forwarded outside a VPN and also prevent packets that are outside a VPN from being forwarded to a router within the VPN. VPN Routing Information: Distribution The distribution of VPN routing information is controlled through the use of VPN route target communities, implemented by BGP extended communities. VPN routing information is distributed as follows: • When a VPN route that is learned from a CE router is injected into a BGP, a list of VPN route target extended community attributes is associated with it. Typically, the list of route target community extended values is set from an export list of route targets associated with the VRF from which the route was learned.Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs Information About MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 14 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 • An import list of route target extended communities is associated with each VRF. The import list defines route target extended community attributes that a route must have for the route to be imported into the VRF. For example, if the import list for a particular VRF includes route target extended communities A, B, and C, then any VPN route that carries any of those route target extended communities—A, B, or C—is imported into the VRF. BGP Distribution of VPN Routing Information A PE router can learn an IP prefix from these sources: • A CE router by static configuration • An eBGP session with the CE router • A Routing Information Protocol (RIP) exchange with the CE router • Open Shortest Path First (OSPF), Enhanced Interior Gateway Routing Protocol (EIGRP), and RIP as Interior Gateway Protocols (IGPs) The IP prefix is a member of the IPv4 address family. After the PE router learns the IP prefix, the PE converts it into the VPN-IPv4 prefix by combining it with a 64-bit route distinguisher. The generated prefix is a member of the VPN-IPv4 address family. It uniquely identifies the customer address, even if the customer site is using globally nonunique (unregistered private) IP addresses. The route distinguisher used to generate the VPN-IPv4 prefix is specified by the rd command associated with the VRF on the PE router. BGP distributes reachability information for VPN-IPv4 prefixes for each VPN. BGP communication takes place at two levels: • Within the IP domain, known as an autonomous system. • Between autonomous systems. PE to PE or PE to route reflector (RR) sessions are iBGP sessions, and PE to CE sessions are eBGP sessions. PE to CE eBGP sessions can be directly or indirectly connected (eBGP multihop). BGP propagates reachability information for VPN-IPv4 prefixes among PE routers by the BGP protocol extensions (see RFC 2283, Multiprotocol Extensions for BGP-4), which define support for address families other than IPv4. Using the extensions ensures that the routes for a given VPN are learned only by other members of that VPN, enabling members of the VPN to communicate with each other. MPLS Forwarding Based on routing information stored in the VRF IP routing table and the VRF FIB table, packets are forwarded to their destination using MPLS. A PE router binds a label to each customer prefix learned from a CE router and includes the label in the network reachability information for the prefix that it advertises to other PE routers. When a PE router forwards a packet received from a CE router across the provider network, it labels the packet with the label learned from the destination PE router. When the destination PE router receives the labeled packet, it pops the label and uses it to direct the packet to the correct CE router. Label forwarding across the provider backbone is based on either dynamic label switching or traffic engineered paths. A customer data packet carries two levels of labels when traversing the backbone: • The top label directs the packet to the correct PE router. • The second label indicates how that PE router should forward the packet to the CE router.Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs Inter-AS Support for L3VPN 15 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 More labels can be stacked if other features are enabled. For example, if traffic engineering (TE) tunnels with fast reroute (FRR) are enabled, the total number of labels imposed in the PE is four (Layer 3 VPN, Label Distribution Protocol (LDP), TE, and FRR). Automatic Route Distinguisher Assignment To take advantage of iBGP load balancing, every network VRF must be assigned a unique route distinguisher. VRFs require a route distinguisher for BGP to distinguish between potentially identical prefixes received from different VPNs. With thousands of routers in a network each supporting multiple VRFs, configuration and management of route distinguishers across the network can present a problem. Cisco IOS XR software simplifies this process by assigning unique route distinguisher to VRFs using the rd auto command. To assign a unique route distinguisher for each router, you must ensure that each router has a unique BGP router-id. If so, the rd auto command assigns a Type 1 route distinguisher to the VRF using this format: ip-address:number. The IP address is specified by the BGP router-id statement and the number (which is derived as an unused index in the 0 to 65535 range) is unique across the VRFs. Finally, route distinguisher values are checkpointed so that route distinguisher assignment to VRF is persistent across failover or process restart. If an route distinguisher is explicitely configured for a VRF, this value is not overridden by the autoroute distinguisher. MPLS L3VPN Major Components An MPLS-based VPN network has three major components: • VPN route target communities—A VPN route target community is a list of all members of a VPN community. VPN route targets need to be configured for each VPN community member. • Multiprotocol BGP (MP-BGP) peering of the VPN community PE routers—MP-BGP propagates VRF reachability information to all members of a VPN community. MP-BGP peering needs to be configured in all PE routers within a VPN community. • MPLS forwarding—MPLS transports all traffic between all VPN community members across a VPN service-provider network. A one-to-one relationship does not necessarily exist between customer sites and VPNs. A given site can be a member of multiple VPNs. However, a site can associate with only one VRF. A customer-site VRF contains all the routes available to the site from the VPNs of which it is a member. Inter-AS Support for L3VPN This section contains these topics: • Inter-AS Support: Overview, page VPC-16 • Inter-AS and ASBRs, page VPC-16 • Confederations, page VPC-17 • MPLS VPN Inter-AS BGP Label Distribution, page VPC-18 • Exchanging IPv4 Routes with MPLS labels, page VPC-19Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs Inter-AS Support for L3VPN 16 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Inter-AS Support: Overview An autonomous system (AS) is a single network or group of networks that is controlled by a common system administration group and uses a single, clearly defined routing protocol. As VPNs grow, their requirements expand. In some cases, VPNs need to reside on different autonomous systems in different geographic areas. In addition, some VPNs need to extend across multiple service providers (overlapping VPNs). Regardless of the complexity and location of the VPNs, the connection between autonomous systems must be seamless. An MPLS VPN Inter-AS provides these benefits: • Allows a VPN to cross more than one service provider backbone. Service providers, running separate autonomous systems, can jointly offer MPLS VPN services to the same end customer. A VPN can begin at one customer site and traverse different VPN service provider backbones before arriving at another site of the same customer. Previously, MPLS VPN could traverse only a single BGP autonomous system service provider backbone. This feature lets multiple autonomous systems form a continuous, seamless network between customer sites of a service provider. • Allows a VPN to exist in different areas. A service provider can create a VPN in different geographic areas. Having all VPN traffic flow through one point (between the areas) allows for better rate control of network traffic between the areas. • Allows confederations to optimize iBGP meshing. Internal Border Gateway Protocol (iBGP) meshing in an autonomous system is more organized and manageable. You can divide an autonomous system into multiple, separate subautonomous systems and then classify them into a single confederation. This capability lets a service provider offer MPLS VPNs across the confederation, as it supports the exchange of labeled VPN-IPv4 Network Layer Reachability Information (NLRI) between the subautonomous systems that form the confederation. Inter-AS and ASBRs Separate autonomous systems from different service providers can communicate by exchanging IPv4 NLRI in the form of VPN-IPv4 addresses. The ASBRs use eBGP to exchange that information. Then an Interior Gateway Protocol (IGP) distributes the network layer information for VPN-IPV4 prefixes throughout each VPN and each autonomous system. These protocols are used for sharing routing information: • Within an autonomous system, routing information is shared using an IGP. • Between autonomous systems, routing information is shared using an eBGP. An eBGP lets service providers set up an interdomain routing system that guarantees the loop-free exchange of routing information between separate autonomous systems. The primary function of an eBGP is to exchange network reachability information between autonomous systems, including information about the list of autonomous system routes. The autonomous systems use EBGP border edge routers to distribute the routes, which include label switching information. Each border edge router rewrites the next-hop and MPLS labels. Inter-AS configurations supported in an MPLS VPN can include:Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs Inter-AS Support for L3VPN 17 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 • Interprovider VPN—MPLS VPNs that include two or more autonomous systems, connected by separate border edge routers. The autonomous systems exchange routes using eBGP. No IGP or routing information is exchanged between the autonomous systems. • BGP Confederations—MPLS VPNs that divide a single autonomous system into multiple subautonomous systems and classify them as a single, designated confederation. The network recognizes the confederation as a single autonomous system. The peers in the different autonomous systems communicate over eBGP sessions; however, they can exchange route information as if they were iBGP peers. Confederations A confederation is multiple subautonomous systems grouped together. A confederation reduces the total number of peer devices in an autonomous system. A confederation divides an autonomous system into subautonomous systems and assigns a confederation identifier to the autonomous systems. A VPN can span service providers running in separate autonomous systems or multiple subautonomous systems that form a confederation. In a confederation, each subautonomous system is fully meshed with other subautonomous systems. The subautonomous systems communicate using an IGP, such as Open Shortest Path First (OSPF) or Intermediate System-to-Intermediate System (IS-IS). Each subautonomous system also has an eBGP connection to the other subautonomous systems. The confederation eBGP (CEBGP) border edge routers forward next-hop-self addresses between the specified subautonomous systems. The next-hop-self address forces the BGP to use a specified address as the next hop rather than letting the protocol choose the next hop. You can configure a confederation with separate subautonomous systems two ways: • Configure a router to forward next-hop-self addresses between only the CEBGP border edge routers (both directions). The subautonomous systems (iBGP peers) at the subautonomous system border do not forward the next-hop-self address. Each subautonomous system runs as a single IGP domain. However, the CEBGP border edge router addresses are known in the IGP domains. • Configure a router to forward next-hop-self addresses between the CEBGP border edge routers (both directions) and within the iBGP peers at the subautonomous system border. Each subautonomous system runs as a single IGP domain but also forwards next-hop-self addresses between the PE routers in the domain. The CEBGP border edge router addresses are known in the IGP domains. Figure 2 illustrates a typical MPLS VPN confederation configuration. In this configuration: • The two CEBGP border edge routers exchange VPN-IPv4 addresses with labels between the two autonomous systems. • The distributing router changes the next-hop addresses and labels and uses a next-hop-self address. • IGP-1 and IGP-2 know the addresses of CEBGP-1 and CEBGP-2.Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs Inter-AS Support for L3VPN 18 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Figure 2 eBGP Connection Between Two Subautonomous Systems in a Confederation In this confederation configuration: • CEBGP border edge routers function as neighboring peers between the subautonomous systems. The subautonomous systems use eBGP to exchange route information. • Each CEBGP border edge router (CEBGP-1 and CEBGP-2) assigns a label for the router before distributing the route to the next subautonomous system. The CEBGP border edge router distributes the route as a VPN-IPv4 address by using the multiprotocol extensions of BGP. The label and the VPN identifier are encoded as part of the NLRI. • Each PE and CEBGP border edge router assigns its own label to each VPN-IPv4 address prefix before redistributing the routes. The CEBGP border edge routers exchange IPV-IPv4 addresses with the labels. The next-hop-self address is included in the label (as the value of the eBGP next-hop attribute). Within the subautonomous systems, the CEBGP border edge router address is distributed throughout the iBGP neighbors, and the two CEBGP border edge routers are known to both confederations. For more information about how to configure confederations, see the “Configuring MPLS Forwarding for ASBR Confederations” section on page MPC-66. MPLS VPN Inter-AS BGP Label Distribution Note This section is not applicable to Inter-AS over IP tunnels. You can set up the MPLS VPN Inter-AS network so that the ASBRs exchange IPv4 routes with MPLS labels of the provider edge (PE) routers. Route reflectors (RRs) exchange VPN-IPv4 routes by using multihop, multiprotocol external Border Gateway Protocol (eBGP). This method of configuring the Inter-AS system is often called MPLS VPN Inter-AS BGP Label Distribution. Configuring the Inter-AS system so that the ASBRs exchange the IPv4 routes and MPLS labels has these benefits: CE-1 CE-2 CE-3 CE-4 CE-5 PE-1 PE-2 PE-3 CEGBP-1 CEBGP-2 Core of P routers Core of P routers 43880 Sub-AS2 with IGP-2 Sub-AS1 with IGP-1 eBGP intraconfederation for VPNv4 routes with label distribution Service Provider 1 Service Provider 1 VPN 1 VPN 1Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs Inter-AS Support for L3VPN 19 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 • Saves the ASBRs from having to store all the VPN-IPv4 routes. Using the route reflectors to store the VPN-IPv4 routes and forward them to the PE routers results in improved scalability compared with configurations in which the ASBR holds all the VPN-IPv4 routes and forwards the routes based on VPN-IPv4 labels. • Having the route reflectors hold the VPN-IPv4 routes also simplifies the configuration at the border of the network. • Enables a non-VPN core network to act as a transit network for VPN traffic. You can transport IPv4 routes with MPLS labels over a non-MPLS VPN service provider. • Eliminates the need for any other label distribution protocol between adjacent label switch routers (LSRs). If two adjacent LSRs are also BGP peers, BGP can handle the distribution of the MPLS labels. No other label distribution protocol is needed between the two LSRs. Exchanging IPv4 Routes with MPLS labels Note This section is not applicable to Inter-AS over IP tunnels. You can set up a VPN service provider network to exchange IPv4 routes with MPLS labels. You can configure the VPN service provider network as follows: • Route reflectors exchange VPN-IPv4 routes by using multihop, multiprotocol eBGP. This configuration also preserves the next-hop information and the VPN labels across the autonomous systems. • A local PE router (for example, PE1 in Figure 3) needs to know the routes and label information for the remote PE router (PE2). This information can be exchanged between the PE routers and ASBRs in one of two ways: – Internal Gateway Protocol (IGP) and Label Distribution Protocol (LDP): The ASBR can redistribute the IPv4 routes and MPLS labels it learned from eBGP into IGP and LDP and from IGP and LDP into eBGP. – Internal Border Gateway Protocol (iBGP) IPv4 label distribution: The ASBR and PE router can use direct iBGP sessions to exchange VPN-IPv4 and IPv4 routes and MPLS labels. Alternatively, the route reflector can reflect the IPv4 routes and MPLS labels learned from the ASBR to the PE routers in the VPN. This reflecting of learned IPv4 routes and MPLS labels is accomplished by enabling the ASBR to exchange IPv4 routes and MPLS labels with the route reflector. The route reflector also reflects the VPN-IPv4 routes to the PE routers in the VPN. For example, in VPN1, RR1 reflects to PE1 the VPN-IPv4 routes it learned and IPv4 routes and MPLS labels learned from ASBR1. Using the route reflectors to store the VPN-IPv4 routes and forward them through the PE routers and ASBRs allows for a scalable configuration.Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs Inter-AS Support for L3VPN 20 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Figure 3 VPNs Using eBGP and iBGP to Distribute Routes and MPLS Labels BGP Routing Information BGP routing information includes these items: • Network number (prefix), which is the IP address of the destination. • Autonomous system (AS) path, which is a list of the other ASs through which a route passes on the way to the local router. The first AS in the list is closest to the local router; the last AS in the list is farthest from the local router and usually the AS where the route began. • Path attributes, which provide other information about the AS path, for example, the next hop. BGP Messages and MPLS Labels MPLS labels are included in the update messages that a router sends. Routers exchange these types of BGP messages: • Open messages—After a router establishes a TCP connection with a neighboring router, the routers exchange open messages. This message contains the number of the autonomous system to which the router belongs and the IP address of the router that sent the message. • Update messages—When a router has a new, changed, or broken route, it sends an update message to the neighboring router. This message contains the NLRI, which lists the IP addresses of the usable routes. The update message includes any routes that are no longer usable. The update message also includes path attributes and the lengths of both the usable and unusable paths. Labels for VPN-IPv4 routes are encoded in the update message, as specified in RFC 2858. The labels for the IPv4 routes are encoded in the update message, as specified in RFC 3107. • Keepalive messages—Routers exchange keepalive messages to determine if a neighboring router is still available to exchange routing information. The router sends these messages at regular intervals. (Sixty seconds is the default for Cisco routers.) The keepalive message does not contain routing data; it contains only a message header. • Notification messages—When a router detects an error, it sends a notification message. RR1 PE1 CE1 CE2 VPN1 VPN2 PE2 RR2 ASBR1 ASBR2 Multihop Multiprotocol VPNv4 BGP IPv4 routes and label with multipath support 59251Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs Inter-AS Support for L3VPN 21 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Sending MPLS Labels with Routes When BGP (eBGP and iBGP) distributes a route, it can also distribute an MPLS label that is mapped to that route. The MPLS label mapping information for the route is carried in the BGP update message that contains the information about the route. If the next hop is not changed, the label is preserved. When you issue the show bgp neighbors ip-address command on both BGP routers, the routers advertise to each other that they can then send MPLS labels with the routes. If the routers successfully negotiate their ability to send MPLS labels, the routers add MPLS labels to all outgoing BGP updates. Generic Routing Encapsulation Support for L3VPN Generic Routing Encapsulation (GRE) is a tunneling protocol that can encapsulate many types of packets to enable data transmission using a tunnel. The GRE tunneling protocol enables: • High assurance Internet Protocol encryptor (HAIPE) devices for encryption over the public Internet and nonsecure connections. • Service providers (that do not run MPLS in their core network) to provide VPN services along with the security services. Note GRE is used with IP to create a virtual point-to-point link to routers at remote points in a network. For detailed information about configuring GRE tunnel interfaces, refer to the Cisco IOS XR Interfaces and Hardware Components Configuration Guide. For a PE to PE (core) link, enable LDP (with implicit null) on the GRE interfaces for L3VPN. GRE Restriction for L3VPN The following restrictions are applicable to L3VPN forwarding over GRE: • Carrier Supporting Carrier (CsC) or Inter-AS is not supported. • GRE-based L3VPN does not interwork with MPLS or IP VPNs. • GRE tunnel is supported only as a core link(PE-PE, PE-P, P-P, P-PE). A PE-CE (edge) link is not supported. • VPNv6 forwarding using GRE tunnels is not supported. VPNv4 Forwarding Using GRE Tunnels This section describes the working of VPNv4 forwarding over GRE tunnels. The following description assumes that GRE is used only as a core link between the encapsulation and decapsulation provider edge (PE) routers that are connected to one or more customer edge (CE) routers. Ingress of Encapsulation Router On receiving prefixes from the CE routers, Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) assigns the VPN label to the prefixes that need to be exported. These VPN prefixes are then forwarded to the Forwarding Information Base (FIB) using the Route Information Base (RIB) or the label switched database (LSD). The FIB then populates the prefix in the appropriate VRF table. The FIB also populates the label in the global label table. Using BGP, the prefixes are then relayed to the remote PE router (decapsulation router).Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs Inter-AS Support for L3VPN 22 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Egress of Encapsulation Router The forwarding behavior on egress of the encapsulation PE router is similar to the MPLS VPN label imposition. Regardless of whether the VPN label imposition is performed on the ingress or egress side, the GRE tunnel forwards a packet that has an associated label. This labeled packet is then encapsulated with a GRE header and forwarded based on the IP header. Ingress of Decapsulation Router The decapsulation PE router learns the VPN prefixes and label information from the remote encapsulation PE router using BGP. The next-hop information for the VPN prefix is the address of the GRE tunnel interface connecting the two PE routers. BGP downloads these prefixes to the RIB. The RIB downloads the routes to the FIB and the FIB installs the routes in the hardware. Egress of Decapsulation Router The egress forwarding behavior on the decapsulation PE router is similar to VPN disposition and forwarding, based on the protocol type of the inner payload.Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs Carrier Supporting Carrier Support for L3VPN 23 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Carrier Supporting Carrier Support for L3VPN This section provides conceptual information about MPLS VPN Carrier Supporting Carrier (CSC) functionality and includes these topics: • CSC Prerequisites, page VPC-23 • CSC Benefits, page VPC-23 • Configuration Options for the Backbone and Customer Carriers, page VPC-24 Throughout this document, the following terminology is used in the context of CSC: backbone carrier—Service provider that provides the segment of the backbone network to the other provider. A backbone carrier offers BGP and MPLS VPN services. customer carrier—Service provider that uses the segment of the backbone network. The customer carrier may be an Internet service provider (ISP) or a BGP/MPLS VPN service provider. CE router—A customer edge router is part of a customer network and interfaces to a provider edge (PE) router. In this document, the CE router sits on the edge of the customer carrier network. PE router—A provider edge router is part of a service provider's network connected to a customer edge (CE) router. In this document, the PE router sits on the edge of the backbone carrier network ASBR—An autonomous system boundary router connects one autonomous system to another. CSC Prerequisites These prerequisites are required to configure CSC: • You must be able to configure MPLS VPNs with end-to-end (CE-to-CE router) pings working. • You must be able to configure Interior Gateway Protocols (IGPs), MPLS Label Distribution Protocol (LDP), and Multiprotocol Border Gateway Protocol (MP-BGP). • You must ensure that CSC-PE and CSC-CE routers support BGP label distribution. Note BGP is the only supported label distribution protocol on the link between CE and PE. CSC Benefits This section describes the benefits of CSC to the backbone carrier and customer carriers. Benefits to the Backbone Carrier • The backbone carrier can accommodate many customer carriers and give them access to its backbone. • The MPLS VPN carrier supporting carrier feature is scalable. • The MPLS VPN carrier supporting carrier feature is a flexible solution. Benefits to the Customer Carriers • The MPLS VPN carrier supporting carrier feature removes from the customer carrier the burden of configuring, operating, and maintaining its own backbone.Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs Carrier Supporting Carrier Support for L3VPN 24 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 • Customer carriers who use the VPN services provided by the backbone carrier receive the same level of security that Frame Relay or ATM-based VPNs provide. • Customer carriers can use any link layer technology to connect the CE routers to the PE routers. • The customer carrier can use any addressing scheme and still be supported by a backbone carrier. Benefits of Implementing MPLS VPN CSC Using BGP The benefits of using BGP to distribute IPv4 routes and MPLS label routes are: • BGP takes the place of an IGP and LDP in a VPN forwarding and routing instance (VRF) table. • BGP is the preferred routing protocol for connecting two ISPs, Configuration Options for the Backbone and Customer Carriers To enable CSC, the backbone and customer carriers must be configured accordingly: • The backbone carrier must offer BGP and MPLS VPN services. • The customer carrier can take several networking forms. The customer carrier can be: – An ISP with an IP core (see the “Customer Carrier: ISP with IP Core” section on page MPC-24). – An MPLS service provider with or without VPN services (see “Customer Carrier: MPLS Service Provider” section on page MPC-25). Note An IGP in the customer carrier network is used to distribute next hops and loopbacks to the CSC-CE. IBGP with label sessions are used in the customer carrier network to distribute next hops and loopbacks to the CSC-CE. Customer Carrier: ISP with IP Core Figure 4 shows a network configuration where the customer carrier is an ISP. The customer carrier has two sites, each of which is a point of presence (POP). The customer carrier connects these sites using a VPN service provided by the backbone carrier. The backbone carrier uses MPLS or IP tunnels to provide VPN services. The ISP sites use IP. Figure 4 Network: Customer Carrier Is an ISP The links between the CE and PE routers use eBGP to distribute IPv4 routes and MPLS labels. Between the links, the PE routers use multiprotocol iBGP to distribute VPNv4 routes. ISP site 1 CSC-CE1 IP IP MPLS CSC-PE1 CSC-PE2 CSC-CE2 Backbone carrier ISP site 2 50846Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs Carrier Supporting Carrier Support for L3VPN 25 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Customer Carrier: MPLS Service Provider Figure 5 shows a network configuration where the backbone carrier and the customer carrier are BGP/MPLS VPN service providers. The customer carrier has two sites. The customer carrier uses MPLS in its network while the backbone carrier may use MPLS or IP tunnels in its network. Figure 5 Network: Customer Carrier Is an MPLS VPN Service Provider In this configuration (Figure 5), the customer carrier can configure its network in one of these ways: • The customer carrier can run an IGP and LDP in its core network. In this case, the CSC-CE1 router in the customer carrier redistributes the eBGP routes it learns from the CSC-PE1 router of the backbone carrier to an IGP. • The CSC-CE1 router of the customer carrier system can run an IPv4 and labels iBGP session with the PE1 router. CE1 PE1 Customer carrier MPLS VPN SP Backbone carrier MPLS VPN SP Customer carrier MPLS VPN SP CSC-CE1 CSC-PE1 CSC-PE2 IPv4 + labels IPv4 + labels CSC-CE2 PE2 CE2 MP-IBGP exchanging VPNv4 prefixes MP-IBGP exchanging VPNv4 prefixes 65682Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 26 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs This section contains instructions for these tasks: • Configuring the Core Network, page VPC-26 • Connecting MPLS VPN Customers, page VPC-29 • Providing VPN Connectivity Across Multiple Autonomous Systems with MPLS VPN Inter-AS with ASBRs Exchanging IPv4 Routes and MPLS Labels, page VPC-50 (optional) • Providing VPN Connectivity Across Multiple Autonomous Systems with MPLS VPN Inter-AS with ASBRs Exchanging VPN-IPv4 Addresses, page VPC-59 (optional) • Configuring Carrier Supporting Carrier, page VPC-70 (optional) • Verifying the MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration, page VPC-80 • Configuring L3VPN over GRE, page VPC-83 Configuring the Core Network Configuring the core network includes these tasks: • Assessing the Needs of MPLS VPN Customers, page VPC-26 • Configuring Routing Protocols in the Core, page VPC-27 • Configuring MPLS in the Core, page VPC-27 • Determining if FIB Is Enabled in the Core, page VPC-27 • Configuring Multiprotocol BGP on the PE Routers and Route Reflectors, page VPC-28 Assessing the Needs of MPLS VPN Customers Before configuring an MPLS VPN, the core network topology must be identified so that it can best serve MPLS VPN customers. Perform this task to identify the core network topology. SUMMARY STEPS 1. Identify the size of the network. 2. Identify the routing protocols in the core. 3. Determine if MPLS High Availability support is required. 4. Determine if BGP load sharing and redundant paths are required.Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 27 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 DETAILED STEPS Configuring Routing Protocols in the Core To configure a routing protocol, see the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Routers Routing Configuration Guide. Configuring MPLS in the Core To enable MPLS on all routers in the core, you must configure a Label Distribution Protocol (LDP). You can use either of these as an LDP: • MPLS LDP—See the Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routersfor configuration information. • MPLS Traffic Engineering Resource Reservation Protocol (RSVP)—See Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routers module in this document for configuration information. Determining if FIB Is Enabled in the Core Forwarding Information Base (FIB) must be enabled on all routers in the core, including the provider edge (PE) routers. For information on how to determine if FIB is enabled, see the Implementing Cisco Express Forwarding on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routers module in the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router IP Addresses and Services Configuration Guide. Command or Action Purpose Step 1 Identify the size of the network. Identify these to determine the number of routers and ports required: • How many customers will be supported? • How many VPNs are required for each customer? • How many virtual routing and forwarding (VRF) instances are there for each VPN? Step 2 Identify the routing protocols in the core. Determine which routing protocols are required in the core network. Step 3 Determine if MPLS High Availability support is required. MPLS VPN nonstop forwarding and graceful restart are supported on select routers and Cisco IOS XR software releases. Step 4 Determine if BGP load sharing and redundant paths are required. Determine if BGP load sharing and redundant paths in the MPLS VPN core are required.Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 28 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Configuring Multiprotocol BGP on the PE Routers and Route Reflectors Perform this task to configure multiprotocol BGP (MP-BGP) connectivity on the PE routers and route reflectors. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp autonomous-system-number 3. address-family vpnv4 unicast 4. neighbor ip-address remote-as autonomous-system-number 5. address-family vpnv4 unicast end or commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 configure Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Enters global configuration mode. Step 2 router bgp autonomous-system-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 Enters BGP configuration mode allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. Step 3 address-family vpnv4 unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family vpnv4 unicast Enters VPNv4 address family configuration mode for the VPNv4 address family. Step 4 neighbor ip-address remote-as autonomous-system-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 172.168.40.24 remote-as 2002 Creates a neighbor and assigns it a remote autonomous system number.Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 29 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Connecting MPLS VPN Customers To connect MPLS VPN customers to the VPN, perform these tasks: • Defining VRFs on the PE Routers to Enable Customer Connectivity, page VPC-30 • Configuring VRF Interfaces on PE Routers for Each VPN Customer, page VPC-32 • Configuring BGP as the Routing Protocol Between the PE and CE Routers, page VPC-34 (optional) • Configuring RIPv2 as the Routing Protocol Between the PE and CE Routers, page VPC-38 (optional) • Configuring Static Routes Between the PE and CE Routers, page VPC-41 (optional) • Configuring OSPF as the Routing Protocol Between the PE and CE Routers, page VPC-42 (optional) • Configuring EIGRP as the Routing Protocol Between the PE and CE Routers, page VPC-45 (optional) • Configuring EIGRP Redistribution in the MPLS VPN, page VPC-48 (optional) Step 5 address-family vpnv4 unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family vpnv4 unicast Enters VPNv4 address family configuration mode for the VPNv4 address family. Step 6 end or commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# end or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# commit Saves configuration changes. • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting (yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: – Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. – Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. – Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 30 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Defining VRFs on the PE Routers to Enable Customer Connectivity Perform this task to define VPN routing and forwarding (VRF) instances. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. vrf vrf-name 3. address-family ipv4 unicast 4. import route-policy policy-name 5. import route-target [as-number:nn | ip-address:nn] 6. export route-policy policy-name 7. export route-target [as-number:nn | ip-address:nn] 8. exit 9. exit 10. router bgp autonomous-system-number 11. vrf vrf-name 12. rd {as-number | ip-address | auto} 13. end or commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 configure Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Enters global configuration mode. Step 2 vrf vrf-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# vrf vrf_1 Configures a VRF instance and enters VRF configuration mode. Step 3 address-family ipv4 unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast Enters VRF address family configuration mode for the IPv4 address family. Step 4 import route-policy policy-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf-af)# import route-policy policy_A Specifies a route policy that can be imported into the local VPN.Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 31 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Step 5 import route-target [as-number:nn | ip-address:nn] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf-af)# import route-target 120:1 Allows exported VPN routes to be imported into the VPN if one of the route targets of the exported route matches one of the local VPN import route targets. Step 6 export route-policy policy-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf-af)# export route-policy policy_B Specifies a route policy that can be exported from the local VPN. Step 7 export route-target [as-number:nn | ip-address:nn] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf-af)# export route-target 120:2 Associates the local VPN with a route target. When the route is advertised to other provider edge (PE) routers, the export route target is sent along with the route as an extended community. Step 8 exit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf-af)# exit Exits VRF address family configuration mode and returns the router to VRF configuration mode. Step 9 exit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# exit Exits VRF configuration mode and returns the router to global configuration mode. Step 10 router bgp autonomous-system-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 Enters BGP configuration mode allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. Step 11 vrf vrf-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# vrf vrf_1 Configures a VRF instance and enters VRF configuration mode for BGP routing. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 32 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Configuring VRF Interfaces on PE Routers for Each VPN Customer Perform this task to associate a VPN routing and forwarding (VRF) instance with an interface or a subinterface on the PE routers. Note You must remove IPv4/IPv6 addresses from an interface prior to assigning, removing, or changing an interface's VRF. If this is not done in advance, any attempt to change the VRF on an IP interface is rejected. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. interface type interface-path-id 3. vrf vrf-name 4. ipv4 address ipv4-address mask 5. end or commit Step 12 rd {as-number | ip-address | auto} Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# rd auto Automatically assigns a unique route distinguisher (RD) to vrf_1. Step 13 end or commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# end or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# commit Saves configuration changes. • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: – Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. – Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. – Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 33 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 configure Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Enters global configuration mode. Step 2 interface type interface-path-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# interface GigabitEthernet 0/3/0/0 Enters interface configuration mode. Step 3 vrf vrf-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# vrf vrf_A Configures a VRF instance and enters VRF configuration mode. Step 4 ipv4 address ipv4-address mask Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# ipv4 address 192.168.1.27 255.255.255.0 Configures a primary IPv4 address for the specified interface. Step 5 end or commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# end or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# commit Saves configuration changes. • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: – Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. – Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. – Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session.Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 34 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Configuring BGP as the Routing Protocol Between the PE and CE Routers Perform this task to configure PE-to-CE routing sessions using BGP. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp autonomous-system-number 3. bgp router-id {ip-address} 4. vrf vrf-name 5. label-allocation-mode per-ce 6. address-family ipv4 unicast 7. redistribute connected [metric metric-value] [route-policy route-policy-name] or redistribute isis process-id [level {1 | 1-inter-area | 2}] [metric metric-value] [route-policy route-policy-name] or redistribute ospf process-id [match {external [1 | 2] | internal | nssa-external [1 | 2]}] [metric metric-value] [route-policy route-policy-name] or redistribute static [metric metric-value] [route-policy route-policy-name] 8. aggregate-address address/mask-length [as-set] [as-confed-set] [summary-only] [route-policy route-policy-name] 9. network {ip-address/prefix-length | ip-address mask} [route-policy route-policy-name] 10. exit 11. neighbor ip-address 12. remote-as autonomous-system-number 13. password {clear | encrypted} password 14. ebgp-multihop [ttl-value] 15. address-family ipv4 unicast 16. allowas-in [as-occurrence-number] 17. route-policy route-policy-name in 18. route-policy route-policy-name out 19. end or commitImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 35 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 configure Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Enters global configuration mode. Step 2 router bgp autonomous-system-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 Enters Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) configuration mode allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. Step 3 bgp router-id {ip-address} Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp router-id 192.168.70.24 Configures the local router with a router ID of 192.168.70.24. Step 4 vrf vrf-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# vrf vrf_1 Configures a VPN routing and forwarding (VRF) instance and enters VRF configuration mode for BGP routing. Step 5 label-allocation-mode per-ce Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# label-allocation-mode per-ce Sets the MPLS VPN label allocation mode for each customer edge (CE) label mode allowing the provider edge (PE) router to allocate one label for every immediate next-hop. Step 6 address-family ipv4 unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast Enters VRF address family configuration mode for the IPv4 address family. Step 7 redistribute connected [metric metric-value] [route-policy route-policy-name] or redistribute isis process-id [level {1 | 1-inter-area | 2}] [metric metric-value] [route-policy route-policy-name] or redistribute ospf process-id [match {external [1 | 2] | internal | nssa-external [1 | 2]}] [metric metric-value] [route-policy route-policy-name] or redistribute static [metric metric-value] [route-policy route-policy-name] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)# redistribute connected Causes routes to be redistributed into BGP. The routes that can be redistributed into BGP are: • Connected • Intermediate System-to-Intermediate System (IS-IS) • Open Shortest Path First (OSPF) • StaticImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 36 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Step 8 aggregate-address address/mask-length [as-set] [as-confed-set] [summary-only] [route-policy route-policy-name] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)# aggregate-address 10.0.0.0/8 as-set Creates an aggregate address. The path advertised for this route is an autonomous system set consisting of all elements contained in all paths that are being summarized. • The as-set keyword generates autonomous system set path information and community information from contributing paths. • The as-confed-set keyword generates autonomous system confederation set path information from contributing paths. • The summary-only keyword filters all more specific routes from updates. • The route-policy route-policy-name keyword and argument specify the route policy used to set the attributes of the aggregate route. Step 9 network {ip-address/prefix-length | ip-address mask} [route-policy route-policy-name] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)# network 172.20.0.0/16 Configures the local router to originate and advertise the specified network. Step 10 exit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)# exit Exits VRF address family configuration mode and returns the router to VRF configuration mode for BGP routing. Step 11 neighbor ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# neighbor 172.168.40.24 Places the router in VRF neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address 172.168.40.24 as a BGP peer. Step 12 remote-as autonomous-system-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr)# remote-as 2002 Creates a neighbor and assigns it a remote autonomous system number. Step 13 password {clear | encrypted} password Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr)# password clear pswd123 Configures neighbor 172.168.40.24 to use MD5 authentication with the password pswd123. Step 14 ebgp-multihop [ttl-value] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr)# ebgp-multihop Allows a BGP connection to neighbor 172.168.40.24. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 37 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Step 15 address-family ipv4 unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast Enters VRF neighbor address family configuration mode for BGP routing. Step 16 allowas-in [as-occurrence-number] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr-af)# allowas-in 3 Replaces the neighbor autonomous system number (ASN) with the PE ASN in the AS path three times. Step 17 route-policy route-policy-name in Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr-af)# route-policy In-Ipv4 in Applies the In-Ipv4 policy to inbound IPv4 unicast routes. Step 18 route-policy route-policy-name out Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr-af)# route-policy In-Ipv4 in Applies the In-Ipv4 policy to outbound IPv4 unicast routes. Step 19 end or commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr-af)# end or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr-af)# commit Saves configuration changes. • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: – Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. – Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. – Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 38 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Configuring RIPv2 as the Routing Protocol Between the PE and CE Routers Perform this task to configure provider edge (PE)-to-customer edge (CE) routing sessions using Routing Information Protocol version 2 (RIPv2). SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router rip 3. vrf vrf-name 4. interface type instance 5. site-of-origin {as-number:number | ip-address:number} 6. exit 7. redistribute bgp as-number [[external | internal | local] [route-policy name] or redistribute connected [route-policy name] or redistribute isis process-id [level-1 | level-1-2 | level-2] [route-policy name] or redistribute eigrp as-number [route-policy name] or redistribute ospf process-id [match {external [1 | 2] | internal | nssa-external [1 | 2]}] [route-policy name] or redistribute static [route-policy name] 8. end or commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 configure Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Enters global configuration mode. Step 2 router rip Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router rip Enters the Routing Information Protocol (RIP) configuration mode allowing you to configure the RIP routing process. Step 3 vrf vrf-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rip)# vrf vrf_1 Configures a VPN routing and forwarding (VRF) instance and enters VRF configuration mode for RIP routing.Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 39 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Step 4 interface type instance Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rip-vrf)# interface GigabitEthernet 0/3/0/0 Enters VRF interface configuration mode. Step 5 site-of-origin {as-number:number | ip-address:number} Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rip-vrf-if)# site-of-origin 200:1 Identifies routes that have originated from a site so that the re-advertisement of that prefix back to the source site can be prevented. Uniquely identifies the site from which a PE router has learned a route. Step 6 exit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rip-vrf-if)# exit Exits VRF interface configuration mode, and returns the router to VRF configuration mode for RIP routing. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 40 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Step 7 redistribute bgp as-number [[external | internal | local] [route-policy name] or redistribute connected [route-policy name] or redistribute eigrp as-number [route-policy name] or redistribute isis process-id [level-1 | level-1-2 | level-2] [route-policy name] or redistribute ospf process-id [match {external [1 | 2] | internal | nssa-external [1 | 2]}] [route-policy name] or redistribute static [route-policy name] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rip-vrf)# redistribute connected Causes routes to be redistributed into RIP. The routes that can be redistributed into RIP are: • Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) • Connected • Enhanced Interior Gateway Routing Protocol (EIGRP) • Intermediate System-to-Intermediate System (IS-IS) • Open Shortest Path First (OSPF) • Static Step 8 end or commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rip-vrf)# end or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rip-vrf)# commit Saves configuration changes. • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: – Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. – Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. – Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 41 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Configuring Static Routes Between the PE and CE Routers Perform this task to configure provider edge (PE)-to-customer edge (CE) routing sessions that use static routes. Note You must remove IPv4/IPv6 addresses from an interface prior to assigning, removing, or changing an interface's VRF. If this is not done in advance, any attempt to change the VRF on an IP interface is rejected. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router static 3. vrf vrf-name 4. address-family ipv4 unicast 5. prefix/mask [vrf vrf-name] {ip-address | type interface-path-id} 6. prefix/mask [vrf vrf-name] bfd fast-detect 7. end or commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 configure Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Enters global configuration mode. Step 2 router static Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router static Enters static routing configuration mode allowing you to configure the static routing process. Step 3 vrf vrf-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-static)# vrf vrf_1 Configures a VPN routing and forwarding (VRF) instance and enters VRF configuration mode for static routing. Step 4 address-family ipv4 unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-static-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast Enters VRF address family configuration mode for the IPv4 address family.Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 42 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Configuring OSPF as the Routing Protocol Between the PE and CE Routers Perform this task to configure provider edge (PE)-to-customer edge (CE) routing sessions that use Open Shortest Path First (OSPF). SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router ospf process-name 3. vrf vrf-name 4. router-id {router-id | type interface-path-id} 5. redistribute bgp process-id [metric metric-value] [metric-type {1 | 2}] [route-policy policy-name] [tag tag-value] or redistribute connected [metric metric-value] [metric-type {1 | 2}] [route-policy policy-name] [tag tag-value] Step 5 prefix/mask [vrf vrf-name] {ip-address | type interface-path-id} Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-static-vrf-afi)# 172.168.40.24/24 vrf vrf_1 10.1.1.1 Assigns the static route to vrf_1. Step 6 prefix/mask [vrf vrf-name] bfd fast-detect Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-static-vrf-afi)# 172.168.40.24/24 vrf vrf_1 bfd fast-detect Enables bidirectional forwarding detection (BFD) to detect failures in the path between adjacent forwarding engines. This option is available is when the forwarding router address is specified in Step 5. Step 7 end or commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-static-vrf-afi)# end or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-static-vrf-afi)# commit Saves configuration changes. • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: – Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. – Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. – Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 43 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 or redistribute ospf process-id [match {external [1 | 2] | internal | nssa-external [1 | 2]}] [metric metric-value] [metric-type {1 | 2}] [route-policy policy-name] [tag tag-value] or redistribute static [metric metric-value] [metric-type {1 | 2}] [route-policy policy-name] [tag tag-value] or redistribute eigrp process-id [match {external [1 | 2] | internal | nssa-external [1 | 2]}] [metric metric-value] [metric-type {1 | 2}] [route-policy policy-name] [tag tag-value] or redistribute rip [metric metric-value] [metric-type {1 | 2}] [route-policy policy-name] [tag tag-value] 6. area area-id 7. interface type interface-path-id 8. end or commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 configure Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Enters global configuration mode. Step 2 router ospf process-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router ospf 109 Enters OSPF configuration mode allowing you to configure the OSPF routing process. Step 3 vrf vrf-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf)# vrf vrf_1 Configures a VPN routing and forwarding (VRF) instance and enters VRF configuration mode for OSPF routing. Step 4 router-id {router-id | type interface-path-id} Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf-vrf)# router-id 172.20.10.10 Configures the router ID for the OSPF routing process.Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 44 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Step 5 redistribute bgp process-id [metric metric-value] [metric-type {1 | 2}] [route-policy policy-name] [tag tag-value] or redistribute connected [metric metric-value] [metric-type {1 | 2}] [route-policy policy-name] [tag tag-value] or redistribute ospf process-id [match {external [1 | 2] | internal | nssa-external [1 | 2]}] [metric metric-value] [metric-type {1 | 2}] [route-policy policy-name] [tag tag-value] or redistribute static [metric metric-value] [metric-type {1 | 2}] [route-policy policy-name] [tag tag-value] or redistribute eigrp process-id [match {external [1 | 2] | internal | nssa-external [1 | 2]]}[metric metric-value] [metric-type {1 | 2}] [route-policy policy-name] [tag tag-value] or redistribute rip [metric metric-value] [metric-type {1 | 2}] [route-policy policy-name] [tag tag-value] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf-vrf)# redistribute connected Causes routes to be redistributed into OSPF. The routes that can be redistributed into OSPF are: • Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) • Connected • Enhanced Interior Gateway Routing Protocol (EIGRP) • OSPF • Static • Routing Information Protocol (RIP) Step 6 area area-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf-vrf)# area 0 Configures the OSPF area as area 0. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 45 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Configuring EIGRP as the Routing Protocol Between the PE and CE Routers Perform this task to configure provider edge (PE)-to-customer edge (CE) routing sessions that use Enhanced Interior Gateway Routing Protocol (EIGRP). Using EIGRP between the PE and CE routers allows you to transparently connect EIGRP customer networks through an MPLS-enable Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) core network so that EIGRP routes are redistributed through the VPN across the BGP network as internal BGP (iBGP) routes. Prerequisites BGP must configured in the network. See the Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routers module in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Routers Routing Configuration Guide. Note You must remove IPv4/IPv6 addresses from an interface prior to assigning, removing, or changing an interface's VRF. If this is not done in advance, any attempt to change the VRF on an IP interface is rejected. Step 7 interface type interface-path-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf-vrf-ar)# interface GigabitEthernet 0/3/0/0 Associates interface GigabitEthernet 0/3/0/0 with area 0. Step 8 end or commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf-vrf-ar-if)# end or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf-vrf-ar-if)# commit Saves configuration changes. • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: – Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. – Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. – Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 46 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router eigrp as-number 3. vrf vrf-name 4. address-family ipv4 5. router-id router-id 6. autonomous-system as-number 7. default-metric bandwidth delay reliability loading mtu 8. redistribute {{bgp | connected | isis | ospf| rip | static} [as-number | instance-name]} [route-policy name] 9. interface type interface-path-id 10. site-of-origin {as-number:number | ip-address:number} 11. end or commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 configure Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Enters global configuration mode. Step 2 router eigrp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router eigrp 24 Enters EIGRP configuration mode allowing you to configure the EIGRP routing process. Step 3 vrf vrf-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp)# vrf vrf_1 Configures a VPN routing and forwarding (VRF) instance and enters VRF configuration mode for EIGRP routing. Step 4 address-family ipv4 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf)# address family ipv4 Enters VRF address family configuration mode for the IPv4 address family. Step 5 router-id router-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf-af)# router-id 172.20.0.0 Configures the router ID for the Enhanced Interior Gateway Routing Protocol (EIGRP) routing process.Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 47 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Step 6 autonomous-system as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf-af)# autonomous-system 6 Configures the EIGRP routing process to run within a VRF. Step 7 default-metric bandwidth delay reliability loading mtu Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf-af)# default-metric 100000 4000 200 45 4470 Sets the metrics for an EIGRP. Step 8 redistribute {{bgp | connected | isis | ospf| rip | static} [as-number | instance-name]} [route-policy name] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf-af)# redistribute connected Causes connected routes to be redistributed into EIGRP. Step 9 interface type interface-path-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf-af)# interface GigabitEthernet 0/3/0/0 Associates interface GigabitEthernet 0/3/0/0 with the EIGRP routing process. Step 10 site-of-origin {as-number:number | ip-address:number} Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf-af-if)# site-of-origin 201:1 Configures site of origin (SoO) on interface GigabitEthernet 0/3/0/0. Step 11 end or commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf-af-if)# end or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf-af-if)# commit Saves configuration changes. • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: – Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. – Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. – Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 48 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Configuring EIGRP Redistribution in the MPLS VPN Perform this task for every provider edge (PE) router that provides VPN services to enable Enhanced Interior Gateway Routing Protocol (EIGRP) redistribution in the MPLS VPN. Prerequisites The metric can be configured in the route-policy configuring using the redistribute command (or configured with the default-metric command). If an external route is received from another EIGRP autonomous system or a non-EIGRP network without a configured metric, the route is not installed in the EIGRP database. If an external route is received from another EIGRP autonomous system or a non-EIGRP network without a configured metric, the route is not advertised to the CE router. See the Implementing EIGRP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routers module in the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Routers Routing Configuration Guide. Restrictions Redistribution between native EIGRP VPN routing and forwarding (VRF) instances is not supported. This behavior is designed. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router eigrp as-number 3. vrf vrf-name 4. address-family ipv4 5. redistribute bgp [as-number] [route-policy policy-name] 6. end or commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 configure Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Enters global configuration mode. Step 2 router eigrp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router eigrp 24 Enters EIGRP configuration mode allowing you to configure the EIGRP routing process. Step 3 vrf vrf-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp)# vrf vrf_1 Configures a VRF instance and enters VRF configuration mode for EIGRP routing.Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 49 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Step 4 address-family ipv4 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf)# address family ipv4 Enters VRF address family configuration mode for the IPv4 address family. Step 5 redistribute bgp [as-number] [route-policy policy-name] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf-af)# redistribute bgp 24 route-policy policy_A Causes Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) routes to be redistributed into EIGRP. Step 6 end or commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf-af-if)# end or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-eigrp-vrf-af-if)# commit Saves configuration changes. • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: – Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. – Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. – Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 50 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Providing VPN Connectivity Across Multiple Autonomous Systems with MPLS VPN Inter-AS with ASBRs Exchanging IPv4 Routes and MPLS Labels Note This section is not applicable to Inter-AS over IP tunnels. This section contains instructions for these tasks: • Configuring ASBRs to Exchange IPv4 Routes and MPLS Labels, page VPC-50 • Configuring the Route Reflectors to Exchange VPN-IPv4 Routes, page VPC-53 • Configuring the Route Reflector to Reflect Remote Routes in its AS, page VPC-56 Configuring ASBRs to Exchange IPv4 Routes and MPLS Labels Perform this task to configure the autonomous system boundary routers (ASBRs) to exchange IPv4 routes and MPLS labels. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp autonomous-system-number 3. address-family ipv4 unicast 4. allocate-label all 5. neighbor ip-address 6. remote-as autonomous-system-number 7. address-family ipv4 labeled-unicast 8. route-policy route-policy-name in 9. route-policy route-policy-name out 10. end or commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 configure Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Enters global configuration mode. Step 2 router bgp autonomous-system-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# Enters Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) configuration mode allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 51 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Step 3 address-family ipv4 unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# Enters global address family configuration mode for the IPv4 unicast address family. Step 4 allocate-label all Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# allocate-label all Allocates the MPLS labels for a specific IPv4 unicast or VPN routing and forwarding (VRF) IPv4 unicast routes so that the BGP router can send labels with BGP routes to a neighboring router that is configured for a labeled-unicast session. Step 5 neighbor ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# neighbor 172.168.40.24 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address 172.168.40.24 as a BGP peer. Step 6 remote-as autonomous-system-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 2002 Creates a neighbor and assigns it a remote autonomous system number. Step 7 address-family ipv4 labeled-unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 labeled-unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af) Enters neighbor address family configuration mode for the IPv4 labeled-unicast address family. Step 8 route-policy route-policy-name in Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy pass-all in Applies a routing policy to updates that are received from a BGP neighbor. • Use the route-policy-name argument to define the name of the of route policy. The example shows that the route policy name is defined as pass-all. • Use the in keyword to define the policy for inbound routes. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 52 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Step 9 route-policy route-policy-name out Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy pass-all out Applies a routing policy to updates that are sent to a BGP neighbor. • Use the route-policy-name argument to define the name of the of route policy. The example shows that the route policy name is defined as pass-all. • Use the out keyword to define the policy for outbound routes. Step 10 end or commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# end or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# commit Saves configuration changes. • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: – Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. – Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. – Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 53 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Configuring the Route Reflectors to Exchange VPN-IPv4 Routes Perform this task to enable the route reflectors to exchange VPN-IPv4 routes by using multihop. This task specifies that the next-hop information and the VPN label are to be preserved across the autonomous system. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp autonomous-system-number 3. neighbor ip-address 4. remote-as autonomous-system-number 5. ebgp-multihop [ttl-value] 6. update-source type interface-path-id 7. address-family vpnv4 unicast 8. route-policy route-policy-name in 9. route-policy route-policy-name out 10. next-hop-unchanged 11. end or commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 configure Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Enters global configuration mode. Step 2 router bgp autonomous-system-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# Enters Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) configuration mode allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. Step 3 neighbor ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 172.168.40.24 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address 172.168.40.24 as a BGP peer. Step 4 remote-as autonomous-system-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 2002 Creates a neighbor and assigns it a remote autonomous system number.Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 54 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Step 5 ebgp-multihop [ttl-value] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# ebgp-multihop Enables multihop peerings with external BGP neighbors. Step 6 update-source type interface-path-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# update-source loopback0 Allows BGP sessions to use the primary IP address from a particular interface as the local address. Step 7 address-family vpnv4 unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family vpnv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# Configures VPNv4 address family. Step 8 route-policy route-policy-name in Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy pass-all in Applies a routing policy to updates that are received from a BGP neighbor. • Use the route-policy-name argument to define the name of the of route policy. The example shows that the route policy name is defined as pass-all. • Use the in keyword to define the policy for inbound routes. Step 9 route-policy route-policy-name out Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy pass-all out Applies a routing policy to updates that are sent to a BGP neighbor. • Use the route-policy-name argument to define the name of the of route policy. The example shows that the route policy name is defined as pass-all. • Use the out keyword to define the policy for outbound routes. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 55 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Step 10 next-hop-unchanged Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# next-hop-unchanged Disables overwriting of the next hop before advertising to external Border Gateway Protocol (eBGP) peers. Step 11 end or commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# end or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# commit Saves configuration changes. • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: – Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. – Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. – Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 56 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Configuring the Route Reflector to Reflect Remote Routes in its AS Perform this task to enable the route reflector (RR) to reflect the IPv4 routes and labels learned by the autonomous system boundary router (ASBR) to the provider edge (PE) routers in the autonomous system. This task is accomplished by making the ASBR and PE route reflector clients of the RR. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp autonomous-system-number 3. address-family ipv4 unicast 4. allocate-label all 5. neighbor ip-address 6. remote-as autonomous-system-number 7. update-source type interface-path-id 8. address-family ipv4 labeled-unicast 9. route-reflector-client 10. neighbor ip-address 11. remote-as autonomous-system-number 12. update-source type interface-path-id 13. address-family ipv4 labeled-unicast 14. route-reflector-client 15. end or commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 configure Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Enters global configuration mode. Step 2 router bgp autonomous-system-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 Enters Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) configuration mode allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. Step 3 address-family ipv4 unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# Enters global address family configuration mode for the IPv4 unicast address family.Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 57 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Step 4 allocate-label all Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# allocate-label all Allocates the MPLS labels for a specific IPv4 unicast or VPN routing and forwarding (VRF) IPv4 unicast routes so that the BGP router can send labels with BGP routes to a neighboring router that is configured for a labeled-unicast session. Step 5 neighbor ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# neighbor 172.168.40.24 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address 172.168.40.24 as an ASBR eBGP peer. Step 6 remote-as autonomous-system-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 2002 Creates a neighbor and assigns it a remote autonomous system number. Step 7 update-source type interface-path-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# update-source loopback0 Allows BGP sessions to use the primary IP address from a particular interface as the local address. Step 8 address-family ipv4 labeled-unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 labeled-unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# Enters neighbor address family configuration mode for the IPv4 labeled-unicast address family. Step 9 route-reflector-client Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-reflector-client Configures the router as a BGP route reflector and neighbor 172.168.40.24 as its client. Step 10 neighbor ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# neighbor 10.40.25.2 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address 10.40.25.2 as an VPNv4 iBGP peer. Step 11 remote-as autonomous-system-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 2002 Creates a neighbor and assigns it a remote autonomous system number. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 58 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Step 12 update-source type interface-path-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# update-source loopback0 Allows BGP sessions to use the primary IP address from a particular interface as the local address. Step 13 address-family ipv4 labeled-unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 labeled-unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# Enters neighbor address family configuration mode for the IPv4 labeled-unicast address family. Step 14 route-reflector-client Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-reflector-client Configures the neighbor as a route reflector client. Step 15 end or commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# end or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# commit Saves configuration changes. • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: – Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. – Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. – Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 59 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Providing VPN Connectivity Across Multiple Autonomous Systems with MPLS VPN Inter-AS with ASBRs Exchanging VPN-IPv4 Addresses This section contains instructions for these tasks: • Configuring the ASBRs to Exchange VPN-IPv4 Addresses, page VPC-59 • Configuring a Static Route to an ASBR Peer, page VPC-62 • Configuring EBGP Routing to Exchange VPN Routes Between Subautonomous Systems in a Confederation, page VPC-64 • Configuring MPLS Forwarding for ASBR Confederations, page VPC-66 • Configuring a Static Route to an ASBR Confederation Peer, page VPC-68 Configuring the ASBRs to Exchange VPN-IPv4 Addresses Perform this task to configure an external Border Gateway Protocol (eBGP) autonomous system boundary router (ASBR) to exchange VPN-IPv4 routes with another autonomous system. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp autonomous-system-number 3. address-family vpnv4 unicast 4. retain route-target {all | route-policy route-policy-name} 5. neighbor ip-address 6. remote-as autonomous-system-number 7. address-family vpnv4 unicast 8. route-policy route-policy-name in 9. route-policy route-policy-name out 10. neighbor ip-address 11. remote-as autonomous-system-number 12. update-source type interface-path-id 13. address-family vpnv4 unicast 14. end or commitImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 60 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 configure Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Enters global configuration mode. Step 2 router bgp autonomous-system-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# Enters Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) configuration mode allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. Step 3 address-family vpnv4 unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family vpnv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# Configures VPNv4 address family. Step 4 retain route-target {all | route-policy route-policy-name} Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# retain route-target route-policy policy1 Retrieves VPNv4 table from PE routers. The retain route-target command is required on an Inter-AS option B ASBR. You can use this command with either all or route-policy keyword Step 5 neighbor ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# neighbor 172.168.40.24 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address 172.168.40.24 as an ASBR eBGP peer. Step 6 remote-as autonomous-system-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 2002 Creates a neighbor and assigns it a remote autonomous system number. Step 7 address-family vpnv4 unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family vpnv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# Configures VPNv4 address family.Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 61 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Step 8 route-policy route-policy-name in Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy pass-all in Applies a routing policy to updates that are received from a BGP neighbor. • Use the route-policy-name argument to define the name of the of route policy. The example shows that the route policy name is defined as pass-all. • Use the in keyword to define the policy for inbound routes. Step 9 route-policy route-policy-name out Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy pass-all out Applies a routing policy to updates that are sent from a BGP neighbor. • Use the route-policy-name argument to define the name of the of route policy. The example shows that the route policy name is defined as pass-all. • Use the out keyword to define the policy for outbound routes. Step 10 neighbor ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# neighbor 10.40.25.2 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address 10.40.25.2 as an VPNv4 iBGP peer. Step 11 remote-as autonomous-system-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 2002 Creates a neighbor and assigns it a remote autonomous system number. Step 12 update-source type interface-path-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# update-source loopback0 Allows BGP sessions to use the primary IP address from a particular interface as the local address. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 62 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Configuring a Static Route to an ASBR Peer Perform this task to configure a static route to an ASBR peer. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router static 3. address-family ipv4 unicast 4. A.B.C.D/length next-hop 5. end or commit Step 13 address-family vpnv4 unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family vpnv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# Configures VPNv4 address family. Step 14 end or commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# end or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# commit Saves configuration changes. • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: – Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. – Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. – Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 63 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 configure Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Enters global configuration mode. Step 2 router static Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router static RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-static)# Enters router static configuration mode. Step 3 address-family ipv4 unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-static)# address-family ipv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-static-afi)# Enables an IPv4 address family. Step 4 A.B.C.D/length next-hop Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-static-afi)# 10.10.10.10/32 10.9.9.9 Enters the address of the destination router (including IPv4 subnet mask). Step 5 end or commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-static-afi)# end or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-static-afi)# commit Saves configuration changes. • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: – Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. – Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. – Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session.Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 64 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Configuring EBGP Routing to Exchange VPN Routes Between Subautonomous Systems in a Confederation Perform this task to configure external Border Gateway Protocol (eBGP) routing to exchange VPN routes between subautonomous systems in a confederation. Note To ensure that host routes for VPN-IPv4 eBGP neighbors are propagated (by means of the Interior Gateway Protocol [IGP]) to other routers and PE routers, specify the redistribute connected command in the IGP configuration portion of the confederation eBGP (CEBGP) router. If you are using Open Shortest Path First (OSPF), make sure that the OSPF process is not enabled on the CEBGP interface in which the “redistribute connected” subnet exists. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp autonomous-system-number 3. bgp confederation peers peer autonomous-system-number 4. bgp confederation identifier autonomous-system-number 5. address-family vpnv4 unicast 6. neighbor ip-address 7. remote-as autonomous-system-number 8. address-family vpnv4 unicast 9. route-policy route-policy-name in 10. route-policy route-policy-name out 11. next-hop-self 12. end or commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 configure Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Enters global configuration mode. Step 2 router bgp autonomous-system-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# Enters BGP configuration mode allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 65 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Step 3 bgp confederation peers peer autonomous-system-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp confederation peers 8 Configures the peer autonomous system number that belongs to the confederation. Step 4 bgp confederation identifier autonomous-system-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp confederation identifier 5 Specifies the autonomous system number for the confederation ID. Step 5 address-family vpnv4 unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family vpnv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# Configures VPNv4 address family. Step 6 neighbor ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# neighbor 10.168.40.24 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address 10.168.40.24 as a BGP peer. Step 7 remote-as autonomous-system-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 2002 Creates a neighbor and assigns it a remote autonomous system number. Step 8 address-family vpnv4 unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family vpnv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# Configures VPNv4 address family. Step 9 route-policy route-policy-name in Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy In-Ipv4 in Applies a routing policy to updates received from a BGP neighbor. Step 10 route-policy route-policy-name out Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy Out-Ipv4 out Applies a routing policy to updates advertised to a BGP neighbor. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 66 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Configuring MPLS Forwarding for ASBR Confederations Perform this task to configure MPLS forwarding for autonomous system boundary router (ASBR) confederations (in BGP) on a specified interface. Note This configuration adds the implicit NULL rewrite corresponding to the peer associated with the interface, which is required to prevent BGP from automatically installing rewrites by LDP (in multihop instances). SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. mpls activate 4. interface type interface-path-id 5. end or commit Step 11 next-hop-self Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# next-hop-self Disables next-hop calculation and let you insert your own address in the next-hop field of BGP updates. Step 12 end or commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# end or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# commit Saves configuration changes. • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: – Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. – Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. – Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 67 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 configure Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Enters global configuration mode. Step 2 router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp) Enters BGP configuration mode allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. Step 3 mpls activate Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# mpls activate RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-mpls)# Enters BGP MPLS activate configuration mode. Step 4 interface type interface-path-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-mpls)# interface GigabitEthernet 0/3/0/0 Enables MPLS on the interface. Step 5 end or commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-mpls)# end or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-mpls)# commit Saves configuration changes. • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: – Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. – Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. – Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session.Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 68 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Configuring a Static Route to an ASBR Confederation Peer Perform this task to configure a static route to an Inter-AS confederation peer. For more detailed information, see “Configuring a Static Route to a Peer” section on page MPC-78. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router static 3. address-family ipv4 unicast 4. A.B.C.D/length next-hop 5. end or commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 configure Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Enters global configuration mode. Step 2 router static Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router static RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-static)# Enters router static configuration mode. Step 3 address-family ipv4 unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-static)# address-family ipv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-static-afi)# Enables an IPv4 address family.Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 69 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Step 4 A.B.C.D/length next-hop Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-static-afi)# 10.10.10.10/32 10.9.9.9 Enters the address of the destination router (including IPv4 subnet mask). Step 5 end or commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-static-afi)# end or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-static-afi)# commit Saves configuration changes. • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: – Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. – Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. – Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 70 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Configuring Carrier Supporting Carrier Perform the tasks in this section to configure Carrier Supporting Carrier (CSC): • Identifying the Carrier Supporting Carrier Topology, page VPC-70 • Configuring the Backbone Carrier Core, page VPC-71 • Configuring the CSC-PE and CSC-CE Routers, page VPC-71 • Configuring a Static Route to a Peer, page VPC-78 Identifying the Carrier Supporting Carrier Topology Before you configure the MPLS VPN CSC with BGP, you must identify both the backbone and customer carrier topology. Note You can connect multiple CSC-CE routers to the same PE, or you can connect a single CSC-CE router to multiple CSC-PEs using more than one CSC-CE interface to provide redundancy and multiple path support in a CSC topology. Perform this task to identify the carrier supporting carrier topology. SUMMARY STEPS 1. Identify the type of customer carrier, ISP, or MPLS VPN service provider. 2. Identify the CE routers. 3. Identify the customer carrier core router configuration. 4. Identify the customer carrier edge (CSC-CE) routers. 5. Identify the backbone carrier router configuration. DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 Identify the type of customer carrier, ISP, or MPLS VPN service provider. Sets up requirements for configuration of carrier supporting carrier network. Step 2 Identify the CE routers. Sets up requirements for configuration of CE to PE connections. Step 3 Identify the customer carrier core router configuration. Sets up requirements for configuration between core (P) routers and between P routers and edge routers (PE and CSC-CE routers). Step 4 Identify the customer carrier edge (CSC-CE) routers. Sets up requirements for configuration of CSC-CE to CSC-PE connections. Step 5 Identify the backbone carrier router configuration. Sets up requirements for configuration between CSC core routers and between CSC core routers and edge routers (CSC-CE and CSC-PE routers).Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 71 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Configuring the Backbone Carrier Core Configuring the backbone carrier core requires setting up connectivity and routing functions for the CSC core and the CSC-PE routers. To do so, you must complete these high-level tasks: • Verify IP connectivity in the CSC core. • Verify LDP configuration in the CSC core. Note This task is not applicable to CSC over IP tunnels. • Configure VRFs for CSC-PE routers. • Configure multiprotocol BGP for VPN connectivity in the backbone carrier. Configuring the CSC-PE and CSC-CE Routers Perform these tasks to configure links between a CSC-PE router and the carrier CSC-CE router for an MPLS VPN CSC network that uses BGP to distribute routes and MPLS labels: • Configuring a CSC-PE • Configuring a CSC-CE Figure 6 shows the configuration for the peering with directly connected interfaces between CSC-PE and CSC-CE routers. This configuration is used as the example in the tasks that follow. Figure 6 Configuration for Peering with Directly Connected Interfaces Between CSC-PE and CSC-CE Routers Configuring a CSC-PE Perform this task to configure a CSC-PE. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. address-family vpnv4 unicast 4. neighbor A.B.C.D 5. remote-as as-number 6. update-source type interface-path-id 7. address-family vpnv4 unicast 8. vrf vrf-name 9. rd {as-number:nn | ip-address:nn | auto} CSC-CE e1/0 e1/0 10.0.0.1 10.0.0.2 CSC-PE 121190Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 72 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 10. address-family ipv4 unicast 11. allocate-label all 12. neighbor A.B.C.D 13. remote-as as-number 14. address-family ipv4 labeled-unicast 15. route-policy route-policy-name in 16. route-policy route-policy-name out 17. end or commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 configure Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Enters global configuration mode. Step 2 router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 2 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# Configures a BGP routing process and enters router configuration mode. • Range for 2-byte numbers is 1 to 65535. Range for 4-byte numbers is 1.0 to 65535.65535. Step 3 address-family vpnv4 unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family vpnv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# Configures VPNv4 address family. Step 4 neighbor A.B.C.D Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# neighbor 10.10.10.0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# Configures the IP address for the BGP neighbor. Step 5 remote-as as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 888 Configures the AS number for the BGP neighbor. Step 6 update-source type interface-path-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# update-source loopback0 Allows BGP sessions to use the primary IP address from a particular interface as the local address.Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 73 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Step 7 address-family vpnv4 unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family vpnv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# Configures VPNv4 unicast address family. Step 8 vrf vrf-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# vrf 9999 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# Configures a VRF instance. Step 9 rd {as-number:nn | ip-address:nn | auto} Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(onfig-bgp-vrf)# rd auto Configures a route distinguisher. Note Use the auto keyword to automatically assign a unique route distinguisher. Step 10 address-family ipv4 unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)# Configures IPv4 unicast address family. Step 11 allocate-label all Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)# allocate-label all Allocate labels for all local prefixes and prefixes received with labels. Step 12 neighbor A.B.C.D Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)# neighbor 10.10.10.0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr)# Configures the IP address for the BGP neighbor. Step 13 remote-as as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr)# remote-as 888 Enables the exchange of information with a neighboring BGP router. Step 14 address-family ipv4 labeled-unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr)# address-family ipv4 labeled-unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr-af)# Configures IPv4 labeled-unicast address family. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 74 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Step 15 route-policy route-policy-name in Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr-af)# route-policy pass-all in Applies the pass-all policy to all inbound routes. Step 16 route-policy route-policy-name out Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr-af)# route-policy pass-all out Applies the pass-all policy to all outbound routes. Step 17 end or commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(cconfig-bgp-vrf-nbr-af)# end or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr-af)# commit Saves configuration changes. • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: – Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. – Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. – Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 75 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Configuring a CSC-CE Perform this task to configure a CSC-CE. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. address-family ipv4 unicast 4. redistribute ospf instance-number 5. allocate-label route-policy route-policy-name 6. exit 7. neighbor A.B.C.D 8. remote-as as-number 9. address-family ipv4 labeled-unicast 10. route-policy route-policy-name in 11. route-policy route-policy-name out 12. end or commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 configure Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Enters global configuration mode. Step 2 router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 1 Configures a BGP routing process and enters router configuration mode. • Range for 2-byte numbers is 1 to 65535. Range for 4-byte numbers is 1.0 to 65535.65535. Step 3 address-family ipv4 unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 unicast Configures IPv4 unicast address-family. Step 4 redistribute ospf instance-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-router-af)# redistribute ospf 1 Redistributes OSPF routes into BGP.Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 76 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Step 5 allocate-label route-policy route-policy-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-router-af)# allocate-label route-policy internal-routes Allocates labels for those routes that match the route policy. These labeled routes are advertised to neighbors configured with address-family ipv4 labeled-unicast. Step 6 exit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# exit Exits the current configuration mode. Step 7 neighbor A.B.C.D Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 10.0.0.1 Configures the IP address for the BGP neighbor. Step 8 remote-as as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 1 Enables the exchange of information with a neighboring BGP router. Step 9 address-family ipv4 labeled-unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 labeled-unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# Configures IPv4 labeled-unicast address family. Step 10 route-policy route-policy-name in Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy pass-all in Applies the route-policy to all inbound routes. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 77 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Step 11 route-policy route-policy-name out Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy pass-all out Applies the route-policy to all outbound routes. Step 12 end or commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# end or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# commit Saves configuration changes. • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: – Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. – Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. – Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 78 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Configuring a Static Route to a Peer Perform this task to configure a static route to an Inter-AS or CSC-CE peer. When you configure an Inter-AS or CSC peer, BGP allocates a label for a /32 route to that peer and performs a NULL label rewrite. When forwarding a labeled packet to the peer, the router removes the top label from the label stack; however, in such an instance, BGP expects a /32 route to the peer. This task ensures that there is, in fact, a /32 route to the peer. Please be aware of these facts before performing this task: • A /32 route is not required to establish BGP peering. A route using a shorter prefix length will also work. • A shorter prefix length route is not associated with the allocated label; even though the BGP session comes up between the peers, without the static route, forwarding will not work. Note To configure a static route on a CSC-PE, you must configure the router under the VRF (as noted in the detailed steps). SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router static 3. address-family ipv4 unicast 4. A.B.C.D/length next-hop 5. end or commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 configure Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# configure Enters global configuration mode. Step 2 router static Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router static Enters router static configuration mode. Step 3 address-family ipv4 unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-static)# address-family ipv4 unicast Enables an IPv4 address family. Note To configure a static route on a CSC-PE, you must first configure the VRF using the vrf command before address-family. Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 79 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Step 4 A.B.C.D/length next-hop Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-static-afi)# 10.10.10.10/32 10.9.9.9 Enters the address of the destination router (including IPv4 subnet mask). Step 5 end or commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-static-af)# end or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-static-af)# commit Saves configuration changes. • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: – Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. – Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. – Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 80 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Verifying the MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Perform this task to verify the MPLS Layer 3 VPN configuration. SUMMARY STEPS 1. show running-config router bgp as-number vrf vrf-name 2. show running-config routes 3. show ospf vrf vrf-name database 4. show running-config router bgp as-number vrf vrf-name neighbor ip-address 5. show bgp vrf vrf-name summary 6. show bgp vrf vrf-name neighbors ip-address 7. show bgp vrf vrf-name 8. show route vrf vrf-name ip-address 9. show bgp vpn unicast summary 10. show running-config router isis 11. show running-config mpls 12. show isis adjacency 13. show mpls ldp forwarding 14. show bgp vpnv4 unicast show bgp vrf vrf-name 15. show bgp vrf vrf-name imported-routes 16. show route vrf vrf-name ip-address 17. show cef vrf vrf-name ip-address 18. show cef vrf vrf-name ip-address location node-id 19. show bgp vrf vrf-name ip-address 20. show ospf vrf vrf-name database DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 show running-config router bgp as-number vrf vrf-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show running-config router bgp 3 vrf vrf_A Displays the specified VPN routing and forwarding (VRF) content of the currently running configuration. Step 2 show running-config routes Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show running-config routes Displays the Open Shortest Path First (OSPF) routes table in the currently running configuration.Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 81 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Step 3 show ospf vrf vrf-name database Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show ospf vrf vrf_A database Displays lists of information related to the OSPF database for a specified VRF. Step 4 show running-config router bgp as-number vrf vrf-name neighbor ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show running-config router bgp 3 vrf vrf_A neighbor 172.168.40.24 Displays the Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) VRF neighbor content of the currently running configuration. Step 5 show bgp vrf vrf-name summary Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp vrf vrf_A summary Displays the status of the specified BGP VRF connections. Step 6 show bgp vrf vrf-name neighbors ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp vrf vrf_A neighbors 172.168.40.24 Displays information about BGP VRF connections to the specified neighbors. Step 7 show bgp vrf vrf-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp vrf vrf_A Displays information about a specified BGP VRF. Step 8 show route vrf vrf-name ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show route vrf vrf_A 10.0.0.0 Displays the current routes in the Routing Information Base (RIB) for a specified VRF. Step 9 show bgp vpn unicast summary Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp vpn unicast summary Displays the status of all BGP VPN unicast connections. Step 10 show running-config router isis Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show running-config router isis Displays the Intermediate System-to-Intermediate System (IS-IS) content of the currently running configuration. Step 11 show running-config mpls Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show running-config mpls Displays the MPLS content of the currently running-configuration. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 82 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Step 12 show isis adjacency Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show isis adjacency Displays IS-IS adjacency information. Step 13 show mpls ldp forwarding Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show mpls ldp forwarding Displays the Label Distribution Protocol (LDP) forwarding state installed in MPLS forwarding. Step 14 show bgp vpnv4 unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp vpnv4 unicast Displays entries in the BGP routing table for VPNv4 unicast addresses. Step 15 show bgp vrf vrf-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp vrf vrf_A Displays entries in the BGP routing table for VRF vrf_A. Step 16 show bgp vrf vrf-name imported-routes Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp vrf vrf_A imported-routes Displays BGP information for routes imported into specified VRF instances. Step 17 show route vrf vrf-name ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show route vrf vrf_A 10.0.0.0 Displays the current specified VRF routes in the RIB. Step 18 show cef vrf vrf-name ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show cef vrf vrf_A 10.0.0.1 Displays the IPv4 Cisco Express Forwarding (CEF) table for a specified VRF. Step 19 show cef vrf vrf-name ip-address location node-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show cef vrf vrf_A 10.0.0.1 location 0/1/cpu0 Displays the IPv4 CEF table for a specified VRF and location. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 83 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Configuring L3VPN over GRE Perform the following tasks to configure L3VPN over GRE: • Creating a GRE Tunnel between Provider Edge Routers • Configuring IGP between Provider Edge Routers • Configuring LDP/GRE on the Provider Edge Routers • Configuring L3VPN Creating a GRE Tunnel between Provider Edge Routers Perform this task to configure a GRE tunnel between provider edge routers. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. interface tunnel-ip number 3. ipv4 address ipv4-address subnet-mask 4. ipv6 address ipv6-prefix/prefix-length 5. tunnel mode gre ipv4 6. tunnel source type number 7. tunnel destination ip-address 8. end or commit Step 20 show bgp vrf vrf-name ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp vrf vrf_A 10.0.0.0 Displays entries in the BGP routing table for VRF vrf_A. Step 21 show ospf vrf vrf-name database Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show ospf vrf vrf_A database Displays lists of information related to the OSPF database for a specified VRF. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 84 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 configure Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Enters global configuration mode. Step 2 interface tunnel-ip number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# interface tunnel-ip 4000 Enters tunnel interface configuration mode. • number is the number associated with the tunnel interface. Step 3 ipv4 address ipv4-address subnet-mask Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# ipv4 address 10.1.1.1 255.255.255.0 Specifies the IPv4 address and subnet mask for the interface. • ipv4-address specifies the IP address of the interface. • subnet-mask specifies the subnet mask of the interface. Step 4 ipv6 address ipv6-prefix/prefix-length Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# ipv6 address 100:1:1:1::1/64 Specifies an IPv6 network assigned to the interface. Step 5 tunnel mode gre ipv4 Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# tunnel mode gre ipv4 Sets the encapsulation mode of the tunnel interface to GRE. Step 6 tunnel source type path-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# tunnel source TenGigE0/2/0/1 Specifies the source of the tunnel interface. Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 85 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Configuring IGP between Provider Edge Routers Perform this task to configure IGP between provider edge routers. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router ospf process-name 3. nsr 4. router-id {router-id} 5. mpls ldp sync 6. dead-interval seconds 7. hello-interval seconds 8. area area-id 9. interface tunnel-ip number 10. end or commit Step 7 tunnel destination ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# tunnel destination 145.12.5.2 Defines the tunnel destination. Step 8 end or commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# end or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# commit Saves configuration changes. • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: – Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. – Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. – Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 86 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 configure Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Enters global configuration mode. Step 2 router ospf process-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router ospf 1 Enables OSPF routing for the specified routing process and places the router in router configuration mode. Step 3 nsr Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf)# nsr Activates BGP NSR. Step 4 router-id {router-id} Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf)# router-id 1.1.1.1 Configures a router ID for the OSPF process. Note We recommend using a stable IP address as the router ID. Step 5 mpls ldp sync Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf)# mpls ldp sync Enables MPLS LDP synchronization. Step 6 dead-interval seconds Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf)# dead-interval 60 Sets the time to wait for a hello packet from a neighbor before declaring the neighbor down. Step 7 hello-interval seconds Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf)# hello-interval 15 Specifies the interval between hello packets that OSPF sends on the interface. Step 8 area area-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf)# area 0 Enters area configuration mode and configures an area for the OSPF process.Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 87 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Configuring LDP/GRE on the Provider Edge Routers Perform this task to configure LDP/GRE on the provider edge routers. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. mpls ldp 3. router-id {router-id} 4. discovery hello holdtime seconds 5. discovery hello interval seconds 6. nsr 7. graceful-restart 8. graceful-restart reconnect-timeout seconds 9. graceful-restart forwarding-state-holdtime seconds 10. holdtime seconds 11. neighbor ip-address 12. interface tunnel-ip number Step 9 interface tunnel-ip number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf)# interface tunnel-ip 4 Enters tunnel interface configuration mode. • number is the number associated with the tunnel interface. Step 10 end or commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf)# end or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf)# commit Saves configuration changes. • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: – Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. – Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. – Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 88 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 13. end or commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 configure Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Enters global configuration mode. Step 2 mpls ldp Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# mpls ldp Enables MPLS LDP configuration mode. Step 3 router-id {router-id} Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# router-id 1.1.1.1 Configures a router ID for the OSPF process. Note We recommend using a stable IP address as the router ID. Step 4 discovery hello holdtime seconds Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# discovery hello holdtime 40 Defines the period of time a discovered LDP neighbor is remembered without receipt of an LDP Hello message from the neighbor. Step 5 discovery hello interval seconds Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# discovery hello holdtime 20 Defines the period of time between the sending of consecutive Hello messages. Step 6 nsr Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# nsr Activates BGP NSR. Step 7 graceful-restart Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# graceful-restart Enables graceful restart on the router. Step 8 graceful-restart reconnect-timeout seconds Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# graceful-restart recoonect-timeout 180 Defines the time for which the neighbor should wait for a reconnection if the LDP session is lost. Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 89 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Configuring L3VPN Perform this task to configure L3VPN. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. vrf vrf-name Step 9 graceful-restart forwarding-state-holdtime seconds Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# graceful-restart forwarding-state-holdtime 300 Defines the time that the neighbor should retain the MPLS forwarding state during a recovery. Step 10 holdtime seconds Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# holdtime 90 Configures the hold time for an interface. Step 11 neighbor ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# neighbor 10.1.1.0 Defines a neighboring router. Step 12 interface tunnel-ip number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# interface tunnel-ip 4 Enters tunnel interface configuration mode. • number is the number associated with the tunnel interface. Step 13 end or commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# end or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# commit Saves configuration changes. • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: – Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. – Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. – Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 90 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 3. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast 4. import route-target [as-number:nn | ip-address:nn] 5. export route-target [as-number:nn | ip-address:nn] 6. interface type interface-path-id 7. vrf vrf-name 8. ipv4 address ipv4-address subnet-mask 9. dot1q vlan vlan-id 10. router bgp process-name 11. nsr 12. bgp router-id ip-address 13. address-family {vpnv4 | vpnv6} unicast 14. neighbor ip-address 15. remote-as as-number 16. update-source type interface-path-id 17. address-family {vpnv4 | vpnv6} unicast 18. route-policy policy-name in 19. route-policy policy-name out 20. vrf vrf-name 21. rd {as-number:nn | ip-address:nn | auto} 22. address-family {ipv4 | ipv6} unicast 23. redistribute connected [metric metric-value] [route-policy route-policy-name] 24. redistribute static [metric metric-value] [route-policy route-policy-name] 25. neighbor ip-address 26. remote-as as-number 27. ebgp-multihop ttl-value 28. address-family {ipv4 | ipv6} unicast 29. route-policy policy-name in 30. route-policy policy-name out 31. end or commitImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 91 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 configure Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Enters global configuration mode. Step 2 vrf vrf-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# vrf vpn1 Configures a VRF instance. Step 3 address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast Specifies either the IPv4 or IPv6 address family and enters address family configuration submode. Step 4 import route-target [as-number:nn | ip-address:nn] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# import route-target 2:1 Specifies a list of route target (RT) extended communities. Only prefixes that are associated with the specified import route target extended communities are imported into the VRF. Step 5 export route-target [as-number:nn | ip-address:nn] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# export route-target 1:1 Specifies a list of route target extended communities. Export route target communities are associated with prefixes when they are advertised to remote PEs. The remote PEs import them into VRFs which have import RTs that match these exported route target communities. Step 6 interface type interface-path-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)#interface TenGigE0/2/0/0.1 Enters interface configuration mode and configures an interface. Step 7 vrf vrf-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# vrf vpn1 Configures a VRF instance. Step 8 ipv4 address ipv4-address subnet-mask Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# ipv4 address 150.1.1.1 255.255.255.0 Specifies the IPv4 address and subnet mask for the interface. • ipv4-address specifies the IP address of the interface. • subnet-mask specifies the subnet mask of the interface. Step 9 dot1q native vlan vlan-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# dot1q native vlan 1 Assigns the native VLAN ID of a physical interface trunking 802.1Q VLAN traffic.Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 92 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Step 10 router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 1 Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. Step 11 nsr Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# nsr Activates BGP NSR. Step 12 bgp router-id ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp router-id 1.1.1.1 Configures the local router with a specified router ID. Step 13 address-family {vpnv4 | vpnv6} unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family vpnv4 unicast Enters address family configuration submode for the specified address family. Step 14 neighbor ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 4.4.4.4 Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer. Step 15 remote-as as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)#remote-as 1 Creates a neighbor and assigns a remote autonomous system number to it. Step 16 update-source type interface-path-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)#update-so urce Loopback0 Allows sessions to use the primary IP address from a specific interface as the local address when forming a session with a neighbor. Step 17 address-family {vpnv4 | vpnv6} unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family vpnv4 unicast Enters address family configuration submode for the specified address family. Step 18 route-policy route-policy-name in Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)#routepolicy pass-all in Defines a route policy and enters route policy configuration mode. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 93 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Step 19 route-policy route-policy-name out Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)#routepolicy pass-all out Defines a route policy and enters route policy configuration mode. Step 20 vrf vrf-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# vrf vpn1 Configures a VRF instance. Step 21 rd {as-number:nn | ip-address:nn | auto} Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)#rd 1:1 Configures the route distinguisher. Step 22 address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast Specifies either the IPv4 or IPv6 address family and enters address family configuration submode. Step 23 redistribute connected [metric metric-value] [route-policy route-policy-name] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf-af)# redistribute connected Causes routes from the specified instance to be redistributed into BGP. Step 24 redistribute static [metric metric-value] [route-policy route-policy-name] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf-af)# redistribute static Causes routes from the specified instance to be redistributed into BGP. Step 25 neighbor ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 150.1.1.2 Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer. Step 26 remote-as as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)#remote-as 7501 Creates a neighbor and assigns a remote autonomous system number to it. Step 27 ebg-multihop ttl-value Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)#ebgp-mult ihop 10 Configures the CE neighbor to accept and attempt BGP connections to external peers residing on networks that are not directly connected. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs How to Implement MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 94 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Step 28 address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast Specifies either the IPv4 or IPv6 address family and enters address family configuration submode. Step 29 route-policy route-policy-name in Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)#routepolicy BGP_pass_all in Defines a route policy and enters route policy configuration mode. Step 30 route-policy route-policy-name out Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)#routepolicy BGP_pass_all out Defines a route policy and enters route policy configuration mode. Step 31 end or commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# end or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# commit Saves configuration changes. • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: – Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. – Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. – Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Command or Action PurposeImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs Configuration Examples for Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 95 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Configuration Examples for Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs This section provides these sample configurations for MPLS L3VPN features: • Configuring an MPLS VPN Using BGP: Example, page VPC-95 • Configuring the Routing Information Protocol on the PE Router: Example, page VPC-96 • Configuring the PE Router Using EIGRP: Example, page VPC-96 • Configuration Examples for MPLS VPN CSC, page VPC-97 • Configuring L3VPN over GRE: Example, page VPC-98 Configuring an MPLS VPN Using BGP: Example This example shows the configuration for an MPLS VPN using BGP on “vrf vpn1”: address-family ipv4 unicast import route-target 100:1 ! export route-target 100:1 ! ! ! route-policy pass-all pass end-policy ! interface Loopback0 ipv4 address 10.0.0.1 255.255.255.255 ! interface gigabitEthernet 0/1/0/0 vrf vpn1 ipv4 address 10.0.0.2 255.0.0.0 ! interface gigabitEthernet 0/1/0/1 ipv4 address 10.0.0.1 255.0.0.0 ! router ospf 100 area 100 interface loopback0 interface gigabitEthernet 0/1/0/1 ! ! router bgp 100 address-family vpnv4 unicast retain route-target route-policy policy1 neighbor 10.0.0.3 remote-as 100 update-source Loopback0 address-family vpnv4 unicast ! vrf vpn1 rd 100:1 address-family ipv4 unicast redistribute connected ! neighbor 10.0.0.1 remote-as 200Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs Configuration Examples for Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 96 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 address-family ipv4 unicast as-override route-policy pass-all in route-policy pass-all out ! advertisement-interval 5 ! ! ! mpls ldp route-id looback0 interface gigabitEthernet 0/1/0/1 ! Configuring the Routing Information Protocol on the PE Router: Example This example shows the configuration for the RIP on the PE router: vrf vpn1 address-family ipv4 unicast import route-target 100:1 ! export route-target 100:1 ! ! ! route-policy pass-all pass end-policy ! interface gigabitEthernet 0/1/0/0 vrf vpn1 ipv4 address 10.0.0.2 255.0.0.0 ! router rip vrf vpn1 interface GigabitEthernet0/1/0/0 ! timers basic 30 90 90 120 redistribute bgp 100 default-metric 3 route-policy pass-all in ! Configuring the PE Router Using EIGRP: Example This example shows the configuration for the Enhanced Interior Gateway Routing Protocol (EIGRP) on the PE router: Router eigrp 10 vrf VRF1 address-family ipv4 router-id 10.1.1.2 default-metric 100000 2000 255 1 1500 as 62 redistribute bgp 2000Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs Configuration Examples for Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 97 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 interface Loopback0 ! interface GigabitEthernet0/6/0/0 Configuration Examples for MPLS VPN CSC Configuration examples for the MPLS VPN CSC include: • Configuring the Backbone Carrier Core: Examples, page VPC-97 • Configuring the Links Between CSC-PE and CSC-CE Routers: Examples, page VPC-97 • Configuring a Static Route to a Peer: Example, page VPC-98 Configuring the Backbone Carrier Core: Examples Configuration examples for the backbone carrier core included in this section are as follows: • Configuring VRFs for CSC-PE Routers: Example, page VPC-97 • Configuring the Links Between CSC-PE and CSC-CE Routers: Examples, page VPC-97 Configuring VRFs for CSC-PE Routers: Example This example shows how to configure a VPN routing and forwarding instance (VRF) for a CSC-PE router: config vrf vpn1 address-family ipv4 unicast import route-target 100:1 export route-target 100:1 end Configuring the Links Between CSC-PE and CSC-CE Routers: Examples This section contains these examples: • Configuring a CSC-PE: Example, page VPC-97 • Configuring a CSC-CE: Example, page VPC-98 Configuring a CSC-PE: Example In this example, a CSC-PE router peers with a PE router, 10.1.0.2, in its own AS. It also has a labeled unicast peering with a CSC-CE router, 10.0.0.1. config router bgp 2 address-family vpnv4 unicast neighbor 10.1.0.2 remote-as 2 update-source loopback0 address-family vpnv4 unicast vrf customer-carrier rd 1:100 address-family ipv4 unicast allocate-label all redistribute static neighbor 10.0.0.1Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs Configuration Examples for Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 98 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 remote-as 1 address-family ipv4 labeled-unicast route-policy pass-all in route-policy pass-all out as-override end Configuring a CSC-CE: Example This example shows how to configure a CSC-CE router. In this example, the CSC-CE router peers CSC-PE router 10.0.0.2 in AS 2. config router bgp 1 address-family ipv4 unicast redistribute ospf 200 allocate-label all neighbor 10.0.0.2 remote-as 2 address-family ipv4 labeled-unicast route-policy pass-all in route-policy pass-all out end Configuring a Static Route to a Peer: Example This example shows how to configure a static route to an Inter-AS or CSC-CE peer: config router static address-family ipv4 unicast 10.0.0.2/32 40.1.1.1 end Configuring L3VPN over GRE: Example The following example shows how to configure L3VPN over GRE: Sample configuration to create a GRE tunnel between PE1 and PE2: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:PE1#sh run int tunnel-ip 1 interface tunnel-ip1 ipv4 address 100.1.1.1 255.255.255.0 ipv6 address 100:1:1:1::1/64 tunnel mode gre ipv4 tunnel source TenGigE0/2/0/1 tunnel destination 145.12.5.2 ! RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:PE2#sh run int tunnel-ip 1 interface tunnel-ip1 ipv4 address 100.1.1.2 255.255.255.0 ipv6 address 100:1:1:1::2/64 tunnel mode gre ipv4 tunnel source TenGigE0/1/0/2 tunnel destination 145.12.1.1 Configure IGP between PE1 and PE2: Sample configuration for PE1 is given below. PE2 will also have a similar configuration. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:PE1#sh run router ospf 1Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs Configuration Examples for Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 99 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 router ospf 1 nsr router-id 1.1.1.1 <=== Loopback0 mpls ldp sync mtu-ignore enable dead-interval 60 hello-interval 15 area 0 interface TenGigE0/2/0/1 ! RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:PE1#sh run router ospf 0 router ospf 0 nsr router-id 1.1.1.1 mpls ldp sync dead-interval 60 hello-interval 15 area 0 interface Loopback0 ! interface tunnel-ip1 ! * Check for OSPF neighbors RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:PE1#sh ospf neighbor Neighbors for OSPF 0 Neighbor ID Pri State Dead Time Address Interface 4.4.4.4 1 FULL/ - 00:00:47 100.1.1.2 tunnel-ip1 <== Neighbor PE2 Neighbor is up for 00:13:40 Neighbors for OSPF 1 Neighbor ID Pri State Dead Time Address Interface 2.2.2.2 1 FULL/DR 00:00:50 145.12.1.2 TenGigE0/2/0/1 <== Neighbor P1 Neighbor is up for 00:13:43 Configure LDP/GRE on PE1 and PE2: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:PE1#sh run mpls ldp mpls ldp router-id 1.1.1.1 <=== Loopback0 discovery hello holdtime 45 discovery hello interval 15 nsr graceful-restart graceful-restart reconnect-timeout 180 graceful-restart forwarding-state-holdtime 300 holdtime 90 log neighbor ! interface tunnel-ip1 ! *Check for mpls forwarding RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:PE1#sh mpls forwarding prefix 4.4.4.4/32 Local Outgoing Prefix Outgoing Next Hop Bytes Label Label or ID Interface Switched Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs Configuration Examples for Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 100 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 ---- ------- -------------- -------- ----------- ---------- 16003 Pop 4.4.4.4/32 ti1 100.4.1.2 0 Configure L3VPN RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:PE1#sh run vrf vpn1 vrf vpn1 address-family ipv4 unicast import route-target 2:1 ! export route-target 1:1 ! RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:PE1#sh run int tenGigE 0/2/0/0.1 interface TenGigE0/2/0/0.1 vrf vpn1 ipv4 address 150.1.1.1 255.255.255.0 dot1q vlan 1 ! RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:PE1#sh run router bgp router bgp 1 nsr bgp router-id 1.1.1.1 <===Loopback0 address-family vpnv4 unicast ! neighbor 4.4.4.4 <===iBGP session with PE2 remote-as 1 update-source Loopback0 address-family vpnv4 unicast route-policy pass-all in route-policy pass-all out ! ! vrf vpn1 rd 1:1 address-family ipv4 unicast redistribute connected redistribute static ! neighbor 150.1.1.2 <=== VRF neighbor remote-as 7501 ebgp-multihop 10 address-family ipv4 unicast route-policy BGP_pass_all in route-policy BGP_pass_all out ! * Check vrf ping to the 150.1.1.2. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:PE1#ping vrf vpn1 150.1.1.2 Type escape sequence to abort. Sending 5, 100-byte ICMP Echos to 150.1.1.2, timeout is 2 seconds: !!!!! Success rate is 100 percent (5/5), round-trip min/avg/max = 1/1/3 ms * Send traffic to vrf routes adverstised and verify that mpls counters increase in tunnel interface accounting RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:PE1#sh int tunnel-ip1 accounting tunnel-ip1 Protocol Pkts In Chars In Pkts Out Chars OutImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs Configuration Examples for Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs 101 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 IPV4_MULTICAST 3 276 3 276 MPLS 697747 48842290 0 0Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs Additional References 102 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Additional References For additional information, refer to these documents: Related Documents Standards MIBs Related Topic Document Title Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router L2VPN commands MPLS Virtual Private Network Commands on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routers module in the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Command Reference Routing (BGP, EIGRP, OSPF, and RIP) commands: complete command syntax, command modes, command history, defaults, usage guidelines, and examples Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Command Reference Routing (BGP, EIGRP, OSPF, and RIP) configuration Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide MPLS LDP configuration: configuration concepts, task, and examples Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routers module in this document. MPLS Traffic Engineering Resource Reservation Protocol configuration: configuration concepts, task, and examples Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routers module in this document. Getting started material Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Getting Started Guide Standards Title No new or modified standards are supported by this feature, and support for existing standards has not been modified by this feature. — MIBs MIBs Link — To locate and download MIBs using Cisco IOS XR software, use the Cisco MIB Locator found at this URL and choose a platform under the Cisco Access Products menu: http://cisco.com/public/sw-center/netmgmt/cmtk/mibs.shtmlImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs Additional References 103 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 RFCs Technical Assistance RFCs Title RFC 1700 Assigned Numbers RFC 1918 Address Allocation for Private Internets RFC 1966 BGP Route Reflectors: An Alternative to Full Mesh iBGP RFC 2283 Multiprotocol Extensions for BGP-4 RFC 2547 BGP/MPLS VPNs RFC 2842 Capabilities Advertisement with BGP-4 RFC 2858 Multiprotocol Extensions for BGP-4 RFC 3107 Carrying Label Information in BGP-4 Description Link The Cisco Technical Support website contains thousands of pages of searchable technical content, including links to products, technologies, solutions, technical tips, and tools. Registered Cisco.com users can log in from this page to access even more content. http://www.cisco.com/techsupportImplementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs Additional References 104 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02105 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Implementing IPv6 VPN Provider Edge Transport over MPLS This module describes how to implement IPv6 VPN Provider Edge Transport over MPLS on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Routers. IPv6 VPN Provider Edge (6PE/VPE) uses the existing MPLS IPv4 core infrastructure for IPv6 transport. 6PE/VPE enables IPv6 sites to communicate with each other over an MPLS IPv4 core network using MPLS label switched paths (LSPs). This feature relies heavily on multiprotocol Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) extensions in the IPv4 network configuration on the provider edge (PE) router to exchange IPv6 reachability information (in addition to an MPLS label) for each IPv6 address prefix. Edge routers are configured as dual-stack, running both IPv4 and IPv6, and use the IPv4 mapped IPv6 address for IPv6 prefix reachability exchange. For detailed information about the commands used to configure L2TP functionality, see the Cisco ASR 9000 Aggregation Services Router Routing Command Reference. Feature History for Implementing 6PE on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routers Contents • Prerequisites for Implementing 6PE/VPE, page VPC-106 • Information About 6PE/VPE, page VPC-106 • How to Implement 6PE/VPE, page VPC-109 • Configuration Examples for 6PE, page VPC-122 • Additional References, page VPC-124 Release Modification Release 3.9.1 This feature was introduced. Release 4.0.0 Support was added for the 6PE and 6VPE features for IPv6 L3VPN on A9K-SIP-700. Support was added for the BGP per VRF/CE label allocation for 6PE feature. Release 4.1.0 Support for the Open Shortest Path First version 3 (OSPFv3) IPv6 VPN Provider Edge (6VPE) feature was added.Implementing IPv6 VPN Provider Edge Transport over MPLS Prerequisites for Implementing 6PE/VPE 106 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Prerequisites for Implementing 6PE/VPE These prerequisites are required to implement 6PE: • You must be in a user group associated with a task group that includes the proper task IDs. The command reference guides include the task IDs required for each command. If you suspect user group assignment is preventing you from using a command, contact your AAA administrator for assistance. • Familiarity with MPLS and BGP4 configuration and troubleshooting. Information About 6PE/VPE To configure the 6PE feature, you should understand the concepts that are described in these sections: • Overview of 6PE/VPE, page VPC-106 • Benefits of 6PE/VPE, page VPC-107 • Deploying IPv6 over MPLS Backbones, page VPC-107 • IPv6 on the Provider Edge and Customer Edge Routers, page VPC-107 • IPv6 Provider Edge Multipath, page VPC-108 • OSPFv3 6VPE, page VPC-108 Overview of 6PE/VPE Multiple techniques are available to integrate IPv6 services over service provider core backbones: • Dedicated IPv6 network running over various data link layers • Dual-stack IPv4-IPv6 backbone • Existing MPLS backbone leverage These solutions are deployed on service providers’ backbones when the amount of IPv6 traffic and the revenue generated are in line with the necessary investments and the agreed-upon risks. Conditions are favorable for the introduction of native IPv6 services, from the edge, in a scalable way, without any IPv6 addressing restrictions and without putting a well-controlled IPv4 backbone in jeopardy. Backbone stability is essential for service providers that have recently stabilized their IPv4 infrastructure. Service providers running an MPLS/IPv4 infrastructure follow similar trends because several integration scenarios that offer IPv6 services on an MPLS network are possible. Cisco Systems has specially developed Cisco 6PE or IPv6 Provider Edge Router over MPLS, to meet all those requirements. Inter-AS support for 6PE requires support of Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) to enable address families and to allocate and distribute PE and ASBR labels.Implementing IPv6 VPN Provider Edge Transport over MPLS Information About 6PE/VPE 107 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Benefits of 6PE/VPE Service providers who currently deploy MPLS experience these benefits of Cisco 6PE: • Minimal operational cost and risk—No impact on existing IPv4 and MPLS services. • Only provider edge routers upgrade—A 6PE/VPE router can be an existing PE router or a new one dedicated to IPv6 traffic. • No impact on IPv6 customer edge routers—The ISP can connect to any customer CE running Static, IGP or EGP. • Production services ready—An ISP can delegate IPv6 prefixes. • IPv6 introduction into an existing MPLS service—6PE/VPE routers can be added at any time. Deploying IPv6 over MPLS Backbones Backbones enabled by 6PE (IPv6 over MPLS) allow IPv6 domains to communicate with each other over an MPLS IPv4 core network. This implementation requires no backbone infrastructure upgrades and no reconfiguration of core routers because forwarding is based on labels instead of the IP header itself. This provides a very cost-effective strategy for IPv6 deployment. Additionally, the inherent virtual private network (VPN) and traffic engineering (TE) services available within an MPLS environment allow IPv6 networks to be combined into VPNs or extranets over an infrastructure that supports IPv4 VPNs and MPLS-TE. IPv6 on the Provider Edge and Customer Edge Routers Service Provider Edge Routers 6PE is particularly applicable to service providers who currently run an MPLS network. One of its advantages is that there is no need to upgrade the hardware, software, or configuration of the core network, and it eliminates the impact on the operations and the revenues generated by existing IPv4 traffic. MPLS is used by many service providers to deliver services to customers. MPLS as a multiservice infrastructure technology is able to provide layer 3 VPN, QoS, traffic engineering, fast re-routing and integration of ATM and IP switching. Customer Edge Routers Using tunnels on the CE routers is the simplest way to deploy IPv6 over MPLS networks. It has no impact on the operation or infrastructure of MPLS, and requires no changes to the P routers in the core or to the PE routers. However, tunnel meshing is required as the number of CEs to connect increases, and it becomes difficult to delegate a global IPv6 prefix for an ISP. Figure 7 illustrates the network architecture using tunnels on the CE routers. Implementing IPv6 VPN Provider Edge Transport over MPLS Information About 6PE/VPE 108 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Figure 7 IPv6 Using Tunnels on the CE Routers IPv6 Provider Edge Multipath Internal and external BGP multipath for IPv6 allows the IPv6 router to balance load between several paths (for example, the same neighboring autonomous system (AS) or sub-AS, or the same metrics) to reach its destination. The 6PE multipath feature uses multiprotocol internal BGP (MP-IBGP) to distribute IPv6 routes over the MPLS IPv4 core network and to attach an MPLS label to each route. When MP-IBGP multipath is enabled on the 6PE router, all labeled paths are installed in the forwarding table with available MPLS information (label stack). This functionality enables 6PE to perform load balancing. OSPFv3 6VPE The Open Shortest Path First version 3 (OSPFv3) IPv6 VPN Provider Edge (6VPE) feature adds VPN routing and forwarding (VRF) and provider edge-to-customer edge(PE-CE) routing support to Cisco IOS XR OSPFv3 implementation. This feature allows: • Multiple VRF support per OSPFv3 routing process • OSPFV3 PE-CE extensions Multiple VRF Support OSPFv3 supports multiple VRFs in a single routing process that allows scaling to tens and hundreds of VRFs without consuming too much route processor (RP) resources. v6 IPv6 PE PE P OC-48/192 IPv6 over IPv4 tunnels v4 IPv4 v6 IPv6 v4 IPv4 v6 IPv6 IPv6 IPv4 v6 v4 P P P PE PE Dual stack IPv4-IPv6 CE routers Dual stack IPv4-IPv6 CE routers 210608Implementing IPv6 VPN Provider Edge Transport over MPLS How to Implement 6PE/VPE 109 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Multiple OSPFv3 processes can be configured on a single router. In large-scale VRF deployments, this allows partition VRF processing across multiple RPs. It is also used to isolate default routing table or high impact VRFs from the regular VRFs. It is recommended to use a single process for all the VRFs. If needed, a second OSPFv3 process must be configured for IPv6 routing. Note The maximum of four OSPFv3 processes are supported. OSPFv3 PE-CE Extensions IPv6 protocol is being vastly deployed in today's customer networks. Service Providers (SPs) need to be able to offer Virtual Private Network (VPN) services to their customers for supporting IPv6 protocol, in addition to the already offered VPN services for IPv4 protocol. In order to support IPv6, routing protocols require additional extensions for operating in the VPN environment. Extensions to OSPFv3 are required in order for OSPFv3 to operate at the PE-CE links. VRF Lite VRF lite feature enables VRF deployment without BGP or MPLS based backbone. In VRF lite, the PE routers are directly connected using VRF interfaces. For OSPFv3, the following needs to operate differently in the VRF lite scenario, as opposed to the deployment with BGP or MPLS backbone: • DN bit processing—In VRF lite environment, the DN bit processing is disabled. • ABR status—In VRF context (except default VRF), OSPFv3 router is automatically set as an ABR, regardless to it’s connectivity to area 0. This automatic ABR status setting is disabled in the VRF lite environment. Note To enable VRF Lite, issue the capability vrf-lite command in the OSPFv3 VRF configuration submode. How to Implement 6PE/VPE This section includes these implementation procedures: • Configuring 6PE/VPE, page VPC-109 • Configuring PE to PE Core, page VPC-111 • Configuring PE to CE Core, page VPC-115 • Configuring OSPFv3 as the Routing Protocol Between the PE and CE Routers, page VPC-118 Configuring 6PE/VPE This task describes how to configure 6PE/VPE on PE routers to transport the IPv6 prefixes across the IPv4 cloud. Ensure that you configure 6PE/VPE on PE routers participating in both the IPv4 cloud and IPv6 clouds. Implementing IPv6 VPN Provider Edge Transport over MPLS How to Implement 6PE/VPE 110 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Note For 6PE, you can use all routing protocols supported on Cisco IOS XR software such as BGP, OSPF, IS-IS, EIGRP, RIP, and Static to learn routes from both clouds. However, for 6VPE, you can use only the BGP, EIGRP and Static routing protocols to learn routes. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp as-number 3. neighbor ip-address 4. address-family ipv6 labeled-unicast 5. exit 6. exit 7. address-family ipv6 unicast 8. allocate-label [all | route-policy policy_name] 9. end or commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 configure Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Enters global configuration mode. Step 2 router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 1 Enters the number that identifies the autonomous system (AS) in which the router resides. Range for 2-byte numbers is 1 to 65535. Range for 4-byte numbers is 1.0 to 65535.65535. Step 3 neighbor ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 1.1.1.1 Enters neighbor configuration mode for configuring Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) routing sessions. Step 4 address-family ipv6 labeled-unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv6 labeled-unicast Specifies IPv6 labeled-unicast address prefixes. Note This option is also available in IPv6 neighbor configuration mode and VRF neighbor configuration mode. Step 5 exit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# exit Exits BGP address-family submode.Implementing IPv6 VPN Provider Edge Transport over MPLS How to Implement 6PE/VPE 111 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Configuring PE to PE Core This task describes how to configure a Provider Edge (PE) to PE Core. For information on configuring VPN Routing and Forwarding (VRF), refer to the Implementing BGP on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp 3. address-family vpnv6 unicast Step 6 exit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# exit Exits BGP neighbor submode. Step 7 address-family ipv6 unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv6 unicast Specifies IPv6 unicast address prefixes. Step 8 allocate-label [all | route-policy policy_name] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# allocate-label all Allocates MPLS labels for specified IPv4 unicast routes. Note The route-policy keyword provides finer control to filter out certain routes from being advertised to the neighbor. Step 9 end or commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# end or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# commit Saves configuration changes. • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: – Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. – Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. – Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Command or Action PurposeImplementing IPv6 VPN Provider Edge Transport over MPLS How to Implement 6PE/VPE 112 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 4. bgp dampening [ half-life [ reuse suppress max-suppress-time ] | route-policy route-policy-name ] 5. bgp client-to-client reflection { cluster-id | disable } 6. neighbor ip-address 7. remote-as as-number 8. description text 9. password { clear | encrypted } password 10. shutdown 11. timers keepalive hold-time 12. update-source type interface-id 13. address-family vpnv6 unicast 14. route-policy route-policy-name { in | out } 15. exit 16. vrf vrf-name 17. rd { as-number : nn | ip-address : nn | auto } 18. end or commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 configure Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Enters global configuration mode. Step 2 router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 10 Specifies the BGP AS number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. Step 3 address-family vpnv6 unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family vpnv6 unicast Specifies the vpnv6 address family and enters address family configuration submode. Step 4 bgp dampening [ half-life [ reuse suppress max-suppress-time ] | route-policy route-policy-name ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# bgp dampening 30 1500 10000 120 Configures BGP dampening for the specified address family.Implementing IPv6 VPN Provider Edge Transport over MPLS How to Implement 6PE/VPE 113 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Step 5 bgp client-to-client reflection {cluster-id | disable } Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# bgp client-to-client reflection disable Configures client to client route reflection. Step 6 exit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# exit Exits the address family configuration submode. Step 7 neighbor ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 10.1.1.1 Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer. Step 8 remote-as as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 100 Creates a neighbor and assigns a remote autonomous system number to it. Step 9 description text Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# description neighbor 172.16.1.1 Provides a description of the neighbor. The description is used to save comments and does not affect software function. Step 10 password { clear | encrypted } password Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# password encrypted 123abc Enables Message Digest 5 (MD5) authentication on the TCP connection between the two BGP neighbors. Step 11 shutdown Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# router bgp 1 Terminates any active sessions for the specified neighbor and removes all associated routing information. Step 12 timers keepalive hold-time Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# timers 12000 200 Set the timers for the BGP neighbor. Step 13 update-source type interface-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# update-source gigabitEthernet 0/1/5/0 Allows iBGP sessions to use the primary IP address from a specific interface as the local address when forming an iBGP session with a neighbor. Command or Action PurposeImplementing IPv6 VPN Provider Edge Transport over MPLS How to Implement 6PE/VPE 114 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Step 14 address-family vpnv6 unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family vpvn6 unicast Enters VPN neighbor address family configuration mode. Step 15 route-policy route-policy-name { in | out } Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy pe-pe-vpn-in in Specifies a routing policy for an inbound route. The policy can be used to filter routes or modify route attributes. Step 16 route-policy route-policy-name { in | out } Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy pe-pe-vpn-out out Specifies a routing policy for an outbound route. The policy can be used to filter routes or modify route attributes. Step 17 exit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# exit Exits address family configuration and neighbor submode. Step 18 vrf vrf-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# vrf vrf-pe Configures a VRF instance. Command or Action PurposeImplementing IPv6 VPN Provider Edge Transport over MPLS How to Implement 6PE/VPE 115 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Configuring PE to CE Core This task describes how to configure a PE to Customer Edge (CE) core. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router bgp 3. vrf vrf-name 4. bgp router-id ip-address 5. label-allocation-mode { per-ce | per-vrf } 6. address-family ipv6 unicast 7. redistribute {connected | static | eigrp } 8. neighbor ip-address 9. remote-as as-number 10. ebgp-multihop { maximum hops | mpls } 11. address-family ipv6 unicast 12. site-of-origin [ as-number : nn | ip-address : nn ] Step 19 rd { as-number : nn | ip-address : nn | auto } Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# rd 345:567 Configures the route distinguisher. Use the auto keyword if you want the router to automatically assign a unique RD to the VRF. Step 20 end or commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# end or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# commit Saves configuration changes. • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: – Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. – Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. – Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Command or Action PurposeImplementing IPv6 VPN Provider Edge Transport over MPLS How to Implement 6PE/VPE 116 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 13. as-override 14. allowas-in [ as-occurrence-number ] 15. end or commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 configure Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Enters global configuration mode. Step 2 router bgp as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 10 Specifies the BGP AS number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process. Step 3 vrf vrf-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# vrf vrf-pe Configures a VRF instance. Step 4 bgp router-id ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)#bgp router-id 172.16.9.9 Configures a fixed router ID for a BGP-speaking router. Step 5 label-allocation-mode { per-ce | per-vrf } Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# label-allocation-mode per-ce Configures the per-CE label allocation mode to avoid an extra lookup on the PE router and conserve label space (per-prefix is the default label allocation mode). In this mode, the PE router allocates one label for every immediate next-hop (in most cases, this would be a CE router). This label is directly mapped to the next hop, so there is no VRF route lookup performed during data forwarding. However, the number of labels allocated would be one for each CE rather than one for each VRF. Because BGP knows all the next hops, it assigns a label for each next hop (not for each PE-CE interface). When the outgoing interface is a multiaccess interface and the media access control (MAC) address of the neighbor is not known, Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) is triggered during packet forwarding. The per-vrf keyword configures the same label to be used for all the routes advertised from a unique VRF.Implementing IPv6 VPN Provider Edge Transport over MPLS How to Implement 6PE/VPE 117 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Step 6 address-family ipv6 unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# address-family ipv6 unicast Specifies an IPv6 address family unicast and enters address family configuration submode. To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?). Step 7 redistribute {connected | static | eigrp } Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)# Causes routes from the specified instance to be redistributed into BGP. Step 8 neighbor ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# neighbor 10.0.0.0 Configures a CE neighbor. The ip-address argument must be a private address. Step 9 remote-as as-number Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr)# remote-as 2 Configures the remote AS for the CE neighbor. Step 10 ebgp-multihop { maximum hops | mpls } Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr)# ebgp-multihop 55 Configures the CE neighbor to accept and attempt BGP connections to external peers residing on networks that are not directly connected. Step 11 address-family ipv6 unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr)# address-family ipv6 unicast Specifies an IPv6 address family unicast and enters address family configuration submode. To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?). Step 12 site-of-origin [as-number:nn | ip-address:nn ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr-af)# site-of-origin 234:111 Configures the site-of-origin (SoO) extended community. Routes that are learned from this CE neighbor are tagged with the SoO extended community before being advertised to the rest of the PEs. SoO is frequently used to detect loops when as-override is configured on the PE router. If the prefix is looped back to the same site, the PE detects this and does not send the update to the CE. Step 13 as-override Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr-af)# as-override Configures AS override on the PE router. This causes the PE router to replace the CE’s ASN with its own (PE) ASN. Note This loss of information could lead to routing loops; to avoid loops caused by as-override, use it in conjunction with site-of-origin. Command or Action PurposeImplementing IPv6 VPN Provider Edge Transport over MPLS How to Implement 6PE/VPE 118 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Configuring OSPFv3 as the Routing Protocol Between the PE and CE Routers Perform this task to configure provider edge (PE)-to-customer edge (CE) routing sessions that use Open Shortest Path First version 3 (OSPFv3). SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router ospfv3 process-name 3. vrf vrf-name 4. capability vrf-lite 5. router-id {router-id | type interface-path-id} 6. domain-id type {0005 | 0105 | 0205 | 8005} value domain-id 7. redistribute bgp process-id [metric metric-value] [metric-type {1 | 2}] [route-policy policy-name] [tag tag-value] or Step 14 allowas-in [ as-occurrence-number ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr-af)# allowas-in 5 Allows an AS path with the PE autonomous system number (ASN) a specified number of times. Hub and spoke VPN networks need the looping back of routing information to the HUB PE through the HUB CE. When this happens, due to the presence of the PE ASN, the looped-back information is dropped by the HUB PE. To avoid this, use the allowas-in command to allow prefixes even if they have the PEs ASN up to the specified number of times. Step 15 end or commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr-af)# end or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr-af)# commit Saves configuration changes. • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: – Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. – Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. – Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Command or Action PurposeImplementing IPv6 VPN Provider Edge Transport over MPLS How to Implement 6PE/VPE 119 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 redistribute connected [metric metric-value] [metric-type {1 | 2}] [route-policy policy-name] [tag tag-value] or redistribute ospf process-id [match {external [1 | 2] | internal | nssa-external [1 | 2]}] [metric metric-value] [metric-type {1 | 2}] [route-policy policy-name] [tag tag-value] or redistribute static [metric metric-value] [metric-type {1 | 2}] [route-policy policy-name] [tag tag-value] or redistribute eigrp process-id [match {external [1 | 2] | internal | nssa-external [1 | 2]}] [metric metric-value] [metric-type {1 | 2}] [route-policy policy-name] [tag tag-value] or redistribute rip [metric metric-value] [metric-type {1 | 2}] [route-policy policy-name] [tag tag-value] 8. area area-id 9. interface type interface-path-id 10. end or commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose Step 1 configure Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Enters global configuration mode. Step 2 router ospf process-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router ospf 109 Enters OSPF configuration mode allowing you to configure the OSPF routing process. Step 3 vrf vrf-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf)# vrf vrf_1 Configures a VPN routing and forwarding (VRF) instance and enters VRF configuration mode for OSPF routing. Step 4 capability vrf-lite Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf-vrf)# capability vrf-lite Enables VRF Lite feature. Step 5 router-id {router-id | type interface-path-id} Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf-vrf)# router-id 172.20.10.10 Configures the router ID for the VRF. Note Router ID configuration is required for each VRF.Implementing IPv6 VPN Provider Edge Transport over MPLS How to Implement 6PE/VPE 120 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Step 6 domain-id type {0005 | 0105 | 0205 | 8005} value domain-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf-vrf)# domain-id type 0005 value CAFE00112233 Specifies the domain ID. Step 7 redistribute bgp process-id [metric metric-value] [metric-type {1 | 2}] [route-policy policy-name] [tag tag-value] or redistribute connected [metric metric-value] [metric-type {1 | 2}] [route-policy policy-name] [tag tag-value] or redistribute ospf process-id [match {external [1 | 2] | internal | nssa-external [1 | 2]}] [metric metric-value] [metric-type {1 | 2}] [route-policy policy-name] [tag tag-value] or redistribute static [metric metric-value] [metric-type {1 | 2}] [route-policy policy-name] [tag tag-value] or redistribute eigrp process-id [match {external [1 | 2] | internal | nssa-external [1 | 2]]}[metric metric-value] [metric-type {1 | 2}] [route-policy policy-name] [tag tag-value] or redistribute rip [metric metric-value] [metric-type {1 | 2}] [route-policy policy-name] [tag tag-value] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf-vrf)# redistribute connected Causes routes to be redistributed into OSPF. The routes that can be redistributed into OSPF are: • Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) • Connected • Enhanced Interior Gateway Routing Protocol (EIGRP) • OSPF • Static • Routing Information Protocol (RIP) Step 8 area area-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf-vrf)# area 0 Configures the OSPF area as area 0. Command or Action PurposeImplementing IPv6 VPN Provider Edge Transport over MPLS How to Implement 6PE/VPE 121 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Step 9 interface type interface-path-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf-vrf-ar)# interface GigabitEthernet 0/3/0/0 Associates interface GigabitEthernet 0/3/0/0 with area 0. Step 10 end or commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf-vrf-ar-if)# end or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf-vrf-ar-if)# commit Saves configuration changes. • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: – Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. – Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. – Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Command or Action PurposeImplementing IPv6 VPN Provider Edge Transport over MPLS Configuration Examples for 6PE 122 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Configuration Examples for 6PE This section includes these configuration example: • Configuring 6PE on a PE Router: Example, page VPC-122 • Configuring 6VPE on a PE Router: Example, page VPC-122 • Configuring 6PE on a PE Router: Example This sample configuration shows the configuration of 6PE on a PE router: interface GigabitEthernet0/3/0/0 ipv6 address 2001::1/64 ! router isis ipv6-cloud net 49.0000.0000.0001.00 address-family ipv6 unicast single-topology interface GigabitEthernet0/3/0/0 address-family ipv6 unicast ! ! router bgp 55400 bgp router-id 54.6.1.1 address-family ipv4 unicast ! address-family ipv6 unicast network 55:5::/64 redistribute connected redistribute isis ipv6-cloud allocate-label all ! neighbor 34.4.3.3 remote-as 55400 address-family ipv4 unicast ! address-family ipv6 labeled-unicast Configuring 6VPE on a PE Router: Example This sample configuration shows the configuration of 6VPE on a PE router: vrf vpn1 address-family ipv6 unicast import route-target 200:2 ! export route-target 200:2 interface Loopback0 ipv4 address 10.0.0.1 255.255.255.255 interface GigabitEthernet0/0/0/1 vrf vpn1 ipv6 address 2001:c003:a::2/64 Implementing IPv6 VPN Provider Edge Transport over MPLS Configuration Examples for 6PE 123 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 router bgp 1 bgp router-id 10.0.0.1 bgp redistribute-internal bgp graceful-restart address-family ipv4 unicast ! address-family vpnv6 unicast ! neighbor 10.0.0.2 >>>> Remote peer loopback address. remote-as 1 update-source Loopback0 address-family ipv4 unicast ! address-family vpnv6 unicast route-policy pass-all in route-policy pass-all out ! vrf vpn1 rd 100:2 bgp router-id 140.140.140.140 address-family ipv6 unicast redistribute connected ! neighbor 2001:c003:a::1 remote-as 6502 address-family ipv6 unicast route-policy pass-all in route-policy pass-all out ! Configuring OSPFv3 between PE to CE: Example: This example shows you how to configure provider edge (PE)-to-customer edge (CE) routing sessions that use Open Shortest Path First version 3 (OSPFv3): router ospfv3 0 vrf V1 router-id 100.0.0.2 domain-id type 0005 value CAFE00112233 domain-id secondary type 0105 value beef00000001 domain-id secondary type 0205 value beef00000002 capability vrf-lite redistribute bgp 1 area 0 interface POS0/3/0/1 vrf V2 router-id 200.0.0.2 capability vrf-lite area 1 interface POS0/3/0/2Implementing IPv6 VPN Provider Edge Transport over MPLS Additional References 124 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Additional References For additional information related to this feature, refer to these references: Related Document Standards MIBs RFCs Related Topic Document Title Getting started material Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Getting Started Guide Standards 1 1. Not all supported standards are listed. Title No new or modified standards are supported by this feature, and support for existing standards has not been modified by this feature. — MIBs MIBs Link — To locate and download MIBs using Cisco IOS XR software, use the Cisco MIB Locator found at this URL and choose a platform under the Cisco Access Products menu: http://cisco.com/public/sw-center/netmgmt/cmtk/mibs.shtml RFCs Title — —Implementing IPv6 VPN Provider Edge Transport over MPLS Additional References 125 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 Technical Assistance Description Link The Cisco Technical Support website contains thousands of pages of searchable technical content, including links to products, technologies, solutions, technical tips, and tools. Registered Cisco.com users can log in from this page to access even more content. http://www.cisco.com/techsupportImplementing IPv6 VPN Provider Edge Transport over MPLS Additional References 126 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02127 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 HC Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Interface and Hardware Component Configuration Guide IC Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router IP Addresses and Services Configuration Guide MCC Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Multicast Configuration Guide MNC Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Monitoring Configuration Guide MPC Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide QC Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Modular Quality of Service Configuration Guide RC Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide SC Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Security Configuration Guide SMC Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Management Configuration Guide LSC Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router L2VPN and Ethernet Services Configuration Guide I N D E X Numerics 6PE/VPE BGP multipath VPC-108 conditions for use VPC-106 how to configure VPC-109 how to deploy VPC-107 overview VPC-106 prerequisites VPC-106 service provider considerations VPC-106 supported protocols VPC-110 A automatic route distinguisher, MPLS Layer 3 VPN VPC-15 autonomous system VPC-16 B BGP confederations VPC-17 BGP (border gateway protocol) distributing routes VPC-21 messages and MPLS labels VPC-20 routing information VPC-20 BGP4 configuration VPC-106 BGP multipath 6PE/VPE VPC-108 C CSC (Carrier Supporting Carrier) configuration examples VPC-78 configuration options for backbone and customer carriers VPC-24 configuring a CSC-PE link VPC-71 configuring a static route to a peer VPC-78 customer carrier network options VPC-24 identifying topology VPC-70 CSC-CE link, how to configure VPC-75 CSC-PE link, how to configure VPC-71 customer edge router 6PE/VPE VPC-107 MPLS Layer 3 VPN VPC-12 customer edge router (CE) MPLS Layer 3 VPN VPC-12 E eBGP VPC-10Index 128 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Layer 3 VPN Configuration Guide OL-26115-02 G Generic Routing Encapsulation (GRE over L3VPN) VPC-21 I Inter-AS configurations BGP VPC-17 interprovider VPN VPC-16 supported VPC-16 interprovider VPN, MPLS VPN VPC-17 M MPLS Layer 3 VPN automatic route distinguisher VPC-15 autonomous system VPC-16 components VPC-12 concepts VPC-11 customer edge router VPC-12 customer router VPC-12 defined VPC-11 defining VPC-11 distributed routing information VPC-13 FIB VPC-10 implementing VPC-11 major components VPC-15 MPLS forwarding VPC-14 PE router VPC-12 prerequisites VPC-10 provider router VPC-12 restrictions VPC-10 scalability VPC-12 security VPC-12 topology VPC-12 VPN routing information VPC-14 working VPC-13 MPLS VPN Inter-AS ASBRs VPC-15 major components VPC-15 P PE router MPLS Layer 3 VPN VPC-12 S service provider edge routers, 6PE VPC-107 service providers, 6PE VPC-106 static router to a peer, how to configure VPC-78 T tunnel types 6PE VPC-107 V verifying IP connectivity, CSC MPLS Layer 3 VPN VPC-71 VRF (virtual routing and forwarding) configuring backbone carrier core VPC-71 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x Americas Headquarters Cisco Systems, Inc. 170 West Tasman Drive San Jose, CA 95134-1706 USA http://www.cisco.com Tel: 408 526-4000 800 553-NETS (6387) Fax: 408 527-0883 Text Part Number: OL-26056-02THE SPECIFICATIONS AND INFORMATION REGARDING THE PRODUCTS IN THIS MANUAL ARE SUBJECT TO CHANGE WITHOUT NOTICE. ALL STATEMENTS, INFORMATION, AND RECOMMENDATIONS IN THIS MANUAL ARE BELIEVED TO BE ACCURATE BUT ARE PRESENTED WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED. USERS MUST TAKE FULL RESPONSIBILITY FOR THEIR APPLICATION OF ANY PRODUCTS. THE SOFTWARE LICENSE AND LIMITED WARRANTY FOR THE ACCOMPANYING PRODUCT ARE SET FORTH IN THE INFORMATION PACKET THAT SHIPPED WITH THE PRODUCT AND ARE INCORPORATED HEREIN BY THIS REFERENCE. IF YOU ARE UNABLE TO LOCATE THE SOFTWARE LICENSE OR LIMITED WARRANTY, CONTACT YOUR CISCO REPRESENTATIVE FOR A COPY. The Cisco implementation of TCP header compression is an adaptation of a program developed by the University of California, Berkeley (UCB) as part of UCB's public domain version of the UNIX operating system. All rights reserved. Copyright © 1981, Regents of the University of California. NOTWITHSTANDING ANY OTHER WARRANTY HEREIN, ALL DOCUMENT FILES AND SOFTWARE OF THESE SUPPLIERS ARE PROVIDED “AS IS" WITH ALL FAULTS. CISCO AND THE ABOVE-NAMED SUPPLIERS DISCLAIM ALL WARRANTIES, EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, THOSE OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT OR ARISING FROM A COURSE OF DEALING, USAGE, OR TRADE PRACTICE. IN NO EVENT SHALL CISCO OR ITS SUPPLIERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY INDIRECT, SPECIAL, CONSEQUENTIAL, OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES, INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, LOST PROFITS OR LOSS OR DAMAGE TO DATA ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THIS MANUAL, EVEN IF CISCO OR ITS SUPPLIERS HAVE BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. Cisco and the Cisco logo are trademarks or registered trademarks of Cisco and/or its affiliates in the U.S. and other countries. To view a list of Cisco trademarks, go to this URL: http:// www.cisco.com/go/trademarks. Third-party trademarks mentioned are the property of their respective owners. The use of the word partner does not imply a partnership relationship between Cisco and any other company. (1110R) Any Internet Protocol (IP) addresses used in this document are not intended to be actual addresses. Any examples, command display output, and figures included in the document are shown for illustrative purposes only. Any use of actual IP addresses in illustrative content is unintentional and coincidental. © 2012 Cisco Systems, Inc. All rights reserved.C O N T E N T S P r e f a c e Preface xiii Changes to This Document xiii Obtaining Documentation and Submitting a Service Request xiii C H A P T E R 1 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol 1 Prerequisites for Implementing Cisco MPLS LDP 2 Information About Implementing Cisco MPLS LDP 2 Overview of Label Distribution Protocol 2 Label Switched Paths 2 LDP Control Plane 3 Exchanging Label Bindings 4 LDP Forwarding 5 LDP Graceful Restart 6 Control Plane Failure 7 Phases in Graceful Restart 8 Recovery with Graceful-Restart 9 Label Advertisement Control (Outbound Filtering) 10 Label Acceptance Control (Inbound Filtering) 10 Local Label Allocation Control 11 Session Protection 11 IGP Synchronization 12 IGP Auto-configuration 13 LDP Nonstop Routing 13 IP LDP Fast Reroute Loop Free Alternate 14 Downstream on Demand 15 Explicit-Null and Implicit-Null Labels 16 How to Implement MPLS LDP 16 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 iiiConfiguring LDP Discovery Parameters 17 Configuring LDP Discovery Over a Link 19 Configuring LDP Discovery for Active Targeted Hellos 20 Configuring LDP Discovery for Passive Targeted Hellos 22 Configuring Label Advertisement Control (Outbound Filtering) 24 Setting Up LDP Neighbors 26 Setting Up LDP Forwarding 29 Setting Up LDP NSF Using Graceful Restart 31 Configuring Label Acceptance Control (Inbound Filtering) 34 Configuring Local Label Allocation Control 36 Configuring Session Protection 37 Configuring LDP IGP Synchronization: OSPF 39 Configuring LDP IGP Synchronization: ISIS 40 Enabling LDP Auto-Configuration for a Specified OSPF Instance 42 Enabling LDP Auto-Configuration in an Area for a Specified OSPF Instance 44 Disabling LDP Auto-Configuration 46 Configuring LDP Nonstop Routing 48 Configuring LDP Downstream on Demand mode 50 Redistributing MPLS LDP Routes into BGP 51 Setting Up Implicit-Null-Override Label 52 Configuration Examples for Implementing MPLS LDP 54 Configuring LDP with Graceful Restart: Example 54 Configuring LDP Discovery: Example 54 Configuring LDP Link: Example 54 Configuring LDP Discovery for Targeted Hellos: Example 55 Configuring Label Advertisement (Outbound Filtering): Example 55 Configuring LDP Neighbors: Example 56 Configuring LDP Forwarding: Example 56 Configuring LDP Nonstop Forwarding with Graceful Restart: Example 56 Configuring Label Acceptance (Inbound Filtering): Example 57 Configuring Local Label Allocation Control: Example 57 Configuring LDP Session Protection: Example 58 Configuring LDP IGP Synchronization—OSPF: Example 58 Configuring LDP IGP Synchronization—ISIS: Example 58 Configuring LDP Auto-Configuration: Example 59 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x iv OL-26056-02 ContentsConfigure IP LDP Fast Reroute Loop Free Alternate: Example 59 Verify IP LDP Fast Reroute Loop Free Alternate: Example 61 Additional References 63 C H A P T E R 2 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE 65 Prerequisites for Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE 66 Information About Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE 66 Overview of RSVP for MPLS-TE 66 LSP Setup 67 High Availability 67 Graceful Restart 67 Graceful Restart: Standard and Interface-Based 68 Graceful Restart: Figure 69 ACL-based Prefix Filtering 70 RSVP MIB 70 Information About Implementing RSVP Authentication 71 RSVP Authentication Functions 71 RSVP Authentication Design 71 Global, Interface, and Neighbor Authentication Modes 72 Security Association 73 Key-source Key-chain 74 Guidelines for Window-Size and Out-of-Sequence Messages 75 Caveats for Out-of-Sequence 75 How to Implement RSVP 75 Configuring Traffic Engineering Tunnel Bandwidth 76 Confirming DiffServ-TE Bandwidth 76 Enabling Graceful Restart 78 Configuring ACL-based Prefix Filtering 80 Configuring ACLs for Prefix Filtering 80 Configuring RSVP Packet Dropping 81 Verifying RSVP Configuration 83 Enabling RSVP Traps 86 How to Implement RSVP Authentication 88 Configuring Global Configuration Mode RSVP Authentication 88 Enabling RSVP Authentication Using the Keychain in Global Configuration Mode 88 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 v ContentsConfiguring a Lifetime for RSVP Authentication in Global Configuration Mode 90 Configuring the Window Size for RSVP Authentication in Global Configuration Mode 91 Configuring an Interface for RSVP Authentication 93 Specifying the RSVP Authentication Keychain in Interface Mode 93 Configuring a Lifetime for an Interface for RSVP Authentication 95 Configuring the Window Size for an Interface for RSVP Authentication 96 Configuring RSVP Neighbor Authentication 98 Specifying the Keychain for RSVP Neighbor Authentication 98 Configuring a Lifetime for RSVP Neighbor Authentication 100 Configuring the Window Size for RSVP Neighbor Authentication 102 Verifying the Details of the RSVP Authentication 104 Eliminating Security Associations for RSVP Authentication 104 Configuration Examples for RSVP 104 Bandwidth Configuration (Prestandard): Example 104 Bandwidth Configuration (MAM): Example 104 Bandwidth Configuration (RDM): Example 105 Refresh Reduction and Reliable Messaging Configuration: Examples 105 Refresh Interval and the Number of Refresh Messages Configuration: Example 105 Retransmit Time Used in Reliable Messaging Configuration: Example 105 Acknowledgement Times Configuration: Example 105 Summary Refresh Message Size Configuration: Example 106 Disable Refresh Reduction: Example 106 Configure Graceful Restart: Examples 106 Enable Graceful Restart: Example 106 Enable Interface-Based Graceful Restart: Example 106 Change the Restart-Time: Example 107 Change the Hello Interval: Example 107 Configure ACL-based Prefix Filtering: Example 107 Set DSCP for RSVP Packets: Example 107 Enable RSVP Traps: Example 108 Configuration Examples for RSVP Authentication 108 RSVP Authentication Global Configuration Mode: Example 108 RSVP Authentication for an Interface: Example 109 RSVP Neighbor Authentication: Example 109 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x vi OL-26056-02 ContentsRSVP Authentication by Using All the Modes: Example 110 Additional References 110 C H A P T E R 3 Implementing MPLS Forwarding 113 Prerequisites for Implementing Cisco MPLS Forwarding 113 Restrictions for Implementing Cisco MPLS Forwarding 113 Information About Implementing MPLS Forwarding 114 MPLS Forwarding Overview 114 Label Switching Functions 114 Distribution of Label Bindings 115 MFI Control-Plane Services 115 MFI Data-Plane Services 115 MPLS Maximum Transmission Unit 116 Additional References 116 C H A P T E R 4 Implementing MPLS Traffic Engineering 119 Prerequisites for Implementing Cisco MPLS Traffic Engineering 120 Restrictions for Implementing Cisco MPLS Traffic Engineering 120 Information About Implementing MPLS Traffic Engineering 121 Overview of MPLS Traffic Engineering 121 Benefits of MPLS Traffic Engineering 121 How MPLS-TE Works 121 MPLS Traffic Engineering 123 Backup AutoTunnels 123 AutoTunnel Attribute-set 123 Link Protection 124 Node Protection 124 Backup AutoTunnel Assignment 125 Explicit Paths 126 Periodic Backup Promotion 126 Protocol-Based CLI 126 Differentiated Services Traffic Engineering 127 Prestandard DS-TE Mode 127 IETF DS-TE Mode 127 Bandwidth Constraint Models 128 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 vii ContentsMaximum Allocation Bandwidth Constraint Model 128 Russian Doll Bandwidth Constraint Model 128 TE Class Mapping 129 Flooding 129 Flooding Triggers 129 Flooding Thresholds 130 Fast Reroute 130 MPLS-TE and Fast Reroute over Link Bundles 131 Ignore Intermediate System-to-Intermediate System Overload Bit Setting in MPLS-TE 131 Flexible Name-based Tunnel Constraints 132 MPLS Traffic Engineering Interarea Tunneling 133 Interarea Support 133 Multiarea Support 134 Loose Hop Expansion 134 Loose Hop Reoptimization 135 ABR Node Protection 135 Fast Reroute Node Protection 135 MPLS-TE Forwarding Adjacency 135 MPLS-TE Forwarding Adjacency Benefits 136 MPLS-TE Forwarding Adjacency Restrictions 136 MPLS-TE Forwarding Adjacency Prerequisites 136 Path Computation Element 136 Path Protection 138 Prerequisites for Path Protection 138 Restrictions for Path Protection 139 MPLS-TE Automatic Bandwidth 139 MPLS-TE Automatic Bandwidth Overview 139 Adjustment Threshold 141 Overflow Detection 141 Restrictions for MPLS-TE Automatic Bandwidth 141 Point-to-Multipoint Traffic-Engineering 142 Point-to-Multipoint Traffic-Engineering Overview 142 Point-to-Multipoint RSVP-TE 144 Point-to-Multipoint Fast Reroute 144 Point-to-Multipoint Label Switch Path 144 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x viii OL-26056-02 ContentsPath Option for Point-to-Multipoint RSVP-TE 145 MPLS Traffic Engineering Shared Risk Link Groups 146 Explicit Path 147 Fast ReRoute with SRLG Constraints 148 Importance of Protection 149 Delivery of Packets During a Failure 150 Multiple Backup Tunnels Protecting the Same Interface 150 SRLG Limitations 150 Soft-Preemption 151 Path Option Attributes 151 Configuration Hierarchy of Path Option Attributes 152 Traffic Engineering Bandwidth and Bandwidth Pools 152 Path Option Switchover 153 Path Option and Path Protection 153 Auto-Tunnel Mesh 154 Destination List (Prefix-List) 154 How to Implement Traffic Engineering 155 Building MPLS-TE Topology 155 Creating an MPLS-TE Tunnel 158 Configuring Forwarding over the MPLS-TE Tunnel 161 Protecting MPLS Tunnels with Fast Reroute 164 Enabling an AutoTunnel Backup 169 Removing an AutoTunnel Backup 170 Establishing MPLS Backup AutoTunnels to Protect Fast Reroutable TE LSPs 172 Establishing Next-Hop Tunnels with Link Protection 174 Configuring a Prestandard DS-TE Tunnel 176 Configuring an IETF DS-TE Tunnel Using RDM 178 Configuring an IETF DS-TE Tunnel Using MAM 181 Configuring MPLS -TE and Fast-Reroute on OSPF 184 Configuring the Ignore Integrated IS-IS Overload Bit Setting in MPLS-TE 187 Configuring Flexible Name-based Tunnel Constraints 188 Assigning Color Names to Numeric Values 188 Associating Affinity-Names with TE Links 190 Associating Affinity Constraints for TE Tunnels 192 Configuring IS-IS to Flood MPLS-TE Link Information 193 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 ix ContentsConfiguring an OSPF Area of MPLS-TE 195 Configuring Explicit Paths with ABRs Configured as Loose Addresses 197 Configuring MPLS-TE Forwarding Adjacency 199 Configuring a Path Computation Client and Element 200 Configuring a Path Computation Client 200 Configuring a Path Computation Element Address 202 Configuring PCE Parameters 203 Configuring Path Protection on MPLS-TE 206 Enabling Path Protection for an Interface 206 Assigning a Dynamic Path Option to a Tunnel 208 Forcing a Manual Switchover on a Path-Protected Tunnel 210 Configuring the Delay the Tunnel Takes Before Reoptimization 210 Configuring the Automatic Bandwidth 212 Configuring the Collection Frequency 212 Forcing the Current Application Period to Expire Immediately 214 Configuring the Automatic Bandwidth Functions 215 Configuring the Shared Risk Link Groups 218 Configuring the SRLG Values of Each Link that has a Shared Risk with Another Link 218 Creating an Explicit Path With Exclude SRLG 220 Using Explicit Path With Exclude SRLG 222 Creating a Link Protection on Backup Tunnel with SRLG Constraint 226 Creating a Node Protection on Backup Tunnel with SRLG Constraint 229 Configuring Point-to-Multipoint TE 232 Enabling Multicast Routing on the Router 232 Configuring the Static Group for the Point-to-Multipoint Interface 235 Configuring Destinations for the Tunnel Interface 237 Disabling Destinations 241 Logging Per Destinations for Point-to-Multipoint 243 Enabling Soft-Preemption on a Node 245 Enabling Soft-Preemption on a Tunnel 247 Configuring Attributes within a Path-Option Attribute 249 Configuring Auto-Tunnel Mesh Tunnel ID 251 Configuring Auto-tunnel Mesh Unused Timeout 252 Configuring Auto-Tunnel Mesh Group 254 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x x OL-26056-02 ContentsConfiguring Tunnel Attribute-Set Templates 256 Enabling LDP on Auto-Tunnel Mesh 258 Configuration Examples for Cisco MPLS-TE 260 Build MPLS-TE Topology and Tunnels: Example 260 Configure IETF DS-TE Tunnels: Example 261 Configure MPLS-TE and Fast-Reroute on OSPF: Example 262 Configure the Ignore IS-IS Overload Bit Setting in MPLS-TE: Example 262 Configure Flexible Name-based Tunnel Constraints: Example 263 Configure an Interarea Tunnel: Example 264 Configure Forwarding Adjacency: Example 265 Configure PCE: Example 265 Configure Tunnels for Path Protection: Example 266 Configure Automatic Bandwidth: Example 267 Configure the MPLS-TE Shared Risk Link Groups: Example 267 Configure the MPLS-TE Auto-Tunnel Backup: Example 269 Configure Point-to-Multipoint TE: Examples 276 P2MP Topology Scenario: Example 276 Configure Point-to-Multipoint for the Source: Example 278 Configure the Point-to-Multipoint Tunnel: Example 278 Disable a Destination: Example 279 Configure the Point-to-Multipoint Solution: Example 279 Additional References 283 C H A P T E R 5 Implementing MPLS OAM 285 Prerequisites for MPLS LSP Ping and Traceroute for P2MP 285 MPLS Network Management with MPLS LSP Ping and MPLS LSP Traceroute 286 Roles of Various Routers 286 P2MP Ping 287 P2MP Traceroute 288 Configure the Ping and Traceroute: Example 288 C H A P T E R 6 Implementing MPLS Transport Profile 295 Restrictions for MPLS-TP 295 Information About Implementing MPLS Transport Profile 296 MPLS Transport Profile 296 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 xi ContentsBidirectional LSPs 297 MPLS-TP Path Protection 297 Fault OAM Support 297 MPLS-TP Links and Physical Interfaces 299 Tunnel LSPs 299 MPLS-TP IP-less support 300 How to Implement MPLS Transport Profile 300 Configuring the Node ID and Global ID 300 Configuring Pseudowire OAM Attributes 301 Configuring the Pseudowire Class 302 Configuring the Pseudowire 303 Configuring the MPLS TP Tunnel 304 Configuring MPLS-TP LSPs at Midpoint 307 Configuring MPLS-TP Links and Physical Interfaces 309 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x xii OL-26056-02 ContentsPreface The Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide preface contains these sections: • Changes to This Document, page xiii • Obtaining Documentation and Submitting a Service Request, page xiii Changes to This Document This table lists the technical changes made to this document since it was first printed. Table 1: Changes to This Document Revision Date Change Summary Republished with documentation updates for Cisco IOS XR Release 4.2.1. OL-26056-02 June 2012 OL-26056-01 December 2011 Initial release of this document. Obtaining Documentation and Submitting a Service Request For information on obtaining documentation,submitting a service request, and gathering additional information, see the monthly What's New in Cisco Product Documentation, which also lists all new and revised Cisco technical documentation, at: http://www.cisco.com/en/US/docs/general/whatsnew/whatsnew.html Subscribe to the What's New in Cisco Product Documentation as a Really Simple Syndication (RSS) feed and set content to be delivered directly to your desktop using a reader application. The RSS feeds are a free service and Cisco currently supports RSS version 2.0. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 xiii Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x xiv OL-26056-02 Preface Obtaining Documentation and Submitting a Service RequestC H A P T E R 1 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol This module describes how to implement MPLS Label Distribution Protocol on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Routers. The Multiprotocol Label Switching (MPLS) is a standards-based solution driven by the Internet Engineering Task Force (IETF) that was devised to convert the Internet and IP backbones from best-effort networks into business-class transport mediums. MPLS, with its label switching capabilities, eliminates the need for an IP route look-up and creates a virtual circuit (VC)switching function, allowing enterprisesthe same performance on their IP-based network services as with those delivered over traditional networks such as Frame Relay or ATM. Label Distribution Protocol (LDP) performs label distribution in MPLS environments. LDP provides the following capabilities: • LDP performs hop-by-hop or dynamic path setup; it does not provide end-to-end switching services. • LDP assigns labels to routes using the underlying Interior Gateway Protocols (IGP) routing protocols. • LDP provides constraint-based routing using LDP extensions for traffic engineering. Finally, LDP is deployed in the core of the network and is one of the key protocols used in MPLS-based Layer 2 and Layer 3 virtual private networks (VPNs). Feature History for Implementing MPLS LDP Release Modification Release 3.7.2 This feature was introduced. Support was added for these features: • IP LDP Fast Reroute Loop Free Alternate • Downstream on Demand Release 4.0.1 Release 4.2.1 Support was added for LDP Implicit Null for IGP Routes. • Prerequisites for Implementing Cisco MPLS LDP, page 2 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 1• Information About Implementing Cisco MPLS LDP, page 2 • How to Implement MPLS LDP , page 16 • Configuration Examples for Implementing MPLS LDP, page 54 • Additional References, page 63 Prerequisites for Implementing Cisco MPLS LDP These prerequisites are required to implement MPLS LDP: • You must be in a user group associated with a task group that includesthe proper task IDs. The command reference guides include the task IDs required for each command. If you suspect user group assignment is preventing you from using a command, contact your AAA administrator for assistance. • You must be running Cisco IOS XR software. • You must install a composite mini-image and the MPLS package. • You must activate IGP. • We recommend to use a lower session holdtime bandwidth such as neighbors so that a session down occurs before an adjacency-down on a neighbor. Therefore, the following default values for the hello times are listed: • Holdtime is 15 seconds. • Interval is 5 seconds. For example, the LDP session holdtime can be configured as 30 seconds by using the holdtime command. Information About Implementing Cisco MPLS LDP To implement MPLS LDP, you should understand these concepts: Overview of Label Distribution Protocol LDP performs label distribution in MPLS environments. LDP uses hop-by-hop or dynamic path setup, but does not provide end-to-end switching services. Labels are assigned to routesthat are chosen by the underlying IGP routing protocols. The Label Switched Paths (LSPs) that result from the routes, forward labeled traffic across the MPLS backbone to adjacent nodes. Label Switched Paths LSPs are created in the network through MPLS. They can be created statically, by RSVP traffic engineering (TE), or by LDP. LSPs created by LDP perform hop-by-hop path setup instead of an end-to-end path. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 2 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Prerequisites for Implementing Cisco MPLS LDPLDP Control Plane The control plane enableslabelswitched routers(LSRs) to discover their potential peer routers and to establish LDP sessions with those peers to exchange label binding information. This figure shows the control messages exchanged between LDP peers. Figure 1: LDP Control Protocol LDP uses the hello discovery mechanism to discover its neighbor or peer on the network. When LDP is enabled on an interface, it sends hello messages to a link-local multicast address, and joins a specific multicast group to receive hellos from other LSRs present on the given link. When LSRs on a given link receive hellos, their neighbors are discovered and the LDP session (using TCP) is established. Hellos are not only used to discover and trigger LDP sessions; they are also required to maintain LDP sessions. If a certain number of hellos from a given peer are missed in sequence, LDP sessions are brought down until the peer is discovered again. Note LDP also supports non-link neighbors that could be multiple hops away on the network, using the targeted hello mechanism. In these cases, hellos are sent on a directed, unicast address. The first message in the session establishment phase is the initialization message, which is used to negotiate session parameters. After session establishment, LDP sends a list of all its interface addresses to its peers in an address message.Whenever a new address becomes available or unavailable, the peers are notified regarding such changes via ADDRESS or ADDRESS_WITHDRAW messages respectively. When MPLS LDP learns an IGP prefix it allocates a label locally as the inbound label. The local binding between the prefix label is conveyed to its peers via LABEL_MAPPING message. If the binding breaks and becomes unavailable, a LABEL_WITHDRAW message is sent to all its peers, which responds with LABEL_RELEASE messages. The local label binding and remote label binding received from its peer(s) is used to setup forwarding entries. Using routing information from the IGP protocol and the forwarding information base (FIB), the next active hop isselected. Label binding islearned from the next hop peer, and is used asthe outbound label while setting up the forwarding plane. The LDP session is also kept alive using the LDP keepalive mechanism, where an LSR sends a keepalive message periodically to its peers. If no messages are received and a certain number of keepalive messages are missed from a peer, the session is declared dead, and brought down immediately. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 3 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Overview of Label Distribution ProtocolRelated Topics Configuring LDP Discovery Parameters, on page 17 Configuring LDP Discovery Over a Link, on page 19 Configuring LDP Link: Example, on page 54 Configuring LDP Discovery for Active Targeted Hellos, on page 20 Configuring LDP Discovery for Passive Targeted Hellos, on page 22 Configuring LDP Discovery for Targeted Hellos: Example, on page 55 Exchanging Label Bindings LDP creates LSPs to perform the hop-by-hop path setup so that MPLS packets can be transferred between the nodes on the MPLS network. This figure illustrates the process of label binding exchange for setting up LSPs. Figure 2: Setting Up Label Switched Paths For a given network (10.0.0.0), hop-by-hop LSPs are set up between each of the adjacent routers (or, nodes) and each node allocates a local label and passes it to its neighbor as a binding: 1 R4 allocates local label L4 for prefix 10.0.0.0 and advertises it to its neighbors (R3). 2 R3 allocates local label L3 for prefix 10.0.0.0 and advertises it to its neighbors (R1, R2, R4). 3 R1 allocates local label L1 for prefix 10.0.0.0 and advertises it to its neighbors (R2, R3). 4 R2 allocates local label L2 for prefix 10.0.0.0 and advertises it to its neighbors (R1, R3). 5 R1’s label information base (LIB) keeps local and remote labels bindings from its neighbors. 6 R2’s LIB keeps local and remote labels bindings from its neighbors. 7 R3’s LIB keeps local and remote labels bindings from its neighbors. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 4 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Overview of Label Distribution Protocol8 R4’s LIB keeps local and remote labels bindings from its neighbors. Related Topics Setting Up LDP Neighbors, on page 26 Configuring LDP Neighbors: Example, on page 56 LDP Forwarding Once label bindings are learned, the LDP control plane is ready to setup the MPLS forwarding plane as shown in the following figure. Once label bindings are learned, the LDP control plane is ready to setup the MPLS forwarding plane as shown in this figure. Figure 3: Forwarding Setup 1 Because R3 is next hop for 10.0.0.0 as notified by the FIB, R1 selects label binding from R3 and installs forwarding entry (Layer 1, Layer 3). 2 Because R3 is next hop for 10.0.0.0 (as notified by FIB), R2 selects label binding from R3 and installs forwarding entry (Layer 2, Layer 3). 3 Because R4 is next hop for 10.0.0.0 (as notified by FIB), R3 selects label binding from R4 and installs forwarding entry (Layer 3, Layer 4). 4 Because next hop for 10.0.0.0 (as notified by FIB) is beyond R4, R4 uses NO-LABEL as the outbound and installs the forwarding entry (Layer 4); the outbound packet is forwarded IP-only. 5 Incoming IP traffic on ingress LSR R1 gets label-imposed and is forwarded as an MPLS packet with label L3. 6 Incoming IP traffic on ingress LSR R2 gets label-imposed and is forwarded as an MPLS packet with label L3. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 5 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Overview of Label Distribution Protocol7 R3 receives an MPLS packet with label L3, looks up in the MPLS label forwarding table and switches this packet as an MPLS packet with label L4. 8 R4 receives an MPLS packet with label L4, looks up in the MPLS label forwarding table and finds that it should be Unlabeled, pops the top label, and passes it to the IP forwarding plane. 9 IP forwarding takes over and forwards the packet onward. Related Topics Setting Up LDP Forwarding, on page 29 Configuring LDP Forwarding: Example, on page 56 LDP Graceful Restart LDP (Label Distribution Protocol) graceful restart provides a control plane mechanism to ensure high availability and allows detection and recovery from failure conditions while preserving Nonstop Forwarding (NSF)services. Graceful restart is a way to recover from signaling and control plane failures without impacting forwarding. Without LDP graceful restart, when an established session fails, the corresponding forwarding states are cleaned immediately from the restarting and peer nodes. In this case LDP forwarding restarts from the beginning, causing a potential loss of data and connectivity. The LDP graceful restart capability is negotiated between two peers during session initialization time, in FT SESSION TLV. In this typed length value (TLV), each peer advertises the following information to its peers: Reconnect time Advertises the maximum time that other peer will wait for this LSR to reconnect after control channel failure. Recovery time Advertises the maximum time that the other peer has on its side to reinstate or refresh its states with this LSR. This time is used only during session reestablishment after earlier session failure. FT flag Specifies whether a restart could restore the preserved (local) node state for this flag. Once the graceful restart session parameters are conveyed and the session is up and running, graceful restart procedures are activated. When configuring the LDP graceful restart process in a network with multiple links, targeted LDP hello adjacencies with the same neighbor, or both, make sure that graceful restart is activated on the session before any hello adjacency times out in case of neighbor control plane failures. One way of achieving this is by configuring a lower session hold time between neighbors such that session timeout occurs before hello adjacency timeout. It is recommended to set LDP session hold time using the following formula: Session Holdtime <= (Hello holdtime - Hello interval) * 3 This meansthat for default values of 15 seconds and 5 secondsfor link Hello holdtime and interval respectively, session hold time should be set to 30 seconds at most. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 6 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol LDP Graceful RestartFor more information about LDP commands,see the Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol module of the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide. Related Topics Setting Up LDP NSF Using Graceful Restart, on page 31 Configuring LDP Nonstop Forwarding with Graceful Restart: Example, on page 56 Control Plane Failure When a control plane failure occurs, connectivity can be affected. The forwarding statesinstalled by the router control planes are lost, and the in-transit packets could be dropped, thus breaking NSF. Thisfigure illustrates a control plane failure and showsthe process and results of a control plane failure leading to loss of connectivity. Figure 4: Control Plane Failure 1 The R4 LSR control plane restarts. 2 LIB is lost when the control plane restarts. 3 The forwarding states installed by the R4 LDP control plane are immediately deleted. 4 Any in-transit packets flowing from R3 to R4 (still labeled with L4) arrive at R4. 5 The MPLS forwarding plane at R4 performs a lookup on local label L4 which fails. Because of thisfailure, the packet is dropped and NSF is not met. 6 The R3 LDP peer detects the failure of the control plane channel and deletes its label bindings from R4. 7 The R3 control plane stops using outgoing labels from R4 and deletes the corresponding forwarding state (rewrites), which in turn causes forwarding disruption. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 7 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol LDP Graceful Restart8 The established LSPs connected to R4 are terminated at R3, resulting in broken end-to-end LSPs from R1 to R4. 9 The established LSPs connected to R4 are terminated at R3, resulting in broken LSPs end-to-end from R2 to R4. Phases in Graceful Restart The graceful restart mechanism is divided into different phases: Control communication failure detection Control communication failure is detected when the system detects either: • Missed LDP hello discovery messages • Missed LDP keepalive protocol messages • Detection of Transmission Control Protocol (TCP) disconnection a with a peer Forwarding state maintenance during failure Persistent forwarding states at each LSR are achieved through persistent storage (checkpoint) by the LDP control plane. While the control plane is in the process of recovering, the forwarding plane keeps the forwarding states, but marks them as stale. Similarly, the peer control plane also keeps (and marks as stale) the installed forwarding rewrites associated with the node that is restarting. The combination of local node forwarding and remote node forwarding plane states ensures NSF and no disruption in the traffic. Control state recovery Recovery occurs when the session isreestablished and label bindings are exchanged again. This process allows the peer nodes to synchronize and to refresh stale forwarding states. Related Topics Setting Up LDP NSF Using Graceful Restart, on page 31 Configuring LDP Nonstop Forwarding with Graceful Restart: Example, on page 56 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 8 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol LDP Graceful RestartRecovery with Graceful-Restart This figure illustrates the process of failure recovery using graceful restart. Figure 5: Recovering with Graceful Restart 1 The router R4 LSR control plane restarts. 2 With the control plane restart, LIB is gone but forwarding states installed by R4’s LDP control plane are not immediately deleted but are marked as stale. 3 Any in-transit packets from R3 to R4 (still labeled with L4) arrive at R4. 4 The MPLS forwarding plane at R4 performs a successful lookup for the local label L4 as forwarding is still intact. The packet is forwarded accordingly. 5 The router R3 LDP peer detects the failure of the control plane and channel and deletes the label bindings from R4. The peer, however, does not delete the corresponding forwarding states but marks them as stale. 6 At this point there are no forwarding disruptions. 7 The peer also starts the neighbor reconnect timer using the reconnect time value. 8 The established LSPs going toward the router R4 are still intact, and there are no broken LSPs. When the LDP control plane recovers, the restarting LSR starts its forwarding state hold timer and restores its forwarding state from the checkpointed data. This action reinstates the forwarding state and entries and marks them as old. The restarting LSR reconnects to its peer, indicated in the FT Session TLV, that it either was or was not able to restore its state successfully. If it was able to restore the state, the bindings are resynchronized. The peer LSR stops the neighbor reconnect timer (started by the restarting LSR), when the restarting peer connects and starts the neighbor recovery timer. The peer LSR checks the FT Session TLV if the restarting Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 9 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol LDP Graceful Restartpeer was able to restore its state successfully. It reinstates the corresponding forwarding state entries and receives binding from the restarting peer. When the recovery timer expires, any forwarding state that is still marked as stale is deleted. If the restarting LSR fails to recover (restart), the restarting LSR forwarding state and entries will eventually timeout and is deleted, while neighbor-related forwarding states or entries are removed by the Peer LSR on expiration of the reconnect or recovery timers. Related Topics Setting Up LDP NSF Using Graceful Restart, on page 31 Configuring LDP Nonstop Forwarding with Graceful Restart: Example, on page 56 Label Advertisement Control (Outbound Filtering) By default, LDP advertises labels for all the prefixes to all its neighbors. When this is not desirable (for scalability and security reasons), you can configure LDP to perform outbound filtering for local label advertisement for one or more prefixes to one more peers. This feature is known as LDP outbound label filtering, or local label advertisement control. Related Topics Configuring Label Advertisement Control (Outbound Filtering), on page 24 Configuring Label Advertisement (Outbound Filtering): Example, on page 55 Label Acceptance Control (Inbound Filtering) By default, LDP accepts labels (as remote bindings) for all prefixes from all peers. LDP operates in liberal label retention mode, which instructs LDP to keep remote bindings from all peers for a given prefix. For security reasons, or to conserve memory, you can override this behavior by configuring label binding acceptance for set of prefixes from a given peer. The ability to filter remote bindings for a defined set of prefixes is also referred to as LDP inbound label filtering. Inbound filtering can also be implemented using an outbound filtering policy; however, you may not be able to implement this system if an LDP peer resides under a different administration domain. When both inbound and outbound filtering options are available, we recommend that you use outbound label filtering. Note Related Topics Configuring Label Acceptance Control (Inbound Filtering), on page 34 Configuring Label Acceptance (Inbound Filtering): Example, on page 57 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 10 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Label Advertisement Control (Outbound Filtering)Local Label Allocation Control By default, LDP allocates local labels for all prefixes that are not Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) prefixes 1 . This is acceptable when LDP is used for applications other than Layer 3 virtual private networks (L3VPN) core transport. When LDP is used to set up transport LSPs for L3VPN traffic in the core, it is not efficient or even necessary to allocate and advertise local labels for, potentially, thousands of IGP prefixes. In such a case, LDP is typically required to allocate and advertise local label for loopback /32 addresses for PE routers. This is accomplished using LDP local label allocation control, where an access list can be used to limit allocation of local labels to a set of prefixes. Limiting local label allocation provides several benefits, including reduced memory usage requirements, fewer local forwarding updates, and fewer network and peer updates. You can configure label allocation using an IP access list to specify a set of prefixes that local labels can allocate and advertise. Tip Related Topics Configuring Local Label Allocation Control, on page 36 Configuring Local Label Allocation Control: Example, on page 57 Session Protection When a link comes up, IP converges earlier and much faster than MPLS LDP and may result in MPLS traffic loss until MPLS convergence. If a link flaps, the LDP session will also flap due to loss of link discovery. LDP session protection minimizestraffic loss, providesfaster convergence, and protects existing LDP (link)sessions by means of “parallel” source of targeted discovery hello. An LDP session is kept alive and neighbor label bindings are maintained when links are down. Upon reestablishment of primary link adjacencies, MPLS convergence is expedited as LDP need not relearn the neighbor label bindings. LDP session protection lets you configure LDP to automatically protect sessions with all or a given set of peers (as specified by peer-acl). When configured, LDP initiates backup targeted hellos automatically for neighbors for which primary link adjacencies already exist. These backup targeted hellos maintain LDP sessions when primary link adjacencies go down. The Session Protection figure illustrates LDP session protection between neighbors R1 and R3. The primary link adjacency between R1 and R3 is directly connected link and the backup; targeted adjacency is maintained between R1 and R3. If the direct link fails, LDP link adjacency is destroyed, but the session is kept up and 1 For L3VPN Inter-AS option C, LDP may also be required to assign local labels for some BGP prefixes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 11 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Local Label Allocation Controlrunning using targeted hello adjacency (through R2). When the direct link comes back up, there is no change in the LDP session state and LDP can converge quickly and begin forwarding MPLS traffic. Figure 6: Session Protection When LDP session protection is activated (upon link failure), protection is maintained for an unlimited period time. Note Related Topics Configuring Session Protection, on page 37 Configuring LDP Session Protection: Example, on page 58 IGP Synchronization Lack of synchronization between LDP and IGP can cause MPLS traffic loss. Upon link up, for example, IGP can advertise and use a link before LDP convergence has occurred; or, a link may continue to be used in IGP after an LDP session goes down. LDP IGP synchronization synchronizes LDP and IGP so that IGP advertises links with regular metrics only when MPLS LDP is converged on that link. LDP considers a link converged when at least one LDP session is up and running on the link for which LDP has sent its applicable label bindings and received at least one label binding from the peer. LDP communicates this information to IGP upon link up or session down events and IGP acts accordingly, depending on sync state. In the event of an LDP graceful restart session disconnect, a session is treated as converged as long as the graceful restart neighbor is timed out. Additionally, upon local LDP restart, a checkpointed recovered LDP graceful restart session is used and treated as converged and is given an opportunity to connect and resynchronize. Under certain circumstances, it might be required to delay declaration of resynchronization to a configurable interval. LDP provides a configuration option to delay declaring synchronization up for up to 60 seconds. LDP communicates this information to IGP upon linkup or session down events. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 12 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol IGP SynchronizationThe configuration for LDP IGP synchronization resides in respective IGPs (OSPF and IS-IS) and there is no LDP-specific configuration for enabling of thisfeature. However, there is a specific LDP configuration for IGP sync delay timer. Note Related Topics Configuring LDP IGP Synchronization: OSPF, on page 39 Configuring LDP IGP Synchronization—OSPF: Example, on page 58 Configuring LDP IGP Synchronization: ISIS, on page 40 Configuring LDP IGP Synchronization—ISIS: Example, on page 58 IGP Auto-configuration To enable LDP on a large number of interfaces, IGP auto-configuration lets you automatically configure LDP on all interfaces associated with a specified IGP interface; for example, when LDP is used for transport in the core network. However, there needs to be one IGP set up to enable LDP auto-configuration. Typically, LDP assigns and advertises labels for IGP routes and must often be enabled on all active interfaces by an IGP. Without IGP auto-configuration, you must define the set of interfaces under LDP, a procedure that is time-intensive and error-prone. LDP auto-configuration is supported for IPv4 unicast family in the default VRF. The IGP is responsible for verifying and applying the configuration. Note You can also disable auto-configuration on a per-interface basis. This permits LDP to enable all IGP interfaces except those that are explicitly disabled and prevents LDP from enabling an interface when LDP auto-configuration is configured under IGP. Related Topics Enabling LDP Auto-Configuration for a Specified OSPF Instance, on page 42 Enabling LDP Auto-Configuration in an Area for a Specified OSPF Instance, on page 44 Disabling LDP Auto-Configuration, on page 46 Configuring LDP Auto-Configuration: Example, on page 59 LDP Nonstop Routing LDP nonstop routing (NSR) functionality makes failures, such as Route Processor (RP) or Distributed Route Processor (DRP) failover, invisible to routing peers with minimal to no disruption of convergence performance. By default, NSR is globally enabled on all LDP sessions except AToM. A disruption in service may include any of these events: • Route processor (RP) or distributed route processor (DRP) failover • LDP process restart • In-service system upgrade (ISSU) Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 13 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol IGP Auto-configuration• Minimum disruption restart (MDR) Unlike graceful restart functionality, LDP NSR does not require protocol extensions and does not force software upgrades on other routers in the network, nor does LDP NSR require peer routers to support NSR. L2VPN configuration is not supported on NSR. Note Process failures of active TCP or LDP results in session loss and, as a result, NSR cannot be provided unless RP switchover is configured as a recovery action. For more information about how to configure switchover as a recovery action for NSR, see the Configuring Transports module in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router IP Addresses and Services Configuration Guide . Related Topics Configuring LDP Nonstop Routing, on page 48 IP LDP Fast Reroute Loop Free Alternate The IP Fast Reroute is a mechanism that enables a router to rapidly switch traffic, after an adjacent link failure, node failure, or both, towards a pre-programmed loop-free alternative (LFA) path. This LFA path is used to switch traffic until the router installs a new primary next hop again, as computed for the changed network topology. The goal of LFA FRR is to reduce failure reaction time to 50 milliseconds by using a pre-computed alternate next hop, in the event that the currently selected primary next hop fails, so that the alternate can be rapidly used when the failure is detected. This feature targets to address the fast convergence ability by detecting, computing, updating or enabling prefix independent pre-computed alternate loop-free paths at the time of failure. IGP pre-computes a backup path per IGP prefix. IGP selects one and only one backup path per primary path. RIB installs the best path and download path protection information to FIB by providing correct annotation for protected and protecting paths. FIB pre-installsthe backup path in dataplane. Upon the link or node failure, the routing protocol detects the failure, all the backup paths of the impacted prefixes are enabled in a prefix-independent manner. Prerequisites The Label Distribution Protocol (LDP) can use the loop-free alternates as long as these prerequisites are met: The Label Switching Router (LSR) running LDP must distribute its labels for the Forwarding Equivalence Classes (FECs) it can provide to all its neighbors, regardless of whether they are upstream, or not. There are two approaches in computing LFAs: • Link-based (per-link)--In link-based LFAs, all prefixes reachable through the primary (protected) link share the same backup information. This means that the whole set of prefixes, sharing the same primary, also share the repair or fast reroute (FRR) ability. The per-link approach protects only the next hop address. The per-link approach is suboptimal and not the best for capacity planning. This is because all traffic is redirected to the next hop instead of being spread over multiple paths, which may lead to potential congestion on link to the next hop. The per-link approach does not provide support for node protection. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 14 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol IP LDP Fast Reroute Loop Free Alternate• Prefix-based (per-prefix)--Prefix-based LFAs allow computing backup information per prefix. It protects the destination address. The per-prefix approach is the preferred approach due to its greater applicability, and the greater protection and better bandwidth utilization that it offers. The repair or backup information computed for a given prefix using prefix-based LFA may be different from the computed by link-based LFA. Note The per-prefix LFA approach is preferred for LDP IP Fast Reroute LFA for these reasons: • Better node failure resistance • Better capacity planning and coverage Features Not Supported These interfaces and features are not supported for the IP LDP Fast Reroute Loop Free Alternate feature: • BVI interface (IRB) is not supported either as primary or backup path. • GRE tunnel is not supported either as primary or backup path. • Cisco ASR 9000 Series SPA Interface Processor-700 POS line card on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router is not supported as primary link. It can be used as LFA backup only on main interface. • In a multi-topology scenerio, the route in topology T can only use LFA within topology T. Hence, the availability of a backup path depends on the topology. For more information about configuring the IP Fast Reroute Loop-free alternate , see Implementing IS-IS on Cisco IOS XR Software module of the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide. Related Topics Configure IP LDP Fast Reroute Loop Free Alternate: Example, on page 59 Verify IP LDP Fast Reroute Loop Free Alternate: Example, on page 61 Downstream on Demand This Downstream on demand feature adds support for downstream-on-demand mode, where the label is not advertised to a peer, unlessthe peer explicitly requestsit. At the same time,since the peer does not automatically advertise labels, the label request is sent whenever the next-hop points out to a peer that no remote label has been assigned. In order to enable downstream-on-demand mode, this configuration must be applied at mplsldp configuration mode: mpls ldp downstream-on-demand with ACL The ACL contains a list of peer IDs that are configured for downstream-on-demand mode. When the ACL is changed or configured, the list of established neighbors is traversed. If a session's downstream-on-demand Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 15 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Downstream on Demandconfiguration has changed, the session is reset in order that the new down-stream-on-demand mode can be configured. The reason for resetting the session is to ensure that the labels are properly advertised between the peers. When a new session is established, the ACL is verified to determine whether the session should negotiate for downstream-on-demand mode. If the ACL does not exist or is empty, downstream-on-demand mode is not configured for any neighbor. For it to be enabled, the Downstream on demand feature has to be configured on both peers of the session. If only one peer in the session has downstream-on-demand feature configured, then the session does not use downstream-on-demand mode. If, after, a label request is sent, and no remote label is received from the peer, the router will periodically resend the label request. After the peer advertises a label after receiving the label request, it will automatically readvertise the label if any label attribute changes subsequently. Related Topics Configuring LDP Downstream on Demand mode, on page 50 Explicit-Null and Implicit-Null Labels Cisco MPLS LDP uses null label, implicit or explicit, as local label for routes or prefixes that terminate on the given LSR. These routes include all local, connected, and attached networks. By default, the null label is implicit-null that allows LDP control plane to implement penultimate hop popping (PHOP) mechanism. When thisis not desirable, you can configure explicit-null that allows LDP control plane to implement ultimate hop popping (UHOP) mechanism. You can configure this explicit-null feature on the ultimate hop LSR. This configuration knob includes an access-list to specify the IP prefixes for which PHOP is desired. This new enhancement allows you to configure implicit-null local label for non-egress (ultimate hop LSR) prefixes by using the implicit-null-override command. This enforces implicit-null local label for a specific prefix even if the prefix requires a non-null label to be allocated by default. For example, by default, an LSR allocates and advertises a non-null label for an IGP route. If you wish to terminate LSP for this route on penultimate hop of the LSR, you can enforce implicit-null label allocation and advertisement for this prefix using implicit-null-override feature. If a given prefix is permitted in both explicit-null and implicit-null-override feature, then implicit-null-override supercedes and an implicit-null label is allocated and advertised for the prefix. Note In order to enable implicit-null-override mode, this configuration must be applied at MPLS LDP label configuration mode: mpls ldp label implicit-null-override for ! This feature works with any prefix including static, IGP, and BGP, when specified in the ACL. How to Implement MPLS LDP A typical MPLS LDP deployment requires coordination among several global neighbor routers. Various configuration tasks are required to implement MPLS LDP : Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 16 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Explicit-Null and Implicit-Null LabelsConfiguring LDP Discovery Parameters Perform this task to configure LDP discovery parameters (which may be crucial for LDP operations). Note The LDP discovery mechanism is used to discover or locate neighbor nodes. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. mpls ldp 3. router-id { type number | ip-address } 4. discovery { hello | targeted-hello } holdtime seconds 5. discovery { hello | targeted-hello } interval seconds 6. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit 7. (Optional) show mpls ldp parameters DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 mpls ldp Enters MPLS LDP configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# mpls ldp Step 2 Step 3 router-id { type number | ip-address } Specifies the router ID of the local node. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# router-id loopback 1 • In Cisco IOS XR software, the router ID is specified as an interface name or IP address. By default, LDP uses the global router ID (configured by the global router ID process). Specifies the time that a discovered neighbor is kept without receipt of any subsequent hello messages. The default value for the seconds discovery { hello | targeted-hello } holdtime seconds Step 4 argument is 15 seconds for link hello and 90 seconds for targeted hello messages. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 17 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Configuring LDP Discovery ParametersCommand or Action Purpose discovery hello holdtime 30 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# discovery targeted-hello holdtime 180 Selects the period of time between the transmission of consecutive hello messages. The default value for the seconds argument is 5 discovery { hello | targeted-hello } interval seconds Step 5 seconds for link hello messages and 10 seconds for targeted hello messages. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# discovery hello interval 15 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# discovery targeted-hello interval 20 Step 6 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router (config-ldp)# end or ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router configuration changes. (config-ldp)# commit ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. (Optional) Displays all the current MPLS LDP parameters. show mpls ldp parameters Example: Step 7 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router # show mpls ldp parameters Related Topics LDP Control Plane, on page 3 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 18 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Configuring LDP Discovery ParametersConfiguring LDP Discovery Over a Link Perform this task to configure LDP discovery over a link. Note There is no need to enable LDP globally. Before You Begin A stable router ID is required at either end of the link to ensure the link discovery (and session setup) is successful. If you do not assign a router ID to the routers, the system will default to the global router ID. Default router IDs are subject to change and may cause an unstable discovery. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. mpls ldp 3. router-id ip-address 4. interface type interface-path-id 5. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit 6. (Optional) show mpls ldp discovery DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 mpls ldp Enters MPLS LDP configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# mpls ldp Step 2 Step 3 router-id ip-address Specifies the router ID of the local node. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# router-id loopback 1 • In Cisco IOS XR software, the router ID is specified as an interface name or IP address. By default, LDP uses the global router ID (configured by the global router ID process). Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 19 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Configuring LDP Discovery Over a LinkCommand or Action Purpose Enters interface configuration mode for the LDP protocol. Interface type must be Tunnel-TE. interface type interface-path-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# Step 4 interface tunnel-te 12001 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp-if)# Step 5 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp-if)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns or the router to EXEC mode. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp-if)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. (Optional) Displays the status of the LDP discovery process. This command, without an interface filter, generates a list of interfaces over which the LDP show mpls ldp discovery Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show mpls ldp discovery Step 6 discovery process is running. The output information contains the state of the link (xmt/rcv hellos), local LDP identifier, the discovered peer’s LDP identifier, and holdtime values. Related Topics LDP Control Plane, on page 3 Configuring LDP Link: Example, on page 54 Configuring LDP Discovery for Active Targeted Hellos Perform this task to configure LDP discovery for active targeted hellos. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 20 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Configuring LDP Discovery for Active Targeted HellosNote The active side for targeted hellos initiates the unicast hello toward a specific destination. Before You Begin These prerequisites are required to configure LDP discovery for active targeted hellos: • Stable router ID is required at either end of the targeted session. If you do not assign a router ID to the routers, the system will default to the global router ID. Please note that default router IDs are subject to change and may cause an unstable discovery. • One or more MPLS Traffic Engineering tunnels are established between non-directly connected LSRs. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. mpls ldp 3. router-id ip-address 4. interface type interface-path-id 5. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit 6. (Optional) show mpls ldp discovery DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 mpls ldp Enters MPLS LDP configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# mpls ldp Step 2 Step 3 router-id ip-address Specifies the router ID of the local node. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# router-id loopback 1 In Cisco IOS XR software, the router ID is specified as an interface name or IP address. By default, LDP uses the global router ID (configured by global router ID process). Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 21 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Configuring LDP Discovery for Active Targeted HellosCommand or Action Purpose interface type interface-path-id Enters interface configuration mode for the LDP protocol. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# interface tunnel-te 12001 Step 4 Step 5 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# commit ? Entering no exitsthe configuration session and returnsthe router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. (Optional) Displays the status of the LDP discovery process. This command, without an interface filter, generates a list of interfaces over which the LDP show mpls ldp discovery Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show mpls ldp discovery Step 6 discovery process is running. The output information contains the state of the link (xmt/rcv hellos), local LDP identifier, the discovered peer’s LDP identifier, and holdtime values. Related Topics LDP Control Plane, on page 3 Configuring LDP Discovery for Targeted Hellos: Example, on page 55 Configuring LDP Discovery for Passive Targeted Hellos Perform this task to configure LDP discovery for passive targeted hellos. A passive side for targeted hello is the destination router (tunnel tail), which passively waits for an incoming hello message. Because targeted hellos are unicast, the passive side waits for an incoming hello message to respond with hello toward its discovered neighbor. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 22 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Configuring LDP Discovery for Passive Targeted HellosBefore You Begin Stable router ID is required at either end of the link to ensure that the link discovery (and session setup) is successful. If you do not assign a router ID to the routers, the system defaults to the global router ID. Default router IDs are subject to change and may cause an unstable discovery. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. mpls ldp 3. router-id ip-address 4. discovery targeted-hello accept 5. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit 6. (Optional) show mpls ldp discovery DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 mpls ldp Enters MPLS LDP configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# mpls ldp Step 2 Step 3 router-id ip-address Specifies the router ID of the local node. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# router-id loopback 1 • In Cisco IOS XR software, the router ID is specified as an interface name or IP address. By default, LDP uses the global router ID (configured by global router ID process). Directs the system to accept targeted hello messages from any source and activates passive mode on the LSR for targeted hello acceptance. discovery targeted-hello accept Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# discovery targeted-hello accept Step 4 • This command is executed on the receiver node (with respect to a given MPLS TE tunnel). • You can control the targeted-hello acceptance using the discovery targeted-hello accept command. Step 5 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 23 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Configuring LDP Discovery for Passive Targeted HellosCommand or Action Purpose • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • end • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. (Optional) Displays the status of the LDP discovery process. This command, without an interface filter, generates a list of interfaces over which the LDP discovery show mpls ldp discovery Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show mpls ldp discovery Step 6 process is running. The output information contains the state of the link (xmt/rcv hellos), local LDP identifier, the discovered peer’s LDP identifier, and holdtime values. Related Topics LDP Control Plane, on page 3 Configuring LDP Discovery for Targeted Hellos: Example, on page 55 Configuring Label Advertisement Control (Outbound Filtering) Perform this task to configure label advertisement (outbound filtering). By default, a label switched router (LSR) advertises all incoming label prefixes to each neighboring router. You can control the exchange of label binding information using the mpls ldp label advertise command. Using the optional keywords, you can advertise selective prefixesto all neighbors, advertise selective prefixes to defined neighbors, or disable label advertisement to all peers for all prefixes. Note Prefixes and peers advertised selectively are defined in the access list. Before You Begin Before configuring label advertisement, enable LDP and configure an access list. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 24 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Configuring Label Advertisement Control (Outbound Filtering)SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. mpls ldp 3. label advertise { disable | for prefix-acl [ to peer-acl ] | interface type interface-path-id } 4. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 mpls ldp Enters MPLS LDP configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# mpls ldp Step 2 label advertise { disable | for prefix-acl [ Configureslabel advertisement by specifying one of the following options: to peer-acl ] | interface type interface-path-id } Step 3 disable Disables label advertisement to all peers for all prefixes (if there Example: are no other conflicting rules). RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# label interface advertise interface POS 0/1/0/0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# for pfx_acl1 to peer_acl1 Specifies an interface for label advertisement of an interface address. for prefix-acl to peer-acl Specifies neighbors to advertise and receive label advertisements. Step 4 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 25 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Configuring Label Advertisement Control (Outbound Filtering)Command or Action Purpose Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# commit ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Related Topics Label Advertisement Control (Outbound Filtering), on page 10 Configuring Label Advertisement (Outbound Filtering): Example, on page 55 Setting Up LDP Neighbors Perform this task to set up LDP neighbors. Before You Begin Stable router ID isrequired at either end of the link to ensure the link discovery (and session setup) issuccessful. If you do not assign a router ID to the routers, the system will default to the global router ID. Default router IDs are subject to change and may cause an unstable discovery. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 26 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Setting Up LDP NeighborsSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. mpls ldp 3. interface type interface-path-id 4. discovery transport-address [ ip-address | interface ] 5. exit 6. holdtime seconds 7. neighbor ip-address password [ encryption ] password 8. backoff initial maximum 9. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit 10. (Optional) show mpls ldp neighbor DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 mpls ldp Enters MPLS LDP configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# mpls ldp Step 2 interface type interface-path-id Enters interface configuration mode for the LDP protocol. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# interface POS 0/1/0/0 Step 3 discovery transport-address [ ip-address | Provides an alternative transport address for a TCP connection. interface ] Step 4 • Default transport address advertised by an LSR (for TCP connections) to its peer is the router ID. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp-if)# discovery transport-address 192.168.1.42 • Transport address configuration is applied for a given LDP-enabled interface. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# discovery transport-address interface • If the interface version of the command is used, the configured IP address of the interface is passed to its neighbors as the transport address. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 27 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Setting Up LDP NeighborsCommand or Action Purpose exit Exits the current configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp-if)# exit Step 5 Changes the time for which an LDP session is maintained in the absence of LDP messages from the peer. holdtime seconds Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# holdtime 30 Step 6 • Outgoing keepalive interval is adjusted accordingly (to make three keepalives in a given holdtime) with a change in session holdtime value. • Session holdtime is also exchanged when the session is established. • In this example holdtime is set to 30 seconds, which causes the peer session to timeout in 30 seconds, as well as transmitting outgoing keepalive messages toward the peer every 10 seconds. Configures password authentication (using the TCP MD5 option) for a given neighbor. neighbor ip-address password [ encryption ] password Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# neighbor 192.168.2.44 password secretpasswd Step 7 Configures the parameters for the LDP backoff mechanism. The LDP backoff mechanism preventstwo incompatibly configured LSRsfrom backoff initial maximum Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# backoff 10 20 Step 8 engaging in an unthrottled sequence of session setup failures. If a session setup attempt fails due to such incompatibility, each LSR delays its next attempt (backs off), increasing the delay exponentially with each successive failure until the maximum backoff delay is reached. Step 9 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 28 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Setting Up LDP NeighborsCommand or Action Purpose ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. (Optional) Displays the status of the LDP session with its neighbors. This command can be run with various filters as well as with the brief option. show mpls ldp neighbor Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show mpls ldp neighbor Step 10 Related Topics Configuring LDP Neighbors: Example, on page 56 Setting Up LDP Forwarding Perform this task to set up LDP forwarding. By default, the LDP control plane implements the penultimate hop popping (PHOP) mechanism. The PHOP mechanism requires that label switched routers use the implicit-null label as a local label for the given Forwarding Equivalence Class (FEC) for which LSR is the penultimate hop. Although PHOP has certain advantages, it may be required to extend LSP up to the ultimate hop under certain circumstances(for example, to propagate MPL QoS). This is done using a special local label (explicit-null) advertised to the peers after which the peers use this label when forwarding traffic toward the ultimate hop (egress LSR). Before You Begin Stable router ID isrequired at either end of the link to ensure the link discovery (and session setup) issuccessful. If you do not assign a router ID to the routers, the system will default to the global router ID. Default router IDs are subject to change and may cause an unstable discovery. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 29 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Setting Up LDP ForwardingSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. mpls ldp 3. explicit-null 4. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit 5. (Optional) show mpls ldp forwarding 6. (Optional) show mpls forwarding 7. (Optional) ping ip-address DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 mpls ldp Enters MPLS LDP configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# mpls ldp Step 2 Causes a router to advertise an explicit null label in situations where it normally advertises an implicit null label (for example, to enable an ultimate-hop disposition instead of PHOP). explicit-null Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# explicit-null Step 3 Step 4 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 30 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Setting Up LDP ForwardingCommand or Action Purpose ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. (Optional) Displays the MPLS LDP view of installed forwarding states (rewrites). show mpls ldp forwarding Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show mpls ldp forwarding Step 5 (Optional) Displays a global view of all MPLS installed forwarding states (rewrites) by various applications (LDP, TE, and static). show mpls forwarding Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show mpls forwarding Step 6 (Optional) Checks for connectivity to a particular IP address (going through MPLS LSP as shown in the show mpls forwarding command). ping ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# ping 192.168.2.55 Step 7 Related Topics LDP Forwarding, on page 5 Configuring LDP Forwarding: Example, on page 56 Setting Up LDP NSF Using Graceful Restart Perform this task to set up NSF using LDP graceful restart. LDP graceful restart is a way to enable NSF for LDP. The correct way to set up NSF using LDP graceful restart is to bring up LDP neighbors (link or targeted) with additional configuration related to graceful restart. Before You Begin Stable router ID isrequired at either end of the link to ensure the link discovery (and session setup) issuccessful. If you do not assign a router ID to the routers, the system will default to the global router ID. Default router IDs are subject to change and may cause an unstable discovery. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 31 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Setting Up LDP NSF Using Graceful RestartSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. mpls ldp 3. interface type interface-path-id 4. exit 5. graceful-restart 6. graceful-restart forwarding-state-holdtime seconds 7. graceful-restart reconnect-timeout seconds 8. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit 9. (Optional) show mpls ldp parameters 10. (Optional) show mpls ldp neighbor 11. (Optional) show mpls ldp graceful-restart DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 mpls ldp Enters MPLS LDP configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# mpls ldp Step 2 interface type interface-path-id Enters interface configuration mode for the LDP protocol. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# Step 3 interface POS 0/1/0/0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp-if)# exit Exits the current configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp-if)# exit Step 4 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 32 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Setting Up LDP NSF Using Graceful RestartCommand or Action Purpose graceful-restart Enables the LDP graceful restart feature. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# graceful-restart Step 5 Specifies the length of time that forwarding can keep LDP-installed forwarding states and rewrites, and specifies wh en the LDP control plane restarts. graceful-restart forwarding-state-holdtime seconds Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# Step 6 • After restart of the control plane, when the forwarding state holdtime expires, any previously installed LDP forwarding state or rewrite that is not yet refreshed is deleted from the forwarding. graceful-restart forwarding-state-holdtime 180 • Recovery time sent after restart is computed as the current remaining value of the forwarding state hold timer. Specifies the length of time a neighbor waits before restarting the node to reconnect before declaring an earlier graceful restart session graceful-restart reconnect-timeout seconds Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# graceful-restart reconnect-timeout 169 Step 7 as down. This command is used to start a timer on the peer (upon a neighbor restart). Thistimer isreferred to as Neighbor Livenesstimer. Step 8 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 33 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Setting Up LDP NSF Using Graceful RestartCommand or Action Purpose (Optional) Displays all the current MPLS LDP parameters. show mpls ldp parameters Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show mpls ldp parameters Step 9 (Optional) Displays the status of the LDP session with its neighbors. This command can be run with various filters as well as with the brief option. show mpls ldp neighbor Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show mpls ldp neighbor Step 10 (Optional) Displays the status of the LDP graceful restart feature. The output of this command not only shows states of different graceful restart show mpls ldp graceful-restart Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show mpls ldp graceful-restart Step 11 timers, but also a list of graceful restart neighbors, their state, and reconnect count. Related Topics LDP Graceful Restart, on page 6 Phases in Graceful Restart, on page 8 Recovery with Graceful-Restart, on page 9 Configuring LDP Nonstop Forwarding with Graceful Restart: Example, on page 56 Configuring Label Acceptance Control (Inbound Filtering) Perform this task to configure LDP inbound label filtering. By default, there is no inbound label filtering performed by LDP and thus an LSR accepts (and retains) all remote label bindings from all peers. Note SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. mpls ldp 3. label accept for prefix-acl from ip-address 4. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 34 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Configuring Label Acceptance Control (Inbound Filtering)DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters the configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 mpls ldp Enters the MPLS LDP configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# mpls ldp Step 2 Configuresinbound label acceptance for prefixesspecified by prefix-acl from neighbor (as specified by its IP address). label accept for prefix-acl from ip-address Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# label Step 3 accept for pfx_acl_1 from 192.168.1.1 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# label accept for pfx_acl_2 from 192.168.2.2 Step 4 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leavesthe router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Related Topics Label Acceptance Control (Inbound Filtering), on page 10 Configuring Label Acceptance (Inbound Filtering): Example, on page 57 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 35 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Configuring Label Acceptance Control (Inbound Filtering)Configuring Local Label Allocation Control Perform this task to configure label allocation control. Note By default, local label allocation control is disabled and all non-BGP prefixes are assigned local labels. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. mpls ldp 3. label allocate for prefix-acl 4. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters the configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 mpls ldp Enters the MPLS LDP configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# mpls ldp Step 2 label allocate for prefix-acl Configures label allocation control for prefixes as specified by prefix-acl. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# label allocate for pfx_acl_1 Step 3 Step 4 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# end Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 36 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Configuring Local Label Allocation ControlCommand or Action Purpose ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Related Topics Local Label Allocation Control, on page 11 Configuring Local Label Allocation Control: Example, on page 57 Configuring Session Protection Perform this task to configure LDP session protection. By default, there is no protection is done for link sessions by means of targeted hellos. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. mpls ldp 3. session protection [ for peer-acl ] [ duration seconds ] 4. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 37 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Configuring Session ProtectionDETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters the configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 mpls ldp Enters the MPLS LDP configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# mpls ldp Step 2 Configures LDP session protection for peers specified by peer-acl with a maximum duration, in seconds. session protection [ for peer-acl ] [ duration seconds ] Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# Step 3 session protection for peer_acl_1 duration 60 Step 4 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exitsthe configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leavesthe router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Related Topics Session Protection, on page 11 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 38 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Configuring Session ProtectionConfiguring LDP Session Protection: Example, on page 58 Configuring LDP IGP Synchronization: OSPF Perform this task to configure LDP IGP Synchronization under OSPF. Note By default, there is no synchronization between LDP and IGPs. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router ospf process-name 3. Use one of the following commands: • mpls ldp sync • area area-id mpls ldp sync • area area-id interface name mpls ldp sync 4. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Identifies the OSPF routing process and enters OSPF configuration mode. router ospf process-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router ospf 100 Step 2 Step 3 Use one of the following commands: Enables LDP IGP synchronization on an interface. • mpls ldp sync • area area-id mpls ldp sync • area area-id interface name mpls ldp sync Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 39 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Configuring LDP IGP Synchronization: OSPFCommand or Action Purpose Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf)# mpls ldp sync Step 4 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Related Topics IGP Synchronization, on page 12 Configuring LDP IGP Synchronization—OSPF: Example, on page 58 Configuring LDP IGP Synchronization: ISIS Perform this task to configure LDP IGP Synchronization under ISIS. Note By default, there is no synchronization between LDP and ISIS. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 40 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Configuring LDP IGP Synchronization: ISISSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router isis instance-id 3. interface type interface-path-id 4. address-family ipv4 unicast 5. mpls ldp sync 6. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Enables the Intermediate System-to-Intermediate System (IS-IS) routing protocol and defines an IS-IS instance. router isis instance-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router isis Step 2 100 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# Configures the IS-IS protocol on an interface and enters ISIS interface configuration mode. interface type interface-path-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis)# Step 3 interface POS 0/2/0/0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if)# Enters address family configuration mode for configuring IS-IS routing for a standard IP Version 4 (IPv4) address prefix. address-family ipv4 unicast Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if)# Step 4 address-family ipv4 unicast RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if-af)# mpls ldp sync Enables LDP IGP synchronization. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if-af)# mpls ldp sync Step 5 Step 6 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 41 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Configuring LDP IGP Synchronization: ISISCommand or Action Purpose • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • end • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if-af)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-isis-if-af)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Related Topics IGP Synchronization, on page 12 Configuring LDP IGP Synchronization—ISIS: Example, on page 58 Enabling LDP Auto-Configuration for a Specified OSPF Instance Perform this task to enable IGP auto-configuration globally for a specified OSPF process name. You can disable auto-configuration on a per-interface basis. This lets LDP enable all IGP interfaces except those that are explicitly disabled. Note This feature is supported for IPv4 unicast family in default VRF only. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 42 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Enabling LDP Auto-Configuration for a Specified OSPF InstanceSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router ospf process-name 3. mpls ldp auto-config 4. area area-id 5. interface type interface-path-id 6. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Enters a uniquely identifiable OSPF routing process. The process name is any alphanumeric string no longer than 40 characters withoutspaces. router ospf process-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router ospf Step 2 190 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf)# mpls ldp auto-config Enables LDP auto-configuration. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf)# mpls ldp auto-config Step 3 Step 4 area area-id Configures an OSPF area and identifier. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf)# area 8 area-id Either a decimal value or an IP address. Step 5 interface type interface-path-id Enables LDP auto-configuration on the specified interface. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf-ar)# interface pos 0/6/0/0 LDP configurable limit for maximum number of interfaces does not apply to IGP auto-configuration interfaces. Note Step 6 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 43 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Enabling LDP Auto-Configuration for a Specified OSPF InstanceCommand or Action Purpose • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • end • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf-ar-if)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf-ar-if)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Related Topics IGP Auto-configuration, on page 13 Configuring LDP Auto-Configuration: Example, on page 59 Disabling LDP Auto-Configuration, on page 46 Enabling LDP Auto-Configuration in an Area for a Specified OSPF Instance Perform this task to enable IGP auto-configuration in a defined area with a specified OSPF process name. You can disable auto-configuration on a per-interface basis. This lets LDP enable all IGP interfaces except those that are explicitly disabled. Note This feature is supported for IPv4 unicast family in default VRF only. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 44 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Enabling LDP Auto-Configuration in an Area for a Specified OSPF InstanceSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. router ospf process-name 3. area area-id 4. mpls ldp auto-config 5. interface type interface-path-id 6. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Enters a uniquely identifiable OSPF routing process. The process name is any alphanumeric string no longer than 40 characters without spaces. router ospf process-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router ospf Step 2 100 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf)# Step 3 area area-id Configures an OSPF area and identifier. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf)# area area-id Either a decimal value or an IP address. 8 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf-ar)# mpls ldp auto-config Enables LDP auto-configuration. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf-ar)# mpls ldp auto-config Step 4 Enables LDP auto-configuration on the specified interface. The LDP configurable limit for maximum number of interfaces does not apply to IGP auto-config interfaces. interface type interface-path-id Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf-ar)# Step 5 interface pos 0/6/0/0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf-ar-if) Step 6 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 45 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Enabling LDP Auto-Configuration in an Area for a Specified OSPF InstanceCommand or Action Purpose • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • end • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf-ar-if)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ospf-ar-if)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returnsthe router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Related Topics IGP Auto-configuration, on page 13 Configuring LDP Auto-Configuration: Example, on page 59 Disabling LDP Auto-Configuration, on page 46 Disabling LDP Auto-Configuration Perform this task to disable IGP auto-configuration. You can disable auto-configuration on a per-interface basis. This lets LDP enable all IGP interfaces except those that are explicitly disabled. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. mpls ldp 3. interface type interface-path-id 4. igp auto-config disable 5. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 46 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Disabling LDP Auto-ConfigurationDETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 mpls ldp Enters the MPLS LDP configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# mpls ldp RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# Step 2 interface type interface-path-id Enters interface configuration mode and configures an interface. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# interface pos 0/6/0/0 Step 3 igp auto-config disable Disables auto-configuration on the specified interface. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp-if)# igp auto-config disable Step 4 Step 5 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp-if)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp-if)# commit ? Entering no exitsthe configuration session and returnsthe router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 47 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Disabling LDP Auto-ConfigurationRelated Topics IGP Auto-configuration, on page 13 Configuring LDP Auto-Configuration: Example, on page 59 Configuring LDP Nonstop Routing Perform this task to configure LDP NSR. Note By default, NSR is globally-enabled on all LDP sessions except AToM. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. mpls ldp 3. nsr 4. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit 5. show mpls ldp nsr statistics 6. show mpls ldp nsr summary 7. show mpls ldp nsr pending DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 mpls ldp Enters the MPLS LDP configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# mpls ldp Step 2 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 48 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Configuring LDP Nonstop RoutingCommand or Action Purpose nsr Enables LDP nonstop routing. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# nsr Step 3 Step 4 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# end ? Entering yessaves configuration changesto the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. show mpls ldp nsr statistics Displays MPLS LDP NSR statistics. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show mpls ldp nsr statistics Step 5 show mpls ldp nsr summary Displays MPLS LDP NSR summarized information. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show mpls ldp nsr summary Step 6 show mpls ldp nsr pending Displays MPLS LDP NSR pending information. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show mpls ldp nsr pending Step 7 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 49 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Configuring LDP Nonstop RoutingRelated Topics LDP Nonstop Routing, on page 13 Configuring LDP Downstream on Demand mode SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. mpls ldp 3. downstream-on-demand 4. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 mpls ldp Enters MPLS LDP configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# mpls ldp Step 2 Enters downstream on demand label advertisement mode. The ACL contains the list of peer IDs that are configured for downstream-on-demand mode. downstream-on-demand Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# Step 3 When the ACL is changed or configured, the list of established neighbor is traversed. downstream-on-demand with access-list Step 4 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# end Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 50 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Configuring LDP Downstream on Demand modeCommand or Action Purpose ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Related Topics Downstream on Demand, on page 15 Redistributing MPLS LDP Routes into BGP Perform this task to redistribute Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) autonomous system into an MPLS LDP. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. mpls ldp 3. redistribute bgp 4. Use one of these commands: • end • commit 5. show run mpls ldp DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 51 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Redistributing MPLS LDP Routes into BGPCommand or Action Purpose mpls ldp Enters MPLS LDP configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(conf)# mpls Step 2 ldp Step 3 redistribute bgp Allows the redistribution of BGP routes into an MPLS LDP processes. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# Autonomoussystem numbers(ASNs) are globally unique identifiers used to identify autonomous systems (ASs) and enable ASs to exchange exterior routing information between neighboring ASs. A unique ASN is allocated to each AS for use in BGP routing. ASNs are encoded as 2-byte numbers and 4-byte numbers in BGP. Note redistribute bgp {advertise-to access-list | as} Step 4 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. show run mpls ldp Displays information about the redistributed route information. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show run mpls Step 5 ldp Setting Up Implicit-Null-Override Label Perform this task to configure implicit-null label for non-egress prefixes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 52 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Setting Up Implicit-Null-Override LabelSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. mpls ldp 3. label 4. implicit-null-override for access-list 5. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 mpls ldp Enters MPLS LDP configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# mpls ldp Step 2 label Configures the allocation, advertisement ,and acceptance of labels. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# label Step 3 Step 4 implicit-null-override for access-list Configures implicit-null local label for non-egress prefixes. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp-lbl)# implicit-null-override for 70 This feature works with any prefix including static, IGP, and BGP, when specified in the ACL. Note Step 5 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 53 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Setting Up Implicit-Null-Override LabelCommand or Action Purpose or ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-ldp)# commit ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Configuration Examples for Implementing MPLS LDP These configuration examples are provided to implement LDP: Configuring LDP with Graceful Restart: Example The example shows how to enable LDP with graceful restart on the POS interface 0/2/0/0. mpls ldp graceful-restart interface pos0/2/0/0 ! Configuring LDP Discovery: Example The example shows how to configure LDP discovery parameters. mpls ldp router-id loopback0 discovery hello holdtime 15 discovery hello interval 5 ! show mpls ldp parameters show mpls ldp discovery Configuring LDP Link: Example The example shows how to configure LDP link parameters. mpls ldp Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 54 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Configuration Examples for Implementing MPLS LDPinterface pos 0/1/0/0 ! ! show mpls ldp discovery Related Topics Configuring LDP Discovery Over a Link, on page 19 LDP Control Plane, on page 3 Configuring LDP Discovery for Targeted Hellos: Example The examples show how to configure LDP Discovery to accept targeted hello messages. Active (tunnel head) mpls ldp router-id loopback0 interface tunnel-te 12001 ! ! Passive (tunnel tail) mpls ldp router-id loopback0 discovery targeted-hello accept ! Related Topics Configuring LDP Discovery for Active Targeted Hellos, on page 20 Configuring LDP Discovery for Passive Targeted Hellos, on page 22 LDP Control Plane, on page 3 Configuring Label Advertisement (Outbound Filtering): Example The example shows how to configure LDP label advertisement control. mpls ldp label advertise disable for pfx_acl_1 to peer_acl_1 for pfx_acl_2 to peer_acl_2 for pfx_acl_3 interface POS 0/1/0/0 interface POS 0/2/0/0 ! ! ! ipv4 access-list pfx_acl_1 10 permit ip host 1.0.0.0 any ! Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 55 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Configuring LDP Discovery for Targeted Hellos: Exampleipv4 access-list pfx_acl_2 10 permit ip host 2.0.0.0 any ! ipv4 access-list peer_acl_1 10 permit ip host 1.1.1.1 any 20 permit ip host 1.1.1.2 any ! ipv4 access-list peer_acl_2 10 permit ip host 2.2.2.2 any ! show mpls ldp binding Related Topics Configuring Label Advertisement Control (Outbound Filtering), on page 24 Label Advertisement Control (Outbound Filtering), on page 10 Configuring LDP Neighbors: Example The example shows how to disable label advertisement. mpls ldp router-id Loopback0 neighbor 1.1.1.1 password encrypted 110A1016141E neighbor 2.2.2.2 implicit-withdraw ! Related Topics Setting Up LDP Neighbors, on page 26 Configuring LDP Forwarding: Example The example shows how to configure LDP forwarding. mpls ldp explicit-null ! show mpls ldp forwarding show mpls forwarding Related Topics Setting Up LDP Forwarding, on page 29 LDP Forwarding, on page 5 Configuring LDP Nonstop Forwarding with Graceful Restart: Example The example shows how to configure LDP nonstop forwarding with graceful restart. mpls ldp log graceful-restart Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 56 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Configuring LDP Neighbors: Example! graceful-restart graceful-restart forwarding state-holdtime 180 graceful-restart reconnect-timeout 15 interface pos0/1/0/0 ! show mpls ldp graceful-restart show mpls ldp neighbor gr show mpls ldp forwarding show mpls forwarding Related Topics Setting Up LDP NSF Using Graceful Restart, on page 31 LDP Graceful Restart, on page 6 Phases in Graceful Restart, on page 8 Recovery with Graceful-Restart, on page 9 Configuring Label Acceptance (Inbound Filtering): Example The example shows how to configure inbound label filtering. mpls ldp label accept for pfx_acl_2 from 192.168.2.2 ! ! ! Related Topics Configuring Label Acceptance Control (Inbound Filtering), on page 34 Label Acceptance Control (Inbound Filtering), on page 10 Configuring Local Label Allocation Control: Example The example shows how to configure local label allocation control. mpls ldp label allocate for pfx_acl_1 ! ! Related Topics Configuring Local Label Allocation Control, on page 36 Local Label Allocation Control, on page 11 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 57 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Configuring Label Acceptance (Inbound Filtering): ExampleConfiguring LDP Session Protection: Example The example shows how to configure session protection. mpls ldp session protection duration 60 for peer_acl_1 ! Related Topics Configuring Session Protection, on page 37 Session Protection, on page 11 Configuring LDP IGP Synchronization—OSPF: Example The example shows how to configure LDP IGP synchronization for OSPF. router ospf 100 mpls ldp sync ! mpls ldp igp sync delay 30 ! Related Topics Configuring LDP IGP Synchronization: OSPF, on page 39 IGP Synchronization, on page 12 Configuring LDP IGP Synchronization—ISIS: Example The example shows how to configure LDP IGP synchronization. router isis 100 interface POS 0/2/0/0 address-family ipv4 unicast mpls ldp sync ! ! ! mpls ldp igp sync delay 30 ! Related Topics Configuring LDP IGP Synchronization: ISIS, on page 40 IGP Synchronization, on page 12 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 58 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Configuring LDP Session Protection: ExampleConfiguring LDP Auto-Configuration: Example The example shows how to configure the IGP auto-configuration feature globally for a specific OSPF interface ID. router ospf 100 mpls ldp auto-config area 0 interface pos 1/1/1/1 The example shows how to configure the IGP auto-configuration feature on a given area for a given OSPF interface ID. router ospf 100 area 0 mpls ldp auto-config interface pos 1/1/1/1 Related Topics Enabling LDP Auto-Configuration for a Specified OSPF Instance, on page 42 Enabling LDP Auto-Configuration in an Area for a Specified OSPF Instance, on page 44 Disabling LDP Auto-Configuration, on page 46 IGP Auto-configuration, on page 13 Configure IP LDP Fast Reroute Loop Free Alternate: Example The following examples show how to configure the IP LDP FRR LFA on the router. The following example shows how to configure LFA FRR with default tie-break configuration: router isis TEST net 49.0001.0000.0000.0001.00 address-family ipv4 unicast metric-style wide interface GigabitEthernet0/6/0/13 point-to-point address-family ipv4 unicast fast-reroute per-prefix # primary path GigabitEthernet0/6/0/13 will exclude the interface # GigabitEthernet0/6/0/33 in LFA backup path computation. fast-reroute per-prefix exclude interface GigabitEthernet0/6/0/33 ! interface GigabitEthernet0/6/0/23 point-to-point address-family ipv4 unicast ! interface GigabitEthernet0/6/0/24 point-to-point address-family ipv4 unicast ! interface GigabitEthernet0/6/0/33 point-to-point address-family ipv4 unicast ! Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 59 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Configuring LDP Auto-Configuration: ExampleThe following example shows how to configure TE tunnel as LFA backup: router isis TEST net 49.0001.0000.0000.0001.00 address-family ipv4 unicast metric-style wide interface GigabitEthernet0/6/0/13 point-to-point address-family ipv4 unicast fast-reroute per-prefix # primary path GigabitEthernet0/6/0/13 will exclude the interface # GigabitEthernet0/6/0/33 in LFA backup path computation. TE tunnel 1001 # is using the link GigabitEthernet0/6/0/33. fast-reroute per-prefix exclude interface GigabitEthernet0/6/0/33 fast-reroute per-prefix lfa-candidate interface tunnel-te1001 ! interface GigabitEthernet0/6/0/33 point-to-point address-family ipv4 unicast ! The following example shows how to configure LFA FRR with configurable tie-break configuration: router isis TEST net 49.0001.0000.0000.0001.00 address-family ipv4 unicast metric-style wide fast-reroute per-prefix tiebreaker ? downstream Prefer backup path via downstream node lc-disjoint Prefer line card disjoint backup path lowest-backup-metric Prefer backup path with lowest total metric node-protecting Prefer node protecting backup path primary-path Prefer backup path from ECMP set secondary-path Prefer non-ECMP backup path fast-reroute per-prefix tiebreaker lc-disjoint index ? <1-255> Index fast-reroute per-prefix tiebreaker lc-disjoint index 10 Sample configuration: router isis TEST net 49.0001.0000.0000.0001.00 address-family ipv4 unicast metric-style wide fast-reroute per-prefix tiebreaker downstream index 60 fast-reroute per-prefix tiebreaker lc-disjoint index 10 fast-reroute per-prefix tiebreaker lowest-backup-metric index 40 fast-reroute per-prefix tiebreaker node-protecting index 30 fast-reroute per-prefix tiebreaker primary-path index 20 fast-reroute per-prefix tiebreaker secondary-path index 50 ! interface GigabitEthernet0/6/0/13 point-to-point address-family ipv4 unicast fast-reroute per-prefix ! interface GigabitEthernet0/1/0/13 point-to-point address-family ipv4 unicast fast-reroute per-prefix ! interface GigabitEthernet0/3/0/0.1 point-to-point address-family ipv4 unicast ! interface GigabitEthernet0/3/0/0.2 point-to-point address-family ipv4 unicast Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 60 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Configure IP LDP Fast Reroute Loop Free Alternate: ExampleRelated Topics IP LDP Fast Reroute Loop Free Alternate, on page 14 Verify IP LDP Fast Reroute Loop Free Alternate: Example The following examples show how to verify the IP LDP FRR LFA feature on the router. The following example shows how to verify ISIS FRR output: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router#show isis fast-reroute summary IS-IS 1 IPv4 Unicast FRR summary Critical High Medium Low Total Priority Priority Priority Priority Prefixes reachable in L1 All paths protected 0 0 4 1008 1012 Some paths protected 0 0 0 0 0 Unprotected 0 0 0 0 0 Protection coverage 0.00% 0.00% 100.00% 100.00% 100.00% Prefixes reachable in L2 All paths protected 0 0 1 0 1 Some paths protected 0 0 0 0 0 Unprotected 0 0 0 0 0 Protection coverage 0.00% 0.00% 100.00% 0.00% 100.00% The following example shows how to verify the IGP route 211.1.1.1/24 in ISIS Fast Reroute output: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router#show isis fast-reroute 211.1.1.1/24 L1 211.1.1.1/24 [40/115] via 12.0.0.2, GigabitEthernet0/6/0/13, NORTH FRR backup via 14.0.2.2, GigabitEthernet0/6/0/0.3, SOUTH RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router#show isis fast-reroute 211.1.1.1/24 detail L1 211.1.1.1/24 [40/115] low priority via 12.0.0.2, GigabitEthernet0/6/0/13, NORTH FRR backup via 14.0.2.2, GigabitEthernet0/6/0/0.3, SOUTH P: No, TM: 130, LC: No, NP: Yes, D: Yes src sr1.00-00, 173.1.1.2 L2 adv [40] native, propagated The following example shows how to verify the IGP route 211.1.1.1/24 in RIB output: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router#show route 211.1.1.1/24 Routing entry for 211.1.1.0/24 Known via "isis 1", distance 115, metric 40, type level-1 Installed Nov 27 10:22:20.311 for 1d08h Routing Descriptor Blocks 12.0.0.2, from 173.1.1.2, via GigabitEthernet0/6/0/13, Protected Route metric is 40 14.0.2.2, from 173.1.1.2, via GigabitEthernet0/6/0/0.3, Backup Route metric is 0 No advertising protos. The following example shows how to verify the IGP route 211.1.1.1/24 in FIB output: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router#show cef 211.1.1.1/24 211.1.1.0/24, version 0, internal 0x40040001 (ptr 0x9d9e1a68) [1], 0x0 \ (0x9ce0ec40), 0x4500 (0x9e2c69e4) Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 61 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Verify IP LDP Fast Reroute Loop Free Alternate: ExampleUpdated Nov 27 10:22:29.825 remote adjacency to GigabitEthernet0/6/0/13 Prefix Len 24, traffic index 0, precedence routine (0) via 12.0.0.2, GigabitEthernet0/6/0/13, 0 dependencies, weight 0, class 0, \ protected [flags 0x400] path-idx 0, bkup-idx 1 [0x9e5b71b4 0x0] next hop 12.0.0.2 local label 16080 labels imposed {16082} via 14.0.2.2, GigabitEthernet0/6/0/0.3, 3 dependencies, weight 0, class 0, \ backup [flags 0x300] path-idx 1 next hop 14.0.2.2 remote adjacency local label 16080 labels imposed {16079} RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router#show cef 211.1.1.1/24 detail 211.1.1.0/24, version 0, internal 0x40040001 (ptr 0x9d9e1a68) [1], 0x0 \ (0x9ce0ec40), 0x4500 (0x9e2c69e4) Updated Nov 27 10:22:29.825 remote adjacency to GigabitEthernet0/6/0/13 Prefix Len 24, traffic index 0, precedence routine (0) gateway array (0x9cc622f0) reference count 1158, flags 0x28000d00, source lsd \ (2), [387 type 5 flags 0x101001 (0x9df32398) ext 0x0 (0x0)] LW-LDI[type=5, refc=3, ptr=0x9ce0ec40, sh-ldi=0x9df32398] via 12.0.0.2, GigabitEthernet0/6/0/13, 0 dependencies, weight 0, class 0, \ protected [flags 0x400] path-idx 0, bkup-idx 1 [0x9e5b71b4 0x0] next hop 12.0.0.2 local label 16080 labels imposed {16082} via 14.0.2.2, GigabitEthernet0/6/0/0.3, 3 dependencies, weight 0, class 0, \ backup [flags 0x300] path-idx 1 next hop 14.0.2.2 remote adjacency local label 16080 labels imposed {16079} Load distribution: 0 (refcount 387) Hash OK Interface Address 0 Y GigabitEthernet0/6/0/13 remote The following example shows how to verify the IGP route 211.1.1.1/24 in MPLS LDP output: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router#show mpls ldp forwarding 211.1.1.1/24 Prefix Label Label Outgoing Next Hop GR Stale In Out Interface ---------------- ------- ---------- ------------ ------------------- -- ----- 211.1.1.0/24 16080 16082 Gi0/6/0/13 12.0.0.2 Y N 16079 Gi0/6/0/0.3 14.0.2.2 (!) Y N RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router#show mpls ldp forwarding 211.1.1.1/24 detail Prefix Label Label Outgoing Next Hop GR Stale In Out Interface ---------------- ------- ---------- ------------ ------------------- -- ----- 211.1.1.0/24 16080 16082 Gi0/6/0/13 12.0.0.2 Y N [ Protected; path-id 1 backup-path-id 33; peer 20.20.20.20:0 ] 16079 Gi0/6/0/0.3 14.0.2.2 (!) Y N [ Backup; path-id 33; peer 40.40.40.40:0 ] Routing update : Nov 27 10:22:19.560 (1d08h ago) Forwarding update: Nov 27 10:22:29.060 (1d08h ago) Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 62 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Verify IP LDP Fast Reroute Loop Free Alternate: ExampleRelated Topics IP LDP Fast Reroute Loop Free Alternate, on page 14 Additional References For additional information related to Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol, refer to the following references: Related Documents Related Topic Document Title MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Commands on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module in the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Command Reference LDP commands on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Getting Started Guide Getting started material Standards Standards Title No new or modified standards are supported by this — feature, and support for existing standards has not been modified by this feature. MIBs MIBs MIBs Link To locate and download MIBs using Cisco IOS XR software, use the Cisco MIB Locator found at the following URL and choose a platform under the Cisco Access Products menu: http://cisco.com/public/ sw-center/netmgmt/cmtk/mibs.shtml — RFCs RFCs Title RFC 3031 Multiprotocol Label Switching Architecture RFC 3036 LDP Specification Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 63 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Additional ReferencesRFCs Title RFC 3037 LDP Applicability Graceful Restart Mechanism for Label Distribution Protocol RFC 3478 RFC 3815 Definitions of Managed Objects for MPLS LDP Label Distribution and Management Downstream on Demand Label Advertisement RFC 5036 Basic Specification for IP Fast Reroute: Loop-Free Alternates RFC 5286 Technical Assistance Description Link The Cisco Technical Support website contains http://www.cisco.com/techsupport thousands of pages of searchable technical content, including links to products, technologies, solutions, technical tips, and tools. Registered Cisco.com users can log in from this page to access even more content. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 64 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Label Distribution Protocol Additional ReferencesC H A P T E R 2 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE This module describes how to implement Resource Reservation Protocol (RSVP) for MPLS Traffic Engineering (MPLS-TE) on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Routers. The Multiprotocol Label Switching (MPLS) is a standards-based solution, driven by the Internet Engineering Task Force (IETF), devised to convert the Internet and IP backbones from best-effort networks into business-class transport media. Resource Reservation Protocol (RSVP) is a signaling protocol that enables systems to request resource reservations from the network. RSVP processes protocol messages from other systems, processes resource requests from local clients, and generates protocol messages. As a result, resources are reserved for data flows on behalf of local and remote clients. RSVP creates, maintains, and deletes these resource reservations. RSVP provides a secure method to control quality-of-service (QoS) access to a network. MPLS Traffic Engineering (MPLS-TE) uses RSVP to signal label switched paths (LSPs). Feature History for Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Release Modification Release 3.7.2 This feature was introduced. Release 3.9.0 The RSVP MIB feature was added. • Prerequisites for Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE , page 66 • Information About Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE , page 66 • Information About Implementing RSVP Authentication, page 71 • How to Implement RSVP, page 75 • How to Implement RSVP Authentication, page 88 • Configuration Examples for RSVP, page 104 • Configuration Examples for RSVP Authentication, page 108 • Additional References, page 110 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 65Prerequisites for Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE These prerequisites are required to implement RSVP for MPLS-TE : • You must be in a user group associated with a task group that includesthe proper task IDs. The command reference guides include the task IDs required for each command. If you suspect user group assignment is preventing you from using a command, contact your AAA administrator for assistance. • Either a composite mini-image plus an MPLS package, or a full image, must be installed. Information About Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE To implement MPLS RSVP, you must understand the these concepts: Related Topics How to Implement RSVP Authentication, on page 88 Overview of RSVP for MPLS-TE RSVP is a network control protocol that enables Internet applications to signal LSPs for MPLS-TE . The RSVP implementation is compliant with the IETF RFC 2205, and RFC 3209. RSVP is automatically enabled on interfaces on which MPLS-TE is configured. For MPLS-TE LSPs with nonzero bandwidth, the RSVP bandwidth has to be configured on the interfaces. There is no need to configure RSVP, if all MPLS-TE LSPs have zero bandwidth . RSVP Refresh Reduction, defined in RFC 2961, includes support for reliable messages and summary refresh messages. Reliable messages are retransmitted rapidly if the message is lost. Because each summary refresh message contains information to refresh multiple states, this greatly reduces the amount of messaging needed to refresh states. For refresh reduction to be used between two routers, it must be enabled on both routers. Refresh Reduction is enabled by default. Message rate limiting for RSVP allows you to set a maximum threshold on the rate at which RSVP messages are sent on an interface. Message rate limiting is disabled by default. The process that implements RSVP is restartable. A software upgrade, process placement or process failure of RSVP or any of its collaborators, has been designed to ensure Nonstop Forwarding (NSF) of the data plane. RSVP supports graceful restart, which is compliant with RFC 3473. It follows the procedures that apply when the node reestablishes communication with the neighbor’s control plane within a configured restart time. It is important to note that RSVP is not a routing protocol. RSVP works in conjunction with routing protocols and installs the equivalent of dynamic access lists along the routes that routing protocols calculate. Because of this, implementing RSVP in an existing network does not require migration to a new routing protocol. Related Topics Configuring RSVP Packet Dropping, on page 81 Set DSCP for RSVP Packets: Example, on page 107 Verifying RSVP Configuration, on page 83 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 66 OL-26056-02 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Prerequisites for Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TELSP Setup LSP setup is initiated when the LSP head node sends path messages to the tail node (see the RSVP Operation figure ). Figure 7: RSVP Operation The Path messagesreserve resources along the path to each node, creating Path softstates on each node.When the tail node receives a path message, it sends a reservation (RESV) message with a label back to the previous node. When the reservation message arrives at the previous node, it causes the reserved resources to be locked and forwarding entries are programmed with the MPLS label sent from the tail-end node. A new MPLS label is allocated and sent to the next node upstream. When the reservation message reaches the head node, the label is programmed and the MPLS data starts to flow along the path. High Availability RSVP is designed to ensure nonstop forwarding under the following constraints: • Ability to tolerate the failure of one RP of a 1:1 redundant pair. • Hitless software upgrade. The RSVP high availability (HA) design followsthe constraints of the underlying architecture where processes can fail without affecting the operation of other processes. A processfailure of RSVP or any of its collaborators does not cause any traffic loss or cause established LSPs to go down. When RSVP restarts, it recovers its signaling states from its neighbors. No special configuration or manual intervention are required. You may configure RSVP graceful restart, which offers a standard mechanism to recover RSVP state information from neighbors after a failure. Graceful Restart RSVP graceful restart provides a control plane mechanism to ensure high availability (HA), which allows detection and recovery from failure conditions while preserving nonstop forwarding services on the systems running Cisco IOS XR software. RSVP graceful restart provides a mechanism that minimizes the negative effects on MPLS traffic caused by these types of faults: • Disruption of communication channels between two nodes when the communication channels are separate from the data channels. This is called control channel failure. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 67 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE LSP Setup• Control plane of a node fails but the node preservesits data forwarding states. Thisis called node failure. The procedure for RSVP graceful restart is described in the “Fault Handling” section of RFC 3473, Generalized MPLS Signaling, RSVP-TE Extensions. One of the main advantages of using RSVP graceful restart isrecovery of the control plane while preserving nonstop forwarding and existing labels. Graceful Restart: Standard and Interface-Based When you configure RSVP graceful restart, Cisco IOS XR software sends and expects node-id address based Hello messages (that is, Hello Request and Hello Ack messages). The RSVP graceful restart Hello session is not established if the neighbor router does not respond with a node-id based Hello Ack message. You can also configure graceful restart to respond (send Hello Ack messages) to interface-address based Hello messages sent from a neighbor router in order to establish a graceful restart Hello session on the neighbor router. If the neighbor router does not respond with node-id based Hello Ack message, however, the RSVP graceful restart Hello session is not established. Cisco IOS XR software provides two commands to configure graceful restart: • signalling hello graceful-restart • signalling hello graceful-restart interface-based By default, graceful restart is disabled. To enable interface-based graceful restart, you must first enable standard graceful restart. You cannot enable interface-based graceful restart independently. Note Related Topics Enabling Graceful Restart, on page 78 Enable Graceful Restart: Example, on page 106 Enable Interface-Based Graceful Restart: Example, on page 106 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 68 OL-26056-02 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Graceful RestartGraceful Restart: Figure This figure illustrates how RSVP graceful restart handles a node failure condition. Figure 8: Node Failure with RSVP RSVP graceful restart requires the use of RSVP hello messages. Hello messages are used between RSVP neighbors. Each neighbor can autonomously issue a hello message containing a hello request object. A receiver that supports the hello extension replies with a hello message containing a hello acknowledgment (ACK) object. This means that a hello message contains either a hello Request or a hello ACK object. These two objects have the same format. The restart cap object indicates a node’s restart capabilities. It is carried in hello messages if the sending node supports state recovery. The restart cap object has the following two fields: Restart Time Time after a lossin Hello messages within which RSVP hello session can be reestablished. It is possible for a user to manually configure the Restart Time. Recovery Time Time that the sender waits for the recipient to re-synchronize states after the re-establishment of hello messages. This value is computed and advertised based on number of states that existed before the fault occurred. For graceful restart, the hello messages are sent with an IP Time to Live (TTL) of 64. This is because the destination of the hello messages can be multiple hops away. If graceful restart is enabled, hello messages (containing the restart cap object) are send to an RSVP neighbor when RSVP states are shared with that neighbor. Restart cap objects are sent to an RSVP neighbor when RSVP states are shared with that neighbor. If the neighbor replies with hello messages containing the restart cap object, the neighbor is considered to be graceful restart capable. If the neighbor does not reply with hello messages or replies with hello messages that do not Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 69 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Graceful Restartcontain the restart cap object, RSVP backs off sending hellos to that neighbor. If graceful restart is disabled, no hello messages (Requests or ACKs) are sent. If a hello Request message is received from an unknown neighbor, no hello ACK is sent back. ACL-based Prefix Filtering RSVP provides for the configuration of extended access lists (ACLs) to forward, drop, or perform normal processing on RSVP router-alert (RA) packets. Prefix filtering is designed for use at core access routers in order that RA packets (identified by a source/destination address) can be seamlessly forwarded across the core from one access point to another (or, conversely to be dropped at this node). RSVP applies prefix filtering rules only to RA packets because RA packets contain source and destination addresses of the RSVP flow. RA packets forwarded due to prefix filtering must not be sent as RSVP bundle messages, because bundle messages are hop-by-hop and do not contain RA. Forwarding a Bundle message does not work, because the node receiving the messages is expected to apply prefix filtering rules only to RA packets. Note For each incoming RSVP RA packet, RSVP inspectsthe IP header and attemptsto match the source/destination IP addresses with a prefix configured in an extended ACL. The results are as follows: • If an ACL does not exist, the packet is processed like a normal RSVP packet. • If the ACL match yields an explicit permit (and if the packet is not locally destined), the packet is forwarded. The IP TTL is decremented on all forwarded packets. • If the ACL match yields an explicit deny, the packet is dropped. If there is no explicit permit or explicit deny, the ACL infrastructure returns an implicit (default) deny. RSVP can be configured to drop the packet. By default, RSVP processes the packet if the ACL match yields an implicit (default) deny. Related Topics Configuring ACLs for Prefix Filtering, on page 80 Configure ACL-based Prefix Filtering: Example, on page 107 RSVP MIB RFC 2206, RSVP Management Information Base Using SMIv2 defines all the SNMP MIB objects that are relevant to RSVP. By implementing the RSVP MIB, you can perform these functions: • Specifies two traps (NetFlow and LostFlow) which are triggered when a new flow is created or deleted. • Lets you use SNMP to access objects belonging to RSVP. Related Topics Enabling RSVP Traps, on page 86 Enable RSVP Traps: Example, on page 108 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 70 OL-26056-02 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE ACL-based Prefix FilteringInformation About Implementing RSVP Authentication Before implementing RSVP authentication, you must configure a keychain first. The name of the keychain must be the same as the one used in the keychain configuration. For more information about configuring keychains, see Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Security Configuration Guide . Note RSVP authentication supports only keyed-hash message authentication code (HMAC) type algorithms. To implement RSVP authentication on Cisco IOS XR software, you must understand the following concepts: RSVP Authentication Functions You can carry out these tasks with RSVP authentication: • Set up a secure relationship with a neighbor by using secret keys that are known only to you and the neighbor. • Configure RSVP authentication in global, interface, or neighbor configuration modes. • Authenticate incoming messages by checking if there is a valid security relationship that is associated based on key identifier, incoming interface, sender address, and destination address. • Add an integrity object with message digest to the outgoing message. • Use sequence numbers in an integrity object to detect replay attacks. RSVP Authentication Design Network administrators need the ability to establish a security domain to control the set ofsystemsthat initiates RSVP requests. The RSVP authentication feature permits neighborsin an RSVP network to use a secure hash to sign all RSVP signaling messages digitally, thus allowing the receiver of an RSVP message to verify the sender of the message without relying solely on the sender's IP address. The signature is accomplished on a per-RSVP-hop basis with an RSVP integrity object in the RSVP message as defined in RFC 2747. This method provides protection against forgery or message modification. However, the receiver must know the security key used by the sender to validate the digital signature in the received RSVP message. Network administrators manually configure a common key for each RSVP neighbor on the shared network. The following reasons explain how to choose between global, interface, or neighbor configuration modes: • Global configuration mode is optimal when a router belongs to a single security domain (for example, part of a set of provider core routers). A single common key set is expected to be used to authenticate all RSVP messages. • Interface, or neighbor configuration mode, is optimal when a router belongs to more than one security domain. For example, a provider router is adjacent to the provider edge (PE), or a PE is adjacent to an edge device. Different keys can be used but not shared. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 71 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Information About Implementing RSVP AuthenticationGlobal configuration mode configures the defaults for interface and neighbor interface modes. These modes, unless explicitly configured, inherit the parameters from global configuration mode, as follows: • Window-size is set to 1. • Lifetime is set to 1800. • key-source key-chain command is set to none or disabled. Related Topics Configuring a Lifetime for an Interface for RSVP Authentication, on page 95 RSVP Authentication by Using All the Modes: Example, on page 110 Global, Interface, and Neighbor Authentication Modes You can configure global defaults for all authentication parameters including key, window size, and lifetime. These defaults are inherited when you configure authentication for each neighbor or interface. However, you can also configure these parameters individually on a neighbor or interface basis, in which case the global values (configured or default) are no longer inherited. RSVP uses the following rules when choosing which authentication parameter to use when that parameter is configured at multiple levels (interface, neighbor, or global). RSVP goes from the most specific to least specific; that is, neighbor, interface, and global. Note Global keys simplify the configuration and eliminate the chances of a key mismatch when receiving messages from multiple neighbors and multiple interfaces. However, global keys do not provide the best security. Interface keys are used to secure specific interfaces between two RSVP neighbors. Because many of the RSVP messages are IP routed, there are many scenarios in which using interface keys are not recommended. If all keys on the interfaces are not the same, there is a risk of a key mismatch for the following reasons: • When the RSVP graceful restart is enabled, RSVP hello messages are sent with a source IP address of the local router ID and a destination IP address of the neighbor router ID. Because multiple routes can exist between the two neighbors, the RSVP hello message can traverse to different interfaces. • When the RSVP fast reroute (FRR) is active, the RSVP Path and Resv messages can traverse multiple interfaces. • When Generalized Multiprotocol Label Switching (GMPLS) optical tunnels are configured, RSVP messages are exchanged with router IDs as the source and destination IP addresses. Since multiple control channels can exist between the two neighbors, the RSVP messages can traverse different interfaces. Neighbor-based keys are particularly useful in a network in which some neighborssupport RSVP authentication procedures and others do not. When the neighbor-based keys are configured for a particular neighbor, you are advised to configure all the neighbor’s addresses and router IDs for RSVP authentication. Related Topics Configuring a Lifetime for RSVP Authentication in Global Configuration Mode, on page 90 RSVP Authentication Global Configuration Mode: Example, on page 108 Specifying the RSVP Authentication Keychain in Interface Mode, on page 93 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 72 OL-26056-02 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Global, Interface, and Neighbor Authentication ModesRSVP Authentication by Using All the Modes: Example, on page 110 Security Association A security association (SA) is defined as a collection of information that is required to maintain secure communications with a peer to counter replay attacks, spoofing, and packet corruption. This table lists the main parameters that define a security association. Table 2: Security Association Main Parameters Parameter Description src IP address of the sender. dst IP address of the final destination. interface Interface of the SA. direction Send or receive type of the SA. Expiration timer value that is used to collect unused security association data. Lifetime Lastsequence number that was eithersent or accepted (dependent of the direction type). Sequence Number key-source Source of keys for the configurable parameter. Key number (returned form the key-source) that was last used. keyID digest Algorithm last used (returned from the key-source). Specifiesthe tolerance for the configurable parameter. The parameter is applicable when the direction parameter is the receive type. Window Size Specifiesthe last window size value sequence number that is received or accepted. The parameter is applicable when the direction parameter isthe receive type. Window An SA is created dynamically when sending and receiving messagesthat require authentication. The neighbor, source, and destination addresses are obtained either from the IP header or from an RSVP object, such as a HOP object, and whether the message is incoming or outgoing. When the SA is created, an expiration timer is created. When the SA authenticates a message, it is marked as recently used. The lifetime timer periodically checks if the SA is being used. If so, the flag is cleared and is cleaned up for the next period unless it is marked again. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 73 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Security AssociationThis table shows how to locate the source and destination address keys for an SA that is based on the message type. Table 3: Source and Destination Address Locations for Different Message Types Message Type Source Address Location Destination Address Location Path HOP object SESSION object PathTear HOP object SESSION object PathError HOP object IP header Resv HOP object IP header ResvTear HOP object IP header ResvError HOP object IP header ResvConfirm IP header CONFIRM object Ack IP header IP header Srefresh IP header IP header Hello IP header IP header Bundle — — Related Topics Specifying the Keychain for RSVP Neighbor Authentication, on page 98 RSVP Neighbor Authentication: Example, on page 109 Configuring a Lifetime for RSVP Neighbor Authentication, on page 100 RSVP Authentication Global Configuration Mode: Example, on page 108 Key-source Key-chain The key-source key-chain is used to specify which keys to use. You configure a list of keys with specific IDs and have different lifetimes so that keys are changed at predetermined intervals automatically, without any disruption of service. Rollover enhances network security by minimizing the problems that could result if an untrusted source obtained, deduced, or guessed the current key. RSVP handles rollover by using the following key ID types: • On TX, use the youngest eligible key ID. • On RX, use the key ID that is received in an integrity object. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 74 OL-26056-02 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Key-source Key-chainFor more information about implementing keychain management,see Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router System Security Configuration Guide Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router . Related Topics Enabling RSVP Authentication Using the Keychain in Global Configuration Mode, on page 88 RSVP Authentication Global Configuration Mode: Example, on page 108 Specifying the Keychain for RSVP Neighbor Authentication, on page 98 RSVP Neighbor Authentication: Example, on page 109 Guidelines for Window-Size and Out-of-Sequence Messages These guidelines are required for window-size and out-of-sequence messages: • Default window-size is set to 1. If a single message is received out-of-sequence, RSVP rejects it and displays a message. • When RSVP messages are sent in burst mode (for example, tunnel optimization), some messages can become out-of-sequence for a short amount of time. • Window size can be increased by using the window-size command. When the window size is increased, replay attacks can be detected with duplicate sequence numbers. Related Topics Configuring the Window Size for RSVP Authentication in Global Configuration Mode, on page 91 Configuring the Window Size for an Interface for RSVP Authentication, on page 96 Configuring the Window Size for RSVP Neighbor Authentication, on page 102 RSVP Authentication by Using All the Modes: Example, on page 110 RSVP Authentication for an Interface: Example, on page 109 Caveats for Out-of-Sequence These caveats are listed for out-of-sequence: • When RSVP messages traverse multiple interface types with different maximum transmission unit (MTU) values, some messages can become out-of-sequence if they are fragmented. • Packets with some IP options may be reordered. • Change in QoS configurations may lead to a transient reorder of packets. • QoS policies can cause a reorder of packets in a steady state. Because all out-of-sequence messages are dropped, the sender must retransmit them. Because RSVP state timeouts are generally long, out-of-sequence messages during a transient state do not lead to a state timeout. How to Implement RSVP RSVP requires coordination among several routers, establishing exchange of RSVP messages to set up LSPs. Depending on the client application, RSVP requires some basic configuration, as described in these topics: Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 75 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Guidelines for Window-Size and Out-of-Sequence MessagesConfiguring Traffic Engineering Tunnel Bandwidth To configure traffic engineering tunnel bandwidth, you must firstset up TE tunnels and configure the reserved bandwidth per interface (there is no need to configure bandwidth for the data channel or the control channel). Cisco IOS XR software supports two MPLS DS-TE modes: Prestandard and IETF. For prestandard DS-TE you do not need to configure bandwidth for the data channel or the control channel. There is no other specific RSVP configuration required for this application. When no RSVP bandwidth is specified for a particular interface, you can specify zero bandwidth in the LSP setup if it is configured under RSVP interface configuration mode or MPLS-TE configuration mode. Note Related Topics Configuring a Prestandard DS-TE Tunnel, on page 176 Configuring an IETF DS-TE Tunnel Using RDM, on page 178 Configuring an IETF DS-TE Tunnel Using MAM, on page 181 Confirming DiffServ-TE Bandwidth Perform this task to confirm DiffServ-TE bandwidth. In RSVP global and subpools, reservable bandwidths are configured per interface to accommodate TE tunnels on the node. Available bandwidth from all configured bandwidth pools is advertised using IGP. RSVP signals the TE tunnel with appropriate bandwidth pool requirements. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. rsvp 3. interface type interface-path-id 4. bandwidth total-bandwidth max-flow sub-pool sub-pool-bw 5. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 76 OL-26056-02 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Configuring Traffic Engineering Tunnel BandwidthDETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 rsvp Enters RSVP configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# rsvp Step 2 interface type interface-path-id Enters interface configuration mode for the RSVP protocol. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp)# Step 3 interface pos 0/2/0/0 Sets the reservable bandwidth, the maximum RSVP bandwidth available for a flow and the sub-pool bandwidth on this interface. bandwidth total-bandwidth max-flow sub-pool sub-pool-bw Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-if)# Step 4 bandwidth 1000 100 sub-pool 150 Step 5 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-if)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and or returns the router to EXEC mode. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-if)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 77 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Confirming DiffServ-TE BandwidthCommand or Action Purpose • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Related Topics Differentiated Services Traffic Engineering, on page 127 Bandwidth Configuration (MAM): Example, on page 104 Bandwidth Configuration (RDM): Example, on page 105 Enabling Graceful Restart Perform this task to enable graceful restart for implementations using both node-id and interface-based hellos. RSVP graceful restart provides a control plane mechanism to ensure high availability, which allows detection and recovery from failure conditions while preserving nonstop forwarding services. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. rsvp 3. signalling graceful-restart 4. signalling graceful-restart interface-based 5. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router:router# configure Step 1 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 78 OL-26056-02 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Enabling Graceful RestartCommand or Action Purpose rsvp Enters the RSVP configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# rsvp Step 2 signalling graceful-restart Enables the graceful restart process on the node. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp)# Step 3 signalling graceful-restart signalling graceful-restart interface-based Enables interface-based graceful restart process on the node. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp)# Step 4 signalling graceful-restart interface-based Step 5 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Related Topics Graceful Restart: Standard and Interface-Based, on page 68 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 79 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Enabling Graceful RestartEnable Graceful Restart: Example, on page 106 Enable Interface-Based Graceful Restart: Example, on page 106 Configuring ACL-based Prefix Filtering Two procedures are provided to show how RSVP Prefix Filtering is associated: • Configuring ACLs for Prefix Filtering, on page 80 • Configuring RSVP Packet Dropping, on page 81 Configuring ACLs for Prefix Filtering Perform this task to configure an extended access list ACL that identifies the source and destination prefixes used for packet filtering. Note The extended ACL needs to be configured separately using extended ACL configuration commands. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. rsvp 3. signalling prefix-filtering access-list 4. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 rsvp Enters the RSVP configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# rsvp Step 2 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 80 OL-26056-02 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Configuring ACL-based Prefix FilteringCommand or Action Purpose signalling prefix-filtering access-list Enter an extended access list name as a string. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp)# Step 3 signalling prefix-filtering access-list banks Step 4 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exitsthe configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Related Topics ACL-based Prefix Filtering, on page 70 Configure ACL-based Prefix Filtering: Example, on page 107 Configuring RSVP Packet Dropping Perform this task to configure RSVP to drop RA packets when the ACL match returns an implicit (default) deny. The default behavior performs normal RSVP processing on RA packets when the ACL match returns an implicit (default) deny. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 81 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Configuring ACL-based Prefix FilteringSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. rsvp 3. signalling prefix-filtering default-deny-action 4. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 rsvp Enters the RSVP configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# rsvp Step 2 signalling prefix-filtering default-deny-action Drops RA messages. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp)# Step 3 signalling prefix-filtering default-deny-action Step 4 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exitsthe configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 82 OL-26056-02 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Configuring ACL-based Prefix FilteringCommand or Action Purpose ? Entering cancel leavesthe router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Related Topics Overview of RSVP for MPLS-TE , on page 66 Set DSCP for RSVP Packets: Example, on page 107 Verifying RSVP Configuration This figure illustrates the topology. Figure 9: Sample Topology Perform the following steps to verify RSVP configuration. SUMMARY STEPS 1. show rsvp session 2. show rsvp counters messages summary 3. show rsvp counters events 4. show rsvp interface type interface-path-id [detail] 5. show rsvp graceful-restart 6. show rsvp graceful-restart [neighbors ip-address | detail] 7. show rsvp interface 8. show rsvp neighbor DETAILED STEPS Step 1 show rsvp session Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 83 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Verifying RSVP ConfigurationVerifiesthat all routers on the path of the LSP are configured with at least one Path State Block (PSB) and one Reservation State Block (RSB) per session. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show rsvp session Type Destination Add DPort Proto/ExtTunID PSBs RSBs Reqs ---- --------------- ----- --------------- ----- ----- ----- LSP4 172.16.70.70 6 10.51.51.51 1 1 0 In the example , the output represents an LSP from ingress (head) router 10.51.51.51 to egress (tail) router 172.16.70.70. The tunnel ID (also called the destination port) is 6. Example: If no states can be found for a session that should be up, verify the application (for example, MPLS-TE ) to see if everything is in order. If a session has one PSB but no RSB, this indicates that either the Path message is not making it to the egress (tail) router or the reservation message is not making it back to the router R1 in question. Go to the downstream router R2 and display the session information: Example: If R2 has no PSB, either the path message is not making it to the router or the path message is being rejected (for example, due to lack of resources). If R2 has a PSB but no RSB, go to the next downstream router R3 to investigate. If R2 has a PSB and an RSB, this means the reservation is not making it from R2 to R1 or is being rejected. Step 2 show rsvp counters messages summary Verifies whether the RSVP message is being transmitted and received. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show rsvp counters messages summary All RSVP Interfaces Recv Xmit Recv Xmit Path 0 25 Resv 30 0 PathError 0 0 ResvError 0 1 PathTear 0 30 ResvTear 12 0 ResvConfirm 0 0 Ack 24 37 Bundle 0 Hello 0 5099 SRefresh 8974 9012 OutOfOrder 0 Retransmit 20 Rate Limited 0 Step 3 show rsvp counters events Verifies how many RSVP states have expired. Because RSVP uses a soft-state mechanism, some failures will lead to RSVP states to expire due to lack of refresh from the neighbor. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show rsvp counters events mgmtEthernet0/0/0/0 tunnel6 Expired Path states 0 Expired Path states 0 Expired Resv states 0 Expired Resv states 0 NACKs received 0 NACKs received 0 POS0/3/0/0 POS0/3/0/1 Expired Path states 0 Expired Path states 0 Expired Resv states 0 Expired Resv states 0 NACKs received 0 NACKs received 0 POS0/3/0/2 POS0/3/0/3 Expired Path states 0 Expired Path Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 84 OL-26056-02 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Verifying RSVP Configurationstates 0 Expired Resv states 0 Expired Resv states 1 NACKs received 0 NACKs received 1 Step 4 show rsvp interface type interface-path-id [detail] Verifies that refresh reduction is working on a particular interface. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show rsvp interface pos0/3/0/3 detail INTERFACE: POS0/3/0/3 (ifh=0x4000D00). BW (bits/sec): Max=1000M. MaxFlow=1000M. Allocated=1K (0%). MaxSub=0. Signalling: No DSCP marking. No rate limiting. States in: 1. Max missed msgs: 4. Expiry timer: Running (every 30s). Refresh interval: 45s. Normal Refresh timer: Not running. Summary refresh timer: Running. Refresh reduction local: Enabled. Summary Refresh: Enabled (4096 bytes max). Reliable summary refresh: Disabled. Ack hold: 400 ms, Ack max size: 4096 bytes. Retransmit: 900ms. Neighbor information: Neighbor-IP Nbor-MsgIds States-out Refresh-Reduction Expiry(min::sec) -------------- -------------- ---------- ------------------ ---------------- 64.64.64.65 1 1 Enabled 14::45 Step 5 show rsvp graceful-restart Verifies that graceful restart is enabled locally. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show rsvp graceful-restart Graceful restart: enabled Number of global neighbors: 1 Local MPLS router id: 10.51.51.51 Restart time: 60 seconds Recovery time: 0 seconds Recovery timer: Not running Hello interval: 5000 milliseconds Maximum Hello miss-count: 3 Step 6 show rsvp graceful-restart [neighbors ip-address | detail] Verifies that graceful restart is enabled on the neighbor(s). These examples show that neighbor 192.168.60.60 is not responding to hello messages. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show rsvp graceful-restart neighbors 192.168.60.60 Neighbor App State Recovery Reason Since LostCnt --------------- ----- ------ -------- ------------ -------------------- -------- 192.168.60.60 MPLS INIT DONE N/A 12/06/2003 19:01:49 0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show rsvp graceful-restart neighbors detail Neighbor: 192.168.60.60 Source: 10.51.51.51 (MPLS) Hello instance for application MPLS Hello State: INIT (for 3d23h) Number of times communications with neighbor lost: 0 Reason: N/A Recovery State: DONE Number of Interface neighbors: 1 address: 10.64.64.65 Restart time: 0 seconds Recovery time: 0 seconds Restart timer: Not running Recovery timer: Not running Hello interval: 5000 milliseconds Maximum allowed missed Hello messages: 3 Step 7 show rsvp interface Verifies the available RSVP bandwidth. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 85 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Verifying RSVP ConfigurationExample: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show rsvp interface Interface MaxBW MaxFlow Allocated MaxSub ----------- -------- -------- --------------- -------- Et0/0/0/0 0 0 0 ( 0%) 0 PO0/3/0/0 1000M 1000M 0 ( 0%) 0 PO0/3/0/1 1000M 1000M 0 ( 0%) 0 PO0/3/0/2 1000M 1000M 0 ( 0%) 0 PO0/3/0/3 1000M 1000M 1K ( 0%) 0 Step 8 show rsvp neighbor Verifies the RSVP neighbors. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show rsvp neighbor detail Global Neighbor: 40.40.40.40 Interface Neighbor: 1.1.1.1 Interface: POS0/0/0/0 Refresh Reduction: "Enabled" or "Disabled". Remote epoch: 0xXXXXXXXX Out of order messages: 0 Retransmitted messages: 0 Interface Neighbor: 2.2.2.2 Interface: POS0/1/0/0 Refresh Reduction: "Enabled" or "Disabled". Remote epoch: 0xXXXXXXXX Out of order messages: 0 Retransmitted messages: 0 Related Topics Overview of RSVP for MPLS-TE , on page 66 Enabling RSVP Traps With the exception of the RSVP MIB traps, no action is required to activate the MIBs. This MIB feature is automatically enabled when RSVP is turned on; however, RSVP traps must be enabled. Perform this task to enable all RSVP MIB traps, NewFlow traps, and LostFlow traps. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. snmp-server traps rsvp lost-flow 3. snmp-server traps rsvp new-flow 4. snmp-server traps rsvp all 5. Use one of these commands: • end • commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 86 OL-26056-02 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Enabling RSVP TrapsDETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 snmp-server traps rsvp lost-flow Sends RSVP notifications to enable RSVP LostFlow traps. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# snmp-server Step 2 traps rsvp lost-flow snmp-server traps rsvp new-flow Sends RSVP notifications to enable RSVP NewFlow traps. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# snmp-server Step 3 traps rsvp new-flow snmp-server traps rsvp all Sends RSVP notifications to enable all RSVP MIB traps. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# snmp-server Step 4 traps rsvp all Step 5 Use one of these commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 87 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Enabling RSVP TrapsCommand or Action Purpose • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Related Topics RSVP MIB, on page 70 Enable RSVP Traps: Example, on page 108 How to Implement RSVP Authentication There are three types of RSVP authentication modes—global, interface, and neighbor. These topics describe how to implement RSVP authentication for each mode: Configuring Global Configuration Mode RSVP Authentication These tasks describe how to configure RSVP authentication in global configuration mode: Enabling RSVP Authentication Using the Keychain in Global Configuration Mode Perform this task to enable RSVP authentication for cryptographic authentication by specifying the keychain in global configuration mode. You must configure a keychain before completing this task (see Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Security Configuration Guide ). Note SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. rsvp authentication 3. key-source key-chain key-chain-name 4. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 88 OL-26056-02 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE How to Implement RSVP AuthenticationDETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 rsvp authentication Enters RSVP authentication configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# rsvp Step 2 authentication RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-auth)# Specifies the source of the key information to authenticate RSVP signaling messages. key-source key-chain key-chain-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-auth)# Step 3 key-chain-name Name of the keychain. The maximum number of charactersis 32. key-source key-chain mpls-keys Step 4 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-auth)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exitsthe configuration session, and returns or the router to EXEC mode. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-auth)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 89 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Configuring Global Configuration Mode RSVP AuthenticationRelated Topics Key-source Key-chain, on page 74 RSVP Authentication Global Configuration Mode: Example, on page 108 Configuring a Lifetime for RSVP Authentication in Global Configuration Mode Perform this task to configure a lifetime value for RSVP authentication in global configuration mode. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. rsvp authentication 3. life-time seconds 4. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 rsvp authentication Enters RSVP authentication configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# rsvp Step 2 authentication RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-auth)# Controls how long RSVP maintains security associations with other trusted RSVP neighbors. life-time seconds Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-auth)# Step 3 seconds Length of time (in seconds) that RSVP maintains idle security associations with other trusted RSVP neighbors. Range is from 30 to 86400. The default value is 1800. life-time 2000 Step 4 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 90 OL-26056-02 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Configuring Global Configuration Mode RSVP AuthenticationCommand or Action Purpose • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • end • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-auth)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-auth)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Related Topics Global, Interface, and Neighbor Authentication Modes, on page 72 RSVP Authentication Global Configuration Mode: Example, on page 108 Configuring the Window Size for RSVP Authentication in Global Configuration Mode Perform this task to configure the window size for RSVP authentication in global configuration mode. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. rsvp authentication 3. window-size N 4. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 91 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Configuring Global Configuration Mode RSVP AuthenticationDETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 rsvp authentication Enters RSVP authentication configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# rsvp Step 2 authentication RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-auth)# Specifies the maximum number of RSVP authenticated messages that can be received out-of-sequence. window-size N Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-auth)# Step 3 N Size of the window to restrict out-of-sequence messages. The range is from 1 to 64. The default value is 1, in which case all out-of-sequence messages are dropped. window-size 33 Step 4 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-auth)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns or the router to EXEC mode. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-auth)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 92 OL-26056-02 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Configuring Global Configuration Mode RSVP AuthenticationRelated Topics Guidelines for Window-Size and Out-of-Sequence Messages, on page 75 RSVP Authentication by Using All the Modes: Example, on page 110 RSVP Authentication for an Interface: Example, on page 109 Configuring an Interface for RSVP Authentication These tasks describe how to configure an interface for RSVP authentication: Specifying the RSVP Authentication Keychain in Interface Mode Perform this task to specify RSVP authentication keychain in interface mode. You must configure a keychain first (see Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Security Configuration Guide ). SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. rsvp interface type interface-path-id 3. authentication 4. key-source key-chain key-chain-name 5. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 rsvp interface type interface-path-id Enters RSVP interface configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# rsvp Step 2 interface POS 0/2/1/0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-if)# Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 93 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Configuring an Interface for RSVP AuthenticationCommand or Action Purpose authentication Enters RSVP authentication configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-if)# Step 3 authentication RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-if-auth)# Specifies the source of the key information to authenticate RSVP signaling messages. key-source key-chain key-chain-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-if-auth)# Step 4 key-chain-name Name of the keychain. The maximum number of characters is 32. key-source key-chain mpls-keys Step 5 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-if-auth)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and or returns the router to EXEC mode. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-if-auth)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Related Topics Global, Interface, and Neighbor Authentication Modes, on page 72 RSVP Authentication by Using All the Modes: Example, on page 110 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 94 OL-26056-02 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Configuring an Interface for RSVP AuthenticationConfiguring a Lifetime for an Interface for RSVP Authentication Perform this task to configure a lifetime for the security association for an interface. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. rsvp interface type interface-path-id 3. authentication 4. life-time seconds 5. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 rsvp interface type interface-path-id Enters RSVP interface configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# rsvp Step 2 interface POS 0/2/1/0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-if)# authentication Enters RSVP authentication configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-if)# Step 3 authentication RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-if-auth)# Controls how long RSVP maintains security associations with other trusted RSVP neighbors. life-time seconds Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-if-auth)# Step 4 seconds Length of time (in seconds) that RSVP maintainsidle security associations with other trusted RSVP neighbors. Range isfrom 30 to 86400. The default value is 1800. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 95 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Configuring an Interface for RSVP AuthenticationCommand or Action Purpose life-time 2000 Step 5 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-if-auth)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and or returns the router to EXEC mode. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-if-auth)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Related Topics RSVP Authentication Design, on page 71 RSVP Authentication by Using All the Modes: Example, on page 110 Configuring the Window Size for an Interface for RSVP Authentication Perform this task to configure the window size for an interface for RSVP authentication to check the validity of the sequence number received. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 96 OL-26056-02 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Configuring an Interface for RSVP AuthenticationSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. rsvp interface type interface-path-d 3. authentication 4. window-size N 5. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 rsvp interface type interface-path-d Enters RSVP interface configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# rsvp Step 2 interface POS 0/2/1/0 RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-if)# authentication Enters RSVP interface authentication configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-if)# Step 3 authentication RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-if-auth)# Specifies the maximum number of RSVP authenticated messages that can be received out-of-sequence. window-size N Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-if-auth)# Step 4 N Size of the window to restrict out-of-sequence messages. The range is from 1 to 64. The default value is 1, in which case all out-of-sequence messages are dropped. window-size 33 Step 5 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 97 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Configuring an Interface for RSVP AuthenticationCommand or Action Purpose • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • end • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-if-auth)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-if-auth)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Related Topics Guidelines for Window-Size and Out-of-Sequence Messages, on page 75 RSVP Authentication by Using All the Modes: Example, on page 110 RSVP Authentication for an Interface: Example, on page 109 Configuring RSVP Neighbor Authentication These tasks describe how to configure the RSVP neighbor authentication: • Specifying the Keychain for RSVP Neighbor Authentication, on page 98 • Configuring a Lifetime for RSVP Neighbor Authentication, on page 100 • Configuring the Window Size for RSVP Neighbor Authentication, on page 102 Specifying the Keychain for RSVP Neighbor Authentication Perform this task to specify the keychain RSVP neighbor authentication. You must configure a keychain first (see Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router System Security Configuration Guide ). Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 98 OL-26056-02 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Configuring RSVP Neighbor AuthenticationSUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. rsvp neighbor IP-address authentication 3. key-source key-chain key-chain-name 4. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Enters neighbor authentication configuration mode. Use the rsvp neighbor command to activate RSVP cryptographic authentication for a neighbor. rsvp neighbor IP-address authentication Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# rsvp neighbor Step 2 IP address 1.1.1.1 authentication IP address of the neighbor. A single IP address for a specific neighbor; usually one of the neighbor's physical or logical (loopback) interfaces. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-nbor-auth)# authentication Configures the RSVP authentication parameters. Specifies the source of the key information to authenticate RSVP signaling messages. key-source key-chain key-chain-name Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-nbor-auth)# Step 3 key-chain-name Name of the keychain. The maximum number of characters is 32. key-source key-chain mpls-keys Step 4 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 99 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Configuring RSVP Neighbor AuthenticationCommand or Action Purpose Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-nbor-auth)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. or RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-nbor-auth)# commit ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Related Topics Key-source Key-chain, on page 74 Security Association, on page 73 RSVP Neighbor Authentication: Example, on page 109 Configuring a Lifetime for RSVP Neighbor Authentication Perform this task to configure a lifetime for security association for RSVP neighbor authentication mode. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. rsvp neighbor IP-address authentication 3. life-time seconds 4. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 100 OL-26056-02 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Configuring RSVP Neighbor AuthenticationDETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Enters RSVP neighbor authentication configuration mode. Use the rsvp neighbor command to specify a neighbor under RSVP. rsvp neighbor IP-address authentication Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# rsvp neighbor Step 2 IP address IP address of the neighbor. A single IP address for a specific neighbor; usually one of the neighbor's physical or logical (loopback) interfaces. 1.1.1.1 authentication RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-nbor-auth)# authentication Configures the RSVP authentication parameters. Controls how long RSVP maintains security associations with other trusted RSVP neighbors. The argument specifies the life-time seconds Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-nbor-auth)# Step 3 seconds Length of time (in seconds) that RSVP maintainsidle security associations with other trusted RSVP neighbors. Range is from 30 to 86400. The default value is 1800. life-time 2000 Step 4 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-nbor-auth)# end ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and or returns the router to EXEC mode. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-nbor-auth)# commit ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes. ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 101 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Configuring RSVP Neighbor AuthenticationCommand or Action Purpose • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Related Topics Security Association, on page 73 RSVP Authentication Global Configuration Mode: Example, on page 108 Configuring the Window Size for RSVP Neighbor Authentication Perform this task to configure the RSVP neighbor authentication window size to check the validity of the sequence number received. SUMMARY STEPS 1. configure 2. rsvp neighbor IP address authentication 3. window-size N 4. Use one of the following commands: • end • commit DETAILED STEPS Command or Action Purpose configure Enters global configuration mode. Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure Step 1 Enters RSVP neighbor authentication configuration mode. Use the rsvp neighbor command to specify a neighbor under RSVP. rsvp neighbor IP address authentication Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# rsvp neighbor Step 2 IP address IP address of the neighbor. A single IP address for a specific neighbor; usually one of the neighbor's physical or logical (loopback) interfaces. 1.1.1.1 authentication RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-nbor-auth)# Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 102 OL-26056-02 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Configuring RSVP Neighbor AuthenticationCommand or Action Purpose authentication Configures the RSVP authentication parameters. Specifies the maximum number of RSVP authenticated messages that is received out-of-sequence. window-size N Example: RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rsvp-nbor-auth)# window-size 33 Step 3 N Size of the window to restrict out-of-sequence messages. The range is from 1 to 64. The default value is 1, in which case all out-of-sequence messages are dropped. Step 4 Use one of the following commands: Saves configuration changes. • end • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes: Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)? [cancel]: • commit Example: ? Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode. RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router (config-rsvp-nbor-auth)# end or ? Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router configuration changes. (config-rsvp-nbor-auth)# commit ? Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes. • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session. Related Topics Guidelines for Window-Size and Out-of-Sequence Messages, on page 75 RSVP Authentication by Using All the Modes: Example, on page 110 RSVP Authentication for an Interface: Example, on page 109 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 103 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Configuring RSVP Neighbor AuthenticationVerifying the Details of the RSVP Authentication To display the security associations that RSVP has established with other RSVP neighbors, use the show rsvp authentication command. Eliminating Security Associations for RSVP Authentication To eliminate RSVP authentication SA’s, use the clear rsvp authentication command. To eliminate RSVP counters for each SA, use the clear rsvp counters authentication command. Configuration Examples for RSVP Sample RSVP configurations are provided for some of the supported RSVP features. • Bandwidth Configuration (Prestandard): Example, on page 104 • Bandwidth Configuration (MAM): Example, on page 104 • Bandwidth Configuration (RDM): Example, on page 105 • Refresh Reduction and Reliable Messaging Configuration: Examples, on page 105 • Configure Graceful Restart: Examples, on page 106 • Configure ACL-based Prefix Filtering: Example, on page 107 • Set DSCP for RSVP Packets: Example, on page 107 • Enable RSVP Traps: Example, on page 108 Bandwidth Configuration (Prestandard): Example The example shows the configuration of bandwidth on an interface using prestandard DS-TE mode. The example configures an interface for a reservable bandwidth of 7500, specifies the maximum bandwidth for one flow to be 1000 and adds a sub-pool bandwidth of 2000. rsvp interface pos 0/3/0/0 bandwidth 7500 1000 sub-pool 2000 Bandwidth Configuration (MAM): Example The example shows the configuration of bandwidth on an interface using MAM. The example shows how to limit the total of all RSVP reservations on POS interface 0/3/0/0 to 7500 kbps, and allows each single flow to reserve no more than 1000 kbps. rsvp interface pos 0/3/0/0 bandwidth mam 7500 1000 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 104 OL-26056-02 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Verifying the Details of the RSVP AuthenticationRelated Topics Confirming DiffServ-TE Bandwidth, on page 76 Differentiated Services Traffic Engineering, on page 127 Bandwidth Configuration (RDM): Example The example shows the configuration of bandwidth on an interface using RDM. The example shows how to limit the total of all RSVP reservations on POS interface 0/3/0/0 to 7500 kbps, and allows each single flow to reserve no more than 1000 kbps. rsvp interface pos 0/3/0/0 bandwidth rdm 7500 1000 Related Topics Confirming DiffServ-TE Bandwidth, on page 76 Differentiated Services Traffic Engineering, on page 127 Refresh Reduction and Reliable Messaging Configuration: Examples Refresh reduction feature as defined by RFC 2961 issupported and enabled by default. The examplesillustrate the configuration for the refresh reduction feature. Refresh reduction is used with a neighbor only if the neighbor supports it also. Refresh Interval and the Number of Refresh Messages Configuration: Example The example shows how to configure the refresh interval to 30 seconds on POS 0/3/0/0 and how to change the number of refresh messages the node can miss before cleaning up the state from the default value of 4 to 6. rsvp interface pos 0/3/0/0 signalling refresh interval 30 signalling refresh missed 6 Retransmit Time Used in Reliable Messaging Configuration: Example The example shows how to set the retransmit timer to 2 seconds. To prevent unnecessary retransmits, the retransmit time value configured on the interface must be greater than the ACK hold time on its peer. rsvp interface pos 0/4/0/1 signalling refresh reduction reliable retransmit-time 2000 Acknowledgement Times Configuration: Example The example shows how to change the acknowledge hold time from the default value of 400 ms, to delay or speed up sending of ACKs, and the maximum acknowledgment message size from default size of 4096 bytes. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 105 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Bandwidth Configuration (RDM): ExampleThe example shows how to change the acknowledge hold time from the default value of 400 ms and how to delay or speed up sending of ACKs. The maximum acknowledgment message default size is from 4096 bytes. rsvp interface pos 0/4/0/1 signalling refresh reduction reliable ack-hold-time 1000 rsvp interface pos 0/4/0/1 signalling refresh reduction reliable ack-max-size 1000 Ensure retransmit time on the peers’ interface is at least twice the amount of the ACK hold time to prevent unnecessary retransmissions. Note Summary Refresh Message Size Configuration: Example The example shows how to set the summary refresh message maximum size to 1500 bytes. rsvp interface pos 0/4/0/1 signalling refresh reduction summary max-size 1500 Disable Refresh Reduction: Example If the peer node does notsupport refresh reduction, or for any other reason you want to disable refresh reduction on an interface, the example shows how to disable refresh reduction on that interface. rsvp interface pos 0/4/0/1 signalling refresh reduction disable Configure Graceful Restart: Examples RSVP graceful restart is configured globally or per interface (as are refresh-related parameters). These examples show how to enable graceful restart, set the restart time, and change the hello message interval. Enable Graceful Restart: Example The example shows how to enable the RSVP graceful restart by default. If disabled, enable it with the following command. rsvp signalling graceful-restart Related Topics Enabling Graceful Restart, on page 78 Graceful Restart: Standard and Interface-Based, on page 68 Enable Interface-Based Graceful Restart: Example The example shows how to enable the RSVP graceful restart feature on an interface. signalling hello graceful-restart interface-based Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 106 OL-26056-02 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Configure Graceful Restart: ExamplesRelated Topics Enabling Graceful Restart, on page 78 Graceful Restart: Standard and Interface-Based, on page 68 Change the Restart-Time: Example The example shows how to change the restart time that is advertised in hello messages sent to neighbor nodes. rsvp signalling graceful-restart restart-time 200 Change the Hello Interval: Example The example shows how to change the interval at which RSVP graceful restart hello messages are sent per neighbor, and change the number of hellos missed before the neighbor is declared down. rsvp signalling hello graceful-restart refresh interval 4000 rsvp signalling hello graceful-restart refresh misses 4 Configure ACL-based Prefix Filtering: Example The example shows when RSVP receives a Router Alert (RA) packet from source address 1.1.1.1 and 1.1.1.1 is not a local address. The packet is forwarded with IP TTL decremented. Packets destined to 2.2.2.2 are dropped. All other RA packets are processed as normal RSVP packets. show run ipv4 access-list ipv4 access-list rsvpacl 10 permit ip host 1.1.1.1 any 20 deny ip any host 2.2.2.2 ! show run rsvp rsvp signalling prefix-filtering access-list rsvpacl ! Related Topics Configuring ACLs for Prefix Filtering, on page 80 ACL-based Prefix Filtering, on page 70 Set DSCP for RSVP Packets: Example The configuration example setsthe Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP) field in the IP header of RSVP packets. rsvp interface pos0/2/0/1 signalling dscp 20 Related Topics Configuring RSVP Packet Dropping, on page 81 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 107 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Configure ACL-based Prefix Filtering: ExampleOverview of RSVP for MPLS-TE , on page 66 Enable RSVP Traps: Example The example enables the router to send all RSVP traps: configure snmp-server traps rsvp all The example enables the router to send RSVP LostFlow traps: configure snmp-server traps rsvp lost-flow The example enables the router to send RSVP RSVP NewFlow traps: configure snmp-server traps rsvp new-flow Related Topics Enabling RSVP Traps, on page 86 RSVP MIB, on page 70 Configuration Examples for RSVP Authentication These configuration examples are used for RSVP authentication: • RSVP Authentication Global Configuration Mode: Example, on page 108 • RSVP Authentication for an Interface: Example, on page 109 • RSVP Neighbor Authentication: Example, on page 109 • RSVP Authentication by Using All the Modes: Example, on page 110 RSVP Authentication Global Configuration Mode: Example The configuration example enables authentication of all RSVP messages and increases the default lifetime of the SAs. rsvp authentication key-source key-chain default_keys life-time 3600 ! ! Note The specified keychain (default_keys) must exist and contain valid keys, or signaling will fail. Related Topics Enabling RSVP Authentication Using the Keychain in Global Configuration Mode, on page 88 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 108 OL-26056-02 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Enable RSVP Traps: ExampleKey-source Key-chain, on page 74 Configuring a Lifetime for RSVP Authentication in Global Configuration Mode, on page 90 Global, Interface, and Neighbor Authentication Modes, on page 72 Configuring a Lifetime for RSVP Neighbor Authentication, on page 100 Security Association, on page 73 RSVP Authentication for an Interface: Example The configuration example enables authentication of all RSVP messages that are being sent or received on one interface only, and sets the window-size of the SAs. rsvp interface GigabitEthernet0/6/0/0 authentication window-size 64 ! ! Because the key-source keychain configuration is not specified, the global authentication mode keychain is used and inherited. The global keychain must exist and contain valid keys or signaling fails. Note Related Topics Configuring the Window Size for RSVP Authentication in Global Configuration Mode, on page 91 Configuring the Window Size for an Interface for RSVP Authentication, on page 96 Configuring the Window Size for RSVP Neighbor Authentication, on page 102 Guidelines for Window-Size and Out-of-Sequence Messages, on page 75 RSVP Neighbor Authentication: Example The configuration example enables authentication of all RSVP messages that are being sent to and received from only a particular IP address. rsvp neighbor 10.0.0.1 authentication key-source key-chain nbr_keys ! ! ! Related Topics Specifying the Keychain for RSVP Neighbor Authentication, on page 98 Key-source Key-chain, on page 74 Security Association, on page 73 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 109 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE RSVP Authentication for an Interface: ExampleRSVP Authentication by Using All the Modes: Example The configuration example shows how to perform the following functions: • Authenticates all RSVP messages. • Authenticates the RSVP messages to or from 10.0.0.1 by setting the keychain for the key-source key-chain command to nbr_keys, SA lifetime is set to 3600, and the default window-size is set to 1. • Authenticates the RSVP messages not to or from 10.0.0.1 by setting the keychain for the key-source key-chain command to default_keys, SA lifetime is set to 3600, and the window-size is set 64 when using GigabitEthernet0/6/0/0; otherwise, the default value of 1 is used. rsvp interface GigabitEthernet0/6/0/0 authentication window-size 64 ! ! neighbor 10.0.0.1 authentication key-source key-chain nbr_keys ! ! authentication key-source key-chain default_keys life-time 3600 ! ! If a keychain does not exist or contain valid keys, this is considered a configuration error because signaling fails. However, this can be intended to preventsignaling. For example, when using the above configuration, if the nbr_keys does not contain valid keys, all signaling with 10.0.0.1 fails. Note Related Topics Configuring the Window Size for RSVP Authentication in Global Configuration Mode, on page 91 Configuring the Window Size for an Interface for RSVP Authentication, on page 96 Configuring the Window Size for RSVP Neighbor Authentication, on page 102 Guidelines for Window-Size and Out-of-Sequence Messages, on page 75 Specifying the RSVP Authentication Keychain in Interface Mode, on page 93 Global, Interface, and Neighbor Authentication Modes, on page 72 Configuring a Lifetime for an Interface for RSVP Authentication, on page 95 RSVP Authentication Design, on page 71 Additional References These references are related to implementing MPLS RSVP: Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 110 OL-26056-02 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE RSVP Authentication by Using All the Modes: ExampleRelated Documents Related Topic Document Title RSVP Infrastructure Commands on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Command Reference Cisco IOS XR MPLS RSVP commands Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Getting Started Guide Getting started material Configuring AAA Services on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module in Information about user groups and task IDs Standards Standard Title No new or modified standards are supported by this — feature, and support for existing standards has not been modified by this feature. MIBs MIBs MIBs Link To locate and download MIBs using Cisco IOS XR software, use the Cisco MIB Locator found at the following URL and choose a platform under the Cisco Access Products menu: http://cisco.com/public/sw-center/netmgmt/cmtk/ mibs.shtml — RFCs RFCs Title Resource Reservation Protocol Version 1 Functional Specification RFC 2205 RFC 2206 RSVP Management Information Base using SMIv2 RFC 2747 RSVP Cryptographic Authentication RFC 2961 RSVP Refresh Overhead Reduction Extensions Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 111 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Additional ReferencesRFCs Title RFC 3209 RSVP-TE: Extensions to RSVP for LSP Tunnels RFC 3473 Generalized MPLS Signaling, RSVP-TE Extensions RFC 4090 Fast Reroute Extensionsto RSVP-TE for LSP Tunnels Technical Assistance Description Link The Cisco Technical Support website contains http://www.cisco.com/techsupport thousands of pages of searchable technical content, including links to products, technologies, solutions, technical tips, and tools. Registered Cisco.com users can log in from this page to access even more content. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 112 OL-26056-02 Implementing RSVP for MPLS-TE Additional ReferencesC H A P T E R 3 Implementing MPLS Forwarding This module describes how to implement MPLS Forwarding on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Routers. All Multiprotocol Label Switching (MPLS) features require a core set of MPLS label management and forwarding services; the MPLS Forwarding Infrastructure (MFI) supplies these services. Feature History for Implementing MPLS-TE Release Modification Release 3.7.2 This feature was introduced. • Prerequisites for Implementing Cisco MPLS Forwarding, page 113 • Restrictions for Implementing Cisco MPLS Forwarding, page 113 • Information About Implementing MPLS Forwarding, page 114 • Additional References, page 116 Prerequisites for Implementing Cisco MPLS Forwarding These prerequisites are required to implement MPLS Forwarding: • You must be in a user group associated with a task group that includesthe proper task IDs. The command reference guides include the task IDs required for each command. If you suspect user group assignment is preventing you from using a command, contact your AAA administrator for assistance. • Router that runs Cisco IOS XR software. • Installed composite mini-image and the MPLS package, or a full composite image. Restrictions for Implementing Cisco MPLS Forwarding • Label switching on a Cisco router requires that Cisco Express Forwarding (CEF) be enabled. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 113• CEF is mandatory for Cisco IOS XR software and it does not need to be enabled explicitly. Information About Implementing MPLS Forwarding To implement MPLS Forwarding, you should understand these concepts: MPLS Forwarding Overview MPLS combines the performance and capabilities of Layer 2 (data link layer) switching with the proven scalability of Layer 3 (network layer) routing. MPLS enables service providers to meet the challenges of growth in network utilization while providing the opportunity to differentiate services without sacrificing the existing network infrastructure. The MPLS architecture is flexible and can be employed in any combination of Layer 2 technologies. MPLS support is offered for all Layer 3 protocols, and scaling is possible well beyond that typically offered in today’s networks. Based on routing information that is stored in the VRF IP routing table and VRF CEF table, packets are forwarded to their destination using MPLS. A PE router binds a label to each customer prefix learned from a CE router and includes the label in the network reachability information for the prefix that it advertisesto other PE routers. When a PE router forwards a packet received from a CE router across the provider network, it labels the packet with the label learned from the destination PE router. When the destination PE router receives the labeled packet it pops the label and uses it to direct the packet to the correct CE router. Label forwarding across the provider backbone, is based on either dynamic label switching or traffic engineered paths. A customer data packet carries two levels of labels when traversing the backbone: • Top label directs the packet to the correct PE router • Second label indicates how that PE router should forward the packet to the CE router Label Switching Functions In conventional Layer 3 forwarding mechanisms, as a packet traverses the network, each router extracts all the information relevant to forwarding the packet from the Layer 3 header. This information is then used as an index for a routing table lookup to determine the next hop for the packet. In the most common case, the only relevant field in the header is the destination address field, but in some cases, other header fields might also be relevant. As a result, the header analysis must be done independently at each router through which the packet passes. In addition, a complicated table lookup must also be done at each router. In label switching, the analysis of the Layer 3 header is done only once. The Layer 3 header is then mapped into a fixed-length, unstructured value called a label. Many different headers can map to the same label, as long as those headers always result in the same choice of next hop. In effect, a label represents a forwarding equivalence class—that is, a set of packets which, however different they may be, are indistinguishable by the forwarding function. The initial choice of a label need not be based exclusively on the contents of the Layer 3 packet header; for example, forwarding decisions at subsequent hops can also be based on routing policy. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 114 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Forwarding Information About Implementing MPLS ForwardingOnce a label is assigned, a short label header is added at the front of the Layer 3 packet. This header is carried across the network as part of the packet. At subsequent hops through each MPLS router in the network, labels are swapped and forwarding decisions are made by means of MPLS forwarding table lookup for the label carried in the packet header. Hence, the packet header does not need to be reevaluated during packet transit through the network. Because the label is of fixed length and unstructured, the MPLS forwarding table lookup process is both straightforward and fast. Distribution of Label Bindings Each labelswitching router (LSR) in the network makes an independent, local decision asto which label value to use to represent a forwarding equivalence class. This association is known as a label binding. Note The distribution of label bindings cannot be done statically for the Layer 2 VPN pseudowire. Each LSR informs its neighbors of the label bindings it has made. This awareness of label bindings by neighboring routers is facilitated by these protocols: Label Distribution Protocol (LDP) Supports MPLS forwarding along normally routed paths. Resource Reservation Protocol (RSVP) Supports MPLS traffic engineering. Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) Supports MPLS virtual private networks (VPNs). When a labeled packet is sent from LSR A to the neighboring LSR B, the label value carried by the IP packet is the label value that LSR B assigned to represent the forwarding equivalence class of the packet. Thus, the label value changes as the IP packet traverses the network. MFI Control-Plane Services The MFI control-plane provides services to MPLS applications, such as Label Distribution Protocol (LDP) and Traffic Engineering (TE), that include enabling and disabling MPLS on an interface, local label allocation, MPLS rewrite setup (including backup links), management of MPLS label tables, and the interaction with other forwarding paths (IP Version 4 [IPv4] for example) to set up imposition and disposition. MFI Data-Plane Services The MFI data-plane provides a software implementation of MPLS forwarding in all of these forms: • Imposition • Disposition • Label swapping Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 115 Implementing MPLS Forwarding Distribution of Label BindingsMPLS Maximum Transmission Unit MPLS maximum transmission unit (MTU) indicates that the maximum size of the IP packet can still be sent on a data link, without fragmenting the packet. In addition, data linksin MPLS networks have a specific MTU, but for labeled packets. All IPv4 packets have one or more labels. This does imply that the labeled packets are slightly bigger than the IP packets, because for every label, four bytes are added to the packet. So, if n is the number of labels, n * 4 bytes are added to the size of the packet when the packet is labeled. The MPLS MTU parameter pertains to labeled packets. Additional References For additional information related to implementing MPLS Forwarding, refer to the following references: Related Documents Related Topic Document Title MPLS Forwarding Commands on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Routers MPLS Command Reference MPLS Forwarding commands Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Routers Getting Started Guide Getting started material Standards Standards Title No new or modified standards are supported by this — feature, and support for existing standards has not been modified by this feature. MIBs MIBs MIBs Link To locate and download MIBs using Cisco IOS XR software, use the Cisco MIB Locator found at the following URL and choose a platform under the Cisco Access Products menu: http://cisco.com/public/ sw-center/netmgmt/cmtk/mibs.shtml — Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 116 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Forwarding MPLS Maximum Transmission UnitRFCs RFCs Title RFC 3031 Multiprotocol Label Switching Architecture Time to Live (TTL) Processing in Multi-Protocol Label Switching (MPLS) Networks RFC 3443 Requirements for Inter-Area MPLS Traffic Engineering RFC 4105 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 117 Implementing MPLS Forwarding Additional References Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 118 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Forwarding Additional ReferencesC H A P T E R 4 Implementing MPLS Traffic Engineering This module describes how to implement MPLS Traffic Engineering on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router. Multiprotocol Label Switching (MPLS) is a standards-based solution driven by the Internet Engineering Task Force (IETF) that was devised to convert the Internet and IP backbones from best-effort networks into business-class transport mediums. MPLS, with its label switching capabilities, eliminates the need for an IP route look-up and creates a virtual circuit (VC)switching function, allowing enterprisesthe same performance on their IP-based network services as with those delivered over traditional networks such as Frame Relay or Asynchronous Transfer Mode (ATM). MPLS traffic engineering (MPLS-TE) software enables an MPLS backbone to replicate and expand upon the TE capabilities of Layer 2 ATM and Frame Relay networks. MPLS is an integration of Layer 2 and Layer 3 technologies. By making traditional Layer 2 features available to Layer 3, MPLS enablestraffic engineering. Thus, you can offer in a one-tier network what now can be achieved only by overlaying a Layer 3 network on a Layer 2 network. Feature History for Implementing MPLS-TE Release Modification Release 3.7.2 This feature was introduced. The MPLS Traffic Engineering (TE): Path Protection feature was added. Release 3.9.0 Release 3.9.1 The MPLS-TE automatic bandwidth feature is supported. Support was added for the following features: • AutoTunnel Backup • MPLS-TE Automatic Bandwidth • SRLG (Shared Risk Link Groups) Release 4.0.0 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 119Release Modification Support was added for the following features: • Ignore Intermediate System-to-Intermediate System Overload Bit Setting in MPLS-TE • Point-to-Multipoint Traffic-Engineering Release 4.1.0 Release 4.1.1 The Auto-Tunnel Mesh feature was added. Support was added for the following features: • Soft-Preemption • Path Option Attributes Release 4.2.0 The Auto-Tunnel Attribute-set feature was added for auto-backup tunnels. Release 4.2.1 • Prerequisites for Implementing Cisco MPLS Traffic Engineering, page 120 • Restrictions for Implementing Cisco MPLS Traffic Engineering, page 120 • Information About Implementing MPLS Traffic Engineering, page 121 • How to Implement Traffic Engineering, page 155 • Configuration Examples for Cisco MPLS-TE, page 260 • Additional References, page 283 Prerequisites for Implementing Cisco MPLS Traffic Engineering These prerequisites are required to implement MPLS TE: • You must be in a user group associated with a task group that includesthe proper task IDs. The command reference guides include the task IDs required for each command. If you suspect user group assignment is preventing you from using a command, contact your AAA administrator for assistance. • Router that runs Cisco IOS XR software . • Installed composite mini-image and the MPLS package, or a full composite image. • IGP activated. Restrictions for Implementing Cisco MPLS Traffic Engineering In addition to the MPLS-TE Fast Reroute feature supporting the GigabitEthernet and TenGigE line cards, this current release also supports the 8-port OC-12 SPA, 2-port OC-48 SPA, 1-port OC-192 SPA, along with the Cisco ASR 9000 Series SPA Interface Processor-700. This feature is also supported on the main interfaces Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 120 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Traffic Engineering Prerequisites for Implementing Cisco MPLS Traffic Engineeringon the SPA line cards, not on sub-interfaces. There is no support for the MPLS-TE Fast Reroute feature on the 2-port channelized OC-12 SPA or on the 1-port channelized OC-48 SPA. Information About Implementing MPLS Traffic Engineering To implement MPLS-TE, you should understand these concepts: Overview of MPLS Traffic Engineering MPLS-TE software enables an MPLS backbone to replicate and expand upon the traffic engineering capabilities of Layer 2 ATM and Frame Relay networks. MPLS is an integration of Layer 2 and Layer 3 technologies. By making traditional Layer 2 features available to Layer 3, MPLS enables traffic engineering. Thus, you can offer in a one-tier network what now can be achieved only by overlaying a Layer 3 network on a Layer 2 network. MPLS-TE is essential for service provider and Internet service provider (ISP) backbones. Such backbones must support a high use of transmission capacity, and the networks must be very resilient so that they can withstand link or node failures. MPLS-TE provides an integrated approach to traffic engineering.With MPLS, traffic engineering capabilities are integrated into Layer 3, which optimizes the routing of IP traffic, given the constraints imposed by backbone capacity and topology. Related Topics Configuring Forwarding over the MPLS-TE Tunnel, on page 161 Benefits of MPLS Traffic Engineering MPLS-TE enables ISPs to route network traffic to offer the best service to their users in terms of throughput and delay. By making the service provider more efficient, traffic engineering reduces the cost of the network. Currently, some ISPs base their services on an overlay model. In the overlay model, transmission facilities are managed by Layer 2 switching. The routers see only a fully meshed virtual topology, making most destinations appear one hop away. If you use the explicit Layer 2 transit layer, you can precisely control how traffic uses available bandwidth. However, the overlay model has numerous disadvantages. MPLS-TE achieves the TE benefits of the overlay model without running a separate network and without a non-scalable, full mesh of router interconnects. How MPLS-TE Works MPLS-TE automatically establishes and maintains label switched paths (LSPs) across the backbone by using RSVP. The path that an LSP uses is determined by the LSP resource requirements and network resources, such as bandwidth. Available resources are flooded by means of extensions to a link-state-based Interior Gateway Protocol (IGP). MPLS-TE tunnels are calculated at the LSP headend router, based on a fit between the required and available resources (constraint-based routing). The IGP automatically routes the traffic to these LSPs. Typically, a packet crossing the MPLS-TE backbone travels on a single LSP that connects the ingress point to the egress point. MPLS-TE is built on these mechanisms: Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 121 Implementing MPLS Traffic Engineering Information About Implementing MPLS Traffic EngineeringTunnel interfaces From a Layer 2 standpoint, an MPLS tunnel interface represents the headend of an LSP. It is configured with a set of resource requirements, such as bandwidth and media requirements, and priority. From a Layer 3 standpoint, an LSP tunnel interface is the headend of a unidirectional virtual link to the tunnel destination. MPLS-TE path calculation module This calculation module operates at the LSP headend. The module determines a path to use for an LSP. The path calculation uses a link-state database containing flooded topology and resource information. RSVP with TE extensions RSVP operates at each LSP hop and is used to signal and maintain LSPs based on the calculated path. MPLS-TE link management module This module operates at each LSP hop, performs link call admission on the RSVP signaling messages, and performs bookkeeping on topology and resource information to be flooded. Link-state IGP (Intermediate System-to-Intermediate System [IS-IS] or Open Shortest Path First [OSPF]—each with traffic engineering extensions) These IGPs are used to globally flood topology and resource information from the link management module. Enhancements to the shortest path first (SPF) calculation used by the link-state IGP (IS-IS or OSPF) The IGP automatically routes traffic to the appropriate LSP tunnel, based on tunnel destination. Static routes can also be used to direct traffic to LSP tunnels. Label switching forwarding This forwarding mechanism provides routers with a Layer 2-like ability to direct traffic across multiple hops of the LSP established by RSVP signaling. One approach to engineering a backbone is to define a mesh of tunnels from every ingress device to every egress device. The MPLS-TE path calculation and signaling modules determine the path taken by the LSPs for these tunnels, subject to resource availability and the dynamic state of the network. The IGP (operating at an ingress device) determines which traffic should go to which egress device, and steers that traffic into the tunnel from ingress to egress. A flow from an ingress device to an egress device might be so large that it cannot fit over a single link, so it cannot be carried by a single tunnel. In this case, multiple tunnels between a given ingress and egress can be configured, and the flow is distributed using load sharing among the tunnels. Related Topics Building MPLS-TE Topology, on page 155 Creating an MPLS-TE Tunnel, on page 158 Build MPLS-TE Topology and Tunnels: Example, on page 260 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 122 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Traffic Engineering Overview of MPLS Traffic EngineeringMPLS Traffic Engineering Multiprotocol Label Switching (MPLS) is an Internet Engineering Task Force (IETF)-specified framework that provides efficient designation, routing, forwarding, and switching of traffic flows through the network. TE is the process of adjusting bandwidth allocations to ensure that enough bandwidth is available for high-priority traffic. In MPLS TE, the upstream router creates a network tunnel for a particular traffic stream and setsthe bandwidth available for that tunnel. Backup AutoTunnels The MPLS Traffic Engineering AutoTunnel Backup feature enables a router to dynamically build backup tunnels on the interfacesthat are configured with MPLS TE tunnels. Thisfeature enables a router to dynamically build backup tunnels when they are needed. This prevents you from having to build MPLS TE tunnelsstatically. The MPLS Traffic Engineering (TE)—AutoTunnel Backup feature has these benefits: • Backup tunnels are built automatically, eliminating the need for usersto preconfigure each backup tunnel and then assign the backup tunnel to the protected interface. • Protection is expanded—FRR does not protect IP traffic that is not using the TE tunnel or Label Distribution Protocol (LDP) labels that are not using the TE tunnel. This feature protects against these failures: • P2P Tunnel NHOP protection—Protects against link failure for the associated P2P protected tunnel • P2P Tunnel NNHOP protection—Protects against node failure for the associated P2P protected tunnel • P2MP Tunnel NHOP protection—Protects against link failure for the associated P2MP protected tunnel Related Topics Enabling an AutoTunnel Backup, on page 169 Removing an AutoTunnel Backup, on page 170 Establishing MPLS Backup AutoTunnels to Protect Fast Reroutable TE LSPs, on page 172 Establishing Next-Hop Tunnels with Link Protection, on page 174 Configure the MPLS-TE Auto-Tunnel Backup: Example, on page 269 AutoTunnel Attribute-set This feature supports auto-tunnels configuration using attribute templates, known as attribute-set. The TE attribute-set template that specifies a set of TE tunnel attributes, is locally configured at the head-end of auto-tunnels. The control plane triggers the automatic provisioning of a corresponding TE tunnel, whose characteristics are specified in the respective attribute-set. Currently, auto-tunnel backups are created with the default values of all tunnel attributes. To support configurable attributes for auto-tunnel backup, it is required to configure attribute-set and assign it to the backup tunnels. The attribute-set consists of a set of tunnel attributes such as priority, affinity, signaled bandwidth, logging, policy-class, record-route and so on. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 123 Implementing MPLS Traffic Engineering MPLS Traffic EngineeringThe following rules (consistent across all auto-tunnels) apply while configuring the attribute-set: • If no attribute-set template is defined, the auto-tunnels is created using default attribute values. • If an attribute-set is defined and the attribute-set template is already configured, the auto-tunnel is created using the attributes specified in the associated attribute-set. • If an attribute-set is assigned, but it is not defined or configured, auto-tunnel is not created. • Any number of attribute-sets can be configured with same attribute settings. • Empty tunnel attribute implies all parameters have default values. • When specific attribute is not specified in the attribute-set, a default value for that attribute is used. Link Protection The backup tunnels that bypass only a single link of the LSP path provide link protection. They protect LSPs, if a link along their path fails, by rerouting the LSP traffic to the next hop, thereby bypassing the failed link. These are referred to as NHOP backup tunnels because they terminate at the LSP's next hop beyond the point of failure. This figure illustrates link protection. Figure 10: Link Protection Node Protection The backup tunnels that bypass next-hop nodes along LSP paths are called NNHOP backup tunnels because they terminate at the node following the next-hop node of the LSPs, thereby bypassing the next-hop node. They protect LSPs by enabling the node upstream of a link or node failure to reroute the LSPs and their traffic around a node failure to the next-hop node. NNHOP backup tunnels also provide protection from link failures because they bypass the failed link and the node. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 124 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Traffic Engineering MPLS Traffic EngineeringThis figure illustrates node protection. Figure 11: Node Protection Backup AutoTunnel Assignment At the head or mid points of a tunnel, the backup assignment finds an appropriate backup to protect a given primary tunnel for FRR protection. The backup assignment logic is performed differently based on the type of backup configured on the output interface used by the primary tunnel. Configured backup types are: • Static Backup • AutoTunnel Backup • No Backup (In this case no backup assignment is performed and the tunnels is unprotected.) Static backup and Backup AutoTunnel cannot exist together on the same interface or link. Note Node protection is always preferred over link protection in the Backup AutoTunnel assignment. Note In order that the Backup AutoTunnel feature operatessuccessfully, the following configuration must be applied at global configuration level: ipv4 unnumbered mpls traffic-eng Loopback 0 Note The Loopback 0 is used as router ID. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 125 Implementing MPLS Traffic Engineering MPLS Traffic EngineeringExplicit Paths Explicit paths are used to create backup autotunnels as follows: For NHOP Backup Autotunnels: • NHOP excludes the protected link's local IP address. • NHOP excludes the protected link’s remote IP address. • The explicit-path name is _autob_nhop_tunnelxxx, where xxx matches the dynamically created backup tunnel ID. For NNHOP Backup Autotunnels: • NNHOP excludes the protected link’s local IP address. • NNHOP excludes the protected link’s remote IP address (link address on next hop). • NNHOP excludes the NHOP router ID of the protected primary tunnel next hop. • The explicit-path name is _autob_nnhop_tunnelxxx, where xxx matchesthe dynamically created backup tunnel ID. Periodic Backup Promotion The periodic backup promotion attemptsto find and assign a better backup for primary tunnelsthat are already protected. With AutoTunnel Backup, the only scenario where two backups can protect the same primary tunnel is when both an NHOP and NNHOP AutoTunnel Backups get created. The backup assignment takes place as soon as the NHOP and NNHOP backup tunnels come up. So, there is no need to wait for the periodic promotion. Although there is no exception for AutoTunnel Backups, periodic backup promotion has no impact on primary tunnels protected by AutoTunnel Backup. One exception is when a manual promotion is triggered by the user using the mpls traffic-eng fast-reroute timers promotion command, where backup assignment or promotion istriggered on all FRR protected primary tunnels--even unprotected ones. This may trigger the immediate creation of some AutoTunnel Backup, if the command is entered within the time window when a required AutoTunnel Backup has not been yet created. You can configure the periodic promotion timer using the global configuration mpls traffic-eng fast-reroute timers promotion sec command. The range is 0 to 604800 seconds. Note A value of 0 for the periodic promotion timer disables the periodic promotion. Protocol-Based CLI Cisco IOS XR software provides a protocol-based command line interface. The CLI provides commands that can be used with the multiple IGP protocols supported by MPLS-TE. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 126 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Traffic Engineering Protocol-Based CLIDifferentiated Services Traffic Engineering MPLS Differentiated Services (Diff-Serv) Aware Traffic Engineering (DS-TE) is an extension of the regular MPLS-TE feature. Regular traffic engineering does not provide bandwidth guarantees to different traffic classes. A single bandwidth constraint is used in regular TE that is shared by all traffic. To support various classes of service (CoS), users can configure multiple bandwidth constraints. These bandwidth constraints can be treated differently based on the requirement for the traffic class using that constraint. MPLS DS-TE providesthe ability to configure multiple bandwidth constraints on an MPLS-enabled interface. Available bandwidths from all configured bandwidth constraints are advertised using IGP. TE tunnel is configured with bandwidth value and class-type requirements. Path calculation and admission control take the bandwidth and class-type into consideration. RSVP is used to signal the TE tunnel with bandwidth and class-type requirements. MPLS DS-TE is deployed with either Russian Doll Model (RDM) or Maximum Allocation Model (MAM) for bandwidth calculations. Cisco IOS XR software supports two DS-TE modes: Prestandard and IETF. Related Topics Confirming DiffServ-TE Bandwidth, on page 76 Bandwidth Configuration (MAM): Example, on page 104 Bandwidth Configuration (RDM): Example, on page 105 Prestandard DS-TE Mode Prestandard DS-TE uses the Cisco proprietary mechanisms for RSVP signaling and IGP advertisements. This DS-TE mode does not interoperate with third-party vendor equipment. Note that prestandard DS-TE is enabled only after configuring the sub-pool bandwidth values on MPLS-enabled interfaces. Prestandard Diff-Serve TE mode supports a single bandwidth constraint model a Russian Doll Model (RDM) with two bandwidth pools: global-pool and sub-pool. TE class map is not used with Prestandard DS-TE mode. Related Topics Configuring a Prestandard DS-TE Tunnel, on page 176 Configure IETF DS-TE Tunnels: Example, on page 261 IETF DS-TE Mode IETF DS-TE mode usesIETF-defined extensionsfor RSVP and IGP. This mode interoperates with third-party vendor equipment. IETF mode supports multiple bandwidth constraint models, including RDM and MAM, both with two bandwidth pools. In an IETF DS-TE network, identical bandwidth constraint models must be configured on all nodes. TE class map is used with IETF DS-TE mode and must be configured the same way on all nodes in the network. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 127 Implementing MPLS Traffic Engineering Differentiated Services Traffic EngineeringBandwidth Constraint Models IETF DS-TE mode provides support for the RDM and MAM bandwidth constraints models. Both models support up to two bandwidth pools. Cisco IOS XR software provides global configuration for the switching between bandwidth constraint models. Both models can be configured on a single interface to preconfigure the bandwidth constraints before swapping to an alternate bandwidth constraint model. Note NSF is not guaranteed when you change the bandwidth constraint model or configuration information. By default, RDM is the default bandwidth constraint model used in both pre-standard and IETF mode. Maximum Allocation Bandwidth Constraint Model The MAM constraint model has the following characteristics: • Easy to use and intuitive. • Isolation across class types. • Simultaneously achieves isolation, bandwidth efficiency, and protection against QoS degradation. Related Topics Configuring an IETF DS-TE Tunnel Using MAM, on page 181 Russian Doll Bandwidth Constraint Model The RDM constraint model has these characteristics: • Allows greater sharing of bandwidth among different class types. • Ensures bandwidth efficiency simultaneously and protection against QoS degradation of all class types. • Specifies that it is used in conjunction with preemption to simultaneously achieve isolation across class-types such that each class-type is guaranteed its share of bandwidth, bandwidth efficiency, and protection against QoS degradation of all class types. We recommend that RDM not be used in DS-TE environmentsin which the use of preemption is precluded. Although RDM ensures bandwidth efficiency and protection against QoS degradation of class types, it does guarantee isolation across class types. Note Related Topics Configuring an IETF DS-TE Tunnel Using RDM, on page 178 Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x 128 OL-26056-02 Implementing MPLS Traffic Engineering Differentiated Services Traffic EngineeringTE Class Mapping Each of the eight available bandwidth values advertised in the IGP corresponds to a TE class. Because the IGP advertises only eight bandwidth values, there can be a maximum of only eight TE classes supported in an IETF DS-TE network. TE class mapping must be exactly the same on all routers in a DS-TE domain. It is the responsibility of the operator configure these settings properly as there is no way to automatically check or enforce consistency. The operator must configure TE tunnel class types and priority levels to form a valid TE class. When the TE class map configuration is changed, tunnels already up are brought down. Tunnels in the down state, can be set up if a valid TE class map is found. The default TE class and attributes are listed. The default mapping includes four class types. Table 4: TE Classes and Priority TE Class Class Type Priority 0 0 7 1 1 7 2 Unused — 3 Unused — 4 0 0 5 1 0 6 Unused — 7 Unused — Flooding Available bandwidth in all configured bandwidth poolsisflooded on the network to calculate accurate constraint paths when a new TE tunnel is configured. Flooding usesIGP protocol extensions and mechanismsto determine when to flood the network with bandwidth. Flooding Triggers TE Link Management (TE-Link) notifies IGP for both global pool and sub-pool available bandwidth and maximum bandwidth to flood the network in these events: • Periodic timer expires (this does not depend on bandwidth pool type). • Tunnel origination node has out-of-date information for either available global pool orsub-pool bandwidth, causing tunnel admission failure at the midpoint. Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide, Release 4.2.x OL-26056-02 129 Implementing MPLS Traffic Engineering Flooding• Consumed bandwidth crosses user-configured thresholds. The same threshold is used for both global pool and sub-pool. If one bandwidth crosses the threshold, both bandwidths are flooded. Flooding Thresholds Flooding frequently can burden a network because all routers must send out and process these updates. Infrequent flooding causes tunnel heads (tunnel-originating nodes) to have out-of-date information, causing tunnel admission to fail at the midpoints. You can control the frequency of flooding by configuring a set of thresholds. When locked bandwidth (at one or more priority levels) crosses one of these thresholds, flooding is triggered. Thresholds apply to a percentage of the maximum available bandwidth (the global pool), which is locked, and the percentage of maximum available guaranteed bandwidth (the sub-pool), which is locked. If, for one or more priority levels, either of these percentages crosses a threshold, flooding is triggered. Setting up a global pool TE tunnel can cause the locked bandwidth allocated to sub-pool tunnels to be reduced (and hence to cross a threshold). A sub-pool TE tunnel setup can similarly cause the locked bandwidth for global pool TE tunnels to cross a threshold. Thus, sub-pool TE and global pool TE tunnels can affect each other when flooding is triggered by thresholds. Note